CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041 SERVICE MANUAL 003980MIU
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041 SERVICE MANUAL CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041 SERVICE MANUAL
003980MIU
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
It is the reader's responsibility when discussing the information contained within this document to maintain a level of confidentiality that is in the best interest of Ricoh Americas Corporation and its member companies. NO PART OF THIS DOCUMENT MAY BE REPRODUCED IN ANY FASHION AND DISTRIBUTED WITHOUT THE PRIOR PERMISSION OF RICOH AMERICAS CORPORATION. All product names, domain names or product illustrations, including desktop images, used in this document are trademarks, registered trademarks or the property of their respective companies. They are used throughout this book in an informational or editorial fashion only and for the benefit of such companies. No such use, or the use of any trade name, or web site is intended to convey endorsement or other affiliation with Ricoh products.
© 2008 RICOH Americas Corporation. All rights reserved.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
WARNING The Service Manual contains information regarding service techniques, procedures, processes and spare parts of office equipment distributed by Ricoh Americas Corporation. Users of this manual should be either service trained or certified by successfully completing a Ricoh Technical Training Program. Untrained and uncertified users utilizing information contained in this service manual to repair or modify Ricoh equipment risk personal injury, damage to property or loss of warranty protection.
Ricoh Americas Corporation
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
LEGEND PRODUCT CODE D037 D038 D040 D041
GESTETNER MP C2030 MP C2050 MP C2530 MP C2550
COMPANY LANIER RICOH LD520CL Aficio MP C2030 LD520C Aficio MP C2050 LD525CL Aficio MP C2530 LD525C Aficio MP C2550
SAVIN C9020L C9020 C9025L C9025
DOCUMENTATION HISTORY REV. NO. *
DATE 10/2008
COMMENTS Original Printing
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041 TABLE OF CONTENTS PRODUCT INFORMATION 1. PRODUCT INFORMATION.......................................................... 1-1 1.1 SPECIFICATIONS......................................................................................1-1 1.2 MACHINE CONFIGURATION ....................................................................1-2 1.2.1 H-MODEL ..........................................................................................1-2 1.2.2 L-MODEL...........................................................................................1-5 1.3 OVERVIEW ................................................................................................1-7
INSTALLATION 2. INSTALLATION............................................................................ 2-1 2.1 INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS ............................................................2-1 2.1.1 ENVIRONMENT ................................................................................2-1 2.1.2 MACHINE LEVEL..............................................................................2-1 2.1.3 MACHINE SPACE REQUIREMENTS ...............................................2-2 2.1.4 POWER REQUIREMENTS ...............................................................2-2 2.2 OPTIONAL UNIT COMBINATIONS............................................................2-3 2.2.1 MACHINE OPTIONS.........................................................................2-3 2.2.2 CONTROLLER OPTIONS .................................................................2-3 2.3 COPIER INSTALLATION ...........................................................................2-5 2.3.1 POWER SOCKETS FOR PERIPHERALS ........................................2-5 2.3.2 INSTALLATION FLOW CHART ........................................................2-5 2.3.3 ACCESSORY CHECK ......................................................................2-6 2.3.4 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .........................................................2-9 Tapes and Retainers.............................................................................2-9 Developer and Toner Bottles ..............................................................2-11 Paper Trays ........................................................................................2-12 Emblem and Decals............................................................................2-13 Fax Settings for D037-17 ....................................................................2-13 Initialize the Developer........................................................................2-13
SM
i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Settings Relevant to the Service Contract ..........................................2-14 Settings for @Remote Service............................................................2-15 2.3.5 MOVING THE MACHINE ................................................................2-18 2.3.6 TRANSPORTING THE MACHINE ..................................................2-19 Main Frame.........................................................................................2-19 2.4 PAPER FEED UNIT (D331)......................................................................2-20 2.4.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ....................................................................2-20 2.4.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .......................................................2-20 2.5 PAPER FEED UNIT (D425)......................................................................2-23 2.5.1 COMPONENT CHECK....................................................................2-23 2.5.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .......................................................2-23 2.6 CASTER TABLE (D488)...........................................................................2-26 2.6.1 COMPONENT CHECK....................................................................2-26 2.6.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .......................................................2-26 2.7 ARDF (D366) ............................................................................................2-28 2.7.1 COMPONENT CHECK....................................................................2-28 2.7.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .......................................................2-28 2.8 PLATEN COVER INSTALLATION (G329) ...............................................2-32 2.9 SIDE TRAY (D427)...................................................................................2-33 2.9.1 COMPONENT CHECK....................................................................2-33 2.9.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .......................................................2-33 2.10 1-BIN TRAY UNIT (D426) ...................................................................2-36 2.10.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..............................................................2-36 2.10.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-36 2.11 SHIFT TRAY UNIT (D428)..................................................................2-39 2.11.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..............................................................2-39 2.11.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-39 2.12 INTERNAL FINISHER (D429).............................................................2-41 2.12.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..............................................................2-41 2.12.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-42 Preparing before Installing the Internal Finisher..................................2-42 Internal Finisher Installation ................................................................2-44 2.13 PUNCH UNIT (D390)..........................................................................2-47 2.13.1 COMPONENT CHECK ..............................................................2-47 2.13.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-47 Removing the Internal Finisher ...........................................................2-48 Preparing the Punch Unit before Installing the Internal Finisher .........2-50
D037/D038/D040/D041
ii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installing the Punch and Inverter Unit .................................................2-52 Preparing the Internal Finisher............................................................2-54 Installing the Internal Finisher .............................................................2-55 2.14 USB2.0/SD SLOT TYPE A .................................................................2-59 2.14.1 ACCESSORY CHECK ...............................................................2-59 2.14.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-59 2.14.3 TESTING THE SD CARD/USB SLOT .......................................2-62 2.15 MECHANICAL COUNTER (NA ONLY)...............................................2-64 2.15.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-64 2.16 KEY COUNTER BRACKET ................................................................2-66 2.16.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-66 2.17 KEY COUNTER INTERFACE UNIT ...................................................2-68 2.17.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-68 2.18 COPY DATA SECURITY UNIT TYPE F (B829)..................................2-70 2.18.1 INSTALLATION .........................................................................2-70 User Tool Setting ................................................................................2-71 2.19 ANTI-CONDENSATION HEATER ......................................................2-72 2.19.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-72 2.20 TRAY HEATER (MAINFRAME) ..........................................................2-76 2.20.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-76 2.21 TRAY HEATERS (OPTIONAL UNIT)..................................................2-78 2.21.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE..................................................2-78 Tray Heater for D425 ..........................................................................2-78 Tray Heater for D331 ..........................................................................2-82 2.22 CONTROLLER OPTIONS ..................................................................2-86 2.22.1 OVERVIEW................................................................................2-86 I/F Card Slots ......................................................................................2-86 SD Card Slots .....................................................................................2-86 USB Slots ...........................................................................................2-87 2.22.2 SD CARD APPLI MOVE ............................................................2-87 Overview .............................................................................................2-87 Move Exec ..........................................................................................2-88 Undo Exec ..........................................................................................2-89 2.22.3 POSTSCRIPT 3 (D038/D041 ONLY).........................................2-89 2.22.4 FILE FORMAT CONVERTER (D038/D041 ONLY)....................2-90 2.22.5 IEEE1284 (D038/D041 ONLY)...................................................2-91 Installation Procedure .........................................................................2-91
SM
iii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
2.22.6 IEEE 802.11 A/G, G (WIRELESS LAN: D038/D041 ONLY) ......2-92 Installation Procedure .........................................................................2-92 UP Mode Settings for Wireless LAN ...................................................2-94 SP Mode and UP Mode Settings for IEEE 802.11 a/g, g Wireless LAN2-95 2.22.7 BLUETOOTH (D038/D041 ONLY).............................................2-96 2.22.8 DATAOVERWRITESECURITY UNIT TYPE I (D362: D038/D041 ONLY) 2-97 Before You Begin the Procedure ........................................................2-97 Seal Check and Removal ...................................................................2-98 Installation Procedure .........................................................................2-98 2.22.9 HDD ENCRYPTION UNIT (D038/D041 ONLY) .......................2-100 Before You Begin the Procedure ......................................................2-100 Seal Check and Removal .................................................................2-101 Installation Procedure .......................................................................2-102 Recovery from a Device Problem .....................................................2-103 Restoring the Encryption key ............................................................2-103 Clearing the NVRAM.........................................................................2-104 2.22.10 PICTBRIDGE (D038/D041 ONLY) .......................................2-104 2.22.11 VM CARD TYPE I (D038/D041 ONLY) ................................2-105 Installation Procedure .......................................................................2-105 Firmware Update Procedure .............................................................2-106 2.22.12 BROWSER UNIT TYPE E (D038/D041 ONLY)....................2-107 Installation Procedure .......................................................................2-107 Update Procedure.............................................................................2-108 2.22.13 GIGABIT ETHERNET (D038/D041 ONLY) ..........................2-109 2.22.14 MEMORY UNIT TYPE I 512MB (D038/D041 ONLY) ...........2-110 2.22.15 CHECK ALL CONNECTIONS ..............................................2-111
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE 3. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE.................................................... 3-1 3.1 MAINTENANCE TABLES...........................................................................3-1 3.2 PM PARTS SETTINGS ..............................................................................3-2 3.2.1 BEFORE REMOVING THE OLD PM PARTS....................................3-2 3.2.2 AFTER INSTALLING THE NEW PM PARTS ....................................3-3 3.2.3 PREPARATION BEFORE OPERATION CHECK..............................3-3 3.2.4 OPERATION CHECK........................................................................3-4 D037/D038/D040/D041
iv CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 4. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ........................................ 4-1 4.1 BEFOREHAND...........................................................................................4-1 4.2 SPECIAL TOOLS .......................................................................................4-2 4.3 IMAGE ADJUSTMENT ...............................................................................4-3 4.3.1 SCANNING........................................................................................4-3 Scanner sub-scan magnification ...........................................................4-3 Scanner leading edge and side-to-side registration ..............................4-3 4.3.2 ARDF.................................................................................................4-4 ARDF side-to-side, leading edge registration and trailing edge ............4-4 ARDF sub-scan magnification...............................................................4-5 4.3.3 REGISTRATION................................................................................4-5 Image Area ...........................................................................................4-5 Leading Edge........................................................................................4-6 Side to Side...........................................................................................4-6 Adjustment Standard ............................................................................4-6 Paper Registration Standard.................................................................4-6 Adjustment Procedure ..........................................................................4-6 4.3.4 ERASE MARGIN ADJUSTMENT ......................................................4-6 4.3.5 COLOR REGISTRATION ..................................................................4-7 Line Position Adjustment ......................................................................4-7 4.3.6 PRINTER GAMMA CORRECTION ...................................................4-8 Copy Mode ...........................................................................................4-8 Printer Mode .......................................................................................4-13 4.4 EXTERIOR COVERS ...............................................................................4-15 4.4.1 PCDU TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE ..........................................4-15 4.4.2 FRONT DOOR ................................................................................4-15 4.4.3 ITB CLEANING UNIT COVER.........................................................4-16 4.4.4 LEFT COVER ..................................................................................4-17 4.4.5 REAR COVER.................................................................................4-17 4.4.6 REAR LOWER COVER...................................................................4-18 4.4.7 DUST FILTER .................................................................................4-18 4.4.8 RIGHT REAR COVER.....................................................................4-18 4.4.9 OPERATION PANEL.......................................................................4-19 For D038/D041 ...................................................................................4-19 SM
v CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
For D037/D040 ...................................................................................4-20 4.4.10 TOUCH PANEL POSITION ADJUSTMENT (D038/D041) .........4-20 4.4.11 INNER RIGHT COVER ..............................................................4-21 4.4.12 INNER COVER ..........................................................................4-21 4.4.13 FRONT RIGHT COVER.............................................................4-22 4.4.14 RIGHT UPPER COVER.............................................................4-22 4.4.15 LEFT FRAME AND LEFT FRAME REAR COVER ....................4-23 4.4.16 PAPER EXIT COVER ................................................................4-23 4.4.17 INVERTER TRAY ......................................................................4-24 4.4.18 INNER TRAY .............................................................................4-24 4.4.19 INNER REAR COVER ...............................................................4-24 4.5 SCANNER UNIT.......................................................................................4-26 4.5.1 EXPOSURE GLASS........................................................................4-26 4.5.2 ORIGINAL LENGTH SENSORS .....................................................4-27 4.5.3 EXPOSURE LAMP..........................................................................4-28 Reassembling .....................................................................................4-30 4.5.4 SCANNER MOTOR.........................................................................4-30 4.5.5 SENSOR BOARD UNIT (SBU)........................................................4-31 When reassembling ............................................................................4-32 4.5.6 EXPOSURE LAMP STABILIZER ....................................................4-32 4.5.7 SCANNER HP SENSOR .................................................................4-32 4.5.8 PLATEN COVER SENSOR.............................................................4-33 4.5.9 FRONT SCANNER WIRE ...............................................................4-34 Reinstalling the Front Scanner Wire ...................................................4-36 4.5.10 REAR SCANNER WIRE ............................................................4-38 Reinstalling the Rear Scanner Wire ....................................................4-38 4.6 LASER OPTICS .......................................................................................4-40 4.6.1 CAUTION DECAL LOCATION ........................................................4-40 4.6.2 LASER UNIT ...................................................................................4-40 Preparing a new laser unit ..................................................................4-41 Before removing the old laser unit ......................................................4-41 Recovery procedure for no replacement preparation of laser unit ......4-42 Removing the laser unit ......................................................................4-43 After installing a new laser unit ...........................................................4-44 4.6.3 POLYGON MIRROR MOTOR .........................................................4-45 4.7 IMAGE CREATION...................................................................................4-47 4.7.1 PCDU (PHOTO CONDUCTOR AND DEVELOPMENT UNIT) ........4-47
D037/D038/D040/D041
vi CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
When installing a new PCDU ..............................................................4-47 4.7.2 DRUM UNIT AND DEVELOPMENT UNIT.......................................4-48 New unit detection for the development unit .......................................4-50 4.7.3 TONER HOPPER UNIT ..................................................................4-50 Toner hopper unit: K, C, M..................................................................4-50 Toner hopper unit: Y ...........................................................................4-51 When installing a new toner hopper unit .............................................4-52 4.7.4 TONER SUPPLY MOTOR...............................................................4-52 4.7.5 TONER COLLECTION MOTOR......................................................4-54 4.7.6 PCDU TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE FULL SENSOR ................4-56 4.7.7 PCDU TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE SET SWITCH ...................4-56 4.7.8 RFID BOARD ..................................................................................4-57 4.8 IMAGE TRANSFER..................................................................................4-58 4.8.1 ITB CLEANING UNIT ......................................................................4-58 When installing the ITB cleaning unit ..................................................4-58 4.8.2 ITB TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE FULL SENSOR.....................4-58 4.8.3 ITB (IMAGE TRANSFER BELT) UNIT ............................................4-59 4.8.4 ITB UNIT MOTOR ...........................................................................4-60 4.8.5 IMAGE TRANSFER BELT...............................................................4-60 When reinstalling a new image transfer belt .......................................4-64 4.8.6 ITB CONTACT MOTOR ..................................................................4-64 4.8.7 ITB CONTACT SENSOR.................................................................4-65 4.9 PAPER TRANSFER .................................................................................4-67 4.9.1 PTR (PAPER TRANSFER ROLLER) UNIT .....................................4-67 4.9.2 OPENING THE PAPER TRANSFER UNIT .....................................4-68 4.9.3 ID SENSOR BOARD .......................................................................4-68 Cleaning for ID sensors ......................................................................4-69 After installing a new ID sensor unit/board..........................................4-70 4.9.4 TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY SENSOR...................................4-70 4.10 DRIVE UNIT........................................................................................4-72 4.10.1 GEAR UNIT ...............................................................................4-72 Adjustment after reinstalling the gear unit ...........................................4-73 4.10.2 REGISTRATION MOTOR..........................................................4-74 4.10.3 PAPER FEED MOTOR: T1........................................................4-74 4.10.4 PAPER FEED MOTOR: T2........................................................4-75 4.10.5 DRUM MOTOR: CMY................................................................4-75 4.10.6 DEVELOPMENT MOTOR: CMY................................................4-76
SM
vii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
4.10.7 DRUM/DEVELOPMENT MOTOR: K .........................................4-76 4.10.8 DEVELOPMENT CLUTCH: K ....................................................4-77 4.10.9 FUSING/PAPER EXIT MOTOR .................................................4-77 4.11 FUSING ..............................................................................................4-80 4.11.1 PM PARTS.................................................................................4-80 4.11.2 FUSING UNIT ............................................................................4-80 When installing the fusing unit ............................................................4-81 4.11.3 ENTRANCE GUIDE PLATE.......................................................4-81 Cleaning Requirement ........................................................................4-81 4.11.4 STRIPPER PLATE.....................................................................4-82 Cleaning Requirement ........................................................................4-83 4.11.5 EXIT GUIDE PLATE CLEANING PROCEDURE .......................4-84 4.11.6 PRESSURE ROLLER FUSING LAMP.......................................4-84 4.11.7 HEATING ROLLER FUSING LAMP ..........................................4-86 4.11.8 FUSING BELT ...........................................................................4-87 4.11.9 HEATING, FUSING AND TENSION ROLLER...........................4-90 When reinstalling the fusing roller .......................................................4-91 4.11.10 PRESSURE ROLLER ............................................................4-91 Cleaning Requirement ........................................................................4-93 4.11.11 HEATING ROLLER THERMOSTATS ....................................4-93 4.11.12 HEATING ROLLER THERMISTOR .......................................4-93 Cleaning Requirement ........................................................................4-94 4.11.13 PRESSURE ROLLER THERMISTOR....................................4-94 Pressure Roller Thermistor: Center ....................................................4-94 Pressure Roller Thermistor: Center ....................................................4-95 Cleaning Requirement ........................................................................4-96 4.11.14 PRESSURE ROLLER THERMOSTAT...................................4-96 4.11.15 THERMOPILE ........................................................................4-96 When cleaning the lens of the thermopile ...........................................4-97 4.11.16 CLEANING UNIT (OPTION) INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 4-98 4.12 PAPER FEED ...................................................................................4-100 4.12.1 PAPER TRAY ..........................................................................4-100 4.12.2 FEED ROLLER ........................................................................4-100 Tray 1 and Tray 2..............................................................................4-100 When reinstalling the feed roller........................................................4-100 4.12.3 FRICTION PAD........................................................................4-100 When reinstalling the friction pad ......................................................4-101
D037/D038/D040/D041
viii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
4.12.4 PAPER SIZE SWITCH.............................................................4-102 4.12.5 PAPER END SENSOR ............................................................4-102 Paper End Sensor: T1 ......................................................................4-102 Paper End Sensor: T2 ......................................................................4-103 4.12.6 REGISTRATION SENSOR ......................................................4-103 Cleaning the registration roller ..........................................................4-104 4.12.7 VERTICAL TRANSPORT SENSOR ........................................4-105 Vertical Transport Sensor 1 ..............................................................4-105 Vertical Transport Sensor 2 ..............................................................4-106 4.13 PAPER EXIT.....................................................................................4-108 4.13.1 JUNCTION GATE SOLENOID FAN ........................................4-108 When installing the junction gate solenoid fan ..................................4-108 4.13.2 PAPER EXIT UNIT ..................................................................4-108 4.13.3 FUSING EXIT ..........................................................................4-109 4.13.4 PAPER EXIT SENSOR............................................................4-110 When installing the paper exit sensor ...............................................4-111 4.13.5 INVERTER SENSOR...............................................................4-111 4.13.6 INVERTER MOTOR ................................................................4-112 4.13.7 FUSING FRONT FAN ..............................................................4-113 When installing the fusing front fan ...................................................4-113 4.14 DUPLEX UNIT ..................................................................................4-114 4.14.1 DUPLEX UNIT .........................................................................4-114 4.14.2 DUPLEX ENTRANCE SENSOR..............................................4-115 4.14.3 DUPLEX EXIT SENSOR..........................................................4-116 4.14.4 DUPLEX ENTRANCE MOTOR................................................4-117 4.14.5 DUPLEX EXIT MOTOR ...........................................................4-118 4.14.6 BY-PASS MOTOR ...................................................................4-119 4.14.7 BY-PASS TRAY UNIT .............................................................4-120 4.14.8 BY-PASS PAPER LENGTH SENSOR.....................................4-120 4.14.9 BY-PASS PAPER SIZE SENSOR ...........................................4-121 When reinstalling the by-pass paper size sensor..............................4-122 4.14.10 BY-PASS PAPER END SENSOR ........................................4-123 Reinstalling the By-pass Paper End Sensor .....................................4-123 4.14.11 BY-PASS FEED ROLLER ....................................................4-123 4.14.12 BY-PASS TRAY HP SENSOR .............................................4-123 4.15 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS .........................................................4-125 4.15.1 BOARDS..................................................................................4-125
SM
ix CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
4.15.2 CONTROLLER BOX COVER ..................................................4-126 4.15.3 CONTROLLER BOX................................................................4-126 Opening the controller box ................................................................4-126 4.15.4 BCU .........................................................................................4-127 When installing the new BCU............................................................4-128 4.15.5 HDD (ONLY FOR D038/D041) ................................................4-128 4.15.6 CONTROLLER BOX FAN........................................................4-129 When installing the controller box fan ...............................................4-130 4.15.7 FUSING REAR FAN ................................................................4-130 When installing the fusing rear fan....................................................4-131 4.15.8 PSU .........................................................................................4-131 4.15.9 HVPS: TTS BOARD.................................................................4-132 4.15.10 HVPS: CB BOARD ...............................................................4-132 4.15.11 I-CONTROLLER BOARD .....................................................4-133 When installing the new controller board ..........................................4-135 When installing a new HDD unit........................................................4-135 Disposal of HDD Units ......................................................................4-136 Reinstallation ....................................................................................4-136 4.15.12 NVRAM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE.............................4-136 NVRAM on the BCU .........................................................................4-136 NVRAM on the Controller .................................................................4-137 4.16 MACHINE BOOT-UP ........................................................................4-138
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE REFERENCE 5. SYSTEM MAINTENANCE REFERENCE .................................... 5-1 5.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE.....................................................................5-1 5.1.1 SP TABLES .......................................................................................5-1 5.1.2 TYPES OF SP MODES FOR DI-C1 H-MODEL (D038/D041) ...........5-1 SP Mode Button Summary ...................................................................5-2 Switching Between SP Mode and Copy Mode for Test Printing............5-3 Selecting the Program Number.............................................................5-3 Service Mode Lock/Unlock ...................................................................5-4 5.1.3 TYPES OF SP MODES FOR DI-C1 L-MODEL (D037/D040)............5-4 Selecting Programs...............................................................................5-5 Specifying Values .................................................................................5-5 Activating Copy Mode ...........................................................................5-5 D037/D038/D040/D041
x CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Quitting Programs/Ending SP Mode .....................................................5-5 5.1.4 REMARKS.........................................................................................5-6 Display on the Control Panel Screen ....................................................5-6 Others ...................................................................................................5-6 5.2 FIRMWARE UPDATE.................................................................................5-8 5.2.1 TYPE OF FIRMWARE.......................................................................5-8 H-Model (D038/D041)...........................................................................5-8 L-Model (D037/D040) ...........................................................................5-9 5.2.2 BEFORE YOU BEGIN.....................................................................5-10 5.2.3 UPDATING FIRMWARE .................................................................5-11 Preparation .........................................................................................5-11 Updating Procedure ............................................................................5-11 Error Messages...................................................................................5-12 Firmware Update Error .......................................................................5-12 Recovery after Power Loss .................................................................5-13 5.2.4 UPDATING THE LCDC FOR THE OPERATION PANEL................5-13 5.2.5 HANDLING FIRMWARE UPDATE ERRORS..................................5-14 Error Message Table ..........................................................................5-14 5.3 INSTALLING ANOTHER LANGUAGE .....................................................5-16 5.4 REBOOT/SYSTEM SETTING RESET .....................................................5-19 5.4.1 SOFTWARE RESET .......................................................................5-19 5.4.2 SYSTEM SETTINGS AND COPY SETTING RESET......................5-19 System Setting Reset .........................................................................5-19 Copier Setting Reset...........................................................................5-19 5.5 CONTROLLER SELF-DIAGNOSTICS .....................................................5-21 5.5.1 OVERVIEW .....................................................................................5-21 5.6 SD CARD APPLI MOVE...........................................................................5-22 5.6.1 OVERVIEW .....................................................................................5-22 5.6.2 MOVE EXEC ...................................................................................5-23 5.6.3 UNDO EXEC ...................................................................................5-23 5.7 DOWNLOADING STAMP DATA ..............................................................5-25 5.8 NVRAM DATA UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD ....................................................5-26 5.8.1 UPLOADING CONTENT OF NVRAM TO AN SD CARD ................5-26 5.8.2 DOWNLOADING AN SD CARD TO NVRAM ..................................5-26 5.9 ADDRESS BOOK UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD ...............................................5-28 5.9.1 INFORMATION LIST.......................................................................5-28 5.9.2 DOWNLOAD ...................................................................................5-28
SM
xi CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
5.9.3 UPLOAD..........................................................................................5-29 5.10 USING THE DEBUG LOG ..................................................................5-30 5.10.1 OVERVIEW................................................................................5-30 5.10.2 SWITCHING ON AND SETTING UP SAVE DEBUG LOG ........5-30 5.10.3 RETRIEVING THE DEBUG LOG FROM THE HDD ..................5-34 5.10.4 RECORDING ERRORS MANUALLY ........................................5-34 5.11 CARD SAVE FUNCTION....................................................................5-36 5.11.1 OVERVIEW................................................................................5-36 Card Save: ..........................................................................................5-36 5.11.2 PROCEDURE ............................................................................5-36 For D038/D041 ...................................................................................5-36 For D037/D040 ...................................................................................5-39 Error Messages...................................................................................5-41 5.11.3 ERROR MESSAGES .................................................................5-41
TROUBLESHOOTING 6. TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................................. 6-1 6.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS ..................................................................6-1 6.2 PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS ..........................................6-2 6.3 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE ...................................................................6-3 6.3.1 SUB-SCAN MAGNIFICATION ERROR.............................................6-3 Sub-scan Magnification Adjustment Procedure ....................................6-3 Motor Speed Adjustment ......................................................................6-4 6.3.2 TRAPEZOID IMAGE ADJUSTMENT ................................................6-6 Before Adjusting the Trapezoid Image..................................................6-6 Adjusting the Trapezoid Image .............................................................6-7 6.4 JAM DETECTION.....................................................................................6-10 6.5 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS..................................................6-11 6.6 SCANNER TEST MODE ..........................................................................6-12 6.6.1 SBU TEST MODE ...........................................................................6-12 6.6.2 IPU TEST MODE.............................................................................6-12 SP4-904-1 Register Access ................................................................6-12 SP4-904-2 Image Path .......................................................................6-12
D037/D038/D040/D041
xii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041 APPENDICES SEE APPENDIX SECTION FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS
D331 PAPER TRAY UNIT PB3030 SEE SECTION D331 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS
D366 ARDF DF3030 SEE SECTION D366 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS
D388 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3040 SEE SECTION D388 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS
D425 PAPER FEED UNIT PB3070 SEE SECTION D425 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS
D426 1 BIN TRAY BN3060 SEE SECTION D426 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS
D427 SIDE TRAY TYPE C2550 SEE SECTION D427 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS
D428 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3030 SEE SECTION D428 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS
SM
xiii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D429 INTERNAL FINISHER TYPE C2550 SEE SECTION D429 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS
D432/D433 FAX OPTION TYPE C2550/C2530 SEE SECTION D432/D433 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS
D037/D038/D040/D041
xiv CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Read This First Important Safety Notices Responsibilities of the Customer Engineer Customer Engineer Maintenance shall be done only by trained customer engineers who have completed service training for the machine and all optional devices designed for use with the machine. Reference Material for Maintenance
Maintenance shall be done using the special tools and procedures prescribed for maintenance of the machine described in the reference materials (service manuals, technical bulletins, operating instructions, and safety guidelines for customer engineers).
In regard to other safety issues not described in this document, all customer engineers shall strictly obey procedures and recommendations described the "CE Safety Guide".
Use only consumable supplies and replacement parts designed for use of the machine.
Before Installation, Maintenance Shipping and Moving the Machine
Work carefully when lifting or moving the machine. If the machine is heavy, two or more customer engineers may be required to prevent injuries (muscle strains, spinal injuries, etc.) or damage to the machine if it is dropped or tipped over.
Personnel moving or working around the machine should always wear proper clothing and footwear. Never wear loose fitting clothing or accessories (neckties, loose sweaters, bracelets, etc. ) or casual footwear (slippers, sandals, etc.) when lifting or moving the machine.
Always unplug the power cord from the power source before you move the product. Before you move the product, arrange the power cord so it will not fall under the product.
Power
Always disconnect the power plug before doing any maintenance procedure. After switching off the machine, power is still supplied to the main machine and other
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
devices. To prevent electrical shock, switch the machine off, wait for a few seconds, then unplug the machine from the power source.
Before you do any checks or adjustments after turning the machine off, work carefully to avoid injury. After removing covers or opening the machine to do checks or adjustments, never touch electrical components or moving parts (gears, timing belts, etc.).
After turning the machine on with any cover removed, keep your hands away from electrical components and moving parts. Never touch the cover of the fusing unit, gears, timing belts, etc.
Installation, Disassembly, and Adjustments
After installation, maintenance, or adjustment, always check the operation of the machine to make sure that it is operating normally. This ensures that all shipping materials, protective materials, wires and tags, metal brackets, etc., removed for installation, have been removed and that no tools remain inside the machine. This also ensures that all release interlock switches have been restored to normal operation.
Never use your fingers to check moving parts causing spurious noise. Never use your fingers to lubricate moving parts while the machine is operating.
Special Tools
Use only standard tools approved for machine maintenance.
For special adjustments, use only the special tools and lubricants described in the service manual. Using tools incorrectly, or using tools that could damage parts, could damage the machine or cause injuries.
During Maintenance General
Before you begin a maintenance procedure: 1) Switch the machine off, 2) Disconnect the power plug from the power source, 3) Allow the machine to cool for at least 10 minutes.
Avoid touching the components inside the machine that are labeled as hot surfaces.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Safety Devices
Never remove any safety device unless it requires replacement. Always replace safety devices immediately.
Never do any procedure that defeats the function of any safety device. Modification or removal of a safety device (fuse, switch, etc.) could lead to a fire and personal injury. Always test the operation of the machine to ensure that it is operating normally and safely after removal and replacement of any safety device.
For replacements use only the correct fuses or circuit breakers rated for use with the machine. Using replacement devices not designed for use with the machine could lead to a fire and personal injuries.
Organic Cleaners
During preventive maintenance, never use any organic cleaners (alcohol, etc.) other than those described in the service manual.
Make sure the room is well ventilated before using any organic cleaner. Use organic solvents in small amounts to avoid breathing the fumes and becoming nauseous.
Switch the machine off, unplug it, and allow it to cool before doing preventive maintenance. To avoid fire or explosion, never use an organic cleaner near any part that generates heat.
Wash your hands thoroughly after cleaning parts with an organic cleaner to contamination of food, drinks, etc. which could cause illness.
Clean the floor completely after accidental spillage of silicone oil or other materials to prevent slippery surfaces that could cause accidents leading to hand or leg injuries. Use "My Ace" Silicone Oil Remover (or dry rags) to soak up spills. For more details, please refer to Technical Bulletin "Silicone Oil Removal" (A024-50).
Lithium Batteries
Always replace a lithium battery on a PCB with the same type of battery prescribed for use on that board. Replacing a lithium battery with any type other than the one prescribed for use on the board could lead to an explosion or damage to the PCB.
Never discard used batteries by mixing them with other trash. Remove them from the work site and dispose of them in accordance with local laws and regulations regarding the disposal of such items.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Ozone Filters
Always replace ozone filters as soon as their service life expires (as described in the service manual).
An excessive amount of ozone can build up around machines that use ozone filters if they are not replaced at the prescribed time. Excessive ozone could cause personnel working around the machine to feel unwell.
Power Plug and Power Cord
Before serving the machine (especially when responding to a service call), always make sure that the power plug has been inserted completely into the power source. A partially inserted plug could lead to heat generation (due to a power surge caused by high resistance) and cause a fire or other problems.
Always check the power plug and make sure that it is free of dust and lint. Clean it if necessary. A dirty plug can generate heat which could cause a fire.
Inspect the length of the power cord for cuts or other damage. Replace the power cord if necessary. A frayed or otherwise damaged power cord can cause a short circuit which could lead to a fire or personal injury from electrical shock.
Check the length of the power cord between the machine and power supply. Make sure the power cord is not coiled or wrapped around any object such as a table leg. Coiling the power cord can cause excessive heat to build up and could cause a fire.
Make sure that the area around the power source is free of obstacles so the power cord can be removed quickly in case of an emergency.
Make sure that the power cord is grounded (earthed) at the power source with the ground wire on the plug.
Connect the power cord directly into the power source. Never use an extension cord.
When you disconnect the power plug from the power source, always pull on the plug, not the cable.
After Installation, Servicing Disposal of Used Items
Never incinerate used toner or toner cartridges.
Toner or toner cartridges thrown into a fire can ignite or explode and cause serious
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
injury. At the work site always carefully wrap used toner and toner cartridges with plastic bags to avoid spillage before disposal or removal.
Always dispose of used items (developer, toner, toner cartridges, OPC drums, etc.) in accordance with the local laws and regulations regarding the disposal of such items.
To protect the environment, never dispose of this product or any kind of waste from consumables at a household waste collection point. Dispose of these items at one of our dealers or at an authorized collection site.
Return used selenium drums to the service center for handling in accordance with company policy regarding the recycling or disposal of such items.
Points to Confirm with Operators At the end of installation or a service call, instruct the user about use of the machine. Emphasize the following points.
Show operators how to remove jammed paper and troubleshoot other minor problems by following the procedures described in the operating instructions.
Point out the parts inside the machine that they should never touch or attempt to remove.
Confirm that operators know how to store and dispose of consumables.
Make sure that all operators have access to an operating instruction manual for the machine.
Confirm that operators have read and understand all the safety instructions described in the operating instructions.
Demonstrate how to turn off the power and disconnect the power plug (by pulling the plug, not the cord) if any of the following events occur: 1) something has spilled into the product, 2) service or repair of the product is necessary, 3) the product cover has been damaged.
Caution operators about removing paper fasteners around the machine. They should never allow paper clips, staples, or any other small metallic objects to fall into the machine.
Special Safety Instructions for Toner Accidental Physical Exposure
Work carefully when removing paper jams or replacing toner bottles or cartridges to avoid spilling toner on clothing or the hands.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
If toner is inhaled, immediately gargle with large amounts of cold water and move to a well ventilated location. If there are signs of irritation or other problems, seek medical attention.
If toner gets on the skin, wash immediately with soap and cold running water.
If toner gets into the eyes, flush the eyes with cold running water or eye wash. If there are signs of irritation or other problems, seek medical attention.
If toner is swallowed, drink a large amount of cold water to dilute the ingested toner. If there are signs of any problem, seek medical attention.
If toner spills on clothing, wash the affected area immediately with soap and cold water. Never use hot water! Hot water can cause toner to set and permanently stain fabric.
Handling and Storing Toner
Toner, used toner, and developer are extremely flammable.
Never store toner, developer, toner cartridges, or toner bottles (including empty toner bottles or cartridges) in a location where they will be exposed to high temperature or an open flame.
Always store toner and developer supplies such as toner and developer packages, cartridges, and bottles (including used toner and empty bottles and cartridges) out of the reach of children.
Always store fresh toner supplies or empty bottles or cartridges in a cool, dry location that is not exposed to direct sunlight.
Toner Disposal
Never attempt to incinerate toner, used toner, or empty toner containers (bottles or cartridges). Burning toner can explode and scatter, causing serious burns.
Always wrap used toner and empty toner bottles and cartridges in plastic bags to avoid spillage. Follow the local laws and regulations regarding the disposal of such items.
Dispose of used toner and toner cartridges at one of our dealers or at an authorized collection site. Always dispose of used toner cartridges and toner bottles in accordance with the local laws and regulations regarding the disposal of such items.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Safety Instructions for this Machine Prevention of Physical Injury 1.
Before disassembling or assembling parts of the machine and peripherals, make sure that the machine and peripheral power cords are unplugged.
2.
The plug should be near the machine and easily accessible.
3.
Note that some components of the machine and the paper tray unit are supplied with electrical voltage even if the main power switch is turned off.
4.
If any adjustment or operation check has to be made with exterior covers off or open while the main switch is turned on, keep hands away from electrified or mechanically driven components.
5.
If the [Start] key is pressed before the machine completes the warm-up period (the [Start] key starts blinking red and green ), keep hands away from the mechanical and the electrical components as the machine starts making copies as soon as the warm-up period is completed.
6.
The inside and the metal parts of the fusing unit become extremely hot while the machine is operating. Be careful to avoid touching those components with your bare hands.
7.
To prevent a fire or explosion, keep the machine away from flammable liquids, gases, and aerosols.
Health Safety Conditions 1.
Never operate the machine without the ozone filters installed.
2.
Always replace the ozone filters with the specified types at the proper intervals.
3.
Toner and developer are non-toxic, but if you get either of them in your eyes by accident, it may cause temporary eye discomfort. Try to remove with eye drops or flush with water as first aid. If unsuccessful, get medical attention.
Observance of Electrical Safety Standards 1.
The machine and its peripherals must be installed and maintained by a customer service representative who has completed the training course on those models.
2.
The NVRAM on the system control board has a lithium battery which can explode if replaced incorrectly. Replace the NVRAM only with an identical one. The manufacturer recommends replacing the entire NVRAM. Do not recharge or burn this battery. Used NVRAM must be handled in accordance with local regulations.
Safety and Ecological Notes for Disposal 1.
Do not incinerate toner bottles or used toner. Toner dust may ignite suddenly when exposed to an open flame.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
2.
Dispose of used toner, developer, and organic photoconductors in accordance with local regulations. (These are non-toxic supplies.)
3.
Dispose of replaced parts in accordance with local regulations.
4.
When keeping used lithium batteries in order to dispose of them later, do not put more than 100 batteries per sealed box. Storing larger numbers or not sealing them apart may lead to chemical reactions and heat build-up.
The danger of explosion exists if a battery of this type is incorrectly replaced.
Replace only with the same or an equivalent type recommended by the manufacturer. Discard used batteries in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions.
Laser Safety The Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) prohibits the repair of laser-based optical units in the field. The optical housing unit can only be repaired in a factory or at a location with the requisite equipment. The laser subsystem is replaceable in the field by a qualified Customer Engineer. The laser chassis is not repairable in the field. Customer engineers are therefore directed to return all chassis and laser subsystems to the factory or service depot when replacement of the optical subsystem is required.
Use of controls, or adjustment, or performance of procedures other than those specified in this manual may result in hazardous radiation exposure.
WARNING: Turn off the main switch before attempting any of the procedures in the Laser Optics Housing Unit section. Laser beams can seriously damage your eyes.
CAUTION MARKING:
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Symbols, Abbreviations and Trademarks This manual uses several symbols and abbreviations. The meaning of those symbols and abbreviations are as follows:
See or Refer to
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
=
Clamp
E-ring
SEF
Short Edge Feed
LEF
Long Edge Feed
Trademarks Microsoft®, Windows®, and MS-DOS® are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and /or other countries. PostScript® is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated. PCL® is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company. Ethernet® is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation. PowerPC® is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation. Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE APPENDIX: PM TABLES
TAB POSITION 2 TAB POSITION 5
TROUBLESHOOTING APPENDIX: TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
D426 1 BIN TRAY BN3060 D427 SIDE TRAY TYPE C2550
APPENDIX: ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS APPENDIX: SP MODE TABLES D388 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3040 D428 INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3030
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
TAB POSITION 8
APPENDIX: JAM DETECTION
TAB POSITION 7
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE REFERENCE APPENDIX: PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS
TAB POSITION 6
REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT APPENDIX: SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS D429 INTERNAL FINISHER TYPE C2550
TAB POSITION 3
INSTALLATION APPENDIX: OVERVIEW D331 PAPER TRAY UNIT PB3030 D425 PAPER FEED UNIT PB3070
TAB POSITION 4
PRODUCT INFORMATION APPENDIX: SPECIFICATIONS D366 ARDF DF3030 D432/D433 FAX OPTION TYPE C2550/C2530
TAB POSITION 1
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
PRODUCT INFORMATION
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Product Information
Specifications
1. PRODUCT INFORMATION 1.1 SPECIFICATIONS See "Appendices" for the following information:
Mainframe Specifications
Printer Specifications
Scanner Specifications
Supported Paper Sizes
Software Accessories
Optional Equipment
SM
1-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Machine Configuration
1.2 MACHINE CONFIGURATION There are two grades for this machine.
L-Model: This is a light model. Expansion functions and options are limited.
H-Model: This is a high grade model. Various expansion functions and options can be used.
1.2.1 H-MODEL
Machine
Call
Code
out
D038/D041
[1]
D038, D041
Platen cover
G329
[2]
One from the two;
ARDF
D366
[3]
Side tray
D427
[4]
Item
Mainframe
D037/D038/D040/D041
Remarks
[3] is standard. -
1-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Machine
Call
Code
out
1-bin tray
D426
[11]
Shift tray
D388
[10]
Internal finisher
D492
[9]
Item
Remarks
One of the following 4 choices: [9] only, [10] only,
Punch unit: 2/3 holes Punch unit: 2 holes Punch unit: 4 holes
D390-17
D390-27
Requires [9].
[8]
D390-31
Two-tray paper feed unit
D331
[11] only, or [10]+[11]
Requires [9].
Requires [9].
[5]
One from [5], [6], and [7]; The one-tray PFU [6] requires [7].
One-tray paper feed unit
D425
[6]
If neither [5] nor [6] is installed, install [7] if required by the customer.
Caster Table
Item
D448
[7]
Machine code
USB2.0/SD Slot
D422
Fax Option
D432
Memory Unit Type B
G578
Hand Set
B433
Gigabit Ethernet
G874
IEEE 1284
B679
SM
Remark -
SAF memory: Requires the Fax Option. For NA model only: Requires the Fax Option. You can only install one of these at a time.
1-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Product Information
Machine Configuration
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Machine Configuration Wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11a/g) Wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11g) Bluetooth File Format Converter Copy Data Security Unit
D377-01, 02
D377-19
B826 D377-04 B829
-
B870
-
Key Counter Bracket
A674
-
Memory Unit Type I
D435-01
Optional Counter Interface Unit
Printer Enhanced Option
PostScript 3
(For printer function)
D435-03, -04, -05 D435-09, -10, -11
You can only install one of these in SD slot 1 at a time
Data Overwrite Security Unit
D362
PictBridge
M344
VM Card
D430-01, 02, 03
Browser Unit
D430-05, 06, 07
HDD Encryption Unit
D037/D038/D040/D041
In SD card slot 2
D377-16
1-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Product Information
Machine Configuration
1.2.2 L-MODEL
Machine
Call
Code
out
D037/D040
[1]
D037, D040
Platen cover
G329
[2]
One from the two;
ARDF
D366
[3]
Side tray
D427
[4]
-
1-bin tray
D426
[8]
-
D331
[5]
Item
Mainframe
Two-tray paper feed unit
Remarks
[3] is standard for NA and EU
One from [5], [6], and [7]; The one-tray PFU [6] requires [7].
One-tray paper feed unit Caster Table
SM
D425
[6]
If neither [5] nor [6] is installed, install [7] if required by the customer.
D448
[7]
1-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Machine Configuration
Item
Machine code
Remark
Fax Option
D433
Hand Set
B433
Copy Data Security Unit
B829
-
B870
-
Optional Counter Interface Unit
Printer Enhanced Option
For NA model only: Requires the Fax Option.
D435-03, -04, You can only install one of
-05
these in SD slot 1 at a time PictBridge
D037/D038/D040/D041
M344
1-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Product Information
Overview
1.3 OVERVIEW For "Overview" information, see "Appendices".
SM
1-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
INSTALLATION
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installation Requirements
2. INSTALLATION
Installaion
2.1 INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS 2.1.1 ENVIRONMENT
1.
Temperature Range: 10°C to 32°C (50°F to 89.6°F)
2.
Humidity Range: 15% to 80% RH
3.
Ambient Illumination: Less than 1500 lux (do not expose to direct sunlight)
4.
Ventilation: 3 times/hr/person or more
5.
Do not let the machine get exposed to the following: 1) Cool air from an air conditioner 2) Heat from a heater
6.
Do not install the machine in areas that are exposed to corrosive gas.
7.
Install the machine at locations lower than 2,500 m (8,200 ft.) above sea level.
8.
Install the machine on a strong, level base. (Inclination on any side must be no more than 5 mm.)
9.
Do not install the machine in areas that get strong vibrations.
2.1.2 MACHINE LEVEL Front to back: Within 5 mm (0.2") Right to left: Within 5 mm (0.2")
SM
2-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installation Requirements
2.1.3 MACHINE SPACE REQUIREMENTS
This machine, which uses high voltage power sources, can generate ozone gas. High ozone density is harmful to human health. Therefore, the machine must be installed in a well-ventilated room.
A: Over 100 mm (3.9") B: Over 100 mm (3.9") C: Over 100 mm (3.9") D: Over 100 mm (3.9") Put the machine near the power source with the clearance shown above.
2.1.4 POWER REQUIREMENTS
1.
Insert the plug firmly in the outlet.
Do not use an outlet extension plug or cord.
Ground the machine.
Input voltage level:
120 V, 60 Hz: More than 12 A
220 V to 240 V, 50 Hz/60 Hz: More than 8 A
2.
Permissible voltage fluctuation: ±10 %
3.
Do not put things on the power cord.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Optional Unit Combinations
2.2 OPTIONAL UNIT COMBINATIONS
Options No.
Remarks D037/D040
D038/D041
1
2-tray paper feed unit
2-tray paper feed unit
2
1-tray paper feed unit
1-tray paper feed unit
3
Caster table
Caster table
4
Platen cover
Platen cover
One from No.1 or No.2 (No. 2 requires No. 3)
One from No.4 or No.5 5
ARDF
ARDF (Standard)
6
1-bin tray unit
1-bin tray unit
7
-
Shift tray
If No 9 is installed, then No 6 and/or No 7 cannot
8
Side Tray
Side Tray
9
-
Internal finisher
10
-
*Punch kit (4 types)
11
Fax unit
Fax unit
-
12
-
Memory Unit (32M)*
Fax unit required
be installed.
No. 9 required; One of the types
*: Child options (Child options require a parent option.)
2.2.2 CONTROLLER OPTIONS
Options No.
Remarks D037/D040
SM
D038/D041
2-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
2.2.1 MACHINE OPTIONS
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Optional Unit Combinations 1
-
IEEE 802.11a/g
2
-
IEEE 1284
3
-
Bluetooth
4
-
File Format Converter
5
-
Gigabit Ethernet
6
-
PostScript 3
One from six items (I/F
7
Slot)
Printer Enhanced
-
Option
One of these (SD card slot 1)
8
PictBridge
PictBridge
9
-
DataOverwriteSecurity Unit
10
-
HDD Encryption Unit
11
-
Browser Unit
12
-
VM Card
SD card slot 2
13
Copy Data Security Unit
Copy Data Security Unit
-
14
-
Memory Unit (512M)
For SDK applications
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SD card slot 2 (during installation only) SD card slot 2 (during installation only)
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation
2.3 COPIER INSTALLATION
Installaion
2.3.1 POWER SOCKETS FOR PERIPHERALS
CAUTION Rating voltage for peripherals. Make sure to plug the cables into the correct sockets.
[1] ARDF: Rating voltage output connector for accessory Max. DC24V
[2] Finisher: Rating voltage output connector for accessory Max. DC24V
SM
2-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation
2.3.2 INSTALLATION FLOW CHART This flow chart shows the best procedure for installation.
*1: The shift tray should be installed first if you want to install the shift tray with the 1-bin tray at the same time.
2.3.3 ACCESSORY CHECK Check the quantity and condition of these accessories. For D037/D040 No.
Description
Q’ty
1.
Stamp
1
2.
EU Safety Sheet
1
Destination -17, -67
-67 3.
WEEE
D037/D038/D040/D041
1
2-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation No. 4.
Description
Q’ty
Certification
Destination
1
5.
Warranty Sheet (Chinese)
1
6.
Operating Instruction – About this machine
1
7.
Operating Instruction – Troubleshooting
1
8.
Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Copy Guide
1
9.
Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Fax Guide
1
10. Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Printer Guide
1
11. Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Scanner Guide
1
Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Printer &
1
12.
Scanner Guide
-17, -29, -21, -19
-17, -67, -29, -21, -19
-67, -29, -21, -19 -17, -67, -29, -21, -19, -28
13. Operating Instruction – Manual for This Machine
1 -67
14. Operating Instruction – Safety Information
1
15. CD-ROM Instruction – About this machine
1
16. CD-ROM Instruction – Troubleshooting
1
17. CD-ROM Instruction –Copy/Document Server Reference
1
18. CD-ROM Instruction –Facsimile Reference
1
19. CD-ROM Instruction –Printer Reference
1
20. CD-ROM Instruction –Scanner Reference
1
21. CD-ROM Instruction – Printer & Scanner Reference
1
22. CD-ROM Instruction – Network & General Setting Guide
1
23. CD-ROM Instruction – Security Reference
1
24. Printer Driver CD-ROM
1
-29, 28
25. Scanner Driver & Utility CD-ROM
1
-17, -67, -29
-17, -67, -29,
SM
2-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
-21, -19
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
-21
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation No.
Description
Q’ty
26. Clear Cover
Destination
1
For D038/D041
No.
Description
Q’ty
1.
Stamp
1
2.
EU Safety Sheet
1
Destination -57, -67
-67 3.
WEEE
1
4.
Certification
1 -21
5.
Warranty Sheet (Chinese)
1
6.
Operating Instruction – About this machine
1
7.
Operating Instruction – Troubleshooting
1
8.
Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Copy Guide
9.
Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Printer Guide
1
-57, -29, -21, -19 -67, -29, -21, -19
1
10. Operating Instruction – Quick Reference Scanner Guide
1
11. Operating Instruction – Manual for This Machine
1
-57, -67, -29, -21, -19
-67 12. Operating Instruction – Safety Information
1
13. CD-ROM Instruction – About this machine
1
14. CD-ROM Instruction – Troubleshooting
1
15. CD-ROM Instruction –Copy/Document Server Reference
1
16. CD-ROM Instruction –Facsimile Reference
1
17. CD-ROM Instruction –Printer Reference
1
18. CD-ROM Instruction –Scanner Reference
1
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
-57, -67, -29, -21, -19
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation Description
Q’ty
19. CD-ROM Instruction – Network & General Setting Guide
1
20. CD-ROM Instruction – Security Reference
1
Destination
-67, -29, -21,
21. PostScript 3 Supplement
-19, -28
22. Printer Driver CD-ROM
1
23. Scanner Driver & Utility CD-ROM
1
-29, 28
-57, -67, -29 24. Clear Cover
1
2.3.4 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Remove the tapes from the development units before you turn the main switch on. The development units can be severely damaged if you do not remove the tapes.
Put the machine on the paper tray unit first if you install an optional paper tray unit at the same time. Then install the machine and other options.
Keep the shipping retainers after you install the machine. You may need them in the future if you transport the machine to another location.
Tapes and Retainers
1.
Remove all the tapes and retainers on the machine.
2.
Remove all the tapes and retainers in trays 1 and 2.
SM
2-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
No.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation
3.
Remove the scanner unit stay [A].
4.
Keep the scanner unit stay in the cutout in the inner tray.
For the EU models, the scanner unit stay cannot be inserted in the cutout on the inner tray. You must bring this stay back to your depot.
5.
Install the inverter tray [A] (hooks).
6.
Open the duplex unit [A].
7.
Remove the sheet [B] of paper with a red tag.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Copier Installation
8.
Open the paper transfer unit [A].
9.
Remove the front and rear stoppers [B] with a red tag.
10. Close the duplex unit.
11. Attach the handle cover [A] to the front side of the duplex unit.
Developer and Toner Bottles
1.
Open the front door [A] and remove the PCDU toner collection bottle [B].
2.
Remove all tapes except the tape [C] from the four development units and from the toner hopper units.
SM
2-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation
Do not remove the tape [C] at this moment. You will find how to remove this tape later.
The toner hopper cover [C] is removed with tape [D].
Make sure that the all toner hopper covers are removed, when removing all tapes.
3.
Check if the toner hopper shutter [A] is fully closed.
If the toner hopper shutter is not fully closed and the inlet [B] of the toner hopper unit is visible, the toner bottle cannot be installed properly.
4.
Press the ITB lock lever [A] and turn it up as shown above.
5.
Remove the black PCDU [B] ( x 2).
6.
Remove the cover sheet [A] from the black PCDU.
7.
Reinstall the black PCDU into the mainframe ( x 2).
8.
Reinstall the PCDU toner collection bottle.
9.
Shake each toner bottle five or six times.
10. Slide the toner bottles in toner bottle cartridges, then turn each one to the right (clockwise). 11. Close the front door.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation
Installaion
Paper Trays
1.
Pull each paper tray [A] out. Then adjust the side guides and end guide to match the paper size.
To move the side guides, first pull out the tray fully. Then push down the green lock at the rear inside the tray.
Emblem and Decals
1.
Attach the correct emblem [A] and the cover [B] to the front door [C] of the machine, if the emblem is not attached.
If you want to change the emblem that has been already attached, remove the panel with an object (not a sharp object) as shown [D], and then install the correct emblem.
2.
SM
Attach the correct paper tray number and size decals to the paper trays [E].
2-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation
Paper tray number and size decals are also used for the optional paper tray or the optional LCT. Keep these decals for use with these optional units.
Fax Settings for D037-17 The D037-17 model has a fax unit as a standard function. Because of this, the fax settings are required at machine installation. Refer to steps 7 to 9 and 14 to 16 in the "Fax Option (D432) Installation Procedure" in the “Field Service Manual” of the fax option manual.
Initialize the Developer 1.
Make sure that the platen or ARDF is closed and the main power is turned off.
2.
Plug in the machine.
3.
Turn the main power switch on. The machine automatically starts the initialization procedure. The Start button LED (C) turns green when this procedure has finished.
4.
Make copies of image samples (text, photo, and text/photo modes).
5.
Do the Automatic Color Calibration process (ACC) for each mode (Copy mode, Printer 600 x 600 dpi, Printer 1800 x 600 dpi, and Printer 1200 x 1200 dpi) as follows ((Printer 1200 x 1200 dpi is for D038/D041 only):
1) Print the ACC test pattern (User tools > Maintenance > ACC > Start).
2) Put the printout on the exposure glass.
3) Put 10 sheets of white paper on top of the test chart.
4) Close the ARDF or the platen cover.
5) Press “Start Scanning” on the LCD panel. The machine starts the ACC.
6.
Check that the sample image has been copied normally.
7.
Open the front cover.
8.
Remove the instruction guide sheet [A], and make sure the SMC report [B] is stored as shown above. Then replace the instruction guide sheet.
Settings Relevant to the Service Contract Change the necessary settings for the following SP modes if the customer has made a service contract.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation
You must select one of the counter methods (developments/prints) in accordance with the contract ( SP5045-001).
SP No.
Function
Default
Specifies if the counting method used in meter charge mode is based on SP5-045-001
developments or prints. NOTE: You can set
“0”: Developments
this one time only. You cannot change the setting after you have set it for the first time. A3/11" x 17" double counting SP No.
Function
Default
Specifies whether the counter is doubled for SP5-104-001
A3/11" x 17" paper. When you have to
“No”: Single counting
change this setting, contact your supervisor. Service Tel. No. Setting SP No.
Function
Default
5812-002 programs the service station fax SP5-812-001 through 004
number. The number is printed on the counter list when the meter charge mode is selected. This lets the user fax the counter data to the service station.
Settings for @Remote Service
Prepare and check the following check points before you visit the customer site. For details, ask the @Remote key person.
Check points before making @Remote settings 1.
The setting of SP5816-201 in the mainframe must be "0".
2.
Device ID2 (SP5811-003) must be correctly programmed.
SM
6 spaces must be put between the 3-digit prefix and the following 8-digit number
2-15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
Counting method
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation (e.g. xxx______xxxxxxxx).
ID2 (SP5811-003) and the serial number (SP5811-001) must be the same (e.g. ID2: A01______23456789 = serial No. A0123456789)
3.
4.
The following settings must be correctly programmed.
Proxy server IP address (SP5816-063)
Proxy server Port number (SP5816-064)
Proxy User ID (SP5816-065)
Proxy Password (SP5816-066)
Get a Request Number
Execute the @Remote Settings 1.
Enter the SP mode.
2.
Input the Request number which you have obtained from @Remote Center GUI, and then enter [OK] with SP5816-202.
3.
Confirm the Request number, and then click [EXECUTE] with SP5816-203.
4.
Check the confirmation result with SP5816-204.
Value
Meaning
Solution/ Workaround
0
Succeeded
-
1
Request number error
Check the request number again.
3
4
5
Communication error (proxy
Communication error (proxy
Check the network condition.
disabled) Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)
6
Communication error
8
Other error
9
Check the network condition.
enabled)
Check the network condition. See "SP5816-208 Error Codes" below this.
Request number confirmation
Processing… Please wait.
executing
D037/D038/D040/D041
Check Proxy user name and password.
2-16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation 5.
Make sure that the screen displays the Location Information with SP5816-205 only
6.
Click [EXECUTE] to execute the registration with SP5816-206.
7.
Check the registration result with SP5816-207.
Value
Solution/ Workaround
0
Succeeded
-
1
Request number error
Check the request number again.
2
Already registered
Check the registration status.
3
4
5
8
9
8.
Meaning
Communication error (proxy
Check the network condition.
enabled) Communication error (proxy
Check the network condition.
disabled) Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)
Check Proxy user name and password.
See "SP5816-208 Error Codes" below
Other error
this.
Request number confirmation
Processing… Please wait.
executing
Exit the SP mode.
SP5816-208 Error Codes
Cause
Code
Operation Error, Incorrect Setting
-12002
Meaning
Inquiry, registration attempted without acquiring Request No.
-12003 Attempted registration without
Solution/ Workaround Obtain a Request Number before attempting the Inquiry or Registration. Perform Confirmation
execution of a confirmation and before attempting the no previous registration.
SM
2-17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Registration.
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
when it has been input at the Center GUI.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation Cause
Code
Meaning
-12004 Attempted setting with illegal
Solution/ Workaround Check ID2 of the
entries for certification and ID2. mainframe. -12005 @Remote communication is prohibited. The device has an Embedded RC gate-related problem.
Make sure that "Remote Service" in User Tools is set to "Do not prohibit".
-12006 A confirmation request was made after the confirmation
Execute registration.
had been already completed. -12007 The request number used at registration was different from
Check Request No.
the one used at confirmation. -12008 Update certification failed
Error Caused by Response from GW URL
Check the mainframe
because mainframe was in
condition. If the mainframe
use.
is in use, try again later.
-2385 Other error -2387 Not supported at the Service Center -2389 Database out of service -2390 Program out of service
-2391
Two registrations for the same
Check the registration
mainframe
condition of the mainframe
-2392 Parameter error -2393 External RCG not managed -2394 Mainframe not managed
-2395
D037/D038/D040/D041
Box ID for external RCG is illegal.
2-18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier Installation Code
-2396
Meaning Mainframe ID for external RCG is illegal.
-2397 Incorrect ID2 format
-2398
Solution/ Workaround
Incorrect request number format
Check the ID2 of the mainframe.
Check the Request No.
2.3.5 MOVING THE MACHINE This section shows you how to manually move the machine from one floor to another floor. See the section “Transporting the Machine” if you have to pack the machine and move it a longer distance.
Remove all trays from the optional paper feed unit.
2.3.6 TRANSPORTING THE MACHINE Main Frame 1.
Do SP 4806-001 to move the scanner carriage from the home position. This prevents dust from falling into the machine during transportation.
2.
Make sure there is no paper left in the paper trays. Then fix down the bottom plates with a sheet of paper and tape.
3.
Do one of the following:
Attach shipping tape to the covers and doors.
Shrink-wrap the machine tightly.
After you move the machine, Make sure you do the "Auto Color Registration" as follows. This optimizes color registration.
Do the "Forced Line Position Adj. Mode c" (SP2-111-3).
Then do the "Forced Line Position Adj. Mode a" (SP2-111-1). To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12.
Make sure that the side fences in the trays are correctly positioned to prevent color registration errors.
SM
2-19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
Cause
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed Unit (D331)
2.4 PAPER FEED UNIT (D331) 2.4.1 ACCESSORY CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.
Description
Q’ty
1
Paper Feed Unit
1
2
Screw - M4 x 10
4
3
Securing Bracket
2
2.4.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
The handles of the main machine for lifting must be inserted inside the machine and locked, unless these handles are used for the installation or relocation of the main machine.
You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one person, and may cause human injury or property damage.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed Unit (D331)
This installation procedure uses the following symbol.
: Screws
Remove the strips of tape.
2.
Set the copier [A] on the paper tray unit [B].
Installaion
1.
When installing the copier, be careful not to pinch the cable [C].
3.
Remove the connector cover [A] (rivet screw x 1).
4.
Connect the cable [B] to the copier, as shown.
5.
Attach a securing bracket [C] to each side of the paper tray unit, as shown ( x 1: M3 x 8 each).
6.
SM
Re-install the connector cover.
2-21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed Unit (D331)
7.
Remove the 1st and 2nd paper trays [A] and secure the paper tray unit with two screws (M4 x 10) [B].
8.
Reinstall all the paper trays.
9.
Attach the appropriate paper tray number decal and paper size decal to each handle of the trays.
The paper tray number and size decal sheet is in the accessory box of the main machine.
10. Rotate the adjuster [A] until the machine cannot be pushed across the floor. 11. Load paper into the paper trays and select the proper paper size. 12. Turn on the main switch. 13. Adjust the registration for each tray ( Section: Image Adjustment).
For tray 3, use SP1002-004
For tray 4, use SP1002-005
14. Check the machine’s operation and copy quality.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed Unit (D425)
2.5 PAPER FEED UNIT (D425)
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.
Description
Q’ty
1
Paper Feed Unit
1
2
Securing bracket
2
3
Screw (M4 x 10)
4
2.5.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation procedure.
You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one person, and may cause human injury or property damage.
Do not lift the copier with the paper feed unit installed. The handle and grips may be damaged.
The one-tray paper feed unit must be installed on the caster table (D448). Prepare the caster table first before installing this unit.
SM
2-23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
2.5.1 COMPONENT CHECK
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed Unit (D425)
This installation procedure uses the following symbols:
: Screws
1.
Remove all tape on the paper feed unit.
2.
Remove the paper tray and remove all tapes and padding.
3.
Put the paper tray unit on the caster table (D448).
For details about the installation of the caster table, see the Section: "Caster Table (D488)"” installation procedure.
4.
Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine.
5.
Lift the copier and install it on the paper feed unit [C].
Hold the handle and grips of the machine when you lift and move the machine.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Paper Feed Unit (D425)
6.
Remove the rear connector cover [A] of the main machine (rivet screw x 1).
7.
Connect the harness [B] to the main machine.
8.
Reinstall the rear connector cover [A] (rivet screw x 1).
9.
Remove tray 1 and 2 of the machine.
10. Fasten the screws (M4 x 10) [C]. 11. Reinstall all trays. 12. Attach the securing brackets [D] (M4 x 10; x 1 each). 13. Load paper into the paper feed unit. 14. Turn on the main power switch of the machine. 15. Adjust the registration for each tray ( Section: Image Adjustment).
Use SP1002-004
16. Check the paper feed unit operation and copy quality.
SM
2-25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Caster Table (D488)
2.6 CASTER TABLE (D488) 2.6.1 COMPONENT CHECK
No.
Description
Q’ty
1
Caster Table
1
2
Pin
2
3
Step Screw
2
2.6.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1.
Put the caster table on a flat place.
2.
Install the two pins in the screw holes.
Use the screw holes [A] and [C] if the mainframe is directly installed on the caster
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-26 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Caster Table (D488) table.
Use the screw holes [B] and [C] if the one-tray paper feed unit (D425) is installed
Installaion
on the caster table.
3.
Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine, if the copier is to be installed on the caster table.
Hold the handle and grips of the machine when you lift and move the machine.
4.
Lift the copier or one-tray paper feed unit [C], and then install it on the caster table [D].
5.
Pull out tray 2 of the mainframe or the tray of the one-tray paper feed unit.
6.
Secure the machine or one-tray paper feed unit to the caster table (step screw x 2)
7.
Reinstall the tray in the mainframe or one-tray paper feed unit.
SM
2-27 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
ARDF (D366)
2.7 ARDF (D366) 2.7.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.
Description
Q’ty
1
ARDF
1
2
Stamp Cartridge
1
3
Knob Screw
2
4
Stud Screw
2
5
Attention Decal – Top Cover
1
2.7.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1.
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
Remove all tapes and shipping retainers.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-28 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
ARDF (D366)
2.
Insert the two stud screws [A] on the top of the machine.
3.
Mount the ARDF [A] by aligning the screw keyholes [B] of the ARDF support plate over the stud screws.
4.
Slide the ARDF toward the front of the machine.
5.
Secure the ARDF with the two knob screws [C].
SM
2-29 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
ARDF (D366)
6.
Install the stamp cartridge [A] in the ARDF.
[B]
[A]
b789i104
7.
Peel off the platen sheet [A] and place it on the exposure glass.
8.
Align the rear left corner (of the platen sheet) with the corner [B] on the exposure glass.
9.
Close the ARDF.
10. Open the ARDF and check that the platen sheet is correctly attached.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-30 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
ARDF (D366)
11. Attach the decal [A] to the top cover as shown. Choose the language that you want. 12. Plug in and turn on the main power switch of the machine, and then check the ARDF operation. 13. Make a full size copy. Check that the registrations (side-to-side and leading edge) and image skew are correct. If they are not, adjust the registrations and image skew (see
Section: "Image Adjustment"" in the "Replacements and Adjustments" chapter).
SM
2-31 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Platen Cover Installation (G329)
2.8 PLATEN COVER INSTALLATION (G329)
1.
Install the stud screws [A] ( x 2) on the top cover as shown.
2.
Position the platen cover bracket [B] on the heads of the stud screws, and slide the platen cover [C] to the left.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-32 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Side Tray (D427)
2.9 SIDE TRAY (D427)
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.
Description
Q’ty
1
Side Tray Paper Exit Unit
1
2
Side Tray
1
3
Decal: Push
1
4
Decal: Door Push
1
5
Screw: M3x8
1
6
Tray Stopper
1
2.9.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
SM
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
2-33 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
2.9.1 COMPONENT CHECK
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Side Tray (D427) 1.
Remove all tapes on the side tray.
2.
Open the duplex unit [A].
3.
Remove the right upper cover [B] ( x 2).
4.
Close the side tray paper exit unit [A], and then connect the harness [B] to the machine.
5.
Install the side tray paper exit unit ( x 2: removed in step 3).
6.
Install the side tray [A].
7.
Lift the side tray, and then install the tray stopper [B] ( x 1: M3x8).
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-34 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Side Tray (D427)
8.
Attach the ‘Push door’ decal [A] to the top front edge of the duplex unit cover.
9.
Close the duplex unit, and then attach the ‘Push’ decal [A] to the duplex unit cover.
10. Turn on the main power switch of the machine. 11. Check the side tray operation.
SM
2-35 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
1-Bin Tray Unit (D426)
2.10 1-BIN TRAY UNIT (D426) 2.10.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.
Description
Q’ty
1
Tray
1
2
1-Bin Tray Unit
1
3
Screw: Blue (M3 x 6)
1
4
Screw (M3 x 8)
1
5
Tray Support Bar
1
2.10.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-36 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
1-Bin Tray Unit (D426)
If both the shift tray unit and the 1-bin tray unit are installed in the mainframe at the same time, install the shift tray unit first. Installing the shift tray unit after the 1-bin tray unit may be difficult.
Remove all tapes.
2.
Remove the inverter tray [A] (hook).
3.
Open the right door [B] of the machine.
4.
Remove the front right cover [C] ( x 1).
5.
Remove the paper exit cover [A].
6.
Remove the connector cover [A] with a small flat screwdriver.
Installaion
1.
SM
2-37 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
1-Bin Tray Unit (D426) 7.
Remove the left frame cover [B] ( x 1).
8.
Install the 1-bin tray unit [A] ( x 1: M3x6 blue, x 1).
9.
Install the tray [A] (with the tray support bar) in the machine.
10. Attach the tray support cover [B] ( x 2: M3x8 in the accessories and one screw removed in step 7). 11. Reassemble the machine. 12. Turn on the main power switch of the machine, and check the 1-bin tray unit operation.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-38 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Shift Tray Unit (D428)
2.11 SHIFT TRAY UNIT (D428)
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No. 1
Description Shift Tray Unit
Q’ty 1
2.11.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
If both the shift tray unit and the 1-bin tray unit are installed in the mainframe at the same time, install the shift tray unit first. Installing the shift tray unit after the 1-bin tray unit may be difficult.
1.
SM
Remove all tapes.
2-39 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
2.11.1 COMPONENT CHECK
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Shift Tray Unit (D428) 2.
Remove the inverter tray [A] (hook).
3.
Remove the output tray [B] ( x 2).
4.
Put the shift tray [A] in the machine, and then connect the harness to the connector [B] on the inner rear frame.
If the shift tray is difficult to install in the mainframe, remove the paper exit cover [C] first ( x 1).
5.
Install the shift tray [A] fully in the machine ( x 2).
6.
Reinstall the inverter tray.
7.
Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
8.
Check the shift tray unit operation.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-40 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Internal Finisher (D429)
2.12 INTERNAL FINISHER (D429) This procedure explains how to install the internal finisher, without installing the punch unit
2.12.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.
SM
Description
Q’ty
1
Internal Finisher
1
2
Inverter Unit
1
3
Inner Bottom Plate
1
4
Screw: M3x10
3
5
Screw: M3x6
11
6
Guide Rail
1
7
Inverter Cover
1
8
Left Cover
1
2-41 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
at the same time.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Internal Finisher (D429)
2.12.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
Preparing before Installing the Internal Finisher 1.
Remove all tapes from the internal finisher.
2.
Remove the inverter tray [A].
3.
Open the front door [B].
4.
Remove the lower inner cover [A].
5.
Press the ITB lock lever [B] and turn it up as shown above.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-42 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Internal Finisher (D429)
6.
Remove the inner right cover [A] ( x 2).
7.
Open the duplex unit [A], and then remove the front right cover [B] ( x 1).
8.
Remove the following:
SM
Inner tray [A] ( x 2)
Left frame rear cover [B] ( x 2)
Left frame cover [C] ( x 1)
Paper exit cover [D] ( x 1)
Inner rear cover [E] ( x 1)
2-43 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Internal Finisher (D429)
9.
Install the inner bottom plate [A] ( x 6).
10. Attach the left cover [A] ( x 2: M3x6, one screw removed in step 8).
Internal Finisher Installation
1.
Insert the inverter unit [A] in the machine.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-44 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Internal Finisher (D429)
2.
Insert two joint pins [A] into the two holes in the inner rear bracket.
3.
Fully attach the front side [B] of the inverter unit to the paper exit unit of the mainframe after inserting the two joint pins ( x 1: M3x6).
Insert the two joint pins before attaching the front side of the inverter unit to the paper exit unit of the mainframe. Otherwise, paper jams may occur between the paper exit unit and inverter unit.
4.
Install the guide rail [A] ( x 2: M3x6).
5.
Attach the inverter cover [A] ( x 3: M3x10).
SM
2-45 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Internal Finisher (D429)
6.
Install the internal finisher [A] from the left side of the machine.
7.
Insert the rear rail pins [A] into the frame of the machine ( x 1: M3x6).
8.
Push the internal finisher [A] and connect the cable [B] to the power socket of the machine.
9.
Reassemble the machine.
10. Turn on the main power switch of the machine. 11. Check the internal finisher operation.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-46 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Punch Unit (D390)
2.13 PUNCH UNIT (D390)
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.
Description
Q’ty
1
Punch Unit
1
2
Output Tray Lower Cover
1
3
Drawer Connector
1
4
Bracket
1
5
Left Frame Cover
1
6
Punch Cover
1
2.13.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE If the internal finisher has not already been installed, skip the ‘Removing the Internal Finisher’ section, and go to the ‘Preparing the Punch Unit before Installing the Internal
SM
2-47 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
2.13.1 COMPONENT CHECK
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Punch Unit (D390) Finisher’ section. Also do ‘Preparing before Installing the Internal Finisher’ in the ‘Internal Finisher (D429)’ section. If the internal finisher has already been installed, you must remove it first. Start from the ‘Removing the Internal Finisher’ section.
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
Removing the Internal Finisher 1.
Open the front door.
2.
Open the right door [A], and then remove the front right cover [B] ( x 1).
3.
Disconnect the cable [A] from the power socket of the machine, and then pull out the internal finisher [B].
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-48 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Punch Unit (D390)
4.
Remove the internal finisher [A] ( x 1: M3x6).
5.
Remove the inverter cover [A] ( x 3: M3x10).
6.
Remove the guide rail [A] ( x 2: M3x6).
SM
2-49 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Punch Unit (D390)
7.
Pull the inverter unit [A] toward the front side ( x 1: M3x6).
8.
Remove the inverter unit [A] from the machine.
Preparing the Punch Unit before Installing the Internal Finisher
1.
Remove the inverter right bracket [A] from the inverter unit ( x 4).
2.
To remove screw [B], open guide plate [C].
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-50 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Punch Unit (D390)
3.
Remove the positioning pin bracket [A] from the inverter right bracket ( x 2).
4.
Attach the inverter right bracket [A] to the punch unit [B] ( x 1: M3x6).
5.
Slide the inverter small guide [A] to the front side (arrow direction), and then remove it ( x 1).
6.
Remove all the tapes on the punch unit.
SM
If all the tapes are not removed, SC763 may occur.
2-51 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Punch Unit (D390)
7.
Attach the inverter unit [A] to the punch unit [B], and then secure the inverter unit with the punch unit ( x 4 removed in step 1).
8.
Attach the drawer connector [A] of the punch unit to the rear bracket of the inverter unit ( x 2 removed in step 3).
9.
Attach the clamp [B] to the rear bracket of the inverter unit.
Installing the Punch and Inverter Unit
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-52 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Punch Unit (D390) Install the punch and inverter unit [A] in the mainframe.
2.
Insert the two joint pins [A] (this picture does not show the two joint pins) into the two
Installaion
1.
holes in the inner rear bracket. 3.
Fully attach the front side [B] of the inverter unit to the paper exit unit of the mainframe after inserting two joint pins ( x 1: M3x6).
Insert the two joint pins before attaching the front side of the inverter unit to the paper exit unit of the mainframe. Otherwise, paper jams may occur between the paper exit unit and inverter unit.
4.
Remove the stopper [A] from the guide rail, and then attach with the screw holes [B] (these screw holes must be used when the internal finisher is installed with the punch unit).
SM
2-53 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Punch Unit (D390)
5.
Install the guide rail [A] on the front edge of the inner bottom plate ( x 2).
6.
Install the punch cover [A] ( x 3: M3x6).
Preparing the Internal Finisher
1.
Remove the left rear cover [A] and the rear cover [B] of the internal finisher ( x 2 each).
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-54 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Punch Unit (D390)
2.
Attach the drawer connector [A] to the rear bracket of the finisher.
3.
Connect the harnesses [B] to the connectors [C] on the main board.
4.
Black harness connector to CN16
Gray harness connector to CN17
Reinstall the rear cover (removed in step 1) ( x 2).
Installing the Internal Finisher
1.
Install the internal finisher [A] in the mainframe ( x 1).
2.
Remove the bracket [A] ( x 2).
SM
2-55 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Punch Unit (D390)
3.
Attach the bracket [A] ( x 2); this bracket is for the internal finisher when used with the punch unit.
4.
Remove the output tray lower cover [A]; this cover is for the internal finisher without the punch unit ( x 3).
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-56 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Punch Unit (D390)
5.
Attach the output tray lower cover [A]; this cover is for the internal finisher when used with the punch unit ( x 3).
Note
The two projections [A] on the output tray lower cover (this plate is actually attached to the output tray lower cover) must be inserted along the two guide rails [B] inside the output tray unit.
SM
2-57 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Punch Unit (D390)
[A]
Correct
Incorrect d390i550
d390i551
Push the slide plate [A] to check if the output tray lower cover is correctly installed. The left side picture shows the correct result and the right side picture shows the incorrect result.
6.
Attach the left frame cover [A] ( x 2).
7.
Push the internal finisher in the mainframe.
8.
Connect the I/F cable [B] of the finisher to the inlet of the mainframe.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-58 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
USB2.0/SD Slot Type A
2.14 USB2.0/SD SLOT TYPE A
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.
Description
Q’ty
1
USB2.0/SD Slot
1
2
Ground Plate
1
3
USB Cable
1
4
Screw: M3 x 6 blue
1
5
Screw: M3 x 8
4
6
Decal
1
2.14.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1.
Connect the USB cable [B] to the USB slot [A] in the USB2.0/SD Slot unit.
2.
Attach the ground plate [C] to the bracket of the USB2.0/SD Slot ( x 1: M3x6 blue).
SM
2-59 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
2.14.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
USB2.0/SD Slot Type A
3.
Remove the screw [A] first, and the rear cover [B] ( x 7).
4.
Remove the scanner left cover [A] ( x 2).
5.
Remove the left frame cover [B] ( x 2).
6.
Remove the part [A] on the scanner left cover.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-60 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
7.
Make four holes in the scanner left cover with a screwdriver as shown [A].
Smooth the four holes in the scanner left cover as shown [B].
8.
Route the USB cable [A] through the gaps in the left scanner cover.
9.
Secure the USB2.0/SD Slot [B] with the left scanner cover as shown above ( x 4: M3x8).
SM
Use the screw holes [C] as shown above.
2-61 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
USB2.0/SD Slot Type A
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
USB2.0/SD Slot Type A
10. Attach the scanner left cover [A] to the mainframe, and then connect the USB cable [B] to USB-A (this is the USB slot closest to the front side of the machine) as shown above.
Make sure that the USB cable is inserted in USB-A (front side).
11. Plug in and turn on the mainframe. 12. Enter the SP mode, and then change the setting of SP1013-001 from “0” to “1”.
13. Attach the decal [A] to the USB2.0/SD Slot as shown above.
2.14.3 TESTING THE SD CARD/USB SLOT 1.
Insert an SD card or USB memory device in the slot.
You can connect only one removable memory device at a time. 1.
Close the media slot cover.
If you leave the cover open, static electricity conducted through an inserted SD card could cause the machine to malfunction.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-62 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
USB2.0/SD Slot Type A 1.
Make sure that no previous settings remain.
1.
Place an original on the exposure glass.
2.
Press [Store File].
3.
Press [Store to Memory Device].
4.
Press [OK].
5.
Press the [Start] key.
Installaion
If a previous setting remains, press the [Clear Modes] key.
When writing is complete, a confirmation message appears. 1.
Press [Exit].
2.
Remove the memory device from the media slot.
Do not remove the memory device while writing is in process.
SM
2-63 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Mechanical Counter (NA Only)
2.15 MECHANICAL COUNTER (NA ONLY)
This counter is supplied as a spare part.
2.15.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1.
Rear cover ( Section: "Rear Cover" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section)
2.
Rear lower cover ( Section: "Rear Lower Cover" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section)
3.
Controller box cover ( Section: "Controller Box Cover " in the “Replacement and Adjustment” section)
4.
Remove the cutouts [A] in the rear lower cover with nippers.
5.
Attach the mechanical counters [A] to the bracket [B] and connect the harness to each mechanical counter as shown above.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-64 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Mechanical Counter (NA Only)
6.
Attach the clamp [A] as shown above.
7.
Attach the mechanical counter bracket [B] to the frame ( x 2).
8.
Connect the mechanical counter harness [C] to the mechanical counter [D] and the BCU (CN218) [E], and route the harness as shown above (= x 6)
9.
Reassemble the machine.
10. Plug in the machine and turn on the main power switch. 11. Enter the SP mode. 12. Set SP5987-001 to "1: ON". 13. Exit the SP mode, and then turn the machine off and on.
SM
2-65 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Key Counter Bracket
2.16 KEY COUNTER BRACKET After the key counter bracket is installed in the mainframe, the following options cannot be used at the same time.
Internal finisher (D429)
Handset (B433)
2.16.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1.
Hold the key counter plate nuts [A] on the inside of the key counter bracket [B] and insert the key counter holder [C].
2.
Secure the key counter holder to the bracket ( x 2).
3.
Install the key counter cover [D] ( x 2).
4.
Rear cover ( "Rear Cover" in the Replacement and Adjustment section)
5.
Cut off the part [A] of the rear cover.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-66 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Key Counter Bracket
6.
Peel off double sided tape on the key counter bracket, and attach the key counter to the scanner right cover.
7.
Connect the key counter cable [A] to the connector [B].
8.
Reassemble the machine.
SM
2-67 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Key Counter Interface Unit
2.17 KEY COUNTER INTERFACE UNIT 2.17.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
1.
Rear cover ( Section: "Rear Cover" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section)
2.
Rear lower cover ( Section: "Rear Lower Cover" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section)
3.
Cut off the part [A] of the rear cover.
4.
Attach the clamp [A] to the DRB bracket.
5.
Install the key counter interface board [B] on the DRB bracket ( x 4).
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-68 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Key Counter Interface Unit
6.
Connect and route the key counter cable [A] to the connector on the key counter interface board as shown above (ground screw x 1, = x 6).
7.
Connect and route the harness [B] to the connector on the key counter interface board and connector CN216 [C] on the BCU (= x 5)
8.
Pull the key counter cable through from the cutout and connect it to the connector [A] of the key counter unit.
9.
SM
Reassemble the machine.
2-69 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copy Data Security Unit Type F (B829)
2.18 COPY DATA SECURITY UNIT TYPE F (B829) 2.18.1 INSTALLATION
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
1.
Remove the rear lower cover [A] of the machine ( x 5).
2.
Remove the rear cover [B] of the machine ( x 7)
3.
Scanner cable bracket [A] ( x 4)
4.
Loosen the eight screws, and slide up the controller box cover [B].
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-70 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Copy Data Security Unit Type F (B829)
5.
Attach the ICIB-3 (copy data security board) [A] to CN 504 [B] on the BCU ( x 2).
6.
Reassemble the machine.
User Tool Setting 1.
Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
2.
Go into the User Tools mode, and select System Settings > Administrator Tools > Copy Data Security Option > “On”.
3.
Exit User Tools.
4.
Check the operation.
The machine will issue an SC165 error if the machine is powered on with the ICIB-3 removed and the “Data Security for Copying “feature set to “ON”.
When you remove this option from the machine, first set the setting to “OFF” with the user tool before removing this board. If you forget to do this, “Data Security for Copying “feature cannot appear in the user tool setting. And then SC165 will appear every time the machine is switched on, and the machine cannot be used.
Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see "Check All Connections" at the end of this section).
SM
2-71 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Anti-Condensation Heater
2.19 ANTI-CONDENSATION HEATER 2.19.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
This heater is supplied as a spare part.
1.
Rear cover ( Section: "Rear Cover" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section)
2.
Open the ARDF or platen cover.
3.
Glass cover [A] (stepped screw x 4)
4.
Scanner right cover [A] ( x 2)
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-72 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Anti-Condensation Heater
5.
ARDF exposure glass [A]
Position the white marker [B] at the rear-left corner when you reattach the ARDF exposure glass.
6.
Rear scale [A] (stepped screw x 3)
7.
Exposure glass [A] with left scale.
SM
Position the marker at the front-left corner when you reattach the exposure
2-73 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Anti-Condensation Heater glass.
8.
Move the scanner carriage fully across to the right side by rotating the scanner motor [A] at the rear of the machine.
9.
Put the connector of the heater [B] through the cutout [C].
10. Move the scanner carriage to the left side as shown above by rotating the scanner motor at the rear of the machine. 11. Install the heater in the scanner unit ( x 1). 12. Secure the cable cover [A] and the left side of the heater ( x 1).
13. Attach a clamp as shown above. 14. Connect the harness [A] of the heater to the connector [B] in the frame of the machine.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-74 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Anti-Condensation Heater
Installaion
15. Reassemble the machine.
16. Attach the on/standby decal [A] to the left-hand side of the main power switch.
SM
2-75 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Tray Heater (Mainframe)
2.20 TRAY HEATER (MAINFRAME) 2.20.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
This heater is supplied as a spare part.
1.
Remove trays 1 and 2 from the machine.
2.
Remove the connector cover [A] ( x 1).
3.
Connect the connector [B] of the heater to the connector of the main machine.
4.
Install the heater [C] inside the machine ( x 1)
5.
Reassemble the machine.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-76 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Tray Heater (Mainframe)
6.
SM
Attach the on/standby decal [A] to the left-hand side of the main power switch.
2-77 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)
2.21 TRAY HEATERS (OPTIONAL UNIT) 2.21.1 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
This heater is supplied as a spare part.
Tray Heater for D425
1.
Remove the rear connector cover [A] (rivet screw x 1) of the mainframe.
2.
Disconnect the harness [B].
3.
Remove the rear lower cover [A] of the mainframe ( x 5).
4.
Pull out all the tray cassettes of the paper feed unit.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-78 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)
5.
Remove the securing brackets [A] ( x 1 each), and then the rear cover [B] of the paper feed unit ( x 2).
6.
Pass the connector [A] through the opening [B].
7.
Install the tray heater [C] ( x 1)
8.
Connect the heater harness [A] of the heater to the relay harness [B].
SM
2-79 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)
9.
Insert the heater harness [A] into the tube [B], and push the tube against the rear frame of the paper feed unit as shown above.
Make sure that the tube is in contact with the rear frame [C].
10. Route the relay harness [A] as shown above (= x 5).
Make sure that the connector [A] is placed securely as shown above.
Make sure that the edge of the tube [B] is placed as shown above.
11. Reattach the rear cover of the paper feed unit ( x 2) and securing brackets ( x 1 each)
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-80 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)
12. Remove the connector cap [A] from the tray heater harness. 13. Connect the relay harness [B] to the tray heater harness [C] of the mainframe.
Do not connect the relay harness [B] to the tray heater harness of the mainframe before installing the securing bracket [D]. Otherwise, the securing bracket may pinch the relay harness.
14. Reinstall the rear lower cover of the mainframe ( x 5). 15. Reinstall all the tray cassettes.
16. Attach the on/standby decal [A] to the left-hand side of the main power switch.
SM
2-81 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)
Tray Heater for D331
1.
Remove the rear connector cover [A] (rivet screw x 1) of the mainframe.
2.
Disconnect the harness [B].
3.
Remove the rear lower cover [A] of the mainframe ( x 5).
4.
Pull out all the tray cassettes of the paper feed unit.
5.
Remove the securing brackets [A] ( x 1 each), and then rear cover [B] of the paper feed unit ( x 2).
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-82 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)
6.
Pass the connector [A] through the opening [B].
7.
Install the tray heater [C] ( x 1).
8.
Connect heater harness [A] of the heater to the relay harness [B].
9.
Remove the harness guide [A] ( x 1), and move it in the blue arrow direction as shown above.
SM
2-83 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)
10. Insert the heater harness [A] into the tube [B], and push the tube against the rear frame of the paper feed unit as shown above.
Make sure that the tube is contact with the rear frame [C].
11. Route the relay harness as shown above (= x 6).
Make sure that the edge of the tube [A] is placed as shown above.
The clamp [B] is not used.
12. Reinstall the harness guide. 13. Reattach the rear cover of the paper feed unit ( x 2) and securing brackets ( x 1 each).
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-84 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Tray Heaters (Optional Unit)
14. Remove the connector cap [A] from the tray heater harness. 15. Connect the relay harness [B] to the tray heater harness [C] of the mainframe.
Do not connect the relay harness [B] to the tray heater harness of the mainframe before installing the securing bracket [D]. Otherwise, the securing bracket may pinch the relay harness.
16. Reinstall the rear lower cover of the mainframe ( x 5). 17. Reinstall all the tray cassettes.
18. Attach the on/standby decal [A] to the left-hand side of the main power switch.
SM
2-85 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options
2.22 CONTROLLER OPTIONS 2.22.1 OVERVIEW This machine has I/F card slots for optional I/F connections and SD card slot applications. After you install an option, check that the machine can recognize it (see “Check All Connections” at the end of this section).
I/F Card Slots
Fax slot [A] is used for the Fax Option
I/F slot [B] is used for one of the optional I/F connections (only one can be installed): IEEE1284, IEEE802.11a/g, g (Wireless LAN), Bluetooth, File Format Converter, or Gigabit Ethernet.
The I/F Slot [B] is only used for D038/D041 (H Model).
SD Card Slots D037/D040:
Slot 1 is used for "Printer Enhanced Option".
Slot 2 is used for service only (for example, updating the firmware).
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-86 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options D038/D041:
Slot 1 is used for one of the optional applications: PostScript 3, Data Overwrite Security Unit, PictBridge Slot 2 is used for installing the Browser Unit, HDD Encryption unit, VM card or for service only (for example, updating the firmware).
USB Slots
Left-side USB slot [C]: Used for connecting a digital camera (only works if PictBridge is installed).
Right-side USB slot [D]: Used when installing the optional USB2.0/SD card slot
D038/D041 has two slots. D037/D040 has only one slot (there is no optional USB2.0/SD card slot for these models).
2.22.2 SD CARD APPLI MOVE
The PostScript3 application and fonts cannot be moved to another SD card. However, other applications can be moved onto the PostScript3 SD card.
Overview The service program “SD Card Appli Move” (SP5-873) lets you copy application programs from one SD card to another SD card. Slot 1 is used to store application programs. But there are 3 possible applications (PostScript 3, DOS (DataOverwriteSecurity) unit, PictBridge). You cannot run application programs from Slot 2. However you can move application programs from Slot 2 to Slot 1 with the following procedure. Make sure that the target SD card has enough space. 1.
Enter SP5873 “SD Card Appli Move”.
2.
Then move the application from the SD Card in Slot 2 to the SD Card in Slot 1.
3.
Do steps 1-2 again if you want to move another application program.
Exit the SP mode.
Be very careful when you do the SD Card Appli Move procedure:
The data necessary for authentication is transferred with the application program from an SD card to another SD card. Authentication fails if you try to use the SD card after you copy the application program from one card to another card.
SM
Do not use the SD card if it has been used before for other purposes. Normal operation
2-87 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options is not guaranteed when such an SD card is used.
Hold down the lever [A] and turn it in the arrow direction.
Remove the inner cover [B] ( x 4), and then keep the SD card in the place [C] after you copy the application program from one card to another card. This is done for the following reasons: 1) The SD card can be the only proof that the user is licensed to use the application program. 2) You may need to check the SD card and its data to solve a problem in the future.
You cannot copy PostScript application to another SD card. You have to copy the other application (PictBridge, DOS Unit) to the SD card that stores the PostScript application.
Move Exec The menu “Move Exec” (SP5-873-001) lets you copy application programs from the original SD card to another SD card.
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on the machine. If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware upgrade or application merge.
1.
Turn the main switch off.
2.
Make sure that an SD card is in SD Card Slot 1. The application program is copied to this SD card.
3.
Insert the SD card with the application program in SD Card Slot 2.The application program is copied from this SD card.
4.
Turn the main switch on.
5.
Start the SP mode.
6.
Select SP5-873-001 “Move Exec.”
7.
Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-88 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options 8.
Turn the main switch off.
9.
Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2.
10. Turn the main switch on.
Undo Exec “Undo Exec” (SP5-873-002) lets you copy back application programs from an SD card to the original SD card. You can use this program when, for example, you have mistakenly copied some programs by using Move Exec (SP5-873-001).
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on the machine. If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware upgrade or application merge.
1.
Turn the main switch off.
2.
Insert the original SD card in SD Card Slot 2. The application program is copied back into this card.
3.
Insert the SD card with the application program in SD Card Slot 1.The application program is copied back from this SD card.
4.
Turn the main switch on.
5.
Start the SP mode.
6.
Select SP5-873-002 “Undo Exec.”
7.
Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
8.
Turn the main switch off.
9.
Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2.
This step assumes that the application programs in the SD card are used by the machine.
10. Turn the main switch on. 11. Check that the application programs run normally. 12. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).
2.22.3 POSTSCRIPT 3 (D038/D041 ONLY) The PostScript3 application and fonts cannot be moved to another SD card. However, other applications can be moved onto the PostScript3 SD card.
SM
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
2-89 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
11. Check that the application programs run normally.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options
1.
Remove the SD-card slot cover [A] from the SD card slots ( x 1).
2.
Turn the SD-card label face to the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into slot 1 [B] until you hear a click.
3.
Attach the slot cover [A] ( x 1).
4.
Attach the “Adobe PostScript 3” decal [A] to the front door.
5.
Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).
2.22.4 FILE FORMAT CONVERTER (D038/D041 ONLY)
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-90 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Controller Options
1.
Remove the I/F-slot cover [A] ( x 2).
2.
Install the file format converter [B] into the I/F-slot and then fasten it with screws.
3.
Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
4.
Check or set the following SP codes with the values shown below.
SP No.
Title
Setting
SP5-836-001
Capture Function (0:Off 1:On)
"1"
SP5-836-002
Panel Setting
"0"
5.
Check the operation.
6.
Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).
2.22.5 IEEE1284 (D038/D041 ONLY) Installation Procedure
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at a time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g, g (Wireless LAN), IEEE1284, Bluetooth).
SM
2-91 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options
1.
Remove the I/F-slot cover [A] ( x 2).
2.
Install the interface board [B] (Knob-screw x 2) into the I/F-slot.
3.
Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).
2.22.6 IEEE 802.11 A/G, G (WIRELESS LAN: D038/D041 ONLY) Installation Procedure
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at one time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g, g (Wireless LAN), IEEE1284, Bluetooth).
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-92 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options 1.
Remove the I/F-slot cover [A] from the I/F-slot ( x 2).
2.
Install the wireless LAN board [B] (Knob-screw x 2) into the I/F-slot.
3.
Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at
Installaion
the end of this section).
4.
Peel off the double-sided tapes on the Velcro fasteners [A], and then attach them at the front left and rear left of the machine.
5.
Attach "ANT1" (having a black ferrite core) [B] to the front left of the machine.
6.
Attach "ANT2" (having a white ferrite core) [C] to the rear right of the machine.
"ANT1" is a transmission/reception antenna and "ANT2" is a reception antenna. Do not attach them at the wrong places.
7.
Attach the clamps as shown above.
8.
Wire the cables and clamp them (= x 7).
Make sure that the cables are not slack. Keep them wired tightly along the covers.
You may have to move the machine if the reception is not clear.
Make sure that the machine is not located near an appliance or any type of equipment that generates strong magnetic fields.
Put the machine as close as possible to the access point.
Installing Various Hardware Combinations
SM
2-93 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options
Refer to the above picture when installing the USB2.0/SD.
UP Mode Settings for Wireless LAN Enter the UP mode. Then do the procedure below to perform the initial interface settings for IEEE 802.11 a/g, g. These settings take effect every time the machine is powered on.
You cannot use the wireless LAN if you use Ethernet.
1.
Press the “User Tools/Counter” key.
2.
On the touch panel, press “System Settings”.
The Network I/F (default: Ethernet) must be set for either Ethernet or wireless LAN.
3.
Select “Interface Settings”.
4.
Press “Wireless LAN”. Only the wireless LAN options show.
5.
Communication Mode. Select either “802.11 Ad hoc”, “Ad hoc” or “Infrastructure”.
6.
SSID Setting. Enter the SSID setting. (The setting is case sensitive.)
7.
Channel. You need this setting when Ad Hoc Mode is selected. Range: 1 to 14 (default: 11)
8.
The allowed range for the channel settings may vary for different countries.
WEP (Encryption) Setting. The WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) setting is designed to protect wireless data transmission. The same WEP key is required on the receiving side in order to unlock encoded data. There are 64 bit and 128 bit WEP keys. WEP: Selects “Active” or “Inactive” (“Inactive” is default.). Range of Allowed Settings: 64 bit: 10 characters 128 bit: 26 characters
9.
Transmission Speed. Press the Next button to show more settings. Then select the
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-94 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options transmission speed for the mode: Auto, 11 Mbps, 5.5 Mbps, 2 Mbps, 1 Mbps (default: Auto). This setting should match the distance between the closest machine or access
For the Ad Hoc Mode, this is the distance between the machine and the closest PC in the network. For the Infrastructure Mode, this is the distance between the machine and the closest access point.
11 Mbps: 140 m (153 yd.) 5.5 Mbps: 200 m (219 yd.) 2 Mbps: 270 m (295 yd.) 1 Mbps: 400 m (437 yd.) 10. Press “Return to Default” to initialize the wireless LAN settings. Press “Yes” to initialize the following settings:
Transmission mode
Channel
Transmission Speed
WEP
SSID
WEP Key
SP Mode and UP Mode Settings for IEEE 802.11 a/g, g Wireless LAN The following SP commands and UP modes can be set for IEEE 802.11 a/g, g.
SP No.
Name
5840-006
Channel MAX
5840-007
Channel MIN
5840-011
WEP Key Select
Used to select the WEP key (Default: 00).
UP mode
Name
Function
SSID
Used to confirm the current SSID setting.
WEP Key
SM
Function Sets the maximum range of the channel settings for the country. Sets the minimum range of the channels settings allowed for your country.
Used to confirm the current WEP
2-95 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
point. This depends on which mode is selected.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options key setting. Used to show the maximum WEP Mode
length of the string that can be used for the WEP Key entry.
2.22.7 BLUETOOTH (D038/D041 ONLY)
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at a time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g, g (Wireless LAN), IEEE1284, Bluetooth).
1.
Remove the slot cover [A] ( x 2).
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-96 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Controller Options
2.
Install the Bluetooth board [A] (Knob-screw x 2) into the slot.
3.
Insert the Bluetooth card [B] into the Bluetooth card adaptor.
4.
Install the Bluetooth card adaptor on the Bluetooth board.
5.
Attach the antenna cap to the Bluetooth board.
6.
Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).
2.22.8 DATAOVERWRITESECURITY UNIT TYPE I (D362: D038/D041 ONLY) Before You Begin the Procedure 1.
Confirm that the DataOverwriteSecurity unit SD card is the correct type for the machine. The correct type for this machine is "Type I".
2.
Make sure that the following settings are not at their factory default values:
Supervisor login password
Administrator login name
Administrator login password
If any of these settings is at a factory default value, tell the customer these settings must be changed before you do the installation procedure. 3.
Make sure that “Admin. Authentication” is ON. [System Settings] – [Administrator Tools] – [Administrator Authentication Management] - [Admin. Authentication] If this setting is OFF, tell the customer this setting must be ON before you do the installation procedure.
4.
SM
Make sure that “Administrator Tools” is enabled (selected).
2-97 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options [System Settings] – [Administrator Tools] – [Administrator Authentication Management] - [Available Settings] If this setting is disabled (not selected), tell the customer this setting must be enabled (selected) before you do the installation procedure.
Seal Check and Removal
You must check the box seals to make sure that they were not removed after the items were sealed in the box at the factory before you do the installation.
1.
Check the box seals [A] on each corner of the box.
Make sure that a tape is attached to each corner.
The surfaces of the tapes must be blank. If you see “VOID” on the tapes, do not install the components in the box.
2.
If the surfaces of the tapes do not show “VOID”, remove them from the corners of the box.
3.
You can see the “VOID” marks [B] when you remove each seal. In this condition, they cannot be attached to the box again.
Installation Procedure
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You must install the DataOverwriteSecurity unit in SD Card slot 1. However, the Postscript option and others are also installed in SD Card slot 1. You must do the "SD Card Appli Move" procedure first if you want to install the Data Overwrite Security unit.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-98 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options Turn off the main power switch if the machine is turned on.
2.
Disconnect the network cable if it is connected.
3.
Remove the slot cover [A] of SD slots ( x 1).
4.
Turn the SD-card label face [B] to the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into slot
Installaion
1.
1 until you hear a click. 5.
Connect the network cable if it needs to be connected.
6.
Turn on the main power switch.
7.
Go into the SP mode and push “EXECUTE” with SP5-878-001.
8.
Exit the SP mode and turn off the operation switch. Then turn off the main power switch.
9.
Turn on the machine power.
10. Go into the User Tools mode, and select System Settings> Administrator Tools> Auto Erase Memory Setting> On. 11. Exit the User Tools mode.
12. Check the display and make sure that the overwrite erase icon [A] shows. 13. Check the overwrite erase icon.
SM
2-99 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options
The icon [B]: This icon is lit when there is temporary data to be overwritten, and blinks during overwriting.
The icon [C]: This icon is lit when there is no temporary data to be overwritten.
2.22.9 HDD ENCRYPTION UNIT (D038/D041 ONLY) Before You Begin the Procedure 1.
Make sure that the following settings are not at the factory default settings:
Supervisor login password
Administrator login name
Administrator login password
These settings must be set up by the customer before the HDD Encryption unit can be installed.
2.
Confirm that "Admin. Authentication" is on: [User Tools] > "System Settings"> "Administrator Tools"> "Administrator Authentication Management"> "Admin. Authentication"> "On" If this setting is "Off", tell the customer that this setting must be "On" before you can do the installation procedure.
3.
Confirm that "Administrator Tools" is selected and enabled: [User Tools]> "System Settings"> "Administrator Tools"> "Administrator Authentication Management"> "Available Settings"
"Available Settings" is not displayed until Step 2 is done.
If this setting is not selected, tell the customer that this setting must be selected before you can do the installation procedure.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-100 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options
Installaion
Seal Check and Removal
You must check the box seals to make sure that they were not removed after the items were sealed in the box at the factory before you do the installation.
1.
Check the box seals [A] on each corner of the box.
Make sure that a tape is attached to each corner.
The surfaces of the tapes must be blank. If you see “VOID” on the tapes, do not install the components in the box.
2.
If the surfaces of the tapes do not show “VOID”, remove them from the corners of the box.
3.
You can see the “VOID” marks [B] when you remove each seal. In this condition, they cannot be attached to the box again.
SM
2-101 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options
Installation Procedure
1.
Remove the SD card slot cover [A] ( x 1).
2.
Turn the SD-card label to face the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into slot 2 [B] until you hear a click.
3.
Turn on the main power switch, and then enter the SP mode.
4.
Select SP5878-002, and then press "Execute" on the LCD.
5.
Exit the SP mode after "Completed" is displayed on the LCD.
6.
Turn off the main power switch.
7.
Remove the SD card from slot 2.
8.
Attach the SD card slot cover [A] ( x 1).
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-102 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options
Installaion
Recovery from a Device Problem
Restoring the Encryption key When replacing the controller board for a model in which the HDD encryption unit has been installed, updating the encryption key is required. 1.
Prepare an SD card which is initialized.
2.
Make the "restore_key" folder in the SD card.
3.
Make an "nvram_key.txt" file in the "restore_key" folder in the SD card.
4.
Ask an administrator to input the encryption key (this has been printed out earlier by the user) into the "nvram_key.txt" file.
5.
Remove only the HDD unit ( Section: HDD (Only for D038/D041)).
6.
Turn on the main power switch.
7.
Confirm that the prompt on the LCD tells you to install the SD card (storing the encryption key) in the machine.
8.
Turn off the main power switch.
9.
Insert the SD card that contains the encryption key into slot 2.
10. Turn on the main power switch, and the machine automatically restores the encryption key in the flash memory on the controller board. 11. Turn off the main power switch after the machine has returned to normal status. 12. Remove the SD card from slot 2. 13. Reinstall the HDD unit.
SM
2-103 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options
Clearing the NVRAM When replacing the controller board for a model in which the HDD encryption unit has been installed and a customer has lost the encryption key, clearing the NVRAM is required to recover the HDD encryption unit. 1.
Prepare an SD card which is initialized.
2.
Make the "restore_key" folder in the SD card.
3.
Make an "nvram_key.txt" file in the "restore_key" folder in the SD card.
4.
Input "nvclear" into the "nvram_key.txt" file.
5.
Turn on the main power switch.
6.
Confirm that the prompt on the LCD tells you to install the SD card (storing the encryption key) in the machine.
7.
Turn off the main power switch.
8.
Insert the SD card that contains “nvclear” into slot 2.
9.
Turn on the main power switch, and the machine automatically restores the encryption key in the flash memory on the controller board.
10. Turn off the main power switch after the machine has returned to normal status. 11. Remove the SD card from slot 2. 12. Turn on the main power switch. 13. Initialize the NVRAM (SP5801-001) and HDD unit (SP5832-001) with SP mode. 14. The user must enable the HDD encryption unit with a user tool.
2.22.10 PICTBRIDGE (D038/D041 ONLY)
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You must install the PictBridge option in SD Card slot 1. However, the Postscript option and the data overwrite security unit option are also installed in SD Card slot 1. You must do the SD Card Appli move procedure first if you have the postscript or data overwrite security unit option installed and you want to install the PictBridge unit.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-104 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installaion
Controller Options
1.
Remove the SD-card slot cover [A] for SD cards ( x 1).
2.
Turn the SD-card label face to the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into slot 1 [B] until you hear a click.
3.
Attach the SD-card slot cover [A] ( x 1).
4.
Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).
2.22.11 VM CARD TYPE I (D038/D041 ONLY) Installation Procedure 1.
Switch the machine off.
2.
Remove the SD card slot cover [A] ( x1).
3.
Insert the SD card [B] into slot 2.
SM
2-105 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options 4.
Reattach the SD card slot cover.
5.
Switch the machine on.
6.
On the operation panel, remove the bottom blank keytop and replace it with the keytop provided.
7.
Attach the decal to the copier.
Firmware Update Procedure Application halt 1.
Press the “User Tools/Counter” key, then press the “Extended Feature Settings” button and press the “Extended Feature Setting” button that appears. If required, log in as a machine administrator.
2.
Press “Administrator Tools”, then press “Heap/Stack Size Settings”. Take note of the heap size and stack size. (After updating, the heap and stack size settings are cleared.)
3.
Press “Startup”, then stop all applications.
The following problems can occur if the VM firmware is updated without the application halt.
4.
The VM firmware update fails.
All settings for the application are cleared.
Turn the main power off, then remove the SD card slot cover, and remove the VM SD card from the SD card slot.
Updating the VM SD card 1.
Insert the SD card into the SD card writer that is connected to a PC.
2.
Make sure which drive is assigned for the SD card.
3.
Decompress the downloaded update file, then there are two files (one file has an “.exe” file extension and the other has a “.bat” file extension).
4.
Double click the “.bat” file, then the command prompt screen appears.
5.
The first command line is shown as “Please input drive letter of SD card [a – x]:” Then enter the SD card drive name, and press the “Enter” key.
6.
“Press any key to continue…” appears, then press the “Enter” key again. The update to the SD card starts.
7.
“Press any key to continue…”appears again, then press “Enter” key. The command prompt screen disappears automatically if the update is successful.
8.
Remove the SD card from the SD card writer after the access lamp going off on the SD card writer.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-106 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options 9.
Insert the SD card in the SD card slot 2 of the machine and turn the main power on.
Starting the application 1.
Press the “User Tools/Counter” key, then press the “Extended Feature Settings” button
machine administrator. 2.
Press “Startup”, then change the status to “Starting up” for each application.
3.
Press “Administrator Tools”, then press “Heap/Stack Size Settings”. Program the heap size and stack size as the settings as before.
4.
Turn the main power off and on.
5.
Enter the “Extended Feature Settings” menu again, and check the version of the VM card firmware on the “Extended Feature Info” screen.
The version of the VM card firmware is also shown on the Self Diagnostic Report (a part of the SMC report). But the version on the Self Diagnostic Report is not changed after updating.
2.22.12 BROWSER UNIT TYPE E (D038/D041 ONLY) Installation Procedure
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
Do not leave the SD card in slot 2 after installing this application.
1.
Remove the slot cover [A] for SD cards ( x 1).
2.
Turn the SD-card label face to the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into slot 2
SM
2-107 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Installaion
and press the “Extended Feature Setting” button that appears. If required, log in as a
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options until you hear a click. 3.
Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
4.
Push the "User Tools" key.
If an administrator setting is registered for the machine, step 5 and 6 are required. Otherwise, skip to step 7
5.
Push the "Login/ Logout" key.
6.
Login with the administrator user name and password.
7.
Touch "Extended Feature Settings" twice on the LCD.
8.
Touch "Install" on the LCD.
9.
Touch "SD Card".
10. Touch the "Browser" line. 11. Under "Install to" touch "Machine HDD" and touch "Next". 12. When you see "Ready to Install", check the information on the screen to confirm your previous selection. 13. Touch "OK". You will see "Installing the extended feature... Please wait.", and then "Completed". 14. Touch "Exit" to go back to the setting screen. 15. Touch "Change Allocation". 16. Touch the "Browser" line. 17. Press the hard key that you want to use for the Browser Unit. As a default, this function is assigned to the "Other Functions" key (the bottom key of the function keys). 18. Touch "OK". 19. Touch "Exit" twice to go back to the copy screen. 20. Turn off the main power switch. 21. Install the key for "Browser Unit" to the place where you want. 22. Remove the SD card from slot 2. 23. Attach the slot cover [A] ( x 1). 24. Keep the SD card in the place ( Section: SD Card Appli Move in Installation section) after you install the application program from the card to HDD. This is because: ¬ The SD card can be the only proof that the user is licensed to use the application program. You may need to check the SD card and its data to solve a problem in the future.
Update Procedure 1.
Remove the slot cover [A] for SD cards ( x 1).
2.
Turn the SD-card label face to the rear of the machine. Then push it slowly into slot 2 until you hear a click.
3.
Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-108 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options 4.
Push the "User Tools" key.
If an administrator setting is registered for the machine, step 5 and 6 are required.
5.
Push the "Login/ Logout" key.
6.
Login with the administrator user name and password.
7.
Touch "Extended Feature Settings" twice on the LCD.
8.
Touch "Uninstall" on the LCD.
9.
Touch the "Browser" line
Installaion
Otherwise, skip to step 7
10. Confirmation message appears on the LCD. 11. Touch "Yes" to proceed. 12. Reconfirmation message appears on the LCD. 13. Touch "Yes" to uninstall the browser unit. 14. You will see "Uninstalling the extended feature... Please wait.", and then "Completed". 15. Touch "Exit" to go back to the setting screen. 16. Exit "User/Tools" setting, and then turn off the main power switch. 17. Remove the SD card from SD card slot 2. 18. Overwrite the updated program in the "sdk" folder of the browser unit application with PC. 19. Do the "Installation Procedure" to install the browser unit.
2.22.13 GIGABIT ETHERNET (D038/D041 ONLY)
SM
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
2-109 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options 1.
Remove the I/F-slot cover [A] from the I/F-slot ( x 2).
2.
Install the Gigabit Ethernet board [B] (Knob-screw x 2) into the I/F-slot.
3.
Attach the two caps to the Ethernet (10/100 Base-T) ports as shown above.
4.
Attach the ferrite core [A] to the LAN cable [B] as shown above, and connect the LAN cable to the machine.
5.
Connect the USB cable to the USB connector.
6.
Make sure that the machine can recognize this option (see ‘Check All Connections’ at the end of this section).
2.22.14 MEMORY UNIT TYPE I 512MB (D038/D041 ONLY)
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Controller box cover ( Section: Controller Box Cover)
3.
HDD bracket ( Section: HDD (Only for D038/D041)
4.
Unlock the lock levers [A].
5.
Remove the installed memory [B] (256 MB).
6.
Push the memory unit [C] (512 MB) until both lock levers lock the memory unit.
7.
Reassemble the machine.
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-110 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Options
2.22.15 CHECK ALL CONNECTIONS 1.
Plug in the power cord. Then turn on the main switch.
2.
Enter the printer user mode. Then print the configuration page. Installaion
User Tools > Printer Settings > List Test Print > Config. Page All installed options are shown in the “System Reference” column.
SM
2-111 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Maintenance Tables
3. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE 3.1 MAINTENANCE TABLES See "Appendices" for the following information: Preventive Maintenance Items
Other Yield Parts Preventive Maintenance
SM
3-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
PM Parts Settings
3.2 PM PARTS SETTINGS 3.2.1 BEFORE REMOVING THE OLD PM PARTS 1.
Enter the SP mode.
2.
Output the SMC logging data with SP5-990-004.
3.
Set the following SPs to "1" before you turn the power off. Then, the machine will reset the PM counters automatically. In the case of developer, the developer initialization will also be done automatically.
4.
Exit the SP mode.
Item
SP Black: 3902-001
Development Unit
Cyan: 3902-002 Magenta: 3902-003 Yellow: 3902-004 Black: 3902-009
Drum Unit
Cyan: 3902-010 Magenta: 3902-011 Yellow: 3902-012
ITB Unit
3902-013
Fusing Unit
3902-014
Fusing Roller
3902-015
Fusing Belt
3902-016
ITB Cleaning Unit
3902-017
PTR Unit
3902-018
PCDU Toner Collection Bottle
3902-019*1
ITB Toner Collection Bottle
3902-020*1
D037/D038/D040/D041
3-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
PM Parts Settings
*1: Only if the toner collection bottle is replaced before the machine detects near-full.
For the following units, there is a new unit detection mechanism. It is not necessary to reset PM counters.
Development unit
PCU/ ITB Toner Collection Bottle (if full or near-full)
1.
Turn on the main power switch.
2.
Output the SMC logging data with SP5-990-004 and check the counter values.
3.
Make sure that the PM counters for the replaced units are “0” with SP7-803. If the PM counter for a unit was not reset, then reset that counter with SP 7-804.
4.
Make sure that the exchange counter counts up with SP7-853.
5.
Make sure that the counters for the previous units (SP7-906) on the new SMC logging data list (from step 2 above) are equal to the counters (SP7-803) for these units on the previous SMC logging data list (the list that was output in the “Before removing the old parts” section).
6.
Make sure that the unit replacement date is updated with SP7-950.
3.2.3 PREPARATION BEFORE OPERATION CHECK 1.
Clean the exposure glasses (for DF and book scanning).
2.
Enter the user tools mode.
3.
Do the “Automatic Color Calibration “(ACC) for the copier mode & printer mode as follows:
Print the ACC test pattern (User Tools > Maintenance > ACC > Start).
Put the printout on the exposure glass.
Put 10 sheets of white paper on the test chart. This ensures the precise ACC adjustment.
Close the ARDF or the platen cover.
Press “Start Scanning” on the LCD. Then, the machine starts the ACC.
4.
Exit the User Tools mode, and then enter the SP mode.
5.
Do the “Forced line position adjustment” as follows.
First do SP2-111-3 (Mode c).
Then do SP2-111-1 (Mode a).
To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12.
SM
3-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Preventive Maintenance
3.2.2 AFTER INSTALLING THE NEW PM PARTS
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
PM Parts Settings 6.
Exit the SP mode.
3.2.4 OPERATION CHECK Check if the sample image has been copied normally.
D037/D038/D040/D041
3-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Beforehand
4. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 4.1 BEFOREHAND
Installing options, please do the following:
If there is a fax unit in the machine, print out all messages stored in the memory, the lists of user-programmed items, and the system parameter list.
If there are printer jobs in the machine, print out all jobs in the printer buffer.
Turn off the main switch and disconnect the power cord, the telephone line, and
Replacement & Adjustment
the network cable.
SM
4-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Special Tools
4.2 SPECIAL TOOLS
Part Number
Description
Q’ty
B645 5010
SD Card
1
B645 6820
USB Reader/Writer
1
VSSM9000
Digital Multimeter – FLUKE87
1
C401 9503
20X Magnification Scope
1
A257 9300
Grease Barrierta – S552R
1
A092 9503
C4 Color Test Chart (3 pcs/set)
1
A184 9501
Optics Adjustment Tool (2 pcs/set)
2
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Adjustment
4.3 IMAGE ADJUSTMENT 4.3.1 SCANNING Check the printing registration/side-to-side adjustment and the blank margin adjustment before you do the following scanner adjustments.
Use S-2-1 test chart to do the following adjustments.
Replacement & Adjustment
Scanner sub-scan magnification
A: Sub-scan magnification 1.
Put the test chart on the exposure glass. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.
2.
Check the magnification ratio. Adjust with SP4-008 if necessary. Standard: ±1.0%.
Scanner leading edge and side-to-side registration
A: Leading Edge Registration
SM
4-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Adjustment 1.
Put the test chart on the exposure glass. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.
2.
Check the leading edge and side-to-side registration. Adjust the following SP modes if necessary. Standard: 0 ± 2 mm for the leading edge registration, 0 ± 2 mm for the side-to-side registration.
SP mode Leading Edge Registration
SP4-010-001
Side-to-Side Registration
SP4-011-001
4.3.2 ARDF ARDF side-to-side, leading edge registration and trailing edge
A: Leading edge registration, B: Side-to-Side registration Use A3/DLT paper to make a temporary test chart as shown above. 1.
Put the temporary test chart on the ARDF. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.
2.
Check the registration. Check the leading edge and side-to-side registration. Adjust the following SP modes if necessary. Standard: 4.2 ± 3.0 mm for the leading edge registration, 2 ± 3.0 mm for the side-to-side registration. Use the following SP modes to adjust if necessary.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Adjustment SP Code
What It Does
Adjustment Range
SP6-006-001
Side-to-Side Registration (1st side)
± 3.0 mm
SP6-006-002
Side-to-Side Registration (2nd side)
± 3.0 mm
SP6-006-003
Leading Edge Registration
± 5.0 mm
SP6-006-005
Buckle: Duplex Front
± 5.0 mm
SP6-006-006
Buckle: Duplex Rear
± 5.0 mm
SP6-006-007
Rear Edge Erase (Trailing Edge)
± 5.0 mm
1.
Put the temporary test chart on the ARDF. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.
2.
Check the magnification ratio. Adjust with SP6-017-001 if necessary.
Standard: ±5.0%
Reduction mode: ±5.0%
Enlargement mode: ±5.0%
4.3.3 REGISTRATION Image Area
A = C = 5.2 mm (0.2"), B = 2.0 mm Make sure that the registration is adjusted within the adjustment standard range as shown below.
SM
4-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
ARDF sub-scan magnification
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Adjustment
Leading Edge Adjusts the leading edge registration for each paper type and process line speed.
Side to Side Adjusts the side-to-side registration for each paper feed station. Use SP mode (SP1-002) to adjust the side-to-side registration for the optional paper feed unit, LCT, and duplex unit.
Adjustment Standard
Leading edge (sub-scan direction): 5.2 ± 2 mm
Side to side (main-scan direction): 2 ± 1 mm
Paper Registration Standard The registration in both main- and sub-scan directions can change within the following tolerance.
Sub-scan direction: 0 ± 9 mm
Main-scan direction: 0 ± 4 mm
Adjustment Procedure 1.
Enter SP2-109-003.
2.
Print out the test pattern (14: Trimming Area) with SP2-109-003.
Registration can change slightly as shown on the previous page. Print some pages of the "Trimming Area" for step 3 and 4. Then average the leading edge and side-to-side registration values, and adjust each SP mode.
3.
Do the leading edge registration adjustment. 1) Check the leading edge registration and adjust it with SP1-001. 2) Select the adjustment conditions (paper type and process line speed). 3) Input the value. Then press the key. 4) Generate a trim pattern to check the leading edge adjustment.
4.
Do the side-to-side registration adjustment. 1) Check the side-to-side registration and adjust it with SP1-002. 2) Select the adjustment conditions (paper feed station). 3) Input the value. Then press the key. 4) Generate a trim pattern to check the leading edge adjustment.
4.3.4 ERASE MARGIN ADJUSTMENT
Adjust the erase margin C and D only if the registration (main scan and sub scan)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Adjustment cannot be adjusted within the standard values. Do the registration adjustment after
1.
Enter SP2-109-003.
2.
Print out the test pattern (14: 1-dot trimming pattern) with SP2-109-003.
3.
Check the erase margin A and B. Adjust them with SP2-103-001 to -010 if necessary.
Leading edge: 1.5 to 5.0 mm,
Side-to-side: 0.5 to 4.0 mm,
Trailing edge: 0.5 to 0.6 mm
4.3.5 COLOR REGISTRATION Line Position Adjustment The automatic line position adjustment usually is done for a specified condition to get the best color prints. Do the following if color registration shifts:
Do “Auto Color Registration” as follows to do the forced line position adjustment. 1.
First do SP2-111-3.
2.
Then do SP2-111-1. To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12 (0: Completed successfully, 1: Failed).
You should also do the line position adjustment at these times: 1.
SM
After you transport or move the machine (you should do the forced line position
4-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
adjusting the erase margin C and D, and then adjust the erase margin A and B.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Adjustment adjustment if you install the machine at the user location.) if the machine is pre-installed at the workshop and moved to the user location, 2.
When you remove the PCDU
3.
When you remove or replace the motors, clutches, and/or gears related to the drum/development/transfer sections
4.
When you remove or replace the image transfer belt, image transfer belt unit or laser optical housing unit
4.3.6 PRINTER GAMMA CORRECTION
The ACC is usually sufficient to adjust the color balance to get the best print output. You only need the printer gamma correction to fine-tune to meet user requirements.
Use SP modes if you want to modify the printer gamma curve created with ACC. You can adjust the gamma data for the following:
Highlight
Middle
Shadow areas
IDmax.
The adjustable range is from 0 to 30 (31 steps).
Copy Mode - Photo Mode, Full Color -
Item to Adjust
Level on the C-4 chart
Adjustment Standard Adjust the offset value so that
ID max:
the density of level 10
(K, C, M, and Y)
matches that of level 10 on the C-4 chart.
1 For adjusting K ID max: SP4-915-004 For adjusting C ID max: SP4-916-004 For adjusting M ID max: SP4-917-004 For adjusting Y ID max: SP4-918-004 2 Middle (Middle ID)
Adjust the offset value so that
(K, C, M, and Y)
the density of level 6 matches
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Adjustment Item to Adjust
Level on the C-4 chart
Adjustment Standard that of level 6 on the C-4 chart.
For adjusting K Middle: SP4-915-002 For adjusting C Middle: SP4-916-002 For adjusting M Middle: SP4-917-002 For adjusting Y Middle: SP4-918-002 Adjust the offset value so that Shadow (High ID)
the density of level 8 matches
(K, C, M, and Y)
that of level 8 on the C-4 chart.
3 Replacement & Adjustment
For adjusting K Shadow: SP4-915-003 For adjusting C Shadow: SP4-916-003 For adjusting M Shadow: SP4-917-003 For adjusting Y Shadow: SP4-918-003 Adjust the offset value so that dirty background does not Highlight (Low ID)
show on the copy and the
(K, C, M, and Y)
density of level 3 is slightly lighter than that of level 3 on
4
the C-4 chart. For adjusting K Highlight: SP4-915-005 For adjusting C Highlight: SP4-916-005 For adjusting M Highlight: SP4-917-005 For adjusting Y Highlight: SP4-918-005 Adjust the offset value so that the color balance of black
K Highlight (Low ID) 5
scale levels 3 through 5 in the
(C,M, and Y)
copy is seen as gray (no C,
M, or Y should be visible). If
copy>
the black scale contains C, M, or Y, do steps 1 to 4 again.
SM
4-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Adjustment Item to Adjust
Level on the C-4 chart
Adjustment Standard
For adjusting K Highlight: SP4-915-005
- Photo Mode, Single Color -
Item to Adjust
Level on the C-4 chart
Adjustment Standard Adjust the offset value so that the density of level 10
ID max: (K)
matches that of level 10 on
1
the C-4 chart. For adjusting K ID max: SP4-909-004 Adjust the offset value so that
2
Middle (Middle ID)
the density of level 6 matches
(K)
that of level 6 on the C-4 chart.
For adjusting K Middle: SP4-909-002 Adjust the offset value so that
3
Shadow (High ID)
the density of level 8 matches
(K)
that of level 8 on the C-4 chart.
For adjusting K Shadow: SP4-909-003 Adjust the offset value so that dirty background does not
4
Highlight (Low ID)
show on the copy and the
(K)
density of level 3 is slightly lighter than that of level 3 on the C-4 chart.
For adjusting K Highlight: SP4-909-001
- Text (Letter) Mode, Full Color -
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Adjustment
Item to Adjust
Level on the C-4 chart (K)
Adjustment Standard Adjust the offset value so that
ID max: (K, C, M,
the density of level 10
and Y)
matches that of level 10 on the C-4 chart.
1 For adjusting K ID max: SP4-910-004 For adjusting C ID max: SP4-911-004 For adjusting M ID max: SP4-912-004 For adjusting Y ID max: SP4-913-004
Middle (Middle ID)
the density of level 6 matches
(K, C, M, and Y)
that of level 6 on the C-4 chart.
2 For adjusting K Middle: SP4-910-002 For adjusting C Middle: SP4-911-002 For adjusting M Middle: SP4-912-002 For adjusting Y Middle: SP4-913-002 Adjust the offset value so that Shadow (High ID)
the density of level 8 matches
(K, C, M, and Y)
that of level 8 on the C-4 chart.
3 For adjusting K Shadow: SP4-910-003 For adjusting C Shadow: SP4-911-003 For adjusting M Shadow: SP4-912-003 For adjusting Y Shadow: SP4-913-003 Adjust the offset value so that dirty background does not 4
Highlight (Low ID)
show on the copy and the
(K, C, M, and Y)
density of level 3 is slightly lighter than that of level 3 on the C-4 chart.
SM
4-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
Adjust the offset value so that
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Adjustment Item to Adjust
Level on the C-4 chart (K)
Adjustment Standard
For adjusting K Highlight: SP4-910-001 For adjusting C Highlight: SP4-911-001 For adjusting M Highlight: SP4-912-001 For adjusting Y Highlight: SP4-913-001
- Text (Letter) Mode, Single Color -
Item to Adjust
Level on the C-4 chart (K)
Adjustment Standard Adjust the offset value so that the density of level 10
ID max: (K)
matches that of level 10 on
1
the C-4 chart. For adjusting K ID max: SP4-914-004 Adjust the offset value so
2
Middle (Middle ID)
that the density of level 6
(K)
matches that of level 6 on the C-4 chart.
For adjusting K Middle: SP4-914-002 Adjust the offset value so
3
Shadow (High ID)
that the density of level 8
(K)
matches that of level 8 on the C-4 chart.
For adjusting K Shadow: SP4-914-003 Adjust the offset value so that dirty background does 4
Highlight (Low ID)
not show on the copy and
(K)
the density of level 3 is slightly lighter than that of level 3 on the C-4 chart.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Adjustment Item to Adjust
Level on the C-4 chart (K)
Adjustment Standard
For adjusting K Highlight: SP4-914-001
Text parts of the test pattern cannot be printed clearly after you adjust “shadow” as shown above. At this time, check if the 5 line/mm pattern at each corner is printed clearly. If it is not, adjust the offset value of “shadow” again until it is.
Printer Mode
1200 x 1200 photo mode
1200 x 1200 text mode
2400 x 600 photo mode
2400 x 600 text mode
1800 x 600 photo mode
1800 x 600 text mode
600 x 600 photo mode
600 x 600 text mode
Replacement & Adjustment
There are six adjustable modes (select these modes with printer SP1-102-001):
K
C
M
Y
Highlight
SP1-104-1
SP1-104-21
SP1-104-41
SP1-104-61
Shadow
SP1-104-2
SP1-104-22
SP1-104-42
SP1-104-62
Middle
SP1-104-3
SP1-104-23
SP1-104-43
SP1-104-63
IDmax
SP1-104-4
SP1-104-24
SP1-104-44
SP1-104-64
- Adjustment Procedure 1.
Do ACC for the printer mode.
2.
Turn the main power off and on.
3.
Enter SP mode.
4.
Select “Printer SP”.
5.
Select SP1-102-001. Then select the necessary print mode to adjust.
6.
Choose SP1-103-1 to print out a tone control test sheet if you want to examine the image quality for these settings.
7.
SM
Adjust the color density with SP1-104. Compare the tone control test sheet with the C4
4-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Adjustment test chart. 8.
Adjust the density in this order: “ID Max”, “Shadow”, “Middle”, “Highlight”.
Use SP1-105-001 to keep the adjusted settings.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Exterior Covers
4.4 EXTERIOR COVERS 4.4.1 PCDU TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE If you replace this toner collection bottle after the machine detects that it is full or near-full, the machine automatically resets the PM counter for the PCDU toner collection bottle after replacement. But, if you replace a bottle that is not full or near-full, then you must reset the PM counter
Replacement & Adjustment
for this unit. To do this, set SP 3902 019 to 1 before you start to work on the machine.
1.
Open the front door [A].
2.
PCDU toner collection bottle [A] (lock x 2)
4.4.2 FRONT DOOR 1.
Open the front door.
2.
PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit))
SM
4-15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Exterior Covers
3.
Release the belt [A].
4.
Front door [A] ( x 2, pin x 2)
4.4.3 ITB CLEANING UNIT COVER
1.
Open the ITB cleaning unit cover [A] ( x 2).
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Exterior Covers
2.
Release the tab [A], and then remove the ITB cleaning unit cover [B].
Replacement & Adjustment
4.4.4 LEFT COVER
1.
Left cover [A] ( x 10)
4.4.5 REAR COVER
1.
SM
Rear cover [A] ( x 8)
4-17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Exterior Covers
Remove the screw [B] of the lower cover when reinstalling the rear cover.
4.4.6 REAR LOWER COVER
1.
Rear lower cover [A] ( x 5)
4.4.7 DUST FILTER
1.
Dust filter cover [A] (hooks)
2.
Dust filter [B]
4.4.8 RIGHT REAR COVER 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Exterior Covers
2.
Open the duplex unit [A].
3.
Right rear cover [B] ( x 5)
Replacement & Adjustment
4.4.9 OPERATION PANEL For D038/D041
1.
Remove six screws on the operation panel [A].
2.
Slide the operation panel to the front side.
3.
Disconnect the harness [A].
SM
4-19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Exterior Covers 4.
Operation panel [B]
For D037/D040
1.
Remove six screws on the operation panel.
2.
Slide the operation panel to the front side.
3.
Remove the connector [A].
4.
Operation panel [B]
4.4.10 TOUCH PANEL POSITION ADJUSTMENT (D038/D041)
It is necessary to calibrate the touch panel at the following times:
When you replace the operation panel.
When you replace the controller board.
When the touch panel detection function does not operate correctly
Do not use items [2] to [9] on the Self-Diagnostic Menu. These items are for design use only. 1.
Press S, press , press \ 5 times to open the Self-Diagnostics menu.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
2.
On the touch screen press “Touch Screen Adjust” (or press ).
3.
Use a pointed (not sharp) tool to press the upper left mark).
4.
Press the lower right mark when “*” shows.
5.
Press [#] OK on the screen (or press k) when you are finished.
6.
Touch [#] Exit on the screen to close the Self-Diagnostic menu. Save the calibration settings.
4.4.11 INNER RIGHT COVER 1.
PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)
2.
Press the ITB lock lever [A] and turn it up clockwise as shown above.
3.
Inner right cover [B] ( x 2)
4.4.12 INNER COVER 1.
PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)
2.
Inner right cover ( Section: Inner Cover)
SM
4-21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
Exterior Covers
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Exterior Covers
3.
Inner cover [A] ( x 4)
4.4.13 FRONT RIGHT COVER 1.
Open the duplex unit.
1.
PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)
1.
Inner right cover ( Section: Inner Right Cover)
2.
Remove the front right cover [A] with the operation panel [B] lifted up ( x 1).
4.4.14 RIGHT UPPER COVER
1.
Right upper cover [A] ( x 2)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Exterior Covers
1.
Left frame cover [A] ( x 1)
2.
Left frame rear cover [B] ( x 2) Replacement & Adjustment
4.4.15 LEFT FRAME AND LEFT FRAME REAR COVER
4.4.16 PAPER EXIT COVER
1.
Inverter tray [A]
2.
Paper exit cover [B] ( x 1)
SM
4-23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Exterior Covers
4.4.17 INVERTER TRAY
1.
Inverter tray [A] (hooks)
4.4.18 INNER TRAY
1.
Inner tray [A] ( x 2)
4.4.19 INNER REAR COVER 1.
Left frame cover ( Section: Left Frame and Left Frame Rear Cover)
2.
Paper exit cover ( Section: Paper Exit Cover)
3.
Inner tray ( Section: Inner Tray)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Exterior Covers
Inner rear cover [A] ( x 1)
Replacement & Adjustment
4.
SM
4-25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit
4.5 SCANNER UNIT 4.5.1 EXPOSURE GLASS 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Open the ARDF or platen cover.
3.
Glass cover [A] ( x 4)
4.
Scanner right cover [A] ( x 2)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-26 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit 5.
ARDF exposure glass [A]
Position the white marker [B] at the rear-left corner when you reattach the ARDF exposure glass.
Rear scale [A] ( x 3)
7.
Exposure glass [A] with left scale
Replacement & Adjustment
6.
Position the marker at the front-left corner when you reattach the exposure glass.
4.5.2 ORIGINAL LENGTH SENSORS 1.
SM
Exposure glass with left scale ( Section: Exposure Glass)
4-27 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit
2.
SBU cover [A] ( x 6)
The three screws [B] do not need to be fully removed. Just loosen them to remove the SBU cover.
3.
Original length sensors [A] (hooks, = x1, x 1 each))
4.5.3 EXPOSURE LAMP 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Operation panel ( Section: Operation Panel)
3.
Exposure glass ( Section: Exposure Glass)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-28 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit Scanner rear cover [A] ( x 1)
5.
Disconnect the connector [A] from the lamp stabilizer [B].
6.
Move the carriage unit [A] to the cutout position [B].
7.
Cable guide [A] (hooks)
Replacement & Adjustment
4.
8.
SM
Keep the cable guide for reassembling.
Adjustor clamp [B] ( x 1)
4-29 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit 9.
Pulley [C]
10. Release the cable clamp [A] (one hook under the cable clamp) at the rear edge of the exposure lamp. 11. Hold down the snap [B], and then slide the exposure lamp [C] to the front side.
12. Exposure lamp [A]
Reassembling
Run the cable so there is no slack. Slide the adjustor clamp [A] to adjust the cable slack.
4.5.4 SCANNER MOTOR 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-30 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit
Scanner motor bracket [A] ( x 2, spring x 1, x 1, timing belt x 1)
3.
Scanner motor [A] ( x 2, ground plate [B] x 1)
Replacement & Adjustment
2.
Make sure that the ground plate [B] is attached when installing the scanner motor in the scanner motor bracket.
Do the scanner image adjustment after replacing the scanner motor ( Section: Image Adjustment).
4.5.5 SENSOR BOARD UNIT (SBU) 1.
SM
Exposure glass ( Section: Exposure Glass)
4-31 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit
2.
Original length sensor bracket [A] ( x 1, = x1, x 1 each)
3.
Sensor board unit [A] ( x 4, ground screw x 1, x 2)
When reassembling Adjust the following SP modes after you replace the sensor board unit:
SP4–008 (Sub Scan Mag): Section: "Image Adjustment: Scanning".
SP4–010 (Sub Mag Reg.): Section: "Image Adjustment: Scanning".
SP4–011 (Main Scan Reg): Section: "Image Adjustment: Scanning".
SP4–688 (DF: Density Adjustment): Use this to adjust the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode is different.
4.5.6 EXPOSURE LAMP STABILIZER 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-32 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit
2.
Exposure lamp stabilizer bracket [A] ( x 2, x 2)
4.5.7 SCANNER HP SENSOR Rear Cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Scanner rear cover ( Section: Exposure Lamp)
3.
Move the 1st scanner carriage [A] to the right side by rotating the scanner motor [B]
Replacement & Adjustment
1.
clockwise.
4.
Remove the mylar [A].
5.
Remove the scanner HP sensor [B] ( x 1, hooks).
SM
4-33 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit
4.5.8 PLATEN COVER SENSOR 1.
Scanner rear cover ( Section: Exposure Lamp)
2.
Holder bracket [A] ( x 1)
3.
Platen cover sensor [B] ( x 1)
4.5.9 FRONT SCANNER WIRE 1.
Rear Cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Operation panel ( Section: Operation Panel)
3.
Exposure glass ( Section: Exposure Glass)
4.
Scanner left cover [A] ( x 2)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-34 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit
Scanner left stay [A] ( x 3)
6.
Scanner front frame [B] ( x 5)
7.
Take aside the connector bracket [A] ( x 2).
8.
Scanner rear frame [B] ( x 8, = x all, x all)
9.
Scanner motor bracket ( Section: Scanner Motor)
Replacement & Adjustment
5.
10. Rear scanner drive pulley [A] ( x 1)
SM
4-35 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit
11. Front scanner wire clamp [A] 12. Loosen the front scanner wire bracket [B] ( x 1) 13. Front scanner wire 14. Move the shaft [C] in the red arrow direction ( x 1: at front), and remove the scanner drive pulley [D] ( x 1).
When removing the rear scanner wire, remove the e-ring at the rear side of the shaft.
Reinstalling the Front Scanner Wire
1.
Position the center ball [A] in the middle of the forked holder.
2.
Pass the right end (with the ball) [B] through the square hole. Pass the left end (with
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-36 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit the ring) through the notch. 3.
Wind the right end counterclockwise (shown from the machine’s front) five times. Wind the left end clockwise three times.
The two green marks [C] come together when you have done this. Stick the wire to the pulley with tape. This lets you easily handle the assembly at the
Replacement & Adjustment
time of installation.
4.
Install the drive pulley on the shaft [A].
5.
Do not attach the pulley to the shaft with the screw at this time.
Insert the left end into the slit [B]. The end should go via the rear track of the left pulley [C] and the rear track of the movable pulley [D].
SM
4-37 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit
6.
Hook the right end onto the front scanner wire bracket [A]. The end should go via the rear track of the right pulley [B] and the front track of the movable pulley [C].
Do not attach the scanner wire bracket with the screw at this time.
[D] [I]
[A]
[H]
[B] [E]
[G]
[C] [F]
d037r273
7.
Remove the tape from the drive pulley.
8.
Insert a scanner positioning pin [A] through the 2nd carriage hole [B] and the left holes [C] in the front rail. Insert another scanner positioning pin [D] through the 1st carriage hole [E] and the right holes in the front rail [F].
9.
Insert two more scanner positioning pins through the holes in the rear rail.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-38 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit 10. Screw the drive pulley to the shaft [G]. 11. Screw the scanner wire bracket to the front rail [H]. 12. Install the scanner wire clamp [I]. 13. Pull out the positioning pins.
Make sure the 1st and 2nd carriages move smoothly after you remove the positioning pins. Do steps 8 through 13 again if they do not.
1.
Rear Cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Operation panel ( Section:.Operation Panel)
3.
Exposure glass ( Section: Exposure Glass)
4.
Scanner left cover ( Section: Front Scanner Wire)
5.
Scanner front frame ( Section: Front Scanner Wire)
6.
Scanner left stay ( Section: Front Scanner Wire)
7.
Scanner rear frame ( Section: Front Scanner Wire)
8.
Follow steps 10 through 14 in Section: Front Scanner Wire. You can remove the rear scanner wire with the same manner for replacing the front scanner wire.
Reinstalling the Rear Scanner Wire
1.
Position the center ball [A] in the middle of the forked holder.
2.
Pass the left end (with the ball) [B] through the drive pulley notch. Pass the right end (with the ring) through the drive pulley hole.
3.
Wind the left end [B] clockwise (shown from the machine’s front) five times. Wind the right end counterclockwise three times.
SM
4-39 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
4.5.10 REAR SCANNER WIRE
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Unit
The two green marks [C] come together when you do this. Attach the wire to the pulley with tape. This lets you easily handle the assembly at the time of installation.
4.
Install the drive pulley on the shaft.
5.
Do not attach the pulley on the shaft with the screw at this time.
Install the wire.
The winding of the wire on the three pulleys at the rear of the scanner should be the same as the winding on the three pulleys at the front. This must show as a mirror image.
Example: At the front of the machine, the side of the drive pulley with the three windings must face the front of the machine. At the rear of the machine, it must face the rear. 6.
Do steps 7 through 13 from the “Reinstalling the Front Scanner Wire” ( Section: Front Scanner Wire).
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-40 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Laser Optics
4.6 LASER OPTICS
Turn off the main switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the procedures in this section. Laser beams can cause serious eye injury.
4.6.1 CAUTION DECAL LOCATION
Replacement & Adjustment
The caution decal is placed as shown below.
Be sure to turn off the main switch and disconnect the power plug from the power outlet before beginning any disassembly or adjustment of the laser unit. This copier uses a class IIIb laser beam with a wavelength of 648 - 663 nm and an output of 9 mW. The laser can cause serious eye injury.
4.6.2 LASER UNIT
Before installing a new laser unit, remove the polygon motor holder bracket and the tag from the new unit.
SM
4-41 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Laser Optics
Preparing a new laser unit
1.
Polygon mirror motor cover [A] of the laser unit ( x 4)
2.
Polygon motor holder bracket [B] with a red tag ( x 3)
3.
Install the three screws [C] (removed in step 2) in the laser unit.
4.
Reinstall the polygon mirror motor cover [A] ( x 4).
Before removing the old laser unit Do the following settings before removing the laser unit. These are adjustments for skew
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-42 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Laser Optics adjustment motors in the laser unit. 1.
Plug in and turn on the main power switch of the copier.
2.
Enter the SP mode.
3.
Execute SP2-220-001 to clear the Mirror-No.2 positioning motor setting for Cyan.
4.
Execute SP2-220-002 to clear the Mirror-No.2 positioning motor setting for Magenta.
5.
Execute SP2-220-003 to clear the Mirror-No.2 positioning motor setting for Yellow.
6.
Exit the SP mode.
7.
Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord of the copier.
Recovery procedure for no replacement preparation of laser unit If you did not do the procedure in ‘Before removing the laser unit’ before removing the laser unit, you must do the following. Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord of the copier.
2.
Remove the left cover (see the following "Removing the laser unit").
3.
Disconnect the harness [A] of the skew correction motor.
4.
Do steps 1 to 7 of "Before removing the laser unit".
5.
Connect the harness [A] and reinstall the left cover.
6.
Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
Replacement & Adjustment
1.
SM
4-43 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Laser Optics
Removing the laser unit
1.
Left cover [A] ( x 10)
2.
ITB cleaning unit [A] ( x 2)
3.
Ventilation rear fan holder [A] ( x 2, x 1)
4.
Ventilation front fan holder [B] ( x 2, = x 1, x 1)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-44 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Laser Optics
5.
Remove the laser unit [A] ( x 2, = x 2, x 3)
After installing a new laser unit 1.
Open the front door of the machine.
2.
Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
3.
Check that the settings of SP2-119-001, -002 and -003 are "0". If these settings are not "0", execute "Recovery procedure for no replacement preparation of laser unit" described above.
4.
If this step is not correctly done, an image problem may occur on printouts.
Input the SP settings on the sheet provided with a new LD unit.
SP2-101-001 to -004: Color Registration: Main Scan for each color
SP2-101-013 to -016: Color Registration: Sub Scan for each color
SP2-102-001, -003, -004, -006, -007, -009, -010, -012: Main Magnification for each color and line speed
SM
SP2-104-001 to -004: :LD Initial Power Adjustment for each color
4-45 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
Do the following adjustment after installing the new laser unit.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Laser Optics
The printed values [A] are different for each laser unit.
5.
Print the test pattern (14: 1-dot trimming pattern in the SP2-109-003).
6.
Check that the left and right trim margin is within 4 ± 1 mm. If not, change the standard value for the main scan magnification adjustment.
7.
Select "0" with SP2-109-003 after printing the "1-dot trimming pattern.
8.
Do the line position adjustment.
First do SP2-111-003.
Then do SP2-111-001.
To check if SP 2-111-001 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-010 to -012.
9.
Exit the SP mode.
4.6.3 POLYGON MIRROR MOTOR 1.
Laser unit ( Section: Laser Unit)
2.
Polygon mirror motor cover [A] ( x 4)
3.
Polygon mirror motor holder [A] ( x 1)
4.
Polygon mirror motor [B] ( x 4, x 1)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-46 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Laser Optics After installing the laser optics housing unit:
Do the "Line Pos. Adjust Execute:Mode c" (SP2-111-003).
Then do the "Line Pos. Adjust Execute:Mode a" (SP2-111-001).
To check if SP 2-111-001 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message
Replacement & Adjustment
is displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP2-194-010 to -012.
SM
4-47 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Creation
4.7 IMAGE CREATION 4.7.1 PCDU (PHOTO CONDUCTOR AND DEVELOPMENT UNIT)
Do not touch the OPC drum. Do not let metal objects touch the development sleeve.
1.
Open the front door.
2.
PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)
3.
Turn the ITB lock lever [A] to the ‘up’ position.
4.
PCDU [B] ( x 2 each)
When installing a new PCDU
Remove the cover [A] on the toner inlet and pull out the tape [B] from the new development unit before installing a new PCDU in the machine.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-48 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Creation
4.7.2 DRUM UNIT AND DEVELOPMENT UNIT The new drum unit has a front cover. When you attach the new drum unit to the development unit, remove the front cover first. Use it for installing the new drum unit and development unit. 1.
If you install a new drum unit only, set SP 3902-xxx to "1".
Black: 3902-009
Cyan: 3902-010
Magenta: 3902-011
Yellow: 3902-012
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the drum unit automatically, after you turn the power on again.
If you install a new development unit only, set SP 3902-xxx to "1".
Black: 3902-001
Cyan: 3902-002
Magenta: 3902-003
Yellow: 3902-004
Replacement & Adjustment
2.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the development unit automatically, after you turn the power on again.
3.
Turn the machine power off.
4.
PCDU ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit))
5.
Front cover [A] ( x 2)
SM
4-49 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Creation
6.
Rear cover [A] ( x 2)
7.
Drum unit [A] and development unit [B] ( x 1)
When the development unit is removed from the drum unit, clean the entrance mylar [A] with a vacuum cleaner.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-50 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Creation
Remove the connector [A] with a small flat tool [B].
9.
Keep this connector [A] for the new drum unit.
If you change the development unit, do the ACC procedure.
10. Execute the drum phase adjustment with SP1902-001 twice.
New unit detection for the development unit When a new development unit is installed in the machine, the machine will automatically reset the PM counters for the development unit and drum unit, even if the drum unit was not changed. To avoid resetting both counters after you install a new development unit only, make sure that step 2 in the procedure above is done before installing.
4.7.3 TONER HOPPER UNIT Toner hopper unit: K, C, M 1.
Open the front door.
2.
PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)
3.
Inner cover ( Section: Inner Cover)
4.
PCDU ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit))
Remove the corresponding color PCDU. For example, if you remove the toner hopper unit: K, remove the black PCDU.
SM
4-51 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
8.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Creation
5.
Toner supply drive gear [A] (hook x 1)
6.
Toner hopper unit: K, C, M [B] ( x 2, = x 1 for K and M; 2 for C , x 1 each)
7.
Place the toner hopper unit [A] on sheets of paper.
Toner hopper unit: Y 1.
Open the front door.
2.
PCDU toner collection bottle Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)
3.
Inner cover ( Section: Inner Cover)
4.
PCDU ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit))
5.
Gear cover [A] ( x 2, = x 2)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-52 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Creation 6.
Toner supply drive gear (hook x 1)
7.
Toner hopper unit: Y [B] ( x 2, x 1 each)
8.
Place the toner hopper unit [A] on sheets of paper.
Developer must be added to the new toner hopper. Some developer (8 g) is provided with each new toner hopper unit. Pour this into the toner hopper unit before reattaching the inner cover.
1.
Slowly open the toner hopper shutter [A].
Do not try to open the toner hopper shutter fully at one try. This shutter comes off easily without the inner cover. If the toner hopper shutter has come off, reattach it.
2.
Pour the developer (8 g) into the inlet [B] of the toner hopper unit.
3.
Close the toner hopper shutter.
4.
Reassemble the machine.
4.7.4 TONER SUPPLY MOTOR 1.
SM
Open the front door.
4-53 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
When installing a new toner hopper unit
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Creation 2.
PCDU toner collection bottle Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)
3.
Inner cover ( Section: Inner Cover)
4.
Inner tray ( Section: Inner Tray)
5.
Toner supply drive gear [A] (hook x 1)
6.
Pull the toner supply drive shaft [B].
7.
Take aside the toner supply gear unit [A] ( x 3).
NOTE When removing the toner supply gear unit for Yellow, one of screws on the toner supply gear unit is difficult to see. 1) Remove the left cover ( Section: Left Cover)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-54 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Creation
Replacement & Adjustment
2) Check the screw position [A] as shown above.
8.
Release the clamp [A], and then disconnect the harness [B].
9.
Toner supply motor [A] (= x 1, x 1, x 2)
4.7.5 TONER COLLECTION MOTOR 1.
Open the front door.
2.
PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)
3.
PCDU: Yellow ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit))
SM
4-55 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Creation 4.
Ventilation Fan: Front ( Ventilation Fan)
5.
Disconnect two harnesses [A].
6.
Toner collection motor assembly [A] (= x 2, x 3)
7.
Gears [A] ( x 1)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-56 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Creation
8.
Toner collection motor [A] ( x 2)
4.7.6 PCDU TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE FULL SENSOR Toner collection motor assembly ( Section: Toner Collection Motor)
2.
PCDU toner collection bottle full sensor [A] (= x 1, x 1, hooks)
Replacement & Adjustment
1.
4.7.7 PCDU TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE SET SWITCH 1.
Toner collection motor assembly ( Section: Toner Collection Motor)
2.
PCDU toner collection bottle set switch [A] (hooks, x 1)
SM
4-57 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Creation
4.7.8 RFID BOARD 1.
All toner hopper units ( Section: Toner Hopper Unit)
2.
Inner tray ( Section: Inner Tray)
3.
Toner supply drive shafts [A]
4.
Harness cover [A] ( x 1)
5.
RFID board [A] ( x 3, = x 1)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-58 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Transfer
4.8 IMAGE TRANSFER 4.8.1 ITB CLEANING UNIT If you replace the cleaning unit or toner collection bottle after the machine detects that it is full or near-full, the machine automatically resets the PM counter for the bottle after replacement. But, if you replace a bottle that is not full or near-full, then you must reset the PM counter for this unit. To do this, set SPs 3902-017 and -020 to 1 before you turn off the power switch. If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the units automatically, after you turn the power on again. SP 3902-017 is for the ITB cleaning unit and SP 3902-020 is for the ITB toner collection
1.
Left cover ( Section: Left Cover)
2.
ITB cleaning unit [A] ( x 2)
Replacement & Adjustment
bottle.
When installing the ITB cleaning unit Secure the front side [B] first with a screw. This [B] is the positioning screw.
4.8.2 ITB TONER COLLECTION BOTTLE FULL SENSOR 1.
SM
Left cover ( Section: Left Cover)
4-59 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Transfer
2.
Bottle full sensor assembly [A] ( x 1, = x 1, x 1)
3.
ITB toner collection bottle full sensor [B] (hooks)
4.8.3 ITB (IMAGE TRANSFER BELT) UNIT 1.
Left cover ( Section: Left Cover)
2.
ITB cleaning unit ( Section: ITB Cleaning Unit)
3.
PCU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)
4.
Unlock the ITB lock lever ( Section: Inner Right Cover).
5.
Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)
6.
Hinge bracket [A] ( x 1)
7.
Pull the lever [B] to open the paper transfer unit.
8.
Harness cover [C] ( x 1)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-60 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Transfer
9.
Grasp the handles [A], and then pull out the ITB unit fully [B] ( x 2, x 1).
10. Remove the ITB unit motor after pulling out the ITB unit from the machine. ( Next procedure)
1.
ITB cleaning unit ( Section: ITB Cleaning Unit)
2.
ITB unit ( Section: ITB Unit)
3.
ITB unit motor [A] ( x 3, x 1)
Replacement & Adjustment
4.8.4 ITB UNIT MOTOR
4.8.5 IMAGE TRANSFER BELT 1.
ITB cleaning unit ( Section: ITB Cleaning Unit)
2.
ITB unit ( Section: ITB Unit)
3.
ITB unit motor ( Section: ITB Unit Motor)
SM
4-61 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Transfer
4.
Two stays [A] ( x 2 each)
5.
Rear holder bracket [A] (as seen from the front) ( x 1: M3x10)
6.
Front holder bracket [A] (as seen from the rear) ( x 1: M3x10)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-62 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Transfer
Handle [A] ( x 2: M3x10)
8.
Guide bracket [A]
9.
Pull the tension roller [A] as shown.
Replacement & Adjustment
7.
SM
4-63 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Transfer
10. Front guide pin bracket [A] ( x 1) 11. Press roller bracket [B] ( x 2)
12. Attach the handle, which was removed in step 6, to the projection [B] on the rear left side ( x 1).
This handle will be used as a stand in later steps.
13. Stand the ITB unit [A] as shown above.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-64 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Transfer 14. Image transfer belt [B]
Reset the PM counter
There is a rim [A] at each edge of the transfer belt. The ends of all the rollers ([B] for example) in the transfer belt unit must be between the two rims.
There are two rims (width [C]: about 5 mm) at the front and rear edges inside the image transfer belt.
This belt must be installed the correct way around. When you reinstall the image transfer belt unit, install it with the number [A] on the belt at the rear side of the unit.
4.8.6 ITB CONTACT MOTOR 1.
Pull out all the toner bottles.
2.
Inverter tray ( Section: Inverter Tray)
3.
Inner tray ( Section: Inner Tray)
SM
4-65 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
When reinstalling a new image transfer belt
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Transfer
4.
Take aside the ITB contact motor unit [A] ( x 2)
5.
Disconnect two harnesses [A], and then remove the ITB contact motor unit (= x 1)
6.
ITB contact motor [A] ( x 2)
4.8.7 ITB CONTACT SENSOR 1.
ITB contact motor unit ( Section: ITB Contact Motor)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-66 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Image Transfer
ITB contact sensor [A] (hooks)
Replacement & Adjustment
2.
SM
4-67 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Transfer
4.9 PAPER TRANSFER 4.9.1 PTR (PAPER TRANSFER ROLLER) UNIT
If you install a new PTR unit, then set SP 3902-018 to "1" before you start this procedure.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the paper transfer unit automatically, after you turn the power on again.
1.
Open the duplex unit.
2.
Open the paper transfer unit [A].
3.
Remove the PTR unit [A], releasing the two locks [B].
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-68 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Transfer
4.
Remove the two springs [A].
Keep these two springs from the old PTR unit and install them in the new PTR unit.
1.
Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)
2.
Hinge bracket [A] ( x 1)
3.
Open the paper transfer unit [B].
Replacement & Adjustment
4.9.2 OPENING THE PAPER TRANSFER UNIT
4.9.3 ID SENSOR BOARD 1.
Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
2.
Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)
SM
4-69 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Transfer
3.
ID sensor cover [A] ( x 2)
4.
ID sensor board [A] ( x 6, , = x 1, x 1)
If the black spacer [B] is stuck to the sensor board as shown above, remove all black spacers. These black spacers should be used when a new ID sensor board is installed.
Cleaning for ID sensors ID sensors require cleaning maintenance every EM. Do the following steps for ID sensor cleaning. 1.
PCDU: K ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit))
2.
ITB unit ( Section: ITB (Image Transfer Belt) Unit)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-70 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Transfer
Clean the ID sensors [A].
Use a cloth moistened with alcohol to clean the ID sensors.
Do not use a dry cloth. Otherwise, the ID sensors may get more dirty due to static electricity.
After installing a new ID sensor unit/board Do the following adjustment after installing a new ID sensor unit/board. 1.
Plug in and turn on the main power switch of the copier.
2.
Enter the SP mode.
3.
Input all correction coefficients [A] for the ID sensor with the SP modes referring to the barcode sheet provided with the new ID sensor unit/board.
4.
For example, input "0.98" with SP3-362-013.
Exit the SP mode.
4.9.4 TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY SENSOR 1.
SM
Right rear cover ( Section: Right Rear Cover)
4-71 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
3.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Transfer
2.
Temperature and humidity sensor [A] ( x 1, x 1)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-72 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Drive Unit
Replacement & Adjustment
4.10 DRIVE UNIT
The drawing above shows the drive unit layout.
1. ITB drive motor
6. Drum/Development motor: K
2. Fusing/paper exit motor
7. Paper feed motor: T1
3. Drum motor: CMY
8. Paper feed motor: T2
4. Development motor: CMY
9. Registration motor
5. Development clutch: K
There are some motors and clutches that are not shown in the above drawing:
Duplex inverter motor
Duplex Exit Motor
Duplex Entrance Motor
By-pass Motor
4.10.1 GEAR UNIT 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)
SM
4-73 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Drive Unit 3.
Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)
4.
Remove all connectors and clamps (blue arrows) on the HVPS: CB board [A].
5.
Pull all the PCDUs to the front side. ( Section: PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit))
6.
Gear unit [A] ( x all, = x all: blue arrows, x 8)
The picture below shows how to remove the screw [B] of the gear unit.
Adjustment after reinstalling the gear unit Do the following procedures after reinstalling the gear unit. 1.
Turn on the main power switch.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-74 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Drive Unit 2.
Enter "System SP" in the SP mode.
3.
Do "Drum Phase Adj." with SP1902-001.
4.
Check the result of the Drum Phase Adjustment with SP1902-002. 0: Success, 2: Failure due to no sampling data, 3: Failure due to insufficient number of pattern detections When the result of this adjustment is "2" or "3":
Check that the all PCDUs are correctly set and that the ITB unit is correctly set.
Do "Drum Phase Adj." again after checking the PCDUs and ITB unit.
When the result is still "2" or "3" after checking the PCDUs and image transfer belt unit: 5.
Check that the gear unit is installed correctly.
Exit the SP mode.
1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)
3.
Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)
4.
Registration motor [A] ( x 2, x 1)
Replacement & Adjustment
4.10.2 REGISTRATION MOTOR
4.10.3 PAPER FEED MOTOR: T1 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Rear lower cover ( Section: Right Lower Cover)
3.
Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)
SM
4-75 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Drive Unit
4.
Paper feed motor: T1 [A] ( x 1, x 2)
The picture below shows how to remove the screw [B] of the paper feed motor T1.
4.10.4 PAPER FEED MOTOR: T2 1.
Rear cover Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Rear lower cover ( Section:Rear Lower Cover)
3.
Paper feed motor: T2 [A] ( x 1, x 2)
4.10.5 DRUM MOTOR: CMY
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-76 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Drive Unit Do not remove the PCDUs when you replace the drum motor-CMY.
1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)
3.
Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)
4.
Drum motor: CMY [A] ( x 3, x 1)
Replacement & Adjustment
4.10.6 DEVELOPMENT MOTOR: CMY 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover
2.
Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)
3.
Open the controller box. ( Section: Controller Box)
4.
Development motor: CMY [A] ( x 3, x 1)
4.10.7 DRUM/DEVELOPMENT MOTOR: K 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
1.
Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)
2.
Open the controller box. ( Section: Controller Box)
SM
4-77 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Drive Unit
3.
Drum/Development motor: K [A] ( x 3, x 1)
4.10.8 DEVELOPMENT CLUTCH: K 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
1.
Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)
2.
Open the controller box. ( Section: Controller Box)
3.
Drum/Development Motor: K ( Section: Drum/Development Motor: K)
4.
Remove the bracket with the development clutch: K [A] ( x 2, = x 1, x 1)
5.
Remove the development clutch: K [B] from the bracket.
4.10.9 FUSING/PAPER EXIT MOTOR 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
1.
Rear lower cover ( Section: Rear Lower Cover)
2.
Open the controller box. ( Section: Controller Box)
3.
Drum/Development Motor: K ( Section: Drum/Development Motor: K)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-78 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Drive Unit
4.
Loosen the stay [A] ( x 1, hook [B] x 1)
The hook [B] is installed as shown above. Do not pull the stay by force, or the
Replacement & Adjustment
hook might be broken.
5.
Fusing/paper exit motor [A] ( x 3, x 1)
The picture below shows how to remove the screw [B] of the fusing/paper exit motor.
SM
4-79 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Drive Unit
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-80 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
4.11 FUSING 4.11.1 PM PARTS
PM Parts
Replacement Procedure
Fusing Roller
Section: Heating, Fusing and Tension Roller
Fusing Belt
Section: Fusing Belt
Section: Heating Roller Thermistor and Section:
Thermistor
Entrance Guide Plate
Section: Entrance Guide Plate
Exit Guide Plate
Section: Exit Guide Plate Cleaning Procedure
Stripper Plate
Section: Stripper Plate
Thermopile
Section: Thermopile
4.11.2 FUSING UNIT
Turn off the main switch and wait until the fusing unit cools down before beginning any of the procedures in this section. The fusing unit can cause serious burns.
1.
If you install a new fusing unit (at PM for example), then set SP 3902-014 to "1" before you start this procedure.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the fusing unit automatically, after you turn the power on again.
2.
Turn off the main power switch.
3.
Open the duplex unit.
SM
4-81 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
Pressure Roller Thermistor
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
4.
Open the paper transfer unit [A]
5.
Release the lock levers [B].
6.
Hold the fusing unit handles [C], and then pull out the fusing unit.
When installing the fusing unit Make sure that the both lock levers [B] are locked before closing the duplex unit. Otherwise, these lock levers [B] can be broken.
4.11.3 ENTRANCE GUIDE PLATE 1.
Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
2.
Entrance Guide Plate [A] ( x 2)
Cleaning Requirement The entrance guide plate requires cleaning maintenance at every 60 K interval. Clean the entrance guide plate with a cloth moistened with alcohol at the following points.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-82 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
Replacement & Adjustment
4.11.4 STRIPPER PLATE 1.
Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
2.
Fusing upper cover [A] ( x 4)
3.
Spring [A] and bearing [B] at front and rear side
SM
4-83 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
4.
Top frame [A] ( x 4, x 1)
5.
Release the springs [A] at the front and rear side.
6.
Stripper plate [B]
Cleaning Requirement The stripper plate requires cleaning maintenance at every 60 K interval. Clean the stripper plate with a cloth moistened with alcohol at the following points.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-84 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
4.11.5 EXIT GUIDE PLATE CLEANING PROCEDURE The exit guide plate requires cleaning maintenance at every 60 K interval. Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
2.
Open the exit guide plate [A].
3.
Clean the exit guide plate [A] with a cloth moistened with alcohol.
Replacement & Adjustment
1.
4.11.6 PRESSURE ROLLER FUSING LAMP 1.
SM
Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
4-85 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
2.
Fusing upper cover [A] ( x 4)
3.
Remove the cable [A] from the rear stay ( x 1).
4.
Remove the cable [A] from the front stay ( x 1).
The color of the pressure roller fusing lamp cord differs depending on the destination.
5.
Red: 220 - 240 V, Blue: 120 V
Front pressure roller lamp stay [B] ( x 1)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-86 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
6.
Pressure roller fusing lamp [A]
4.11.7 HEATING ROLLER FUSING LAMP Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
2.
Remove the cords [A] from the front stay ( x 2)
3.
Remove the cords [A] from the rear stay ( x 2)
4.
Rear stay [B] ( x 2)
Replacement & Adjustment
1.
SM
4-87 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
5.
Heating roller fusing lamp [A]
4.11.8 FUSING BELT If you install a new fusing belt, set SP 3902-016 to "1" before you start this procedure.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the fusing belt automatically, after you turn the power on again.
1.
Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
2.
Fusing upper cover ( Section: Pressure Roller Fusing Lamp)
3.
Heating roller fusing lamp ( Section: Heating Roller Fusing Lamp)
4.
Idle gear [A] and fusing roller gear [B]
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-88 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
Remove the front cord [A] of the pressure roller fusing lamp ( x 1).
6.
Front stay [B] ( x 2)
7.
Spring [A] and bearing [B] at front and rear side
8.
Top frame [A] ( x 4, x 1)
Replacement & Adjustment
5.
SM
4-89 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
9.
Release the springs [A] at the front and rear side.
10. Stripper plate [B]
11. Take the thermostat base [A] aside ( x 2).
This prevents the fusing belt from being torn or scratched when the fusing belt is removed from the fusing unit.
12. Bearings [A] of the heating roller (C-ring x 1 each)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-90 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing 13. Bearings [B] of the fusing roller ( x 1 each)
Replacement & Adjustment
14. Fusing belt [A] with rollers
15. Fusing belt [A]
4.11.9 HEATING, FUSING AND TENSION ROLLER If you install a new fusing roller, set SP 3902-015 to "1" before you start this procedure.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the fusing unit automatically, after you turn the power on again.
1.
SM
Fusing belt with rollers ( Section: Fusing Belt)
4-91 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
2.
Fusing roller [A]
3.
Heating roller [B]
4.
Tension roller [C]
When reinstalling the fusing roller When replacing the fusing roller, you have to apply lubricant to the following places. Fusing Roller
Apply "Barrierta S552R" to the area [A] at the front side of the fusing roller.
Apply "Barrierta S552R" to the area [B] at the rear side of the fusing roller.
Do not apply lubricant to areas other than the areas [A] and [B] as shown above.
4.11.10 PRESSURE ROLLER 1.
Fusing belt with rollers ( Section: Fusing Belt)
2.
Pressure roller fusing lamp ( Section: Pressure Roller Fusing Lamp)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-92 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
Pressure levers [A] at the rear side (snap ring x 1, spring x 1)
4.
Top right frame [A] ( x 4)
5.
Pressure roller gear [A] and bearing [B] at the rear side (C-ring x 1)
6.
Bearing [C] (C-ring x 1)
Replacement & Adjustment
3.
SM
4-93 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
7.
Pressure roller [A]
Cleaning Requirement The pressure roller requires cleaning maintenance (if it is dirty) at every 60 K interval. Clean the pressure roller with a cloth moistened with alcohol.
4.11.11 HEATING ROLLER THERMOSTATS 1.
Fusing upper cover ( Section: Pressure Roller Fusing Lamp)
2.
Heating roller thermostats [A] ( x 3)
Do not re-use a thermostat that is already opened. Safety is not guaranteed if you do this.
4.11.12 HEATING ROLLER THERMISTOR 1.
Fusing upper cover ( Section: Pressure Roller Fusing Lamp)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-94 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
Disconnect the connector [A].
3.
Heating roller thermistor assembly [B] ( x 1)
4.
Heating roller thermistor [A] ( x 1)
Replacement & Adjustment
2.
Cleaning Requirement The heating roller thermistor requires cleaning maintenance at every 60 K interval. Clean the heating roller thermistor with a dry cloth.
4.11.13 PRESSURE ROLLER THERMISTOR Pressure Roller Thermistor: Center 1.
Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
2.
Fusing upper cover ( Section: Pressure Roller Fusing Lamp)
SM
4-95 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
3.
Thermistor center assembly [A] ( x 1, x 1)
4.
Pressure roller thermistor: Center [A] ( x 1)
Pressure Roller Thermistor: Center 1.
Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
2.
Fusing upper cover ( Section: Pressure Roller Fusing Lamp)
3.
Thermistor end assembly [A] ( x 1, x 1)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-96 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
4.
Pressure roller thermistor: End [A] ( x 1)
Cleaning Requirement The pressure roller thermistors (center and end) require cleaning maintenance at every 60 Replacement & Adjustment
K interval. Clean the pressure roller thermistors (center and end) with a dry cloth.
4.11.14 PRESSURE ROLLER THERMOSTAT 1.
Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
1.
Fusing belt with rollers ( Section: Fusing Belt)
2.
Pressure roller ( Section: Pressure Roller)
3.
Pressure roller thermostats [A] ( x 2)
4.11.15 THERMOPILE 1.
SM
Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
4-97 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
2.
Thermopile base [A] ( x 1, x 1)
3.
Thermopile cover [A] ( x 2)
4.
Thermopile [B]
When cleaning the lens of the thermopile
Do this cleaning procedure after the fusing unit has completely cooled down. Otherwise, you may get a serious burn.
1.
Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
2.
Clean the thermopile lens [A] with a dry cloth.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-98 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
4.11.16 CLEANING UNIT (OPTION) INSTALLATION PROCEDURE Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
2.
Fusing upper cover [A] ( x 4)
3.
Top right frame [A] ( x 4)
4.
Install the cleaning unit [A] in the fusing unit.
Replacement & Adjustment
1.
SM
4-99 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fusing
5.
Secure the cleaning unit [A] ( x 2)
6.
Reassemble the fusing unit.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-100 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed
4.12 PAPER FEED
1.
Pull paper tray 1 or 2 [A] part of the way out.
2.
Remove two screws from both tray guides.
3.
Pull out paper tray 1 or 2 [A].
Replacement & Adjustment
4.12.1 PAPER TRAY
4.12.2 FEED ROLLER Tray 1 and Tray 2 1.
Paper tray 1 or 2 ( Section: Paper Tray)
2.
Press down the bottom plate [A].
3.
Slide the feed roller shaft [B] to the rear side ( x 1).
4.
Feed roller [C] (hook x 1)
When reinstalling the feed roller Do not touch the feed roller with your bare hands when replacing it. If you do, clean the feed roller with a damp cloth or alcohol.
4.12.3 FRICTION PAD 1.
SM
Paper tray 1 or 2 ( Section: Paper Tray)
4-101 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed 2.
Feed roller ( Section: Feed Roller)
3.
Remove the coupling gear [A] (pin x 1, spring x 1, x 1).
4.
Slide the feed roller shaft to the front side, and then remove it.
5.
Friction pad [A] (hooks, spring x 1)
When reinstalling the friction pad
Make sure that the mylar [A] does not go under the friction pad when reinstalling the friction pad. Do not touch the feed roller with your bare hands, when replacing it. If you do, clean the feed roller with a damp cloth or alcohol.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-102 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed
4.12.4 PAPER SIZE SWITCH Paper tray 1 and 2 ( Section: Paper Tray)
Paper size switch: T1 [A]
Paper size switch: T2 [B] Replacement & Adjustment
1.
2.
Paper size switch [A] (hooks, x 1)
4.12.5 PAPER END SENSOR Paper End Sensor: T1 1.
SM
Paper tray 1 and 2 ( Section: Paper Tray)
4-103 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed 2.
Release the two clamps [A].
3.
Paper end sensor: T1 [B] (hooks, x 1)
Paper End Sensor: T2 1.
Paper tray 1 and 2 ( Section: Paper Tray)
2.
Release the clamp [A].
3.
Paper end sensor: T2 [B] (hooks, x 1)
4.12.6 REGISTRATION SENSOR 1.
Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)
2.
Open the paper transfer unit to the fully-open position ( Section: PTR (Paper Transfer Roller) Unit).
3.
Registration roller guide [A] ( x 2)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-104 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed
Close the paper transfer unit [A].
5.
Relay guide plate [B] ( x 2)
6.
Upper vertical transport guide [C] (= x 1, x 2)
7.
Registration sensor [A] (= x 2, hooks, x 1)
Replacement & Adjustment
4.
Cleaning the registration roller
SM
4-105 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed Clean the registration roller and registration idle roller [A] with a damp cloth every 60 K (total count).
Never use alcohol to clean the registration roller.
4.12.7 VERTICAL TRANSPORT SENSOR Vertical Transport Sensor 1 1.
Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)
2.
Open the paper transfer unit to the fully-open position ( Section: PTR (Paper Transfer Roller) Unit).
3.
Middle guide plate [A] ( x 2)
4.
Open the lower right door [A].
5.
Release the belt [B].
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-106 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed
Open the lower guide plate [A]
7.
Middle guide bracket [B] ( x 4, = x 2, x 1)
8.
Sensor bracket [A] ( x 1, = x 1)
9.
Vertical transport sensor 1 [B] ( x 1, hooks)
Replacement & Adjustment
6.
Vertical Transport Sensor 2 1.
Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)
2.
Open the lower right door [A].
3.
Release the belt [B].
SM
4-107 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed
4.
Release the rear pivot [A], and then remove the lower right door [B].
5.
Lower guide bracket [A] ( x 2)
6.
Sensor bracket [A] ( x 1)
7.
Vertical transport sensor 2 [B] (hooks, x 1)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-108 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Exit
4.13 PAPER EXIT 4.13.1 JUNCTION GATE SOLENOID FAN Right upper cover ( Section: Right Upper Cover)
2.
Right rear cover
3.
Fan base [A] ( x 1, x 1)
4.
Junction gate solenoid fan [B] (hooks)
Replacement & Adjustment
1.
When installing the junction gate solenoid fan Make sure that the junction gate solenoid fan is installed with its decal facing to the left side.
4.13.2 PAPER EXIT UNIT 1.
Fusing Unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
2.
Front right cover ( Section: Front Right Cover)
3.
Junction gate solenoid fan base ( Section: Junction Gate Solenoid Fan)
4.
Paper exit cover ( Section: Paper Exit Cover)
5.
Inner Tray ( Section: Inner Tray)
SM
4-109 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Exit 6.
Front harness cover [A] ( x 1)
7.
Remove or disconnect the following:
8.
Two screws [A] at the front side
Front harness [B]
Ground cable [C] ( x 1)
Rear harness [D]
Paper exit unit [A]
4.13.3 FUSING EXIT 1.
Paper exit unit ( Section: Paper Exit Unit)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-110 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Exit
Sensor assembly [A] ( x 1, = x 1, x 1)
3.
Fusing exit sensor [A] ( x 1)
Replacement & Adjustment
2.
4.13.4 PAPER EXIT SENSOR 1.
Paper exit unit ( Section: Paper Exit Unit)
2.
Paper exit sensor [A] (hooks, x 1)
SM
4-111 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Exit
When installing the paper exit sensor
Stand the paper exit unit so that [A] is facing up. Otherwise, the paper exit sensor feeler interrupts the installation of the paper exit sensor.
Insert the hook [B] first.
4.13.5 INVERTER SENSOR 1.
Paper exit unit ( Section: Paper Exit Unit)
2.
Remove the screw [A].
3.
Release all clamps that clamp the harness [B].
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-112 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Exit 4.
Move the sensor assembly [A] to the cutout [B], and then remove it (= x1, x 1)
5.
Inverter sensor [A] (hooks)
4.13.6 INVERTER MOTOR Paper exit unit ( Section: Paper Exit Unit)
2.
Inverter motor [A] ( x 2, x 1)
Replacement & Adjustment
1.
SM
4-113 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Exit
4.13.7 FUSING FRONT FAN 1.
Front right cover ( Section: Front Right Cover)
2.
Fusing front fan [A] ( x 2, = x 1, x 1)
When installing the fusing front fan Make sure that the fusing front fan is installed with its decal facing to the rear side.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-114 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Duplex Unit
4.14 DUPLEX UNIT 4.14.1 DUPLEX UNIT Open the duplex unit.
2.
Remove the screw [A].
3.
Move the duplex unit in the direction shown by , and remove the hook [A].
4.
Disconnect the harness [B].
5.
Release the front and rear arms [A], [B] ( x 1 each).
SM
Replacement & Adjustment
1.
4-115 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Duplex Unit
6.
Remove the clip [A].
7.
Slide the duplex unit [B] to the front side, and then remove it.
4.14.2 DUPLEX ENTRANCE SENSOR 1.
Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)
2.
Duplex inner cover [A] ( x 2)
3.
Duplex entrance guide unit [A] (hook x 3)
Lift up the duplex guide plate [A] first when reinstalling the duplex entrance
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-116 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Duplex Unit
Replacement & Adjustment
guide unit.
4.
Duplex outer guide plate [A] ( x 4)
5.
Duplex entrance sensor [A] (hook)
4.14.3 DUPLEX EXIT SENSOR 1.
Pull out the 1st tray.
2.
Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)
SM
4-117 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Duplex Unit
1.
Duplex exit sensor assembly cover [A] ( x 1)
2.
Duplex exit sensor assembly [B] ( x 1, ground screw x 1, = x 1, x 1)
3.
Duplex exit sensor [A] (hook)
4.14.4 DUPLEX ENTRANCE MOTOR 1.
Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)
2.
Duplex inner cover ( Section: Duplex Entrance Sensor)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-118 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Duplex Unit
Duplex entrance motor with the bracket [A] ( x 3, = x1, x 1)
4.
Separate the duplex entrance motor [A] from the bracket ( x 2)
Replacement & Adjustment
3.
4.14.5 DUPLEX EXIT MOTOR 1.
Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)
2.
Duplex inner cover ( Section: Duplex Entrance Sensor)
3.
Duplex exit motor with the bracket [A] ( x 3, = x 2, x 1)
SM
4-119 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Duplex Unit
4.
Separate the duplex exit motor [A] from the bracket ( x 2)
4.14.6 BY-PASS MOTOR 1.
Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)
2.
Duplex inner cover ( Section: Duplex Entrance Sensor)
3.
By-pass motor with the bracket [A] ( x 3, = x 2, x 1)
4.
Remove the clamp [B] from the bracket to disconnect the harness.
By-pass motor [A] ( x 2)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-120 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Duplex Unit
4.14.7 BY-PASS TRAY UNIT Duplex unit ( Section: Duplex Unit)
2.
Duplex inner cover ( Section: Duplex Entrance Sensor)
3.
Reinstall the duplex unit once, and open it.
4.
Disconnect the harness [A].
5.
Close the duplex unit.
6.
Open the by-pass tray unit [A]
7.
By-pass tray unit ( x 2, hook [B]).
Replacement & Adjustment
1.
Use a flat-head screw driver or similar tool to push the hook [B] down.
4.14.8 BY-PASS PAPER LENGTH SENSOR 1.
SM
Open the by-pass tray unit.
4-121 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Duplex Unit
2.
By-pass tray right cover [A] ( x 2)
3.
By-pass paper length sensor [A] ( x 1)
4.14.9 BY-PASS PAPER SIZE SENSOR 1.
By-pass tray unit ( Section: By-Pass Tray Unit)
2.
By-pass tray cover [A] (hook x 1)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-122 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Duplex Unit
3.
By-pass paper size sensor [A] ( x 1)
Replacement & Adjustment
When reinstalling the by-pass paper size sensor
1.
Adjust the projection [A] of the left side fence bar (it must be centered).
2.
Install the by-pass paper size detection switch so that the hole [B] in this switch faces the projection [C] of the left side fence bar.
3.
Reassemble the copier.
4.
Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
5.
Check this switch operation with SP5803-046 (By-Pass Size Detection SW < Input Check).
- Display on the LCD -
SM
Paper Size
Display
Paper Size
Display
A3 SEF
00001001
A5 SEF
00001110
B4 SEF
00001011
B6 SEF
00001100
A4 SEF
00000011
A6 SEF
00001101
B5 SEF
00000111
Smaller A6 SEF
00001101
4-123 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Duplex Unit
4.14.10 BY-PASS PAPER END SENSOR 1.
By-pass tray unit ( Section: By-Pass Tray Unit)
2.
By-pass paper end sensor [A] ( x 1, hook)
Reinstalling the By-pass Paper End Sensor
Reinstall the right hook first and then the left hook using a flat-head screw driver or similar tool.
4.14.11 BY-PASS FEED ROLLER 1.
By-pass tray unit ( Section: By-Pass Tray Unit)
2.
By-pass feed roller [A] (hook)
4.14.12 BY-PASS TRAY HP SENSOR 1.
Open the by-pass tray unit.
2.
Open the duplex unit.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-124 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Duplex Unit
Remove the hand holder [A].
4.
Rotate the actuator [A] counter clockwise as shown above.
5.
By-pass tray HP sensor [B] (hook).
Replacement & Adjustment
3.
SM
4-125 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
4.15 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 4.15.1 BOARDS Controller Box Closed
[A]
BCU
[B]
i-Controller Board (D038/D041)
[B1]
i-Controller Board (D037/D040)
[C]
HDD (D038/D041 only)
[D]
DRB
[E]
PSU
Controller Box Open
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-126 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
[F]
HVPS: TTS Board
[G]
HVPS: CB Board
Replacement & Adjustment
Electrical Components
4.15.2 CONTROLLER BOX COVER 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Scanner cable bracket [A] ( x 4)
3.
Loosen the eight screws.
4.
Slide up the controller box cover [B], and then remove it.
4.15.3 CONTROLLER BOX Opening the controller box 1.
SM
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
4-127 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components 2.
Controller box cover ( Section: Controller Box Cover)
3.
Remove the four screws and disconnect the scanner cable [A] ( x 1, ground screw x 1)
4.
Open the controller box [A].
4.15.4 BCU 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Controller box cover ( Section: Controller Box Cover)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-128 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
BCU [A] ( x 7, x All)
Make sure the NVRAM is correctly installed on the BCU. Insert the NVRAM in the NVRAM slot with the "half-moon" pointing [B] to the downward side.
When installing the new BCU 1.
Remove the NVRAM from the old BCU.
2.
Install the NVRAM on the new BCU after you replace the BCU.
3.
Reassemble the machine.
4.
Turn on the main power of the machine.
5.
"SC995-01" occurs.
6.
Enter the serial number with SP5811-004.
7.
Turn the main power of the machine off and on.
Make sure you print out the SMC reports (“SP Mode Data” and “Logging Data”) before you replace the NVRAM.
Keep NVRAM away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static electricity can damage NVRAM data.
4.15.5 HDD (ONLY FOR D038/D041) 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Controller box cover ( Section: Controller Box Cover)
SM
4-129 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
3.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
3.
HDD assembly [A] ( x 3, x 2 from the controller board).
4.
HDD [A] ( x 4, x 2).
Reconnect the harnesses to the controller board.
4.15.6 CONTROLLER BOX FAN 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Controller box cover ( Section: Controller Box Cover)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-130 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
3.
Controller box fan [A] ( x 2, = x 2, x 1)
When installing the controller box fan Make sure that the controller box fan is installed with its decal facing upward.
4.15.7 FUSING REAR FAN 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Fusing rear fan with the bracket [A]
SM
( x 2, x 1, = x 1)
4-131 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
Electrical Components
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
3.
Remove the bracket [A] from the fusing rear fan [B] (hook x 6).
When installing the fusing rear fan Make sure that the fusing rear fan is installed with its decal facing to the rear side.
4.15.8 PSU 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
DRB with the bracket [A] ( x 4, x all, = x all)
3.
Power cord [A] (Blue: ground screw x 1, x 2)
4.
Remove the clamp [B] from the bracket.
5.
PSU board [C] ( x 9, = x All, x All)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-132 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)
3.
Fusing rear fan [A] ( x 2, = x 1, x 1)
4.
HVPS: TTS board [B] ( x 5, x all)
Replacement & Adjustment
4.15.9 HVPS: TTS BOARD
4.15.10 HVPS: CB BOARD 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)
3.
HVPS: CB board [A] ( x 6, All s)
SM
4-133 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
4.15.11 I-CONTROLLER BOARD 1.
Rear cover ( Section: Rear Cover)
2.
Open the controller box ( Section: Controller Box)
3.
Controller box left bracket [A] ( x 5)
For D037/D040
1.
i-controller board [A] ( x 9, x all)
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-134 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
2.
Replacement & Adjustment
Electrical Components
Remove the Interface rails [A], NVRAM [B] and RAM-DIMM [C].
For D038/D041
1.
HDD ( Section: HDD (Only for D038/D041))
2.
i-controller board [A] ( x 8, x all)
SM
4-135 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
3.
Remove the interface rails [A], NVRAMs [B] and RAM-DIMMs [C]
When installing the new controller board 1.
Remove the NVRAM from the old controller board.
2.
Install the NVRAM on the new controller board after you replace the controller board.
3.
Reassemble the machine.
4.
Turn on the main power of the machine
Make sure you print out the SMC reports (“SP Mode Data” and “Logging Data”) before you replace the NVRAM.
Keep NVRAMs away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static electricity can damage NVRAM data.
Make sure the NVRAM is correctly installed on the controller board.
When installing a new HDD unit 1.
Turn the main power switch on. The disk is automatically formatted.
2.
Install the stamp data using "SP5853".
3.
Switch the machine off and on to enable the fixed stamps for use.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-136 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
Disposal of HDD Units
Never remove an HDD unit from the work site without the consent of the client.
If the customer has any concerns about the security of any information on the HDD, the HDD must remain with the customer for disposal or safe keeping.
The HDD may contain proprietary or classified (Confidential, Secret) information. Specifically, the HDD contains document server documents and data stored in temporary files created automatically during copy job sorting and jam recovery. Such data is stored on the HDD in a special format so it cannot normally be read but can be recovered with illegal methods.
Reinstallation Explain to the customer that the following information stored on the HDD is lost when the
Document server documents
Custom-made stamps
Document server address book
The address book and document server documents (if needed) must be input again. If you previously backed up the address book to an SD card with SP5846 051, you can use SP 5846 052 to copy the data from the SD card to the hard disk. If the customer is using the Data Overwrite Security feature, the DOS function must be set up again. For more, see Section 1 (Installation). If the customer is using the optional Browser Unit, this unit must be installed again. For more, see Section 1 (Installation).
4.15.12 NVRAM REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE NVRAM on the BCU 1.
Make sure that you have the SMC report (factory settings). This report comes with the machine.
2.
Output the SMC data ( SP5-990-001) if possible.
3.
Turn the main switch off.
4.
Install an SD card into SD card slot 2. Then turn the main power on.
5.
Copy the NVRAM data to an SD card ( SP5-824-001) if possible.
6.
Turn off the main switch. Then unplug the power cord.
7.
Replace the NVRAM on the BCU and reassemble the machine.
8.
Plug in the power cord. Then turn the main switch on.
9.
SC995-01 occurs.
10. Copy the data from the SD card to the NVRAM ( SP5-825-001) if you have
SM
4-137 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replacement & Adjustment
HDD is replaced:
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components successfully copied them to the SD card. 11. Turn the main switch off. Then remove the SD card from SD card slot 2. 12. Turn the main switch on. 13. Specify the SP and UP mode settings. 14. Do the process control self-check. 15. Do ACC for the copier application program. 16. Do ACC for the printer application program.
NVRAM on the Controller 1.
Make sure that you have the SMC report (factory settings). This report comes with the machine.
2.
Output the SMC data ( SP5-990-001) if possible.
3.
Turn the main switch off. Then unplug the power cord.
4.
Install a New NVRAM on the controller. Then reassemble the machine.
5.
Turn the main switch on.
6.
SC995-02 occurs.
7.
Turn the machine off and on.
8.
Do the process control self-check.
9.
Do ACC for the copier application program.
10. Do ACC for the printer application program.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-138 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Machine Boot-Up
4.16 MACHINE BOOT-UP This machine boots up the modules in the following order.
Module Name System application
2
Copy application
3
Printer application
4
Web System application
5
Scanner application
6
Fax application
SM
Replacement & Adjustment
1
It takes approximately 90 seconds to boot up all modules.
4-139 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE REFERENCE
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service Program Mode
5. SYSTEM MAINTENANCE REFERENCE 5.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE
Make sure that the data-in LED () is not on before you go into the SP mode. This LED indicates that some data is coming to the machine. When the LED is on, wait for the copier to process the data.
5.1.1 SP TABLES See "Appendices" for the following information:
System SP Tables
Printer SP Tables
Scanner SP Tables
System SP: SP modes related to the engine functions
Printer SP: SP modes related to the controller functions
Scanner SP: SP modes related to the scanner functions
Fax SP: SP modes related to the fax functions
Select one of the Service Program modes (System, Printer, Scanner, or Fax) from the touch panel as shown in the diagram below after you access the SP mode. This section explains the functions of the System/Printer/Scanner SP modes. Refer to the Fax service manual for the Fax SP modes.
SM
5-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
System Maintenance Reference
5.1.2 TYPES OF SP MODES FOR DI-C1 H-MODEL (D038/D041)
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service Program Mode
SP Mode Button Summary Here is a short summary of the touch-panel buttons.
Opens all SP groups and sublevels.
Closes all open groups and sublevels and restores the initial SP mode display.
Opens the copy window (copy mode) so you can make test copies. Press SP Mode (highlighted) in the copy window to return to the SP mode screen, Enter the SP code directly with the number keys if you know the SP number. Then
press. (The required SP Mode number will be highlighted when pressing . If not, just press the required SP Mode number.)
Press two times to leave the SP mode and return to the copy window to resume normal operation.
Press any Class 1 number to open a list of Class 2 SP modes.
Press to scroll the show to the previous or next group.
Press to scroll to the previous or next display in segments the size of the screen display (page).
¡
Press to scroll the show the previous or next line (line by line).
¢
Press to move the highlight on the left to the previous or next selection in the list.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service Program Mode
Switching Between SP Mode and Copy Mode for Test Printing 1.
In the SP mode, select the test print. Then press "Copy Window".
2.
Use the copy window (copier mode), to select the appropriate settings (paper size, etc.) for the test print.
3.
Press Start C to start the test print.
4.
Press SP Mode (highlighted) to return to the SP mode screen and repeat from step 1.
Selecting the Program Number Program numbers have two or three levels. 1.
Refer to the Service Tables to find the SP that you want to adjust before you begin.
2.
Press the Group number on the left side SP Mode window that contains the SP that you want to adjust.
3.
Use the scrolling buttons in the center of the SP mode window to show the SP number that you want to open. Then press that number to expand the list.
4.
Use the center touch-panel buttons to scroll to the number and title of the item that you want to set and press it. The small entry box on the right activates and shows the
System Maintenance Reference
below default or the current settings.
1.
Refer to the SP Tables for the range of allowed settings.
Do this procedure to enter a setting:
Press to toggle between plus and minus and use the keypad to enter the appropriate number. The number you enter writes over the previous setting.
Press to enter the setting. (The value is not registered if you enter a number that is out of range.)
SM
Press “Yes” when you are prompted to complete the selection.
5-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service Program Mode 2.
If you need to perform a test print, press Copy Window to open the copy window and select the settings for the test print. Press Start C and then press SP Mode (highlighted) in the copy window to return to the SP mode display.
3.
Press Exit two times to return to the copy window when you are finished.
Service Mode Lock/Unlock At locations where the machine contains sensitive data, the customer engineer cannot operate the machine until the Administrator turns the service mode lock off. This function makes sure that work on the machine is always done with the permission of the Administrator. 1.
If you cannot go into the SP mode, ask the Administrator to log in with the User Tool and then set “Service Mode Lock” to OFF after he or she logs in: User Tools > System Settings > Administrator Tools > Service Mode Lock > OFF
This unlocks the machine and lets you get access to all the SP codes.
The CE can service the machine and turn the machine off and on. It is not necessary to ask the Administrator to log in again each time the machine is turned on.
2.
Go into the SP mode and set SP5169 to “1” if you must use the printer bit switches.
3.
After machine servicing is completed:
Change SP5169 from “1” to “0”.
Turn the machine off and on. Tell the administrator that you have completed servicing the machine.
The Administrator will then set the “Service Mode Lock” to ON.
5.1.3 TYPES OF SP MODES FOR DI-C1 L-MODEL (D037/D040)
System SP: SP modes related to the engine functions
Printer SP: SP modes related to the controller functions
Scanner SP: SP modes related to the scanner functions
Fax SP: SP modes related to the fax functions
Select one of the Service Program modes (System, Printer, Scanner, or Fax) from the operation panel as shown in the diagram below after you access the SP mode. This section explains the functions of the System/Printer/Scanner SP modes. Refer to the Fax service manual for the Fax SP modes.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service Program Mode
Selecting Programs
When a blinking underscore (or several blinking underscores) is displayed, you can type a number from the numeric keypad [A].
When the sign "' (/OK" [B] is displayed upper right corner, you can scroll through the menu by pressing the left-arrow key [C] or the right-arrow key [D]. To select a program, press the "OK" key [E].
1.
After locating a program, press the "OK" key. A blinking underscore (or several blinking underscores) indicates which value you can change. The value in parentheses is the default value of the menu.
2.
Type a necessary value from the numeric keypad. To switch between positive (plus) and negative (minus) values, press the [./*] (period/asterisk) key.
3.
To validate the value, press the "OK" key. To cancel the value, press the cancel key [F].
Activating Copy Mode You can activate the copy mode while the SP mode is running. When you do so, the copier outputs images or patterns that help you adjust the SP-mode program. 1.
Press the C key. The copy mode is activated.
2.
Specify copy settings and press the "OK" key.
3.
To return to the SP mode, press the D key.
You cannot end the SP mode while the copy mode is activated.
Quitting Programs/Ending SP Mode Press the D key or the "Cancel" key to quit the program. You can end the SP mode by pressing one of these keys several times.
SM
5-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
System Maintenance Reference
Specifying Values
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service Program Mode
5.1.4 REMARKS Display on the Control Panel Screen The maximum number of characters which can show on the control panel screen is limited to 30 (H-model)/ 17 (L-model) characters. For this reason, some of the SP modes shown on the screen need to be abbreviated. The following are abbreviations used for the SP modes for which the full description is over 30 (H-model)/ 17 (L-model) characters.
Paper Weight Thin paper: 52-59.9 g/m2 Plain Paper1: 60-74 g/m2, 16-20lb. Plain Paper2: 74.1-90 g/m2, 20-24lb. Middle Thick: 90.1-105 g/m2, 24-28lb. Thick Paper 1: 105.1-169 g/m2, 28.5-44.9lb. Thick Paper 2: 169.1-210 g/m2, 45-56lb. Thick Paper 3: 210.1-256 g/m2, 56lb-68lb Paper Type
Paper Feed Station
N: Normal paper
P: Paper tray
MTH: Middle thick paper
B: By-pass table
TH: Thick paper Color Mode [Color] [K]: Black in B&W mode
[Y], [M], or [C]: Yellow, Magenta, or Cyan in Full Color mode [YMC]: Only for Yellow, Magenta, and Cyan [FC]: Full Color mode [FC, K], [FC, Y], [FC, M], or [FC, C]: Black, Yellow, Magenta, or Cyan in full color mode Print Mode
Process Speed
S: Simplex
L: Low speed (60 mm/s)
D: Duplex
M: Middle speed (120 mm/s)
Others The following symbols are used in the SP mode tables. FA: Factory setting (Data may be adjusted from the default setting at the factory. Refer to the factory setting
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service Program Mode sheets enclosed. You can find it under the jammed paper removal decal.) DFU: Design/Factory Use only Do not touch these SP modes in the field. A sharp (#) to the right hand side of the mode number column means that the main switch must be turned off and on to effect the setting change. An asterisk (*) to the right hand side of the mode number column means that this mode is stored in the NVRAM. If you do a RAM clear, this SP mode will be reset to the default value. “ENG” and “CTL” show which NVRAM contains the data.
ENG: NVRAM on the BCU board
CTL: NVRAM on the controller board
The settings of each SP mode are explained in the right-hand column of the SP table in the following way. [Adjustable range / Default setting / Step] Alphanumeric
If “Alphanumeric” is written to the right of the bracket as shown above, the setting of the SP mode shows on the screen using alphanumeric characters instead of only numbers. However, the settings in the bracket in the SP mode table are explained by using only the numbers.
SM
5-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Maintenance Reference
SSP: This denotes a “Special Service Program” mode setting.
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Firmware Update
5.2 FIRMWARE UPDATE To update the firmware for this machine, you must have the new version of the firmware downloaded onto an SD (Secure Digital) Card. The SD Card is inserted into SD Card Slot 2 on the left rear side of the controller box.
5.2.1 TYPE OF FIRMWARE H-Model (D038/D041)
Location of
Type of firmware
Function
Engine
Printer engine control
System/Copy Application
Printer Application
Scanner Application
firmware BCU Flash ROM Flash ROM on the
Operating system
controller board Flash ROM on the
Feature application
controller board Flash ROM on the
Feature application
controller board Flash ROM on the
Message shown
Engine
System/Copy
Printer
Scanner
Fax Application
Feature application
NIB
Network Interface
Operation Panel
Panel control
Operation Panel
OpePanel.
Fax FCU
Fax control
FCU
GWFCU-4(ww)-1-1
Remote Fax
Fax control
controller board Flash ROM on the controller board
Flash ROM on the controller board
Language firmware Language
Fax
Network Support
Remote Fax
Language 1
Two languages can be
Operation Panel
selected from 16
Language 2
languages.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Firmware Update WebDocBox
WebSys
PS/ PDF
Document server
Flash ROM on the
application
controller board
Web Service application
Page description language (PostScript3)
Flash ROM on the controller board
Web Uapl
Web Support
PS3 SD card
PS3/ PDF
PictBridge
PictBridge control
PictBridge SD card
PctBrgd
ARDF
ARDF control
ARDF
ADF
Finisher (D429)
Finisher control
Finisher (D429)
Finisher
L-Model (D037/D040)
Function
Engine
Printer engine control
System/Copy Application
Printer Application
Scanner Application
firmware BCU Flash ROM Flash ROM on the
Operating system
controller board Flash ROM on the
Feature application
controller board Flash ROM on the
Feature application
controller board Flash ROM on the
Message shown
Engine
System/Copy
Printer
Scanner
Fax Application
Feature application
NIB
Network Interface
Operation Panel
Panel control
Operation Panel
OpePanel.
Fax FCU
Fax control
FCU
GWFCU-4(ww)-1-1
SM
controller board Flash ROM on the controller board
5-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fax
Network Support
D037/D038/D040/D041
System Maintenance Reference
Location of
Type of firmware
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Firmware Update Remote Fax
Flash ROM on the
Fax control
controller board
Language firmware Language
Remote Fax
Language 1
Two languages can be
Operation Panel
selected from 16
Language 2
languages.
WebDocBox
Document server
Flash ROM on the
application
controller board
WebSys
Web Service application
ARDF
ARDF control
Flash ROM on the controller board ARDF
Web Uapl
Web Support
ADF
5.2.2 BEFORE YOU BEGIN An SD card is a precision device. Always observe the following precautions when you handle SD cards:
Always switch the machine off before you insert an SD card. Never insert the SD card into the slot with the power on.
Do not remove the SD card from the service slot after the power has been switched on.
Never switch the machine off while the firmware is downloading from the SD card.
Keep SD cards in a safe location where they are not exposed to high temperature, high humidity, or exposure to direct sunlight.
Always handle SD cards with care. Do not bend or scratch them. Do not let the SD card get exposed to shock or vibration.
Make sure that the write protection of an SD card is unlocked when you download an application to it. If not, downloading fails and a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware upgrade.
Keep the following points in mind when you use the firmware update software:
“Upload” means to send data from the machine to the SD card. “Download” means to send data from the SD card to the machine.
To select an item on the LCD, touch the appropriate button on the soft touch-screen of the LCD, or, press the appropriate number key on the 10-key pad of the operation panel. For example, when “Exit (0)” shows on the screen you can touch the Exit button on the screen, or, press the button on the operation panel of the copier.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Firmware Update
Make sure that the machine is disconnected from the network to prevent a print job for arriving while the firmware update is in progress before you start the firmware update procedure.
5.2.3 UPDATING FIRMWARE Preparation
If the SD card is blank, copy the entire “romdata” folder onto the SD card.
If the card already contains the “romdata” folder, copy the “D037” folder onto the card.
If the card already contains folders up to “D037”, copy the necessary firmware files (e.g. D037xxxx.fwu) into this folder.
Do not put multiple machine firmware programs on the same SD card. Copy the only model firmware you want.
Updating Procedure 1.
Turn the main power switch off.
2.
Remove the slot cover ( x 1).
3.
Insert the SD card into SD Card Slot 2. Make sure the label on the SD card faces the
4.
Slowly push the SD card into the slot so it locks in place. You will hear it click. Make sure the SD card locks in place.
To remove the SD, push it in to unlock the spring lock. Then release it so it pops out of the slot.
5.
Disconnect the network cable from the copier if the machine is connected to a network.
6.
Switch the main power switch on. After about 45 seconds, the initial version update screen appears on the LCD in English.
7.
On the screen, touch the button or press the corresponding number key on the operation panel to select the item in the menu that you want to update.
ROM/NEW
What it means Tells you the number of the module and name of the version
ROM:
currently installed. The first line is the module number, the second line the version name.
NEW:
SM
Tells you the number of the module and name version on the SD
5-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
System Maintenance Reference
rear side of the machine.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Firmware Update card. The first line is the module number, the second line the version name.
Controller, engine and operation panel firmware cannot be updated at the same time. It is recommended to update firmware modules one by one.
8.
Touch “UpDate (#)” (or ) to start the update.
The progress bar does not show for the operation panel firmware after you touch “OpPanel”. The power on key flashes on and off at 0.5 s intervals when the LCDC firmware is updating. The power key flashes on and off at 3 s intervals when the update is finished.
9.
The "Update is Done" message appears on the operation panel after completing the updating. The message differs depending on the firmware that has been updated.
10. Switch the copier main power switch off when you see the “Update is Done” message or follow the procedure that is displayed on the operation panel. 11. Press in the SD card to release it. Then remove it from the slot. 12. Switch the copier on for normal operation.
Error Messages An error message shows in the first line if an error occurs during the download. The error code consists of the letter “E” and a number. The example above shows error “E24” displayed. For details, refer to the Error Message Table. ( Section: Handling Firmware Update Error)
Firmware Update Error If a firmware update error occurs, this means the update was cancelled during the update because the module selected for update was not on the SD card.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Firmware Update
Recovery after Power Loss If the ROM update is interrupted as a result of accidental loss of power while the firmware is updating, then the correct operation of the machine cannot be guaranteed after the machine is switched on again. If the ROM update does not complete successfully for any reason, then in order to ensure the correct operation of the machine, the ROM update error will continue to show until the ROM is updated successfully.
download automatically from the card without the menu display.
5.2.4 UPDATING THE LCDC FOR THE OPERATION PANEL Do the following procedure to update the LCDC (LCD Control Board). 1.
Turn the copier main switch off.
2.
Remove the SD slot cover ( x 1).
3.
Insert the SD card into SD Card Slot 2.
4.
Switch the copier main switch on.
5.
The initial screen opens in English after about 45 seconds.
6.
Touch “Ope Panel.xx”.
7.
"xx" differs depending on the destination.
8.
Touch “UpDate(#) or () to start the update.
9.
Downloading starts after about 9 seconds.
10. The operation panel goes off and the main power on key flashes in red at 0.5 s intervals when the data is downloading. The same key starts flashing in green at 1 s intervals when the update is finished. 11. Switch the copier main power switch off and remove the SD card. Then switch the copier on.
SM
5-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
System Maintenance Reference
In this case, insert the card again and switch on the machine to continue the firmware
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Firmware Update 12. Press the “Exit” button. Then turn the copier off and on again.
5.2.5 HANDLING FIRMWARE UPDATE ERRORS An error message shows in the first line if an error occurs during a download. The error code consists of the letter “E” and a number (“E20”, for example).
Error Message Table
Code
Meaning
20
Cannot map logical address
Make sure the SD card is inserted correctly.
21
Cannot access memory
HDD connection incorrect or replace hard disks.
Cannot decompress
Incorrect ROM data on the SD card, or data is
compressed data
corrupted.
Error occurred when ROM
Controller program abnormal. If the second
update program started
attempt fails, replace controller board.
22
23
24
30
31
32
33
34
Solution
Make sure SD card inserted correctly, or use
SD card access error
another SD card.
No HDD available for stamp data download
Data incorrect for continuous download
HDD connection incorrect or replace hard disks.
Insert the SD card with the remaining data required for the download, the re-start the procedure.
Data incorrect after download interrupted
Execute the recovery procedure for the intended module download, then repeat the installation procedure.
Incorrect SD card version
Incorrect ROM data on the SD card, or data is corrupted.
Module mismatch - Correct
SD update data is incorrect. Acquire the correct
module is not on the SD
data (Japan, Overseas, OEM, etc.) then install
card)
again.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Firmware Update
36
40
42
43
44
50
SM
SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD
on SD card is not for this
card is for another machine. Acquire correct
machine
update data then install again. SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD
Cannot write module – Cause other than E34, E35
Engine module download failed
card is for another machine. Acquire correct update data then install again. Replace the update data for the module on the SD card and try again, or replace the BCU board.
Operation panel module
Replace the update data for the module on the
download failed
SD card and try again, or replace the LCDC.
Stamp data module
Replace the update data for the module on the
download failed
SD card and try again, or replace the hard disks.
Controller module download failed
SD card and tray again, or replace controller board.
Electronic confirmation check failed
Replace the update data for the module on the
SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD card is for another machine. Acquire correct update data then install again.
5-15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
System Maintenance Reference
35
Module mismatch – Module
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installing Another Language
5.3 INSTALLING ANOTHER LANGUAGE Many languages are available. But you can only switch between two languages at a time. Do the following procedure to select the two languages you want. You can select both of the languages you want from the user interface on the operation panel. 1.
Switch the copier main power switch off.
2.
Remove the SD slot cover ( x 1).
3.
Insert the SD card with the language data into SD Card Slot 2.
4.
Switch the copier main power switch on. The initial screen opens after about 45 seconds.
5.
Touch "Language Data (2)" on the screen (or press ).
6.
Touch "LANG. 1(1)" or "LANG. 2(2)"
Key
LANG. 1(1)
LANG. 1(2)
Exit(0)
7.
What it does Touch this button on the screen (or press on the 10-key pad) to open the next screen so you can select the 1st language. Touch this button on the screen (or press on the 10-key pad) to open the next screen so you can select the 2nd language. Touch this key on the screen (or press on the 10-key pad) to quit the update procedure and return to normal screen.
Touch "LANG 1(1)" to select the 1st Language. Touch "LANG (2)" to select the 2nd Language.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installing Another Language
8.
Touch the appropriate button on the screen (or press the number on the 10-keypad) to select a language as the 1st (or 2nd) language.
9.
If a language is already selected, it will show in reverse.
Touching "Exit (0)" returns you to the previous screen.
If you do not see the language that you want to select, touch "↑(7)" or "↓(9)" on the screen (or press or ) to show more choices. The Download Screen opens after you select a language.
The following show to right of the selection:
1. The first column shows the language currently selected.
2. The 2nd column shows the language selected to replace that language.
The example below shows that the download will replace "Japanese" with "Italian" as the 1st language.
10. Touch "Update(#)" on the screen (or press) to start the download. Another screen with a progress bar does not show when the language is downloading.
SM
5-17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
System Maintenance Reference
The 1st or 2nd language selected for updating shows.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Installing Another Language The following occur at the time the language is downloading:
The operation panel switches off.
The LED on the power on key flashes rapidly.
11. After the message of installation completed has shown on the LCD, switch the copier main power switch off. Then remove the SD card from the slot. 12. Switch the copier main power switch on to resume normal operation.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Reboot/System Setting Reset
5.4 REBOOT/SYSTEM SETTING RESET 5.4.1 SOFTWARE RESET You can reboot the software with one of the following two procedures: 1.
Turn the main power switch off and on.
2.
Press and hold down together for over 10 seconds. When the machine beeps once, release both buttons. After “Now loading. Please wait” shows for a few seconds, the copy window will open. The machine is ready for normal operation.
5.4.2 SYSTEM SETTINGS AND COPY SETTING RESET System Setting Reset The system settings in the UP mode can be reset to their defaults. Use the following procedure. 1.
Press User Tools/Counter .
2.
Hold down and then press System Settings. You must press first. System Maintenance Reference
3.
Press yes when the message prompts you to confirm that you want to reset the system settings.
4.
Press exit when the message tells you that the settings have been reset.
Copier Setting Reset Use the following procedure to reset the copy settings in the UP mode to their defaults. 1.
Press User Tools/Counter .
2.
Hold down and then press Copier/Document Server Settings.
SM
You must press first.
5-19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Reboot/System Setting Reset
3.
Press “Yes” when the message prompts you to confirm that you want to reset the Copier Document Server settings.
4.
Press exit when the message tells you that the settings have been reset.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Controller Self-Diagnostics
5.5 CONTROLLER SELF-DIAGNOSTICS 5.5.1 OVERVIEW There are three types of self-diagnostics for the controller. 1.
Power-on self-diagnostics: The machine automatically starts the self-diagnostics just after the power has been turned on.
2.
SC detection: The machine automatically detects SC conditions at power-on or during operation.
System Maintenance Reference
The following shows the workflow of the power-on and detailed self-diagnostics.
SM
5-21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SD Card Appli Move
5.6 SD CARD APPLI MOVE 5.6.1 OVERVIEW The service program “SD Card Appli Move” (SP5-873) lets you to copy application programs from one SD card to another SD card. Slot 1 and Slot 2 are used to store application programs. However, more than two optional applications are supplied for this machine. In that case, you can move application programs from Slot 2 to Slot 1 with the following procedure. Consider the following limitations when you try to merge SD cards.
PostScript3 cannot be moved to the other SD card.
The destination SD card should have the largest memory size of all the application SD cards. Refer to the following table for the memory size of each SD card.
Outline of SD Card Appli Move: 1.
Choose a SD card with enough space.
Do not use an SD card if it has been used on a computer. Normal operation is not guaranteed when such an SD card is used.
2.
Enter SP5873 “SD Card Appli Move”. Then move the application from the SD Card in Slot 2 to the card in slot 1.
3.
Exit the SP mode Use caution when you do the SD Card Appli Move procedure:
The data necessary for authentication is transferred with the application program from an SD card to another SD card. Authentication fails if you try to use the SD card after you copy the application program from one card to another card.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SD Card Appli Move 4.
Remove the inner cover ( Section: Inner Cover in the Replacement and Adjustment).
5.
Keep the SD card in the place [A] inside the inner cover after you have copied the application program from one card to another card. This is done for the following reasons:
1) The SD card can be the only proof that the user is licensed to use the application program.
2) You may need to check the SD card and its data to solve a problem in the future.
5.6.2 MOVE EXEC The menu “Move Exec” (SP5-873-001) lets you copy application programs from the original SD card to another SD card.
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of an application SD card on the machine. If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware upgrade or application merge.
1.
Turn the main switch off.
2.
Make sure that an SD card is in SD Card Slot 1. The application program is copied into
3.
Insert the SD card (having stored the application program) to SD Card Slot 2. The application program is copied from this SD card.
4.
Turn the main switch on.
5.
Start the SP mode.
6.
Select SP5-873-001 “Move Exec.”
7.
Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
8.
Turn the main switch off.
9.
Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2.
10. Turn the main switch on. 11. Check that the application programs run normally.
5.6.3 UNDO EXEC The menu “Undo Exec” (SP5-873-002) lets you copy back application programs from an SD card to the original SD card. You can use this program when, for example, you have mistakenly copied some programs by using Move Exec (SP5-873-001).
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of an application SD card on the machine. If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs
SM
5-23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
System Maintenance Reference
this SD card.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SD Card Appli Move during a firmware upgrade or application merge. 1.
Turn the main switch off.
2.
Insert the original SD card in SD Card Slot 2. The application program is copied back into this card.
3.
Insert the SD card (having stored the application program) to SD Card Slot 1. The application program is copied back from this SD card.
4.
Turn the main switch on.
5.
Start the SP mode.
6.
Select SP5-873-002 “Undo Exec.”
7.
Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
8.
Turn the main switch off.
9.
Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2.
This step assumes that the application programs in the SD card are used by the machine.
10. Turn the main switch on. 11. Check that the application programs run normally.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Downloading Stamp Data
5.7 DOWNLOADING STAMP DATA The stamp data should be downloaded from the controller firmware to the hard disks at the following times:
After the hard disks have been replaced.
The print data contains the controller software. Execute SP 5853 to download the fixed stamp data required by the hard disks. 1.
Enter the SP mode.
2.
Select SP5853 and then press “EXECUTE”. The following screen opens while the
The download is finished when the message prompts you to close.
3.
SM
Press the “Exit” button. Then turn the copier off and on again.
5-25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
System Maintenance Reference
stamp data is downloading.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
NVRAM Data Upload/Download
5.8 NVRAM DATA UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD 5.8.1 UPLOADING CONTENT OF NVRAM TO AN SD CARD Do the following procedure to upload SP code settings from NVRAM to an SD card.
This data should always be uploaded to an SD card before the NVRAM is replaced.
1.
Make sure that the write protection of an SD card is unlocked
Do SP5990-001 (SMC Print) before you switch the machine off. You will need a record of the NVRAM settings if the upload fails.
2.
Switch the copier main power switch off.
3.
Remove the SD slot cover ( x 1).
4.
Insert the SD card into SD card slot 2. Then switch the copier on.
5.
Execute SP5824-001 (NVRAM Data Upload) and then press the “Execute” key.
6.
The following files are coped to an NVRAM folder on the SD card when the upload procedure is finished. The file is saved to the path and the following filename: NVRAM¥<serial number>.NV Here is an example with Serial Number “K5000017114”: NVRAM¥K5000017114.NV
7.
In order to prevent an error during the download, be sure to mark the SD card that holds the uploaded data with the number of the machine from which the data was uploaded.
You can upload NVRAM data from more than one machine to the same SD card.
5.8.2 DOWNLOADING AN SD CARD TO NVRAM Do the following procedure to download SP data from an SD card to the NVRAM in the machine.
The NVRAM data download may fail if the SD card with the NVRAM data is damaged, or if the connection between the controller and BCU is defective.
Do the download procedure again if the download fails.
Do the following procedure if the second attempt fails:
Enter the NVRAM data manually using the SMC print you created before uploading the NVRAM data.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-26 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
NVRAM Data Upload/Download 1.
Switch the copier main power switch off.
2.
Remove the SD slot cover ( x 1).
3.
Insert the SD card with the NVRAM data into SD Card Slot 2.
4.
Switch the copier main power switch on.
5.
Do SP5825-001 (NVRAM Data Download) and press the “Execute” key.
The serial number of the file on the SD card must match the serial number of the machine for the NVRAM data to download successfully. The download fails if the serial numbers do not match.
This procedure does not download the following data to the NVRAM: Total Count
C/O, P/O Count
System Maintenance Reference
SM
5-27 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Address Book Upload/Download
5.9 ADDRESS BOOK UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD 5.9.1 INFORMATION LIST The following information is possible to be uploaded and downloaded.
Information
Registration No.
User Code
E-mail
Protection Code
Fax Destination
Fax Option
Group Name
Key Display
Select Title
Folder
Local Authentication
Folder Authentication
Account ACL
New Document Initial ACL
LDAP Authentication
5.9.2 DOWNLOAD 1.
Prepare a formatted SD card.
2.
Make sure that the write-protection on the SD card is off.
3.
Turn off the main power switch of the main machine.
4.
Remove the SD slot cover at the left rear side of the machine ( x 1).
5.
Install the SD card into the SD card slot 2 (for service use).
6.
Turn on the main power switch.
7.
Enter the SP mode.
8.
Do SP5-846-051 (Backup All Addr Book).
9.
Exit the SP mode, and then turn off the main power switch.
10. Remove the SD card form the SD card slot 2. 11. Install the SD slot cover.
If the capacity of SD card is not enough to store the local user information, an error message is displayed.
Carefully handle the SD card, which contains user information. Do not take it back to your location.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-28 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Address Book Upload/Download
5.9.3 UPLOAD 1.
Turn off the main power switch of the main machine.
2.
Remove the SD slot cover at the left rear side of the machine ( x 1).
3.
Install the SD card, which has already been uploaded, into the SD card slot 2.
4.
Turn on the main power switch.
5.
Enter the SP mode.
6.
Do SP5-846-052 (Restore All Addr Book).
7.
Exit the SP mode, and then turn off the main power switch.
8.
Remove the SD card form the SD card slot 2.
9.
Install the SD slot cover.
The counter in the user code information is initialized after uploading.
The information of an administrator and supervisor cannot be downloaded nor uploaded.
If there is no data of address book information in the SD card, an error message is
System Maintenance Reference
displayed.
SM
5-29 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Using the Debug Log
5.10 USING THE DEBUG LOG 5.10.1 OVERVIEW This machine provides a Save Debug Log feature that allows the Customer Engineer to save and retrieve error information for analysis. Every time an error occurs, debug information is recorded in volatile memory. But this information is lost when the machine is switched off and on. To capture this debug information, the Save Debug Log feature provides two main features:
Switching on the debug feature so error information is saved directly to the HDD for later retrieval.
Copying the error information from the HDD to an SD card.
Do the following procedure below to set up the machine so the error information is saved automatically to the HDD when a user has problems with the machine. Then ask the user to reproduce the problem.
5.10.2 SWITCHING ON AND SETTING UP SAVE DEBUG LOG The debug information cannot be saved until the “Save Debug Log” function has been switched on and a target has been selected. 1.
Enter the SP mode and switch the Save Debug Log feature on.
Enter “System SP”.
On the LCD panel, open SP5857.
2.
Under “5857 Save Debug Log”, touch “1 On/Off”.
3.
On the control panel keypad, press “1”. Then press . This switches the Save Debug Log feature on.
The default setting is “0” (OFF). This feature must be switched on in order for the debug information to be saved.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-30 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Using the Debug Log
4.
Select the target destination where the debug information will be saved. Under “5857 Save Debug Log”, touch “2 Target”, enter “2” with the operation panel key to select the hard disk as the target destination. Then press .
Select “3 SD Card” to save the debug information directly to the SD card if it is inserted in the service slot.
5.
Now touch “5858” and specify the events that you want to record in the debug log. SP5858 (Debug Save When) provides the following items for selection.
Engine SC Error
2
Controller SC Error
3
Any SC Error
4
Jam
Saves data when an engine-related SC code is generated. Saves debug data when a controller-related SC Code is generated. Saves data only for the SC code that you specify by entering code number. Saves data for jams.
More than one event can be selected.
Example 1: To Select Items 1, 2, 4 Touch the appropriate items(s). Press “ON” for each selection. This example shows “Engine SC Error” selected.
SM
5-31 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
System Maintenance Reference
1
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Using the Debug Log
Example 2: To Specify an SC Code Touch “3 Any SC Error”, enter the 3-digit SC code number with the control panel number keys. Then press . This example shows an entry for SC670.
For details about SC code numbers, please refer to the SC tables in Section 4. “Troubleshooting”.
6.
Select one or more memory modules for reading and recording debug information. Touch “5859”. Under “5859” press the necessary key item for the module that you want to record. Enter the appropriate 4-digit number. Then press .
Refer to the two tables below for the 4-digit numbers to enter for each key.
The example below shows “Key 1” with “2222” entered.
The following keys can be set with the corresponding numbers. (The initials in parentheses indicate the names of the modules.)
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-32 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Using the Debug Log 4-Digit Entries for Keys 1 to 10
Copy
Printer
Scanner
1
2222 (SCS)
2
14000 (SRM)
3
256 (IMH)
4
1000 (ECS)
5
1025 (MCS)
Web
6
4848 (COPY)
4400 (GPS)
5375 (Scan)
5682 (NFA)
7
2224 (BCU)
4500 (PDL)
5682 (NFA)
6600 (WebDB)
3000 (UCS)
3300 (PTS)
4600
8
(GPS-PM)
9
2000 (NCS)
2000 (NCS)
6666 (WebSys)
10
2224 (BCU)
4126 (DCS)
2000 (NCS)
The default settings for Keys 1 to 10 are all zero (“0”).
Key to Acronyms
Acronym
Meaning
Acronym
Meaning
ECS
Engine Control Service
NFA
Net File Application
GPS
GW Print Service
PDL
Printer Design Language
PTS
Print Server
System Control Service
GSP-PM
GW Print Service – Print Module
IMH
Image Memory Handler
SCS
MCS
Memory Control Service
SRM
SM
5-33 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Resource Management
D037/D038/D040/D041
System Maintenance Reference
Key No.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Using the Debug Log NCS
1.
Network Control Service
WebDB
Web Document Box (Document Server)
The machine is now set to record the debugging information automatically on the HDD (the target selected with SP5857-002) for the events that you selected with SP5858 and the memory modules selected with SP5859.
Please keep the following important points in mind when you do this setting:
Note that the number entries for Keys 1 to 5 are the same for the Copy, Printer, Scanner, and Web memory modules.
The initial settings are all zero.
These settings remain in effect until you change them. Be sure to check all the settings, especially the settings for Keys 6 to 10. To switch off a key setting, enter a zero for that key.
You can select any number of keys from 1 to 10 (or all) by entering the corresponding 4-digit numbers from the table.
You cannot mix settings for the groups (COPY, PRINTER, etc.) for 006 to 010. For example, if you want to create a PRINTER debug log you must select the settings from the 9 available selections for the “PRINTER” column only.
One area of the disk is reserved to store the debug log. The size of this area is limited to 4 MB.
5.10.3 RETRIEVING THE DEBUG LOG FROM THE HDD Retrieve the debug log by copying it from the hard disk to an SD card. 1.
Insert the SD card into slot 2 (service slot) of the copier.
2.
Enter the SP mode and execute SP5857-009 (Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB)) to write the debugging data to the SD card.
3.
Use a card reader to copy the file and send it for analysis to your local Ricoh representative by email. You can also send the SD card by regular mail if you want.
5.10.4 RECORDING ERRORS MANUALLY SC errors and jams only are recorded to the debug log automatically. Please instruct the user to do the following immediately after occurrence to save the debug data for any other errors that occur while the customer engineer is not on site. Such problems also include a controller or panel freeze.
You must previously switch on the Save Debug Feature (SP5857-001) and select
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-34 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Using the Debug Log the hard disk as the save destination (SP5857-002) if you want to use this feature. 1.
Press S (Clear Modes).on the operation panel when the error occurs.
2.
On the control panel, enter “01”. Then hold down D for at least 3 seconds until the machine beeps and then release it. This saves the debug log to the hard disk for later retrieval with an SD card by the service representatives.
3.
Switch the machine off and on to resume operation. The debug information for the error is saved on the hard disk. This lets the service
System Maintenance Reference
representative retrieve it on their next visit by copying it from the HDD to an SD card.
SM
5-35 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Card Save Function
5.11 CARD SAVE FUNCTION 5.11.1 OVERVIEW Card Save:
The Card Save function is used to save print jobs received by the printer on an SD card with no print output. Card Save mode is toggled using printer Bit Switch #1 bit number 4. Card Save will remain enabled until the SD card becomes full, or until all file names have been used.
Captures are stored on the SD card in the folder /prt/cardsave. File names are assigned sequentially from PRT00000.prn to PRT99999.prn. An additional file PRT.CTL will be created. This file contains a list of all files created on the card by the card save function.
Previously stored files on the SD card can be overwritten or left intact. Card Save SD has “Add” and “New” menu items.
Card Save (Add): Appends files to the SD Card. Does not overwrite existing files. If the card becomes full or if all file names are used, an error will be displayed on the operation panel. Subsequent jobs will not be stored.
Card Save (New): Overwrites files in the card's /prt/cardsave directory.
Limitation:
Card Save cannot be used with PJL Status Readback commands. PJL Status Readbacks will not work. In addition they will cause the Card Save to fail.
5.11.2 PROCEDURE For D038/D041 1.
Turn the main power switch OFF.
2.
Insert the SD card into slot 2. Then turn the power ON.
3.
Enter SP mode.
4.
Select the “Printer Sp”.
5.
Select SP-1001 "Bit Switch”.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-36 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Card Save Function
6.
Select “Bit Switch 1 Settings” and use the numeric keypad to turn bit 4 ON and then press the “#” button to register the change. The result should look like: 00010000. By
System Maintenance Reference
doing this, Card Save option will appear in the “List/Test Print” menu.
7.
Press “Exit” to exit SP Mode.
8.
Press the “User Tools/Counter” button.
9.
Select “Printer Features”.
10. Card Save (Add) and Card Save (New) should be displayed on the screen. Select Card Save (Add) or Card Save (New).
SM
5-37 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Card Save Function
11. Press “OK” and then exit the “User Tools/Counter” menu.
12. Press the “Printer” button. 13. Card Save should be displayed in the top left of the display panel.
14. Send a job to the printer. The Communicating light should start blinking as shown below.
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-38 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Card Save Function
15. As soon as the printer receives the data, it will be stored on the SD card automatically with no print output. Nothing is displayed on the screen, indicating that a Card Save operation was successful.
System Maintenance Reference
16. Press “Offline” and then the “Clear/Stop” button to exit Card Save mode.
17. Change the Bit Switch Settings back to the default 00000000. Press the “#” button in the numeric keypad to register the changes. 18. Remove the SD card after the main power switch is turned off.
For D037/D040 1.
SM
Turn the main power switch OFF.
5-39 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Card Save Function 2.
Insert the SD card into the service slot of the controller board. Then turn the power ON.
To determine which slot is the service slot, please see the service manual.
3.
Enter SP mode.
4.
Select “Printer SP”.
5.
Select “Service Mode” and press “OK” button.
6.
Select “1.001 Bit Switch”and press “OK” button.
7.
Use the arrow key to turn “Bit Switch 4” and use the numeric key “4” to turn bit 4 ON. The result should look like: 00010000. By doing this Card Save option will appear in “List/Test Print”.
8.
Press the “Escape” button several times to exit SP Mode.
9.
Press the “User Tools/Counter” button.
10. Use the arrow key and select “Printer Features”.
11. Use the arrow key and select “List/Test Print”.
12. Use the arrow key and select “Cardsave (ADD) or Cardsave (New).
13. To enable the newly configured settings, select “switch” button and then press the
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-40 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Card Save Function “Escape” button to exit the “List/Test Print” menu. 14. Send a job to the printer. 15. As soon as the printer receives the data, it will be stored on the SD card automatically with no print output. Nothing is displayed on the screen indicating that a Card Save operation was successful. 16. Press the “Online” button and then the “Escape” button to exit Card Save mode. 17. Change the Bit Switch Settings back to the default 00000000. 18. Remove the SD card after main power switch is turned off.
Error Messages Card Save error messages:
Init error: A card save process (i.e. card detection, change to kernel mode) failed to initialize.
Card not found: Card cannot be detected in the slot.
No memory: Insufficient working memory to process the job.
Write error: Failed to write to the card.
Other error: An unknown error occurred.
If an error occurs, pressing “OK” will cause the device to discard the job and return to the
5.11.3 ERROR MESSAGES Card Save error messages:
Init error: A card save process (e.g. card detection, change to kernel mode) failed to initialize.
Card not found: Card cannot be detected in the slot.
No memory: Insufficient working memory to process the job.
Write error: Failed to write to the card.
Other error: An unknown error occurred.
If an error occurs, pressing “OK” will cause the device to discard the job and return to the ready state.
SM
5-41 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
System Maintenance Reference
ready state.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
TROUBLESHOOTING
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service Call Conditions
6. TROUBLESHOOTING 6.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS
Troubleshooting
For "SC Table" information, see "Appendices".
SM
6-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Process Control Error Conditions
6.2 PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS See "Appendices" for the following information:
Developer Initialization Result
Process Control Self-Check Result
Line Position Adjustment Result
D037/D038/D040/D041
6-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide
6.3 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE See "Appendices" for the following information:
Image Quality
Line Position Adjustment
Image Problems at Periodical Intervals
6.3.1 SUB-SCAN MAGNIFICATION ERROR If a sub-scan magnification error of an image occurs on an output, follow the procedure below to adjust the sub-scan magnification.
Sub-scan Magnification Adjustment Procedure 1.
Adjust the sub-scan magnification for each paper type and print mode with the following SPs.
Input the same value in these SP settings. Otherwise, color registration errors
SP1-803-001: Plain paper/ 600 dpi Input
SP1-803-002: Plain paper/ 1200 dpi Input
SP1-803-003: Thick paper Input
2.
Turn the main power of the machine off and on.
3.
Check if all settings of the following SPs are "0" (success).
SP1-803-004: Plain paper/ 600 dpi Result
SP1-803-005: Plain paper/ 1200 dpi Result
SP1-803-006: Thick paper Result
If one of the settings of SP1-803-004 to 006 is "1" (error), return to step 1 and then input a value which is closer to "0" compared with the previously input value.
For example, if "+0.9" is input in the settings of SP1-803-001 to 003 and an error occurs, input "+0.8" or less with SP1-803-001 to 003.
For example, if "-0.9" is input in the settings of SP1-803-001 to 003 and an error occurs, input "-0.8" or more with SP1-803-001 to 003.
If an error still remains, refer to "Motor Speed Adjustment".
4.
Execute the line position adjustment (rough) with SP2-111-003.
5.
Execute the line position adjustment (fine) with SP2-111-001.
SM
6-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Troubleshooting
occur on outputs and this cannot be recovered by the line position adjustment.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide 6.
Make sample copies and check if outputs are satisfactory.
Motor Speed Adjustment If "Sub-scan Magnification Adjustment Procedure" does not solve the sub-scan magnification error, the setting of the motor speed adjustment may be out of adjustable range. Check the following three points. 1.
An error ("1") occurs in the SP1-803-004. [Setting values of the following SPs + input value with SP1-803-001] > motor speed adjustable range e.g.) 3.5 (SP1-801-002) + 1 (SP1-803-001 to -003) = 4.5 In this case, "4.5" is over the maximum adjustable value ("4") of the SP1-801-002. As a result, the result of the motor speed adjustment issues "1" (error).
Adjust the settings of the SP1-830-001 to -003 so that the total value (motor speed setting value + input value) is within the adjustable range for each motor described below.
SP No.
Max.
Min.
SP1-801-002
4
-4
Regist Mot:120 (0.3 default)
SP1-801-003
4
-4
Bk OpcDevMot:120 (-0.4 default)
SP1-801-007
6
-6
Fusing Mot:120 (-0.4 default)
SP1-801-009
4
-4
Transfer Mot:120 (0 default)
SP1-801-012
2
-2
Feed1:CW120 (0.3 default)
SP1-801-014
2
-2
Feed1:CCW120 (0.3 default)
SP1-801-016
2
-2
Feed2:CW120 (0.3 default)
SP1-801-018
2
-2
Feed2:CCW120 (0.3 default)
SP1-801-020
2
-2
By-pass:120 (0.3 default)
SP1-801-022
2
-2
Inverter:CW120 (0 default)
SP1-801-024
2
-2
Inverter:CCW120 (0 default)
SP1-801-026
2
-2
Duplex Entrance:120 (0.3 default)
D037/D038/D040/D041
Title
6-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide SP No. SP1-801-028
2.
Max.
Min.
2
-2
Title Duplex Exit:120 (0.3 default)
An error ("1") occurs in the SP1-803-005. [Setting values of the following SPs + input value with SP1-803-001] > motor speed adjustable range e.g.) 1.5 (SP1-801-025) + 1 (SP1-803-001 to -003) = 2.5 In this case, "2.5" is over the maximum adjustable value ("2") of the SP1-801-025. As a result, the result of the motor speed adjustment issues "1" (error).
Adjust the settings of the SP1-830-001 to -003 so that the total value (motor speed setting value + input value) is within the adjustable range for each motor described below.
SM
Max.
Min.
Title
SP1-801-025
2
-2
Duplex Entrance:60
SP1-801-027
2
-2
Duplex Exit:60
SP1-801-033
4
-4
Regist Mot:60:1200dpi
SP1-801-034
2
-2
Feed1:CW60:1200dpi
SP1-801-035
2
-2
Feed1:CCW60:1200dpi
SP1-801-036
2
-2
Feed2:CW60:1200dpi
SP1-801-037
2
-2
Feed2:CCW60:1200dpi
SP1-801-038
2
-2
By-pass:60:1200dpi
SP1-801-039
2
-2
Inverter:CW60:1200dpi
SP1-801-040
2
-2
Inverter:CCW60:1200dpi
SP1-801-041
6
-6
FusingMot:60:1200dpi
SP1-801-042
4
-4
BkOpcDevMot:60:1200dpi
SP1-801-043
4
-4
TransferMot:60:1200dpi
6-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting
SP No.
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide 3.
An error ("1") occurs in the SP1-803-006. [Setting values of the following SPs + input value with SP1-803-001] > motor speed adjustable range e.g.) 3.5 (SP1-801-001) + 1 (SP1-803-001 to -003) = 4.5 In this case, "4.5" is over the maximum adjustable value ("4") of the SP1-801-025. As a result, the result of the motor speed adjustment issues "1" (error).
Adjust the settings of the SP1-830-001 to -003 so that the total value (motor speed setting value + input value) is within the adjustable range for each motor described below.
SP No.
Max.
Min.
Title
SP1-801-001
4
-4
Regist Mot:60:Thick
SP1-801-004
4
-4
Bk OpcDevMot:60:Thick
SP1-801-008
6
-6
Fusing Mot:60:Thick
SP1-801-010
4
-4
TransferMot:60:Thick
SP1-801-011
2
-2
Feed1:CW60:Thick
SP1-801-013
2
-2
Feed1:CCW60:Thick
SP1-801-015
2
-2
Feed2:CW60:Thick
SP1-801-017
2
-2
Feed2:CCW60:Thick
SP1-801-019
2
-2
By-pass:60:Thick
SP1-801-021
2
-2
Inverter:CW60:Thick
SP1-801-023
2
-2
Inverter:CCW60:Thick
6.3.2 TRAPEZOID IMAGE ADJUSTMENT Before Adjusting the Trapezoid Image 1.
Enter SP2-109 and print out the test pattern 14 (Trimming Area).
D037/D038/D040/D041
6-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide
2.
Make sure the horizontal lines are parallel. “Parallel”: The gap between horizontal lines is 1.8 mm or less.
3.
If the lines are not parallel, check the following and apply corrections as necessary:
Make sure that the side fences of the tray are set neatly against the sides of the paper.
Make sure that the PTR unit is connected to the bracket correctly.
Make sure that the shafts of the duplex unit are not bent nor damaged.
Adjusting the Trapezoid Image
SM
Remove the following items:
Fusing unit ( Section: Fusing Unit)
Front right cover ( Section: Front Right Cover)
PCDU toner collection bottle ( Section: PCDU Toner Collection Bottle)
Inner cover ( Section: Inner Cover)
Inner right cover ( Section: Inner Right Cover)
6-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Troubleshooting
1.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide
2.
Remove the interlock switch bracket [A] ( x 3, = x 1, x 2).
3.
Loosen the four screws [A] on the front fusing guide.
4.
Remove the screw [B] on the adjustor lever.
5.
This screw is not necessary after tightening the front fusing guide.
If the horizontal lines slope down to the left [A], move the front fusing guide upward. To
D037/D038/D040/D041
6-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide do this, turn the adjustor lever [B] of the fusing front guide clockwise [C].
6.
One step of the adjustor lever moves the front fusing guide by 1 mm.
If the horizontal lines slope down to the right [A], move the fusing front guide downward. To do this, turn the adjustor lever [B] of the front fusing guide counterclockwise [C].
One step of the adjustor lever moves the front fusing guide by 1 mm.
Retighten the four screws for the front fusing guide.
8.
Print out the test pattern and check the image quality.
9.
If the symptom still occurs, repeat the above steps.
Troubleshooting
7.
SM
6-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Jam Detection
6.4 JAM DETECTION See "Appendices" for the following information:
Paper Jam Display
Jam Codes and Display Codes (Paper Size Code) (Sensor Locations)
D037/D038/D040/D041
6-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Component Defects
6.5 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS See "Appendices" for the following information:
Sensors
Blown Fuse Conditions
Troubleshooting
(Power Supply Unit)
SM
6-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Test Mode
6.6 SCANNER TEST MODE 6.6.1 SBU TEST MODE Output the SBU test pattern with SP4-807-001 to make sure the scanner SBU control operates correctly. The SBU test pattern prints out after you have set the SP mode settings and pressed the start key.
The CCD on the SBU board may be defective if the copy is abnormal and the SBU test pattern is normal.
The followings can be the cause if the copy is normal and the SBU test pattern is abnormal:
The harness may not be correctly connected between the SBU and the i-controller.
The i-controller or SBU board may be defective.
6.6.2 IPU TEST MODE You can check the BICU board with the SP mode menu, SP4-904-1. If no error is detected, the test ends. Then the completion code shows in the operation panel display. If an error is detected, the test is interrupted. Then an error code shows. The table below lists the completion and error codes.
SP4-904-1 Register Access There are 16 bits switches in this SP. Each bit indicates a different CPU. The error result is displayed on the operation panel as a decimal number. 0: Normal, 1: Error
SP4-904-2 Image Path There are 16 bits switches in this SP. Each bit indicates a different CPU path. The error result is displayed on the operation panel as a decimal number. 0: Normal, 1: Error Errors may be caused by the following problems: 1.
2.
Short circuit on the signal lines
When the i-controller board is installed, a pin or two on the ASIC is damaged.
Some conductive matter or object is trapped among the pins.
Condensation
Destruction of circuit elements
Over current or a defective element breaks the circuit.
D037/D038/D040/D041
6-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner Test Mode 3.
Abnormal power supply •The required voltage is not supplied to the devices.
4.
Overheat/overcooling
5.
Static electricity
6.
The environment is inappropriate for the board (the scanner unit).
Static electricity of a high voltage occurs during the test.
Others
The scanner and i-controller are incorrectly connected.
When you have completed a check, turn the main switch off and on before you do another check. When you have completed all necessary checks, turn the main switch off and
Troubleshooting
on.Error! No index entries found.
SM
6-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041 SERVICE MANUAL APPENDICES
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041 APPENDICES TABLE OF CONTENTS APPENDIX: SPECIFICATIONS 1. APPENDIX: SPECIFICATIONS ................................................... 1-1 1.1 COPIER ..................................................................................................... 1-1 1.2 PRINTER ................................................................................................... 1-5 1.3 SCANNER ................................................................................................. 1-7 1.4 SUPPORTED PAPER SIZES .................................................................... 1-8 1.4.1 PAPER FEED ................................................................................... 1-8 North America ...................................................................................... 1-8 Europe/ Asia....................................................................................... 1-10 1.4.2 PAPER EXIT................................................................................... 1-12 Mainframe and optional trays ............................................................. 1-12 Internal Finisher.................................................................................. 1-14 1.4.3 PLATEN/ARDF ORIGINAL SIZE DETECTION............................... 1-16 1.5 SOFTWARE ACCESSORIES .................................................................. 1-18 1.5.1 PRINTER DRIVERS ....................................................................... 1-18 1.5.2 SCANNER AND LAN FAX DRIVERS ............................................. 1-18 1.5.3 UTILITY SOFTWARE ..................................................................... 1-19 1.6 OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT......................................................................... 1-21 1.6.1 ARDF (D366: STANDARD FOR H-MODELS (D038/D041))........... 1-21 1.6.2 PAPER FEED UNIT (D425) ............................................................ 1-21 1.6.3 PAPER FEED UNIT (D331) ............................................................ 1-22 1.6.4 INTERNAL FINISHER & PUNCH UNIT (D429) .............................. 1-23 1.6.5 SHIFT TRAY (D428) ....................................................................... 1-24 1.6.6 1-BIN TRAY UNIT (D426) ............................................................... 1-24 1.6.7 SIDE TRAY (D427) ......................................................................... 1-25
APPENDIX: OVERVIEW 2. APPENDIX: OVERVIEW.............................................................. 2-1 2.1 OVERVIEW................................................................................................ 2-1 SM Appendix
i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ........................................... 2-1 2.1.2 PAPER PATH ................................................................................... 2-2 With options.......................................................................................... 2-2 Without options..................................................................................... 2-3 2.1.3 DRIVE LAYOUT................................................................................ 2-4
APPENDIX: PM TABLES 3. APPENDIX: PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE TABLES ............... 3-1 3.1 MAINTENANCE TABLES .......................................................................... 3-1 3.1.1 PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE ITEMS ............................................ 3-1 Mainframe ............................................................................................ 3-1 ARDF (D366)........................................................................................ 3-3 One-tray Paper Feed Unit (D425) ........................................................ 3-4 Two-tray Paper Feed Unit (D331) ........................................................ 3-4 1 Bin Tray (D426) ................................................................................. 3-4 Shift Tray (D427) .................................................................................. 3-5 3.1.2 OTHERS YIELD PARTS................................................................... 3-5 ARDF ................................................................................................... 3-5
APPENDIX: SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS 4. APPENDIX: SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS ............................... 4-1 4.1 SC TABLES ............................................................................................... 4-1 4.1.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS......................................................... 4-1 Summary .............................................................................................. 4-1 SC Code Classification......................................................................... 4-2 4.1.2 SC1XX: SCANNING ......................................................................... 4-4 4.1.3 SC 2XX: EXPOSURE ....................................................................... 4-8 4.1.4 SC3XX: IMAGE PROCESSING – 1................................................ 4-13 4.1.5 SC4XX: IMAGE PROCESSING – 2................................................ 4-18 4.1.6 SC5XX: PAPER FEED AND FUSING ............................................ 4-21 4.1.7 SC6XX: DEVICE COMMUNICATION ............................................. 4-34 4.1.8 SC7XX: PERIPHERALS ................................................................. 4-42 4.1.9 SC8XX: OVERALL SYSTEM .......................................................... 4-48 D037/D038/D040/D041
ii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
4.1.10
SC9XX: MISCELLANEOUS ...................................................... 4-66
APPENDIX: PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS 5. APPENDIX: PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS ....... 5-1 5.1 PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS.......................................... 5-1 5.1.1 DEVELOPER INITIALIZATION RESULT.......................................... 5-1 5.1.2 PROCESS CONTROL SELF-CHECK RESULT ............................... 5-2 Vsg Adjustment Result ......................................................................... 5-4 5.1.3 LINE POSITION ADJUSTMENT RESULT........................................ 5-5
APPENDIX: TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE 6. APPENDIX: TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE ................................ 6-1 6.1 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE................................................................... 6-1 6.1.1 IMAGE QUALITY .............................................................................. 6-1 6.1.2 LINE POSITION ADJUSTMENT....................................................... 6-3 Test ...................................................................................................... 6-3 Countermeasure list for color registration errors .................................. 6-3 6.1.3 IMAGE PROBLEMS AT REGULAR INTERVALS............................. 6-9
APPENDIX: JAM DETECTION 7. APPENDIX: JAM DETECTION.................................................... 7-1 7.1 JAM DETECTION ...................................................................................... 7-1 7.1.1 PAPER JAM DISPLAY ..................................................................... 7-1 Paper Size Code .................................................................................. 7-1 7.1.2 JAM CODES AND DISPLAY CODES............................................... 7-2 Mainframe ............................................................................................ 7-2 ARDF (Original Jam) ............................................................................ 7-5 Sensor Locations.................................................................................. 7-7
SM Appendix
iii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
APPENDIX: ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS 8. APPENDIX: ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS ................ 8-1 8.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS ................................................... 8-1 8.1.1 SENSORS ........................................................................................ 8-1 8.1.2 BLOWN FUSE CONDITIONS........................................................... 8-6 Power Supply Unit................................................................................ 8-6
APPENDIX: SP MODE TABLES 9. APPENDIX: SP MODE TABLES ................................................. 9-1 9.1 SYSTEM SERVICE MODE........................................................................ 9-1 9.1.1 SERVICE MODE TABLE .................................................................. 9-1 SP1-XXX (Feed)................................................................................... 9-1 SP2-XXX (Drum) ................................................................................ 9-24 SP3-XXX (Process).......................................................................... 9-112 SP4-XXX (Scanner) ......................................................................... 9-162 SP5-XXX (Mode).............................................................................. 9-187 SP6-XXX (Peripherals)..................................................................... 9-250 SP7-XXX (Data Log) ........................................................................ 9-253 SP8-xxx: Data Log2 ......................................................................... 9-287 9.1.2 INPUT CHECK TABLE ................................................................. 9-336 Copier............................................................................................... 9-337 ARDF (D366).................................................................................... 9-341 Internal Finisher (D429).................................................................... 9-341 Table 1: Paper Size Switch (Tray 1/ 2)............................................. 9-343 Table 2: Paper Size (By-pass Table)................................................ 9-344 Table 3: APS Original Size Detection............................................... 9-344 Table 4: Paper Size Switch (Tray 3/ 4)............................................. 9-345 Table 5: Area Display ....................................................................... 9-346 9.1.3 OUTPUT CHECK TABLE ............................................................. 9-346 Copier............................................................................................... 9-346 Internal Finisher (D429).................................................................... 9-352 ARDF (D366).................................................................................... 9-353 9.1.4 TEST PATTERN PRINTING ......................................................... 9-354 D037/D038/D040/D041
iv CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
9.2 PRINTER SERVICE MODE................................................................... 9-356 9.2.1 SP1-XXX (SERVICE MODE) ........................................................ 9-356 9.3 SCANNER SP MODE ............................................................................ 9-363 9.3.1 SP1-XXX (SYSTEM AND OTHERS) ............................................ 9-363 9.3.2 SP2-XXX (SCANNING-IMAGE QUALITY).................................... 9-364
SM Appendix
v CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
APPENDIX: SPECIFICATIONS
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier
1. APPENDIX: SPECIFICATIONS 1.1 COPIER
Configuration:
Print Process:
Resolution:
Gradation:
Desktop Laser beam scanning & Dry electrostatic transfer system 4 drums tandem method Scan: 600 dpi Print: 600 dpi Scan: 8 bits/pixel each for RGB/ 600 dpi 1 bit/pixel (B/W C1L) Print: 600dpi / 4 bits/pixel
Original type:
Sheets, book, objects
Maximum original size:
A3/11" x 17" ADF 1 to 1, LT/ A4 LEF Thin (60 g/m2 or less) D037/D038: 20 cpm (color/black & white) D040/D041: 25 cpm (color/black & white) Plain 1 (74 g/m2 or less)/ 2 (90 g/m2 or less) D037/D038: 20 cpm (color/black & white) D040/D041: 25 cpm (color/black & white) Middle Thick (105 g/m2 or less)
Copy speed:
D037/D038: 20 cpm (color/black & white) D040/D041: 25 cpm (color/black & white) Thick 1 (169 g/m2 or less) D037/D038: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) D040/D041: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) Thick 2 (220 g/m2 or less) D037/D038: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) D040/D041: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) Thick 3 (256 g/m2 or less) D037/D038: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white)
SM Appendix
1-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Specifications
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier D040/D041: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) OHP, Glossy (1200 dpi) D037/D038: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) D040/D041: 12.5 cpm (color/black & white) First copy (normal
Color: 9.5 seconds or less (A4/LT LEF)
mode):
Black & white: 6.5 seconds or less (A4/LT LEF)
Warm-up time:
Less than 30 seconds (20°C) Standard tray: 250 sheets x 2 + 100
Print Paper Capacity: 2
(80 g/m , 20 lb)
By-pass tray: 100 sheets (Plain), 40 sheets (Thick 1: 106 169g/m2), 20 sheets (Thick 2/3: 170 - 256 g/m2), 35 sheets (Postcard) Optional paper feed tray: 500 sheets x 2 (Refer to “Supported Paper Sizes”.) -
Print Paper Size:
Minimum A5 (LEF)/
Tray 1/ Tray 2
8.5" x 11"
By-pass
90 x 148 mm A5 (LEF)/
Optional Tray
8.5" x 11"
Maximum
A3/11" x 17"
305 x 600 mm
A3/11" x 17"
Standard tray 1: 60 to 256 g/m2 (16 to 68 lb.) Standard tray 2: 60 to 169 g/m2 (16 to 45 lb.) Printing Paper Weight:
Optional paper tray: 60 to 105 g/m2 (16 to 28 lb.) By-pass tray: 52 to 256 g/m2 (14 to 68 lb.) Duplex unit: 60 to 105 g/m2 (16 to 28 lb.) Standard exit tray: 500 sheets or more (face down)*1 Shift tray: 250 sheets (80 g/m2)
Output Paper Capacity:
1-bin tray: 100 (80 g/m2) Side tray: 50 (80 g/m2) Internal finisher 500 (80 g/m2) *1: T6200, A4 LEF
D037/D038/D040/D041
1-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
Copier Continuous copy:
Up to 999 sheets Arbitrary: From 25 to 400% (1% step) H Fixed:
L Fixed:
NA
Europe
NA
Europe
25%
25%
25%
25%
50%
50%
50%
50%
65%
61%
65%
-
73%
71%
-
71%
78%
82%
78%
82%
85%
87%
-
-
93%
93%
93%
93%
100%
100%
100%
100%
121%
115%
121%
-
129%
122%
129%
122%
155%
141%
155%
141%
200%
200%
-
200%
400%
400%
400%
400%
Zoom:
Memory:
Power Source:
H Standard: 768 MB/ Max.:1 GB L Standard: 512 MB 120 V, 60 Hz: 12A or more (for North America) 220 V - 240 V, 50/60 Hz: 8A or more (for Europe/ASIA) -
Power Consumption:
SM Appendix
120V
220 - 240V
Maximum
1440 W or less
1680 W or less
Energy Saver
H: 7.8 W or less
H: 6.4 W or less
1-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Specifications
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Copier L: 6.1 W or less
L: 6.0 W or less
(*1) The complete system consists of mainframe, ARDF, finisher, and LCT. The above measurements were made in accordance with Ricoh standard methodology. Dimensions (W x D x H): Copier: 587 x 655 x 725 mm (23.1" x 25.8" x 28.5") Copier (L) + PFU + Right tray: 854 x 655 x 1117 mm (33.6" x 25.8" x 44.0") Copier (H) + PFU + Right tray + Internal finisher: 1009 x 655 x 1117 mm (39.7" x 25.8" x 44.0")
Weight:
D037/D038/D040/D041
Less than 85 kg (187 lb.) [without ARDF excluding toner] Less than 100 kg (220 lb.) [with ARDF excluding toner]
1-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
Printer
1.2 PRINTER
PCL 5c/6 (standard for H, optional for L) RPCS (Refined Printing Command Stream) Printer Languages:
Adobe PostScript 3 (optional) PDF Direct (optional) PictBridge (optional) PCL 5c/6: 300 x 300 dpi : Available only in B/W mode 600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1 bit), Standard (2 bits)
Resolution and Gradation:
RPCS: 600 x 600 dpi, 1,800 x 600 dpi*, 1200 dpi x 1200 dpi *1,800 x 600 dpi = 600 x 600 dpi (2 bits) PS3: 600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1 bit), Standard (2 bits) 1200 dpi x 1200 dpi D037/D038: 20 ppm in Plain/Middle Thick mode
Printing speed:
12.5 ppm in Thick/OHP mode (depending on paper type) D040/D041: 25 ppm in Plain/Middle Thick mode 12.5 ppm in Thick/OHP mode (depending on paper type) PCL 5c/6 (Standard): H 45 Compatible fonts
Resident Fonts:
13 International fonts Adobe PostScript 3 (Optional): H 136 fonts (24 Type 2 fonts, 112 Type 14 fonts) USB2.0: Standard Ethernet (100 Base-TX/10 Base-T): Standard
Host Interfaces:
Gigabit Ethernet (1000 Base-T): Optional only for H IEEE1284 parallel x 1: Optional only for H IEEE802.11a/g, g (Wireless LAN): Optional only for H
SM Appendix
1-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Specifications
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Printer Bluetooth (Wireless): Optional only for H Network Protocols:
TCP/IP (IPv4, IPv6), IPX/SPX, AppleTalk (Auto Switching)
HDD
60 GB (standard only for H)
D037/D038/D040/D041
1-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
Scanner
1.3 SCANNER
Standard Scanner
Main scan/Sub scan
Resolution:
600 dpi Twain Mode:
Available scanning
100 to1200 dpi
Resolution Range:
Delivery Mode: 100/200/300/400/600 dpi
Grayscales:
1 bit or 8 bits/pixel each for RGB (H model) only
Scanning Throughput (ARDF mode):
Scan to E-mail / Folder: BW: 26 ipm (A4LEF / BW Text (Print) / 200dpi /Compression: On (MH)) FC: 41 ipm (A4LEF / FC Text / Photo / 200dpi / Compression: Standard)
Interface:
Ethernet (100 Base-TX/10 Base-T/1000 Base-T for TCP/IP), Wireless LAN, USB2.0/SD Slot
Compression
B&W: TIFF (MH, MR, MMR)
Method:
Gray Scale, Full Color: JPEG
SM Appendix
1-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Specifications
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Supported Paper Sizes
1.4 SUPPORTED PAPER SIZES 1.4.1 PAPER FEED North America BT: By-pass Tray, T1/2: Tray 1/2 (standard), T3/4: Tray 3/4 (option), DU: Duplex Unit
Paper
Size
BT
T1/2
T3/4
DU
12" x 18"
M
-
-
-
A3 SEF
297 x 420mm
M
S1
S1
M
A4 SEF
210 x 297mm
M
A
A
M
A4 LEF
297 x 210mm
M
S3
S3
M
A5 SEF
148 x 210mm
M
-
M
M
A5 LEF
210 x 148mm
M
A
A
M
A6 SEF
105 x 148mm
M
-
-
-
B4 SEF
257 x 364mm
M
S2
S2
M
B5 SEF
182 x 257mm
M
A
A
M
B5 LEF
257 x 182mm
M
S4
S4
M
B6 SEF
128 x 182mm
M
-
-
-
Ledger
11" x 17"
A
A1
A1
M
Letter SEF
8.5" x 11"
A
A
A
M
Letter LEF
11" x 8.5"
A
A3
A3
M
Legal SEF
8.5" x 14"
M
A2
A2
M
8.25" x 14"
M
M
M
M
A3 W
Government Legal SEF
D037/D038/D040/D041
(W x L)
1-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
Supported Paper Sizes Size
Paper
(W x L)
BT
T1/2
T3/4
DU
Half Letter SEF
5.5" x 8.5"
A
-
-
-
Executive SEF
7.25" x 10.5"
M
M
M
M
Executive LEF
10.5" x 7.25"
M
A4
A4
M
8" x 13"
M
M
M
M
8.5" x 13"
M
M
M
M
8.25" x 13"
M
M
M
M
11" x 15"
M
M
M
M
10" x 14"
M
M
M
M
8" x 10"
M
M
M
M
8K
267 x 390mm
M
M
M
M
16K SEF
195 x 267mm
M
M
M
M
16K LEF
267 x 195mm
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
-
F SEF Foolscap SEF
Folio SEF
Custom Com10 Env.
4.125" x 9.5"
M
-
-
-
Monarch Env.
3.875" x 7.5"
M
-
-
-
C6 Env.
114 x 162mm
M
-
-
-
C5 Env.
162 x 229mm
M
-
-
-
DL Env.
110 x 220mm
M
-
-
-
Remarks:
A
Supported: the sensor detects the paper size.
M
Supported: the user specifies the paper size.
SM Appendix
1-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Specifications
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Supported Paper Sizes Supported: depends on a technician adjustment S
Paper size which has same superscript number can be changeable with SP setting. (eg. Ledger: A1 <=> A3 SEF: S1)
-
Not supported
Europe/ Asia BT: By-pass Tray, T1/2: Tray 1/2 (standard), T3/4: Tray 3/4 (option), DU: Duplex Unit
Paper
Size
BT
T1/2
T3/4
DU
12" x 18"
M
-
-
-
A3 SEF
297 x 420mm
A
A1
S1
M
A4 SEF
210 x 297mm
A
A
A
M
A4 LEF
297 x 210mm
A
A3
A3
M
A5 SEF
148 x 210mm
A
-
A
M
A5 LEF
210 x 148mm
A
A
A
M
A6 SEF
105 x 148mm
M
-
-
-
B4 SEF
257 x 364mm
M
A2
A2
M
B5 SEF
182 x 257mm
M
A
A
M
B5 LEF
257 x 182mm
M
A4
A4
M
B6 SEF
128 x 182mm
M
-
-
-
Ledger
11" x 17"
M
S1
S1
M
Letter SEF
8.5" x 11"
M
A
A
M
Letter LEF
11" x 8.5"
M
S3
S3
M
Legal SEF
8.5" x 14"
M
S2
S2
M
A3 W
D037/D038/D040/D041
(W x L)
1-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
Supported Paper Sizes Paper
Size
BT
T1/2
T3/4
DU
8.25" x 14"
M
M
M
M
Half Letter SEF
5.5" x 8.5"
M
-
-
-
Executive SEF
7.25" x 10.5"
M
M
M
M
Executive LEF
10.5" x 7.25"
M
S4
S4
M
8" x 13"
M
M
M
M
8.5" x 13"
M
M
M
M
8.25" x 13"
M
M
M
M
11" x 15"
M
M
M
M
10" x 14"
M
M
M
M
8" x 10"
M
M
M
M
8K
267 x 390mm
M
M
M
M
16K SEF
195 x 267mm
M
M
M
M
16K LEF
267 x 195mm
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
-
Government Legal SEF
F SEF Foolscap SEF
Folio SEF
(W x L)
Custom Com10 Env.
4.125" x 9.5"
M
-
-
-
Monarch Env.
3.875" x 7.5"
M
-
-
-
C6 Env.
114 x 162mm
M
-
-
-
C5 Env.
162 x 229mm
M
-
-
-
DL Env.
110 x 220mm
M
-
-
-
Remarks:
SM Appendix
1-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Specifications
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Supported Paper Sizes A
Supported: the sensor detects the paper size.
M
Supported: the user specifies the paper size. Supported: depends on a technician adjustment
S
Paper size which has same superscript number can be changeable with SP setting. (eg. Ledger: S1 <=> A3 SEF: A1)
-
Not supported
1.4.2 PAPER EXIT Mainframe and optional trays Main: Mainframe/ 1-bin: 1-bin tray/ Shift: Shift Tray/ Side: Side Tray
Paper
Size (W x L)
Main
1-bin
Shift
Side
A3 W
12" x 18"
Y
-
-
-
A3 SEF
297 x 420 mm
Y
Y
Y
Y
A4 SEF
210 x 297 mm
Y
Y
Y
Y
A4 LEF
297 x 210 mm
Y
Y
Y
Y
A5 SEF
148 x 210 mm
Y
Y
Y
Y
A5 LEF
210 x 148 mm
Y
Y
Y
Y
A6 SEF
105 x 148 mm
Y
-
Y
-
B4 SEF
257 x 364 mm
Y
Y
Y
Y
B5 SEF
182 x 257 mm
Y
Y
Y
Y
B5 LEF
257 x 182 mm
Y
Y
Y
Y
B6 SEF
128 x 182 mm
Y
-
Y
-
Ledger
11" x 17"
Y
Y
Y
Y
Letter SEF
8.5" x 11"
Y
Y
Y
Y
D037/D038/D040/D041
1-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
Supported Paper Sizes Paper
Size (W x L)
Main
1-bin
Shift
Side
Letter LEF
11" x 8.5"
Y
Y
Y
Y
Legal SEF
8.5" x 14"
Y
Y
Y
Y
8.25" x 14"
Y
Y
Y
Y
Half Letter SEF
5.5" x 8.5"
Y
Y
Y
Y
Executive SEF
7.25" x 10.5"
Y
Y
Y
Y
Executive LEF
10.5" x 7.25"
Y
Y
Y
Y
F SEF
8" x 13"
Y
Y
Y
Y
Foolscap SEF
8.5" x 13"
Y
Y
Y
Y
8.25" x 13"
Y
Y
Y
Y
11" x 15"
Y
Y
Y
Y
10" x 14"
Y
Y
Y
Y
8" x 10"
Y
Y
Y
Y
8K
267 x 390 mm
Y
Y
Y
Y
16K SEF
195 x 267 mm
Y
Y
Y
Y
16K LEF
267 x 195 mm
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
-
Y
-
Government Legal SEF
Folio SEF
Custom Com10 Env.
4.125" x 9.5"
Y
-
Y
-
Monarch Env.
3.875" x 7.5"
Y
-
Y
-
C6 Env.
114 x 162 mm
Y
-
Y
-
C5 Env.
162 x 229 mm
Y
-
Y
-
DL Env.
110 x 220 mm
Y
-
Y
-
Remarks: SM Appendix
1-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Specifications
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Supported Paper Sizes
Y
Supported
-
Not supported
Internal Finisher Str: Straight Feed Out/ Inv: Inverter Path/ Srt; Sort/ Stp: Staple/ 2/3P: 2/3 Holes Punch/ 4P: 4 Holes Punch/ S4P: Scandinavia 4 Holes Punch/ RT: Right Tray
Paper
Internal finisher
Size (W x L) Str
Inv
Srt
Stp
2/3P
4P
S4P
A3 W
12" x 18"
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
A3 SEF
297 x 420 mm
Y
Y
10
30
Y
Y
Y
A4 SEF
210 x 297 mm
Y
Y
20
50
Y*
-
Y
A4 LEF
297 x 210 mm
Y
Y
20
50
Y
Y
Y
A5 SEF
148 x 210 mm
Y
Y
-
-
-
-
-
A5 LEF
210 x 148 mm
Y
Y
-
-
-
-
-
A6 SEF
105 x 148 mm
Y
Y
-
-
-
-
-
B4 SEF
257 x 364 mm
Y
Y
10
30
-
-
-
B5 SEF
182 x 257 mm
Y
Y
20
50
-
-
-
B5 LEF
257 x 182 mm
Y
Y
20
50
-
-
-
B6 SEF
128 x 182 mm
Y
Y
-
-
-
-
-
Ledger
11" x 17"
Y
Y
10
30
Y
Y
Y
Letter SEF
8.5" x 11"
Y
Y
20
50
Y*
-
Y
Letter LEF
11" x 8.5"
Y
Y
20
50
Y
Y
Y
Legal SEF
8.5" x 14"
Y
Y
10
30
Y*
-
Y
D037/D038/D040/D041
1-14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
Supported Paper Sizes Paper
Internal finisher
Size (W x L) Str
Inv
Srt
Stp
2/3P
4P
S4P
8.25" x 14"
Y
Y
10
30
-
-
-
Half Letter SEF
5.5" x 8.5"
Y
Y
-
-
-
-
-
Executive SEF
7.25" x 10.5"
Y
Y
20
50
-
-
-
Executive LEF
10.5" x 7.25"
Y
Y
20
50
-
-
-
F SEF
8" x 13"
Y
Y
-
-
-
-
-
Foolscap SEF
8.5" x 13"
Y
Y
10
30
Y*
-
Y
8.25" x 13"
Y
Y
10
30
-
-
-
11" x 15"
Y
Y
10
30
-
-
-
10" x 14"
Y
Y
-
-
-
-
-
8" x 10"
Y
Y
-
-
-
-
-
8K
267 x 390 mm
Y
Y
10
30
-
-
-
16K SEF
195 x 267 mm
Y
Y
-
-
-
-
-
16K LEF
267 x 195 mm
Y
Y
20
50
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Government Legal SEF
Folio SEF
Custom Com10 Env.
4.125" x 9.5"
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Monarch Env.
3.875" x 7.5"
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
C6 Env.
114 x 162 mm
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
C5 Env.
162 x 229 mm
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
DL Env.
110 x 220 mm
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Remarks:
SM Appendix
1-15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Specifications
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Supported Paper Sizes Y
Supported (*1: 2 holes punch only)
30
Output up to 30 sheets
50
Output up to 50 sheets
-
Not supported
1.4.3 PLATEN/ARDF ORIGINAL SIZE DETECTION
Platen
ARDF
Platen
ARDF
Inches
Inches
Metric
Metric
A3 (297 x 420) L
-
Y
Y*3
Y
B4 (257 x 364) L
-
-
Y*3
Y
A4 (210 x 297) L
Y*1
Y
Y*3
Y
A4 (297 x 210) S
Y*3
Y
Y*3
Y
B5 (182 x 257) L
-
-
Y*3
Y
B5 (257 x 182) S
-
-
Y*3
Y
A5 (148 x 210) L
-
-
-*1
Y
A5 (210 x 148) S
-
-
-*1
Y
B6 (128 x 182) L
-
-
-
-
B6 (182 x 128) S
-
-
-
-
11" x 17" (DLT)
Y
Y*2
-
Y*2
11" x 15"
-
Y*2
-
-
10" x 14"
-
Y
-
-
8.5" x 14" (LG)
Y
Y*2
-
-
8.5" x 13" (F4)
-
Y*2
Y*4
Y*4
Size (width x length) [mm]
D037/D038/D040/D041
1-16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
Supported Paper Sizes 8.25" x 13"
-
-
Y*4
Y*4
8" x 13"(F)
-
-
Y*4
Y*4
8.5" x 11" (LT)
Y*3
Y*2
Y*3
Y*2
11" x 8.5" (LT)
Y*3
Y*2
Y*3
Y*2
-
Y*2
-
-
5.5" x 8.5" (HLT)
-*1
Y
-
-
8.5" x 5.5" (HLT)
-*1
Y
-
-
8K (267 x 390)
-
-
Y*3
Y*2
16K L (195 x 267)
-
-
Y*3
Y*2
16K S (267 x 195)
-
-
Y*3
Y*2
-
Y
-
-
-
Y*2
-
-
8" x 10"
7.25" x 10.5" (Executive) 10.5" x 7.25" (Executive)
*1: Use SP4-303 to detect original sizes as A5 lengthwise/HLT when the message “Can-t detect original size” shows. *2: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP6-016-1. *3: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP4-305-1. *4: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP5-126-1.
SM Appendix
1-17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Specifications
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Software Accessories
1.5 SOFTWARE ACCESSORIES The printer drivers and utility software are provided as following two CD-ROMs 1: Printer Drivers and Utilities CD-ROM 2: Scanner/PostScript® Drivers and Utilities CD-ROM. An auto-run installer lets you to select the components you want to install.
1.5.1 PRINTER DRIVERS
Printer Language
Windows 2000, XP, Server 2003, Vista, Server 20038
PCL5c
MacOS8.6 to 9.x, MacOSX10.1 or later
Yes
No
PS3 *2)
Yes
Yes
RPCS
Yes
No
/ PCL6
The PCL5c/6 and RPCS drivers are provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM
The PS drivers are provided on the Scanner/PostScript® Drivers and Utilities CD-ROM.
The printer drivers for Windows NT 4.0 are only for the Intel x86 platform. There is no Windows NT 4.0 printer driver for the PowerPC, Alpha, or MIPS platforms.
The PS3 drivers are all genuine Adobe PS drivers, except for Windows 2000/XP/2003/Vista. Windows 2000 uses Microsoft PS. A PPD file for each operating system is provided with the driver.
The PS3 driver for Macintosh supports Mac OS X 10.1 or later versions.
1.5.2 SCANNER AND LAN FAX DRIVERS
Printer
Windows
Windows
Windows 2000, XP,
Language
95/98/ME
NT4.0
Server 2003/Vista
D037/D038/D040/D041
1-18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
MacOS8.6 to 9.x, MacOSX10.1 or later
SM Appendix
Software Accessories Network TWAIN LAN-FAX
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
The Network TWAIN and LAN Fax drivers are provided on the scanner drivers CD-ROM.
This software lets you fax documents directly form your PC. Address Book Editor and Cover Sheet Editor are to be installed as well. (These require the optional fax unit.)
1.5.3 UTILITY SOFTWARE
Software Font Manager 2000 (Win9x/ME, 2000/XP/2003, NT4)
Description A font management utility with screen fonts for the printer This is provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM
Smart Device Monitor for Admin
A printer management utility for network
(Win 95/98/Me, NT4,
administrators. NIB setup utilities are also available.
2000/XP/Server 2003/Vista)
This is provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM A printer management utility for client users.
DeskTopBinder – SmartDeviceMonitor for Client (Win 95/98/Me, NT4, 2000/XP/Server 2003/Vista)
A utility for peer-to-peer printing over a NetBEUI or TCP/IP network. A peer-to-peer print utility over a TCP/IP network. This provides the parallel printing and recovery printing features. This is provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM A utility for peer-to-peer printing over a NetBEUI or
Printer Utility for Mac
TCP This software provides several convenient
(Mac)
functions for printing from Macintosh clients. This is provided on the scanner drivers CD-ROM
DeskTopBinder Lite
SM Appendix
DeskTopBinder Lite itself can be used as personal
1-19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Specifications
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Software Accessories (Win9x/ME, 2000/XP/2003, NT4)
document management software and can manage both image data converted from paper documents and application files saved in each client’s PC. This is provided on the scanner drivers CD-ROM
D037/D038/D040/D041
1-20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
Optional Equipment
1.6 OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT 1.6.1 ARDF (D366: STANDARD FOR H-MODELS (D038/D041))
Simplex Paper Size/Weight: Duplex
Size
A3 to A5, DLT to HLT
Weight
40 to 128 g/m2 (10 to 34 lb.)
Size
A3 to A5, DLT to HLT
Weight
52 to 105 g/m2 (14 to 28 lb.)
Table Capacity:
50 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb)
Original Standard Position:
Rear left corner
Separation:
Feed belt and separation roller
Original Transport:
Roller transport
Original Feed Order:
From the top original Copy
Supported Magnification Ratios:
Fax
-
32 to 200 %
Color
32.6 to 200 %
Black & white
48.9 to 200 %
Power Source:
DC 24V, 5V from the scanner unit
Power Consumption:
50 W or less
Dimensions (W × D × H):
550 mm x 491 mm x 120 mm (21.7" x 19.3" x 4.7")
Weight:
10 kg (22 lb.)
1.6.2 PAPER FEED UNIT (D425)
Paper Feed System:
FRR
Paper Height Detection:
4 steps (100%, 70%, 30%, Near end)
SM Appendix
1-21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Specifications
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Optional Equipment Capacity:
500 sheets
Paper Weight:
80 g/m2 (21 lb.)
Paper Size:
A3 SEF to A5, DLT SEF to HLT
Power Source:
DC 24V, 5V (from the main frame)
Power Consumption:
58 W
Dimensions (W x D x H):
550 mm x 520 mm x 137 mm (22" x 20.8" x 5.48")
Weight:
Less than 12 kg (26.4 lbs)
1.6.3 PAPER FEED UNIT (D331)
Paper Size:
A5 to A3, 51/2" x 81/2" SEF to 11" x 17"
Paper Weight:
60 - 105 g/m2, 16 - 28 lb
Tray Capacity:
500 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb) x 2 trays
Paper Feed System:
Feed roller and friction pad
Paper Height Detection:
4 steps (100%, 70%, 30%, Near end)
24 Vdc and 5Vdc (from the copier/printer)
120 Vac (120 V version) from the copier/printer when the optional tray heater is installed
Power Source:
220 – 240 Vac (230 V version) from the copier/printer when the optional tray heater is installed
Power Consumption:
35 W (Copying/printing)
Weight:
25 kg (55 lb)
Size (W x D x H):
550 mm x 520 mm x 271 mm
D037/D038/D040/D041
1-22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
Optional Equipment
1.6.4 INTERNAL FINISHER & PUNCH UNIT (D429)
No punch mode: A3/11" x 17" to B6/5.5" x 8.5" (SEF) Punch mode: 2 holes: A3, A4 or 11" x 17", 8.5" x 14" (SEF), 8.5" x 13" (SEF), 8.5" x 11" 3 holes: Print Paper Size:
A3, A4 (LEF) or 11" x 17", 8.5" x 11" (LEF) 4 holes (Europe): A3, A4 (LEF) or 11" x 17", 8.5" x 11" (LEF) 4 holes (Scandinavia): A3, A4 or 11" x 17", 8.5" x 14" (SEF), 8.5" x 13" (SEF), 8.5" x 11", 7.25" x 10.5" Staple mode: A3/11" x 17" to B5/8.5" x 11" No punch mode: 52 to 256 g/m2 (14 to 68 lb.) Punch mode:
Paper Weight:
52 to 163 g/m2 (14 to 43 lb.) Staple mode: 52 to 128 g/m2 (14 to 34 lb.) Label/Thick paper/OHP cannot be stapled
Tray Capacity:
500 sheets: A4, 8.5" x 11" or less 250 sheets: B4, 8.5" x 14" or more Single size:
Staple capacity:
50 sheets: A4, 8.5" x 11" or smaller 30 sheets: B4, 8.5" x 14" or larger 3 positions
Staple position:
1-staple: 2 positions (Top Left, Top Right) 2-staples: 1 positions
SM Appendix
1-23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Specifications
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Optional Equipment Staple replenishment:
Cartridge (5000 staples)
Power consumption:
50 W + 12 W (Punch Unit)
Dimensions (W x D x H):
440 x 595 x 205 mm (17.3" x 23.4" x8.1")
Weight:
Without punch unit:
13 kg (28.6 lb.)
With punch unit:
16.2 Kg (35.6 lb.)
1.6.5 SHIFT TRAY (D428)
Paper Capacity:
250 sheet (A4/ 81/2” x 111/2” or smaller: 80g/m2/ 20 lbs) Standard sizes A6 SEF to A3, HLT to DLT
Paper Size:
Non-standard sizes Width: 90 to 305 mm Length: 148 to 600 mm
Paper Weight:
52-256 g/m2/ 14 - 68 lbs
Power Consumption:
Max 13 W (Power is supplied from the mainframe.)
Dimension (W x D x H):
431 x 477.5 x 107mm (17.2” x 19.1” x 4.3”)
Weight:
Approx. 2kg (4.4lbs)
1.6.6 1-BIN TRAY UNIT (D426)
Paper Size:
Standard Size: A3 /DLT to A5/ HLT SEF
Paper Weight:
60 to 105 g/m2, 16 to 28 lb.
Tray Capacity:
100 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb., A4)
Power Source:
DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier)
D037/D038/D040/D041
1-24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
Optional Equipment Power Consumption:
Less than 1 W
Weight:
Less than 2kg (4.4lbs)
Size (W x D x H):
455 x 530 x 226mm (18.2” x 21.2” x 9”)
1.6.7 SIDE TRAY (D427)
Paper Size:
Standard Size: A3 /DLT to A5/ HLT SEF
Paper Weight:
60 to 105 g/m2, 16 to 28 lb.
Tray Capacity:
50 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb., A4)
Power Source:
DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier)
Power Consumption:
Less than 40 W
Weight:
1.5 kg
Size (W x D x H):
480 x 480 x 170mm (19.2”x19.2”x6.8”)
SM Appendix
1-25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Specifications
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
APPENDIX: OVERVIEW
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Overview
2. APPENDIX: OVERVIEW
Appendix: Overview
2.1 OVERVIEW 2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT
1. 2nd carriage
16. Vertical transport roller 2
2. 1st carriage
17. Feed roller: T1
3. Original length sensor
18. Vertical transport roller 3
4. Lens
19. Tray 2
5. SBU
20. Tray 1
6. Inverter roller
21. Laser unit
SM Appendix
2-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Overview 7. Paper exit roller
22. Drum unit
8. Junction gate
23. Development unit
9. Duplex unit
24. ITB cleaning unit
10. Fusing unit
25. ITB roller
11. PTR (Paper transfer roller) unit
26. Toner bottle
12. Registration roller
27. ITB (Image Transfer Belt) unit
13. Vertical transport roller 1
28. Inner Tray
14. By-pass feed roller 15. Feed roller: T1
2.1.2 PAPER PATH With options
1. DF path
6. By-pass tray path
2. Exit path: Straight feed out
7. Vertical transport path: Tray 2
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Overview 3. Exit path: Side tray
8. Vertical transport path: Tray 3 (option)
4. Duplex path
9. Vertical transport path: Tray 4 (option)
5. Vertical transport path: Tray 1
10. Inverter path (option)
Appendix: Overview
11. Exit path: Staple/ Shift
Without options
1. DF path
5. By-pass tray path
2. Inverter path
6. Vertical transport path: Tray 2
3. Duplex path
7. Exit path
4. Vertical transport path: T1
SM Appendix
2-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Overview
2.1.3 DRIVE LAYOUT
1. Scanner motor
10. Paper feed motor: T1
2. Toner supply motors
11. By-pass motor
3. ITB contact motor
12. Registration motor
4. Used toner collection motor
13. Duplex exit motor
5. Drum motor: CMY
14. PTR contact motor
6. Development motor: CMY
15. ITB unit motor
7. Development clutch: K
16. Duplex entrance motor
8. Drum/Development motor: K
17. Fusing/Paper exit motor
9. Paper feed motor: T2
18. Inverter motor
D037/D038/D040/D041
2-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
APPENDIX: PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Maintenance Tables
3. APPENDIX: PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE TABLES 3.1 MAINTENANCE TABLES 3.1.1 PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE ITEMS Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables
Chart: A4 (LT)/5% Mode: 3 copies / original (prints/job) Ratio 30% Environment: Normal temperature and humidity Yield may change depending on circumstances and print conditions. Symbol keys: C: Clean, R: Replace, L: Lubricant, I: Inspect
Mainframe
Item
60K
150K
240K
EM
Remarks
Scanner Reflector
C
Optics cloth
1st/2nd/3rd Mirrors
C
Optics cloth
Front and Rear Rails
C
Dry cloth
Exposure Glass
C
C
Dry cloth; alcohol
ADF Exposure Glass
C
C
Dry cloth; alcohol
APS Sensor
C
Dry cloth
PCDU Drum Unit-K, C, M, Y
R
PCDU Toner Collection Bottle
R
ITB and PTR unit
SM Appendix
3-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Maintenance Tables Item ITB Cleaning Unit
60K
150K
240K
EM
Remarks
R
Fusing Fusing Roller
R
Fusing Belt
R
S552R
Alcohol
Pressure Roller
C*
Heating Roller Thermistor
C
C
Dry cloth
Pressure Roller Thermistor
C
C
Dry cloth
Entrance Guide Plate
C
C
Alcohol
Exit Guide Plate
C
C
Alcohol
Stripper Plate
C
C
Alcohol
C
Dry cloth
Thermopile
*: Clean it if dirty.
C
Others Dust Filter
R
Item
60K
120K
240K
EM
Remarks
Paper Feed Feed Roller: Tray 1/2
R
C
Damp cloth
Friction Pad: Tray 1/2
R
C
Dry cloth
Registration Roller
C*1
C
Damp cloth Never use alcohol.
Registration Sensor
C
Dry cloth
Vertical Transport Roller
C
Damp cloth
D037/D038/D040/D041
3-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Maintenance Tables Item
60K
120K
240K
EM
Remarks
Vertical Transport Sensor
C
Dry cloth
By-pass Feed Roller
C
Damp cloth
By-pass Friction Pad
C
Dry cloth
By-pass HP Sensor
C
Dry cloth
Duplex Transport Roller
C
Damp cloth
Duplex Exit Sensor
C
Dry cloth
Paper Exit Paper Exit Roller
Damp cloth
Inverter Roller
C
Damp cloth
Inverter Relay Roller
C
Damp cloth
Inverter Sensor
C
Dry cloth
Fusing Exit Sensor
C
Dry cloth
*1: The registration roller requires a cleaning maintenance every 60 K (total count).
ARDF (D366)
Item
120K
EM
Remarks
Sensors
C
Platen Sheet Cover
C
White Plate
C
Dry or damp cloth
Drive Gear
L
Grease G501
Transport Roller
C
Damp cloth; alcohol
SM Appendix
3-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Blower brush Damp cloth; alcohol (Replace if required.)
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables
Duplex
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Maintenance Tables Exit Roller
C
Damp cloth; alcohol
Inverter Roller
C
Damp cloth; alcohol
Idle Rollers
C
Damp cloth; alcohol
One-tray Paper Feed Unit (D425)
Item
60K
120K
EM
R
C
Dry cloth
Feed Roller
Remarks
Bottom Plate Pad
C
C
Dry cloth
Paper Feed Guide
C
C
Dry cloth
C
Dry cloth
Friction Pad
R
Paper Feed Clutch
I
Two-tray Paper Feed Unit (D331)
Item
60K
120K
EM
Remarks
Paper Feed Roller
R
C
Dry cloth
Friction Pad
R
C
Dry cloth
Paper Feed Guides
C
C
Dry cloth
Relay Rollers
C
C
Dry cloth
Bottom Plate Pad
C
C
Dry cloth
Relay Clutch
I
Replace if necessary
Paper Feed Clutch
I
Replace if necessary
1 Bin Tray (D426)
D037/D038/D040/D041
3-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Maintenance Tables Items
15K
EM
Exit Rollers
C
C
Idle Rollers
C
Remarks Damp or Dry cloth Damp or Dry cloth
C
Damp cloth
C
Blower brush
Paper Sensor
C
Blower brush
Bearing
C
S552R
Exit Sensor
C
Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables
Tray
Shift Tray (D427)
Items
EM
Tray
C
Remarks Damp cloth
3.1.2 OTHERS YIELD PARTS The parts mentioned in these tables have a target yield. However, the total copy/print volume made by the machine will not reach the target yield within the machine’s targeted lifetime if the machine is used under the target usage conditions (ACV, color ratio, P/J, and C/O). So, these parts are categorized not as PM parts but as yield parts (EM parts).
ARDF
Item
80K
120K
240K
Remarks
Pick-up Roller
R
Number of originals
Feed Belt
R
Number of originals
Separation Roller
R
Number of originals
SM Appendix
3-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
APPENDIX: SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables
4. APPENDIX: SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS 4.1 SC TABLES 4.1.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS Summary The ‘SC Table’ section shows the SC codes for controller errors and other errors. The latter (not controller errors) are put into four types. The type is determined by their reset procedures. The table shows the classification of the SC codes.
Controller errors
CTL
Definition
Reset Procedure
The error has occurred in the
See “Troubleshooting Procedure”
controller.
in the table.
The error involves the fusing A
unit. The machine operation is disabled. The user cannot reset the error.
Turn the main switch off and on. Reset the SC (set SP5-810-1). Turn the main switch off and on.
The error involves one or some B
specific units. The machine
Turn the operation switch off and
operates as usual, excluding
on.
the related units. The error is logged. The
Other errors C
SC-code history is updated.
The SC will not show. Only the
The machine operates as
SC history is updated.
usual. The machine operation is disabled. You can reset the machine by turning the D
operation switch or main switch off and on. If the error occurs
Turn the operation switch or main power switch off and on.
again, the same SC code is displayed.
SM Appendix
4-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
Key
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables
After you turn the main power switch off, wait for one second or more before you turn the main power switch on ( SC 672). All SCs are logged. The print log data (SP5-990-004) in SP mode can check the latest 10 SC codes detected and total counters when the SC code is detected.
If the problem concerns electrical circuit boards, first disconnect then reconnect the connectors before you replace the PCBs.
If the problem concerns a motor lock, first check the mechanical load before you replace motors or sensors.
SC Code Classification The table shows the classification of the SC codes:
Class 1
1XX
2XX
3XX
4XX
Section
SC Code
Scanning
Laser exposure
Image development 1
Image development 2
D037/D038/D040/D041
Detailed section
100 -
Scanner
190 -
Unique for a specific model
200 -
Polygon motor
220 -
Synchronization control
230 -
FGATE signal related
240 -
LD control
280 -
Unique for a specific model
300 -
Charge
330 -
Drum potential
350 -
Development
380 -
Unique for a specific model
400 -
Image transfer
420 -
Paper separation
430 -
Cleaning
4-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables
5XX
5XX
6XX
7XX
8XX
SM Appendix
Section
SC Code
Paper feed / Fusing
Paper feed / Fusing
Communication
Peripherals
Controller
Detailed section
440 -
Around drum
460 -
Unit
480 -
Others
500 -
Paper feed
515 -
Duplex
520 -
Paper transport
530 -
Fan motor
540 -
Fusing
560 -
Others
570 -
Unique for a specific model
600 -
Electrical counters
620 -
Mechanical counters
630 -
Account control
640 -
CSS
650 -
Network
670 -
Internal data processing
680 -
Unique for a specific model
700 -
Original handling
720 -
Two-tray finisher
740 -
Booklet finisher
800 -
Error after ready condition
820 -
Diagnostics error
4-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
Class 1
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables Class 1
Section
9XX
SC Code
Others
Detailed section
860 -
Hard disk
880 -
Unique for a specific model
900 -
Counter
920 -
Memory
990 -
Others
4.1.2 SC1XX: SCANNING
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Exposure lamp error The peak white level is less than 64/255 digits (8 bits) when scanning the shading plate.
101
D
Exposure lamp defective
Lamp stabilizer defective
Exposure lamp connector defective
Standard white plate dirty
Scanner mirror or scanner lens out of position or dirty
1.
Check and clean the scanner mirror(s) and scanner lens.
2.
Check and clean the shading plate.
3.
Replace the exposure lamp.
4.
Replace the lamp stabilizer.
5.
Replace the scanner mirror(s) or scanner lens.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Scanner home position error 1 The scanner home position sensor does not detect the “OFF” condition during operation.
No.
D
Scanner motor driver defective
Scanner motor defective
Harness between BCU and scanner motor disconnected
Scanner HP sensor defective
Harness between BCU and HP sensor disconnected
1.
Check the cable connection between the BCU and scanner motor.
2.
Check the cable connection between the BCU and HP sensor.
3.
Replace the scanner motor.
4.
Replace the scanner HP sensor.
Type
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
120
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Scanner home position error 2 The scanner home position sensor does not detect the “ON” condition during operation.
121
D
Scanner motor driver defective
Scanner motor defective
Harness between BCU and scanner motor disconnected
Scanner HP sensor defective
Harness between BCU and HP sensor disconnected
1.
Check the cable connection between the BCU board and scanner motor.
SM Appendix
2.
Check the cable connection between the BCU and HP sensor.
3.
Replace the scanner motor.
4.
Replace the HP sensor.
4-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Black level detection error The black level cannot be adjusted within the target value during the zero clamp.
141
No.
D
Harness disconnected
Defective SBU
1.
Check the cable connection
2.
Replace the SBU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) White level detection error The white level cannot be adjusted within the target during auto gain control.
142
No. 144
D
Type D
Dirty exposure glass or optics section
SBU board defective
Exposure lamp defective
Lamp stabilizer defective
Scanner motor defective
1.
Clean the exposure glass, white plate, mirrors, and lens.
2.
Check if the exposure lamp is lit during initialization.
3.
Check the harness connection between SBU and BCU.
4.
Replace the exposure lamp.
5.
Replace the scanner motor.
6.
Replace the SBU board.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) SBU communication error The SBU connection cannot be detected at power on or recovery from the energy save mode.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
No. 161
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Defective SBU
Defective harness
Defective detection port on the BCU
1.
Replace the harness.
2.
Replace the SBU.
3.
Replace the BCU.
Type D
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) IPU error
detected. 001
D
Defective i-controller
Defective connection between i-controller and SBU
1.
Check the connection between i-controller and SBU.
2.
Replace the i-controller.
Detected an error during an access to the i-controller. 002
D
Defective i-controller board
Replace the i-controller board.
No. 165
Type D
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Copy Data Security Unit error
The copy data security board is not detected when the copy data security function is set "ON" with the initial setting.
A device check error occurs when the copy data security function is set "ON" with the initial setting.
SM Appendix
Incorrect installation of the copy data security board
Defective copy data security board
4-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
The error result of self-diagnostic by the ASIC on the i-controller is
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.
Reinstall the copy data security board.
2.
Replace the copy data security board.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Serial Number Mismatch Serial number stored in the memory does not have the correct
code. 195
D
NVRAM defective
BCU replaced without original NVRAM
1.
Check the serial number with SP5-811-002.
2.
If the stored serial number is incorrect, contact your supervisor.
4.1.3 SC 2XX: EXPOSURE
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Polygon motor error 1: ON timeout The polygon mirror motor does not reach the targeted operating speed within the specified time after turning on or changing speed
202
D
Defective or disconnected harness to polygon motor driver board
Defective polygon motor driver board
Defective polygon motor.
1.
Replace the polygon motor.
2.
Replace the laser unit.
3.
Replace the harness.
4.
Replace the BCU.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Polygon motor error 2: OFF timeout The polygon mirror motor does leave the READY status within 3 seconds after the polygon motor switches off.
D
No.
Disconnected or defective harness to polygon motor driver board
Defective polygon motor driver board
Defective polygon motor
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the polygon motor.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Polygon motor error 3: XSCRDY signal error The SCRDY_N signal goes HIGH (inactive) while the laser diode is firing.
204
D
No.
Type
Disconnected or defective harness to polygon motor driver board
Defective polygon motor
Defective polygon motor driver board
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the polygon motor.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
220
D
Laser synchronizing detection error: start position [K]: LD0
222
D
Laser synchronizing detection error: start position [Y]: LD0 The laser synchronizing detection signal for the start position of the
-
-
LDB [K], [Y], is not output for two seconds after LDB unit turns on while the polygon motor is rotating normally.
SM Appendix
4-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
203
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Disconnected cable from the laser synchronizing detection unit or
defective connection
No.
Defective laser synchronizing detector
Defective LDB
Defective BCU
1.
Check the connectors.
2.
Replace the laser unit.
3.
Replace the BCU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE ON error: K The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after processing the image in normal job or MUSIC for start position [K].
230
No.
D
Defective ASIC (Lupus)
Poor connection between i-controller and BCU.
Defective BCU
1.
Check the connection between the controller board and the BCU.
2.
Replace the BCU.
3.
Replace the controller board.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE OFF error: K
231
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position
D
adjustment) for end position [K].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE ON error: Y The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after
232
D
processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position adjustment) for start position [Y]. See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
233
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position
D
adjustment) for end position [Y].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE ON error: M The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after
234
D
processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position adjustment) for start position [M]. See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
SM Appendix
4-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
FGATE OFF error: Y
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE OFF error: M The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after
235
processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position
D
adjustment) for end position [M]. The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE ON error: C The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after
236
D
processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position adjustment) for start position [C]. See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) FGATE OFF error: C The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after
237
processing the image in normal job or MUSIC (line position
D
adjustment) for end position [C]. The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
240
C
LD error: K
241
C
LD error: Y
-
-
The BCU detects LDB error a few times consecutively when LDB unit
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) turns on after LDB initialization.
No.
Worn-out LD
Disconnected or broken harness of the LD
1.
Replace the harness of the LD.
2.
Replace the laser unit.
3.
Replace the BCU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Line position adjustment fails four consecutive times.
285
D
Pattern sampling error ( insufficient image density )
Defective ID sensors for the line position adjustment
Defective image transfer belt unit
Defective PCDU(s)
Defective laser unit
1.
Check and reinstall the image transfer belt unit and PCDU(s).
2.
Check if each toner bottle has enough toner.
3.
Replace the ID sensor.
4.
Replace the image transfer belt unit.
5.
Replace the PCDU(s).
6.
Replace the laser unit.
4.1.4 SC3XX: IMAGE PROCESSING – 1 No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
300
D
AC charge output error [K]
301
D
AC charge output error [M]
302
D
AC charge output error [C]
SM Appendix
4-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
Line position adjustment (MUSIC) error
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
303
D
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) AC charge output error [Y] The measured voltage is not proper when BCU measures the charge output for each color.
-
-
No.
Disconnected or broken high voltage cable
Defective or not installed PCDU
Defective HVPS-CB board
1.
Check or replace the connectors.
2.
Replace the PCDU for the affected color.
3.
Replace the HVPS-CB board.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Color development motor error The motor LOCK signal is not detected for more than two seconds while the motor START signal is on.
325
D
Color development motor slip due to an increase in the torque
1.
Adjust the torque properly by replacing or cleaning the development unit.
2.
No.
Type
Replace the development motor: CMY if the load torque is normal.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
360
D
TD sensor (Vt high) error 1: K
361
D
TD sensor (Vt high) error 1: M
362
D
TD sensor (Vt high) error 1: C
363
D
TD sensor (Vt high) error 1: Y
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
The Vt value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor exceeds the specified value (default: 4.7V) with SP3020-002 for twenty counts.
The [Vt - Vtref] value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor exceeds the specified value (default: 5.0V) with SP3020-001.
-
-
Black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor disconnected
Harness between TD sensor and development unit defective
Defective TD sensor.
1.
Check the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor connector Appendix: Service Call Conditions
and harness between the TD sensor and development unit for damage.
No.
2.
Check the drawer connector of the PCDU.
3.
Replace the development unit.
4.
Replace the PCDU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
364
D
TD sensor (Vt low) error 2: K
365
D
TD sensor (Vt low) error 2: M
366
D
TD sensor (Vt low) error 2: C
367
D
TD sensor (Vt low) error 2: Y The Vt value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor is below the specified value with SP3020-004 (default: 0.5V) for 10 counts.
-
-
TD sensor harness disconnected, loose, defective
A drawer connector disconnected, loose, defective
TD sensor defective
1.
Check the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor connector and harness between the TD sensor and development unit for damage.
SM Appendix
4-15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
No.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 2.
Check the drawer connector of the PCDU.
3.
Replace the development unit.
4.
Replace the PCDU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
372
D
TD sensor adjustment error: K
373
D
TD sensor adjustment error: M
374
D
TD sensor adjustment error: C
375
D
TD sensor adjustment error: Y During TD sensor initialization, the output value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor is not within the range of the specified value with SP3238-001 to -004 (default: 2.5V) ± 0.2V
-
-
No.
Heat seal not removed from a new developer pack
TD harness sensor disconnected, loose or defective
TD sensor defective
Harness between TD sensor and drawer disconnected, defective
1.
Remove the heat seal from each PCDU.
2.
Replace the PCDU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
380
C
Drum gear position sensor error: K
381
C
Drum gear position sensor error: M, C, Y The machine does not detect the drum position signal for 2.4 seconds at the drum phase adjustment.
-
-
Dirty or defective drum gear position sensor
1.
Replace the drum gear position sensor.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 2.
No.
Type
396
D
Replace the PCDU.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Drum/Development motor error: K The machine detects a High signal from the drum/development motor:
-
-
No.
Overload on the drum/development motor: K
Defective drum/development motor: K
Defective harness
Shorted 24 V fuse on the PSU
Defective interlock system
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the drum/development motor: K.
3.
Replace the 24V fuse on the PSU.
Type
397
D
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
K for 2 seconds after the drum/development motor: K turned on.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Drum motor error: CMY The machine detects a High signal from the drum motor: CMY for 2 seconds after the drum motor: CMY turned on.
-
-
SM Appendix
Overload on the drum motor: CMY
Defective drum motor: CMY
Defective harness
Shorted 24 V fuse on the PSU
Defective interlock system
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the drum motor: CMY.
3.
Replace the 24V fuse on the PSU.
4-17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables
4.1.5 SC4XX: IMAGE PROCESSING – 2 No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ID sensor adjustment error When the Vsg error counter reaches "3", the machine detects "SC400". The Vsg error counter counts "1" when the Vsg detected by ID sensor is more than the value (default: 4.5V) specified with SP3324-005 or less than the value (default: 3.5V) specified with SP3324-006.
400
D
Dirty or defective ID sensor
1.
Check the harness of the ID sensor.
2.
Clean or replace the ID sensor.
After replacing the ID sensor, input the ID sensor correction coefficient with SP3362-013 and -016. For details, refer to "ID sensor board" in the Replacement and Adjustment section.
No.
1.
Replace the BCU.
2.
Replace the ITB unit.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ITB unit motor error The motor LOCK signal is not detected for more than two seconds while the motor START signal is on.
441
No. 442
D
Type D
Motor overload
Defective ITB unit motor
1.
Replace the ITB unit.
2.
Replace the BCU.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ITB contact motor error The ITB contact sensor does not detect the movement of actuator at
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) the sensor while the polygon motor rotates.
No.
Dirty ITB contact sensor
Defective ITB contact motor
Disconnected connector of ITB contact sensor or motor
Disconnected cable
1.
Replace the ITB contact sensor.
2.
Replace the ITB contact motor.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
ITB unit error The machine detects the encoder sensor error.
443
No. 452
C
Disconnect or defective harness
Defective encoder sensor
ITB unit installation error
Defective ITB unit motor
1.
Connect or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the encoder sensor.
3.
Check if the ITB unit is correctly set.
4.
Replace the ITB unit motor.
5.
Replace the ITB unit.
Type D
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Paper transfer unit contact error The paper transfer unit contact sensor does not detect the movement of actuator at the sensor while the polygon motor rotates.
SM Appendix
Defective paper transfer unit contact sensor
Defective paper transfer unit contact motor
4-19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Broken +24V fuse on PSU
Defective BCU
1.
Check the connection between the paper transfer unit and PSU.
2.
Replace the paper transfer unit contact sensor.
3.
Replace the paper transfer unit contact motor.
4.
Replace the +24V fuse on the PSU.
5.
Replace the BCU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) High voltage power: Drum/ development bias output error An error signal is detected for 0.2 seconds when charging the drum or development.
491
No. 492
D
High voltage leak
Broken harness
Defective drum unit or development unit
Defective HVPS-CB board
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the drum unit or paper transfer unit.
3.
Replace the HVPS-CB board.
Type C
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) High voltage power: Image transfer/ paper transfer bias output error An error signal is detected for 0.2 seconds when charging the separation, image transfer bet or paper transfer roller.
High voltage leak
Broken harness
Defective image transfer belt unit or paper transfer unit
Defective HVPS-TTS board
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
No.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the image transfer belt unit or paper transfer unit.
3.
Replace the HVPS-TTS board.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Toner collection motor error The machine detects that the PCDU toner collection bottle is not set
495
D
PCDU toner collection bottle motor damaged
Disconnect or defective harness
Defective DRB board
Defective BCU
1.
Replace the waste toner collection bottle motor.
2.
Check or replace the harness.
3.
Replace the DRB board
4.
Replace the BCU
4.1.6 SC5XX: PAPER FEED AND FUSING No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
503
B
3rd paper tray lift motor malfunction (optional Paper Tray Unit)
504
B
4th paper tray lift motor malfunction (optional Paper Tray Unit)
-
-
The paper lift sensor did not activate within 18 sec. after the tray lift motor switched on.
An obstruction (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) has blocked the motor drive and caused an overload.
SM Appendix
Paper lift sensor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged
Paper lift sensor defective
Tray lift motor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged
Tray lift motor defective
4-21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
when the toner collection motor is turned off.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the tray lift motor.
3.
Replace the BCU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Paper tray feed motor lock (optional Paper Tray Unit) A motor lock signal is not detected for more than 1.5 s or the lock signal is not detected for more than 1.0 s during rotation. An obstruction (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) has blocked the
506
B
feed motor drive and caused an overload. Paper tray feed motor connection loose, disconnected, or
damaged
No.
Paper tray feed motor defective
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the feed motor.
3.
Replace the BCU
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) By-pass bottom plate error The signal from the by-pass tray HP sensor does not change for 1.0 second after the by-pass motor has rotated counterclockwise. If this condition occurs three consecutive times, the SC is generated.
508
B
Disconnect or defective harness of the by-pass motor
Defective by-pass motor
Disconnect or defective harness of the by-pass tray HP sensor
Defective by-pass tray HP sensor
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the by-pass motor.
3.
Replace the by-pass tray HP sensor.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 4.
No.
Replace the BCU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
530
D
Ventilation fan: front error
531
D
Ventilation fan: rear error The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal was first detected.
No.
Type
Defective ventilation fan: front or rear
Disconnected or defective harness
Defective DRB
Defective BCU
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the ventilation fan: front (SC530) or rear (SC531).
3.
Replace the DRB.
4.
Replace the BCU.
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Laser unit fan error The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal was first detected.
532
D
SM Appendix
Defective laser unit fan
Disconnected or defective harness
Defective drive board
Defective BCU
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the laser unit fan.
3.
Replace the DRB.
4.
Replace the BCU.
4-23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Fusing front fan error The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal was first detected.
533
No.
D
Defective fusing front fan
Disconnected or defective harness
Defective DRB
Defective BCU
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the fusing front fan.
3.
Replace the DRB.
4.
Replace the BCU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Fusing rear fan error The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal was first detected.
534
No. 535
D
Type D
Defective fusing rear fan
Disconnected or defective harness
Defective DRB
Defective BCU
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the fusing rear fan.
3.
Replace the DRB.
4.
Replace the BCU.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Controller box fan error
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor
No.
Defective controller box fan
Disconnected or defective harness
Defective DRB
Defective BCU
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the controller box fan.
3.
Replace the DRB.
4.
Replace the BCU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Junction gate solenoid fan error The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal was first detected.
536
No. 540
D
Type D
Defective junction gate solenoid fan
Disconnected or defective harness
Defective DRB
Defective BCU
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the Junction gate solenoid fan.
3.
Replace the DRB.
4.
Replace the BCU.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Fusing/Paper exit motor error The BCU receives the lock signal 2.0 seconds after turning on the fusing/paper exit motor.
SM Appendix
4-25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
lock signal was first detected.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Motor overload
Defective fusing/paper exit motor
Replace the fusing/paper exit motor.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller error 1 The temperature detected by the thermopile does not reach 0°C for 6 seconds.
541
No. 542
A
Loose connection of the thermopile
Defective thermopile
1.
Check that the thermopile is firmly connected.
2.
Replace the thermopile.
Type A
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller warm-up error 1
After the main switch is turned on or the cover is closed, the increment of the heating roller temperature per 10 seconds is 40°C or less. If this condition is detected five times consecutively, SC 542 is defined.
The heating roller temperature does not reach 100°C for 9 seconds after the heating lamp on.
The heating roller temperature does not reach the ready temperature while 75 seconds after the heating lamp on.
The center temperature of the heating roller does not reach the ready temperature for 30 seconds after the edge temperature of the heating roller has reached the ready temperature.
Dirty or defective thermopile
Defective heating roller lamp
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-26 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.
Check if the thermopile is firmly connected.
2.
Replace the thermopile.
3.
Replace the heating roller lamp.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller fusing lamp overheat 1 (software error) The detected fusing temperature stays at 230°C for 1 second.
543
A
Defective PSU
Defective BCU
No.
1.
Replace the PSU.
2.
Replace the BCU.
Type
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
Related SC code: SC 553
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller fusing lamp overheat 1 (hardware error) During stand-by mode or a print job, the detected heating roller temperature reaches 250 °C.
544
A
Defective PSU
Defective BCU
Defective fusing control system
Related SC code: SC 543
SM Appendix
1.
Replace the PSU.
2.
Replace the BCU.
4-27 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller fusing lamp consecutive full power 1 When the fusing unit is not running in the ready condition, the heating roller fusing lamp keeps on full power for 37 seconds.
545
A
Broken heating roller thermistor
Related SC code: SC 555 Replace the heating roller thermistor.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Zero cross error The zero cross signal is detected three times even though the
heater relay is off when turning on the main power. The zero cross signal is not detected for 2 seconds even though
the heater relay is on after turning on the main power or closing the front door. 547
D
The detection error occurs twice or more in the 11 zero cross signal
detections. This error is defined when the detected zero cross signal is less than 45.
No. 551
Type A
Defective fusing lamp relay
Defective fusing lamp relay circuit
Unstable power supply
1.
Check the power supply source.
2.
Replace the PSU
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller thermistor (end) error 2
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-28 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
The temperature measured by the heating roller thermistor (end) does not reach 0°C for 150 seconds and the temperature/humidity sensor of the machine detects 5°C or more.
The heating roller thermistor detects -5°C for 9 seconds.
Loose connection of heating roller thermistor
Defective heating roller thermistor
No.
1.
Check that the heating roller thermistor is firmly connected.
2.
Replace the heating roller thermistor.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller warm-up error 2
After the main switch is turned on or the cover is closed, the increment of the heating roller temperature per 10 seconds is 40°C or less. If this condition is detected five times consecutively, SC 552 is defined.
The heating roller temperature does not reach 100°C for 9 seconds after the heating lamp on.
552
A
The heating roller temperature does not reach the ready temperature while 75 seconds after the heating lamp on.
The end temperature of the heating roller does not reach the ready temperature for 30 seconds after the edge temperature of the heating roller has reached the ready temperature.
Dirty or defective thermistor (end)
Heating roller fusing lamp broken
Related SC code: SC 542
SM Appendix
1.
Check if the heating roller thermistor is firmly connected.
2.
Replace the heating roller fusing lamp.
4-29 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
Related SC code: SC 541
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller fusing lamp overheat 2 (software error) The detected pressure roller temperature stays at 230°C or more for 1 second.
553
A
Defective PSU
Defective BCU
Related SC code: SC 543
No.
1.
Replace the heating roller thermistor.
2.
Replace the PSU.
3.
Replace the BCU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller fusing lamp overheat 2 (hardware error) The heating roller thermistor detects 250°C or more.
554
No. 555
A
Defective PSU
Defective BCU
Defective fusing control system
1.
Replace the heating roller thermistor.
2.
Replace the PSU.
3.
Replace the BCU.
Type A
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Heating roller lamp consecutive full power 2 When the fusing unit is not running in the ready condition, the pressure roller-fusing lamp keeps ON full power for 130 seconds or more.
Broken heating roller fusing lamp
Related SC code: SC 545
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-30 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.
Replace the heating roller fusing lamp.
2.
Replace the PSU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Zero cross frequency error When the zero cross signal is 66 or more and it is detected 10 times or
C
more in 11 detections, the machine determines that input 60 Hz and SC557 occurs.
Noise (High frequency)
Check the power supply source.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Consecutive fusing jam The paper jam counter for the fusing unit reaches 3 times. The paper jam counter is cleared if the paper is fed correctly.
559
A
This SC is activated only when SP1159-001 is set to "1" (default "0").
Paper jam in the fusing unit.
Remove the paper that is jammed in the fusing unit. Then make sure that the fusing unit is clean and has no obstacles in the paper feed path.
No. 561
Type A
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller thermister error 3 The temperature measured by the pressure roller thermistor (center) does not reach 0 °C for 45 seconds.
SM Appendix
Loose connection of pressure roller thermistor
Defective pressure roller thermistor
4-31 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
557
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Related SC code: SC 541
No.
1.
Check that the pressure roller thermistor is firmly connected.
2.
Replace the pressure roller thermistor.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller overheat 3 (software error) The detected fusing roller temperature stays at 230°C or more for 1 second.
563
No.
A
Defective PSU
Defective BCU
1.
Replace the pressure roller thermistor (center).
2.
Replace the PSU.
3.
Replace the BCU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller overheat 3 (hardware error) The pressure roller thermistor (center) detects 250°C or more.
564
No. 565
A
Type A
Defective PSU
Defective BCU
Defective fusing control system
1.
Replace the pressure roller thermistor (center).
2.
Replace the PSU.
3.
Replace the BCU.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller fusing lamp consecutive full power 3
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-32 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) When the fusing unit is not running in the ready condition, the pressure roller fusing lamp keeps ON full power for 250 seconds or more.
No.
Broken Pressure roller fusing lamp
1.
Replace the pressure roller fusing lamp.
2.
Replace the PSU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller thermister error 4
not reach 0 °C for 20 seconds. 571
A
Loose connection of pressure roller thermistor (end)
Defective pressure roller thermistor (end)
Related SC code: SC 541
No.
1.
Check that the pressure roller thermistor (end) is firmly connected.
2.
Replace the pressure roller thermistor (end).
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller overheat 4 (software error) The detected pressure roller temperature stays at 230°C or more for 1 second.
573
A
SM Appendix
Defective PSU
Defective BCU
1.
Replace the pressure roller thermistor (end).
2.
Replace the PSU.
3.
Replace the BCU.
4-33 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
The temperature measured by the pressure roller thermistor (end) does
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pressure roller overheat 4 (hardware error) The pressure roller thermistor (end) detects 250°C or more.
574
A
Defective pressure roller thermistor (end)
Defective PSU
Defective BCU
Defective fusing control system
1.
Replace the pressure roller thermistor (end).
2.
Replace the PSU.
3.
Replace the BCU.
4.1.7 SC6XX: DEVICE COMMUNICATION
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
610
D
Mechanical counter error: K
611
D
Mechanical counter error: FC This SC is only for NA models. The machine detects the mechanical counter error when SP5987-001 is set to "1".
-
-
No. 620
Type D
Disconnected mechanical counter
Defective mechanical counter
1.
Check or replace the mechanical counter.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) ARDF communication error After the ARDF is detected, the break signal occurs or communication timeout occurs.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-34 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables Type
No.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Incorrect installation of ARDF
ARDF defective
BCU board defective
External noise
1.
Check the cable connection of the ARDF.
2.
Shut out the external noise.
3.
Replace the ARDF.
4.
Replace the BCU board.
Type
621
D
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Finisher communication error While the BCU communicates with an optional unit, an SC code is displayed if one of following conditions occurs.
The BCU receives the break signal which is generated by the peripherals only just after the main switch is turned on.
When the BCU does not receive an OK signal from a peripheral 100ms after sending a command to it. The BCU resends the command. The BCU does not receive an OK signal after sending the command 3 times.
-
-
No. 632
Type CTL
SM Appendix
Cable problems
BCU problems
PSU problems in the machine
Main board problems in the peripherals
1.
Check if the cables of peripherals are correctly connected.
2.
Replace the PSU if no power is supplied to peripherals.
3.
Replace the main board of peripherals.
4.
Replace the BCU.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Counter device error 1
4-35 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
No.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
B
After 3 attempts to send a data frame to the optional counter device via the serial communication line, no ACK signal was received within 100 ms. Serial line between the optional counter device, the relay board
and copier control board is disconnected or damaged Make sure that SP5113 is set to enable the optional counter
device.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Counter device error 2 After 3 attempts to send a data frame to the optional counter device via the serial communication line, no ACK signal was received within 100
633
CTL
ms.
B Serial line between the optional counter device, the relay board
and copier control board is disconnected or damaged Make sure that SP5113 is set to enable the optional counter
device.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Counter device error 3
634
No. 635
CTL
A backup RAM error was returned by the counter device.
B
Type CTL B
Counter device control board defective
Backup battery of counter device defective
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Counter device error 4 A backup battery error was returned by the counter device.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-36 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
No. 636
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Counter device control board defective
Backup battery of counter device defective
Type CTL
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) SD Card Error Expanded authentication module error There is no expanded authentication module in the machine. The SD card or the file of the expanded authentication module is broken.
01
D
No expanded authentication module
Defective SD card
No DESS module
1.
Install the expanded authentication module.
2.
Install the SD card.
3.
Install the DESS module.
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
There is no DESS module in the machine.
Version error
02
No. 641
D
The version of the expanded authentication module is not correct.
Incorrect module version
1.
Install the correct file of the expanded authentication module.
Type CTL D
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) BCU control data transfer abnormal A sampling of the control data sent from the BCU reveals an abnormality.
SM Appendix
Controller board defective
4-37 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
No.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
External noise
BCU board defective
1.
Check the connection between the controller board and BCU.
2.
Replace the controller board.
3.
Replace the BCU.
Type CTL
650
B
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Communication error of the remote service modem (RCG-M) Authentication error The authentication for the RCG-M fails at a dial up connection.
-001
-
Incorrect SP settings
Disconnected telephone line
Disconnected modem board
Check and set the correct user name (SP5816-156) and password (SP5816-157). Incorrect modem setting
-004
-
Dial up fails due to the incorrect modem setting. Same as -001 Check and set the correct AT command (SP5819-160). Communication line error The supplied voltage is not sufficient due to the defective
-005
-
communication line or defective connection. Same as -001 Consult with the user's local telephone company.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-38 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Incorrect dial up connection -001: Program parameter error -002: Program execution error
651
CTL C
An unexpected error occurs when the modem (RCG-M) tries to call the center with a dial up connection.
Caused by a software bug
No action required because this SC does not interfere with operation of
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) NVRAM error Retry of NVRAM communication fails three times after the machine has
669
D
detected the NVRAM error.
Caused by noise
Turn the main power switch off and on.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Engine start up error
670
CTL D
The ready signal from the engine board is not detected.
Defective engine board.
Replace the engine board.
671
CTL D
SM Appendix
Engine board mismatch error Engine board and controller mismatch detected.
4-39 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
the machine.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables
No.
Wrong engine board installed.
Wrong controller board installed.
Check the type of engine board and controller board.
1.
Replace the BCU.
2.
Replace the controller board.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Controller-to-operation panel communication error at startup After powering on the machine, the communication circuit between the controller and the operation panel is not opened, or communication with controller is interrupted after a normal startup.
672
No.
CTL D
Controller stall
Controller board installed incorrectly
Controller board defective
Operation panel connector loose or defective
1.
Check the harness connection.
2.
Replace the controller board.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) RFID: Communication error
Communication error occurs when the RFID starts to communicate with the RFID receptor.
Retry of RFID communication fails three times after the machine has detected the RFID communication error.
681
D
Defective RFID reader and writer
Disconnected ASAP I/F
No memory chip on the toner cartridge
Noise
1.
Replace the RFID controller board.
2.
Replace the toner cartridge.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-40 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Memory chip at TD sensor: Communication error Retry of memory chip communication fails three times after the
682
No.
D
Damaged memory chip data
Disconnected inter face
No memory chip on the development unit
Noise
1.
Replace the development unit.
2.
Replace the PCDU.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) RFID: Unit check error The machine gets RFID communication error even the toner cartridges
683
C
have not been installed in the machine.
Caused by noise
Turn the main power switch off and on.
No. 687
Type D
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Memory address command error The BCU does not receive a memory address command from the controller for the prescribed time after the paper has reached the registration sensor.
SM Appendix
Harness Disconnection at BCU
Controller board loose or broken
Defective BCU
Defective i-controller
4-41 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
machine has detected the memory chip communication error.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.
Check if the controller is firmly connected to the BCU.
2.
Replace the BCU.
3.
Replace the i-controller.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) GAVD communication error
The I2C bus device ID is not identified during initialization.
A device-status error occurs during I2C bus communication.
The I2C bus communication is not established due to an error other than a buffer shortage.
690
D
Loose connection
Defective BCU
Defective LD controller board
1.
Turn the main switch off and on.
2.
Check the cable connection.
3.
Replace the laser unit.
4.
Replace the BCU board.
4.1.8 SC7XX: PERIPHERALS
No. 730
Type B
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Shift tray motor error The shift tray HP sensor does not activate within 1.86 seconds after the shift tray motor starts to move at power on or copying. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.
Defective shift tray motor
Defective shift tray HP sensor.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-42 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Replace the shift tray motor.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Finisher stapler motor error (D038/D041) The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues
740
B
Staple jam
Motor overload
Defective stapler motor
Defective stapler safety sensor
1.
Check the connections and cables for the components mentioned above.
No.
2.
Replace the stapler unit
3.
Replace the finisher main board.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Finisher stapler movement motor error (D038/D041)
742
B
SM Appendix
Motor overload
Loose connection of the stapler unit HP sensor
Loose connection of the stapler unit movement motor
Defective stapler unit HP sensor
Defective stapler movement motor
1.
Check the connection of the stapler movement motor.
2.
Check the connection of the stapler unit HP sensor.
3.
Replace the stapler unit HP sensor.
4.
Replace the stapler unit movement motor.
4-43 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
this SC code.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Tray lift motor error (D038/D041)
750
No.
B
Motor overload
Loose connection of the tray lift motor
Defective tray lift motor
1.
Check the connections to the tray lift motor.
2.
Replace the tray lift motor.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Finisher punch motor error (D038/D041) The punch HP sensor is not activated within the specified time after the punch motor turned on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.
760
D
Punch HP sensor disconnected, defective
Punch motor disconnected or defective
Punch motor overload due to obstruction
1.
Check the connections and cables for the punch motor and HP sensor.
No. 763
2.
Check for blockages in the punch motor mechanism.
3.
Replace the punch slider unit.
4.
Replace the punch unit.
5.
Replace the finisher main board.
Type B
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Punch registration motor error (D038/D041) The punch unit moves but is not detected at the home position within the specified time. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.
D037/D038/D040/D041
Motor harness disconnected, loose, defective
4-44 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Defective registration motor
1.
Check the connections to the punch registration motor.
2.
Replace the punch unit slider.
3.
Replace the punch unit.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Paper edge detection sensor error (D038/D041) The machine does not detect correct voltage from the paper edge
787
D
No.
Defective connector
Defective paper edge detection sensor.
Defective DA or AD converter.
1.
Replace the punch slider unit.
2.
Replace the punch unit.
Type
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
detection sensor.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
788
D
Paper size sensor error without side tray (D038/D041)
789
B
Paper size sensor error with side tray (D038/D041) The machine does not detect correct voltage from the paper size sensors.
SM Appendix
Defective connector
Defective paper size sensors
Defective DA or AD converter.
1.
Replace the punch slider unit.
2.
Replace the punch unit.
4-45 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
790
D
Front jogger motor error without side tray (D038/D041)
793
B
Front jogger motor error with side tray (D038/D041) The machine does not detect a correct signal from the front jogger fence HP sensor at power-on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.
No.
Type
Defective front jogger motor
Loosen connection
Motor overload
Defective front jogger fence HP sensor
1.
Replace the front jogger fence HP sensor.
2.
Replace the front jogger motor.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
791
D
Rear jogger motor error without side tray (D038/D041)
794
B
Rear jogger motor error with side tray (D038/D041) The machine does not detect a correct signal from the rear jogger fence HP sensor at power-on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.
No. 792
Type D
D037/D038/D040/D041
Defective rear jogger motor
Loosen connection
Motor overload
Defective rear jogger fence HP sensor
1.
Replace the rear jogger fence HP sensor.
2.
Replace the rear jogger motor.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pick-up roller contact motor error without side tray (D038/D041)
4-46 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
795
B
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Pick-up roller contact motor error with side tray (D038/D041) The machine does not detect a correct signal from the pick-up roller HP sensor at power-on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error,
No.
Type
Defective pick-up roller contact motor
Loosen connection
Motor overload
Defective pick-up roller HP sensor
1.
Replace the pick-up contact motor.
2.
Replace the pick-up roller HP sensor.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Belt roller solenoid error
796
No.
B
Disconnected harness
Defective belt roller position sensor
Defective belt roller solenoid
1.
Check the harness connection.
2.
Replace the belt roller position sensor.
3.
Replace the belt roller solenoid.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) NVRAM data error
797
D
SM Appendix
Defective NVRAM on the main board of the internal finisher
1.
Check the harness connection.
2.
Replace the main board.
4-47 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Front Fan error The machine detects the fan lock signal (ON) consecutively 200 ms.
798
No.
D
Front fan damaged
Disconnect or defective the harness
Front fan overload
1.
Check or replace the harness.
2.
Replace the front fan.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Output tray motor error
799
D
Output tray motor damaged
Output tray motor overload
Loose connection of the Output tray motor
Defective output tray motor
Replace the output tray unit.
4.1.9 SC8XX: OVERALL SYSTEM
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Energy saving I/O sub-system error
816
CTL D
The energy saving I/O sub-system detects an error. Controller board defective
Replace the controller board.
No. 817
Type CTL
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Monitor Error
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-48 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
D
This is a file detection and electronic file signature check error when the boot loader attempts to read the self-diagnostic module, system kernel, or root system files from the OS Flash ROM, or the items on the SD card in the controller slot are false or corrupted.
No.
OS Flash ROM data defective; change the controller firmware
SD card data defective; use another SD card
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Fatal kernel error
CTL C
Due to a control error, a RAM overflow occurred during system processing. One of the following messages was displayed on the operation panel.
[0x5032]
HAIC-P2 error
[0x696e]
init died
[0x766d]
vm_pageout: VM is full
[554C]
USB error
No. 820
Type
System program defective
Controller board defective
Optional board defective
1.
Replace controller firmware
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
CTL
Self-diagnostics error: CPU
D
[XXXX]: Detailed error code CPU error
[0001] to
During the self-diagnostic, the controller CPU detects an error. There
[06FF]
are 47 types of error code (0001 to 4005) depending on the cause of
[0801] to [4005] the error. The CPU detects an error and displays the specific error code with the program address where the error occurs.
SM Appendix
System firmware problem
Defective controller
4-49 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
819
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 1.
Turn the main switch off and on.
2.
Reinstall the controller system firmware.
3.
Replace the controller.
When the problem cannot be fixed with the above procedure, the following information displayed on the screen needs to be fed back to a technical support center.
SC code
Detailed error code
Program address
CPU/Memory Error
System firmware problem
[0702]
Defective RAM-DIMM
[0709]
Defective controller
1.
Reinstall the controller system software.
2.
Replace the RAM-DIMM.
3.
Replace the controller.
[070A]
No. 821
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
CTL
Self-diagnostics error: ASIC
D
[XXXX]: Detailed error code ASIC error
[0B00]
The write-&-verify check error has occurred in the ASIC.
Defective ASIC device
Replace the controller. [0B06]
ASIC detection error The I/O ASIC for system control is not detected.
Defective ASIC
Defective North Bridge and PCI I/F
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-50 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Replace the controller board. Self-diagnosis error: ASIC The CPU checks if the ASIC timer works correctly compared with the CPU timer. If the ASIC timer does not function in the specified range,
[0D05]
System firmware problem
Defective RAM-DIMM
Defective controller
1.
Reinstall the controller system firmware.
2.
Replace the RAM-DIMM.
3.
Replace the controller board.
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
this SC code is displayed.
Video bridge device error 1: ASIC The CPU does not detects the video bridge device.
[50A1]
Defective I/F between the video bridge device and i-controller
Replace the i-controller. Video bridge device error 1: ASIC The CPU detects the video bridge device, but detects error data from the video bridge device..
[50A2]
Defective I/F between the video bridge device and i-controller
Replace the i-controller.
No. 822
Type CTL B
[3003]
SM Appendix
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Self-diagnostic error: HDD (Hard Disk Drive) [XXXX]: Detailed error code Timeout error
4-51 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
[3004] -
Command error When the main switch is turned on or starting the self-diagnostic, the
-
-
HDD stays busy for the specified time or more.
-
-
-
No. 823
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Type CTL B
Loose connection
Defective HDD
Defective controller
1.
Check that the HDD is correctly connected to the controller.
2.
Replace the HDD.
3.
Replace the controller.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Self-diagnostic error: NIB [XXXX]: Detailed error code MAC address check sum error
[6101]
The result of the MAC address check sum does not match the check sum stored in ROM. PHY IC error
[6104]
The PHY IC on the controller cannot be correctly recognized. PHY IC loop-back error
[6105]
An error occurred during the loop-back test for the PHY IC on the controller.
-
Replace the controller.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) [1401]
824
CTL D
Self-diagnosis error: Standard NVRAM The controller cannot recognize the standard NVRAM installed or detects that the NVRAM is defective.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-52 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables
No. 826
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Loose connection
Defective standard NVRAM
Defective controller
1.
Check the standard NVRAM is firmly inserted into the socket.
2.
Replace the NVRAM.
3.
Replace the controller
Type CTL D
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) [15FF] Self-diagnostic Error: RTC/optional NVRAM Appendix: Service Call Conditions
No.
RTC error [1501]
Defective the RTC device
Replace the i-controller. The RTC device is not detected.
[15FF]
RTC defective
NVRAM without RTC installed
Backup battery discharged
Replace the NVRAM with another NVRAM with an RTC device.
No. 827
Type CTL D
[0201]
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Self-diagnostic error: Standard SDRAM DIMM [XXXX]: Detailed error code Verification error Error detected during a write/verify check for the standard RAM (SDRAM DIMM).
SM Appendix
Loose connection
4-53 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Defective SDRAM DIMM
Defective controller
1.
Turn the main switch off and on.
2.
Replace the SDRAM DIMM.
3.
Replace the controller.
Resident memory error The SPD values in all RAM DIMM are incorrect or unreadable. [0202]
No.
Defective RAM DIMM
Defective SPD ROM on RAM DIMM
Defective 12C bus
1.
Replace the RAM DIMM.
Type
828
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
CTL
Self-diagnostic error: ROM
D
[XXXX]: Detailed error code Check sum error 1 The boot monitor and OS program stored in the ROM DIMM is
[0101]
checked. If the check sum of the program is incorrect, this SC code is displayed.
No.
Type CTL
829
B
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Self-diagnosis error: optional RAM [XXXX]: Detailed error code Verification error (Slot 1)
[0401]
The data stored in the optional RAM in Slot 1 does not match the data when reading.
-
-
D037/D038/D040/D041
Not specified RAM DIMM installed
4-54 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables
-
Type
-
No. 833
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Defective RAM DIMM
1.
Replace the RAM DIMM.
2.
Replace the controller board.
Type CTL C
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Self-diagnostic error 8: Engine I/F ASIC
[0F30]
ASIC (Mandolin) for system control could not be detected. After the PCI configuration, the device ID for the ASIC could not be checked.
[0F31]
Replace the VBCU
ASIC (Mandolin) for system control could not be detected. After the PCI configuration, the device ID for the ASIC could not be checked.
[0F41]
Replace the VBCU Could not initialize or read the bus connection. [50B1]
Check for loose connections at the mother board.
Replace the mother board Value of the SSCG register is incorrect. [50B2]
Check for loose connections at the mother board.
Replace the mother board
No. 839
Type CTL C
[9101]
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) USB NAND Flash ROM error The ID of the USB NAND Flash ROM cannot be read.
SM Appendix
Defective controller board
4-55 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
No.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Replace the controller board. The USB NAND Flash ROM is disconnected.
[9110]
Defective controller board
Replace the controller board.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) IEEE1394 interface error The 1394 interface is unusable.
851
No.
CTL
Defective IEEE1394
B
Defective controller.
1.
Turn the main switch off and on.
2.
Replace the IEEE1394 interface board.
3.
Replace the controller.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Wireless LAN card not detected
853
CTL B
The wireless LAN card is not detected before communication is established, though the wireless LAN board is detected. Loose connection
Check the connection.
No. 854
Type CTL B
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Wireless LAN/Bluetooth card not detected The wireless LAN/Bluetooth card is not detected after communication is established, but the wireless LAN board is detected.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-56 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Loose connection
Check the connection.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Wireless LAN/Bluetooth card error
855
CTL
856
B
No.
Loose connection
Defective wireless LAN/Bluetooth card
1.
Check the connection.
2.
Replace the wireless LAN/Bluetooth card.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) USB interface error The USB interface cannot be used due to a driver error.
857
No. 858
CTL B
Defective USB driver
Loose connection
1.
Check the connection.
2.
Replace the USB board.
Type CTL C
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD Encryption unit error 1 A serious error occurs when data is encrypted to update an encryption key with the HDD encryption unit. [0]
SM Appendix
Encryption key acquisition error: The controller fails to get a new encryption key.
4-57 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
An error is detected in the wireless LAN/Bluetooth card.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Defective controller board
1.
Replace the controller board.
Encryption key setting for HDD error: The controller fails to copy a new encryption key to the HDD.
[1]
Defective SATA chip on the controller board
1.
Replace the controller board.
NVRAM data encryption error 1: An error occurs while the NVRAM data is encrypted.
[2]
Defective NVRAM on the controller board
1.
Replace the NVRAM.
NVRAM data encryption error 2: [30]
An error occurs before the NVRAM data is encrypted.
Defective controller board
1.
Replace the controller board.
Other error: [30]
A serious error occurs while the data is encrypted.
No. 859
Type CTL C
Same as SC991
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD Encryption unit error 2 A serious error occurs when the HDD data is encrypted to update an encryption key with the HDD encryption unit. HDD check error: The HDD is not correctly installed. [8]
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-58 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
No HDD installed
Unformatted HDD
The encryption key on the controller is different from the one on the HDD
1.
Install the HDD correctly.
1.
Initialize the HDD.
Power failure during the data encryption: The data encryption (NVRAM and HDD) has not been completed.
Power failure during the data encryption
1.
Initialize the HDD. Appendix: Service Call Conditions
[9]
Data read/write error: [10]
The DMAC error is detected twice or more.
No.
Type
Same as SC863
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD: Initialization error The controller detects that the hard disk fails.
860
No.
861
CTL B
Type
CTL D
HDD not initialized
Defective HDD
1.
Reformat the HDD.
2.
Replace the HDD.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD: Reboot error The HDD does not become ready within 30 seconds after the power is supplied to the HDD.
SM Appendix
4-59 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
Loose connection
Defective cables
Defective HDD
Defective controller
1.
Check the connection between the HDD and controller.
2.
Check and replace the cables.
3.
Replace the HDD.
4.
Replace the controller.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Bad sector number error
862
No.
CTL D
The number of bad sectors in the HDD goes over 101.
Defective HDD
1.
Format the HDD with SP5-832-002.
2.
Replace the HDD.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD: Read error The data stored in the HDD cannot be read correctly.
863
No. 864
CTL D
Type CTL
Defective HDD
Defective controller
1.
Replace the HDD.
2.
Replace the controller.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD: CRC error
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-60 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type D
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) While reading data from the HDD or storing data in the HDD, data transmission fails.
Defective HDD
Replace the HDD.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD: Access error
CTL D
An error is detected while operating the HDD.
Defective HDD Appendix: Service Call Conditions
865
Replace the HDD.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) SD card authentication error
866
CTL B
A correct license is not found in the SD card.
SD-card data is corrupted.
Store correct data in the SD card.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) SD card error
867
CTL
The SD card is ejected from the slot.
D
SM Appendix
1.
Install the SD card.
2.
Turn the main switch off and on.
4-61 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) SD card access error
868
No.
CTL D
-13 to -3: File system error
Other number: Device error
An error report is sent from the SD card reader.
An error is detected in the SD card.
1.
For a file system error, format the SD card on your PC.
2.
For a device error, turn the mains switch off and on.
3.
Replace the SD card.
4.
Replace the controller.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Address book error An error is detected in the data copied to the address book over a network.
870
No.
CTL
Defective software program
B
Defective HDD
Incorrect path to the server
1.
Initialize the address book data (SP5-846-050).
2.
Initialize the user information (SP5-832-006).
3.
Replace the HDD.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD mail data error
872
CTL B
An error is detected in the HDD at machine initialization.
Defective HDD
Power failure during an access to the HDD
1.
Turn the main switch off and on.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-62 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 2.
Initialize the HDD partition (SP5-832-007).
3.
Replace the HDD.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD mail transfer error
873
No.
CTL B
Defective HDD
Power failure during an access to the HDD
1.
Initialize the HDD partition (SP5-832-008).
2.
Replace the HDD.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Delete All error 1: HDD An error is detected while all of the HDD or NVRAM are formatted
874
No.
CTL D
physically by the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (D362).
DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (SD card) not installed
Defective HDD
1.
Install the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (D362).
2.
Replace the HDD.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Delete All error 2: Data area
875
CTL D
An error is detected while all of the HDD or NVRAM are formatted logically by the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (D362).
The logical format for the HDD fails.
Turn the main switch off/on and try the operation again
SM Appendix
4-63 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
An error is detected in the HDD at machine initialization.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Log Data Error
876
CTL D
An error was detected in the handling of the log data at power on or during machine operation. This can be caused by switching the machine off while it is operating. Log Data Error 1
-001
Damaged log data file in the HDD
Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004. Log Data Error 2 -002
An encryption module not installed
1.
Disable the log encryption setting with SP9730-004 ("0" is off.)
2.
Install the DESS module.
Log Data Error 3 -003
Invalid log encryption key due to defective NVRAM data
1.
Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004.
2.
Disable the log encryption setting with SP9730-004 ("0" is off.)
Log Data Error 4 -004
Unusual log encryption function due to defective NVRAM data
Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004. Log Data Error 5 -005
Installed NVRAM or HDD which is used in another machine
1.
Reinstall the previous NVRAM or HDD.
2.
Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004.
-099 Log Data Error 99
D037/D038/D040/D041
Other than the above causes
4-64 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Ask your supervisor.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) HDD Data Overwrite Security SD card error The 'all delete' function cannot be executed but the
No.
D
DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (D362) is installed and activated.
Defective SD card (D362)
SD card (D362) not installed
1.
Replace the NVRAM and then install the new SD card (D362).
2.
Check and reinstall the SD card (D362).
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) TPM system authentication error
878
CTL D
The system firmware is not authenticated by TPM (security chip).
Incorrect updating for the system firmware
Defective flash ROM on the controller board
Replace the controller board.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) File format converter error
880
CTL D
The file format converter does not respond.
Defective file format converter
Replace the file format converter.
SM Appendix
4-65 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
877
CTL
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables
4.1.10 SC9XX: MISCELLANEOUS
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Electric counter error Abnormal data in the counters.
900
No.
CTL
Defective NVRAM
D
Defective controller
1.
Check the connection between the NVRAM and controller.
2.
Replace the NVRAM.
3.
Replace the controller.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Printer application error An error is detected in the printer application program.
920
CTL
Defective software
D
Unexpected hardware resource (e.g., memory shortage)
1.
Software defective; switch off/on, or change the controller firmware if the problem is not solved
2.
No.
Type
Insufficient memory
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Printer font error
921
CTL D
A necessary font is not found in the SD card.
A necessary font is not found in the SD card.
The SD card data is corrupted.
Check that the SD card has the correct data.
D037/D038/D040/D041
4-66 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Software performance error The software makes an unexpected operation.
D
Defective software
Defective controller
Software error
1.
Turn the main switch off and on.
2.
Reinstall the controller and/or engine main firmware.
No.
Type
See Note 1 at the end of the SC table.
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Software continuity error The software has attempted to perform an unexpected operation.
991
CTL C
However, unlike SC 990, the object of the error is continuity of the software.
Software program error
Internal parameter incorrect, insufficient working memory.
This SC is not displayed on the LCD (logging only).
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Undefined error
992
CTL D
Defective software program
No. 995
Type D
SM Appendix
An error undetectable by any other SC code occurred
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) CPM setting error
4-67 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
990
CTL
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No. 995
Type D
-001
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) CPM setting error
Defective BCU
NVRAM replacement error
1.
Install the previous NVRAM on the BCU.
2.
Input the serial number with SP5811-004, and turn the main power switch off/on.
-002
Defective NVRAM on the controller
Defective controller
1.
Update the controller firmware.
2.
Install a new NVRAM, and turn off and on the main power switch after SC995-002 has occurred. Incorrect type controller installed
Defective controller
-003
-004
No.
1.
Replace the controller with the correct type.
Incorrect model controller installed.
1.
Replace the controller with the correct model.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Application function selection error
The application selected by the operation panel key does not start or ends abnormally.
997
CTL
Software (including the software configuration) defective
An option required by the application (RAM, DIMM, board) is not
B
installed
Nesting of the fax group addresses is too complicated
1.
Check the devices necessary for the application program. If necessary devices have not been installed, install them.
2.
D037/D038/D040/D041
Check that application programs are correctly configured.
4-68 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC Tables No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) 3.
For a fax operation problem, simplify the nesting of the fax group addresses.
4.
Take necessary countermeasures specific to the application program. If the logs can be displayed on the operation panel, see the logs.
No.
Type
Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures) Application start error
998
CTL D
Loose connection of RAM-DIMM, ROM-DIMM
Defective controller
Software problem
1.
Check the setting of SP5875-001. If the setting is set to "1 (OFF)", change it to "0 (OFF)".
2.
Check if the RAM-DIMM and ROM-DIMM are correctly connected.
3.
Reinstall the controller system firmware.
4.
Replace the controller.
Note 1 If a problem always occurs in a specific condition (for example. printer driver setting, image file), the problem may be caused by a software error. In this case, the following data and information needs to be sent back to your product specialist. Please understand that it may take some time to get a reply on how to solve the problem, because in some cases the design staff in Japan must analyze the data.
Symptom / Possible Causes / Action taken
Summary sheet (SP mode “Printer SP”, SP1-004 [Print Summary])
SMC - All (SP5-990-001)
SMC - Logging (SP5-990-004)
Printer driver settings used when the problem occurs
All data displayed on the screen (SC code, error code, and program address where the problem is logged.)
Image file which causes the problem, if possible
SM Appendix
4-69 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Service Call Conditions
No applications start within 60 seconds after the power is turned on.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
APPENDIX: PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Process Control Error Conditions
5. APPENDIX: PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS 5.1 PROCESS CONTROL ERROR CONDITIONS 5.1.1 DEVELOPER INITIALIZATION RESULT SP-3-014-001 (Developer Initialization Result)
No.
Result
Description
Possible Causes/Action
Developer 1
Successfully
initialization is
completed
successfully
-
completed. A cover was opened or the main switch was turned off during the initialization. 2
Forced termination
1.
Developer
Do the developer initialization again
initialization was
when done in SP mode. Reinstall the
forcibly terminated.
engine main firmware if the result is the same. 2.
Turn the main switch off and on when done at unit replacement.
6
Vt error
1.
Vt is more than 0.7V
development unit is not removed.
when Vcnt is 4.3V. Vcnt is less than 4.7V
7
8
Vcnt error 1
Vcnt error 2
SM Appendix
Make sure that the heat seal on the
2.
Defective TD sensor
1.
Defective TD sensor
when Vcnt is Vt target 2.
Vt target settings are not correct.
±0.2V.
3.
Toner density error
Vt is more than 0.7V
1.
Make sure that the heat seal on the
when Vcnt is 4.3V and
development unit is not removed.
5-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Process Control Error Conditions No.
Result
Description
Possible Causes/Action
Vcnt is less than 4.7V
2.
Defective TD sensor
1.
Make sure that the heat seal on the
when Vcnt is Vt target ±0.2V.
development unit is not removed 9
Vcnt error 3
Vcnt is less than 4.7V. 2.
Defective TD sensor
3.
Vt target settings are not correct.
4.
Toner density error
The machine starts developer initialization after you set “1” in SP3-902-005, 006, 007, or 008. Developer initialization automatically resumes when you open and close the front door or turn the main switch off and on if an error other than Error 8 occurs.
5.1.2 PROCESS CONTROL SELF-CHECK RESULT Displayed number shows results of each color sensor check. 00000000 = YYCCMMKK SP3-012-001 to -010 (Process Control Self-check Result)
No. Result
Description
Possible Causes/Action
Process control 11
Successfully
self-check
Check the Vsg adjustment. See the "Vsg
completed
successfully
Adjustment Result" following this table.
completed.
Defective development unit
Vt maximum error and an image is faint: 41
Vt error
Vt maximum or
1.
Replace the toner hopper unit.
minimum error is
Vt maximum error and an image is O.K:
detected.
1.
Replace the development unit.
2.
Replace the BCU board.
Vt minimum error:
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Process Control Error Conditions Description
Possible Causes/Action
ID sensor 53
Solid image is not sufficient density:
1.
Retry the process control.
2.
Replace the ID sensors.
3.
Replace the BCU board.
(K5) detection
be sampled.
1.
Replace the ID sensors.
2.
Replace the BCU board.
ID sensor is dirty:
1.
Clean the ID sensors.
2.
Retry the process control.
ID sensor pattern density is too high
(K5) minimum error
58
Solid image is O.K.
maximum/
57
Replace the BCU board.
coefficient
56
2.
Not enough data can
ID sensor
55
Replace the development unit.
coefficient error
54
1.
When the K5 is more than the value of
SP3-362-004, the
Same as 53
error 54 is displayed. Gamma is out of
Maximum
range. 5.0 < Gamma
Minimum
range. Gamma < 0.15
Vk is out of range.
Maximum
150 < Vk
Vk error:
Vk is out of range.
Minimum
Vk < –150
ID sensor pattern density is too high.
Hardware defective.
Same as 53
Gamma is out of
Vk error:
SM Appendix
ID sensor or shutter is defective.
than the value of
Gamma error:
Gamma error:
or low.
SP3-362-003 or less
ID sensor pattern density is too low.
Hardware defective.
1.
Same as 53
2.
Replace the toner hopper unit.
ID sensor pattern density is too low.
Hardware defective.
Same as 53
ID sensor pattern density is too high.
Background dirty
Hardware defective
5-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions
No. Result
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Process Control Error Conditions No. Result
Description
Possible Causes/Action Same as 53
Sampling data 59
error during
be sampled during the
gamma
gamma correction.
correction 99
Not enough data can
Unexpected
or low.
Hardware defective
Same as 53
Process control fails.
error
ID sensor pattern density is too high
Power Failure
Check the power source.
Vsg Adjustment Result SP3-325-001 to -010 (Vsg Adjustment Result)
No. Result 1
O.K
Description
Possible Causes/Action
Vsg adjustment is correctly done.
Dirty ID sensors (toner, dust, or foreign material)
2
ID sensor
Vsg cannot be
adjustment
adjusted within
error
4.0 ±0.5V.
Dirty image transfer belt
Scratched image transfer belt
Defective ID sensors
Poor connection
Defective BCU
1.
Clean the ID sensors.
2.
Check the ITB cleaning unit. Clean or replace the image transfer belt.
3
3.
Replace the image transfer belt.
4.
Replace the ID sensors.
5.
Check the connection.
6.
Replace the BCU board.
ID sensor
ID sensor output
Defective ID sensors
output error
is more than
Poor connection
D037/D038/D040/D041
5-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Process Control Error Conditions No. Result
9
Description
Possible Causes/Action
"Voffset
Defective BCU
Threshold"
1.
Replace the ID sensors.
(SP3-324-004)
2.
Check the connection.
3.
Replace the BCU board.
Other cases
Vsg
Vsg adjustment
Adjustment
has not been
error
completed.
Retry SP3-321-010.
5.1.3 LINE POSITION ADJUSTMENT RESULT SP2-194-010 to -012 (Line Position Adjustment Result: M, C, Y) This SP shows the number as a line position adjustment result on the LCD. It shows which
No. 0 1
2
Result
Description
Note
Not done
Line position adjustment has not been done.
-
Completed
Line position adjustment has correctly been
successfully
done,
Cannot detect
ID sensors have not detected the patterns for
patterns
line position adjustment.
Fewer lines on 3
the pattern than the target
The patterns, which ID sensors have detected, are not enough for line position adjustment.
-
See Note
See Note
More lines on 4
the pattern than
Not used in this machine.
-
-
-
the target 5-9
Not used
For details, see the "Troubleshooting Guide - Line Position Adjustment" section.
SM Appendix
5-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions
color has an error (M, Y or C).
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
APPENDIX: TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide
6. APPENDIX: TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE 6.1 TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE 6.1.1 IMAGE QUALITY The following work-flow shows the basic troubleshooting steps for the image quality problems on this product. Start
Can the problem be duplicated?
Verification of problem reported from users
Ask customer to duplicate it.
No
Yes
Image Quality?
No
Troubleshoot using the service manual or technical bulletin.
Yes Make copy in the enlargement or reduction mode.
Copy
Copy or Print?
Print
Location of the image problem shifted?
Make a test pattern using SP2-109.
Color related?
No
Troubleshoot depending on the type of problem.
Possible Symptoms
Yes
Vertical white dotted lines Check the transfer bias or paper condition. Vertical white lines on thick paper Check the timing when the problem occurs.
Yes
Dirty lines Check the transfer belt cleaning section. Poor fusing / Fusing offset Check the paper types selected in the printer driver. Smeared image at trailing edge Check the fusing unit speed. A
SM Appendix
B
Crow marks Check the humidity condition and adjust the transfer bias if necessary.
6-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
No problem on pattern * Font problem * Image data missing Especially, problems related to the above symptoms and if no problem is found on the test pattern, it may be related to the application used or driver. Collect a capture file for further investigation (select 'Print to File' in the driver).
b222t501
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Troubleshooting Guide
No
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide A
B Possible Symptoms Color shift Check the level of the color shift and follow the troubleshooting guide if required.
Problem is related to the scanner section.
Make a test print from SBU in SP4807 in each color.
Connection of cable between the i-controller and laser unit.
No Yes Color missing
Mirror position of related colour located in the laser unit. i-Controller or BCU board defective
No
No
Make a test print from IPU in SP4-417 by selecting related color.
Can the problem be duplicated?
All colors?
Check Points
Can the problem be duplicated?
Yes
Yes
Check the scanner section (exposure glass, mirrors, scanner movement, etc.)
No
Check the connection between the SBU/ iController or replace the SBU.
Specify the color that caused the image problem.
Check the image processing area of the color specified in the previous step
Yes Check connection between the BCU/ iController, or replace the i-Controller.
Considerable Symptoms Toner blasting Check which color is blasting and adjust the toner limit or transfer bias. Image density change Check when the problem is reported and follow the necessary steps. Dirty Background Check in which condition the problem is reported, and follow the required procedure. Color vertical bands/lines/dirty background Check the OPC drum and/or development unit. Color shift Check the level of the color shift and follow the troubleshooting guide if required. Color lines/bands/dirty background When the PCDU is close to its life end, the developer or the cleaning blade of the drum unit wears out, causing vertical color lines, bands, or dirty background. Check the related color unit and replace it if necessary.
d037t502
D037/D038/D040/D041
6-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide
6.1.2 LINE POSITION ADJUSTMENT When there are color registration errors on the output, do the line position adjustment as follows.
Use A3/DLT size paper for this adjustment.
Test 1.
Do SP2-111-003 (Mode c: rough adjustment).
2.
Use SP2-194-007 to check if the result of the line position adjustment is correct (0: Completed successfully, 1: Not completed). If the result is "1", refer to ‘Countermeasure list for color registration errors’.
3.
Do SP2-111-001 (Mode a: fine adjustment twice).
4.
Use SP2-194-007 to check if the result of the line position adjustment is correct (0: Completed successfully, 1: Not completed). If the result is "1", refer to ‘Countermeasure list for color registration errors’.
5.
Put some A3/DLT paper on the by-pass tray.
When you print a test pattern, use the by-pass tray to feed the paper.
6.
Print out test pattern "7" with SP2-109-003.
7.
Check the printed output with a loupe.
8.
If there are no color registration errors on the output, the line position adjustment is correctly done. If not, refer to the countermeasure list for color registration errors.
After Executing SP2-111-003
Result: "1" in SP2-194-007
Result: "2" or "3" (Line pattern detection failure) in SP2-194-010, -011, -012
Test pattern check
Possible cause/Countermeasure
Defective image processing unit
Low density of test pattern
White image, Abnormal image,
Defective i-controller
Low density
1.
Replace the high voltage power supply unit.
2.
Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply some toner (SP3-015-xxx).
SM Appendix
6-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Troubleshooting Guide
Countermeasure list for color registration errors
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide Test pattern check
Possible cause/Countermeasure 3.
Replace the BCU.
Defective ID sensors
Normal image, but with color
Defective BCU
registration errors
1.
Replace the ID sensor.
2.
Replace the BCU.
After Executing SP2-111-003
Result: "1" in SP2-194-007
One of results: "5" (Out of adjustable range) in SP2-194-010, -011, -012.
Test pattern check
Possible cause/Countermeasure
The main scan registrations of M,
Defective laser unit
C, Y are shifted by more than ±15
Defective BCU
mm from the main scan
1.
Replace the laser unit.
registration of K.
2.
Replace the BCU.
Defective image transfer belt
Defective drive units
The sub scan registrations of M,
C, Y are shifted by more than ±20
Defective BCU
mm from the sub scan
1.
Replace the image transfer belt.
registration of K.
2.
Replace the drum motor.
3.
Replace the BCU.
Defective ID sensor at center
The main scan registration is
Deformed center area on the image transfer belt
shifted by more than ±0.66 mm,
Defective BCU
but only at the central area of the 1. image on the output.
The skew for M, C, Y is more than ±0.75 mm from the main scan registration of K
D037/D038/D040/D041
Replace the ID sensor.
2.
Replace the image transfer belt.
3.
Replace the BCU.
Defective PCU
Defective laser unit
Defective BCU
1.
Reinstall or replace the BCU.
6-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide Test pattern check
Others
Possible cause/Countermeasure 2.
Replace the laser unit.
3.
Replace the BCU.
Skew correction upper limit error
Defective BCU
Defective laser unit
1.
Replace the BCU.
2.
Replace the laser unit.
After Executing SP2-111-003
Result: "1" in SP2-194-007
Result: "0" in SP2-194-010, -011, -012.
Test pattern check
Possible cause/Countermeasure Do SP2-111-001 or -002.
After Executing SP2-111-001
Result: "1" in SP2-194-007
Result: "2" or "3" (Line pattern detection failure) in SP2-194-010, -011, -012
Possible cause/Countermeasure
White image, Abnormal image,
Defective image processing unit
Low density
Low density of test pattern
Defective BCU
1.
Replace the high voltage power supply unit.
2.
Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply some toner (SP3-015-xxx).
3.
Replace the BCU.
Normal image, but with color
Defective ID sensor
registration errors
Defective BCU
1.
Replace the ID sensor.
2.
Replace the BCU.
SM Appendix
6-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Troubleshooting Guide
Test pattern check
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide
After Executing SP2-111-001
Result: "1" in SP2-194-007
Result: "5" (Out of adjustable range) in SP2-194-010, -011, -012
Test pattern check Low image density on the output
Possible cause/Countermeasure
Low pattern density
Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply some toner (SP3-015-xxx). The main scan registrations of M,
No defective component
C, Y are shifted by more than
Defective laser optics housing unit
±1.4 mm from the main scan
Defective BCU
registration of K.
1.
Do SP2-111-003 again.
2.
Replace the laser unit.
3.
Replace the BCU.
The sub scan registrations of M,
No defective component
C, Y are shifted by more than
Defective image transfer belt
±1.4mm from the sub scan
Defective drive units
registration of K.
Defective BCU
1.
Do SP2-111-003 again.
2.
Replace the image transfer belt.
3.
Replace the drum motor.
4.
Replace the BCU.
The main scan registration is
Defective ID sensor at center
shifted by more than ±0.66 mm,
Deformed center area on the image transfer belt
but only at the central area of the
Defective BCU
1.
Replace the ID sensor.
2.
Replace the image transfer belt.
3.
Replace the BCU.
The skew for M, C, Y is more
Defective PCDU
than ± 0.75 mm from the main
Defective laser unit
scan registration of K. – at the
Defective BCU
end of the scan line?
1.
Reinstall or replace the PCDU.
image on the output.
D037/D038/D040/D041
6-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide Test pattern check
Others
Possible cause/Countermeasure 2.
Replace the laser unit.
3.
Replace the BCU.
Skew correction upper limit error
Defective BCU
Defective laser unit
1.
Replace the BCU.
2.
Replace the laser unit.
After Executing SP2-111-001
Result: "0" in SP2-194-007
Result: No color registration errors in SP2-194-010, -011, -012
Test pattern check
Possible cause/Countermeasure
The main scan registration of K is
Abnormal SP setting value of main scan: K
shifted.
Adjust the value with SP2-101-001.
The main scan length of K is
shifted.
Abnormal SP setting value of main scan length detection: K
Adjust the value with SP2-102-001 and -003. Note: Appendix: Troubleshooting Guide
The setting value of these SPs should be same.
After Executing SP2-111-001
Result: "0" in SP2-194-007
Result: Color registration errors in SP2-194-010, -011, -012
Test pattern check Low image density on the output
Possible cause/Countermeasure
Low pattern density
Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply some toner (SP3-015-xxx). The main scan registration is
SM Appendix
Defective ID sensor at center
6-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide Test pattern check
Possible cause/Countermeasure
shifted, but only at the central
Deformed center area on the image transfer belt
area of the image on the output.
Defective BCU
1.
Replace the ID sensor.
2.
Replace the image transfer belt.
3.
Replace the BCU.
The main scan registrations of M,
Defective laser optics housing unit
C, Y are shifted.
Defective ID sensor
Defective BCU
Incorrect SP value
1.
Replace the laser optics housing unit.
2.
Replace the ID sensor.
3.
Replace the BCU.
4.
Adjust the value with SP2-182-004 to -021.
The sub scan registrations of M,
Defective image transfer belt
C, Y are shifted.
Defective drive units
Defective ID sensor
Defective BCU
Incorrect SP value
1.
Replace the image transfer belt.
2.
Replace the ID sensor.
3.
Replace the drum motor.
4.
Replace the BCU.
5.
Adjust the value with SP2-182-022 to -039.
Defective PCDU
Defective laser optics housing unit
Defective BCU
1.
Reinstall or replace the PCDU.
2.
Replace the laser optics housing unit.
3.
Replace the BCU.
The sub scan lines are shifted.
Defective PCDU
Shifted lines appear cyclically.
Defective drive unit
Drum phase adjustment error
The skew of M, C, Y is different.
D037/D038/D040/D041
6-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Troubleshooting Guide Test pattern check
Possible cause/Countermeasure 1.
Do SP1-902-001 (Drum phase adjustment); see Replacement and Adjustment – Drive Unit – Gear Unit for details.
2.
Reinstall or replace the PCDU.
3.
Check or replace the drive unit.
6.1.3 IMAGE PROBLEMS AT REGULAR INTERVALS If a defect occurs in the image at one of these intervals, the related component may be defective.
Development roller: 32 mm
PTR (Paper Transfer Roller): 75.0 mm
Drum: 94.2 mm
Fusing belt: 157.1 mm Appendix: Troubleshooting Guide
SM Appendix
6-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
APPENDIX: JAM DETECTION
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Jam Detection
7. APPENDIX: JAM DETECTION 7.1 JAM DETECTION 7.1.1 PAPER JAM DISPLAY SP7-507 shows the paper jam history.
CODE: Indicates the jam code.
SIZE: Indicates the paper Size Code.
TOTAL: Indicates the total counter (SP7-502-001).
DATE: indicates the date when the jam occurred.
Paper Size Code
Paper Size
Size Code
Paper Size
05
A4 LEF
141
B4 SEF
06
A5 LEF
142
B5 SEF
14
B5 LEF
160
DLT SEF
38
LT LEF
164
LG SEF
44
HLT LEF
166
LT SEF
132
A3 SEF
172
HLT SEF
133
A4 SEF
255
Others
134
A5 SEF
-
-
SM Appendix
7-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Jam Detection
Size Code
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Jam Detection
7.1.2 JAM CODES AND DISPLAY CODES Mainframe SP7-504 shows how many jams occurred at each location.
Jam Code
LCD
Display
Description
7504 1
At Power On
Paper is stack at power-on.
Note
7504 3
Tray 1: ON
Paper is not fed from tray 1.
A2
7504 4
Tray 2: ON
Paper is not fed from tray 2.
A1
7504 5
Tray 3: ON
7504 6
Tray 4: ON
Paper is not fed from tray 4.
Y
7504 8
Bypass: ON
Paper is not fed from the by-pass tray.
A2
7504 9
Duplex: ON
Paper is jammed at the duplex unit.
Vertical Transport 1:
Vertical transport sensor 1 does not
ON
detect paper from tray 1.
Vertical Transport 2:
Vertical transport sensor 2 does not
ON
detect paper from tray 2.
SP
7504 11
7504 12
Paper is not fed from tray 3 (one-tray
Y
paper feed unit).
Z A1
Y
Registration sensor does not detect
7504 17
Registration: ON
7504 18
Fusing Entrance: ON
7504 19
Fusing Exit: ON
7504 20
Paper Exit: ON
7504 21
Relay Exit: ON
D037/D038/D040/D041
Display
A2
paper. Fusing entrance sensor does not detect paper. Fusing exit sensor does not detect
C
paper. Paper exit sensor does not detect paper. Tray exit sensor (bridge unit) does not detect paper.
7-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
B
C D
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Jam Detection LCD
Display
Description
7504 24
Inverter Sn: ON
Inverter sensor does not detect paper.
7504 25
Duplex Exit: ON
7504 27
Duplex Entrance: ON
7504 28
1-Bin Exit Sensor
7504 29
R-tray Paper Exit: ON
SP
Display
Duplex exit sensor does not detect paper. Duplex entrance sensor does not detect paper. 1-bin tray exit sensor does not detect paper. Paper exit sensor of the side tray does not detect paper.
C Z
Z
C
C
Vertical Transport
Vertical transport sensor 1 does not turn
Sensor1
off.
Vertical Transport
Vertical transport sensor 2 does not turn
Sensor2
off.
Vertical Transport
Vertical transport sensor 3 does not turn
Sensor3
off.
Registration Sensor
Registration sensor does not turn off.
Fusing Entrance
Fusing entrance sensor does not turn
Sensor
off.
7504 59
Fusing Exit Sensor
Fusing exit sensor does not turn off.
C
7504 60
Exit Sensor
Paper exit sensor does not turn off.
C
7504 64
Inverter Sensor
Inverter sensor does not turn off.
C
7504 65
Duplex Exit Sensor
Duplex exit sensor does not turn off.
Z
Duplex Entrance
Duplex entrance sensor does not turn
Sensor
off.
1-Bin Exit: ON
1-bin tray exit sensor does not turn off.
7504 51
7504 52
7504 53 7504 57 7504 58
7504 67 7504 68
SM Appendix
7-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
A1, A2
Y
Y B C
Z R
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Jam Detection
Jam Code
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Jam Detection Jam Code SP 7504 69
Display
Description
R-tray Paper Exit
Paper exit sensor of the side tray does
Sensor
not turn off.
LCD Display W
The machine does not get paper exit
7504 230
FIN:Paper Exit Error
7504 231
FIN:Command Error
7504 240
Fin. Entrance: ON
7504 241
Fin. Entrance Sensor
R1, R2
data from the internal finisher. The machine gets a command error
R1, R2
from the internal finisher. Entrance sensor of the internal finisher
C, R1,
does not detect paper.
R2
Entrance sensor of the internal finisher
R1, R2
does not turn off. The mainframe detects the lock signal
7504 242
Feed-Out Belt Motor
from the paper transport motor of the
R1, R2
internal finisher. The mainframe detects the lock signal 7504 243
Stapler Motor
from the staple motor of the internal
R1, R2
finisher. The mainframe detects the lock signal 7504 244
Jogger Motor
from the front or rear jogger motor of the
R1, R2
internal finisher.
7504 245
7504 246
Pick-Up Roller Lift Motor
Stapler Unit Drive Motor
The mainframe detects the lock signal from the pick-up roller contact motor of
R1, R2
the internal finisher. The mainframe detects the lock signal from the stapler unit movement motor of
R1, R2
the punch unit. The mainframe detects the lock signal
7504 247
Output Tray Motor
from the feed motor of the internal
R1, R2
finisher.
D037/D038/D040/D041
7-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Jam Detection Jam Code SP
Display
7504 248
Belt Lift Solenoid
7504 249
Finisher Fan
7504 250
Punch Motor
LCD
Description
Display
The mainframe detects the belt lift solenoid error from the internal finisher. The mainframe detects the finisher fan error from the internal finisher. The mainframe detects the lock signal from the punch motor.
R1, R2
R1, R2
R1, R2
The mainframe detects the lock signal 7504 251
Finisher Proof Exit
from the registration motor of the punch
R1, R2
unit. 7504 252
7504 253
FIN:Stapler Position
The stapler unit stays on the jogger end
Error
fence so that stapling is disabled. Unexpected job data is sent to the
FIN:Job Data Error
internal finisher from the mainframe.
R1, R2
R1, R2
The jam location display depends on where a paper jam is detected at power-on.
ARDF (Original Jam)
LCD
Display
Description
7505 1
At Power On
Original is stack at power-on.
7505 3
Skew Correction: ON
7505 4
Registration: ON
7505 5
Paper Exit: ON
7505 53
Skew Correction: OFF Skew correction sensor does not turn
SP
SM Appendix
Display P
Skew correction sensor does not detect paper. Registration sensor does not detect paper. Exit Sensor does not detect paper.
7-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
P
P P P
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Jam Detection
Jam Code
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Jam Detection Jam Code SP
Display
Description
LCD Display
off. 7505 54
Registration: OFF
Registration sensor does not turn off.
P
7505 55
Paper Exit: OFF
Exit Sensor does not turn off.
P
D037/D038/D040/D041
7-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Jam Detection
Appendix: Jam Detection
Sensor Locations
SM Appendix
7-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
APPENDIX: ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Component Defects
8. APPENDIX: ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS 8.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS 8.1.1 SENSORS
No.
SW4
The CN numbers in the following table are the connector numbers on the IOB.
Sensor Name/ Sensor Board Name
Duplex Unit Open Switch
Active
CN
Condition
Open L
CN232/2 Shorted
Sxx
Sxx
Sxx
Sxx Sxx
ID Sensor: Front
A
CN214/8, 9
ID Sensor: Center
A
CN214/6, 7
ID Sensor: Rear
A
CN214/2, 3
H
CN232/4
L
CN214/11
ID Sensor Shutter Sensor
Registration Sensor
Drum Phase Sensor: K Drum Phase Sensor:
SM Appendix
H
CN220/2
H
CN220/17
Open/ Shorted Open/ Shorted Open/ Shorted Open/ Shorted
Symptom "Open Cover" is displayed. "Open cover" cannot be detected. SC258/ SC400
SC258/ SC400
SC258/ SC400
SC400
Open
Jam A2 (Jam17)
Shorted
Jam B (Jam57)
Open/ Shorted Open/
8-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC380/SC396 SC381/SC397
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Electrical Component Defects
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Component Defects No.
Sensor Name/ Sensor Board Name
Active
CN
CMY
Sxx Sxx Sxx Sxx
Sxx
Sxx
Open
Toner End Sensor - Y L
Toner End Sensor -
CN234/14,
Vertical Transport Sensor 1
Toner end cannot be detected. Toner end is detected
17, 20, 23 Shorted
M
ITB Rotation Sensor
Symptom
Shorted
Toner End Sensor - K Toner End Sensor - C
Condition
when there is enough toner.
H/L
CN219/20
L
CN219/10
Open/ Shorted
SC443
Open
Jam A1 (Jam11)
Shorted
Jam A1, A2 (Jam51) Paper end is not
Open Sxx
Paper End
Sxx
Sensor 1, 2
L
CN214/17,
detected when there is no paper in the paper tray.
19
Paper end is detected Shorted
when there is paper in the paper tray.
Sxx
Vertical Transport Sensor 2
L
CN219/15
Open
Jam Y (Jam12)
Shorted
Jam Y (Jam52)
Open/ SWx
Tray 1 Paper Size Switch
L
CN211/11,
Shorted
12, 13, 15 Shorted
S12 Sxx
By-pass Paper Size Sensor By-pass Paper End
D037/D038/D040/D041
L L
CN221/9,
Open/
10, 12, 13
Shorted
CN221/18
Open
8-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper size error Tray 1 is detected when tray 1 is not set. Paper size error
Paper on the by-pass
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Component Defects No.
Sensor Name/ Sensor Board Name
Active
CN
Condition
Symptom tray is not detected when paper is set.
Sensor
Paper on the by-pass Shorted
tray is detected when paper is not set.
Sxx
Sx
Sx
Sx
By-pass Paper Length Sensor
By-pass HP Sensor
Fusing Entrance Sensor Duplex Entrance Sensor
Duplex Exit Sensor
L
Open
Paper size error
Shorted H
CN221/21
L
CN214/14
L
L
Sx
TD Sensor - K
A
Sx
TD Sensor - M
A
Sx
TD Sensor - C
A
Sx
TD Sensor - Y
A
Sx
Fusing Exit Sensor
L
SM Appendix
CN221/15
CN221/24
CN221/27
Open/ Shorted
SC508
Open
Jam B (Jam18)
Shorted
Jam C (Jam58)
Open
Jam Z (Jam27)
Shorted
Jam Z (Jam67)
Open
Jam Z (Jam25)
Shorted
Jam Z (Jam65)
CN212/B9,
Open/
B11
Shorted
CN212/A9,
Open/
A11
Shorted
CN212/A3,
Open/
A5
Shorted
CN212/A3,
Open/
A5
Shorted
CN227/18
Open
8-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SC372
SC373
SC374
SC375 Jam C (Jam19)
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Electrical Component Defects
Sxx
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Component Defects No.
Sensor Name/ Sensor Board Name
Active
CN
Condition Shorted
Symptom Jam C (Jam59) Used toner near full
Open
near full.
PCDU Toner Sxx
Collection Bottle Full
indicated when it is not
H
CN211/9
Used toner near full
Sensor Shorted
cannot be detected when the waste toner bottle is nearly full. Toner collection bottle
Open PCDU Toner SWx
Collection Bottle Set
L
is not detected when the waste toner bottle is set.
CN211/7
Toner collection bottle
Switch Shorted
is detected when the waste toner bottle is not set. Used toner near full
Open
Sxx
ITB Toner Collection Bottle Full Sensor
indicated when it is not near full.
H
CN211/4
Used toner near full Shorted
cannot be detected when the waste toner bottle is nearly full.
SWx
Tray 2 Paper Size Switch
L
CN211/16,
Open/
17, 18, 20
Shorted
Paper size error Printed image has
Sx
Temperature/ Humidity Sensor
A
CN222/15,
Open/
some problems such as
17
Shorted
rough image, dirty background, weak
D037/D038/D040/D041
8-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Component Defects No.
Sensor Name/ Sensor Board Name
Active
CN
Condition
Symptom image or poor fusing.
TH1
TH2
TH3
S3
Sxx
Sxx
Sxx
Thermopile Heating Roller Thermistor Pressure Roller Thermistor 1 (Center) Pressure Roller Thermistor 2 (Ends)
Paper Exit Sensor
Original Length Sensor 1 Original Length Sensor 2
Scanner HP Sensor
A
CN237/14
A
CN233/4
A
CN233/11
A
CN233/9
L
CN227/21
A
CN206/2
A
CN206/5
H
CN205/2
Sxx
Platen Cover Sensor
L
CN205/5
Sxx
ITB Contact Sensor
L
CN234/5
Sx
Inverter Sensor
L
CN227/15
SWx
Right Lower Door Open Switch
SM Appendix
L
CN219/13
Open/ Shorted Open/ Shorted Open/ Shorted Open/ Shorted
SC541
SC551
SC561
SC571
Open
Jam C (Jam20)
Shorted
Jam C (Jam60)
Open/
Original paper size
Shorted
cannot be detected.
Open/
Original paper size
Shorted
cannot be detected.
Open
SC120
Shorted
SC121
Open/
Platen cover open
Shorted
cannot be detected.
Open/ Shorted
SC442
Open
(Jam 24)
Shorted
Jam C (Jam64)
Open
8-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
"Open Cover" is displayed.
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: Electrical Component Defects
Sxx
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Component Defects No.
Sensor Name/ Sensor Board Name
Active
CN
Condition
Shorted
Symptom "Open cover" cannot be detected.
8.1.2 BLOWN FUSE CONDITIONS Power Supply Unit
Rating
Fuse
Symptom when turning on the main switch
115V
220V - 240V
FU101
15A/125V
8A/250V
FU102
10A/125V
5A/250V
FU103
2A/250V
2A/250V
FU4
5A/250V
5A/250V
FU5
5A/250V
5A/250V
5V power to the BCU is not supplied.
FU6
5A/250V
5A/125V
5VS power to the i-controller is not supplied.
FU7
10A/125V
10A/125V
24VS power to the BCU is not supplied.
FU8
10A/125V
10A/125V
24VS power to the BCU is not supplied.
FU9
6.3A/125V
6.3A/125V
The i-controller works, but SC547 is issued. (5V power to the fusing unit is not supplied.) No response. (5V power to the PSU is not supplied.) 5V power to the scanner heater and tray heater is not supplied. 5V power to the i-controller and BCU is not supplied.
24V power to the DRB and i-controller is not supplied.
For continued protection against risk of fire, replace only with same type and rating of fuse.
D037/D038/D040/D041
8-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
APPENDIX: SP MODE TABLES
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
9. APPENDIX: SP MODE TABLES 9.1 SYSTEM SERVICE MODE 9.1.1 SERVICE MODE TABLE SP1-XXX (Feed)
[Leading Edge Registration] Leading Edge Registration Adjustment (Tray Location, Paper Type, Color Mode), Paper Type -> Plain, Thick 1, Thick 1001
2 or Thick3 Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the registration motor operation timing for each mode. *ENG
002 Tray:Thick1:600dpi
*ENG
003 Tray:M-Thick:600dpi
*ENG
004 By-pass:Plain:600dpi
*ENG
005 By-pass:Thick1:600dpi
*ENG
006 By-pass:Thick2:600dpi
*ENG
007 By-pass:Thick3:600dpi
*ENG
008 By-pass: M-Thick:600dpi
*ENG
009 Duplex:Plain:600dpi
*ENG
010 Duplex:M-Thick:600dpi
*ENG
011 Tray:Thick1:1200dpi
*ENG
012 Tray:M-Thick:1200dpi
*ENG
[–9 to 9 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]
[–9 to 9 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Tray:Plain:600dpi
013 By-pass:Plain:M-Thick:1200dpi *ENG 014 By-pass:Plain:1200dpi
SM Appendix
*ENG
9-1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 015 By-pass:Thick1:1200dpi
*ENG
016 By-pass:Thick2:1200dpi
*ENG
017 By-pass:Thick3:1200dpi
*ENG
018 By-pass:M-Thick:1200dpi
*ENG
019 Duplex:Plain:1200dpi
*ENG
020 Duplex:M-Thick:1200dpi
*ENG
[Side-to-Side Registration] 1002
Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the laser main scan start position for each mode. 001 By-pass
*ENG
002 Paper Tray 1
*ENG
003 Paper Tray 2
*ENG
004 Paper Tray 3
*ENG
005 Paper Tray 4
*ENG
006 Duplex
*ENG
[–4 to 4 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]
[Paper Buckle] Paper Buckle Adjustment 1003
(Tray Location, Paper Type), Paper Type: N: Normal, TH: Thick Adjusts the amount of paper buckle at the registration roller by changing the paper feed timing. 001 Tray1:Plain:600dpi
*ENG
002 Tray1:Thick1:600dpi
*ENG
003 Tray1:M-Thick:600dpi
*ENG
004 Tray234:Plain:600dpi
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[–5 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
9-2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode *ENG
006 Tray234:M-Thick:600dpi
*ENG
007 By-pass:Plain:600dpi
*ENG
008 By-pass:Thick1:600dpi
*ENG
009 By-pass:Thick2:600dpi
*ENG
010 By-pass:Thick3:600dpi
*ENG
011 By-pass:M-Thick:600dpi
*ENG
012 Duplex:Plain:600dpi
*ENG
013 Duplex:M-Thick:600dpi
*ENG
014 Tray1:Plain:1200dpi
*ENG
015 Tray1:Thick1:1200dpi
*ENG
016 Tray1:M-Thick:1200dpi
*ENG
017 Tray1:Thick1:1200dpi
*ENG
018 Tray234:Thick1:1200dpi
*ENG
019 Tray234:M-Thick:1200dpi
*ENG
020 By-pass:Plain:1200dpi
*ENG
021 By-pass:Thick1:1200dpi
*ENG
022 By-pass:Thick2:1200dpi
*ENG
023 By-pass:Thick3:1200dpi
*ENG
024 By-pass:M-Thick:1200dpi
*ENG
025 Duplex:Plain:1200dpi
*ENG
026 Duplex:M-Thick:1200dpi
*ENG
[–5 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
005 Tray234:Thick1:600dpi
SM Appendix
9-3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 1007
[By-Pass Size Detection] By-Pass Size Detection Display 0:LT SEF/ 1:LG
*ENG
-
Enables or disables the automatic paper size detection function of the by-pass 001 tray. This SP determines what paper size the machine detects if the detected size is less than 8.5”. 0: OFF (Letter/SEF), 1: ON (Legal/SEF)
1101
[Flicker Control] [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 Flicker Control
*ENG
0: Flicker Control: OFF 1: Flicker Control: ON
1103
[Fusing Idling] Fusing Idling Adjustment
011 Idling Start Temp.
*ENG
[0 to 75 / 75 / 1 deg/step]
012 Forced Idling Stop
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
013 Forced Idling Stop Temp.
*ENG
[100 to 180 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
014 Minimum Idling Time
*ENG
[0 to 10 / 2 / 1 sec/step] Specifies how long the extra idling operation is executed for each
016 Extra Idling Time (L)
*ENG
environment. [0 to 60 / 0 / 1 sec/step] Each environment is determined with SP1112-001 and 002.
017 Extra Idling Time (H)
*ENG
018 Extra Idling Time (M)
*ENG
019 Ex Idling Temp:P-Roll
*ENG
[0 to 160 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
020 Control Switch Temp
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
9-4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
1104
[Fusing Idling Before Job]
001 Environment Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 2 / 1 /step]
002 Idling Temp:P-Roll
*ENG
[0 to 160 / 150 / 1 /step]
003 Idling Time: BW
*ENG
004 Idling Time: FC
*ENG
005 Idling Time: M-Thick: BW
*ENG
006 Idling Time: M-Thick: FC
*ENG
007 Paper Feed Temp:P-Roller
*ENG
008 P.Feed Temp:MThick:P-Roll:BW
*ENG
009 P.Feed Temp:MThick:P-Roll:FC
*ENG
010 Fusing Upper Limit Temp
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 15/ 1 deg/step]
011 Offset: Feed Start
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 25/ 1 deg/step]
012 Offset: Feed Start: M-Thick
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 10/ 1 deg/step]
031 Offset:Feed Start:1200dpi
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 deg/step]
033 Offset: Feed Start: Glossy
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 15/ 1 deg/step]
1105
[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
[0 to 10 / 2 / 1 sec/step]
[0 to 130 / 50/ 1 deg/step]
[Fusing Temperature] Fusing Temperature Adjustment (Printing Mode, Roller Type, [Color], Simplex/Duplex) Roller Type –> Center and Ends: Heating roller, Pressure –> Pressure roller Paper Type -> Plain, Thin, Thick, OHP, Middle Thick, Special
001
Fusing Ready Temp.
*ENG
[145 to 155 / 150 / 1 deg/step]
006
P-Roll Ready Target Temp.
SM Appendix
*ENG
[140 to 160 / 140 / 1 deg/step]
9-5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Pressure Ready Temp
*ENG
[0 to 150 / 20 / 1 deg/step]
007 Sets the heating roller offset temperature at the end of the heating roller. This value is one of the thresholds to determine if the machine is at the heating roller target temperature during warm-up. 010 Stand-By: Center
* ENG
[140 to 170 / 160 / 1 deg/step]
011 Stand-By: End
* ENG
[140 to 170 / 165 / 1 deg/step]
* ENG
[135 to 165 / 155 / 1 deg/step]
Stand-By:P-Roller
012 Sets the pressure roller offset temperature. This value is one of the thresholds to determine if the machine is at the heating roller target temperature during warm-up. 013 Panel Off Mode: Center
* ENG
[100 to 150 / 130 / 1 deg /step]
014 Panel Off Mode: Ends
* ENG
[100 to 150 / 130 / 1 deg /step]
015 Panel Off Mode: P-Roller
*ENG
[135 to 165 / 150 / 1 deg /step]
016 Low Power: Center
*ENG
017 Low Power: Ends
*ENG
018 Low Power: P-Roller
*ENG
019 Off Mode: Center
*ENG
020 Off Mode: Ends
*ENG
021 Off Mode:P-Roller
*ENG
[0 to 170 / 0 / 1 deg /step]
030 Plain:FC:Simplex:Center
*ENG
[125 to 175 / 145 / 1 deg /step]
031 Plain: FC: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
032 Plain:FC:Duplex:Center
*ENG
033 Plain: FC: Duplex: Ends
*ENG
034 Plain: BW: Simplex:Center
*ENG
035 Plain: BW: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[30 to 100 / 40 / 1 deg /step]
[30 to 155 / 100 / 1 deg /step]
[0 to 180 / 0 / 1 deg /step]
9-6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 036 Plain: BW: Duplex:Center
*ENG
037 Plain: BW: Duplex: Ends
*ENG
038 Thin: FC: Simplex:Center
*ENG
039 Thin: FC: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
040 Thin:FC:Duplex:Center 041 Thin:FC:Duplex:Ends
[125 to 175 / 140 / 1 deg /step]
042 Thin: BW: Simplex:Center
*ENG
043 Thin: BW: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
044 Thin: BW: Duplex:Center
*ENG
045 Thin:BW:Duplex:Ends 046 Thick 1: FC: Simplex:Center
*ENG
047 Thick 1: FC: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
048 Thick 1: FC: Duplex:Center
*ENG
049 Thick 1: FC: Duplex:Ends
*ENG
050 Thick 1: BW: Simplex:Center
*ENG
051 Thick 1: BW: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
052 Thick 1: BW: Duplex:Center
*ENG
[135 to 180 / 150 / 1 deg /step]
053 Thick 1:BW:Duplex:Ends 054 Thick 2: FC: Simplex:Center
*ENG
055 Thick 2: BW: Simplex:Center
*ENG
056 OHP: FC
*ENG
[125 to 175 / 160 / 1 deg /step]
057 OHP: BW
*ENG
[125 to 175 / 150 / 1 deg /step]
058 SP 1:FC:Simplex:Center
*ENG
[125 to 175 / 155 / 1 deg/step]
SM Appendix
9-7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[135 to 180 / 160 / 1 deg /step]
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 059 SP 1:FC:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
060 SP 1:FC:Duplex:Center
*ENG
061 SP 1:FC:Duplex:Ends
*ENG
062 SP 1:BW:Simplex:Center
*ENG
063 SP 1:BW:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
064 SP 1:BW:Duplex:Center
*ENG
065 SP 1: BW: Duplex: Ends
*ENG
066 SP 2:FC:Simplex:Center
*ENG
067 SP 2: FC: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
068 SP 2:FC:Duplex:Center
*ENG
069 SP 2:FC:Duplex:Ends
*ENG
070 SP 2:BW:Simplex:Center
*ENG
071 SP 2:BW:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
072 SP 2:BW:Duplex:Center
*ENG
073 SP 2:BW:Duplex:Ends
*ENG
074 SP 3:FC:Simplex:Center
*ENG
075 SP 3:FC:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
076 SP 3:FC:Duplex:Center
*ENG
077 SP 3:FC:Duplex:Ends
*ENG
078 SP 3:BW:Simplex:Center
*ENG
079 SP 3:BW:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
080 SP 3:BW:Duplex:Center
*ENG
081 SP 3:BW:Duplex:Ends
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[125 to 175 / 160 / 1 deg/step]
[125 to 175 / 150 / 1 deg/step]
9-8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Target Temp. After Ready 082
*ENG
[140 to 165 / 160 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the target temperature for the maintain mode after the machine has reached the target temperature in warm-up mode. Recovery Target Temp.
083
*ENG
[140 to 160 / 155 / 1 deg /step]
Specifies the target temperature for the print mode without printing/copying job after the machine's recovery. *ENG
088 Thick 2: BW: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
089 Thick 3: FC: Simplex: Center
*ENG
090 Thick 3: FC: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
091 Thick 3: BW: Simplex: Center
*ENG
092 Thick 3: BW: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
109 M-Thick:FC:Simplex:Center
*ENG
110 M-Thick:FC:Duplex:Center
*ENG
111 M-Thick: BW: Simplex:Center
*ENG
112 M-Thick: BW: Duplex:Center
*ENG
113 M-Thick: FC: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
114 M-Thick: FC: Duplex: Ends
*ENG
115 M-Thick: BW: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
116 M-Thick: BW: Duplex: Ends
*ENG
120 Plain2: FC: Simplex:Center
*ENG
121 Plain2: FC: Simplex:Ends
*ENG
122 Plain2: FC: Duplex:Center
*ENG
123 Plain2: FC: Duplex:Ends
*ENG
SM Appendix
[135 to 180 / 160 / 1 deg/step]
[135 to 180 / 165 / 1 deg/step]
[125 to 175 / 155 / 1 deg/step]
[125 to 175 / 150 / 1 deg/step]
9-9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
087 Thick 2: FC: Simplex: Ends
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 124 Plain2: BW: Simplex:Center
*ENG
125 Plain2: BW: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
126 Plain2: BW: Duplex:Center
*ENG
127 Plain2: BW: Duplex: Ends
*ENG
128 F: Plain1: FC : Simplex:Center
*ENG
129 F: Plain1: FC : Simplex: Ends
*ENG
130 F: Plain1: BW : Simplex:Center
*ENG
131 F: Plain1: BW : Simplex: Ends
*ENG
132 F: Plain2: FC: Simplex:Center
*ENG
133 F: Plain2: FC: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
134 F: Plain2: BW: Simplex:Center
*ENG
135 F: Plain2: BW: Simplex: Ends
*ENG
136
137
138
139
F: Middle Thick: FC:
F: Middle Thick: FC: Simplex: Ends
*ENG [110 to 160 / 130 / 1 deg /step]
F: Middle Thick: BW:
*ENG
Simplex:Center F: Middle Thick: BW: Simplex:
*ENG
142 Glossy: Plain1:Center
*ENG
143 Glossy: Plain1: Ends
*ENG
144 Glossy: Plain2:Center
*ENG
145 Glossy: Plain2: Ends
*ENG
146 Glossy: MThick:Center
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[110 to 160 / 125 / 1 deg /step]
*ENG
Simplex:Center
Ends
[110 to 160 / 120 / 1 deg/step]
[110 to 160 / 125 / 1 deg/step]
[110 to 160 / 130 / 1 deg/step]
[110 to 160 / 135 / 1 deg/step]
9-10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode *ENG
148 SP 4:FC:Simplex:Center
*ENG
149 SP 4:FC:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
150 SP 4:FC:Duplex:Center
*ENG
151 SP 4:FC:Duplex:Ends
*ENG
152 SP 4:BW:Simplex:Center
*ENG
153 SP 4:BW:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
154 SP 4:BW:Duplex:Center
*ENG
155 SP 4:BW:Duplex:Ends
*ENG
156 SP 5:FC:Simplex:Center
*ENG
157 SP 5:FC:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
158 SP 5:FC:Duplex:Center
*ENG
159 SP 5:FC:Duplex:Ends
*ENG
160 SP 5:BW:Simplex:Center
*ENG
161 SP 5:BW:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
162 SP 5:BW:Duplex:Center
*ENG
163 SP 5:BW:Duplex:Ends
*ENG
164 SP 6:FC:Simplex:Center
*ENG
165 SP 6:FC:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
166 SP 6:FC:Duplex:Center
*ENG
167 SP 6:FC:Duplex:Ends
*ENG
168 SP 6:BW:Simplex:Center
*ENG
169 SP 6:BW:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
SM Appendix
[135 to 180 / 150 / 1 deg/step]
[135 to 180 / 150 / 1 deg/step]
[135 to 180 / 160 / 1 deg/step]
[135 to 180 / 145 / 1 deg/step]
9-11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
147 Glossy: MThick: Ends
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 170 SP 6:BW:Duplex:Center
*ENG
171 SP 6:BW:Duplex:Ends
*ENG
172 F:SP 1:FC:Simplex:Center
*ENG
173 F:SP 1:FC:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
174 F:SP 1:BW:Simplex:Center
*ENG
175 F:SP 1:BW:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
176 F:SP 2:FC:Simplex:Center
*ENG
177 F:SP 2:FC:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
178 F:SP 2:BW:Simplex:Center
*ENG
179 F:SP 2:BW:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
180 F:SP 3:FC:Simplex:Center
*ENG
181 F:SP 3:FC:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
182 F:SP 3:BW:Simplex:Center
*ENG
183 F:SP 3:BW:Simplex:Ends
*ENG
[110 to 160 / 130 / 1 deg/step]
[110 to 160 / 135 / 1 deg/step]
[110 to 160 / 125 / 1 deg/step]
[Fusing Temperature Display] Fusing Temperature Display (Heating or 1106
Pressure) Displays the current temperature of the heating and pressure rollers.
001 Fusing Roller: Center
-
[–20 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
002 Fusing Roller: Ends
-
[–10 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
The heating roller has two lamps. One heats the center of the heating roller and the other heats both ends of the heating roller. 003 Pressure Roller: Center
-
[–10 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
004 Pressure Roller:Ends
-
[–10 to 250 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode The pressure roller has one lamp.
1108
[Ready Temp Setting] Japan use only
007 Ready Temp Time
1109
*ENG
[22 to 60 / 22 / 0.1 sec/step]
[Fusing Nip Band Check] [0 or 1 / 0 / 1] Executes the nip band measurement
001
Execute
between fusing belt and pressure roller.
-
If the nip band width is not 8 mm, and fusing is not good, replace the pressure roller or install a new fusing unit.
Pre-Idling Time
002
*ENG
[0 to 120 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
Specifies the fusing rotation time before executing SP1109-001. Stop Time
003
* ENG
[5 to 30 / 20 / 1 sec/step]
Specifies the time for measuring the nip.
1112
001
[Environmental Correct: Fusing] Temp.: Threshold: Low
*ENG
[10 to 23 / 17 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the threshold temperature for low temperature condition.
002
Temp.: Threshold: High
*ENG
[24 to 40 / 30 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the threshold temperature for high temperature condition. *ENG
[0 to 15 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
003 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller. When the low temperature condition (specified with SP1112-001) is detected, the value of this SP is added to the heating roller temperature.
SM Appendix
9-13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Low Temp. Correction
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode High Temp. Correction
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
004 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller. When the high temperature condition (specified with SP1112-002) is detected, the value of this SP is subtracted from the heating roller temperature. 005 Offset Temp:Low
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 6.5 / 0.1 deg/step]
006 Offset Temp:High
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 5 / 0.1 deg/step]
1113
[Stand-by Mode Setting]
001
Wait Time AF Ready
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 20 / 1 sec/step]
Wait Time AF Recovery
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 10 / 1 sec/step]
003
Specifies the time for keeping the target temperature after recovery (SP1105-083) without any jobs.
004
Wait Time AF Job
*ENG
005
P-Roll Thresh AF Ready
*ENG
006
P-Roll Thresh AF Job
*ENG
008
ON/OFF Time SW Timer
*ENG
[0 to 999 / 300 / 1 sec/step]
1115
[Stand-by Idling] *ENG
[0 to 240 / 60 / 1 min/step]
Interval 001
[0 to 60 / 10 / 1 sec/step]
[0 to 160 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the interval between idling during stand-by mode. This idling during the stand-by mode prevents the roller deformation.
002
Idling Time
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 2 / 0.1 sec/step]
Specifies the length of each idling operation during stand-by mode. 003 Idling Speed
1116
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 mm/sec/step]
[Fusing Temp Change]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Center Temp. 1: 226–
ENG
[-10 / 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
010 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (center) when the paper width is 226 mm or more. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-018. Ends Temp. 1: 226–
ENG
[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
011 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (ends) when the paper width is 226 mm or more. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-018. Center Temp. 2: 226–
ENG
[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
012 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (center) when the paper width is 226 mm or more. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-019. Ends Temp. 2: 226–
ENG
[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
013 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (ends) when the paper width is 226 mm or more. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-019. Center Temp. 3: –226
ENG
[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
014 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (center) when the paper width is less than 226 mm. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-020. Ends Temp. 3: –226
ENG
[-10 to 10 / -5 / 1 deg/step]
015 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (ends) when the paper width is less than 226 mm. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-020. Center Temp. 4: –226
ENG
[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
paper width is less than 226 mm. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-021.
SM Appendix
9-15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
016 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (center) when the
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Ends Temp. 4: –226
ENG
[-10 to 10 / -10 / 1 deg/step]
017 Specifies the temperature correction for the heating roller (ends) when the paper width is less than 226 mm. The start time of this SP can be adjusted with SP1116-021. Control Time 1: 226–
018
ENG
[0 to 250 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
Specifies the start time of the temperature correction that is set with SP1116-010 and -011. The temperature correction is added when the time specified with this SP has passed after feeding the paper. Control Time 2: 226–
019
ENG
[0 to 250 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
Specifies the start time of the temperature correction that is set with SP1116-012 and -013. The temperature correction is added when the time specified with this SP has passed after feeding the paper. Control Time 3: –226
020
ENG
[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
Specifies the start time of the temperature correction that is set with SP1116-014 and -015. The temperature correction is added when the time specified with this SP has passed after feeding the paper. Control Time 4: –226
021
ENG
[0 to 250 / 60 / 1 sec/step]
Specifies the start time of the temperature correction that is set with SP1116-016 and -017. The temperature correction is added when the time specified with this SP has passed after feeding the paper.
022 Center Temp.1:Duplex:226-
ENG
023 Ends Temp.1:Duplex:226-
ENG
024 Center Temp.2:Duplex:226-
ENG
025 Ends Temp.2:Duplex:226-
ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 026
027
Control Time 1 Duplex 226
ENG
Center Temp.3:MThick:-226 Control Time 2 Duplex 226
ENG
Ends Temp.3:MThick:-226
028 Center Temp.4:MThick:-226
ENG
029 Ends Temp.4:MThick:-226
ENG
030 Center Temp.1:Other:226-
ENG
031 Ends Temp.1:Other:226-
ENG
032 Center Temp.2:Other:226-
ENG
033 Ends Temp.2:Other:226-
ENG
034 Center Temp.3:Other:-226
ENG
035 Ends Temp.3:Other:-226
ENG
036 Center Temp.4:Other:-226
ENG
037 Ends Temp.4:Other:-226
ENG
1117
[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
[-10 to 10 / -5 / 1 deg/step]
[-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
[Idling Time After Heater OFF] After Ready
001
[-10 to 10 / -5 / 1 deg/step]
ENG
[0 to 4 / 4 / 1 sec/step] DFU
Specifies the idling time without the lamp on after reaching the ready temperature. After Job End
002
ENG
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
Specifies the idling time without the lamp on after job end. This idling prevents the heating roller overheating after job end.
[Curl Temp Correction]
001 Operation Pattern
SM Appendix
*ENG
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
1118
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1]
9-17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 002 Humidity Thresh 1
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %]
003 Humidity Thresh 2
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 80 / 1 %]
004 Pattern 1: MM: H-Roll
*ENG
[-15 to 0 / -5 / 1 deg]
005 Pattern 1: MM: P-Roll
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]
006 Pattern 1: HM: H-Roll
*ENG
[-15 to 0 / -5 / 1 deg]
007 Pattern 1: HM: P-Roll
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]
008 Pattern 2: MM: H-Roll
*ENG
[-15 to 0 / -5 / 1 deg]
009 Pattern 2: MM: P-Roll
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]
010 Pattern 2: HM: H-Roll
*ENG
[-15 to 0 / -5 / 1 deg]
011 Pattern 2: HM: P-Roll
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 deg]
1119
[Fusing FF Correct]
001 Plain: Center
*ENG
002 Plain: Ends
*ENG
003 Thin: Center
*ENG
004 Thin: Ends
*ENG
005 M-Thick: Center
*ENG
006 M-Thick: Ends
*ENG
007 Thick1: Center
*ENG
008 Thick1: Ends
*ENG
009 Thick2: Center
*ENG
010 Thick2: Ends
*ENG
011 Thick3: Center
*ENG
012 Thick3: Ends
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 %]
[0 to 100 / 50 / 1 %]
[0 to 100 / 70 / 1 %]
9-18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 013 OHP: Center
*ENG
014 OHP: Ends
*ENG
015 SP 1: Center
*ENG
016 SP 1: Ends
*ENG
017 SP 2: Center
*ENG
018 SP 2: Ends
*ENG
019 SP 3:: Center
*ENG
020 SP 3: Ends
*ENG
021 Envir. Correct:Low
*ENG
022 Envir. Correct:High
*ENG
023 Envir. Correct: Center
*ENG
024 FF Correct:Ends
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 40 / 1 %]
[0 to 100 / 70 / 1 %]
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 %]
[-100 to 100 / 10 / 1 %]
[-100 to 100 / 0 / 1 %]
[FF Correct Time] 025 FF Correct Time
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 0 / 1 sec]
[FF Control thresh] 026 Offset:Center
*ENG
027 Offset:Ends
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 25 / 1 deg]
[FF Start Time] *ENG
[0 to 10000 / 1900 / 1msec]
029 Fgate Timer:BW:Full
*ENG
[0 to 10000 / 5300 / 100msec]
030 Fgate Timer:BW:Full
*ENG
[0 to 10000 / 0 / 100msec]
031 Fgate Timer:BW:Half
*ENG
[0 to 10000 / 400 / 100msec] Appendix: SP Mode Tables
028 Fgate Timer:FC:Full
[FF Correct Time]
SM Appendix
9-19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 032 Time Set:Full
*ENG
033 Time Set:Half
*ENG
034 SP 4:Center
*ENG
035 SP 4:Ends
*ENG
036 SP 5:Center
*ENG
037 SP 5:Ends
*ENG
038 SP 6:Center
*ENG
039 SP 6:Ends
*ENG
1120
[100 to 0 / 70 / 1msec]
[100 to 0 / 60 / 1msec]
[Multi-Print Mode] Feed Condition
001
[-5000 to 5000 / 0 / 100msec]
*ENG
[0 or 2 / 0 / 1]
Selects the paper feed timing. 0: Productivity priority, 1: Fusing quality priory
1159
[Fusing Jam Detection] SC Display
001
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]
Enables or disables the fusing consecutive jam (three times) SC detection. 0: No detection, 1: Detection
1801
[Motor Speed Adjust] FA
001 Regist Mot:60:Thick
*ENG
002 Regist Mot:120
*ENG
003 Bk OpcDevMot:120
*ENG
004 Bk OpcDevMot:60:Thick
*ENG
005 Color OpcMot:120
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[–4 to 4 / 0.3 / 0.05 %/step]
[–4 to 4 / –0.4 / 0.01 %/step]
[–15 to 15 / 0 / 1 %/step]
9-20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 006 Color OpcMot:60
*ENG
007 Fusing Mot:120
*ENG
[–6 to 6 / -0.4 / 0.01 %/step]
008 Fusing Mot:60:Thick
*ENG
[–6 to 6 / -0.05 / 0.01 %/step]
009 Transfer Mot:120
*ENG
[–4 to 4 / 0 / 0.01 %/step]
010 TransferMot:60:Thick
*ENG
[–4 to 4 / 0 / 0.01 %/step]
011 Feed1:CW60:Thick
*ENG
012 Feed1:CW120
*ENG
013 Feed1:CCW60:Thick
*ENG
014 Feed1:CCW120
*ENG
015 Feed12:CW60:Thick
*ENG
016 Feed12:CW120
*ENG
017 Feed12:CCW60:Thick
*ENG
018 Feed12:CCW120
*ENG
019 By-pass:60:Thick
*ENG
020 By-pass:120
*ENG
021 Reverse:CW60:Thick
*ENG
022 Reverse:CW120
*ENG
023 Reverse:CCW60:Thick
*ENG
024 Reverse:CCW120
*ENG
025 Duplex Entrance:60
*ENG
026 Duplex Entrance:120
*ENG
027 Duplex Exit:60
*ENG
028 Duplex Exit:120
*ENG
SM Appendix
[–2 to 2 / 0.3 / 0.05 %/step]
[–2 to 2 / 0 / 0.05 %/step]
9-21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[–2 to 2 / 0.3 / 0.05 %/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 029 R-Tray Exit Motor
*ENG
[–2 to 2 / 0 / 0.05 %/step]
030 Fine Adj. Control
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 /1]
031 Offset:120:Color
*ENG
032 Offset:60:Color
*ENG
033 Regist Mot:60:1200dpi
*ENG
034 Feed1:CW60:1200dpi
*ENG
035 Feed1:CCW60:1200dpi
*ENG
036 Feed12:CW60:1200dpi
*ENG
037 Feed12:CCW60:1200dpi
*ENG
038 By-pass:60:1200dpi
*ENG
039 Reverse:CW60:1200dpi
*ENG
040 Reverse:CCW60:1200dpi
*ENG
041 Fusing:Thin Nrml Mid
*ENG
[–6 to 6 / -0.05 / 0.01 %/step]
042 BkOpcDevMot:60:1200dpi
*ENG
[–4 to 4 / -0.4 / 0.01 %/step]
043 TransferMot:60:1200dpi
*ENG
[–4 to 4 / 0 / 0.01 %/step]
1802
[–4 to 4 / 0.3 / 0.05 %/step]
[–2 to 2 / 0.3 / 0.05 %/step]
[–2 to 2 / 0 / 0.05 %/step]
[CPM Setting]
001 -
1803
[-7 to 7 / 0 /1step]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
[Sub Mag ADJ]
001 Plain:600dpi:input
*ENG
002 Plain:1200dpi:input
*ENG
003 Thick:input
*ENG
004 Plain:600dpi:result
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[-1 to 1 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
9-22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 005 Plain:1200dpi:result
*ENG
006 Thick:result
*ENG
1902
[Drum Phase Adj.]
001 Execute
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]
-
Execute drum phase adjustment. [0 to 3 / 0 / 1] Displays the result of drum phase
002 Result
*ENG
adjustment. 0: Successfully done 2: Sampling failure 3: Insufficient detection number [0 or 1 / 1 / 1]
003 Auto Execution
*ENG
Turns the automatic drum phase adjustment on or off. 0: Off, 1: On
1907
[Inverter Timing Adj]
001 Inverter Position Adj.
*ENG
[–10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[Feed Timing Adj] 002 R-Tray J-Gate SOL:ON
*ENG
003 R-Tray J-Gate SOL:OFF
*ENG
[Fan Cooling Time Set]
001 Development Fan1
*ENG
002 Development Fan2
*ENG
003 Imaging Fan
*ENG
SM Appendix
[0 to 600 / 0 / 1sec/step]
9-23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
1950
[–10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 004 Fusing Exit Sn Fan
*ENG
005 Fusing Exit Fan
*ENG
006 Electrical Fan
*ENG
007 PSU Fan
*ENG
008 Solenoid Cooling Fan
*ENG
SP2-XXX (Drum) [Charge DC V:Fixed] 2005
(Paper Type, Process Speed, Color) Paper Type –> Plain, Thick 1, Thick 2 Adjusts the DC component of the charge roller bias in the various print modes. Charge bias (DC component) is automatically adjusted during process control; therefore, adjusting these settings does not effect while process control mode (SP3-041-1 Default: ON) is activated. When deactivating process control mode with SP3-041-1, the values in these SP modes are used for printing.
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: C
*ENG
003 Plain: M
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
005 Thick 2&FINE: Bk
*ENG
006 Thick 2&FINE: C
*ENG
007 Thick 2&FINE: M
*ENG
008 Thick 2&FINE: Y
*ENG
[0 to 1000 / 600 / 10 –V/step]
[Charge DC V:Fixed] 2006
(Paper Type, Process Speed, Color) Paper Type –> Plain, Thick 1, Thick 2
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Adjusts the AC component of the charge roller bias in the various print modes. Charge bias (AC component) is adjusted by environment correction (SP2-007-xxx to SP2-011-xxx). These SPs are activated only when SP2-012-1 is set to "1: manual control". 001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: C
*ENG
003 Plain: M
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
009 Thick 2&FINE: Bk
*ENG
010 Thick 2&FINE: C
*ENG
011 Thick 2&FINE: M
*ENG
012 Thick 2&FINE: Y
*ENG
[0 to 3000 / 2100 / 10V/step]
[Charge AC A: LL] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for LL 2007
(Color) Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for LL environment (Low temperature and Low humidity). DFU
001 Environmental Target: Bk
*ENG
002 Environmental Target: C
*ENG
003 Environmental Target: M
*ENG
[0 to 3000 / 760 / 10 ųA/step]
004 Environmental Target: Y
*ENG
[0 to 3000 / 750 / 10 ųA/step]
[0 to 3000 / 710 / 10 ųA/step]
[Charge AC A: ML] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for MM (Color) Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for ML environment (Middle temperature and Low humidity). DFU
SM Appendix
9-25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2008
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001 Environmental Target: Bk
*ENG
002 Environmental Target: C
*ENG
003 Environmental Target: M
*ENG
[0 to 3000 / 760 / 10 ųA/step]
004 Environmental Target: Y
*ENG
[0 to 3000 / 750 / 10 ųA/step]
[0 to 3000 / 740 / 10 ųA/step]
[Charge AC A: MM] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for MM 2009
(Color) Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for MM environment (Middle temperature and Middle humidity). DFU
001 Environmental Target: Bk
*ENG
002 Environmental Target: C
*ENG
003 Environmental Target: M
*ENG
004 Environmental Target: Y
*ENG
[0 to 3000 / 790 / 10 ųA/step]
[0 to 3000 / 850 / 10 ųA/step]
[Charge AC A: MH] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for MH 2010
(Color) Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for MH environment (Middle temperature and High humidity). DFU
001 Environmental Target: Bk
*ENG
002 Environmental Target: C
*ENG
003 Environmental Target: M
*ENG
[0 to 3000 / 840 / 10 ųA/step]
004 Environmental Target: Y
*ENG
[0 to 3000 / 880 / 10 ųA/step]
[0 to 3000 / 820 / 10 ųA/step]
[Charge AC A: HH] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for HH 2011
(Color) Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for HH environment
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-26 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode (High temperature and High humidity). DFU 001 Environmental Target: Bk
*ENG
002 Environmental Target: C
*ENG
003 Environmental Target: M
*ENG
[0 to 3000 / 840 / 10 ųA/step]
004 Environmental Target: Y
*ENG
[0 to 3000 / 940 / 10 ųA/step]
2012
[0 to 3000 / 860 / 10 ųA/step]
[Charge Output Control] Selects the AC voltage control type. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 AC Voltage
*ENG
0: Process control 1: Manual control (AC voltages are decided with SP2006.)
2013
[Envir. Correct:PCU] Displays the environmental condition, which is measured in absolute humidity. [1 to 5 / – / 1 /step]
001 Envir. Range:FC:Display
*ENG
1: LL (LL <= 4.3 g/m3) 2: ML (4.3 < ML <= 11.3 g/m3) 3: MM (11.3 < MM <= 18.0 g/m3) 4: MH (18.0 < MH <= 24.0 g/m3) 5: HH (24.0 g/m3 < HH) Selects the environmental condition manually.
002 Forced Setting
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: The environmental condition is 1: LL, 2: ML, 3: MM, 4: MH, 5: HH
003 Absolute Humidity: Thresh 1
SM Appendix
*ENG
Changes the humidity threshold
9-27 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
determined automatically.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode between LL and ML. [0 to 100 / 4.3 / 0.01 g/m3/step] Changes the humidity threshold 004 Absolute Humidity: Thresh 2
*ENG
between ML and MM. [0 to 100 / 11.3 / 0.01 g/m3/step] Changes the humidity threshold
005 Absolute Humidity: Thresh 3
*ENG
between MM and MH. [0 to 100 / 18.0 / 0.01 g/m3/step] Changes the humidity threshold
006 Absolute Humidity: Thresh 4
*ENG
between MH and HH. [0 to 100 / 24.0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
007 Current Temp.: Display
*ENG
008 Relative Humidity: Display
*ENG
009 Absolute Humidity: Display
*ENG
Displays the current temperature. [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step] Displays the current relative humidity. [0 to 100 / 0 / 1%RH/step] Displays the absolute humidity. [0 to 100 / 0 / 0.01 g/m3/step] Displays the previous environmental
010
condition, which is measured in
Previous Envir. Range:
*ENG
Display
absolute humidity. [1 to 5 / – / 1 /step] 1: LL, 2: ML, 3: MM, 4: MH, 5: HH
011 Previous Temp.: Display
*ENG
Displays the previous temperature. [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step] Displays the previous relative
012 Relative Humidity: Display
*ENG
humidity. [0 to 100 / 0 / 1%RH/step] Displays the previous absolute
013 Absolute Humidity: Display
*ENG
humidity. [0 to 100 / 0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-28 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
2014
[Charge AC Control: Setting]
001 Main Interval: Power ON
*ENG
002 Main Interval: Print
*ENG
003 Sub: Interval
*ENG
[0 to 500 / 10 / 1 page/step]
004 Sub:Thresh Temp
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 25 / 1 deg/step]
005 Sub:R-Humid Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]
006 Sub:A-Humid Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 12 / 1 g/m3/step]
007 Main:Temp Change Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 10 / 1 deg/step]
008 Main:RH Change Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]
009 Main:AH Change Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]
010 Sub:Temp Change Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 20 / 1 / 0.1 deg/step]
011 Sub:RH Change Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 5 / 1 %RH/step]
012 Sub:AH Change Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 20 / 1 / 0.1 g/m3/step]
013 Non-use Time
*ENG
[0 to 1440 / 360 / 10 min/step]
014 Correction Coeff.
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 1 / 0.01 kV/mA/step]
2015
[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]
[Charge AC Adj: Result] *ENG
002 C
*ENG
003 M
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 /step]
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Bk
SM Appendix
9-29 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [Color Regist Adjust] FA These values are the parameters for the automatic line position adjustment 2101
and are adjusted at the factory. However, you must input a value for SP2101-001 after replacing the laser optics housing unit. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section. The value should be provided with the new laser optics housing unit.
001 Bk: Main Scan: Dot
*ENG
002 C Main Scan: Dot
*ENG
003 M Main Scan: Dot
*ENG
004 Y Main Scan: Dot
*ENG
013 Bk: Sub Scan: Line
*ENG
014 C: Sub Scan: Line
*ENG
015 M: Sub Scan: Line
*ENG
016 Y: Sub Scan: Line
*ENG
2102
[–512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]
[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]
[Magnification Adjust] DFU
001 Main Mag.: Bk:High Spd
*ENG
003 Main Mag.: Bk:Low Spd
*ENG
004 Main Mag.: C:High Spd
*ENG
006 Main Mag.: C:Low Spd
*ENG
007 Main Mag.: M:High Spd
*ENG
009 Main Mag.: M:Low Spd
*ENG
010 Main Mag.: Y:High Spd
*ENG
012 Main Mag.: Y:Low Spd
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
These are results of the main scan length adjustment. [0 to 560 / 280 / 1 /step]
9-30 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 2103
[Erase Margin Adjust] (Area, Paper Size) Adjusts the erase margin by deleting image data at the margins.
001 Lead Edge
*ENG
002 Trailing Edge
*ENG
003 Left
*ENG
004 Right
*ENG
2104
[0 to 9.9 / 2 / 0.1 mm/step]
[LD Initial Power Adjust]
001 Bk
*ENG
002 C
*ENG
003 M
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
2105
[0 to 9.9 / 4.2 / 0.1 mm/step]
[80 to 120 / 100 / 1 %/step]
[LD Power Adjust] (Process Speed, Color) Adjusts the LD power of each color for each process speed. Each LD power setting is decided by process control. High Speed: 120 mm/sec,Low Speed: 60 mm/sec *ENG
002 C: High Speed
*ENG
003 M: High Speed
*ENG
004 Y: High Speed
*ENG
009 Bk: Low Speed
*ENG
010 C: Low Speed
*ENG
011 M: Low Speed
*ENG
012 Y: Low Speed
*ENG
SM Appendix
[50 to 120 / 100 / 1%/step] Decreasing a value makes lines thinner on the output. Increasing a value makes lines thicker on the output.
9-31 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Bk: High Speed
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
2106
[Polygon Rotation Time] Adjusts the time of the polygon motor rotation. DFU
001 Warming-Up
*ENG
002 Job End
*ENG
2107
[0 to 60 / 10 / 1 sec/step]
[Image Parameter] DFU
001 Image Gamma Flag
*ENG
002 Shading Correction Flag
*ENG
2109
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
[Test Pattern] Generates the test pattern using "COPY Window" tab in the LCD. [0 to 23 / 0 / 1/step] 0 None 1: Vertical Line (1dot) 2: Vertical Line (2dot) 3: Horizontal (1dot) 4: Horizontal (2dot) 5: Grid Vertical Line 6: Grid Horizontal Line
003 Pattern Selection
-
7: Grid pattern Small 8: Grid pattern Large 9: Argyle Pattern Small 10: Argyle Pattern Large 11. Independent Pattern (1dot) 12. Independent Pattern (2dot) 13. Independent Pattern (4dot) 14. Trimming Area 16: Hound’s Tooth Check (Horizontal)
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-32 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 17: Band (Horizontal) 18: Band (Vertical) 19: Checker Flag Pattern 20: Grayscale Vertical Margin 21: Grayscale Horizontal Margin 23: Full Dot Pattern Specifies the color for the test pattern. 005 Color Selection
[1 to 4 / 1 / 1/step]
-
1: All colors, 2: Magenta, 3: Yellow, 4: Cyan
006 Density: Bk
-
007 Density: C
-
008 Density: M
-
009 Density: Y
-
2111
Specifies the color density for the test pattern. [0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step] 0: Lightest density 15: Darkest density
[Line Pos. Ajust] Executes the fine line position adjustment twice.
001 Execute: Mode a
-
If this SP is not completed (NG is displayed), do SP2111-003 first and then try this SP again. Executes the fine line position adjustment
002 Execute:Mode b
-
once. If this SP is not completed, do SP2111-003 first and then try this SP again. Executes the rough line position adjustment once.
-
After doing this SP, make sure to execute SP2111-001 or -002. Otherwise, the line position adjustment is not perfectly done.
SM Appendix
9-33 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
003 Execute:Mode c
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 2112
[TM/P Sensor Test] ID Sensor Check FA This SP is used to check the ID sensors at
001 Execute
the factory. The results of this SP are displayed in SP2140 to SP2145.
[Skew Adjustment]
2117
Specifies a skew adjustment value for the skew motor M, C or Y. These SPs must be used when a new laser optics housing unit is installed or when SC285 occurs. For details, see “Laser Optics Housing Unit” in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section.
001 Pulse: C
*ENG
002 Pulse: M
*ENG
003 Pulse: Y
*ENG
2118
[–75 to 75 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
[Skew Adjustment]
001 Execute: C
*ENG
002 Execute: M
*ENG
Changes the current skew adjustment values to the values specified with SP2117. These SPs must be used when a new laser optics housing unit is installed or when
003 Execute: Y
SC285 occurs. For details, see “Laser
*ENG
Optics Housing Unit” in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section.
2119
[Skew Adjustment Display] Displays the current skew adjustment value for each skew motor.
001 C
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 Y
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[–75 to 75 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
9-34 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [P-Sensor Test] 2140
Displays the maximum result values of the ID sensor check. Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment
001 PWM
*ENG
[TM-Sensor Test] DFU 005 PWM: Front
*ENG
006 PWM: Center
*ENG
007 PWM: Rear
*ENG
[0 to 1024 / 0 / 1/step]
[P-Sensor Test] 2141
Displays the maximum result values of the ID sensor check. Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment
001 Average
*ENG
[TM-Sensor Test] DFU 005 Average: Front
*ENG
006 Average: Center
*ENG
007 Average: Rear
*ENG
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]
[P-Sensor Test] DFU 2142
Displays the maximum result values of the ID sensor check. Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control
001 Maximum
*ENG
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]
[TM-Sensor Test] DFU
SM Appendix
9-35 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 005 Maximum: Front
*ENG
006 Maximum: Center
*ENG
007 Maximum: Rear
*ENG
[P-Sensor Test] DFU 2143
Displays the minimum result values of the ID sensor check. Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment
001 Minimum
*ENG
[TM-Sensor Test] DFU 005 Minimum: Front
*ENG
006 Minimum: Center
*ENG
007 Minimum: Rear
*ENG
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]
[P-Sensor Test] DFU 2144
Displays the maximum result 2 values of the ID sensor check. Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment
001 Maximum 2:
*ENG
[TM-Sensor Test] DFU 005 Maximum 2: Front
*ENG
006 Maximum 2: Center
*ENG
007 Maximum 2: Rear
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]
9-36 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [P-Sensor Test] DFU 2145
Displays the minimum result 2 values of the ID sensor check. Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment
001 Minimum 2
*ENG
[TM-Sensor Test] DFU 005 Minimum 2: Front
*ENG
006 Minimum 2: Center
*ENG
007 Minimum 2: Rear
*ENG
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]
[Area Mag. Correction] LD Pulse Area Correction (Color, Area) FA Adjusts the magnification for each area. The main scan (297 mm) is divided 2150
into 8 areas. Area 1 is at the front side of the machine (left side of the image) and area 8 is at the rear side of the machine (right side of the image). Decreasing a value makes the image shift to the left side on the print. Increasing a value makes the image shift to the right side on the print. 1 pulse = 1/16 dot *ENG
028 Bk: Area1
*ENG
029 Bk: Area2
*ENG
030 Bk: Area3
*ENG
031 Bk: Area4
*ENG
032 Bk: Area5
*ENG
033 Bk: Area6
*ENG
034 Bk: Area7
*ENG
035 Bk: Area8
*ENG
SM Appendix
[-256 to 255 / 0 / 1sub-dot/step]
Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0. [–256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step ]
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
027 Bk: Area0
9-37 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 079 C: Area0
*ENG
080 C: Area
*ENG
081 C: Area2
*ENG
082 C: Area3
*ENG
083 C: Area4
*ENG
084 C: Area5
*ENG
085 C: Area6
*ENG
086 C: Area7
*ENG
087 C: Area8
*ENG
131 M: Area0
*ENG
132 M: Area1
*ENG
133 M: Area2
*ENG
134 M: Area3
*ENG
135 M: Area4
*ENG
136 M: Area5
*ENG
137 M: Area6
*ENG
138 M: Area7
*ENG
139 M: Area8
*ENG
183 Y: Area0
*ENG
[–256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]
184 Y: Area1
*ENG
Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0.
185 Y: Area2
*ENG
186 Y: Area3
*ENG
187 Y: Area4
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[-256 to 255 / 0 / 1sub-dot/step]
Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0. [–255 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]
[-256 to 255 / 0 / 1sub-dot/step]
Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0. [–256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]
[–256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]
9-38 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 188 Y: Area5
*ENG
189 Y: Area6
*ENG
190 Y: Area7
*ENG
191 Y: Area8
*ENG
[Shading Correct Setting] FA Adjusts the area correction value for each LD power. The main scan is divided into 16 areas. However, the image areas are limited 2152
from area 1 to area 14. For BK and Magenta, area 1 is at the rear side of the machine (left side of the image) and area 14 is at the front side of the machine (right side of the image). For Cyan and Yellow, area 1 is at the front side of the machine (right side of the image) and area 14 is at the rear side of the machine (left side of the image). *ENG
002 Bk: Area 1
*ENG
003 Bk: Area 2
*ENG
004 Bk: Area 3
*ENG
005 Bk: Area 4
*ENG
006 Bk: Area 5
*ENG
007 Bk: Area 6
*ENG
008 Bk: Area 7
*ENG
009 Bk: Area 8
*ENG
010 Bk: Area 9
*ENG
011 Bk: Area 10
*ENG
012 Bk: Area 11
*ENG
013 Bk: Area 12
*ENG
SM Appendix
This is for the synchronizing detection board. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Bk: Area 0
9-39 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 014 Bk: Area 13
*ENG
015 Bk: Area 14
*ENG
016 Bk: Area 15
*ENG
033 C: Area 0
*ENG
034 C: Area 1
*ENG
035 C: Area 2
*ENG
036 C: Area 3
*ENG
037 C: Area 4
*ENG
038 C: Area 5
*ENG
039 C: Area 6
*ENG
040 C: Area 7
*ENG
041 C: Area 8
*ENG
042 C: Area 9
*ENG
043 C: Area 10
*ENG
044 C: Area 11
*ENG
045 C: Area 12
*ENG
046 C: Area 13
*ENG
047 C: Area 14
*ENG
048 C: Area 15
*ENG
This is out of the image area. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
This is for the synchronizing detection board. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
This is out of the image area. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step] This is for the synchronizing detection
065 M: Area 0
*ENG
board. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
066 M: Area 1
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
9-40 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 067 M: Area 2
*ENG
068 M: Area 3
*ENG
069 M: Area 4
*ENG
070 M: Area 5
*ENG
071 M: Area 6
*ENG
072 M: Area 7
*ENG
073 M: Area 8
*ENG
074 M: Area 9
*ENG
075 M: Area 10
*ENG
076 M: Area 11
*ENG
077 M: Area 12
*ENG
078 M: Area 13
*ENG
079 M: Area 14
*ENG
080 M: Area 15
*ENG
This is out of the image area. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step] This is for the synchronizing detection
097 Y: Area 0
*ENG
board. [50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
*ENG
099 Y: Area 2
*ENG
100 Y: Area 3
*ENG
101 Y: Area 4
*ENG
102 Y: Area 5
*ENG
103 Y: Area 6
*ENG
SM Appendix
[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
098 Y: Area 1
9-41 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 104 Y: Area 7
*ENG
105 Y: Area 8
*ENG
106 Y: Area 9
*ENG
107 Y: Area 10
*ENG
108 Y: Area 11
*ENG
109 Y: Area 12
*ENG
110 Y: Area 13
*ENG
111 Y: Area 14
*ENG
112 Y: Area 15
*ENG
2160
[Vertical Line Width] DFU
001 600dpi:Bk
*ENG
002 600dpi:C
*ENG
003 600dpi:M
*ENG
004 600dpi:Y
*ENG
005 1200dpi:Bk
*ENG
006 1200dpi:C
*ENG
007 1200dpi:M
*ENG
008 1200dpi:Y
*ENG
2180
This is out of the image area.
[10 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
[Line Pos. Adj. Clear]
001 Color Regist.
-
003 MUSIC Result
-
004 Area Mag. Correction
-
D037/D038/D040/D041
DFU
9-42 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
2181
[Line Pos. Adj. Result] Displays the values for each correction.
"Paper Int. Mag: Subdot" indicates the magnification correction value between two sheets of paper.
"Mag.Cor. Subdot" indicates the magnification correction value.
"M. Scan Erro." indicates the shift correction value in the main scan direction.
"S. Scan Erro." Indicates the shift correction value in the sub scan direction.
"M. Cor.: Dot" indicates the dot correction value in the main scan direction.
"M. Cor.: Subdot" indicates the sub dot correction value in the main scan direction. Bk: Black, M: Magenta, C: Cyan, Y: Yellow
001 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: Bk
*ENG
[–32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
002 Mag.Cor. Subdot: Bk
*ENG
[–32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
003 Skew: C
*ENG
004 Bent: C
*ENG
005 M. Scan Shift: Left: C
*ENG
006 M. Scan Shift: Center: C
*ENG
007 M. Scan Shift: Right: C
*ENG
008 S. Scan Shift: Left: C
*ENG
009 S. Scan Shift: Center: C
*ENG
010 S. Scan Shift: Right: C
*ENG
011 M. Cor.: Dot: C
*ENG
[–512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]
012 M. Cor.: Subdot: C
*ENG
[–15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
013 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: C
*ENG
[–32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
014 Mag.Cor. Subdot: C
*ENG
SM Appendix
[–5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]
9-43 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 015 M. Left Mag.: Subdot: C
*ENG
016 M. Right Mag.: Subdot: C
*ENG
017 S. Cor.: 600 Line: C
*ENG
[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]
018 S. Cor.: 600 Subdot: C
*ENG
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
019 S. Cor.: 1200 Line: C
*ENG
[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]
020 S. Cor.: 1200 Subdot: C
*ENG
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
021 Skew: M
*ENG
022 Bent: M
*ENG
023 M. Scan Shift: Left: M
*ENG
024 M. Scan Shift: Center: M
*ENG
025 M. Scan Shift: Right: M
*ENG
026 S. Scan Shift: Left: M
*ENG
027 S. Scan Shift: Center: M
*ENG
028 S. Scan Shift: Right: M
*ENG
029 M. Cor.: Dot: M
*ENG
[–512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]
030 M. Cor.: Subdot: M
*ENG
[–15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
031 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: M
*ENG
032 Mag.Cor. Subdot: M
*ENG
033 M. Left Mag.: Subdot: M
*ENG
034 M. Right Mag.: Subdot: M
*ENG
035 S. Cor.: 600 Line: M
*ENG
[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]
036 S. Cor.: 600 Subdot: M
*ENG
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
037 S. Cor.: 1200 Line: M
*ENG
[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
[–5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]
[–32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
9-44 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 038 S. Cor.: 1200 Subdot: M
*ENG
039 Skew: Y
*ENG
040 Bent: Y
*ENG
041 M. Scan Shift: Left: Y
*ENG
042 M. Scan Shift: Center: Y
*ENG
043 M. Scan Shift: Right: Y
*ENG
044 S. Scan Shift: Left: Y
*ENG
045 S. Scan Shift: Center: Y
*ENG
046 S. Scan Shift: Right: Y
*ENG
047 M. Cor.: Dot: Y
*ENG
[–512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]
048 M. Cor.: Subdot: Y
*ENG
[–15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
049 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: Y
*ENG
050 Mag.Cor. Subdot: Y
*ENG
051 M. Left Mag.: Subdot: Y
*ENG
052 M. Right Mag.: Subdot: Y
*ENG
053 S. Cor.: 600 Line: Y
*ENG
[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]
054 S. Cor.: 600 Subdot: Y
*ENG
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
055 S. Cor.: 1200 Line: Y
*ENG
[–16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]
056 S. Cor.: 1200 Subdot: Y
*ENG
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
057 S. Cor.: 600 Subdot
*ENG
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
058 Drum Cor.:600:Subdot
*ENG
[–7 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]
059 S. Cor.:1200 Subdot
*ENG
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
060 Drum Cor.:1200:Subdot
*ENG
[–7 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]
SM Appendix
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
[–5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]
9-45 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[–32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [Line Position Adj. Offset] 2182
(Color) M. Scan: Main scan, S. Scan: Sub-scan High / Medium: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 C Magnification
*ENG
002 M Magnification
*ENG
Adjusts the line position manually. [-1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001%/step] When line shifts are not corrected by the automatic line position adjustment, do this SP.
003 Y Magnification
*ENG
Increasing a value reduces the image in the main scan direction. Decreasing a value enlarges the image in the main scan direction.
004 M. Scan: High: Dot: C
*ENG
[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]
005 M. Scan: High: Subdot: C
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
008 M. Scan: Low: Dot: C
*ENG
[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]
009 M. Scan: Low: Subdot: C
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
010 M. Scan: High: Dot: M
*ENG
[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]
011 M. Scan: High: Subdot: M
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
014 M. Scan: Low: Dot: M
*ENG
[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]
015 M. Scan: Low: Subdot: M
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
016 M. Scan: High: Dot: Y
*ENG
[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]
017 M. Scan: High: Subdot: Y
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
020 M. Scan: Low: Dot: Y
*ENG
[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]
021 M. Scan: Low: Subdot: Y
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
022 S. Scan: High: Dot: C
*ENG
[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line]
023 S. Scan: High: Subdot: C
*ENG
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
026 S. Scan: Low: Dot: C
*ENG
[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-46 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 027 S. Scan: Low: Subdot: C
*ENG
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
028 S. Scan: High: Dot: M
*ENG
[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line]
029 S. Scan: High: Subdot: M
*ENG
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
032 S. Scan: Low: Dot: M
*ENG
[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line]
033 S. Scan: Low: Subdot: M
*ENG
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
034 S. Scan: High: Dot: Y
*ENG
[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line]
035 S. Scan: High: Subdot: Y
*ENG
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
038 S. Scan: Low: Dot: Y
*ENG
[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line]
039 S. Scan: Low: Subdot: Y
*ENG
[–1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
040 C:Skew
*ENG
041 M:Skew
*ENG
042 Y:Skew
*ENG
[Line Pos. Adj. Mode]
001 Paper Int. Mag.: Subdot: Bk
*ENG
002 Paper Int. Mag.: Subdot: C
*ENG
003 Paper Int. Mag.: Subdot: M
*ENG
004 Paper Int. Mag.: Subdot: Y
*ENG
005 M. Scan Mag.: Subdot: C
*ENG
006 M. Scan Mag.: Subdot: M
*ENG
007 M. Scan Mag.: Subdot: Y
*ENG
008 Area Mag.: Subdot: C
*ENG
009 Area Mag.: Subdot: M
*ENG
010 Area Mag.: Subdot: Y
*ENG
SM Appendix
DFU [0 or 1 / 1 / 1 boolean/step]
DFU [0 or 1 / 1 / 1 boolean /step] 0: Disable correction 1: Enable correction
DFU [0 or 1 / 1 / 1 boolean /step]
9-47 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2190
[-50 to 50 / 0 / 1um]
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode DFU [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 boolean /step] 011 S. Scan Cor. Setting
*ENG
0: Adjusted with Bk 1: Adjusted in minimum shift among four colors
2191
[MUSIC Coeff Setting] Line Position Adjustment: Coefficient Setting DFU ch 0: ID sensor at rear, ch 1: ID sensor at center, ch 2: ID sensor at front
001 ch 0: Filter: Front: a1
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 125869 / 1 bit/step]
002 ch 0: Filter: Front: a2
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / –60488 / 1 bit/step]
003 ch 0: Filter: Front: b0
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]
004 ch 0: Filter: Front: b1
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 77 / 1 bit/step]
005 ch 0: Filter: Front: b2
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]
006 ch 0: Filter: Rear: a1
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 128596 / 1 bit/step]
007 ch 0: Filter: Rear: a2
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / –63398 / 1 bit/step]
008 ch 0: Filter: Rear: b0
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]
009 ch 0: Filter: Rear: b1
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 168 / 1 bit/step]
010 ch 0: Filter: Rear: b2
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]
011 ch 1: Filter: Front: a1
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 125869 / 1 bit/step]
012 ch 1: Filter: Front: a2
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / –60488 / 1 bit/step]
013 ch 1: Filter: Front: b0
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]
014 ch 1: Filter: Front: b1
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 77 / 1 bit/step]
015 ch 1: Filter: Front: b2
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]
016 ch 1: Filter: Rear: a1
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 128596 / 1 bit/step]
017 ch 1: Filter: Rear: a2
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / –63398 / 1 bit/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-48 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 018 ch 1: Filter: Rear: b0
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]
019 ch 1: Filter: Rear: b1
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 168 / 1 bit/step]
020 ch 1: Filter: Rear: b2
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]
021 ch 2: Filter: Front: a1
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 125869 / 1 bit/step]
022 ch 2: Filter: Front: a2
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / –60488 / 1 bit/step]
023 ch 2: Filter: Front: b0
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]
024 ch 2: Filter: Front: b1
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 77 / 1 bit/step]
025 ch 2: Filter: Front: b2
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]
026 ch 2: Filter: Rear: a1
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 128596 / 1 bit/step]
027 ch 2: Filter: Rear: a2
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / –63398 / 1 bit/step]
028 ch 2: Filter: Rear: b0
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]
029 ch 2: Filter: Rear: b1
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 168 / 1 bit/step]
030 ch 2: Filter: Rear: b2
*ENG
[–131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]
031 Q Format Selection
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1/step]
[MUSIC Threshold Setting] Line Position Adjustment: Threshold Setting DFU ch 0: ID sensor at rear, ch 1: ID sensor at center, ch 2: ID sensor at front
001 ch 0: 1st
*ENG
002 ch 0: 2nd
*ENG
003 ch 0: 3rd
*ENG
004 ch 0: 4th
*ENG
005 ch 1: 1st
*ENG
006 ch 1: 2nd
*ENG
007 ch 1: 3rd
*ENG
SM Appendix
[0.5 to 3 / 1.4 / 0.1 V/step]
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2192
9-49 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 008 ch 1: 4th
*ENG
009 ch 2: 1st
*ENG
010 ch 2: 2nd
*ENG
011 ch 2: 3rd
*ENG
012 ch 2: 4th
*ENG
2193
001
[MUSIC Condition] Line Position Adjustment: Condition Setting Auto Execution
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 ] 0: OFF, 1: ON
Enables/disables the automatic line position adjustment Page: Job End: BW+FC 002
*ENG
[0 to 999 / 500 / 1 page/step]
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing mode after job end. Page: Job End: FC
003
*ENG
[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for color printing mode after job end. Page: Interrupt: BW+FC
004
*ENG
[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing mode during job. Page: Interrupt: FC
005
*ENG
[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for color printing mode during jobs. Page: Standby: BW + FC
006
*ENG
[0 to 999 / 100 / 1 page/step]
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW printing mode in stand-by mode. The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in BW printing mode reaches the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009 is satisfied.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-50 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Page: Standby: FC
007
*ENG
[0 to 999 / 100 / 1 page/step]
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW printing mode in stand-by mode. The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in color printing mode reaches the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009 is satisfied. Temp Change
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 5 / 1deg/step]
008 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode b: adjustment once). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions. Section Descriptions" section. Elapse Time
*ENG
[1 to 1440 / 300 / 1 minute/step]
009 Adjust the time threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode b: adjustment once). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions. Temp Change 2
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 10 / 1deg/step]
011 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode a: adjustment twice). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions. Elapse Time 2
*ENG
[1 to 9999 / 600 / 1 minute/step]
012 Adjust the time threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode a: adjustment twice). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions. 016 Page: Power ON:BW+FC
[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]
[MUSIC Exe Result] Line Position Adjustment: Execution Result
001 Year
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 year/step]
002 Month
*ENG
[1 to 12 / 1 / 1 month/step]
003 Date
*ENG
[1 to 31 / 1 / 1 day/step]
SM Appendix
9-51 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2194
*ENG
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 004 Hour
*ENG
[0 to 23 / 0 / 1 hour/step]
005 Minute
*ENG
[0 to 59 / 0 / 1 minute/step]
006 Temperature
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
007 Execution Result
*ENG
008 Number of Execution
*ENG
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 times/step]
009 Number of Failure
*ENG
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 times/step]
010 Error Counter: C
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 /step]
011 Error Counter: M
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Completed successfully, 1: Failed
0: Not done 1: Completed successfully 2: Cannot detect patterns 3: Fewer lines on the pattern than the target
012 Error Counter: Y
*ENG
4: Not used 5: Out of the adjustment range 6 to 9: Not used
2197
[MUSIC Exe Time] DFU
001 Execution Time
*ENG
[10 to 40 / 20 / 10ms/step]
002 TM Sensor Position
*ENG
[48.2 to 500 / 48.2 / 0.1mm/step]
*ENG
[7.5 to 20 / 10 / 0.1 μs/step]
*ENG
[0.1 to 9.9 / 4 / 0.1 sec /step]
2198
[Music A/D Interval]
001 ADC Trigger Counter
2199
[Music Time Setting] DFU
001 Error Time Set
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-52 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 2220
[Skew Origin Set]
001 C:Skew Motor
*ENG -
002 M:Skew Motor 003 Y:Skew Motor
[LD Power: Fixed] LD Power Control 2221
Adjusts the fixed LD power for each line speed and color. These SPs are activated only when SP3-041-002 is set to "0". Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Bk:Normal Spd
*ENG
002 C:Normal Spd
*ENG
003 M:Normal Spd
*ENG
004 Y:Normal Spd
*ENG
009 Bk:Low Spd
*ENG
010 C:Low Spd
*ENG
011 M:Low Spd
*ENG
012 Y:Low Spd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 100 / 1%/step] Increasing this value makes the image density darker.
[Dev. DC Bias:Fixed] Development DC Bias Adjustment Adjusts the development bias. Development bias is automatically adjusted during process control; therefore, 2229
adjusting these settings has no effect while Process Control (SP3-041-001 Default: ON) is activated. After deactivating Process Control with SP3-041-001, the values in these SP Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Plain: Bk
SM Appendix
*ENG
[0 to 800 / 450 / 10 –V/step]
9-53 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
modes are used for printing.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
009 Thick 2: Bk
*ENG
010 Thick 2: M
*ENG
011 Thick 2: C
*ENG
012 Thick 2: Y
*ENG
2241
[Ambient Temp/Hum:Display] Displays the environment temperature and humidity.
001 Temperature
-
[–1280 to 1270 / - / 0.1deg/step]
002 Relative Humidity
-
[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1 %RH/step]
003 Absolute Humidity
-
[0 to 100 / - / 0.1 g/m3/step]
2302
[Env. Correct:Transfer] Environmental Correction: Image Transfer Belt Unit Forced Setting
*ENG
[0 to 6 / 0 / 1 /step]
Sets the environment condition manually. 0: Automatic environment control 002 1: LL (Low temperature/ Low humidity) 2: ML (Middle temperature/ Low humidity) 3: MM (Middle temperature/ Middle humidity) 4: MH (Middle temperature/ High humidity) 5: HH (High temperature/ High humidity)
003
Absolute Humidity: Threshold 1
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 4 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
Adjusts the threshold value between LL and ML.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-54 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 004
Absolute Humidity: Threshold 2
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 8 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
Adjusts the threshold value between ML and MM.
005
Absolute Humidity: Threshold 3
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 16 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
Adjusts the threshold value between MM and MH.
006
Absolute Humidity: Threshold 4
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 24 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
Adjusts the threshold value between MH and HH. 007 Temp Threshold
2308
*ENG
[–5 to 30 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
[Paper Size Correction] Adjusts the threshold value for the paper size correction. [0 to 350 / 290 / 1 mm/step]
001 Threshold 1
*ENG
Threshold 1 ≤ paper: Paper is detected as "S1" size. [0 to 350 / 250 / 1 mm/step]
002 Threshold 2
*ENG
Threshold 2 ≤ paper ≤ Threshold 1: Paper is detected as "S2" size. [0 to 350 / 194 / 1 mm/step]
003 Threshold 3
*ENG
Threshold 3 ≤ paper ≤ Threshold 2: Paper is detected as "S3" size. [0 to 350 / 150 / 1 mm/step] Threshold 4 ≤ paper ≤ Threshold 3:
004 Threshold 4
*ENG
Paper is detected as "S4" size. Paper ≤ Threshold 4:
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Paper is detected as "S5" size.
SM Appendix
9-55 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
2311
[Non Image Area: Bias] Adjusts the bias of the image transfer belt
001 Image Transfer
*ENG
between images. This value is added to the value of the image transfer belt bias. [10 to 250 / 100 / 5 %/step] Adjusts the bias of the paper transfer roller
002 Paper Transfer
*ENG
between images. [0 to 130 / 5 / 1 μA/step]
2316
[Power ON:Bias]
001 Image Transfer
2326
[0 to 60 / 5 / 1 μA /step]
[Transfer Roller CL: Bias] Transfer Roller Cleaning: Bias Adjustment Positive:before and
001
*ENG
after JOB
*ENG
[0 to 2100 / 250 / 10 V /step]
Adjusts the positive voltage of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller. Negative:before and 002
after JOB
*ENG
[10 to 400 / 100 / 10 %/step]
Adjusts the negative current of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller. Positive:after JAM 003
*ENG
[0 to 2100 / 2000 / 10 V/step]
Adjusts the positive current limit of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller.
004 Negative:after JAM
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
[10 to 400 / 100 / 10 %/step]
9-56 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 2351
001
[Common: BW: Bias] Image Transfer Belt: B/W: Bias Adjustment Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec Image Transfer:Standard Speed
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 25 / 1 μA]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for plain paper.
003
Image Transfer:Low Speed
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 13 / 1 μA]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for thick 1 paper.
2357
[Common: FC: Bias] Image Transfer Belt: Full Color: Bias Adjustment Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec Image Transfer: Standard Spd:Bk
001
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 23 / 1 μA]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for plain paper. Image Transfer:: Standard Spd:C
002
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 22 / 1 μA]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for plain paper. Image Transfer: Standard Spd:M
003
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 25 / 1 μA]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for plain paper. Image Transfer: Standard Spd:Y
004
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 29 / 1 μA]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for plain paper. Image Transfer: Low Speed:Bk
009
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 13 / 1 μA]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for
010
Image Transfer: Low Speed:C
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 12 / 1 μA]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for
SM Appendix
9-57 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
thick 1 paper.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode thick 1 paper. Image Transfer: Low Speed:M 011
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 13 / 1 μA]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for thick 1 paper. Image Transfer: Low Speed:Y
012
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 14 / 1 μA]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
2360
-
[Common: BW Env. Correction Table] 001 Image Transfer: Standard
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 42 / 1 /step]
003 Image Transfer: Low
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 38 / 1 /step]
004 Image Transfer: Standard Spd:BK
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 25 / 1 /step]
005 Image Transfer: Standard Spd: C
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 46 / 1 /step]
006 Image Transfer: Standard Spd:M
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 43 / 1 /step]
007 Image Transfer:: Standard Spd:Y
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 45 / 1 /step]
012 Image Transfer: Low Speed:Bk
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 26 / 1 /step]
013 Image Transfer: Low Speed:C
*ENG
014 Image Transfer: Low Speed:M
*ENG
015 Image Transfer: Low Speed:Y
*ENG
[Common: FC Env. Correction Table]
[1 to 50 / 38 / 1 /step]
[1 to 50 / 45 / 1 /step]
[Plain: Bias: BW] 2403
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in black-and-white mode.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-58 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 20 / 1 –μA /step]
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 23 / 1 –μA /step]
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 12 / 1 –μA /step]
[Plain: Bias: FC] 2407
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in full color mode. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 25 / 1 –μA /step]
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 28 / 1 –μA /step]
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step]
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 14 / 1 –μA /step]
[Plain-T:SizeCorrect:BW] 2411
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd: S1
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)
005 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)
SM Appendix
9-59 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[100 to 4000 / 140 / 5%/step]
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [100 to 4000 / 165 / 5%/step] 006 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 150 / 5%/step]
007 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]
008 Paper Transfer: Low : 2nd:S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 175 / 5%/step]
009 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 230 / 5%/step]
010 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]
011 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 290 / 5%/step]
012 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd:S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]
013 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 285 / 5%/step]
014 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 210 / 5%/step]
015 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st Side: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-60 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [100 to 4000 / 360 / 5%/step] 016 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd side: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
017 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5
*ENG
018 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5
*ENG
019 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S5
*ENG
020 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd: S5
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 200 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 340 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 210 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 420 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[Plain-T:SizeCorrect:FC] 2412
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard l: 1st: S1
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd: S1
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 4000 / 130 / 5%/step] 005 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 160 / 5%/step]
006 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm
[100 to 4000 / 140 / 5%/step] 007 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)
SM Appendix
9-61 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
(Paper width)
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [100 to 4000 / 215 / 5%/step] 008 Paper Transfer: Low : 2nd:S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 160 / 5%/step]
009 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 215 / 5%/step]
010 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 175 / 5%/step]
011 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 320 / 5%/step]
012 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd:S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]
013 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 285 / 5%/step]
014 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]
015 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st Side: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 465 / 5%/step]
016 Paper Transfer: Low: 2st Side: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
017 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5
*ENG
018 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-62 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
[100 to 4000 / 220 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 355 / 5%/step]
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
019 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S5
*ENG
020 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd: S5
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 230 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 565 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[Plain-T:Size-Env.Correct:BW] 2413
Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd: S1
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 30 / 1/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 23 / 1/step] 005 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 9 / 1/step]
006 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 34 / 1/step]
007 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 26 / 1/step]
008 Paper Transfer: Low : 2nd:S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm
[1 to 50 / 10 / 1/step] 009 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)
SM Appendix
9-63 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
(Paper width)
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [1 to 50 / 15 / 1/step] 010 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 12 / 1/step]
011 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 13 / 1/step]
012 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd:S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 10 / 1/step]
013 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 15 / 1/step]
014 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 35 / 1/step]
015 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st Side: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 13 / 1/step]
016 Paper Transfer: Low: 2st Side: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 29 / 1/step]
017 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5
*ENG
150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 15 / 1/step]
018 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5
*ENG
150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 41 / 1/step]
019 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S5
*ENG
150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-64 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [1 to 50 / 13 / 1/step] 020 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd: S5
*ENG
150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[Plain-T:Size-Env.Correct:FC] 2414
Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd: S1
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 30 / 1/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 37 / 1/step] 005 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 16 / 1/step]
006 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 32 / 1/step]
007 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 24 / 1/step]
008 Paper Transfer: Low : 2nd:S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 36 / 1/step]
009 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm
010 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3
SM Appendix
*ENG
9-65 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
[1 to 50 / 9 / 1/step] 250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
(Paper width)
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 29 / 1/step] 011 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 18 / 1/step]
012 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd:S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 29 / 1/step]
013 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 7 / 1/step]
014 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 22 / 1/step]
015 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st Side: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 4 / 1/step]
016 Paper Transfer: Low: 2st Side: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
017 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5
*ENG
018 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5
*ENG
019 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S5
*ENG
020 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd: S5
*ENG
2421
[1 to 50 / 12 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 7 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 27 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 4 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[Plain:L-Edge Correction]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-66 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each mode. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2422.
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[Plain: Sw Timing: L-Edge]
2422
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[Plain: T-Edge Correction] Plain Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the 2423
paper trailing edge in each mode. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2424.
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
SM Appendix
*ENG
9-67 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[Plain: Switch Timing: T-Edge]
2424
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
2430
[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[Plain: Environment Correction]
003 Paper Transfer: BW: Standard: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 39 / 1 /step]
004 Paper Transfer: BW: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 26 / 1 /step]
005 Paper Transfer: FC: Standard:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 39 / 1 /step]
006 Paper Transfer: FC: Standard:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 33 / 1 /step]
009 PaperTransfer:BW:Low:1st
*ENG
010 Paper Transfer: BW:Low:2nd
*ENG
011 Paper Transfer: FC: Low:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 45 / 1 /step]
012 Paper Transfer: FC: Low:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 31 / 1 /step]
2453
[1 to 50 / 25 / 1 /step]
[Thin: Bias: BW]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-68 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in black-and-white mode. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 20 / 1 –μA /step]
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 –μA /step]
[Thin: Bias: FC] 2457
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in full color mode. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 23 / 1 –μA /step]
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step]
[Thin: L-Edge Correction] Thin Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2471
edge in each mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2472.
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[Thin: Switch Timing: L-Edge]
2472
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
SM Appendix
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
9-69 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
[Thin: T-Edge Correction] Thin Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the 2473
paper trailing edge in each mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2474.
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[Thin: Switch Timing: T-Edge]
2474
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
2480
[-100 to 0 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[Thin: Env. Correct Table]
003 Paper Transfer: BW: Standard: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 24 / 1 /step]
005 Paper Transfer: FC: Standard: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 38 / 1 /step]
009 Paper Transfer: BW: Standard: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 32 / 1 /step]
011 Paper Transfer: FC: Standard: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 44 / 1 /step]
2482
[Glossy: Bias: BW]
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]
9-70 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 2483
[Glossy: Bias: FC]
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
2485
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[Glossy: Trailing Edge Correction] *ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5 %/step]
[Glossy: Trailing Edge Correction]
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
2489
[10 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
*ENG
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
2488
*ENG
[Glossy: Switch Timing: L-Edge]
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
2487
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]
[Glossy: L-Edge Correction]
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
2486
*ENG
*ENG
[-100 to 0 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[Glossy: Environment Correction Table]
003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 17 / 1 /step]
005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 21 / 1 /step]
[Thick 1: Bias: BW] 2502
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in black-and-white mode.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 10 / 1 –μA /step]
SM Appendix
9-71 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Thick: 60 mm/sec
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [Thick 1: Bias: FC] 2507
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in full color mode. Thick: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]
[Thick-T:Size Correct:BW] 2511
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: 1st: S1
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S1
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 125 / 5%/step]
005 Paper Transfer: 1st: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 225 / 5%/step]
006 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 150 / 5%/step]
009 Paper Transfer: 1st: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 450 / 5%/step]
010 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 275 / 5%/step]
013 Paper Transfer: 1st: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
014 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S4
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 825 / 5%/step]
9-72 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) 017 Paper Transfer: 1st: S5
*ENG
018 Paper Transfer:: 2nd: S5
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 400 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 1200 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[Thick-T:Size Correct:FC] 2512
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: 1st: S1
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S1
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 110 / 5%/step]
005 Paper Transfer: 1st: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 215 / 5%/step]
006 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 115 / 5%/step]
009 Paper Transfer: 1st: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 335 / 5%/step]
010 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 405 / 5%/step]
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
014 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S4
SM Appendix
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 665 / 5%/step]
9-73 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
013 Paper Transfer: 1st: S4
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) 017 Paper Transfer: 1st: S5
*ENG
018 Paper Transfer:: 2nd: S5
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 690 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 1000 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[Thick-T:Size-Env.Correct:BW] 2513
Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: 1st: S1
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S1
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 30 / 1/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 36 / 1/step]
005 Paper Transfer: 1st: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 21 / 1/step]
006 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 40 / 1/step]
009 Paper Transfer: 1st: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 8 / 1/step]
010 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 27 / 1/step]
013 Paper Transfer: 1st: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
014 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S4
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 5 / 1/step]
9-74 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) 017 Paper Transfer: 1st: S5
*ENG
018 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S5
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 20 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 3 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[Thick-T:Size-Env.Correct:FC] 2514
Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: 1st: S1
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S1
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 30 / 1/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 49 / 1/step]
005 Paper Transfer: 1st: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 21 / 1/step]
006 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 50 / 1/step]
009 Paper Transfer: 1st: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 8 / 1/step]
010 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S3 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 35 / 1/step]
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
014 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S4
SM Appendix
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 4 / 1/step]
9-75 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
013 Paper Transfer: 1st: S4
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) 017 Paper Transfer: 1st: S5
*ENG
018 Paper Transfer: 2nd: S5
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 6 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 3 / 1/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[Thick 1:L-Edge Correct] Thick 1 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2521
edge in each mode. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2522.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[Thick 1: Switch Timing: L-Edge]
2522
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Thick: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[Thick 1: T-Edge Correction] Thick 1 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction
2523
Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each mode. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-76 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2524.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[Thick 1: Switch Timing: T-Edge]
2524
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Thick: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
2530
[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[Thick 1: Env. Correct Table]
003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 17 / 1 /step]
004 Paper Transfer: BW:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 15 / 1 /step]
005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 29 / 1 /step]
006 Paper Transfer: FC:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 19 / 1 /step]
[Thick 2: Bias: BW] 2553
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick2 paper in black-and-white mode.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 10 / 1 –μA /step]
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 10 / 1 –μA /step]
2558
[Thick 2: Bias: FC]
SM Appendix
9-77 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Thick: 60 mm/sec
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick2 paper in full color mode. Thick: 60 mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step]
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]
[Thick 2: L-Edge Correct] Thick 2 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2571
edge in each mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2572.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[Thick 2: Switch Timing: L-Edge]
2572
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Thick: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2mm/step]
[Thick 2: Trailing Edge Correction] Thick 2 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2573
edge in each mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2574.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-78 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[Thick2:T-Edge Correct]
2574
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Thick: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
2580
[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[Thick 2 Env. Correct Table]
003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 36 / 1 /step]
004 Paper Transfer: BW: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 13 / 1 /step]
005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 23 / 1 /step]
006 Paper Transfer: FC: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 19 / 1 /step]
[OHP: Bias: BW] 2603
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for OHP in black-and-white mode.
001 Paper Transfer
2608
*ENG
[0 to 200 / NA: 15, EU/AA: 13 / 1 –μA /step]
[OHP: Bias: FC]
001 Paper Transfer
SM Appendix
*ENG
[0 to 200 / NA: 24, EU/AA: 20 / 1 –μA /step]
9-79 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for OHP in full color mode.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [OHP: L-Edge Correct] OHP: Leading Edge Correction
2621
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2622.
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[OHP: Switch Timing: L-Edge] 2622
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[OHP: T-Edge Correct] OHP: Trailing Edge Correction
2623
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2624.
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[OHP: Trailing Edge Correction] 2624
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
001 Paper Transfer
2630
*ENG
[–100 to 0 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[OHP: Env. Correct Table]
002 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
[1 to 50 / NA: 39, EU/AA: 26 / 1 /step]
9-80 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 003 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / NA: 7, EU/AA: 47 / 1 /step]
[Thick 3: Bias: BW] 2651
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 3 in black-and-white mode. Thick: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 10 / 1 –μA /step]
[Thick 3: Bias: FC] 2652
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 3 in full color mode. Thick: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step]
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]
[Thick 3: L-Edge Correct] Thick 3 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2654
edge in each mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2655.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
2655
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image
SM Appendix
9-81 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Thick 3: Switch Timing: L-Edge]
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode area. Thick: 60 mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[Thick 3: T-Edge Correct] Thick 3 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2656
edge in each mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values. Thick: 60 mm/sec
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2657.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[Thick 3: Trailing Edge Correction]
2657
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Thick: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[Thick 3: Env. Correct Table] Thick 3 Paper: MM Environment Coefficient 2660
Adjustment Thick: 60 mm/sec
003 Paper Transfer:BW:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 36 / 1 /step]
004 Paper Transfer:BW:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 13 / 1 /step]
005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 23 / 1 /step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-82 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 006 Paper Transfer: FC: 2nd
[1 to 50 / 19 / 1 /step]
[M-Thick:Bias:BW] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer:Standard:1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer:Standard:2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 11 / 1-uA /step]
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 13 / 1-uA /step]
2707
[0 to 200 / 20 / 1-uA /step]
[M-Thick:Bias:FC] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer:Standard:1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 25 / 1-uA /step]
002 Paper Transfer:Standard:2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 28 / 1-uA /step]
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 11/ 1-uA /step]
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 14 / 1-uA /step]
2721
[M-Thick:L-Edge Correct] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer:Standard:1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer:Standard:2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
2722
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5-uA /step]
[M-Thick:SwTiming:L-Edge] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer:Standard:1st
SM Appendix
*ENG
9-83 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2-uA /step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2703
*ENG
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 002 Paper Transfer:Standard:2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
2723
[M-Thick:T-Edge Correct] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer:Standard:1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer:Standard:2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
2724
[M-Thick:SwTiming:T-Edge] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer:Standard:1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer:Standard:2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
2730
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5-uA /step]
[0 to -100 / 0 / 2-uA /step]
[M-Thick:Env.Correct Table] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
003 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 23 / 1-uA /step]
004 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 26 / 1-uA /step]
005 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 38 / 1-uA /step]
006 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 33 / 1-uA /step]
009 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 32 / 1-uA /step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-84 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 010 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 21 / 1-uA /step]
011 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 48 / 1-uA /step]
012 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 28 / 1-uA /step]
[SP 1: Bias: BW] 2753
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in black-and-white mode. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 –μA /step]
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step]
[0 to 200 / 20 / 1 –μA /step]
[SP 1: Bias: FC] 2757
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in full color mode. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 25 / 1 –μA /step]
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 28 / 1 –μA /step]
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 –μA /step]
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 14 / 1 –μA /step]
[SP1,2,3-T:Size Correct:BW] Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
SM Appendix
9-85 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2761
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001
002
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1
*ENG
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S1
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S1
*ENG
005
006
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2
[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 4000 / 140 / 5%/step] *ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)
Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2
[100 to 4000 / 165 / 5%/step] *ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 150 / 5%/step]
007 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]
008 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)
009
010
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3
[100 to 4000 / 175 / 5%/step] *ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)
Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3
[100 to 4000 / 230 / 5%/step] *ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]
011 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 290 / 5%/step]
012 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-86 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
013
014
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4
[100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step] *ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4
[100 to 4000 / 285 / 5%/step] *ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 210 / 5%/step]
015 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 360 / 5%/step]
016 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
017
018
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5
*ENG
*ENG
019 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S5
*ENG
020 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S5
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 200 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 340 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 210 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 420 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[SP1,2,3-T:Size Correct:FC] 2762
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
002
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1
SM Appendix
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001
*ENG
9-87 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 003 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S1
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S1
*ENG
005
006
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2
[100 to 4000 / 130 / 5%/step] *ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)
Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2
[100 to 4000 / 160 / 5%/step] *ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 140 / 5%/step]
007 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 215 / 5%/step]
008 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)
009
010
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3
[100 to 4000 / 160 / 5%/step] *ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)
Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3
[100 to 4000 / 215 / 5%/step] *ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 175 / 5%/step]
011 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 320 / 5%/step]
012 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)
013
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
014 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd:
D037/D038/D040/D041
[100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 285 / 5%/step]
9-88 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode S4
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 190 / 5%/step]
015 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 465 / 5%/step]
016 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
017
018
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5
*ENG
*ENG
019 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S5
*ENG
020 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S5
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 220 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 355 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 230 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 565 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[SP1,2,3-T:Size Env.Correct:BW] 2763
Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
002
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1
*ENG
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S1
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S1
*ENG
005
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2
SM Appendix
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 30 / 1%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 23 / 1%/step] 290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper
9-89 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode width)
006
Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2
[1 to 50 / 9 / 1%/step] *ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 34 / 1%/step]
007 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 26 / 1%/step]
008 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)
009
010
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3
[1 to 50 / 10 / 1%/step] *ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)
Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3
[1 to 50 / 15 / 1%/step] *ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 12 / 1%/step]
011 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 13 / 1%/step]
012 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)
013
014
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4
[1 to 50 / 15 / 1%/step] *ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
015 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S4
D037/D038/D040/D041
[1 to 50 / 10 / 1%/step]
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 35 / 1%/step] 194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper
9-90 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode width) [1 to 50 / 13 / 1%/step] 016 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
017
018
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st:
*ENG
S5 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd:
*ENG
S5
019 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S5
*ENG
020 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S5
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 29 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 15 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 41 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 13 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[SP1,2,3-T:Size Env.Correct:FC] 2764
Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
002
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S1 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S1
*ENG
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S1
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S1
*ENG
005
006
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S2
SM Appendix
S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 37 / 1%/step] *ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)
Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S2
[1 to 50 / 30 / 1%/step]
[1 to 50 / 16 / 1%/step] *ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)
9-91 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [1 to 50 / 32 / 1%/step] 007 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 24 / 1%/step]
008 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)
009
010
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S3
[1 to 50 / 36 / 1%/step] *ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)
Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S3
[1 to 50 / 9 / 1%/step] *ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 29 / 1%/step]
011 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 18 / 1%/step]
012 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)
013
014
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S4
[1 to 50 / 29 / 1%/step] *ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S4
[1 to 50 / 7 / 1%/step] *ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 22 / 1%/step]
015 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 4 / 1%/step]
016 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-92 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 017
018
Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st: S5 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd: S5
*ENG
*ENG
019 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S5
*ENG
020 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S5
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 12 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 7 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 27 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 4 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[SP1: L-Edge Correct] Special 1 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2771
edge in each mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2772.
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[SP 1: Switch Timing: L-Edge]
2772
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec *ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
SM Appendix
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
9-93 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[SP1: T-Edge Correct] Special 1 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2773
edge in each mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2774.
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
005 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[SP 1: Switch Timing: T-Edge]
2774
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
2780
[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[SP 1: Env. Correct Table] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
003 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 23 / 1-uA /step]
004 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 26 / 1-uA /step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-94 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 005 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 38 / 1-uA /step]
006 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 33 / 1-uA /step]
009 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 32 / 1-uA /step]
010 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 21 / 1-uA /step]
011 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 48 / 1-uA /step]
012 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 28 / 1-uA /step]
[SP 4: Bias: BW] 2783
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in black-and-white mode. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]
[SP 4: Bias: FC] 2787
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in full color mode. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]
[SP4,5,6-T:Size Correct:BW] 2791
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec *ENG
005 Paper Transfer: Normal: S2
*ENG
SM Appendix
[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 125 / 5%/step] 290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper
9-95 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Paper Transfer: Normal S1
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode width) [100 to 4000 / 150 / 5%/step] 009 Paper Transfer: Normal: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 275 / 5%/step]
013 Paper Transfer: Normal: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
017 Paper Transfer: Normal: S5
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 400 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[SP4,5,6-T:Size Correct:FC] 2792
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Normal: S1
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 110 / 5%/step]
005 Paper Transfer: Normal:S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 115 / 5%/step]
009 Paper Transfer: Normal:S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [100 to 4000 / 405 / 5%/step]
013 Paper Transfer: Normal: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
017 Paper Transfer: Normal: S5
2793
*ENG
[100 to 4000 / 690 / 5%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[SP4,5,6-T:Size Env.Correct:BW]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-96 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer: Normal:S1
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 30 / 1%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 36 / 1%/step]
005 Paper Transfer: Normal: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 40 / 1%/step]
009 Paper Transfer: Normal: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 27 / 1%/step]
013 Paper Transfer: Normal: S4
*ENG
194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width)
017 Paper Transfer: Normal: S5
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 20 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[SP4,5,6-T:Size Env.Correct:FC] 2794
Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Normal:S1
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 30 / 1%/step] S1 size ≥ 290 mm (Paper width) [1 to 50 / 49 / 1%/step]
005 Paper Transfer: Normal: S2
*ENG
290 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 250 mm (Paper width)
009 Paper Transfer: Normal: S3
*ENG
250 mm ≥ S2 size ≥ 194 mm (Paper width)
013 Paper Transfer: Normal: S4
SM Appendix
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 35 / 1%/step]
9-97 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[1 to 50 / 50 / 1%/step]
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 194 mm ≥ S4 size ≥ 150 mm (Paper width) 017 Paper Transfer: Normal: S5
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 6 / 1%/step] 150 mm ≥ S5 size (Paper width)
[SP4: L-Edge Correct] Special 4 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2795
edge in each mode. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2796.
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[SP 4: Switch Timing: L-Edge]
2796
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[SP4: T-Edge Correct] Special 1 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2797
edge in each mode. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2798.
001 Paper Transfer
2798
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[SP 4: Sw Timing: T-Edge]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-98 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
003 Paper Transfer:BW: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 17 / 1-uA /step]
005 Paper Transfer:FC: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 29 / 1-uA /step]
2799
[SP 4: Env. Correct Table]
[SP 2: Bias: BW] 2803
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in black-and-white mode. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 –μA /step]
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step]
[0 to 200 / 20 / 1 –μA /step]
[SP2: Bias: FC] 2807
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in full color mode.
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 25 / 1 –μA /step]
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 28 / 1 –μA /step]
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 –μA /step]
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 14 / 1 –μA /step]
SM Appendix
9-99 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
[SP 2: L-Edge Correct] Special 2 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2821
edge in each mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2822.
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[SP 2: SW Timing: L-Edge]
2822
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[SP 2: T-Edge Correct] Special 2 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2823
edge in each mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2824.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-100 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[SP 2: SwTiming: T-Edge]
2824
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[SP 2: Env. Correct Table] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
003 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 23 / 1-uA /step]
004 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 26 / 1-uA /step]
005 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 38 / 1-uA /step]
006 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 33 / 1-uA /step]
009 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 32 / 1-uA /step]
010 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 21 / 1-uA /step]
011 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 48 / 1-uA /step]
012 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 28 / 1-uA /step]
SM Appendix
9-101 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2830
[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [SP 5: Bias: BW] 2833
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 5 in black-and-white mode. Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]
[SP 5: Bias: FC] 2837
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 5 in full color mode. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]
[SP5: L-Edge Correct] Special 5Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2845
edge in each mode. SP2833 and SP2837 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2846.
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[SP 5: Switch Timing: L-Edge]
2846
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer
2847
*ENG
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[SP5: T-Edge Correct] Special 5 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-102 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each mode. SP2833 and SP2837 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2848.
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[SP 5: Sw Timing: T-Edge]
2848
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
003 Paper Transfer:BW: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 17 / 1-uA /step]
005 Paper Transfer:FC: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 29 / 1-uA /step]
2849
[SP 5: Env. Correct Table]
[SP3: Bias: BW] 2852
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in black-and-white mode. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 –μA /step]
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 13 / 1 –μA /step] Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2857
[0 to 200 / 20 / 1 –μA /step]
[Special 3: Bias: FC]
SM Appendix
9-103 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in full color mode. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec 001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 25 / 1 –μA /step]
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 28 / 1 –μA /step]
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 –μA /step]
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 14 / 1 –μA /step]
[SP 3: L-Edge Correction] Special 3 Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2871
edge in each mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2872.
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5% /step]
[Special 3: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]
2872
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-104 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[SP 3: T-Edge Correction] Special 3 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2873
edge in each mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2874.
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[SP 3: Sw Timing: T-Edge]
2874
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer: Standard: 1st
*ENG
002 Paper Transfer: Standard: 2nd
*ENG
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st
*ENG
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd
*ENG
[SP 3: Env. Correct Table] Standard: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
003 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 23 / 1-uA /step]
004 Paper Transfer:BW:Standard:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 26 / 1-uA /step]
SM Appendix
9-105 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2880
[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 005 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 38 / 1-uA /step]
006 Paper Transfer:FC:Standard:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 33 / 1-uA /step]
009 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 32 / 1-uA /step]
010 Paper Transfer:BW:Low:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 21 / 1-uA /step]
011 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 48 / 1-uA /step]
012 Paper Transfer:FC:Low:2nd
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 28 / 1-uA /step]
[SP 6: Bias: BW] 2883
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 6 in black-and-white mode. Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]
[SP 6: Bias: FC] 2887
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 6 in full color mode. Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 –μA /step]
[SP6: L-Edge Correct] Special 5Paper: Leading Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading 2895
edge in each mode. SP2883 and SP2887 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2896.
001 Paper Transfer
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
9-106 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [SP 6: Sw Timing: L-Edge]
2896
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to 30 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[SP6: T-Edge Correct] Special 5 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing 2897
edge in each mode. SP2883 and SP2887 are multiplied by these SP values. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2898.
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[SP 6: Sw Timing: T-Edge]
2898
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area. Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
001 Paper Transfer
*ENG
[0 to -100 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
003 Paper Transfer:BW: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 17 / 1-uA /step]
005 Paper Transfer:FC: 1st
*ENG
[1 to 50 / 29 / 1-uA /step]
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 5 / 1sec /step]
2900
[SP 5: Env. Correct Table]
[Drum Idling Time]
003 Normal Speed
SM Appendix
9-107 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2899
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 005 Low Speed
2902
*ENG
[0 to 120 / 5 / 1sec /step]
[OPC Drum Rev Time] Adjusts the time for how long the OPC drum motor reverses after job end. DFU
001 All: BW
*ENG
[0to 200 / 60 / 10 msec/step]
002 All: FC
*ENG
[0to 200 / 50 / 10 msec/step]
003 DevRev: FC
*ENG
[0to 200 / 70 / 10 msec/step]
004 DevRev: Bk
*ENG
[0to 200 / 200 / 10 msec/step]
[ImageTrunsferRevTime] 2904
Adjusts the time for how long the image transfer belt motor reverses after job end. DFU
003 All
2906
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 50 / 10 msec/step]
[Drum Stop Angle] DFU
001 Color
*ENG
002 Bk
*ENG
2908
[0 to 359 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
[GainAdj:TransferM] Gain Adjustment of Image Transfer Belt Motor DFU [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
001 120 mm/sec
*ENG
0: GAIN: High speed 1: GAIN: Low speed
002 60 mm/sec
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step] 0: GAIN: High speed
9-108 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 1: GAIN: Low speed
2915
[GainAdj:BkOpcDevM] [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
001 120 mm/sec
*ENG
0: GAIN: High speed 1: GAIN: Low speed [0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
002 60 mm/sec
*ENG
0: GAIN: High speed 1: GAIN: Low speed
2916
[GainAdj:ColorOpcM] [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
001 120 mm/sec
*ENG
0: GAIN: High speed 1: GAIN: Low speed [0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
002 60 mm/sec
*ENG
0: GAIN: High speed 1: GAIN: Low speed
2920
[Transfer Motor Ctrl] [0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
001 TransferMotorCtrl
*ENG
0: FG Control 1: ENC Control
002 SC443 Count
2921
*ENG
[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 /step]
[ITB Speed Control] [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 ] *ENG
0: Disavailable Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 On/Off
1: Available 002 Execute
SM Appendix
*ENG
-
9-109 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 003 Execution Interval
*ENG
[1 or 6000 / 600 / 1 min /step]
004 Correct Delay Time
*ENG
[2 or 20 / 2 / 0.01 sec /step]
020 Amp. Correct 1
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]
021 Amp. Correct 2
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]
022 Amp. Correct 3
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]
030 Pha. Correct 1
*ENG
[0 or 359 / 0 / 1 /step]
031 Pha. Correct 2
*ENG
[0 or 359 / 0 / 1 /step]
032 Pha. Correct 3
*ENG
[0 or 359 / 0 / 1 /step]
040 Amp. Error Thresh
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 65535 / 1 /step]
041 Amp. Error Counter
*ENG
[0 or 1000 / 0 / 1 /step]
050 Amp. Coeff 1:120
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 18681 / 1 /step]
051 Amp. Coeff 2:120
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 26048 / 1 /step]
052 Amp. Coeff 3:120
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 31468 / 1 /step]
053 Amp. Coeff 1:60
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 9341 / 1 /step]
054 Amp. Coeff 2:60
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 13024 / 1 /step]
055 Amp. Coeff 3:60
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 15734 / 1 /step]
056 Pha. Coeff 1
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 35987 / 1 /step]
057 Pha. Coeff 2
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 27263 / 1 /step]
058 Pha. Coeff 3
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 21464 / 1 /step]
059 Pha. Coeff 1 LPF
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 5280 / 1 /step]
060 Pha. Coeff 2 LPF
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 10560 / 1 /step]
061 Pha. Coeff 3 LPF
*ENG
[0 or 65535 / 15840 / 1 /step]
2922
[ITB SP Ctrl Counter]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-110 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001 Counter
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 5 / 1 /step]
002 Internal Counter
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 1 / 1 /step]
[P-Transfer:Bias Limit] Paper Transfer Roller Feed-back: Threshold 2930
Adjustment Adjusts the threshold between high resistance (division 1) and low resistance (division 2) at the paper transfer roller. This SP affects SP2931 to SP2939.
001 Bias
*ENG
[0 to 7000 / 6000 / 10 –V/step]
001 T1:Standard Speed
*ENG
[-500 to 1000 / 0 / 10 msec /step]
002 T1:Low Speed
*ENG
[-500 to 1000 / -80 / -80 msec /step]
001 T5:Bk:Normal
*ENG
[-140 to 140 / 0 / 10 msec /step]
002 T7:FC:Normal
*ENG
[-140 to 140 / 0 / 10 msec /step]
003 T5:Bk:Low
*ENG
[-210 to 210 / 0 / 10 msec /step]
004 T7: FC: Low
*ENG
[-210 to 210 / 0 / 10 msec /step]
*ENG
[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
001 No Refresh
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
002 Refresh
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
2941
2960
[Charge Bias On Timing]
[Dev. Bias Down Mode]
[Process Interval]
001 Additional Time
2970
[Cleaning After JOB]
SM Appendix
9-111 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2940
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 2971
[BW Non-Image:Bias ON]
001 T1 BW:Bias On:Normal
*ENG
003 T1 BW:Bias On:Low
*ENG
[-360 to 180 / 0 / 10 msec/step]
SP3-XXX (Process)
3011
[Process Cont. Manual Execution] [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] Executes the normal process control
001 Normal Procon
-
manually (potential control). Check the result with SP3-325-001 after executing this SP. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step ]
002 Toner Density Adjust
-
Executes the toner density adjustment manually. Check the result with SP3-325-001 after executing this SP. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step ] Executes the process control that is
003 Procon BF-ACC
-
normally done before ACC. The type of process control is selected with SP3-041-004. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step ] Executes the process control that is
004 With Full MUSIC
-
normally done at the same time as MUSIC. This SP does the MUSIC (line position adjustment) twice. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step ] Executes the process control that is
005 With Normal MUSIC
-
normally done at the same time as MUSIC. This SP does the MUSIC (line position adjustment) once.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-112 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
[Process Cont. Check Result] Process Control Self-check Result Displays the result of the latest process control self-check. 3012
All colors are displayed. The results are displayed in the order “Y C M K” e.g., 11 (Y) 99 (C) 11 (M) 11 (K): The self-check for Cyan failed but the others were successful. See the “Error Condition Tables” in the Process Control Error section for details.
001 History: Latest
*ENG
002 Result: Latest 1
*ENG
003 Result: Latest 2
*ENG
004 Result: Latest 3
*ENG
005 Result: Latest 4
*ENG
006 Result: Latest 5
*ENG
007 Result: Latest 6
*ENG
008 Result: Latest 7
*ENG
009 Result: Latest 8
*ENG
010 Result: Latest 9
*ENG
[TD Sen Initial Setting] Developer Initialization Setting
001 Execution: ALL
-
002 Execution: COL
-
003 Execution: Bk
-
004 Execution: C
-
005 Execution: M
-
006 Execution: Y
-
SM Appendix
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
9-113 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3013
[11111111 to 99999999 / - / 1/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
3014
[TD Sen Initial Set Result] Developer Initialization Result: Display [0000 to 9999 / - / 1 /step ] Display: YCMK
*ENG
1: Success 2 to 9: Failure
001 Displays the developer initialization result. See the “Error Condition Tables” in the Process Control Error section for details on the meaning of each code. All colors are displayed. Values are displayed in the order Y C M Bk. e.g., 1 (Y) 2 (C) 1 (M) 1 (Bk): Initialization of Cyan failed but the others succeeded.
3015
[Forced Toner Supply] Forced Toner Supply ([Color])
001 Execution: ALL
-
002 Execution: COL
-
003 Execution: Bk
-
004 Execution: C
-
005 Execution: M
-
006 Execution: Y
-
3016
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] Executes the manual toner supply to the development unit.
[Forced Toner Supply Cntl] Forced Toner Supply Setting ([Color]) Specifies the manual toner supply time for each color.
001 Supply Time: Bk
*ENG
002 Supply Time: C
*ENG
003 Supply Time: M
*ENG
004 Supply Time: Y
*ENG
3020
[0 to 30 / 4 / 1 sec/step]
[Vt Limit Error]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-114 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode DFU 001 Delta Vt Threshold
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 5 / 0.01 V/step]
002 Upper Threshold
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4.7 / 0.01 V/step]
003 Upper Error Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 20 / 1 time/step]
004 Lower Threshold
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 V/step]
005 Lower Error Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 10 / 1 times/step]
006 Upper Counter: Bk
*ENG
007 Upper Counter: C
*ENG
008 Upper Counter: M
*ENG
009 Upper Counter: Y
*ENG
010 Lower Counter: Bk
*ENG
011 Lower Counter: C
*ENG
012 Lower Counter: M
*ENG
013 Lower Counter: Y
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 times/step]
[TD Sensor Initial Set] Developer Initialization Setting 3021
Specifies the developer agitation time for each color at the developer initialization. DFU *ENG
002 Agitation Time: C
*ENG
003 Agitation Time: M
*ENG
004 Agitation Time: Y
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
005-008 Sets the execution flag of the developer initialization for each color. DFU 005 Execution Flag: Bk
SM Appendix
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
9-115 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Agitation Time: Bk
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 006 Execution Flag: C
*ENG
007 Execution Flag: M
*ENG
008 Execution Flag: Y
*ENG
0: Flag OFF, 1: Flag ON This flag is cleared after executing TD sensor initialization.
Enables or disables developer 009 Initial Setting Off
*ENG
initialization. DFU [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: Enable, 1: Disable
3022
[Toner Replenishment Mode] DFU Specifies the toner supply time for each color in the toner supply mode.
005 Execution Flag: Bk
*ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
006 Execution Flag: C
*ENG
007 Execution Flag: M
*ENG
008 Execution Flag: Y
*ENG
3041
0: Flag OFF, 1: Flag ON This flag is cleared after executing TD sensor initialization.
[Process Control Type] [0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step ] Alphanumeric 0: FIXED (Use the fixed values for the charge
001
Voltage Control
*ENG
DC bias and development DC bias set with SP2-005 and SP2-229.) 1: CONTROL
Enables or disables potential control. [0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step] Alphanumeric 002
LD Power Control
*ENG
0: FIXED (at the value in SP2221-xxx) 1: CONTROL (adjusted by process control)
Selects the LD power control mode. 004
Pre-ACC Process
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]
9-116 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Control
0: Not Executed 1: Process Control 2: TC Control
Selects the process control mode that is done before ACC. [0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step] 005 P-Pattern Selection
*ENG
0: FIXED 1: INITIALIZED 2: CALCULATED
3043
[TD Adjustment Mode] Repeat Number: Power ON
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at power on. 001 0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number, 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode) 5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is consumed only when the toner density is too dark.) 6 to 9: Disabled Repeat Number: Initial
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at the developer initialization. 002 0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number, 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode) 5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is consumed only when the toner density is too dark.) 6 to 9: Disabled Repeat Number: Non-use
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment in Appendix: SP Mode Tables
003
*ENG
stand by mode. 0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number, 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
SM Appendix
9-117 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is consumed only when the toner density is too dark.) 6 to 9: Disabled Repeat Number: ACC
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at ACC. 004 0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number, 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode) 5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is consumed only when the toner density is too dark.) 6 to 9: Disabled
005
Repeat Number: Recovery
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 time/step]
Not used Repeat Number: Job End
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at job end. 006 0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number, 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode) 5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is consumed only when the toner density is too dark.) 6 to 9: Disabled Repeat: Interrupt 007
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment during printing. DFU Toner Supply Coeff.
008
*ENG
[0 to 25.5 / 10 / 0.1 sec/step]
Adjusts the time for the toner supply mode when a toner density is detected to be low.
009
C-pattern: Bk
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the black toner density
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-118 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode when toner density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment. C-pattern: C 010
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the magenta toner density when toner density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment. C-pattern: M
011
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the cyan toner density when toner density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment. C-pattern: Y
012
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the yellow toner density when toner density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
013
T1 Bias: Bk
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 10 / 1 µA/step]
Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Black.
014
T2 Bias: C
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 10 / 1 µA/step]
Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Cyan.
015
T3 Bias: M
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 10 / 1 µA/step]
Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Magenta.
016
T4 Bias: Y
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 10 / 1 µA/step]
Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Yellow.
017
Developer Agitation Time
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 sec/step]
Specifies the developer mixing time at the toner density adjustment. C-Pattern: LD: DUTY: Bk
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma values (SP3611-001) exceed the target values (SP3611-005) by more than the specified thresholds (SP3239-009).
SM Appendix
9-119 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
018 adjustment.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode C-Pattern: LD: DUTY: C
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density 019 adjustment. In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma values (SP3611-002) exceed the target values (SP3611-006) by more than the specified thresholds (SP3239-009). C-Pattern: LD: DUTY: M
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density 020 adjustment. In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma values (SP3611-003) exceed the target values (SP3611-007) by more than the specified thresholds (SP3239-009). C-Pattern: LD: DUTY: Y
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density 021 adjustment. In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma values (SP3611-004) exceed the target values (SP3611-008) by more than the specified thresholds (SP3239-009).
3044
[Toner Supply Type] Toner Supply Type ([Color]) Selects the toner supply method type.
001 Bk
*ENG
002 C
*ENG
003 M
*ENG
[0 to 4 / 4 / 1/step] Alphanumeric 0: FIXED (with the supply rates stored with SP 3401) 1: PID (Vtref_Fixed) 2: PID (Vtref_Control)
004 Y
*ENG
3: MBD (Vtref_Fixed) 4: MBD (Vtref_Control)
3045
[Toner End Detection: Set]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-120 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Enables/disables the toner alert display on the LCD. 001 ON/OFF
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: Detect, 1: Not Detect [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
002 NE Detection
*ENG
0: ALL 1: TE Sensor
[Toner End/Near End]
3101
Displays the amount of each color toner. DFU 001 Toner Replenishment: Bk
*ENG
002 Toner Replenishment: C
*ENG
003 Toner Replenishment: M
*ENG
004 Toner Replenishment: Y
*ENG
[1 to 600 / 235 / 1 g/step]
005-008 Displays the consumed amount of each color toner. 005 Toner Consumption: Bk
*ENG
006 Toner Consumption: C
*ENG
007 Toner Consumption: M
*ENG
008 Toner Consumption: Y
*ENG
Displays the remaining amount of each color toner. These are calculated by the operating times of the toner supply motors.
009 Toner Remaining: Bk
*ENG
010 Toner Remaining: C
*ENG
011 Toner Remaining: M
*ENG
012 Toner Remaining: Y
*ENG
[–50000 to 600 / 0 / 0.001 g/step]
013-016 Adjusts the threshold of toner near end for each color. The toner near end
SM Appendix
9-121 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
009-012
[0 to 3000 / 0 / 0.001 g/step]
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode message appears on the LCD when the remaining toner amount reaches this threshold. When one of these SPs (SP3-101-009 to 012 or -032 to -035) reaches this threshold, toner near end is detected. 013 Near End Threshold: Bk
*ENG
014 Near End Threshold: C
*ENG
015 Near End Threshold: M
*ENG
016 Near End Threshold: Y
*ENG
Delta Vt Threshold
*ENG
[0 to 600 / 13 / 1 g/step]
[0 to 600 / 3 / 1 g/step]
[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 V/step]
021 This SP is the threshold for toner end. Delta Vt: Vt-Vtref When both this SP and SP3-101-026 occur at same time, toner end is determined. 022-025
Displays the total delta Vt (Vt-Vtref) value for each color.These are calculated by pixel counting.
022 Delta Vt Sum: Bk
*ENG
023 Delta Vt Sum: C
*ENG
024 Delta Vt Sum: M
*ENG
025 Delta Vt Sum: Y
*ENG
026 Delta Vt Sum Threshold
*ENG
028-031
[0 to 655 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]
[0 to 255 / 10 / 1 V/step]
Displays the consumed toner amount calculated with the pixel count for each color.
028 Pixel: Consumption: Bk
*ENG
029 Pixel: Consumption: C
*ENG
030 Pixel: Consumption: M
*ENG
031 Pixel: Consumption: Y
*ENG
[0 to 3000 / 0 / 0.001 g/step]
032-035 Displays the remaining toner amount for each color, using pixel count.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-122 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 032 Pixel: Remaining : Bk
*ENG
033 Pixel: Remaining : C
*ENG
034 Pixel: Remaining : M
*ENG
035 Pixel: Remaining : Y
*ENG
[-50000 to 600 / 0 / 0.001 g/step]
040-043 Displays the pixel M/A for each color. 040 Pixel M/A: Bk
*ENG
041 Pixel M/A: C
*ENG
042 Pixel M/A: M
*ENG
043 Pixel M/A: Y
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.05 / 0.001 mg/cm2/step]
[0 to 1 / 0.6 / 0.001 mg/cm2/step] Adjusts the delta Vt (Vt – Vtref) of toner
044 Delta Vt Threshold BF NE
*ENG
end before toner near end is detected. [0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 V/step] Adjusts the total delta Vt (Vt – Vtref) of
045
Delta Vt Sum Threshold BF NE
*ENG
toner end before toner near end is detected. [0 to 255 / 10 / 1 V/step]
046-049 Displays the latest mohno off time. 046 Bottle Motor Off Time: Bk
*ENG
047 Bottle Motor Off Time: C
*ENG
048 Bottle Motor Off Time: M
*ENG
049 Bottle Motor Off Time: Y
*ENG
[0 to 0 x FFFFFFFF / 0 / 1 sec/step]
050-053 *ENG
051 TE Sn Detect Thresh:C
*ENG
052 TE Sn Detect Thresh:M
*ENG
SM Appendix
[1 to 600 / 33 / 1 g/step]
9-123 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
050 TE Sn Detect Thresh:Bk
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 053 TE Sn Detect Thresh:Y
*ENG
[Toner End Recovery] Not used 3102
Adjusts the number of times toner supply is attempted for each color when the TD sensor continues to detect toner end during toner recovery.
001 Repeat: Bk
*ENG
002 Repeat: C
*ENG
003 Repeat: M
*ENG
004 Repeat: Y
*ENG
3131
[1 to 20 / 5 / 1 time/step]
[TE Count m: Display] Display the number of toner end detections for each color.
001 Bk
*ENG
002 C
*ENG
003 M
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
3201
[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 time/step]
[TD Sensor: Vt Display] Display the current voltage of the TD sensor for each color.
001 Current: Bk
*ENG
002 Current: C
*ENG
003 Current: M
*ENG
004 Current: Y
*ENG
3211
[0 to 5.5 / 0.01 / 0.01 V/step]
[Vt Shift: Display/Set]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-124 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Adjusts the Vt correction value for each line speed. Thick 1 and Thick 2&Fine: 77 mm/sec 001 Med Speed Shift:Bk
*ENG
002 Med Speed Shift:C
*ENG
003 Med Speed Shift:M
*ENG
004 Med Speed Shift:Y
*ENG
005 Low Speed Shift:Bk
*ENG
006 Low Speed Shift:C
*ENG
007 Low Speed Shift:M
*ENG
008 Low Speed Shift:Y
*ENG
3221
[0 to 5 / 0.29 / 0.01 V/step]
[Vtcnt: Display/Set] Displays or adjusts the current Vtcnt value for each color.
001 Current: Bk
*ENG
002 Current: C
*ENG
003 Current: M
*ENG
004 Current: Y
*ENG
005-008
Displays or adjusts the Vtcnt value for each color at developer initialization. DFU *ENG
006 Initial: C
*ENG
007 Initial: M
*ENG
008 Initial: Y
*ENG
[2 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
005 Initial: Bk
3222
[2 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
[Vtref: Display/Set]
SM Appendix
9-125 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Displays or adjusts the current Vtref value for each color. 001 Current: Bk
*ENG
002 Current: C
*ENG
003 Current: M
*ENG
004 Current: Y
*ENG
005-008
[0 to 5.5 / 3 / 0.01 V/step]
Displays or adjusts the Vtref value for each color at developer initialization. DFU
005 Initial: Bk
*ENG
006 Initial: C
*ENG
007 Initial: M
*ENG
008 Initial: Y
*ENG
[0 to 5.5 / 3 / 0.01 V/step]
009-012 Displays and adjusts Vtref correction by pixel coverage for each color. DFU 009 Pixel Correction: Bk
*ENG
010 Pixel Correction: C
*ENG
011 Pixel Correction: M
*ENG
012 Pixel Correction: Y
*ENG
3223
[-5 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]
[-5 to 5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]
[Vtref U/Lower: Set] DFU Adjusts the lower or upper limit value of Vtref for each color.
001 Lower: Bk
*ENG
002 Lower: C
*ENG
003 Lower: M
*ENG
004 Lower: Y
*ENG
005 Upper: Bk
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[0 to 5 / 2 / 0.01 V/step]
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
9-126 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 006 Upper: C
*ENG
007 Upper: M
*ENG
008 Upper: Y
*ENG
009 Initial TC
*ENG
Adjusts the initial toner concentration. [1 to 15 / 7 / 0.1 wt%/step] Adjusts the upper limit of the toner
010 Upper: TC
*ENG
concentration. [1 to 15 / 9.5 / 0.1 wt%/step] Adjusts the lower limit of the toner
011 Lower: TC
*ENG
concentration. [1 to 15 / 4 / 0.1 wt%/step] Adjusts the upper limit of the TD sensor
012 Upper Sensitivity
*ENG
sensitivity. [0.2 to 0.5 / 0.44 / 0.001 V/wt% /step] Adjusts the lower limit of the TD sensor
013 Lower Sensitivity
*ENG
sensitivity. [0.2 to 0.5 / 0.209 / 0.001 V/wt% /step]
014
015
3224
Toner Density Between H /M Toner Density Between M /L
*ENG
[1 to 10 / 3.5 / 0.1 wt%/step]
*ENG
[1 to 10 / 3.5 / 0.1 wt%/step]
[Vtref Correct: Pixel] DFU Adjusts the coefficient of Vtref correction for each coverage and color. *ENG
002 Low Coverage Coeff.C
*ENG
003 Low Coverage Coeffi.M
*ENG
SM Appendix
[0 to 5 / 0.2 / 0.1 /step]
9-127 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Low Coverage Coeffi. Bk
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 004 Low Coverage Coeff. Y
*ENG
005 High Coverage Coeff, Bk
*ENG
006 High Coverage Coeff, C
*ENG
007 High Coverage Coeff, M
*ENG
008 High Coverage Coeff, Y
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0.3 / 0.01 V/step]
Adjusts the threshold of the low 009 Low Coverage: Threshold
*ENG
coverage. [0 to 20 / 3 / 0.1 %/step] Adjusts the threshold of the high
010 High Coverage: Threshold:M
*ENG
coverage. [0 to 100 / 60 / 1 %/step]
011 TC Upper Limit Correction
*ENG
012 Upper Limit TC: Display: Bk
*ENG
013 Upper Limit TC: Display: C
*ENG
014 Upper Limit TC: Display: M
*ENG
015 Upper Limit TC: Display: Y
*ENG
016
Process Control Execution Threshold:M
017 High Coverage: Threshold:H
[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.1 wt%/step]
[1 to 15 / 9.5 / 0.1 wt% /step]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 50 / 1 time/step]
*ENG
Adjusts the threshold of the high coverage.
018 High Coverage: Threshold:L
*ENG
019 Process Control Thresh:H
*ENG
020 Process Control Thresh:L
*ENG
021 Initial ProCon Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 6 / 1 time/step]
022 High Coverage Thresh:LS
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 10 / 1 %/step]
023 Process Control Thresh:LS
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 4 / 1 time/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
[0 to 100 / 20 / 1 %/step]
[0 to 255 / 14 / 1 time/step]
9-128 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
[Toner Supply MBD]
001 ADD:TIME
*ENG
002 ADD:K
*ENG
003 ADD:C
*ENG
004 ADD:M
*ENG
005 ADD:Y
*ENG
[0 to 1000 / 200 / 10 msec/step]
[0.01 to 2 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
006 ADD:LowSpd
*ENG
[0.01 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
007 MSEC:V
*ENG
[0.001 to 1 / 0.08 / 0.001 / step]
011 PID:I:K
*ENG
012 PID:I:C
*ENG
013 PID:I:M
*ENG
014 PID:I:Y
*ENG
015 PID:I:K
*ENG
016 PID:I:C
*ENG
017 PID:I:M
*ENG
018 PID:I:Y
*ENG
019 PID:I:LowSpd
*ENG
020 PID:P:LowSpd
*ENG
021 AWILOW:K
*ENG
022 AWILOW:C
*ENG
023 AWILOW:M
*ENG
024 AWILOW:Y
*ENG
025 AWPUP:K
*ENG
SM Appendix
[0 to 100 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]
[0 to 100 / 8 / 0.01 /step]
[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]
[-1 to 1 / 0.125 / 0.0001 /step]
[-1 to 1 / 0.125 / 0.0001 /step]
9-129 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3230
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 026 AWPUP:C
*ENG
027 AWPUP:M
*ENG
028 AWPUP:Y
*ENG
029 AWILOW:LowSpd
*ENG
030 AWPUP:LowSpd
*ENG
031 SMITH:K
*ENG
032 SMITH:C
*ENG
033 SMITH:M
*ENG
034 SMITH:Y
*ENG
035 SMITH:LowSpd
*ENG
041 ANC:Hori.:K
*ENG
042 ANC:Hori.:C
*ENG
043 ANC:Hori.:M
*ENG
044 ANC:Hori.:Y
*ENG
045 ANC:Ver.:K
*ENG
046 ANC:Ver.:K
*ENG
047 ANC:Ver.:K
*ENG
048 ANC:Ver.:K
*ENG
049 ANC:Hori.:LowSpd
*ENG
050 ANC:Ver.:LowSpd
*ENG
051 ANCG:Long:A:K
*ENG
052 ANCG:Long:A:C
*ENG
053 ANCG:Long:A:M
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[0 to 100 / 2 / 0.01 /step]
[0 to 2 / 0.8 / 0.01 /step]
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
[0 to 10 / 2.8 / 0.01 /step]
[0 to 10 / 1.9 / 0.01 /step]
[0 to 5 / 0.6 / 0.01 /step]
[0 to 10 / 0.66 / 0.01 /step]
9-130 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 054 ANCG:Long:A:Y
*ENG
055 ANCG:Long:B:K
*ENG
056 ANCG:Long:B:C
*ENG
057 ANCG:Long:B:M
*ENG
058 ANCG:Long:B:Y
*ENG
059 ANCG:Long:A:LowSpd
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]
060 ANCG:Long:B:LowSpd
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0.35 / 0.01 /step]
061 AWPNI:K
*ENG
062 AWPNI:C
*ENG
063 AWPNI:M
*ENG
064 AWPNI:Y
*ENG
071 PID
*ENG
080 PIX:TBL:1
*ENG
081 PIX:TBL:2
*ENG
082 PIX:TBL:3
*ENG
083 PIX:TBL:4
*ENG
084 PIX:TBL:5
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0.96 / 0.01 /step]
085 PIX:TBL:6
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0.9 / 0.01 /step]
086 PIX:TBL:7
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0.86 / 0.01 /step]
087 PIX:TBL:8
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0.85 / 0.01 /step]
088 PIX:TBL:9
*ENG
089 PIX:TBL:10
*ENG
090 PIX:TBL:11
*ENG
SM Appendix
[0 to 10 / 0.4 / 0.01 /step]
[-10 to 10 / 0.1 / 0.001 /step]
9-131 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 091 PIX:TBL:12
*ENG
092 PIX:COR:K
*ENG
093 PIX:COR:C
*ENG
094 PIX:COR:M
*ENG
095 PIX:COR:Y
*ENG
096 PIX:AVE:Select
*ENG
[1 to 5 / 2 / 1 /step]
101 PID:I:LIM:Normal
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.125 / 0.001 /step]
102 PID:I:LIM:LowSpd
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.063 / 0.001 /step]
103 PID:I:Nrml to Low
*ENG
104 PID:I:Low to Nrml
*ENG
3231
[0 to 5 / 0.75 / 0.01 /step]
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
[Toner Supply: Setting] Adjusts the coefficient of the toner supply time for each color. DFU
001 Conversion Coeff.:Bk
*ENG
002 Conversion Coeff.:C
*ENG
003 Conversion Coeff.:M
*ENG
004 Conversion Coeff.:Y
*ENG
3232
[0.5 to 9.99 / 3.33 / 0.01 /step]
[T - Supply Coeff.: Setting] DFU
001 Vt Proportion: Bk
*ENG
002 Vt Proportion: C
*ENG
003 Vt Proportion: M
*ENG
004 Vt Proportion: Y
*ENG
005 Pixel Proportion: Bk
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[0 to 2550 / 50 / 1 /step]
[0 to 2.55 / 0.47 / 0.01 /step]
9-132 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 006 Pixel Proportion: C
*ENG
007 Pixel Proportion: M
*ENG
008 Pixel Proportion: Y
*ENG
009 Vt Integral Control: Bk
*ENG
010 Vt Integral Control: C
*ENG
011 Vt Integral Control: M
*ENG
012 Vt Integral Control: Y
*ENG
013 Vt Sum Times: Bk
*ENG
014 Vt Sum Times: C
*ENG
015 Vt Sum Times: M
*ENG
016 Vt Sum Times: Y
*ENG
3233
[0 to 2550 / 500 / 1 /step]
[1 to 255 / 20 / 1 time/step]
[Pixel-Prop. Coeff.2:Set] DFU
001 Correction Coeff.:1
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
002 Correction Coeff.:2
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]
003 Correction Coeff.:3
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 /step]
004 Correction Coeff.:4
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 0.25 / 0.01 /step]
005 Correction Coeff.:5
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]
3234
[Pixel-Prop. Coeff.3:Set] DFU *ENG
[-0.1 to 0 / -0.01 / 0.01 /step]
002 Correction Value 2
*ENG
[0 to 0.1 / 0.01 / 0.01 /step]
3235
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Correction Value 1
[Toner Supply Coeff.: Display] DFU
SM Appendix
9-133 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001 Pixel Proportion 2: Bk
*ENG
002 Pixel Proportion 2: C
*ENG
003 Pixel Proportion 2: M
*ENG
004 Pixel Proportion 2: Y
*ENG
005 Pixel Proportion 3: Bk
*ENG
006 Pixel Proportion 3: C
*ENG
007 Pixel Proportion 3: M
*ENG
008 Pixel Proportion 3: Y
*ENG
009 Vt Integral Value: Bk
*ENG
010 Vt Integral Value: C
*ENG
011 Vt Integral Value: M
*ENG
012 Vt Integral Value: Y
*ENG
3236
[0 to 2.55 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
[0.7 to 1.3 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
[-255 to 255 / 0 / 0.01 /step]
[Toner Supply Consum.: Display] DFU Displays the toner amount of the latest toner supply for each color.
001 Latest: Bk
*ENG
002 Latest: C
*ENG
003 Latest: M
*ENG
004 Latest: Y
*ENG
3237
[0 to 40000 / 0 / 0.1 mg/step]
[Developer Agitation Setting] Displays the toner amount of the latest toner supply for each color. DFU
001 Agitation Time
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 sec/step]
9-134 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 3238
[Vt Target: Setting] Displays the Vt target value at developer initialization. DFU
001 Bk
*ENG
002 C
*ENG
003 M
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
3239
[0 to 5 / 2.7 / 0.01 V/step]
[Vtref Correction: Setting] Adjusts the parameter for Vtref correction at the process control. 001 (+)Consumption: Bk
*ENG
002 (+)Consumption: C
*ENG
003 (+)Consumption: M
*ENG
004 (+)Consumption: Y
*ENG
005 (-)Consumption: Bk
*ENG
006 (-)Consumption: C
*ENG
007 (-)Consumption: M
*ENG
008 (-)Consumption: Y
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.05 / 0.01 V/step]
009 P Rank 1 Threshold
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 0.15 / 0.01 /step]
010 P Rank 2 Threshold
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 /step]
011 P Rank 3 Threshold
*ENG
[-2 to 0 / -0.1 / 0.1 /step]
012 P Rank 4 Threshold
*ENG
[-2 to 0 / -0.15 / 0.01 /step]
013-014 Threshold for image density rank on the image transfer belt. 013 T Rank 1 Threshold
SM Appendix
*ENG
[-1 to 0 / -0.2 / 0.01 V/step]
9-135 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
009-012 Threshold for development gamma rank.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 014 T Rank 2 Threshold
3241
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.2 / 0.01 V/step]
[Background Potential Setting]
001 Coefficient: Bk
*ENG
002 Coefficient: C
*ENG
003 Coefficient: M
*ENG
These are parameters for calculating the charge bias referring to the development bias at process control. [-1000 to 1000 / 0 / 1 /step] DC charge bias = Development bias x (1 +
004 Coefficient: Y
*ENG
0.001 x these vales) + SP3-241-005 to -008
005 Offset: Bk
*ENG
These are additional values for calculating
006 Offset: C
*ENG
007 Offset: M
*ENG
the charge bias referring to the development bias at process control. [0 to 255 / 140 / 1 V/step] DC charge bias = Development bias x (1 +
008 Offset: Y
*ENG
0.001 x SP3-241-001 to -004) + these values
3242
[LD Power Setting] Adjusts the coefficient for LD power control value at the process control.
001 Coefficient: Bk
*ENG
002 Coefficient: C
*ENG
003 Coefficient: M
*ENG
004 Coefficient: Y
*ENG
005 Offset: Bk
*ENG
006 Offset: C
*ENG
007 Offset: M
*ENG
008 Offset: Y
*ENG
017 Low Speed Coeff.:Bk
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[-1000 to 1000 / 128 / 1 /step]
[-1000 to 1000 / 27 / 1 /step]
[-1000 to 1000 / 128 / 1 /step]
9-136 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 018 Low Speed Coeff.:C
*ENG
019 Low Speed Coeff.:M
*ENG
020 Low Speed Coeff.:Y
*ENG
021 Low Speed Offset Coeff.:Bk
*ENG
022 Low Speed Offset Coeff.:C
*ENG
023 Low Speed Offset Coeff.:M
*ENG
024 Low Speed Offset Coeff.:Y
*ENG
3251
[-1000 to 1000 / 58 / 1 /step]
[Coverage] These (-001 to -016) are coefficients for SP3-222-009 to -012. 001 Latest: Pixcel Bk
*ENG
002 Latest: Pixcel C
*ENG
003 Latest: Pixcel M
*ENG
004 Latest: Pixcel Y
*ENG
Displays the latest coverage for each color. [0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 cm2/step]
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction. 005-008 "Average S" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number specified with SP3251-017. 005 Average S: Bk
*ENG
006 Average S: C
*ENG
007 Average S: M
*ENG
008 Average S: Y
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.01 %/step]
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction. the number specified with SP3251-018. 009 Average M: Bk
SM Appendix
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.01 %/step]
9-137 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
009-012 "Average M" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 010 Average M: C
*ENG
011 Average M: M
*ENG
012 Average M: Y
*ENG
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction. 013-016 "Average L" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number specified with SP3-251-019. 013 Average L: Bk
*ENG
014 Average L: C
*ENG
015 Average L: M
*ENG
016 Average L: Y
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.01 %/step]
017-019 Adjusts the threshold for SP3-251-005 to -016. 017 Total Page Setting: S
*ENG
[1 to 100 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]
018 Total Page Setting: M
*ENG
[1 to 500 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]
019 Total Page Setting: L
*ENG
[1 to 999 / 50 / 1 sheet/step]
020-022 Adjusts the threshold for SP3-251-024 to -027. 020 Total Page Setting: S2
*ENG
[1 to 100 / 20 / 1 sheet/step]
021 Total Page Setting: M2
*ENG
[1 to 500 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]
022 Total Page Setting: L2
*ENG
[1 to 999 / 50 / 1 sheet/step]
024-027 Displays the latest coverage ratio for each color. 024 Latest Coverage: Bk
*ENG
025 Latest Coverage: C
*ENG
026 Latest Coverage: M
*ENG
027 Latest Coverage: Y
*ENG
[0 to 100 / - / 0.01 %/step]
028 Displays the threshold of whether to perform developer churning or not.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-138 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode DevAgi. Theresh BF
*ENG
ProCon
3311
[0 to 100 / 20 / 1 %/step]
[ID Sn Detection Value] Displays the ID sensor (regular) offset voltage for Vsg adjustments. 001 Voffset reg: Bk
*ENG
002 Voffset reg: C
*ENG
003 Voffset reg: M
*ENG
004 Voffset reg: Y
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]
005-007 Displays the ID sensor (diffusion) offset voltage for Vsg adjustments. 005 Voffset dif: C
*ENG
006 Voffset dif: M
*ENG
007 Voffset dif: Y
*ENG
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]
008-010 Displays the ID sensor offset voltage for Vsg adjustments. *ENG
009 Voffset TM (Center)
*ENG
010 Voffset TM (Rear)
*ENG
[Vsg Adjustment: Execution]
010 P/TM Sensor All
3322
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]
-
Execute the ID sensor initialization setting for all sensors
[Vsg Adjust. Result: Vsg] Displays the result value of the Vsg adjustment for each sensor.
001 Vsg reg: Bk
SM Appendix
*ENG
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]
9-139 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3321
008 Voffset TM (Front)
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 002 Vsg reg: C
*ENG
003 Vsg reg: M
*ENG
004 Vsg reg: Y
*ENG
005 Vsg dif: C
*ENG
006 Vsg dif: M
*ENG
007 Vsg dif: Y
*ENG
008 Vsg TM (Front)
*ENG
009 Vsg TM (Center)
*ENG
010 Vsg TM (Rear)
*ENG
3323
[Vsg Adjust. Result: Ifsg] DFU
001 Ifsg: Bk
*ENG
002 Ifsg: C
*ENG
003 Ifsg: M
*ENG
004 Ifsg: Y
*ENG
005 Ifsg TM (Front)
*ENG
006 Ifsg TM (Center)
*ENG
007 Ifsg TM (Rear)
*ENG
3324
[0 to 50 / 0 / 0.1 mA/step]
[0 to 50 / 0 / 0.1 mA/step]
[Vsg Adjustment: Set] DFU
003 Vofset Error Counter
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 0 / 0.1 time/step]
004 Vofset Threshold
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 V/step]
005 Vsg Upper Threshold
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4.5 / 0.01 V/step]
006 Vsg Lower Threshold
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3.5 / 0.01 V/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-140 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
[Vsg Adjustment Result]
3325
Displays the result of the Vsg adjustment. The displayed numbers mean the result of each sensor (sensor for Front, sensor for Bk, sensor for Cyan, sensor for Center, sensor for Magenta, sensor for Yellow and sensor for Rear).
001 Latest
*ENG
002 Latest 1
*ENG
003 Latest 2
*ENG
004 Latest 3
*ENG
005 Latest 4
*ENG
006 Latest 5
*ENG
007 Latest 6
*ENG
008 Latest 7
*ENG
009 Latest 8
*ENG
010 Latest 9
*ENG
3: Offset voltage error 2: Vsg adjustment value error 1: O.K
[ID Sensor Sensitivity: Display] Not Used
003 K2C (Latest)
*ENG
004 K5C (Latest)
*ENG
3362
9: Unexpected error
[ID Sn Sensitivity] DFU
003 K5: Upper
*ENG
[0 to 10 / 5 / 0.01 /step]
004 K5: Lower
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]
005 Kn: Upper
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.1 / 0.01 /step]
SM Appendix
9-141 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3361
[111 to 999 / 999 / 1 /step]
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 006 Kn: Lower
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
007 K5 Edit Point
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.15 / 0.01 /step]
008 K5 Target Voltage
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1.63 / 0.01 V/step]
009 K5 Approximate Method
*ENG
010 K2: U/L Limit Coeff. 1
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0 / 0.01 /step]
*ENG
[–0.2 to 0.4 / 0.07 / 0.01 /step]
*ENG
[–0.2 to 0.4 / –0.07 / 0.01 /step]
013 Diffusion Correction
*ENG
[0.75 to 1.35 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
016 K2: Check
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.25 / 0.001 /step]
011
012
3363
K2: Upper Limit Correction K2: Lower Limit Correction
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 /step] 0:Linear, 1: Curve
[ID Pattern Timing Setting] DFU Adjusts the detection timing for the
001 Scan YCMBk
*ENG
process control pattern. [-500 to 500 / 0 / 1 mm/step] Adjusts the timing when the paper
002 Detection Delay Time
*ENG
transfer unit is kept away from the image transfer belt. [0 to 2500 / 400 / 1 msec/step] Adjusts the processing timing for the
003 Delay Time
*ENG
process control pattern. [0 to 2500 / 1335 / 1 msec/step] Adjusts the processing timing for the
004 MUSIC Delay Time
*ENG
pattern that is used for the line position adjustment. [-2500 to 2500 / 300 / 1 msec/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-142 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 3371
[M/A Calculation] DFU
001 Correction Coeff.: Bk
*ENG
[0.5 to 2.0 / 0.99 / 0.01 /step]
002 Correction Coeff.: C
*ENG
[0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
003 Correction Coeff.: M
*ENG
[0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
004 Correction Coeff.: Y
*ENG
[0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
005 Color Correct Coeff.:Bk [0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
006 Color Correct Coeff.:C 007 Color Correct Coeff.:M 008 Color Correct Coeff.:Y
3401
[0.5 to 2.0 / 1.03 / 0.01 /step]
[Fixed Supply Mode] Adjusts the toner supply rate in the fixed toner supply mode.
001 Fixed Rate: Bk
*ENG
002 Fixed Rate: C
*ENG
003 Fixed Rate: M
*ENG
004 Fixed Rate: Y
*ENG
3411
[0 to 100 / 5 / 1 %/step] These SPs are used only when SP3-044 is set to "1".
[Toner Supply Rate: Display] Displays the current toner supply rate. *ENG
002 Latest: C
*ENG
003 Latest: M
*ENG
004 Latest: Y
*ENG
SM Appendix
[0 to 100 / - / 1 %/step]
9-143 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Latest: Bk
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 3421
[Toner Supply Range]
001 Upper Limit: Bk
*ENG
002 Upper Limit: C
*ENG
003 Upper Limit: M
*ENG
004 Upper Limit: Y
*ENG
005 Minimum Supply Time: Bk
*ENG
006 Minimum Supply Time: C
*ENG
007 Minimum Supply Time: M
*ENG
008 Minimum Supply Time: Y
*ENG
3451
*ENG
002 C
*ENG
003 M
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 100 / 1%/step]
Adjusts the minimum toner supply time. [0 to 1000 / 0 / 1 msec/step]
[0 to 10000 / 0 / 1 msec/step]
[Toner Supply Carry Over: Setting] DFU
001 Maximum: Bk
*ENG
002 Maximum: C
*ENG
003 Maximum: M
*ENG
004 Maximum: Y
*ENG
3501
printing.
[T-Supply Carry Over: Display] DFU
001 Bk
3452
Adjusts the toner supply rate during
[0 to 10000 / 1000 / 1 msec/step]
[Process Control Target M/A] Adjusts the target M/A.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-144 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001 Maximum M/A: Bk
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.45 / 0.001 mg/cm2/step]
002 Maximum M/A: C
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.445 / 0.001 mg/cm2/step]
003 Maximum M/A: M
*ENG
004 Maximum M/A: Y
*ENG
3510
[Image Adj. Counter:Display] Displays the total page counter for each adjustment mode.
001 Potential Control: BW
*ENG
002 Potential Control: FC
*ENG
003 Power ON: BW
*ENG
004 Power ON: FC
*ENG
005 MUSIC: BW
*ENG
006 MUSIC: FC
*ENG
007 Vsg Adj.
*ENG
008 Charge AC Control
*ENG
009 MUSIC: Power ON: BW
*ENG
010 MUSIC: Power ON: FC
*ENG
3511
[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 page/step]
[Execution Interval: Setting]
001 Job End: Potential Control: BW
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 250 / 1 page/step]
002 Job End: Potential Control: FC
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 100 / 1 page/step]
003 Interrupt: Potential Control: BW
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]
004 Interrupt: Potential Control: FC
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 200 / 1 page/step]
SM Appendix
9-145 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Adjusts the threshold for each adjustment mode.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 005 Initial: Potential Control: BW
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 250 / 1 page/step]
006 Initial: Potential Control: FC
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 100 / 1 page/step]
007 Vsg Adj. Counter
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 page/step]
008 Charge AC Control Counter
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]
019
Environmental Correction: ON/OFF
*ENG [0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
020 Gamma Correction: ON/OFF
*ENG
0: Not Correct (OFF), 1: Correct (ON)
021
Non-use Time Correction: ON/OFF
*ENG
022 Correction Coeff. 1: JE: BW
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.2 / 0.01 page/step]
023 Correction Coeff. 2: JE: BW
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]
024 Correction Coeff. 1: JE: FC
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.5 / 0.01/step]
025 Correction Coeff. 2: JE: FC
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.1 / 0.01/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.25 / 0.01/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 2 / 1/step]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
026
027
028
029
030
031
Correction Coeff. 1: Interrupt: BW Correction Coeff. 2: Interrupt: BW Correction Coeff. 1: Interrupt: FC Correction Coeff. 2: Interrupt: FC Max. Number Correction Threshold Max. Number Correction Counter
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-146 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 3512
[Image Adj.: Interval] Adjusts the timing for execution of process control and line position adjustment.
001 During Job
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 5 / 1 page/step]
002 During Stand-by
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 10 / 1 minute/step]
[PCU Motor Stop Time: Bk] 3513
Displays the last time that the PCU motors stopped. These are used for process control execution timing.
001 Year
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 0 / 1/step]
002 Month
*ENG
[1 to 12 / 1 / 1/step]
003 Date
*ENG
[1 to 31 / 1 / 1/step]
004 Hour
*ENG
[0 to 23 / 0 / 1/step]
005 Minute
*ENG
[0 to 59 / 0 / 1/step]
[Environmental Displ: Job End] 3514
Displays the environmental conditions for the last job. These are used for process control execution timing.
001 Temperature
*ENG
[-1280 to 1270 / 0 / 0.1°C/step]
002 Relative Humidity
*ENG
[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1%RH/step]
003 Absolute Humidity
*ENG
[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1 g/cm3/step]
[Execution Interval: Display] Displays the current interval for process control execution. When the machine calculates the timing for process control, it uses a number of conditions. These are the results after considering all the conditions. 001 Job End: Potential
SM Appendix
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 250 / 1 page/step]
9-147 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3515
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Control: BW 002
003
004
Job End: Potential Control: FC Interrupt: Potential Control: BW Interrupt: Potential Control: FC
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 100 / 1 page/step]
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 200 / 1 page/step]
[Refresh Mode] DFU While making prints with low coverage, the developer is agitated with less 3516
toner consumption and the toner carrier attraction tends to increase. This may cause low image density or poor transfer (white dots). To prevent this, the coagulated toner or overcharged toner has to be consumed by performing the refresh mode.
001 Dev. Motor Rotation: Display: Bk
*ENG
002 Dev. Motor Rotation: Display: C
*ENG
003 Dev. Motor Rotation: Display: M
*ENG
004 Dev. Motor Rotation: Display: Y
*ENG
005 Rotation Threshold
*ENG
[0 to 1000 / 0.1 / 1 m/step]
006 Pixel Coverage Sum: Bk
*ENG
[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 cm2/step]
007 Pixel Coverage Sum: C
*ENG
008 Pixel Coverage Sum: M
*ENG
009 Pixel Coverage Sum: Y
*ENG
010 Required Area: Bk
*ENG
011 Required Area: C
*ENG
012 Required Area: M
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-148 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
[0 to 1000 / 0 / 0.1 m/step]
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 013 Required Area: Y
*ENG
014 Refresh Threshold: Bk
*ENG
015 Refresh Threshold: C
*ENG
016 Refresh Threshold: M
*ENG
017 Refresh Threshold: Y
*ENG
018 Pattern Number: Bk
*ENG
019 Pattern Number: C
*ENG
020 Pattern Number: M
*ENG
021 Pattern Number: Y
*ENG
022 Pattern Number: Upper limit
*ENG
023 Toner Consumption Pattern Area
*ENG
024 Supply Coefficient
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 1 / 0.01/step]
025 Job End Area Coefficient
*ENG
[0.1 to 25.5 / 1 / 0.1/step]
026 Job End Vb Coefficient
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1%/step]
027 Job End Length
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 19 / 1mm/step]
028 Job End Supply Amt
*ENG
029 Refresh:Page Thresh
*ENG
030 Mode Counter:Bk
*ENG
031 Mode Counter:FC
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 49 / 1 cm2/m/step]
[0 to 255 / 25 / 1 cm2/m/step]
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 time/step]
[10 to 2550 / 280 / 10 cm2/step]
[0 to 1 / 0.45 / 0.001 mg/cm2/step]
[0 to 1000 / 0 / 1 page/step]
3517
Adjusts the threshold temperature for preventing the cleaning blade in the transfer belt cleaning unit from being damaged. If the temperature is above this
SM Appendix
9-149 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Blade Damage Prevention]
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode value, toner is applied to the transfer belt at set intervals during the job to prevent the blade from flipping over. 001
3518
Execution Temp.
*ENG
Threshold
[0 to 50/ 40 / 1°C/step]
[Image Adj. Execution Flag] DFU
001 Toner End Recovery: Bk
*ENG
002 Toner End Recovery: C
*ENG
003 Toner End Recovery: M
*ENG
004 Toner End Recovery: Y
*ENG
005 Vsg Adjustment
*ENG
006 Developer Agitation
*ENG
007 Process Control
*ENG
008 MUSIC
*ENG
009 Drum Phase Adj.
*ENG
010 Charge AC Control
*ENG
011 Blade Damage Prevention
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: OFF. 1: ON
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step] 0: OFF. 1: ON (once), 2: ON (twice) [0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step] 0: OFF. 1: ON (once), 2: ON (twice)
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: OFF. 1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] Sets “1”, when the following values shows. 012 Vsg Average Error
*ENG
Vsg_reg_ave: 3.5 ≤ Vsg_reg_ave ≤ 4.5 or Vsg_dif_ave: 0.0 ≤ Vsg_dif_ave ≤ 0.5
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-150 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 3519
[Toner End Prohibition Setting] Enables or disables each adjustment at toner near end.
001 Process Control
*ENG
002 MUSIC
*ENG
003 TC Adjustment
*ENG
3520
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step] 0: Permit (adjustment is done even toner near end condition) 1: Forbid (adjustment is not done at toner near end condition)
[ITB Idling Rotation]
001 Temperature: High
*ENG
002 Temperature: Medium
*ENG
003 Temperature: Low
*ENG
004 Temperature: L: Power ON
*ENG
005 Temp. Range Thresh:T2
*ENG
[20 or 30 / 30 / 1 deg/step]
006 Temp. Range Thresh:T2
*ENG
[0 or 15 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
010
011
Temp. Thresh Temp. Thresh:High Temp. Thresh Temp. Thresh:Low
[0 or 3 / 0 / 1 revolution/step]
*ENG
[0 or 50 / 30 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
[0 or 50 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
[Initial Process Control Setting]
3522
Adjusts the threshold for the process control at power on. When the current condition has changed by more than the values of these SPs when compared with the conditions at the previous operation, the process
002 Non-use Time Setting
*ENG
[0 to 1440 / 360 / 1 minute/step]
003 Temperature Range
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 10 / 1°C/step]
SM Appendix
9-151 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
control at power on is executed.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 004 Relative Humidity Range
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]
005 Absolute Humidity Range
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]
100
[Rapi_timer] [Time Setting]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
[Non-use Time Process Control Setting]
3531
Adjusts the threshold for the process control at stand-by. When the current condition has changed by more than the values of these SPs when compared with the conditions at the previous operation, the process control at stand-by is executed.
001 Non-use Time Setting
*ENG
[0 to 1440 / 360 / 1 minute/step]
002 Temp. Range
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 10 / 1°C/step]
003 Relative Humidity Range
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]
004 Absolute Humidity Range
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]
005
3611
Maximum Execution Number
Adjusts the maximum execution time for *ENG
the process control at stand-by. [0 to 99 / 10 / 1 time/step]
[Dev. Gamma: Display/Set] Displays the current development gamma
001 Bk (Current)
*ENG
for Bk [0 to 5 / 0.9 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]
002 C (Current)
*ENG
003 M (Current)
*ENG
Displays the current development gamma for C/M/Y. [0 to 5 / 0.8 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]
004 Y (Current)
*ENG
005 Bk (Target Display)
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
Displays the target development gamma for Bk.
9-152 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [0 to 5 / 0.9 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step] Displays the target development gamma 006 C (Target Display)
*ENG
for C/M/Y. [0 to 5 / 0.8 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]
007 M (Target Display)
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0.8 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]
008 Y (Target Display)
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0.77 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step] Displays the standard target development
009 Bk (Standard Target Set)
*ENG
gamma for each color. [0 to 5 / 0.9 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]
010 C (Standard Target Set)
*ENG
011 V (Standard Target Set)
*ENG
012 Y (Standard Target Set)
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0.8 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]
Turns on or off the environmental correction for target development 013 Environmental Correction
*ENG
gamma. [0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Not Correct, 1: Correct
*ENG
015 C (Max Correction)
*ENG
016 M (Max Correction)
*ENG
017 Y (Max Correction)
*ENG
018 K (Max Abs Hum)
*ENG
019 C (Max Abs Hum)
*ENG
020 M (Max Abs Hum)
*ENG
021 Y (Max Abs Hum)
*ENG
SM Appendix
[0 to 5 / 0.1 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kv/step]
[1 to 99 / 15 / 1 g/m3/step]
9-153 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
014 K (Max Correction)
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 3612
[Vk Display] Displays Vk for each color.
001 Bk
*ENG
002 C
*ENG
003 M
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
[-300 to 300 / - / 1 V/step]
[Dev. DC Control:Display] 3621
Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 70 mm/sec Displays the development DC bias adjusted with the process control for each line speed and color.
001 Standard Speed:Bk
*ENG
002 Standard Speed:C
*ENG
003 Standard Speed:M
*ENG
004 Standard Speed:Y
*ENG
009 Low Speed:Bk
*ENG
010 Low Speed:C
*ENG
011 Low Speed:M
*ENG
012 Low Speed:Y
*ENG
[0 to 700 / 550 / 1 -V/step]
[Charge DC Control: Display] 3631
Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec Displays the charge DC voltage adjusted with the process control for each line speed and color.
001 Standard Speed:Bk
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 690 / 1 -V/step]
9-154 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 002 Standard Speed:C
*ENG
003 Standard Speed:M
*ENG
004 Standard Speed:Y
*ENG
009 Low Speed:Bk
*ENG
010 Low Speed:C
*ENG
011 Low Speed:M
*ENG
012 Low Speed:Y
*ENG
[Charge DC Control: Display] 3641
Standard: 120 mm/sec Displays the charge AC voltage adjusted with the process control for each color.
001 Standard Speed:Bk
*ENG
002 Standard Speed:C
*ENG
003 Standard Speed:M
*ENG
004 Standard Speed:Y
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 1.75 / 0.01 kV/step]
[LD Power Control: Display] 3651
Standard: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec Displays the LD power adjusted for each environment. *ENG
002 Standard Speed:C
*ENG
003 Standard Speed:M
*ENG
004 Standard Speed:Y
*ENG
009 Low Speed:Bk
*ENG
SM Appendix
[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 %/step]
9-155 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Standard Speed:Bk
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 010 Low Speed:C
*ENG
011 Low Speed:M
*ENG
012 Low Speed:Y
*ENG
[HST Controll Setting] 3710
TD Sensor: Toner Concentration Control Setting Selects the toner concentration control method by HST memory, which is in the TD sensor.
001 Control Selection
3711
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Not Use, 1: Use
[HST Control: Bk] Displays the factory settings of the black PCU.
001 Vcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]
002 Vt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]
003 Sensitivity: HL
*ENG
[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.5 / 0.01 V/step]
004 Sensitivity: HM
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 1.3 / 0.01 V/step]
005 Sensitivity: ML
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 1.2 / 0.01 V/step]
006 Set Detection
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]
007 Without Developer
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]
008 With Developer
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]
009 Serial Number 1
*ENG
010 Serial Number 2
*ENG
011 Adjustment: Vt
*ENG
012 Adjustment: Vtref
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
9-156 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 013 Adjustment: Vtcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
014 Adjustment: Gamma
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]
015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]
3712
[HST Control: C] Displays the factory settings of the magenta PCU.
001 Vcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]
002 Vt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]
003 Sensitivity: HL
*ENG
[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.5 / 0.01 V/step]
004 Sensitivity: HM
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 1.3 / 0.01 V/step]
005 Sensitivity: ML
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 1.2 / 0.01 V/step]
006 Set Detection
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]
007 Without Developer
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]
008 With Developer
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]
009 Serial Number 1
*ENG
010 Serial Number 2
*ENG
011 Adjustment: Vt
*ENG
012 Adjustment: Vtref
*ENG
013 Adjustment: Vtcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
014 Adjustment: Gamma
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]
015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
[HST Control: M]
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3713
[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]
Displays the factory settings of the cyan PCU.
SM Appendix
9-157 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001 Vcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]
002 Vt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]
003 Sensitivity: HL
*ENG
[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.1 / 0.01 V/step]
004 Sensitivity: HM
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 1.3 / 0.01 V/step]
005 Sensitivity: ML
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 1.2 / 0.01 V/step]
006 Set Detection
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]
007 Without Developer
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]
008 With Developer
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]
009 Serial Number 1
*ENG
010 Serial Number 2
*ENG
011 Adjustment: Vt
*ENG
012 Adjustment: Vtref
*ENG
013 Adjustment: Vtcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
014 Adjustment: Gamma
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]
015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]
3714
[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
[HST Concentration Control: Y] Displays the factory settings of the yellow PCU.
001 Vcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]
002 Vt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]
003 Sensitivity: HL
*ENG
[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.5 / 0.01 V/step]
004 Sensitivity: HM
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 1.3 / 0.01 V/step]
005 Sensitivity: ML
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 1.2 / 0.01 V/step]
006 Set Detection
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-158 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 007 Without Developer
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]
008 With Developer
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]
009 Serial Number 1
*ENG
010 Serial Number 2
*ENG
011 Adjustment: Vt
*ENG
012 Adjustment: Vtref
*ENG
013 Adjustment: Vtcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
014 Adjustment: Gamma
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]
015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]
[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
[Toner Collection Bttl Full] 3800
Displays/ adjusts the toner collection bottle detection settings. These SPs are used for NRS.
001 Condition
*CTL
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]
002 Detection Times
*CTL
[0 to 50 / - / 1 /step]
003 Print Page AF Near Full
*CTL
[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
004 Pixel Count AF Near Full
*CTL
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step] Displays the pixel counter after
005 Pixel Count Af Replacement
*CTL
replacement of toner collection bottle. [0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
008 Coefficient
*ENG
[0.1 to 1 / 1 / 0.1 /step] Enables or disables the calling for @Remote.
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Enable @Remote calling 1: Disable @Remote calling
SM Appendix
9-159 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
011 Notice Setting
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode NOTE: If the toner collection bottle has been replaced before the machine detects used toner near full when this setting is set to "0", the machine cannot detect toner collection bottle near full. In that case, set SP3-902-017 to "1". Day Thresh:NF
*ENG
[1 to 30 / 10 / 1 day/step]
012 Sets the threshold days for the near-full display. The near-full of the toner collection bottle is displayed after the toner collection full sensor has detected the actuator in the toner collection bottle. Displays the total amount of the used 013 Total Collected Toner
*ENG
toner. [0 to 999999999 / 1 / 1]
014 Full Detected Date
3810
Displays the date of the full detection
*ENG
for the toner collection bottle.
[ITB T-Collection Bttl Full]
001 Condition
*CTL
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]
002 Detection Times
*CTL
[0 to 50 / - / 1 /step]
003 Print Page Af Near Full
*CTL
[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
*CTL
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
004
005
Pixel Count After Near Full Pixel Count Af Replacement
008 Coefficient
Displays the pixel counter after *CTL
replacement of toner collection bottle. [0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
*ENG
[0.1 to 1 / 1 / 0.1 /step] Enables or disables the calling for @Remote.
011 Notice Setting
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Enable @Remote calling 1: Disable @Remote calling
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-160 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode NOTE: If the toner collection bottle has been replaced before the machine detects used toner near full when this setting is set to "0", the machine cannot detect toner collection bottle near full. In that case, set SP3-902-017 to "1". Day Thresh:NF
*ENG
[1 to 30 / 10 / 1 day/step]
012 Sets the threshold days for the near-full display. The near-full of the toner collection bottle is displayed after the toner collection full sensor has detected the actuator in the toner collection bottle. Displays the total amount of the used 013 Total Collected Toner
*ENG
toner. [0 to 999999999 / 1 / 1]
014 Full Detected Date
3901
*ENG
Displays the date of the full detection fot the toner collection bottle.
[New PCU Detection] Turns new PCU detection on or off.
001 ON/OFF Setting
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON
[Manual New Unit Set] 3902
Turns the new unit detection flag for each PM unit on or off. The use of these counters is explained in the PM section and in the relevant parts of section 3 (Replacement and Adjustment). *ENG
002 Development Unit: C
*ENG
003 Development Unit: M
*ENG
004 Development Unit: Y
*ENG
005 Developer: Bk
*ENG
SM Appendix
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Development Unit: Bk
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
9-161 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 006 Developer: C
*ENG
007 Developer: M
*ENG
008 Developer: Y
*ENG
009 PCU: Bk
*ENG
010 PCU: C
*ENG
011 PCU: M
*ENG
012 PCU: Y
*ENG
013 ITB Unit
*ENG
014 Fusing Unit
*ENG
015 Fusing Roller
*ENG
016 Fusing Belt
*ENG
017 ITB Cleaning Unit
*ENG
0: OFF, 1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON Do not use 3902-013 if you only change the cleaning unit. 3902-015: This is for the image transfer belt cleaning unit.
018 PTR Unit 019
020
PCU Toner Collection Bottle ITB Toner Collection Bottle
*ENG *ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON
*ENG
SP4-XXX (Scanner)
4008
[Sub Scan Mag. Adjustment] Adjusts the sub-scan magnification by changing the scanner motor speed.
001
Sub Scan Mag. Adjustment
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
[-1.0 to 1.0 / 0 / 0.1%/step] FA
9-162 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [L-Edge Regist Adjustment] 4010
Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the scanning start timing in the sub-scan direction.
001
*ENG
[-2.0 to 2.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step] FA
[S-to-S Regist Adjustment] 4011
Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the scanning start timing in the main scan direction.
001 -
*ENG
[-2.5 to 2.5 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] FA
[Scanner Erase Margin: Scale] Scanner: Erase Margin: Scale 4012
Sets the blank margin at each side for erasing the original shadow caused by the gap between the original and the scale.
001 Book: Leading Edge 002 Book: Trailing Edge
*ENG
[0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] FA
*ENG
[0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] FA
003 Book: Left 004 Book: Right 005 ADF: Leading Edge 007 ADF: Left 008 ADF: Right
[Scanner Free Run] 4013
Performs the scanner free run with the exposure lamp on or off in the following mode.
001 Lamp: OFF
SM Appendix
*ENG
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Full color mode / Full Size / A3 or DLT [0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
9-163 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 002 Lamp: ON
4014
0: OFF, 1: ON
[Scan] Execute the scanner free fun with each mode.
001 HP Detection Enable
-
002 HP Detection Disable
-
4020
Scanner free run with HP sensor check. Scanner free run without HP sensor check.
[Dust Check] Turns the ADF scan glass dust check on/
001 Detection: ON/OFF
*ENG
off. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: OFF, 1: ON Selects the detect level.
002 Dust Detect: Level
*ENG
[0 to 8 / 4 / 1 /step] 0: lowest detection level 8: highest detection level Selects the level of the sub scan line correction when using the ARDF. [0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]
003 Correction Level
*ENG
0: Off 1: Weakest 2: Weak 3: Strong 4: Strongest
[APS Operation Check] 4301
Displays a code that represents the original size detected by the original sensors. (See "Input Check Table".)
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-164 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001 APS Operation Check
-
-
[APS Min Size] 4303
Specifies the result of the detection when the outputs from the original sensors are all OFF. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
001
APS Min. Size
*ENG
(A5/HLT/16K)
0: No Original 1: A5-Lengthwise (16K SEF if 4305 is set to 3)
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Normal Detection (the machine detects A4/LT size as A4 or LT, depending on the 4305
*ENG
[8K/16K Detection]
paper size setting) 1: A4-Sideways LT-Lengthwise 2: LT-Sideways A4-Lengthwise 3: 8K 16K
001 This program enables the machine to automatically recognize the 8K/16K size.
4308
[Scan Size Detection]
001 Detection: ON/OFF
4309
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: OFF, 1: ON
[Scan Size Deted Setting]
001 Original Density Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 32 / 1 digit /step]
002 Detection Time
*ENG
[20 to 100 / 60 / 20 msec /step]
003 Lamp ON:Delay Time
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
4310
[0 to 200 / 40 / 20 msec /step]
[Scan Size Detect Value]
SM Appendix
9-165 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001 S1:R
*ENG
002 S1:G
*ENG
003 S1:B
*ENG
004 S2:R
*ENG
005 S2:G
*ENG
006 S2:B
*ENG
007 S3:R
*ENG
008 S3:G
*ENG
009 S3:B
*ENG
[Scanner Erase Margin] 4400
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 digit /step]
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 digit /step]
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 digit /step]
*ENG
Set the Mask for Original. These SPs set the area to be masked during platen (book) mode scanning. 001 Book: Leading Edge 002 Book: Trailing Edge 003 Book: Left [0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step]
004 Book: Right 005 ADF: Leading Edge 007 ADF: Left 008 ADF: Right
4417
[IPU Test Pattern] Selects the IPU test pattern.
001
Test Pattern
[0 to 24 / 0 / 1/step ]
13: Grid pattern CMYK
Selection
0: Scanned image
14: Color patch CMYK
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-166 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 1: Gradation main scan A
15: Gray pattern (1)
2: Gradation main scan B
16: Gray pattern (2)
3: Gradation main scan C
17: Gray Pattern (3)
4: Gradation main scan D
18: Shading pattern
5: Gradation sub scan (1)
19: Thin line pattern
6: Grid pattern
20: Scanned + Grid pattern
7: Slant grid pattern
21: Scanned + Gray scale
8: Gradation RGBCMYK
22: Scanned + Color patch
9: UCR pattern
23: Scanned + Slant Grid C
10: Color patch 16 (1)
24: Scanned + Slant Grid D
11: Color patch 16 (2) 12: Color patch 64
4429
[Illegal Copy Output]
001 Copy *ENG
002 Scanner
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
003 Fax
4440
[Saturation Adjustment] Adjusts the level of saturation for copying. [0 to 5 / 3 / 1 /step] 0: High 1: Lowest
001 -
*ENG
2: Lower 3: Default 4: Higher 5: Highest
[Scan Image Path Selection] 001 Black Subtraction ON/OFF
SM Appendix
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
4450
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON
9-167 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Uses or does not use the black reduction image path.
002
SH ON/OFF
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: ON, 1: OFF
Uses or does not use the shading image path.
[Digital AE Set] DFU 4460
Specifies the level of deleting the background in the ADS mode. You can adjust its level for each scanning method (platen, ADF).
001 Lower Limit
*ENG
[0 to 1023 / 364 / 4 digit/step]
002 Background Level
*ENG
[512 to 1532 / 932 / 1 digit/step]
4501
[ACC Target Density] Selects the ACC result.
001 Copy: Bk: Text
*ENG
002 Copy: C: Text
*ENG
003 Copy: M: Text
*ENG
004 Copy: Y: Text
*ENG
005 Copy: Bk: Photo
*ENG
006 Copy: C: Photo
*ENG
007 Copy: M: Photo
*ENG
008 Copy: Y: Photo
*ENG
4505
[0 to 10 / 5 / 1 /step] 10: Darkest density
[ACC Correction:Bright] Adjusts the offset correction for light areas of the ACC pattern.
001 Master:K
*ENG
002 Master:C
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 /step]
9-168 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 003 Master:M
*ENG
004 Master:Y
*ENG
005 Slave:K
*ENG
006 Slave:C
*ENG
007 Slave:M
*ENG
008 Slave:Y
*ENG
4506
Reserved
[ACC Correction: Dark] Adjusts the offset correction for dark areas of the ACC pattern.
001 Master:K
*ENG
002 Master:C
*ENG
003 Master:M
*ENG
004 Master:Y
*ENG
005 Slave:K
*ENG
006 Slave:C
*ENG
007 Slave:M
*ENG
008 Slave:Y
*ENG
[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 /step]
Reserved
[Printer Vector Correction] 4540
This SP corrects the printer coverage of 12 hues (RY, YR, YG, etc. x 4 Colors [R, G, B, Option]) for a total of 48 parameters. *ENG
Specifies the printer vector correction value.
005-008 YR Phase: Option/R/G/B
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
009-012 YG Phase: Option/R/G/B
SM Appendix
9-169 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001-004 RY Phase: Option/R/G/B
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 013-016 GY Phase: Option/R/G/B 017-020 GC Phase: Option/R/G/B 021-024 CG Phase: Option/R/G/B 025-028 CB Phase: Option/R/G/B 029-032 BC Phase: Option/R/G/B 033-036 BM Phase: Option/R/G/B 037-040 MB Phase: Option/R/G/B 041-044 MR Phase: Option/R/G/B 045-048 RM Phase: Option/R/G/B
4550
[Scanner Appl.:Text/Chart] DFU
4551
[Scanner Appl.: Text] DFU
4552
[Scanner Appl.:Txt Dropout] DFU
4553
[Scanner Appl.:Text/Photo] DFU
4554
[Scanner Appl.: Photo] DFU
4565
[Scanner Appl.: GrayScale] DFU
4570
[Scan Appl.: Color: Text-Photo] DFU
4571
[Scan Appl.: Color: Glossy Photo] DFU
4572
[Scan Appl.: AutoColor] DFU MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong)
*ENG
-005
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step] 0: MTF Off
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. -006 Smoothing: 0 (x1), 1-7 (Strong)
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
9-170 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 /step]
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.
-007
Brightness: 1–255
*ENG
[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]
Set higher for darker, set lower for lighter.
-008
Contrast: 1–255
*ENG
[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]
Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast. I Dot Erase :0 (x1) 1-7 (Strong)
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]
-009 Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. 0: Not activated
4581
[FAX Appl.: Text/Chart] DFU
4582
[FAX Appl.: Text/Photo] DFU
4583
[FAX Appl.: Photo] DFU MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong)
*ENG
-005
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step] 0: MTF Off
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
-006
Smoothing: 0 (x1), 1-7 (Strong)
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 /step]
Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.
-007
Brightness: 1–255
*ENG
[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]
Set higher for darker, set lower for lighter.
-008
Contrast: 1–255
*ENG
[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]
-009
I Dot Erase (0), 1-7 (Strong)
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]
Selects the contrast level for B/W the Text mode. Sets the erasure level of
SM Appendix
9-171 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. 0: Not activated Texture Erase: 0
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
-010 Sets the erasure level of textures. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. This SP (suffix "-010") only exists in SP4580, 4582 and 4583. 0: Not activated
4581
[FAX Appl.: Text] DFU
4584
[FAX Appl.: Original 1] DFU
4585
[FAX Appl.: Original 2] DFU MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong)
*ENG
-005
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step] 0: MTF Off
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
-006
Smoothing: 0 (x1), 1-7 (Strong)
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 /step]
Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.
-007
Brightness: 1–255
*ENG
[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]
Set higher for darker, set lower for lighter.
-008
Contrast: 1–255
*ENG
[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]
Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast. I Dot Erase (0), 1-7 (Strong)
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]
-009 Selects the contrast level for B/W the Text mode. Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. 0: Not activated
4600
[SBU Version Display]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-172 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [0 to 0xFF / 0 / 1 /step]
001 SBU_ID
-
002 GASBU-N_ID
-
[0 to 0xFF / 0 / 1 /step]
003 VSP5100_ID
-
[0 to 0xFF / 0 / 1 /step]
4602
[Scanner Memory Access]
001 Scanner Memory Access
-
002 Address Set
-
003 Data Set
-
4603
Displays the ID of the SBU.
Enables the read and write check for the SBU registers.
Not used
[AGC Execution]
001 HP Detection Enable
-
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] Executes the AGC.
002 HP Detection Disable
-
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] DFU
4604
[FGATE Open/Close] DFU Opens or closes the FGATE signal. This SP automatically returns to the default
001 -
-
status (close) after exiting this SP. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: OFF, 1: ON
4609
[Gray Balance Set: R] -
[-512 to 511 / -46 / 1 digit/step]
002 DF Scan
-
[-512 to 511 / -46 / 1 digit/step]
4610
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Book Scan
[Gray Balance Set: G]
SM Appendix
9-173 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001 Book Scan
-
[-512 to 511 / -20 / 1 digit/step]
002 DF Scan
-
[-512 to 511 / -20/ 1 digit/step]
001 Book Scan
-
[-512 to 511 / -28 / 1 digit/step]
002 DF Scan
-
[-512 to 511 / -28 / 1 digit/step]
4611
4623
[Gray Balance Set: B]
[Black Level Adj. Display] RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal Displays the black offset value (rough
001 Latest: RE Color
-
adjustment) for the even red signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the black offset value (rough
002 Latest: RO Color
-
adjustment) for the odd red signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4624
[Black Level Adj. Display] GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even green signal in
001 Latest: GE Color
-
the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the black offset value (rough
002 Latest: GO Color
-
adjustment) for the odd green signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-174 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 4625
[Black Level Adj. Display] BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal Displays the black offset value (rough
001 Latest: BE Color
-
adjustment) for the even blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the black offset value (rough
002 Latest: BO Color
-
adjustment) for the odd blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4628
[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.
001 Latest: R Color
4629
-
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
001 Latest: G Color
4630
-
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
001 Latest: B Color
4631
-
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Digital Gain Adjust]
001 Latest: RE Color
-
002 Latest: RO Color
-
SM Appendix
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
9-175 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
4632
[Digital Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
001 Latest: GE Color
-
002 Latest: GO Color
-
4633
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Digital Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
001 Latest: BE Color
-
002 Latest: BO Color
-
4645
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Scan Adjust Error] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller.
001 Black Offset Corr 1
-
002 Black Offset Corr 2
-
4647
[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Read Hard Error] Displays the result of the SBU connection check. [0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 Power-ON
-
0: OK, Other: SBU connection check failure If the SBU connection check fails, SC144 occurs.
4654
001
[Black Level Adj. Display] RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal Last Correct Value: RE Color
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the even red signal in the
9-176 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the black offset value (rough 002
Last Correct Value: RO Color
*ENG
adjustment) for the odd red signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4655
[Black Level Adj. Display] GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal Displays the black offset value (rough
001
Last Correct Value: GE Color
adjustment) for the even green signal in *ENG
the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the black offset value (rough
002
Last Correct Value: GO Color
*ENG
adjustment) for the odd green signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4656
[Black Level Adj. Display] BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal Displays the black offset value (rough
001
Last Correct Value: BE Color
*ENG
adjustment) for the even blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the black offset value (rough
002
Last Correct Value: BO Color
*ENG
adjustment) for the odd blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed).
4658
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Analog Gain Adjust]
SM Appendix
9-177 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red. 001 Last Correct Value: RE Color
4659
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
001 Last Correct Value: GE Color
4660
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
001 Last Correct Value: BE Color
4661
*ENG
[Digital Gain Adjust] RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal
001 Last Correct Value: RE Color
*ENG
002 Last Correct Value: RO Color
*ENG
4662
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Digital Gain Adjust] GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal
001 Last Correct Value: GE Color
*ENG
002 Last Correct Value: GO Color
*ENG
4663
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Digital Gain Adjust] BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal
001 Last Correct Value: BE Color
*ENG
002 Last Correct Value: BO Color
*ENG
D037/D038/D040/D041
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
9-178 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 4673
[Black Level Adj. Display] RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal Displays the factory setting values of the
001
Factory Setting: RE Color
black level adjustment for the even red *ENG
signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed).. [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the factory setting values of the
002
Factory Setting: RO Color
black level adjustment (rough adjustment) *ENG
for the odd red signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4674
[Black Level Adj. Display] GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal Displays the factory setting values of the
001
Factory Setting: GE Color
black level adjustment (rough adjustment) *ENG
for the even green signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the factory setting values of the
002
Factory Setting: GO Color
black level adjustment (rough adjustment) *ENG
for the odd green signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4675
[Black Level Adj. Display] BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal
001
Factory Setting: BE Color
*ENG
black level adjustment (rough adjustment) for the even blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed).
SM Appendix
9-179 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Displays the factory setting values of the
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step] Displays the factory setting values of the 002
black level adjustment (rough adjustment)
Factory Setting: BO
*ENG
Color
for the odd blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing speed). [0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4677
[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Red.
001 Factory Setting: RE Color
4678
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Green.
001 Factory Setting: GE Color
4679
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Analog Gain Adjust] Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Blue.
001 Factory Setting: BE Color
4680
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Digital Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.
001 Latest: RE Color
*ENG
002 Latest: RO Color
*ENG
4681
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Digital Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-180 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001 Latest: GE Color
*ENG
002 Latest: GO Color
*ENG
4682
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Digital Gain Adjust] Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
001 Latest: BE Color
*ENG
002 Latest: BO Color
*ENG
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[DF: Density Adjustment] 4688
Adjusts the white shading parameter when scanning an image with the ARDF. Adjusts the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode is different.
001 -
4690
*ENG
[50 to 150 / 100 / 1%/ step ]
[White Level Peak Read] Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.
001 RE
-
002 RO
-
4691
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[White Level Peak Read] Displays the peak level of the white level scanning. -
002 GO
-
4692
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 GE
[White Level Peak Read] Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.
SM Appendix
9-181 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001 BE
-
002 BO
-
4693
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Black Level Peak Read] Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.
001 RE
-
002 RO
-
4694
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Black Level Peak Read] Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.
001 GE
-
002 GO
-
4695
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Black Level Peak Read] Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.
001 BE
-
002 BO
-
4802
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[DF Shading FreeRun]
001 Lamp ON
Executes the scanner free run of shading -
002 Lamp OFF
movement with exposure lamp on or off. Press "OFF" to stop this free run. Otherwise, the free run lasts.
4804
[Home Position Opetation]
001 -
D037/D038/D040/D041
-
Executes the scanner HP detection.
9-182 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
4806
[Carriage Move] Moves the carriage from the scanner home position.
001 -
Dust may fall through the DF exposure
-
glass. Therefore, do this SP when you transport the machine a long distance.
4807
[SBU Test Pattern Change]
001 -
4808
-
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
-
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
[Factory Setting Input]
002 Execution Flag
[ACC Data Display] 4902
This SP outputs the final data read at the end of ACC execution. A zero is returned if there was an error reading the data. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 R DATA1
*ENG
Photo C Patch Level 1 (8-bit)
002 G DATA1
*ENG
Photo M Patch Level 1 (8-bit)
003 B DATA1
*ENG
Photo Y Patch Level 1 (8-bit)
004 R DATA2
*ENG
Photo C Patch Level 17 (8-bit)
005 G DATA2
*ENG
Photo M Patch Level 17(8-bit)
006 B DATA2
*ENG
Photo Y Patch Level 17 (8-bit)
001
[IPU Board Test] Test1
SM Appendix
-
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
4904
Bit0: TAURUS register
9-183 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Bit1: ORION register Bit2: LUPUS register Bit3 to 11: Not used Bit12: Ri20 Bit13 to 15: Not used 0: OK, 1: Error Performs a write and read check of the ASICs on the BCU board and displays the result. Bit0: Image path from SBU to TAURUS Bit1: Image path from TAURUS to ORION Bit2: Image path from ORION to TAURUS Bit3: Image path from TAURUS to LUPUS 002
Test2
Bit4 to 11: Not used
-
Bit12: Image path from LUPUS to Ri20 Bit13: Image path from Ri20 to GAVD Bit14 and 15: Not used 0: OK, 1: Error Performs an image path check on the BCU board and displays the result.
4905
[Dither Selection] DFU Changes the parameters for error diffusion.
001 Dither Selection
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step] DFU
4909
[Man Gamma:Photo:Mono Bk] DFU
4910
[Man Gamma:Text:Bk]
4911
[Man Gamma:Text:C]
4912
[Man Gamma:Text:M]
4913
[Man Gamma:Text:Y]
001 Offset:Highlight
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
[0 to 30 / 15 / 1 /step]
9-184 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 002 Offset:Middle
*ENG
003 Offset:Shadow
*ENG
004 Offset:Idmax
*ENG
005 Option:Highlight
*ENG
006 Option:Middle
*ENG
007 Option:Shadow
*ENG
008 Option:Idmax
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
4914
[Man Gamma: Text:Mono Bk] DFU
4915
[Man Gamma:Photo:Bk]
4916
[Man Gamma:Photo:C]
4917
[Man Gamma:Photo:M]
4918
[Man Gamma:Photo:Y]
001 Offset:Highlight
*ENG
002 Offset:Middle
*ENG
003 Offset:Shadow
*ENG
004 Offset:Idmax
*ENG
005 Option:Highlight
*ENG
006 Option:Middle
*ENG
007 Option:Shadow
*ENG
008 Option:Idmax
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
[ACC History: Latest]
001 YY/MM/DD
*ENG
-
002 HH/MM/SS
*ENG
-
SM Appendix
9-185 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
4948
[0 to 30 / 15 / 1 /step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
4949
[ACC History: Previous]
001 YY/MM/DD
4954
*ENG
-
[Read/Restore Standard] -
001 Scan New Chart *ENG
002 Recall Previous Chart
[0 or 1 / 0 / - /step]
004 Set Standard Chart
[IPU Image Path Selection ] 4991
Selects the image path. Enter the number to be selected using the 10-key pad. RGB Frame Memory
*ENG
[0 to 11 / 2 / 1 /step ]
0: Scanner input RGB images 1: Scanner I/F RGB images 2: RGB images done by Shading correction (Shading ON, Black offset ON) 3: Shading data 001
4: Inner pattern data: Gray scale 5: RGB images done by Line skipping correction 6: RGB images done by Digital AE 7: RGB images done by Vertical line correction 8: RGB image done by Scanner gamma correction 9: RGB image done by Filtering correction 10: RGB images done by Full color ADS 11: RGB image done by Color correction
4993
[High Light Correction]
001 Sensitivity Selection
D037/D038/D040/D041
*ENG
Selects the Highlight correction level.
9-186 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step] 0: weakest sensitivity 9: strongest sensitivity Selects the range level of Highlight correction. 002 Range Selection
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step] 0: weakest skew correction, 9: strongest skew correction
4994
[Text/Photo Detection Level Adj.] Selects the definition level between Text and Photo for high compression PDF. [0 to 2 / 1 / 1 /step]
001
High Compression PDFvity Level text/photo
*ENG
0: Text priority 1: Normal 2: Photo priority
SP5-XXX (Mode)
5024
[mm/inch Display Selection] Display units (mm or inch) for custom paper sizes.
001 0:mm 1:inch
*CTL
0: mm (Europe/Asia) 1: inch (USA)
[Accounting Counter] 5045
Selects the counting method. NOTE: The counting method can be changed only once, regardless of whether
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
the counter value is negative or positive. [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 001 Counter Method
*CTL 0: Developments 1: Prints
SM Appendix
9-187 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
5047
[Paper Display] Turns on or off the printed paper display on the LCD.
001 -
5051
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON
[Toner Refill Detection Display] Enables or disables the toner refill detection display.
5051 1
5055
Toner Refill Detection Display
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] Alphanumeric *CTL 0: ON 1: OFF
[Display IP Address] Display or does not display the IP address on the LCD.
001 -
5056
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF 1: ON
[Coverage Counter Display] Display or does not display the coverage counter on the LCD.
001 -
5061
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Not display, 1: Display
[Toner Remaining Icon Display] Display or does not display the remaining toner display icon on the LCD.
001 -
D037/D038/D040/D041
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Not display, 1: Display
9-188 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 5062
[Parts PM System Setting] Display or does not display the PM part yield on the LCD.
001 PCU:Bk
*CTL
002 PCU:M
*CTL
003 PCU:C
*CTL
004 PCU:Y
*CTL
005 Dev Unit:Bk
*CTL
006 Dev Unit:M
*CTL
007 Dev Unit:C
*CTL 0: Not display, 1: Display
008 Dev Unit:Y
*CTL
009 Fusing Unit
*CTL
010 Fusing Roller
*CTL
011 Fusing Belt
*CTL
012
5066
PCU Toner Collection Bottle
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
*CTL
[Parts PM Menu Display Setting] Display or does not display the “PM parts” button on the LCD.
001 -
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Not display, 1: Display
[Parts PM System Setting] 5067
Selects the service maintenance or user maintenance for each PM parts.
001 PCU:Bk
SM Appendix
*CTL [0: Service] or [1: User]
9-189 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
If the user service is selected, PM alert is displayed on the LCD.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 002 PCU:M
*CTL
003 PCU:C
*CTL
004 PCU:Y
*CTL
005 Dev Unit:Bk
*CTL
006 Dev Unit:M
*CTL
007 Dev Unit:C
*CTL
008 Dev Unit:Y
*CTL
009 Fusing Unit
*CTL
010 Fusing Roller
*CTL
011 Fusing Belt
*CTL
012
5113
PCU Toner Collection
[0: Service] or [1: User]
[0: Service] or [1: User]
*CTL
Bottle
[Optional Counter Type] This program specifies the counter type. 0: None, 1: Key card (RK 3, 4)
001
Default Optional Counter Type
*CTL
2: Key card (down), 3: Prepaid card 4: Coin rack, 5: MF key card 8: Key counter + Vendor 9: Bar-code Printer This program specifies the external counter type.
002
External Optional Counter Type
*CTL
0: None 1: Expansion Device 1 2: Expansion Device 2 3: Expansion Device 3
5114
[Optional Counter I/F]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-190 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001 MF Key Card Extension
5118
*CTL
[0: Not installed/ 1: Installed (scanning accounting)]
*CTL [0: Not disabled/ 1: Disabled]
[Disable Copying]
001 This program disables copying.
5120
001
5121 001
[Mode Clear Opt.
*CTL
Counter Removal]
[0: Yes (removed)/ 1: Standby (installed but not used)/ 2: No (not removed)]
This program updates the information on the optional counter. When you install or remove an optional counter, check the settings.
*CTL [0: Feed/ 1: Exit]
[Counter Up Timing]
This program specifies when the counter goes up. The settings refer to “paper feed” and “paper exit” respectively.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step] 5126
0: 8 1/2" x 13" (Foolscap)
*ENG
[F Size Original Setting]
1: 8 1/4" x 13" (Folio) 2: 8" x 13" (F)
001 Selects F size original setting.
5127
[APS Mode]
*CTL
[0: Not disabled/ 1: Disabled]
001 This program disables the APS.
5128
[Code Mode With Key/Card Option]
*CTL -
5131
[Paper Size Type Selection]
SM Appendix
*ENG
[0: JP (Japan)/ 1: NA / 2: EU]
9-191 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 DFU
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 001
5150
The program selects a paper size system from the following alternatives: the AB system (0), the LT system (1), and the AF system (2).
*CTL
[By-Pass Length Setting]
[0: OFF/ 1: ON]
Determines whether the transfer sheet from the by-pass tray is used or not. 001 Normally the paper length for sub scanning paper from the by-pass tray is limited to 600 mm, but this can be extended with this SP to 1260 mm.
5162
[App. Switch Method]
*CTL [0: Soft Key Set/ 1: Hard Key Set]
001 This program specifies the switch that selects an application program.
[Fax Printing Mode at Optional] 5167
Enables or disables the automatic print out without an accounting device. This SP is used when the receiving fax is accounted by an external accounting device.
001
Fax Printing Mode at Optional Counter Off
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] *CTL
0: Automatic printing 1: No automatic printing
[CE Login] 5169
If you will change the printer bit switches, you must ‘log in’ to service mode with this SP before you go into the printer SP mode. [0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 CE Login
*CTL
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
5179
[By-pass Size Error Detection] Turns on or off the by-pass tray size error message.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-192 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: OFF 001 -
*ENG
1: ON (Paper size error message is displayed when the paper jam occurs due to the wrong direction of set paper in by-pass mode.)
5181
[Size Adjust] Adjusts the paper size for each tray. *ENG
002 TRAY 1: 2
*ENG
003 TRAY 1: 3
*ENG
004 TRAY 1: 4
*ENG
005 TRAY 2: 1
*ENG
006 TRAY 2: 2
*ENG
007 TRAY 2: 3
*ENG
008 TRAY 2: 4
*ENG
009 TRAY 3: 1
*ENG
010 TRAY 3: 2
*ENG
SM Appendix
[0 to 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / 1 /step] 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A3, 1: DLT [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B4, 1: LG [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A3, 1: DLT [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B4, 1: LG [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A3, 1: DLT
9-193 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 TRAY 1:1
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 011 TRAY 3: 3
*ENG
012 TRAY 3: 4
*ENG
013 TRAY 4: 1
*ENG
014 TRAY 4: 2
*ENG
015 TRAY 4: 3
*ENG
016 TRAY 4: 4
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B4, 1: LG [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF [0 to 2 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A4LEF, 1: LTLEF [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: A3, 1: DLT [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B4, 1: LG [0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[RK 4 Disconnect Operation] 5186
Enables or disables the prevention for RK4 (accounting device) disconnection. If the RK4 is disconnected for 10 seconds when this SP is set to "1 (Enable)", the machine automatically jams a sheet of paper and stops. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
001 -
*ENG
0: Disable 1: Enable
5188
[Copy NV Version] Displays the version number of the NVRAM on the controller board.
001 -
5195
-
-
-
-
[Limitless SW] DFU
001 -
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-194 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 5196
[90 degree rotation (copy)]
001 -
5212
-
[Page Numbering]
*CTL
This program adjusts the position of the second side page numbers. A "– value" moves the page number positions to the left edge. A "+ value" moves the page number positions to the right edge. 003 Duplex Printout Right/Left Position
[–10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
004 Duplex Printout High/Low Position
[Set Time] Adjusts the RTC (real time clock) time setting for the local time zone. Examples: For Japan (+9 GMT), enter 540 (9 hours x 60 min.) 5302
DOM: +540 (Tokyo) NA: -300 (New York) EU: + 60 (Paris) CH: +480 (Peking) TW: +480 (Taipei) AS: +480 (Hong Kong)
002 Time Difference
5307
*CTL#
[-1440 to 1440 / Area / 1 min./step ]
[Summer Time] [ 0 to 1 / NA, EU, ASIA / 1 /step] Setting
-
0: Disabled 1: Enabled NA and EUR: 1, ASIA: 0
001
SM Appendix
Make sure that both SP5-307-3 and -4 are correctly set. Otherwise,
9-195 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Enables or disables the summer time mode.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode this SP is not activated even if this SP is set to "1". Rule Set (Start)
-
Specifies the start setting for the summer time mode. There are 8 digits in this SP. For months 1 to 9, the "0" cannot be input in the first digit, so the eight-digit setting for -2 or -3 becomes a seven-digit setting. 1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12] 3rd digit: The week of the month. [1 to 5] 003 4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 6 = Sunday to Saturday] 5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23] 7th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 9 / 1 hour
/step]
8th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 5 / 10 minutes /step] For example: 3500010 (EU default) The timer is advanced by 1 hour at am 0:00 on the 5th Sunday in March
The digits are counted from the left.
Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1".
Rule Set (End)
-
-
Specifies the end setting for the summer time mode. There are 8 digits in this SP. 1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12] 004 3rd digit: The week of the month. [0 to 5] 4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 7 = Sunday to Saturday] 5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23] The 7th and 8 digits must be set to "00".
The digits are counted from the left.
Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1".
[Access Control] 5401
When installing the SDK application, SAS (VAS) adjusts the following settings. DFU Whenever a new login user is added to 103 Default Document ACL
*CTL
the address book in external certification mode (for Windows, LDAP, RDH), the
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-196 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode default document ACL is updated according to this SP setting. [0 to 3 / 0 / 1] 0: View 1: Edit 2: Edit/Delete 3: Full control Note: This SP setting is ignored on a machine that is not using document server. 162
Extend Certification
-
Detail
200 SDK1 Unique ID 201
*CTL
SDK1 Certification
*CTL
Method
210 SDK2 Unique ID 211
*CTL
SDK2 Certification
*CTL
Method
"SDK" is the "Software Development Kit". This data can be converted from SAS (VAS) when installed or uninstalled. (DFU)
220 SDK3 Unique ID 221
SDK3 Certification
230 SDK certification device
*CTL
240 Detail Option
*CTL
-
[User Code Counter Clear] 001 UCodeCtrClr
5411
*CTL
Method
*CTL
Clears all counters for users. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
5404
*CTL
[LDAP Certification]
SM Appendix
9-197 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Determines whether easy LDAP 004 Easy Certification
*CTL
certification is done. [0 to 1/1/1] 1: On, 0: Off This SP is referenced only when
005
Password Null Not Permit
SP5411-4 is set to "1" (On). *CTL
[0 to 1/0/1] 0: Password NULL not permitted. 1: Password NULL permitted.
5413
[Lockout Setting] Switches on/off the lock on the local 001 Lockout On/Off
*CTL
address book account. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On Sets a limit on the frequency of lockouts
002 Lockout Threshold
*CTL
for account lockouts. [1 to 10 / 5 / 1] Determines whether the system waits the prescribed time for input of a correct user ID and password after an account lockout has occurred.
003 Cancellation On/Off
*CTL
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Off (no wait time, lockout not cancelled) 1: On (system waits, cancels lockout if correct user ID and password are entered. Determines the length of time that the system waits for correct input of the user
004 Cancellation Time
*CTL
ID and password after a lockout has occurred. This setting is used only if SP5413-3 is set to "1" (on).
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-198 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [1 to 999 / 60 / 1 min.] 005 Counter Clear Time
5414
Not Used
[Access Mitigation] Switches on/off masking of continuously used IDs and passwords that are 001 Mitigation On/Off
*CTL
identical. [0 to 1 / 0 /1] 0: Off 1: On Sets the length of time for excluding
002 Mitigation Time
*CTL
continuous access for identical user IDs and passwords. [0 to 60 / 15 / 1 min.]
5415
[Password Attack] Sets the number of attempts to attack the 001 Permissible Number
*CTL
system with random passwords to gain illegal access to the system. [0 to 100 / 30 / 1 attempt] Sets the time limit to stop a password
002 Detect Time
*CTL
attack once such an attack has been detected. [1 to 10 / 5 / 1 sec.]
5416
[Access Information] Limits the number of users used by the Access User Max Number
*CTL
access exclusion and password attack detection functions. [50 to 200 / 200 / 1 users]
SM Appendix
9-199 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Limits the number of passwords used by 002
Access Password Max Number
*CTL
the access exclusion and password attack detection functions. [50 to 200 / 200 / 1 passwords] Sets the processing time interval for
003 Monitor Interval
*CTL
referencing user ID and password information. [1 to 10 / 3 / 1 sec.]
5417
[Access Attack] Sets a limit on access attempts when an 001
Access Permissible
*CTL
Number
excessive number of attempts are detected for MFP features. [0 to 500 / 100 / 1] Sets the length of time for monitoring the
002 Attack Detect Time
*CTL
frequency of access to MFP features. [10 to 30 / 10 / 1 sec.] Sets the wait time to slow down the speed of certification when an excessive
003 Productivity Fall Wait
*CTL
number of access attempts have been detected. [0 to 9 / 3 / 1 sec.] Sets a limit on the number of requests received for certification in order to slow
004 Attack Max Number
*CTL
down the certification speed when an excessive number of access attempts have been detected. [50 to 200 / 200 /1 attempt]
5420
[User Authentication] These settings should be done with the System Administrator.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-200 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Note: These functions are enabled only after the user access feature has been enabled. Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the copy 001 Copy
*CTL
applications. [0 to 1 / 0 /1] 0: On, 1: Off
002 Color Security Setting
*CTL
Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the
011 Document Server
*CTL
document server. [0 to 1 / 0 /1] 0: On, 1: Off Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the fax
021 Fax
*CTL
application. [0 to 1 / 0 /1] 0: On, 1: Off Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the scan
031 Scanner
*CTL
applications. [0 to 1 / 0 /1] 0: On, 1: Off Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the printer
041 Printer
*CTL
applications. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: On, 1: Off
051 SDK1
071 SDK3
SM Appendix
*CTL
Determines whether certification is required before a user can use the SDK application.
9-201 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
061 SDK2
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
5481
[Authentication Error Code] These SP codes determine how the authentication failures are displayed. Determines whether an error code appears in the system log after a user 001 System Log Disp
*CTL
authentication failure occurs. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On Determines whether an error code appears on the operation panel after a
002 Panel Disp
*CTL
user authentication failure occurs. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 1: On, 0: Off
5490
[MF Key Card (Japan only)] Sets up operation of the machine with a keycard. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 001 -
*CTL
0: Disabled. Cancels operation without a user code. 1: Enabled. Allows operation without a user code.
002 Count Mode Setting
5501
*CTL
-
[PM Alarm] Sets the PM alarm interval 001 PM Alarm Level
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1k printouts / step] 0: No PM Alarm
002 Original Count Alarm
D037/D038/D040/D041
*CTL
-
9-202 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 5504
*CTL
[Jam Alarm]
-
Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are not included). [0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step] 001 0: Zero (Off) 1: Low (2.5K jams) 2: Medium (3K jams) 3: High (6K jams)
[Error Alarm] Sets the error alarm level. 5505
The error alarm counter counts "1" when any SC is detected. However, the error alarm counter decreases by "1" when an SC is not detected during a set number of copied sheets (for example, default 1500 sheets). The error alarm occurs when the SC error alarm counter reaches "5". 001 -
5507
[Supply Alarm]
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 255 / 20 / 100 copies /step]
-
001 Paper Supply Alarm
0: Off, 1: On, DFU
002 Staple Supply Alarm
0: Off, 1: On, Japan only
003 Toner Supply Alarm
0: Off, 1: On, DFU Changes the timing of the “Toner Supply Call” via the @Remote, when the following conditions
080 Toner Call Timing
occur. 0: At replacement 1: At near end [250 to 10000 / 1000 / 1 /step] DFU Appendix: SP Mode Tables
128 Interval :Others 132 Interval :A3 133 Interval :A4
SM Appendix
9-203 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 134 Interval :A5 141 Interval :B4 142 Interval :B5 160 Interval :DLT 164 Interval :LG 166 Interval :LT 172 Interval :HLT
5508*
001*
*CTL
[CC Call] Jam Remains
-
0: Disable, 1: Enable
Enables/disables initiating a call for an unattended paper jam.
002*
Continuous Jams
0: Disable, 1: Enable
Enables/disables initiating a call for consecutive paper jams.
003*
Continuous Door Open
0: Disable, 1: Enable
Enables/disables initiating a call when the front door remains open. Jam Detection: Time Length 011*
[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 minute /step]
Sets the time a jam must remain before it becomes an “unattended paper jam”. This setting is enabled only when SP5508-004 is set to "1". Jam Detection: Continuous Count
012*
[2 to 10 / 5 / 1 /step]
Sets the number of consecutive paper jams required to initiate a call. This setting is enabled only when SP5508-004 is set to "1". Door Open: Time Length
[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 /step]
013* Sets the length of time the door remains open before the machine initiates a call. This setting is enabled only when SP5-508-004 is set to "1".
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-204 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 5515
5610
5611
001
[SC Alarm Setting] 001 SC Call
-
002 Service Parts Near End Call
-
003 Service Parts End Call
-
004 User Call
-
006 Communication Test Call
-
007 Machine Information Notice
-
008 Alarm Notice
-
009 Non Genuin Tonner Alarm
-
010 Supply Automatic Ordering Call
-
011 Supply Manegement Report Call
-
012 Jam/Door Open Call
-
[Base Gamma Cutl P: Command] 004 Recall Factory Setting
-
005 Restore Factory Setting
-
006 Restore Prev. Setting
-
[Toner Color in 2C] B-C
*ENG
[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step] 128: Darkest density
002
B-M
*ENG
[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step] 128: Darkest density
Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
SM Appendix
9-205 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode G-C
003
[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]
*ENG
128: Darkest density
Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the green signal in two-color mode. G-Y
004
[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]
*ENG
128: Darkest density
Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the green signal in two-color mode. R-M
005
[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]
*ENG
128: Darkest density
Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the red signal in two-color mode. R-Y
006
[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]
*ENG
128: Darkest density
Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the red signal in two-color mode.
5618
[Color Mode Display Selection] [0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 001
-
*CTL
0: ACS, Color, Black & White, Two Color, Single color 1: ACD, Full Color, Black & White
Selects the color selection display on the LCD.
Memory Clear (SP5-801)
The following tables list the items that are cleared. The serial number information, meter charge setting and meter charge counters (SP8-581, 582, 583, 584, and 586) are not cleared.
5792
[MCS Debug SW] 001 1
-
002 2
-
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-206 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
5792
003 3
-
004 4
-
[ECS Debug SW] 001 1
5801
-
[Memory Clear] Resets all correction data for process control and 001 All Clear
all software counters, and returns all modes and adjustments to their default values.
002 Engine [ENG]
Clears the engine settings. Initializes default system settings, SCS (System
003 SCS
Control Service) settings, operation display coordinates, and ROM update information.
004 IMH Memory Clr
-
005 MCS
-
006 Copier application
Initializes all copier application settings. Initializes the fax reset time, job login ID, all TX/RX
007 Fax application
settings, local storage file numbers, and off-hook timer. The following service settings: Bit switches
Gamma settings (User & Service)
Toner Limit
The following user settings:
Tray Priority
Menu Protect
System Setting except for setting of Energy Saver
SM Appendix
9-207 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
008 Printer application
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
009 Scanner application
010 Web Service
011 NCS
012 R-Fax
014 Clear DCS Settings
015 Clear UCS Settings
016 MIRS Setting
017 CCS
018 SRM Memory Clr
I/F Setup (I/O Buffer and I/O Timeout)
PCL Menu
Initializes the scanner defaults for the scanner and all the scanner SP modes. Deletes the network file application management files and thumbnails, and initializes the job login ID. All setting of Network Setup (User Menu) (NCS: Network Control Service) Initializes the job login ID, SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin, job history, and local storage file numbers. Initializes the DCS (Delivery Control Service) settings. Initializes the UCS (User Information Control Service) settings. Initializes the MIRS (Machine Information Report Service) settings. Initializes the CCS (Certification and Charge-control Service) settings. Initializes the SRM (System Resource Manager) settings.
019 LCS
-
020 Web Uapli
Initializes the web user application settings.
021 ECS
Initializes the ECS settings.
5803
[Input Check]
See "Input Check Table" in this section.
5804
[Output Check]
See "Output Check Table" in this section.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-208 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 5807
[Area Selection] 002 -
1: Japan, 2: NA, 3: EU, 4: Taiwan
-
5: Asia, 6: Chaina, 7: Korea
[SC Reset] Resets a type A service call condition.
5810
Turn the main switch off and on after resetting the SC code.
001 Fusing SC Reset
5811
-
-
[Machine Serial] Machine Serial Number Display 002 Display
*ENG
Displays the machine serial number.
004 BCU
-
Inputs the serial number for the BCU.
005 FRAM
-
Displays the serial number for the BCU.
5812
[Service Tel. No. Setting] Service
*CTL
-
Sets the telephone number for a service representative. This number is 001 printed on the Counter List, which can be printed with the user’s “Counter” menu. This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input). Facsimile
002
*CTL
-
Sets the fax or telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the Counter List. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input). 003 Supply
SM Appendix
*CTL
-
9-209 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Use this to input the telephone number of your supplier for consumables. Enter the number and press #. Operation 004
*CTL
-
Use this to input the telephone number of your sales agency. Enter the number and press #.
5816
*CTL
[Remote Service]
-
I/F Setting Selects the remote service setting. 001 [0 to 2 / 2 / 1 /step] 0: Remote service off 1: CSS remote service on 2: @Remote service on CE Call Performs the CE Call at the start or end of the service. 002 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Start of the service 1: End of the service NOTE: This SP is activated only when SP 5816-001 is set to “2”. Function Flag
003
Enables or disables the remote service function. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
004 Comunication Test Call 005 Device Information Call SSL Disable 007
Uses or does not use the RCG certification by SSL when calling the RCG. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-210 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 0: Uses the RCG certification 1: Does no use the RCG certification RCG Connect Timeout 008
Specifies the connect timeout interval when calling the RCG. [1 to 90 / 10 / 1 second /step] RCG Write Timeout
009
Specifies the write timeout interval when calling the RCG. [1 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step] RCG Read Timeout
010
Specifies the read timeout interval when calling the RCG. [1 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step] Port 80 Enable
011
Enables/disables access via port 80 to the SOAP method. [0 or 1 / 0 / – ] 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
012 @Remote Communication Permission Setting 013 RFU Timing RCG – C Registed 021 This SP displays the Cumin installation end flag. 0: Installation not completed 1: Installation completed RCG – C Registed Detail
022
This SP displays the Cumin installation status. 0: Basil not registered Appendix: SP Mode Tables
1: Basil registered 2: Device registered 023 Connect Type (N/M)
SM Appendix
9-211 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode This SP displays and selects the Cumin connection method. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step 0: Internet connection 1: Dial-up connection
061
Cert. Expire Timing DFU Proximity of the expiration of the certification. Use Proxy
062
This SP setting determines if the proxy server is used when the machine communicates with the service center. Proxy Host This SP sets the address of the proxy server used for communication between Cumin-N and the gateway. Use this SP to set up or display the
063
customer proxy server address. The address is necessary to set up Cumin-N.
The address display is limited to 128 characters. Characters beyond the 128 character are ignored.
This address is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
Proxy Port Number This SP sets the port number of the proxy server used for communication 064
between Cumin-N and the gateway. This setting is necessary to set up Cumin-N.
This port number is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
Proxy User Name
065
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification user name.
The length of the name is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st character is ignored.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-212 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
Proxy Password This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification password. 066
The length of the password is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st character is ignored.
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
067 CERT: Up State Displays the status of the certification update. 0 1
2
3
4
11
12
The certification used by Cumin is set correctly. The certification request (setAuthKey) for update has been received from the GW URL and certification is presently being updated. The certification update is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the successful update. The certification update failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failed update. The period of the certification has expired and new request for an update is being sent to the GW URL. A rescue update for certification has been issued and a rescue certification setting is in progress for the rescue GW connection. The rescue certification setting is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the certification update request. The notification of the request for certification update has completed successfully, and the system is waiting for the certification update request from the rescue GW URL.
14
SM Appendix
The notification of the certification request has been received from the rescue GW controller, and the certification is being stored.
9-213 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
13
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 15
16
The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified of the successful completion of this event. The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failure of this event. The certification update request has been received from the GW URL,
17
the GW URL was notified of the results of the update after it was completed, but a certification error has been received, and the rescue certification is being recorded.
18
The rescue certification of No. 17 has been recorded, and the GW URL is being notified of the failure of the certification update.
CERT: Error Displays a number code that describes the reason for the request for update of the certification. 0 1 068
2
3
Normal. There is no request for certification update in progress. Request for certification update in progress. The current certification has expired. An SSL error notification has been issued. Issued after the certification has expired. Notification of shift from a common authentication to an individual certification.
4
Notification of a common certification without ID2.
5
Notification that no certification was issued.
6
Notification that GW URL does not exist.
069 CERT: Up ID
The ID of the request for certification.
083 Firmware Up Status
Displays the status of the firmware update. This setting determines if the firmware can be
084 Non-HDD Firm Up
updated, even without the HDD installed. 0: Not allowed update
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-214 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 1: Allowed update This SP setting determines if the operator can confirm the previous version of the firmware before the firmware update execution. If the 085 Firm Up User Check
option to confirm the previous version is selected, a notification is sent to the system manager and the firmware update is done with the firmware files from the URL. Allows the service technician to confirm the size
086 Firmware Size
of the firmware data files during the firmware update execution.
087 CERT: Macro Version
088 CERT: PAC Version
Displays the macro version of the NRS certification. Displays the PAC version of the NRS certification. Displays ID2 for the NRS certification. Spaces
089 CERT: ID2 Code
are displayed as underscores (_). Asteriskes () indicate that no NRS certification exists. Displays the common name of the NRS
090 CERT: Subject
certification subject. CN = the following 17 bytes. Spaces are displayed as underscores (_). Asterisks () indicate that no DESS exists.
091 CERT: Serial Number
Displays serial number for the NRS certification. Asterisks () indicate that no DESS exists. Displays the common name of the issuer of the
092 CERT: Issuer
NRS certification. CN = the following 30 bytes. Asteriskes () indicate that no DESS exists.
094 CERT: Valid End
SM Appendix
Displays the start time of the period for which the current NRS certification is enabled. Displays the end time of the period for which the
9-215 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
093 CERT: Valid Start
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode current NRS certification is enabled. 095 Service CN Check 096 GW Host 097 GW URL Path 099 Debug Rescueg/WURL/set Selection Country Select from the list the name of the country where Cumin-M is installed in the machine. After selecting the country, you must also set the following SP 150
codes for Cumin-M:
SP5816-153
SP5816-154
SP5816-161
0: Japan, 1: USA, 2: Canada, 3: UK, 4: Germany, 5: France, 6: Italy, 7: Netherlands, 8: Belgium, 9: Luxembourg, 10: Spain Line Type Authentication Judgment Touch [Execute]. Setting this SP classifies the telephone line where Cumin-M is connected as either dial-up or push type, so Cumin-M can automatically distinguish the 151 number that connects to the outside line.
The current progress, success, or failure of this execution can be displayed with SP5816-152.
If the execution succeeded, SP5816-153 will display the result for confirmation and SP5816-154 will display the telephone number for the connection to the outside line.
Line Type Judgment Result Displays a number to show the result of the execution of SP5816 151. Here is 152 a list of what the numbers mean. 0: Success 1: In progress (no result yet). Please wait. 2: Line abnormal
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-216 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 3: Cannot detect dial tone automatically 4: Line is disconnected 5: Insufficient electrical power supply 6: Line classification not supported 7: Error because fax transmission in progress – ioctl() occurred. 8: Other error occurred 9: Line classification still in progress. Please wait. Selection Dial/Push This SP displays the classification (tone or pulse) of the telephone line to the access point for Cumin-M. The numbered displayed (0 or 1) is the result of the execution of SP5816 151. However, this setting can also be changed manually. 153 [0 to 1/ 0 / 1 /step] 0: Tone Dialing Phone 1: Pulse Dialing Phone Inside Japan "2" may also be displayed: 0: Tone Dialing Phone 1: Pulse Dialing Phone 10PPS 2: Pulse Dialing Phone 20PPS Outside Line/Outgoing Number The SP sets the number that switches to PSTN for the outside connection for Cumin-M in a system that employs a PBX (internal line). 154
If the execution of SP5816 151 has succeeded and Cumin-M has connected to the external line, this SP display is completely blank.
If Cumin-M has connected to an internal line, then the number of the connection to the external line is displayed.
If Cumin-M has connected to an external line, a comma is displayed with the number. The comma is inserted for a 2 sec. pause.
The number setting for the external line can be entered manually
156
Dial Up User Name Use this SP to set a user name for access to remote dial up. Follow these
SM Appendix
9-217 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
(including commas).
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode rules when setting a user name:
Name length: Up to 32 characters
Spaces and # allowed but the entire entry must be enclosed by double quotation marks (").
Dial Up Password Use this SP to set a password for access to remote dial up. Follow these rules 157 when setting a user name:
Name length: Up to 32 characters
Spaces and # allowed but the entire entry must be enclosed by double quotation marks (").
Local Phone Number
161
Use this SP to set the telephone number of the line where Cumin-M is connected. This number is transmitted to and used by the Call Center to return calls. Limit: 24 numbers (numbers only) Connection Timing Adjustment: Incoming When the Call Center calls out to a Cumin-M modem, it sends a repeating ID
162
tone (*#1#). This SP sets the line remains open to send these ID tones after the number of the Cumin-M modem is dialed up and connected. [0 to 24 / 1 / 1 /step] The actual amount of time is this setting x 2 sec. For example, if you set "2" the line will remain open for 4 sec. Access Point This is the number of the dial-up access point for Cumin-M. If no setting is
163 done for this SP code, then a preset value (determined by the country selected) is used. Default: 0 Allowed: Up to 16 alphanumeric characters 164 Line Connecting This SP sets the connection conditions for the customer. This setting
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-218 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode dedicates the line to Cumin-M only, or sets the line for sharing between Cumin-M and a fax unit. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Sharing Fax 1: No Sharing Fax
If this setting is changed, the copier must be cycled off and on.
SP5816 187 determines whether the off-hook button can be used to interrupt a Cumin-M transmission in progress to open the line for fax transaction.
173 Modem Serial Number
This SP displays the serial number registered for the Cumin-M.
Retransmission Limit Normally, it is best to allow unlimited time for certification and ID2 update 174
requests, and for the notification that the certification has been completed. However, Cumin-M generates charges based on transmission time for the customer, so a limit is placed upon the time allowed for these transactions. If these transactions cannot be completed within the allowed time, do this SP to cancel the time restriction.
186 RCG-CM DebugbitSW FAX TX Priority
-
This SP determines whether pushing the off-hook button will interrupt a 187 Cumin-M transmission in progress to open the line for fax transaction. This SP can be used only if SP5816 164 is set to "0". [0 or 1/ 0 / - ] 0: Disable, 1: Enable 200 Manual Polling
-
Executes the manual polling.
201 Displays a number that indicates the status of the NRS service device. 0: Neither the NRS device nor Cumin device are set. 1: The Cumin device is being set. Only Box registration is completed. In this
SM Appendix
9-219 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Regist: Status
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode status the Basil unit cannot answer a polling request. 2: The Cumin device is set. In this status the Basil unit cannot answer a polling request. 3: The NRS device is being set. In this status the Cumin device cannot be set. 4: The NRS module has not started. Allows entry of the number of the request needed
202 Letter Number
for the Cumin device.
203 Confirm Execute
Executes the inquiry request to the NRS GW URL.
204 Confirm Result Displays a number that indicates the result of the inquiry executed with SP5816 203. 0: Succeeded 1: Inquiry number error 2: Registration in progress 3: Proxy error (proxy enabled) 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled) 5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password) 6: Communication error 7: Certification update error 8: Other error 9: Inquiry executing Confirm Place 205 Displays the result of the notification sent to the device from the GW URL in answer to the inquiry request. Displayed only when the result is registered at the GW URL. 206 Register Execute
Executes Cumin Registration.
Register Result
207
Displays a number that indicates the registration result. 0: Succeeded 2: Registration in progress 3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-220 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled) 5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password) 6: Communication error 7: Certification update error 8: Other error 9: Registration executing 208 Error Code Displays a number that describes the error code that was issued when either SP5816-204 or SP5816-207 was executed.
Illegal Modem Parameter
Code
Meaning
-11001
Chat parameter error
-11002
Chat execution error
-11003
Unexpected error
-12002
Operation Error, Incorrect Setting
-12003
of an inquiry and no previous registration.
Error Caused by
Attempted setting with illegal entries for certification and ID2. Attempted dial up overseas without the
-2385
URL
SM Appendix
acquiring device status. Attempted registration without execution
-12004
Response from GW
Inquiry, registration attempted without
correct international prefix for the telephone number.
-2387
Not supported at the Service Center
-2389
Database out of service
-2390
Program out of service
-2391
Two registrations for same device
-2392
Parameter error
9-221 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Cause
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode -2393
Basil not managed
-2394
Device not managed
-2395
Box ID for Basil is illegal
-2396
Device ID for Basil is illegal
-2397
Incorrect ID2 format
-2398
Incorrect request number format
209 @Remote Setting Clear Releases the machine from its Cumin setup. 250 CommLog Print
5821
Prints the communication log.
[Remote Service Address] Sets the IP address of the RCG 002 RCG IP Address
*CTL
(Remote Communication Gate) destination for call processing at the remote service center.
[NV-RAM Data Upload]
5824
Uploads the UP and SP mode data (except for counters and the serial number) from the NVRAM to an SD card. For details, see the "NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in the “System Maintenance Reference” of the Field Service Manual. 001 NV-RAM Data Upload
#
-
[NV-RAM Data Download] 5825
Downloads the UP and SP mode data from an SD card to the NVRAM. For details, see the "NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in the “System Maintenance Reference” of the Field Service Manual. 001 NV-RAM Download
D037/D038/D040/D041
#
-
9-222 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 5828
*CTL
[Network Setting] 001
002
003
006
-
IPv4 Address (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) IPv4 Subnet Mask (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) IPv4 Default Gateway (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11) Not Used
DHCP (Ethernet/IEEE 802.11)
021 Active IPv4 Address 022 Active IPv4 Subnet Mask 023
050
Active IPv4 Gateway Address Enables or disables 1284 Compatibility.
1284 Compatibility
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step]
(Centro)
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Enables or disables ECP Compatibility. [0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step] 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
052 ECP (Centro)
This SP is activated only when SP5-828-50 is set to "1".
Enables/disables Job Spooling. 065 Job Spooling
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / step] 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
066
Job Spooling Clear: Start
power on.
Time
0: ON (Data is cleared) 1: OFF (Automatically printed)
SM Appendix
9-223 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Treatment of the job when a spooled job exists at
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Validates or invalidates the job spooling function for each protocol. 0: Validates 1: Invalidates bit0: LPR 069 Job Spooling (Protocol)
bit1: FTP bit2: IPP bit3: SMB bit4: BMLinkS bit5: DIPRINT bit6: sftp bit7: (Reserved) Enables or disables the Telnet protocol.
090 TELNET (0: OFF 1: ON)
[0 or 1 / 1 / – ] 0: Disable, 1: Enable Enables or disables the Web operation.
091 Web (0: OFF 1: ON)
[0 or 1 / 1 / – ] 0: Disable, 1: Enable This is the IPv6 local address link referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b) in the
145
Active IPv6 Link Local
format:
Address
"Link Local Address" + "Prefix Length" The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each.
147
149
151
153
Active IPv6 Stateless
These SPs are the IPv6 status addresses (1 to 5)
Address 1
referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN
Active IPv6 Stateless Address 2 Active IPv6 Stateless
(802.11b) in the format: "Status Address" + "Prefix Length" The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each.
Address 3 Active IPv6 Stateless Address 4
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-224 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 155
Active IPv6 Stateless Address 5 This SP is the IPv6 manually set address referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b) in the format:
156 IPv6 Manual Address
"Manual Set Address" + "Prefix Length" The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. This SP is the IPv6 gateway address referenced
158 IPv6 Gateway Address
on the Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b). The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each. Enables or disables the automatic setting for
161
IPv6 Stateless Auto
IPv6 stateless.
Setting
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step] 0: Disable, 1: Enable Displays or does not display the Web system items. [0 x 0000 to 0 x ffff / 0 x ffff] 0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed
236 Web Item visible
bit0: Net RICOH bit1: Consumable Supplier bit2-15: Reserved (all) Displays or does not display the link to Net RICOH on the top page and link page of the web 237 Web shopping link visible
system. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Not display, 1:Display
238 Web supplies Link visible
Consumable Supplier on the top page and link page of the web system. [0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
SM Appendix
9-225 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Displays or does not display the link to
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 0: Not display, 1:Display This SP confirms or changes the URL1 name on 239 Web Link1 Name
the link page of the web system. The maximum characters for the URL name are 31 characters. This SP confirms or changes the link to URL1 on
240 Web URL
the link page of the web system. The maximum characters for the URL are 127 characters. Displays or does not display the link to URL1 on the top page of the web system.
241 Web visible
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Not display, 1:Display
242 Web Link2 Name
Same as "-239"
243 Web Link2 URL
Same as "-240"
244 Web Link2 visible
Same as "-241"
5832
*CTL
[HDD] HDD Initialization
Initializes the hard disk. Use this SP
001 HDD Formatting (ALL)
mode only if there is a hard disk error.
002 HDD Formatting (IMH) 003 HDD Formatting (Thumbnail) 004 HDD Formatting (Job Log) 005 HDD Formatting (Printer Fonts) 006 HDD Formatting (User Info) 007 Mail RX Data 008 Mail TX Data 009
HDD Formatting (Data for a Design)
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-226 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 010 HDD Formatting (Log) 011 HDD Formatting (Ridoc I/F)
5836
001
[Capture Settings]
*CTL
Capture Function (0:Off 1:On)
0: Disable, 1: Enable
With this function disabled, the settings related to the capture feature cannot be initialized, displayed, or selected.
002
Panel Setting
0: Displayed, 1: Not displayed
Displays or does not display the capture function buttons. 5836-71 to 5836-76, Copier and Printer Document Reduction The following 6 SP modes set the default reduction for stored documents sent to the document management server via the MLB. Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed. 071 Reduction for Copy Color
0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4
072 Reduction for Copy B&W Text
0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4
073 Reduction for Copy B&W Other
0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4
074 Reduction for Printer Color
0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4
075 Reduction for Printer B&W
0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4
076 Reduction for Printer B&W HQ
0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4
5836-81 to 5836-86, Stored document format The following 6 SP modes set Sets the default format for stored documents sent to the document management server via the MLB. Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed. 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
SM Appendix
9-227 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
This SP is not used in this
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
081 Format for Copy Color
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode model. 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
082 Format for Copy B&W Text
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
083 Format Copy B&W Other
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR, 2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
084 Format for Printer Color
This SP is not used in this model.
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
085 Format for Printer B&W
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR 0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
086 Format for Printer B&W HQ
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
Default for JPEG
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step]
091 Sets the JPEG format default for documents sent to the document management server via the MLB with JPEG selected as the format. Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed. Sets the IP address for the primary capture 101 Primary srv IP address
server. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
102 Primary srv scheme 103
This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
Primary srv port
This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
number
104 Primary srv URL path
111
Sets the IP address for the secondary capture
Secondary srv IP
server. This is basically adjusted by the remote
address
system.
112 Secondary srv scheme
D037/D038/D040/D041
This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
9-228 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 113
114
120
Secondary srv port number Secondary srv URL path Default Reso Rate Switch Reso: Copy (Color)
This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
This is basically adjusted by the remote system. [0 to 3 / 2 / 1/step]
121 Selects the resolution for color copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 300dpi/ 2: 150dpi/ 3: 75dpi Reso: Copy (Mono)
[0 to 5 / 3 / 1/step]
122 Selects the resolution for BW copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi Reso: Print (Color) 123
This is basically adjusted by the remote system. [0 to 3 / 2 / 1/step]
Selects the resolution for color print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 300dpi/ 2: 150dpi/ 3: 75dpi Reso: Print (Color)
124
This is basically adjusted by the remote system. [0 to 5 / 3 / 1/step]
Selects the resolution for BW print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system. 0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi
[IEEE 802.11b] [1 to 11 or 13 / 11 or 13 / 1 /step] 006 Channel MAX
*CTL
Europe/Asia: 1 to 13 NA/ Asia: 1 to 11
SM Appendix
9-229 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
5840
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Sets the maximum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN. The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set for the maximum end of the range for each area. Adjust the upper 4 bits to set the maximum number of channels. DFU
Do not change the setting. [1 to 11 or 13 / 1 / 1 /step]
Channel MIN
*CTL
Europe: 1 to 13 NA/ Asia: 1 to 11
007
Sets the minimum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN. The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set for the minimum end of the range for each area. Adjust the lower 4 bits to set the minimum number of channels. DFU
Do not change the setting. [0 x 00 to 0 x FF / 0 x FF to Auto / -] 0 x FF to Auto [Default] 0 x 11 – 55M Fix 0 x 10 – 48M Fix 0 x 0F – 36M Fix 0 x 0E – 18M Fix 0 x 0D – 12M Fix
008 Transmission Speed
*CTL
0 x 0B – 9M Fix 0 x 0A – 6M Fix 0 x 07 – 11M Fix 0 x 05 – 5.5M Fix 0 x 08 – 1M Fix 0 x 13 – 0 x FE (reserved) 0 x 12 – 72M (reserved) 0 x 09 – 22M (reserved) Selects the WEP key.
011 WEP key Select
*CTL
[00 to 11 / 00 / 1 binary] 00: Key #1
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-230 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 01: Key #2 (Reserved) 10: Key #3 (Reserved) 11: Key #4 (Reserved) Adjusts the fragment threshold for the IEEE802.11 card. 042 Fragment Thresh
*CTL
[256 to 2346 / 2346 / 1] This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed. Determines whether the CTS self function is turned on or off.
043 1g CTS to Self
*CTL
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.
044 11g Slot Time
*CTL
Selects the slot time for IEEE802.11. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: 20 µm, 1: 9 µm Selects the debug level for WPA authentication application.
045 WPA Debug Lvl
*CTL
[1 to 3 / 3 / 1] 1: Info, 2: warning, 3: error This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11 card is installed.
5841
[Supply Name Setting] 001 Toner Name Setting: Black
*CTL
Specifies supply names. These appear on the screen when the
002 Toner Name Setting: Cyan
user presses the Inquiry button in the user tools screen.
003 Toner Name Setting: Yellow 004 Toner Name Setting: Magenta
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
007 OrgStamp 011 Staple Std1 012 Staple Std2
SM Appendix
9-231 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 013 Staple Std3 014 Staple Std4
5842
[GWWS Analysis Mode] DFU Default: 00000000 – do not change 001 Setting 1
*CTL
Netfiles: Jobs to be printed from the document server using a PC and the DeskTopBinder software Adjusts the debug program modesetting. Bit7: 5682 mmseg-log setting
002 Setting 2
*CTL
0: Date/Hour/Minute/Second 1: Minute/Second/Msec. 0 to 6: Not used
5844
[USB]
001
Transfer Rate
*CTL
0x01: Full speed 0x04: Auto Change
Adjusts the USB transfer rate. 002 Vendor ID
*CTL
Displays the vendor ID. DFU
003 Product ID
*CTL
Displays the product ID. DFU
004
Device Release
*CTL
Number
100 Notify Unsupport
5845
*CTL
[Delivery Server Setting]
Displays the development release version number. DFU -
*CTL
-
Provides items for delivery server settings. 001 FTP Port No.
D037/D038/D040/D041
[0 to 65535 / 3670 / 1 /step]
9-232 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Sets the FTP port number used when image files to the Scan Router Server. Range: 000.000.000.000 to
IP Address (Primary)
255.255.255.255
002
Use this SP to set the Scan Router Server address. The IP address under the transfer tab can be referenced by the initial system setting. Delivery Error Display Time
[0 to 999 / 300 / 1 second /step]
006 Use this setting to determine the length of time the prompt message is displayed when a test error occurs during document transfer with the NetFile application and an external device. IP Address (Secondary) 008
Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255
Specifies the IP address assigned to the computer designated to function as the secondary delivery server of Scan Router. This SP allows only the setting of the IP address without reference to the DNS setting. Delivery Server Model
[0 to 4/ 0 / 1 /step]
Allows changing the model of the delivery server registered by the I/O device. 009
0: Unknown 1: SG1 Provided 2: SG1 Package 3: SG2 Provided 4: SG2 Package
010 Delivery Svr Capability
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered. Bit7 = 1 Comment information exits Bit6 = 1 Direct specification of mail address possible
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Bit5 = 1 Mail RX confirmation setting possible Bit4 = 1 Address book automatic update function exists Bit3 = 1 Fax RX delivery function exists
SM Appendix
9-233 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Bit2 = 1 Sender password function exists Bit1 = 1 Function to link MK-1 user and Sender exists Bit0 = 1 Sender specification required (if set to 1, Bit6 is set to “0”) Delivery Svr Capability (Ext)
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered. 011 Bit7 = 1 Address book usage limitation (Limitation for each authorized user) Bit6 = 1 RDH authorization link Bit5 to 0: Not used
013
Server Scheme (Primary) DFU This is used for the scan router program.
014
Server Port Number (Primary) DFU This is used for the scan router program.
015
Server URL Path (Primary) DFU This is used for the scan router program.
016
Server Scheme (Secondary) DFU This is used for the scan router program.
017
Server Port Number (Secondary) DFU This is used for the scan router program.
018
Server URL Path (Secondary) DFU This is used for the scan router program. Rapid Sending Control
022
Enables or disables the prevention function for the continuous data sending error. [0 to 1 / 0 / -] 0: Disable, 1: Enable
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-234 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 5846
*CTL
[UCS Settings]
-
Machine ID (For Delivery Server)
001
Displays ID
Displays the unique device ID in use by the delivery server directory. The value is only displayed and cannot be changed. This ID is created from the NIC MAC or IEEE 1394 EUI. The ID is displayed as either 6-byle or 8-byte binary. Machine ID Clear (For Delivery Server)
002
Clears ID
Clears the unique ID of the device used as the name in the file transfer directory. Execute this SP if the connection of the device to the delivery server is unstable. After clearing the ID, the ID will be established again automatically by cycling the machine off and on. Maximum Entries
[2000 to 20000/ 2000 /1 /step]
003 Changes the maximum number of entries that UCS can handle. If a value smaller than the present value is set, the UCS managed data is cleared, and the data (excluding user code information) is displayed. Delivery Server Retry Timer 006
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
Sets the interval for retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server address book. Delivery Server Retry Times
007
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
Sets the number of retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server address book. Delivery Server Maximum Entries
008
[2000 to 50000 / 2000 / 1/step]
Sets the maximum number account entries of the delivery server user information managed by UCS. LDAP Search Timeout
[1 to 255 / 60 / 1 /step]
Sets the length of the timeout for the search of the LDAP server. 040 Addr Book Migration (SD => HDD)
SM Appendix
9-235 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
010
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Not used in this machine. Fill Addr Acl Info. This SP must be executed immediately after installation of an HDD unit in a basic machine that previously had no HDD. The first time the machine is powered on with the new HDD installed, the system automatically takes the address book from the NVRAM and writes it onto the new HDD. However, the new address book on the HDD can be accessed only by the system administrator at this stage. Executing this SP by the service technician 041
immediately after power on grants full address book access to all users. Procedure 1. Turn the machine off. 2. Install the new HDD. 3. Turn the machine on. 4. The address book and its initial data are created on the HDD automatically. 5. However, at this point the address book can be accessed by only the system administrator or key operator. 6. Enter the SP mode and do SP5846 041. After this SP executes successfully, any user can access the address book. Displays the slot number where an address book data is in. [0 to 30 / - /1] 0: Unconfirmed 1: SD Slot 1
043 Addr Book Media
2: SD Slot 2 4: USB Flash ROM 20: HDD 30: Nothing 046 Initialize All Setting & Addr 047 Initialize Local Addr Book
048
Clears the local address book information, including the user code.
Initialize Delivery Addr
Clears the distribution address book
Book
information, except the user code.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-236 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 049 Initialize LDAP Addr Book
050 Initialize All Addr Book
Clears the LDAP address book information, except the user code. Clears all directory information managed by UCS, including all user codes. Uploads all directory information to the SD
051 Backup All Addr Book
card.
052 Restore All Addr Book
Downloads all directory information from the SD card. Deletes the address book data from the SD card in the service slot. Deletes only the files that were uploaded from this machine. This feature does not work if the card is
053 Clear Backup Info
write-protected.
After you do this SP, go out of the SP mode, and then turn the power off.
Do not remove the SD card until the Power LED stops flashing.
Search Option This SP uses bit switches to set up the fuzzy search options for the UCS local address book. 060
Bit: Meaning 0: Checks both upper/lower case characters 1: Japan Only 2: Japan Only 3: Japan Only 4 to 7: Not Used
062
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book. Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to upper case
SM Appendix
9-237 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Complexity Option 1
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode and sets the length of the password. [0 to 32 / 0 / 1 /step]
This SP does not normally require adjustment.
This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a group password policy to control access to the address book.
063 Complexity Option 2 DFU 064 Complexity Option 3 DFU 065 Complexity Option 4 DFU Specifies the FTP port for getting a 091 FTP Auth Port Setting
distribution server address book that is used in the identification mode. [0 to 65535 / 3671 / 1 /step] Shows the status of the encryption function
094 Encryption Stat
for the address book data.
*CTL
[Rep Resolution Reduction]
-
5847 1 through 5847 8 changes the default settings of image data transferred externally by the Net File page reference function. 5847
[ 0 to 5 / 2 / 1 /step] 5847 21 sets the default for JPEG image quality of image files handled by NetFile. “Net files” are jobs to be printed from the document server using a PC and the DeskTopBinder software. 001 Rate for Copy Color
0: 1x 1: 1/2x
002 Rate for Copy B&W Text
2: 1/3x
003 Rate for Copy B&W Other
3: 1/4x 4: 1/6x
004 Rate for Printer Color
5: 1/8x 005 Rate for Printer B&W
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-238 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Network Quality Default for JPEG
021
Sets the default value for the quality of JPEG images sent as NetFile pages. This function is available only with the MLB (Media Link Board) option installed. [5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step]
*CTL
[Web Service]
-
5848 2 sets the 4-bit switch assignment for the access control setting. Setting
5848
of 0001 has no effect on access and delivery from Scan Router. 5848 100 sets the maximum size allowed for downloaded images. The default is equal to 1 gigabyte.
003
004
007
009
011
021
022
Lower 4 bits)
0000: No access control 0001: Denies access to DeskTop Binder. 0010: No writing control
Access Control: Doc. Svr. Print (Lower 4 bits) Access Control: User Directory (only Lower 4 bits) Access Ctrl: Comm. Log Fax (Lower 4 bits) Access Ctrl: Job Ctrl (Lower 4 bits)
Switches access control on and off. 0000: No access control 0001: Denies access to DeskTop Binder.
Access Ctrl: Device management (Lower 4 bits) Access Ctrl: Delivery (Lower 4 bits) Access Ctrl: uAdministration Appendix: SP Mode Tables
002
Access Ctrl: Repository (only
(Lower 4bits)
099 Repository: Download Image -
SM Appendix
9-239 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Setting
100
Repository: Download Image Max. Size
Specifies the max size of the image data that the machine can download. [1 to 1024 / 1024 / 1 MB /step]
210 Setting: LogType: Job1 211 Setting: LogType: Job2 212 Setting: LogType: Access 213 Setting: Primary Srv
NIA
214 Setting: Secondary Srv 215 Setting: Start Time 216 Setting: Interval Time 217 Setting: Timing
5849
[Installation Date]
5849 1 Display
*CTL
-
The “Counter Clear Day” has been changed to “Installation Date” or “Inst. Date”. Determines whether the installation date is printed on the printout for the total counter.
5849 2 Switch to Print
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: OFF (No Print) 1: ON (Print)
003 Total Counter
-
[Bluetooth Mode] 5851
Sets the operation mode for the Bluetooth Unit. Press either key. [0:Public] [1: Private]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-240 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [Stamp Data Download] Use this SP to download the fixed stamp data stored in the firmware of the ROM and copy it to the HDD. This SP can be executed as many times as
5853
required. This SP must be executed after replacing or formatting the hard disks.
This SP can be executed only with the hard disks installed.
[Remote ROM Update] 5856
Allows the technician to upgrade the firmware using a local port (IEEE1284) when updating the remote ROM. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1/step] 002 Local Port
*CTL
0: Disable 1: Enable
5857
*CTL
[Save Debug Log] On/Off (1:ON 0:OFF) 001
-
0: OFF, 1: ON
Switches the debug log feature on and off. The debug log cannot be captured until this feature is switched on. Target (2: HDD 3: SD)
2: HDD, 3: SD Card
002 Selects the storage device to save debug logs information when the conditions set with SP5-858 are satisfied. [ 2 to 3 / 2 / 1 /step] Save to HDD
005
Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the HDD. A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on Appendix: SP Mode Tables
the SD Card. Up to 4MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be copied one by one to each SD Card. 006 Save to SD Card
SM Appendix
9-241 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the SD card. 009 Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB) 010 Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB Any Key) 011 Erase HDD Debug Data 012 Erase SD Card Debug Data 013 Free Space on SD Card 014 Copy SD to SD (Latest 4 MB) 015 Copy SD to SD (Latest 4 MB Any Key) 016 Make HDD Debug 017 Make SD Debug
[Debug Save When]
5858
*CTL
-
These SPs select the content of the debugging information to be saved to the destination selected by SP5857-002. SP5858-3 stores one SC specified by number. Refer to Section 4 for a list of SC error codes. Turns on/off the debug save for SC codes
001 Engine SC Error
generated by copier engine errors. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step] 0: OFF, 1: ON Turns on/off the debug save for SC codes
002 Controller SC Error
generated by GW controller errors. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step] 0: OFF, 1: ON
003 Any SC Error 004 Jam
D037/D038/D040/D041
[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step] Turns on/off the debug save for jam errors. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step]
9-242 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 0: OFF, 1: ON
5859
*CTL
[Debug Save Key No.]
-
001 Key 1 002 Key 2 003 Key 3 004 Key 4
These SPs allow you to set up to 10 keys for log
005 Key 5
files for functions that use common memory on the controller board.
006 Key 6
[–9999999 to 9999999 / 0 / – ]
007 Key 7 008 Key 8 009 Key 9 010 Key 10
5860
*CTL
[SMTP/POP3/IMAP4]
-
020 Partial Mail Receive Timeout
[1 to 168 / 72 / – ]
Sets the amount of time to wait before saving a mail that breaks up during reception. The received mail is discarded if the remaining portion of the mail is not received during this prescribed time. 021 MDN Response RFC2298 Compliance
[0 to 1 / 1 / – ]
Determines whether RFC2298 compliance is switched on for MDN reply mail. 0: No 1: Yes [0 to 1 / 0 / – ]
Determines whether the FROM item of the mail header is switched to the validated account after the SMTP server is validated.
SM Appendix
9-243 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
022 SMTP Auth. From Field Replacement
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 0: No. “From” item not switched. 1: Yes. “From item switched. 025 SMTP Auth. Direct Setting
[0 or 1 / 0 / – ]
Selects the authentication method for SMTP. Bit switch: • Bit 0: LOGIN • Bit 1: PLAIN • Bit 2: CRAM MD5 • Bit 3: DIGEST MD5 • Bit 4 to 7: Not used
This SP is activated only when SMTP authorization is enabled by UP mode. Selects the MIME header type of an E-mail sent by S/MIME.
026
S/MIME: MIME Header
-
Setting
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1] 0: Microsoft Outlook Express standard 1: Internet Draft standard 2: RFC standard
5866
[E-mail Alert] Not Used
001 Report Validity
*CTL
Adds or does not add the date field to
005 Add Date Field
*CTL
the header of the alert mail. [0 or 1 / 0 / – ] 0: Not added, 1: Added
5870
[Common Key Info Writing] Writes to flash ROM the common proof
001 Writing
*CTL
for validating the device for NRS specifications.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-244 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 003 Initialize
5873
*CTL
-
[SD Card Appli Move] This SP copies the application programs from the original
001 Move Exec
SD card in SD card slot 2 to an SD card in SD card slot 1 (slot 1 has the priority to be copied). This SP copies back the application programs from an SD card in SD Card Slot 2 to the original SD card in SD card slot
002 Undo Exec
1 (slot 1 has the priority to be copied). Use this menu when you have mistakenly copied some programs by using "Move Exec" (SP5873-1).
5875
[SC Auto Reboot] Enables or disables the automatic reboot function when an SC error occurs. [0 or 1/ 0 / – ] 0: The machine reboots automatically when the machine issues an SC error and logs the SC
001 Reboot Setting
*CTL
error code. If the same SC occurs again, the machine does not reboot. 1: The machine does not reboot when an SC error occurs. The reboot is not executed for Type A or C SC codes. Selects the reboot method for SC.
002 Reboot Type
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / -] 0: Manual reboot, 1: Automatic reboot
[Security Clear] DFU
001 All Clear
*ENG
-
011 Clear NCS Security
*ENG
-
SM Appendix
9-245 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
5876
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 015 Clear UCS Security
5878
*ENG
-
[Option Setup] Enables the Data Overwrite Security unit.
001 Data Overwrite Security
-
Press "EXECUTE" on the operation panel. Then turn the machine off and on.
002 HDD Encryption
5881
*ENG
-
*ENG
-
[CPM Set] DFU
001 -
5884
Installs the HDD Encryption unit.
[Fixed Phrase Block erasing]
001 -
5882
-
[Plain 1/2 Setting]
001 By-pass Table
*ENG
002 Tray 1
*ENG
003 Tray 2
*ENG
004 Tray 3
*ENG
005 Tray 4
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / -] 0: Plain Paper 1 1: Plain Paper 2
5885
[WIM Settings] Web Image Monitor Settings Close or disclose the functions of web image monitor. 0: OFF, 1: ON
020
Document Server ACC Ctrl
*CTL
Bit Meaning 0: Forbid all document server access (1) 1: Forbid user mode access (1)
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-246 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 2: Forbid print function (1) 3: Forbid fax TX (1) 4: Forbid scan sending (1) 5: Forbid downloading (1) 6: Forbid delete (1) 7: Reserved Selects the display type for the document box list.
050 DocSvr Format
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1] 0: Thumbnail, 1: Icon, 2: Details Sets the number of documents to be
051 DocSvr Trans
displayed in the document box list. [5 to 20 / 10 / 1]
100 Set Signature
Determines whether the scanned documents with the WIM are encrypted when they are transmitted by an e-mail.
101 Set Encryption
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: Not encrypted, 1:Encryption 200 Detect Mem Leak
-
201 DocSur Timeout
-
5887
[SD Get Counter] This SP determines whether the ROM can be updated. This SP sends a text file to an SD card inserted in SD card Slot 2 (lower slot). The operation stores. The file is stored in *CTL
a folder created in the root directory of the SD card called SD_COUNTER. The file is saved as a text file (*.txt) prefixed with the number of the machine.
SM Appendix
9-247 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 -
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 1.
Insert the SD card in SD card Slot 2 (lower slot).
2.
Select SP5887 then touch [EXECUTE].
Touch [Execute] in the message when you are prompted.
5888
[Personal Information Protect] Selects the protection level for logs. [0 to 1 / 0 / 1}
001 -
0: No authentication, No protection for
*CTL
logs 1: No authentication, Protected logs (only an administrator can see the logs)
5894
[External Charge Unit Setting] -
001 Switch Charge Mode
5896
*ENG
[Copy/PrinterPriority]
001 -
5907
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
-
[Plug & Play Maker/Model Name] Selects the brand name and the production name for Windows Plug & Play. This information is stored in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM is defective, these
001 names should be registered again. After selecting, press the "Original Type" key and "#" key at the same time. When the setting is completed, the beeper sounds five times.
5913
[Switchover Permission Time]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-248 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Print Application Timer
*CTL
[3 to 30 / 3 / 1 second /step]
002 Sets the amount of time to elapse while the machine is in standby mode (and the operation panel keys have not been used) before another application can gain control of the display.
5967
*CTL
[Copy Server Set Function]
0: ON, 1: OFF
Enables and disables the document server. This is a security measure that 001
prevents image data from being left in the temporary area of the HDD. After changing this setting, you must switch the main switch off and on to enable the new setting.
5974
[Cherry Server] Specifies which version of ScanRouter, “Lite” or “Full”, is installed. [0 or 1 / 0 / – ]
001 Cherry Server
*CTL
0: Lite 1: Full
[Device Setting] 5985
The NIC and USB support features are built into the GW controller. Use this SP to enable and disable these features. In order to use the NIC and USB functions built into the controller board, these SP codes must be set to "1". [0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: Disable, 1: Enable, 2: Function limitation When the "Function limitation" is set, "On board NIC" is limited only for the NRS or LDAP/NT authentication.
Other network applications than NRS or LDAP/NT authentication are not available when this SP is set to "2". Even though you can change the initial settings of those
SM Appendix
9-249 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 On Board NIC
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode network applications, the settings do not work. [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
002 On Board USB
5987
0: Disable, 1: Enable
[Mech. Counter Protection] This SP detects that a mechanical counter device
001 0: OFF / 1: ON
5990
is removed. If it is detected, SC610 occurs.
[SP print mode] Prints out the SMC sheets. 001 All (Data List)
-
002 SP (Mode Data List)
-
003 User Program
-
004 Logging Data
-
005 Diagnostic Report
-
006 Non-Default
-
007 NIB Summary
-
008 Capture Log
-
021 Copier User Program
-
022 Scanner SP
-
023 Scanner User Program
-
-
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)
6006
[ADF Adjustment]
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-250 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Adjusts the side-to-side and leading registration of originals with the ARDF. 001 S-to-S Registration 1st
[-3.0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] *ENG
002 S-to-S Registration 2nd 003 Leading Edge Registration
[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]
Adjusts the amount of paper buckle to correct original skew for the front and rear sides. 005 Buckle: Duplex: 1st
*ENG
[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]
006 Buckle: Duplex: 2nd Adjusts the erase margin at the original trailing edge. 007 Trailing Edge Erase
*ENG
[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]
[ADF Input Check] 6007
Displays the signals received from the sensors and switches of the ARDF. Only Bit 0 is used for ADF input check ( “Iutput Check Table” in this section").
[ADF Output Check] 6008
Activates the electrical components for functional check. It is not possible to activate more than one component at the same time ( “Output Check Table” in this section")
6009
[ADF Free Run] Performs a DF free run in simplex, duplex mode or stamp mode.
6010
-
[Stamp Position Adj.] Fax Stamp Position Adjustment Adjusts the horizontal position of the stamp on the scanned originals.
SM Appendix
9-251 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
002 Free Run Duplex Mode
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 6010 1 Stamp Position Adj.
*ENG
[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[Original Size Detection Priority] Original Size Detection Priority 6016
Specifies the original size for a size detected by the original sensor, since original sensors cannot recognize all sizes. [0 or 1 / 0 / - ] *ENG
0: Setting 1 1: Setting 2
001
Original Size Detection
NA
Priority
EU/ ASIA
6017
Setting 1
Setting 2
DLT SEF
Folio SEF 11" x 15"
LG SEF
Foolscap SEF
LT SEF
US EXE 8" x 10"
LT LEF
US EXE LEF
DLT SEF
8K 267 x 390 mm
LT SEF
16K 195 x 267 mm
LT LEF
16K 267 x 195 mm
[DF Magnification Adj.] DF Magnification Adjustment Adjusts the magnification in the sub-scan direction for the ARDF.
001 DF Magnification Adj.
*CTL
[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]
[Staple Position Adjustment] 6101
Adjusts the staple position for finisher. + Value: Moves the staple position to the rear side. - Value: Moves the staple position to the front side.
001 -
D037/D038/D040/D041
ENG
[-2 to 2 / 0 / 0.2mm/step]
9-252 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
6102
[Punch Position Adjustment] Adjusts the punching position in the sub scan direction.
001 Leading Edge Adjustment
6103
ENG
[-1.5 to 1.5 / 0 / 0.1mm/step]
ENG
[-1.5 to 1.5 / 0 / 0.1mm/step]
[Jogger Position Adjustment] Adjusts the jogger position
001 -
6104
[Punch Position Adjustment] Adjusts the punching position in the main scan direction.
001 Side-to-Side Adjustment
ENG
[-2.0 to 2.0 / 0 / 0.2mm/step]
[Finisher Input Check] Finisher (D429) 6120
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the finisher. ( “Iutput Check Table” in this section")
[Finisher Output Check] Finisher (D429) 6121
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the finisher. ( “Output Check Table” in this section")
SP7-XXX (Data Log)
[Total SC Counter] Displays the number of SC codes detected.
001 SC Counter
SM Appendix
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step ]
9-253 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
7401
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [SC History] 7403
Logs the SC codes detected. The 10 most recently detected SC Codes are not displayed on the screen, but can be seen on the SMC (logging) outputs.
001 Latest 002 Latest 1 003 Latest 2 004 Latest 3 005 Latest 4
*CTL
-
006 Latest 5 007 Latest 6 008 Latest 7 009 Latest 8 010 Latest 9
7502
[Total Paper Jam Counter] Displays the total number of jams detected.
001 Total Jam
7503
* CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]
[Total Original Jam Counter] Displays the total number of original jams.
001 Original Jam counter
7504
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 original/step ]
[Paper Jam Location] ON: On check, OFF: Off Check
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-254 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Displays the number of jams according to the location where jams were detected. NOTE: The LCT is counted as the 3rd feed station. *CTL
003 Tray 1: ON
*CTL
004 Tray 2: ON
*CTL
005 Tray 3: ON
*CTL
006 Tray 4: ON
*CTL
008 Bypass: ON
*CTL
009 Duplex: ON
*CTL
011 Vertical Transport 1: ON
*CTL
012 Vertical Transport 2: ON
*CTL
017 Registration: ON
*CTL
018 Fusing Entrance: ON
*CTL
019 Fusing Exit: ON
*CTL
020 Paper Exit: ON
*CTL
021 Relay Exit: ON
*CTL
022 Relay Transport: ON
*CTL
025 Duplex Exit: ON
*CTL
026 Duplex Reverse: ON
*CTL
027 Duplex Entrance: ON
*CTL
028 1 Bin Exit Sensor
*CTL
051 SEF Sensor 1
*CTL
052 SEF Sensor 2
*CTL
SM Appendix
9-255 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
For details, the "Jam Detection" in the Appendix Jam Detection.
For details, the "Jam Detection" in the Appendix Jam Detection.
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 At Power On
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
7505
053 Bank SEF Sensor 1
*CTL
057 Regist Sensor
*CTL
059 Fusing Exit Sensor
*CTL
060 Exit Sensor
*CTL
062 Relay Sensor
*CTL
065 Duplex Exit Sensor
*CTL
068 1-Bin Exit: ON
*CTL
240 Finisher Entrance
*CTL
241 Finisher Shift Tray Exit
*CTL
242 Finisher Staple
*CTL
243 Finisher Exit
*CTL
244 Finisher Drive Motor
*CTL
245 Finisher Tray Lift Motor
*CTL
246 Finisher Jogger Motor
*CTL
247 Finisher Shift Motor
*CTL
248 Finisher Staple Motor
*CTL
249 Finisher Exit Motor
*CTL
250 Finisher Entrance
*CTL
251 Finisher Proof Exit
*CTL
For details, the "Jam Detection" in the Appendix Jam Detection.
[Original Jam Detection] Displays the total number of original jams by location.
001 At Power On
*CTL
-
003 Skew Correction: ON
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-256 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 004 Registration: ON 005 Paper Exit: ON 053 Skew Correction: OFF 054 Registration: OFF 055 Paper Exit: OFF
7506
[Jam Count by Paper Size] Displays the number of jams according to the paper size. 005 A4 LEF 006 A5 LEF 014 B5 LEF 038 LT LEF 044 HLT LEF 132 A3 SEF 133 A4 SEF 134 A5 SEF
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]
141 B4 SEF 142 B5 SEF 160 DLT SEF 164 LG SEF 166 LT SEF
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
172 HLT SEF 255 Others
SM Appendix
9-257 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 7507
[Plotter Jam History] Displays the 10 most recently detected paper jams.
001 Latest 002 Latest 1 003 Latest 2 004 Latest 3 005 Latest 4
*CTL
-
006 Latest 5 007 Latest 6 008 Latest 7 009 Latest 8 010 Latest 9
7508
[Original Jam History] Displays the 10 most recently detected original jams. 001 Latest
*CTL
-
002 Latest-1 003 Latest-2 004 Latest-3 005 Latest-4 006 Latest-5 007 Latest-6 008 Latest-7 009 Latest-8
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-258 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 010 Latest-9
7624
[Parts PM Use Setting] 001 PCU:Bk
*CTL
002 PCU:M
*CTL
003 PCU:C
*CTL
004 PCU:Y
*CTL
005 Dev Unit:Bk
*CTL
006 Dev Unit:M
*CTL
007 Dev Unit:C
*CTL
008 Dev Unit:Y
*CTL
009 Fusing Unit
*CTL
010 Fusing Roller
*CTL
011 Fusing Belt
*CTL
012
7801
PCU Toner Collection
*CTL
Bottle
[ROM No./Firmware Version] 255 Engine
7803
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
*CTL
-
[PM Counter Display] (Page, Unit, [Color])
PM counters click up based on the number of A4 (LT) LEF size sheets printed. Therefore, the A3 (DLT) Double Count is activated. The Double Count cannot be deactivated.
SM Appendix
9-259 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Displays the number of sheets printed for each current maintenance unit.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed. Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous (SP7-906-1 to 10) and is reset to “0”. The total number of sheets printed with the last unit replaced can be checked with SP7-906-1 to 10. NOTE: The LCT is counted as the 3rd feed station. 001 Paper 002 Page: PCU: Bk 003 Page: PCU: C 004 Page: PCU: M 005 Page: PCU: Y 006 Page: Development Unit: Bk 007 Page: Development Unit: C 008 Page: Development Unit: M 009 Page: Development Unit: Y 010 Page: Developer: Bk 011 Page: Developer: C 012 Page: Developer: M 013 Page: Developer: Y 014 Page: ITB Unit 015 Page: ITB Cleaning Unit 016 Page: Fusing Unit 017 Page: Fusing Roller 018 Page: Fusing Belt 019 Page:PTR Unit
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-260 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 020 Page:ITB T-Collect Bottle 021 Page:PCU T-Collect Bottle Displays the number of revolutions of motors or clutches for each current maintenance unit. [ 0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 revolution/step ] When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed. Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous (SP7-906-11 to 20) and is reset to “0”. The total number of revolutions made with the last unit replaced can be checked with SP7-906-11 to 20. 031 Rotation: PCU: Bk 032 Rotation: PCU: C 033 Rotation: PCU: M 034 Rotation: PCU: Y 035 Rotation: Development Unit: Bk 036 Rotation: Development Unit: C 037 Rotation: Development Unit: M 038 Rotation: Development Unit: Y 039 Rotation: Developer: Bk 040 Rotation: Developer: C 041 Rotation: Developer: M 042 Rotation: Developer: Y 043 Rotation:ITB Unit
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
044 Rotation: ITB Cleaning Unit 045 Rotation: Fusing Unit 046 Rotation: Fusing Roller
SM Appendix
9-261 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 047 Rotation: Fusing Belt 048 Rotation: PTR Unit [0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ] Displays the value given by the following formula: (Current revolution ÷ Target revolution) × 100. This shows how much of the unit’s expected lifetime has been used up. The Rotation% counter is based on rotations, not prints. If the number of rotations reaches the limit, the machine enters the end condition for that unit. If the print count lifetime is reached first, the machine also enters the end condition, even though the R% counter is still less than 100%. 049 Amount:ITB T-Collect Bottle 050 Amount:PCU T-Collect Bottle [0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ] *ENG
061 Rotation (%): PCU: Bk
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
062 Rotation (%): PCU: C 063 Rotation (%): PCU: M 064 Rotation (%): PCU: Y 065 Rotation (%): Development Unit: Bk 066 Rotation (%): Development Unit: C 067 Rotation (%): Development Unit:M 068 Rotation (%): Development Unit: Y 069 Rotation (%): Developer: Bk 070 Rotation (%): Developer: C 071 Rotation (%): Developer: M 072 Rotation (%): Developer: Y 073 Rotation (%): ITB Unit
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-262 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 074 Rotation (%): ITB Cleaning Unit 075 Rotation (%): Fusing Unit 076 Rotation (%): Fusing Roller 077 Rotation (%): Fusing Belt 078 Rotation (%):PTR Unit Displays the value given by the following formula: (Current printouts ÷ Target printouts) × 100. This shows how much of the unit’s expected lifetime has been used up. The Page% counter is based on printouts, not revolutions. If the number of printouts reaches the limit, the machine enters the end condition for that unit. If the revolution count lifetime is reached first, the machine also enters the end condition, even though the Page% counter is still less than 100%. 079 Amt(%):ITB T-Collect Bottle 080 Amt(%):PCU T-Collect Bottle [0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step] 091 Page (%): PCU: Bk 092 Page (%): PCU: C 093 Page (%): PCU: M 094 Page (%): PCU: Y 095 Page (%): Development Unit: Bk 096
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
Page (%): Development Unit: C 097 Page (%): Development Unit: M 098 Page (%): Development Unit: Y
100 Page (%): Developer: C
SM Appendix
9-263 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
099 Page (%): Developer: Bk
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 101 Page (%): Developer: M 102 Page (%): Developer: Y 103 Page (%): ITB Unit 104 Page (%): ITB Cleaning Unit 105 Page (%): Fusing Unit 106 Page (%): Fusing Roller 107 Page (%): Fusing Belt 108 Page (%): PTR Unit
7804
[PM Counter Reset] PM Counter Clear (Unit, [Color]) Clears the PM counter. Press the Enter key after the machine asks “Execute?”, which will store the PM counter value in SP7-906 (PM Counter - Previous) and reset the value of the current PM counter (SP7-803) to “0”. 001 Paper 002 PCU: Bk 003 PCU: C 004 PCU: M 005 PCU: Y 006 PCU: All 007 Development Unit: Bk 008 Development Unit: C 009 Development Unit: M 010 Development Unit: Y
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-264 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 011 Development Unit: All 012 Developer: Bk 013 Developer: C 014 Developer: M 015 Developer: Y 016 Developer: All 017 ITB Unit 018 ITB Cleaning Unit 019 Fusing Unit 020 Fusing Roller 021 Fusing Belt 022 PTR Unit 023 ITB T-Collect Bottle 024 PCU T-Collect Bottle 100 All
7807
[SC/Jam Counter Reset] Clears the counters related to SC codes and paper jams.
001 SC/Jam Clear
-
[MF Error Counter] Japan Only
001 Error Total
*CTL
-
002 Error Staple
*CTL
-
SM Appendix
9-265 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
7826
*CTL
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 7827
[MF Error Counter Clear] Japan Only *CTL
-
7832
-
[Self-Diagnose Result Display] Displays the result of the diagnostics.
001 Diag. Result
*CTL
-
001 Copy ACC
-
-
002 Printer ACC
--
7835
7836
[ACC Counter]
Total Memory Size (CTL) Displays the memory capacity of the controller system. -
*CTL
-
[DF Glass Dust Check] 7852
Counts the number of occurrences (0 to 65,535) when dust was detected on the scanning glass of the ADF or resets the dust detection counter. Counting is done only if SP4-020-1 (ADF Scan Glass Dust Check) is switched on.
7853
001 Dust Detection Counter
*CTL
002 Dust Detection Clear Counter
*CTL
[0 to 65535 / - / 1 /step]
[Replacement Counter] Displays the PM parts replacement number. 001 PCU: Bk
*CTL
002 PCU: C
*CTL
D037/D038/D040/D041
[0 to 255 / - / 1 /step]
9-266 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 003 PCU: M
*CTL
004 PCU: Y
*CTL
005 Development Unit: Bk
*CTL
006 Development Unit: C
*CTL
007 Development Unit: M
*CTL
008 Development Unit: Y
*CTL
009 Developer: Bk
*CTL
010 Developer: C
*CTL
011 Developer: M
*CTL
012 Developer: Y
*CTL
013 ITB Unit
*CTL
014 ITB Cleaning Unit
*CTL
015 Fusing Unit
*CTL
016 Fusing Roller
*CTL
017 Fusing Belt
*CTL
018 PTR Unit
*CTL
019 ITB T-Collect Bottle
*CTL
020 PCU T-Collect Bottle
*CTL
[0 to 255 / - / 1 /step]
[Coverage Range] Sets the color coverage threshold. 7855
Coverage rate = Coverage per page / A4 full coverage (dots) x 100
[A] 5% (default) is adjustable with SP7855-001.
[B] 20% (default) is adjustable with SP7855-002.
SM Appendix
9-267 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
There are three coverage counters: Color 1, Color 2, and Color 3
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
The setting value [B] must be set larger than [A].
The total numbers of printouts (BW printing plus color printing) for each coverage range are displayed with the following SPs.
Color1 counter: SP8601-021
Color2 counter: SP8601-022
Color3 counter: SP8601-023
001 Coverage Range 1
*CTL
[1 to 200 / 5 /1]
002 Coverage Range 2
*CTL
[1 to 200 / 20 /1]
[Assert Info] 7901
Records the location where a problem is detected in the program. The data stored in this SP is used for problem analysis. DFU 001 File Name *CTL
002 Number of Lines
-
003 Location
[Prev. Unit PM Counter] 7906
(Page or Rotations, Unit, [Color]), Dev.: Development Unit
*ENG
Displays the number of sheets printed with the previous maintenance units. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 page/step ] 001 Page: PCU: Bk 002 Page: PCU: C 003 Page: PCU: M 004 Page: PCU: Y
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-268 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 005 Page: Development Unit: Bk 006 Page: Development Unit: C 007 Page: Development Unit: M 008 Page: Development Unit: Y 009 Page: Developer: Bk 010 Page: Developer: C 011 Page: Developer: M 012 Page: Developer: Y 013 Page: ITB Unit 014 Page: ITB Cleaning Unit 015 Page: Fusing Unit 016 Page: Fusing Roller 017 Page: Fusing Belt 018 Page: PTR Unit 019 Page:ITB T-Collect Bottle 020 Page:PCU T-Collect Bottle Displays the number of revolutions for motors or clutches in the previous maintenance units. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step ] 031 Rotation: PCU: Bk 032 Rotation: PCU: C 033 Rotation: PCU: M Appendix: SP Mode Tables
034 Rotation: PCU: Y 035 Rotation: Development Unit: Bk
SM Appendix
9-269 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 036 Rotation: Development Unit: C 037 Rotation: Development Unit: M 038 Rotation: Development Unit: Y 039 Rotation: Developer: Bk 040 Rotation: Developer: C 041 Rotation: Developer: M 042 Rotation: Developer: Y 043 Rotation: ITB Unit 044 Rotation: ITB Cleaning Unit 045 Rotation: Fusing Unit 046 Rotation: Fusing Roller 047 Rotation: Fusing Belt 048 Rotation: PTR Unit 049 Rotation:ITB T-Collect Bottle 050 Rotation:PCU T-Collect Bottle Displays the number of revolutions for motors or clutches in the previous maintenance units. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ] 061 Rotation (%): PCU: Bk 062 Rotation (%): PCU: C 063 Rotation (%): PCU: M 064 Rotation (%): PCU: Y 065 Rotation (%): Development Unit: Bk 066 Rotation (%): Development Unit: C
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-270 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 067 Rotation (%): Development Unit: M 068 Rotation (%): Development Unit: Y 069 Rotation (%): Developer: Bk 070 Rotation (%): Developer: C 071 Rotation (%): Developer: M 072 Rotation (%): Developer: Y 073 Rotation (%): ITB Unit 074 Rotation (%): ITB Cleaning Unit 075 Rotation (%): Fusing Unit 076 Rotation (%): Fusing Roller 077 Rotation (%): Fusing Belt 078 Rotation (%): PTU Unit 079 Rotation %:ITB T-Collect Bottle 080 Rotation %:PCU T-Collect Bottle Displays the value given by the following formula: (Current count ÷ Yield count) x 100, where “Current count” is the current values in the counter for the part, and “Yield count” is the recommended yield. [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ] 091 Page (%): PCU: Bk 092 Page (%): PCU: C 093 Page (%): PCU: M 094 Page (%): PCU: Y
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
095 Page (%): Development Unit: Bk 096 Page (%): Development Unit: C
SM Appendix
9-271 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 097 Page (%): Development Unit: M 098 Page (%): Development Unit: Y 099 Page (%): Developer: Bk 100 Page (%): Developer: C 101 Page (%): Developer: M 102 Page (%): Developer: Y 103 Page (%): ITB Unit 104 Page (%): ITB Cleaning Unit 105 Page (%): Fusing Unit 106 Page (%): Fusing Roller 107 Page (%): Fusing Belt 108 Page (%): PTR Unit
7931
[Toner Bottle Bk] Displays the toner bottle information for Bk. 001 Machine Serial ID
*ENG
002 Cartridge Ver
*EGN
003 Brand ID
*EGN
004 Area ID
*EGN
005 Product ID
*EGN
006 Color ID
*EGN
007 Maintenance ID
*EGN
008 New Product Information
*EGN
009 Recycle Counter
*EGN
D037/D038/D040/D041
-
9-272 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
7932
010 Date
*EGN
011 Serial No.
*EGN
012 Toner Remaining
*EGN
013 EDP Code
*EGN
014 End History
*EGN
015 Refill Information
*EGN
016 Attachment: Total Counter
*EGN
017 Attachment: Color Counter
*EGN
018 End: Total Counter
*EGN
019 End: Color Counter
*EGN
020 Attachment Date
*EGN
021 End Date
*EGN
[Toner Bottle M] Displays the toner bottle information for M. *ENG
002 Cartridge Ver
*EGN
003 Brand ID
*EGN
004 Area ID
*EGN
005 Product ID
*EGN
006 Color ID
*EGN
007 Maintenance ID
*EGN
008 New Product Information
*EGN
009 Recycle Counter
*EGN
SM Appendix
-
9-273 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Machine Serial ID
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 010 Date
*EGN
011 Serial No.
*EGN
012 Toner Remaining
*EGN
013 EDP Code
*EGN
014 End History
*EGN
015 Refill Information
*EGN
016 Attachment: Total Counter
*EGN
017 Attachment: Color Counter
*EGN
018 End: Total Counter
*EGN
019 End: Color Counter
*EGN
020 Attachment Date
*EGN
021 End Date
7933
[Toner Bottle C] Displays the toner bottle information for C. 001 Machine Serial ID
*ENG
002 Cartridge Ver
*EGN
003 Brand ID
*EGN
004 Area ID
*EGN
005 Product ID
*EGN
006 Color ID
*EGN
007 Maintenance ID
*EGN
008 New Product Information
*EGN
009 Recycle Counter
*EGN
D037/D038/D040/D041
-
9-274 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
7934
010 Date
*EGN
011 Serial No.
*EGN
012 Toner Remaining
*EGN
013 EDP Code
*EGN
014 End History
*EGN
015 Refill Information
*EGN
016 Attachment: Total Counter
*EGN
017 Attachment: Color Counter
*EGN
018 End: Total Counter
*EGN
019 End: Color Counter
*EGN
020 Attachment Date
*EGN
021 End Date
*EGN
[Toner Bottle Y] Displays the toner bottle information for Y. *ENG
002 Cartridge Ver
*EGN
003 Brand ID
*EGN
004 Area ID
*EGN
005 Product ID
*EGN
006 Color ID
*EGN
007 Maintenance ID
*EGN
008 New Product Information
*EGN
009 Recycle Counter
*EGN
SM Appendix
-
9-275 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Machine Serial ID
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
7935
010 Date
*EGN
011 Serial No.
*EGN
012 Toner Remaining
*EGN
013 EDP Code
*EGN
014 End History
*EGN
015 Refill Information
*EGN
016 Attachment: Total Counter
*EGN
017 Attachment: Color Counter
*EGN
018 End: Total Counter
*EGN
019 End: Color Counter
*EGN
020 Attachment Date
*EGN
021 End Date
*EGN
[Toner Bottle Log 1/2/3/4/5: Bk] 001 Serial No. 002 Attachment Date
*ENG
003 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 1 for Bk.
004 Refill Information 005 Serial No. 006 Attachment Date
*ENG
007 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 2 for Bk.
008 Refill Information 009 Serial No.
*ENG
information log 3 for Bk.
010 Attachment Date
D037/D038/D040/D041
Displays the toner bottle
9-276 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 011 Attachment: Total Counter 012 Refill Information 013 Serial No. 014 Attachment Date
*ENG
015 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 4 for Bk.
016 Refill Information 017 Serial No. 018 Attachment Date
*ENG
019 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 5 for Bk.
020 Refill Information
7936
[Toner Bottle Log 1/2/3/4/5: M] 001 Serial No. 002 Attachment Date
*ENG
003 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 1 for M.
004 Refill Information 005 Serial No. 006 Attachment Date
*ENG
007 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 2 for M.
008 Refill Information 009 Serial No.
*ENG
011 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 3 for M.
012 Refill Information
SM Appendix
9-277 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
010 Attachment Date
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 013 Serial No. 014 Attachment Date
*ENG
015 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 4 for M.
016 Refill Information 017 Serial No. 018 Attachment Date
*ENG
019 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 5 for M.
020 Refill Information
7937
[Toner Bottle Log 1/2/3/4/5: C] 001 Serial No. 002 Attachment Date
*ENG
003 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 1 for C.
004 Refill Information 005 Serial No. 006 Attachment Date
*ENG
007 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 2 for C.
008 Refill Information 009 Serial No. 010 Attachment Date
*ENG
011 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 3 for C.
012 Refill Information 013 Serial No.
*ENG
information log 4 for C.
014 Attachment Date
D037/D038/D040/D041
Displays the toner bottle
9-278 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 015 Attachment: Total Counter 016 Refill Information 017 Serial No. 018 Attachment Date
*ENG
019 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 5 for C.
020 Refill Information
7938
[Toner Bottle Log 1/2/3/4/5: Y] 001 Serial No. 002 Attachment Date
*ENG
003 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 1 for Y.
004 Refill Information 005 Serial No. 006 Attachment Date
*ENG
007 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 2 for Y.
008 Refill Information 009 Serial No. 010 Attachment Date
*ENG
011 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 3 for Y.
012 Refill Information 013 Serial No.
*ENG
015 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 4 for Y.
016 Refill Information
SM Appendix
9-279 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
014 Attachment Date
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 017 Serial No. 018 Attachment Date
*ENG
019 Attachment: Total Counter
Displays the toner bottle information log 5 for Y.
020 Refill Information
7950
[Unit Replacement Date] Displays the replacement date of each PM unit. 001 ITB Unit
*ENG
002 ITB Cleaning Unit
*EGN
003 PTR Unit
*EGN
004 Fusing Unit
*EGN
005 Fusing Roller
*EGN
006 Fusing Belt
*EGN
013 PCU: Bk
*EGN
014 PCU: C
*EGN
015 PCU: M
*EGN
016 PCU: Y
*EGN
017 Development Unit:Bk
*EGN
018 Development Unit:C
*EGN
019 Development Unit:M
*EGN
020 Development Unit:Y
*EGN
021 Developer:Bk
*EGN
022 Developer:C
*EGN
023 Developer:M
*EGN
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-280 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 024 Developer:Y
*EGN
[Remaining Day Counter] 7951
*ENG
Displays the remaining unit life of each PM unit. [0 to 255 / 255 / 1 day/step] 001 Page: PCU: Bk 002 Page: PCU: C 003 Page: PCU: M 004 Page: PCU: Y 005 Page: Development Unit: Bk 006 Page: Development Unit: C 007 Page: Development Unit: M 008 Page: Development Unit: Y 009 Page: Developer: Bk 010 Page: Developer: C 011 Page: Developer: M 012 Page: Developer: Y 013 Page: ITB Unit 014 Page: ITB Cleaning Unit 015 Page: Fusing Unit 016 Page: Fusing Roller 017 Page: Fusing Belt Appendix: SP Mode Tables
018 Page: PTR Unit 031 Rotation: PCU: Bk
SM Appendix
9-281 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 032 Rotation: PCU: C 033 Rotation: PCU: M 034 Rotation: PCU: Y 035 Rotation: Development Unit: Bk 036 Rotation: Development Unit: C 037 Rotation: Development Unit: M 038 Rotation: Development Unit: Y 039 Rotation: Developer: Bk 040 Rotation: Developer: C 041 Rotation: Developer: M 042 Rotation: Developer: Y 043 Rotation: ITB Unit 044 Rotation: ITB Cleaning Unit 045 Rotation: Fusing Unit 046 Rotation: Fusing Roller 047 Rotation: Fusing Belt 048 Rotation:PTR Unit 049 Rotation:ITB T-Collect Bottle 050 Rotation:PCU T-Collect Bottle
7952
[PM Yield Setting] Adjusts the unit yield of each PM unit. 001 Rotation: ITB Unit
D037/D038/D040/D041
*EGN
[0 to 999999999 / 172177000 / 1000 mm/step]
9-282 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 002
Rotation: ITB Cleaning Unit
*EGN
003 Rotation: Fusing Unit
*EGN
004 Rotation: Fusing Roller
*EGN
005 Rotation: Fusing Belt
*EGN
006 Rotation:PTR Unit
*EGN
007
008
[0 to 999999999 / 129133000 / 1 mm/step]
[0 to 999999999 / 87264000 / 1000 mm/step]
[0 to 999999999 / 172177000 / 1000 mm/step]
Amount:ITB T-Collect Bottle
*EGN
Amount:PCU T-Collect
[0 to 999999999 / 300000 / 1000 mg/step]
Bottle
011 Page: ITB Unit
*EGN
[0 to 999999 / 240000 / 1000 sheet/step]
012 Page: ITB Cleaning Unit
*EGN
[0 to 999999 / 180000 / 1 sheet/step]
013 Page: Fusing Unit
*EGN
014 Page: Fusing Roller
*EGN
015 Page: Fusing Belt
*EGN
016 Page: PTR Unit
*EGN
Day Threshold: PCU:
*EGN
Bk
022 Day Threshold: PCU: C
*EGN
023 Day Threshold: PCU: M
*EGN
024 Day Threshold: PCU: Y
*EGN
025
026
Day Threshold: Development Unit: Bk Day Threshold: Development Unit: C
SM Appendix
[0 to 999999 / 240000 / 1 sheet/step] Adjusts the threshold day for the near end fro each PM unit. [1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step] These threshold days are used for NRS alarms.
*EGN Appendix: SP Mode Tables
021
[0 to 999999 / 144000 / 1 sheet/step]
*EGN
9-283 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 027
028
029
030
031
032
Day Threshold:
*EGN
Development Unit: M Day Threshold:
*EGN
Development Unit: Y Day Threshold:
*EGN
Developer: Bk Day Threshold:
*EGN
Developer: C Day Threshold:
*EGN
Developer: M Day Threshold:
*EGN
Developer: Y
033 Day Threshold: ITB Unit 034
035
036
037
Day Threshold: ITB
*EGN *EGN
Cleaning Unit Day Threshold: Fusing Unit Day Threshold: Fusing Roller Day Threshold: Fusing Belt
038 Rotation: PCU: Bk
*EGN
*EGN
*EGN
*EGN
039 Rotation: PCU: C
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
040 Rotation: PCU: M 041 Rotation: PCU: Y 042
Rotation: Development Unit: Bk
D037/D038/D040/D041
*EGN
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
9-284 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 043
044
045
Rotation: Development Unit: C Rotation: Development Unit: M Rotation: Development Unit: Y
*EGN
*EGN
*EGN
046 Rotation: Developer: Bk 047 Rotation: Developer: C
*EGN
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
*EGN
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
*EGN
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
*EGN
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
048 Rotation: Developer: M 049 Rotation: Developer: Y 050 Page: PCU: Bk 051 Page: PCU: C 052 Page: PCU: M 053 Page: PCU: Y 054
055
056
057
Page: Development Unit: Bk Page: Development Unit: C Page: Development Unit: M Page: Development Unit: Y
059 Page: Developer: C
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
058 Page: Developer: Bk
060 Page: Developer: M 061 Page: Developer: Y
SM Appendix
9-285 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 062
063
064
7953
Day Threshold:PTR Adjusts the threshold day for the near end
Unit
fro each PM unit.
Day Thresh:ITB
*EGN
T-Collect Bttl
[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step] These threshold days are used for NRS alarms.
Day Thresh:PCU T-Collect Bttl
[Operation Env. Log: PCU: Bk] Displays the PCU rotation distance in each specified operation environment. T: Temperature (°C), H: Relative Humidity (%) *CTL
001 T<=0
[0 to 99999999 / - / 1 mm/step]
002 0
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-286 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 016 25<=T<30: 80<=H<=100 017 30<=T: 0<=H<30 018 30<=T: 30<=H<55 019 30<=T: 55<=H<80 020 30<=T: 80<=H<=100
7954
[Operation Env. Log Clear] Clears the operation environment log. 001 -
SP8-xxx: Data Log2 Many of these counters are provided for features that are currently not available, such as sending color faxes, and so on. However, here are some Group 8 codes that when used in combination with others, can provide useful information.
SP Numbers
What They Do
SP8 211 to SP8 216
The number of pages scanned to the document server.
SP8 401 to SP8 406
The number of pages printed from the document server
SP8 691 to SP8 696
The number of pages sent from the document server
Specifically, the following questions can be answered:
How is the document server actually being used?
What application is using the document server most frequently?
What data in the document server is being reused?
Most of the SPs in this group are prefixed with a letter that indicates the mode of operation Service Table, make sure that you understand what these prefixes mean.
SM Appendix
9-287 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
(the mode of operation is referred to as an “application”). Before reading the Group 8
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Prefixes
What it means
T:
Total: (Grand Total).
C:
Copy application.
F:
Fax application.
P:
Print application.
S:
Scan application.
Grand total of the items counted for all applications (C, F, P, etc.).
Totals (pages, jobs, etc.) executed for each application when the job was not stored on the document server.
Totals (jobs, pages, etc.) for the document server. The L: counters work differently case by case. Sometimes, they count jobs/pages stored on the document server; this can be in document server Local storage
L:
(document server)
mode (from the document server window), or from another mode, such as from a printer driver or by pressing the Store File button in the Copy mode window. Sometimes, they include occasions when the user uses a file that is already on the document server. Each counter will be discussed case by case.
O:
Other applications
Refers to network applications such as Web Image
(external network
Monitor. Utilities developed with the SDK (Software
applications, for
Development Kit) will also be counted with this
example)
group in the future.
The Group 8 SP codes are limited to 17 characters, forced by the necessity of displaying them on the small LCDs of printers and faxes that also use these SPs. Read over the list of abbreviations below and refer to it again if you see the name of an SP that you do not understand. Key for Abbreviations
Abbreviation /
D037/D038/D040/D041
What it means “By”, e.g. “T:Jobs/Apl” = Total Jobs “by” Application
9-288 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Abbreviation
What it means
>
More (2> “2 or more”, 4> “4 or more”
AddBook
Address Book
Apl
Application
B/W
Black & White
Bk
Black
C
Cyan
ColCr
Color Create
ColMode
Color Mode
Comb
Combine
Comp
Compression
Deliv
Delivery Designated Application. The application (Copy, Fax, Scan,
DesApl
Print) used to store the job on the document server, for
Dev Counter
Development Count, no. of pages developed.
Dup, Duplex
Duplex, printing on both sides
Emul
Emulation
FC
Full Color
FIN
Post-print processing, i.e. finishing (punching, stapling, etc.)
Full Bleed
No Margins
GenCopy
Generation Copy Mode Get Print Counter. For jobs 10 pages or less, this counter does
GPC
not count up. For jobs larger than 10 pages, this counter counts up by the number that is in excess of 10 (e.g., for an 11-page
SM Appendix
9-289 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
example.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Abbreviation
What it means job, the counter counts up 11-10 =1)
IFax ImgEdt
Internet Fax Image Edit performed on the original with the copier GUI, e.g. border removal, adding stamps, page numbers, etc.
K
Black (YMCK)
LS
Local Storage. Refers to the document server.
LSize
Large (paper) Size
Mag
Magnification
MC
One color (monochrome) New Remote Service, which allows a service center to monitor
NRS
machines remotely. “NRS” is used overseas, “CSS” is used in Japan.
Org
Original for scanning
OrgJam
Original Jam Print Job Manager/Desk Top Editor: A pair of utilities that allows
Palm 2
print jobs to be distributed evenly among the printers on the network, and allows files to moved around, combined, and converted to different formats.
PC
Personal Computer Pages. A page is the total scanned surface of the original.
PGS
Duplex pages count as two pages, and A3 simplex count as two pages if the A3/DLT counter SP is switched ON.
PJob
Print Jobs
Ppr
Paper
PrtJam
Printer (plotter) Jam
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-290 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Abbreviation PrtPGS
What it means Print Pages Red (Toner Remaining). Applies to the wide format model A2
R
only. This machine is under development and currently not available.
Rez
Resolution
SC
Service Code (Error SC code displayed)
Scn
Scan
Sim, Simplex
Simplex, printing on 1 side.
S-to-Email
Scan-to-E-mail SMC report printed with SP5990. All of the Group 8 counters
SMC
are recorded in the SMC report.
Svr
Server
TonEnd
Toner End
TonSave
Toner Save
TXJob
Send, Transmission
YMC
Yellow, Magenta, Cyan
YMCK
Yellow, Magenta, Cyan, Black
All of the Group 8 SPs are reset with SP5 801 1 Memory All Clear.
*CTL
8 002
C:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 003
F:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 001
SM Appendix
These SPs count the number of times each application is used to do a job. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] Note: The L: counter is the total number of times the other applications are used to send a job to the
9-291 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
T:Total Jobs
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
8 004
P:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 005
S:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 006
L:Total Jobs
*CTL
document server, plus the number of times a file already on the document server is used.
These SPs reveal the number of times an application is used, not the number of pages processed.
When an application is opened for image input or output, this counts as one job.
Interrupted jobs (paper jams, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
Only jobs executed by the customer are counted. Jobs executed by the customer engineer using the SP modes are not counted.
When using secure printing (when a password is required to start the print job), the job is counted at the time when either “Delete Data” or “Specify Output” is specified.
A job is counted as a fax job when the job is stored for sending.
When a fax is received to fax memory, the F: counter increments but the L: counter does not (the document server is not used).
A fax broadcast counts as one job for the F: counter (the fax destinations in the broadcast are not counted separately).
A fax broadcast is counted only after all the faxes have been sent to their destinations. If one transmission generates an error, then the broadcast will not be counted until the transmission has been completed.
A printed fax report counts as one job for the F: counter.
The F: counter does not distinguish between fax sending or receiving.
When a copy job on the document server is printed, SP8022 also increments, and when a print job stored on the document server is printed, SP8024 also increments.
When an original is both copied and stored on the document server, the C: and L: counters both increment.
When a print job is stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments.
When the user presses the Document Server button to store the job on the document server, only the L: counter increments.
When the user enters document server mode and prints data stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments.
When an image received from Palm 2 is received and stored, the L: counter increments.
When the customer prints a report (user code list, for example), the O: counter increments. However, for fax reports and reports executed from the fax application, the F: counter increments.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-292 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
8 011
T:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 012
C:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 013
F:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 014
P:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 015
S:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 016
L:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 017
O:Jobs/LS
*CTL
These SPs count the number of jobs stored to the document server by each application, to reveal how local storage is being used for input. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored
from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel.
When a scan job is sent to the document server, the S: counter increments. When you enter document server mode and then scan an original, the L: counter increments.
When a print job is sent to the document server, the P: counter increments.
When a network application sends data to the document server, the O: counter increments.
When an image from Palm 2 is stored on the document server, the O: counter increments.
When a fax is sent to the document server, the F: counter increments.
8 021
T:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 022
C:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 023
F:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 024
P:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 025
S:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 026
L:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 027
O:Pjob/LS
*CTL
These SPs reveal how files printed from the document server were stored on the document server originally. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs screen at the operation panel.
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the C: counter increments.
When an application like DeskTopBinder merges a copy job that was stored on the
SM Appendix
9-293 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
stored from within the document server mode
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode document server with a print job that was stored on the document server, the C: and P: counters both increment.
When a job already on the document server is printed with another application, the L: counter increments.
When a scanner job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the S: counter increments. If the original was scanned from within document server mode, then the L: counter increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application (including Palm 2), are printed with another application, the O: counter increments.
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with a network application (Web Image Monitor, for example), the C: counter increments.
When a fax on the document server is printed, the F: counter increments.
8 031
T:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 032
C:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 033
F:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 034
P:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 035
S:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 036
L:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 037
O:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
These SPs reveal what applications were used to output documents from the document server. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs
printed from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel.
When documents already stored on the document server are printed, the count for the application that started the print job is incremented.
When the print job is started from a network application (Desk Top Binder, Web Image Monitor, etc.) the L: counter increments.
8 041
T:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 042
C:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 043
F:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
D037/D038/D040/D041
These SPs count the applications that stored files on the document server that were later accessed for transmission over the telephone line or over a network
9-294 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 044
P:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 045
S:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 046
L:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
(attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image by I-Fax). [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] Note: Jobs merged for sending are counted separately. The L: counter counts the number of jobs
8 047
O:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
scanned from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel.
When a stored copy job is sent from the document server, the C: counter increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application or Palm2 are sent as an e-mail, the O: counter increments.
8 051
T:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 052
C:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 053
F:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 054
P:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 055
S:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 056
L:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 057
O:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
These SPs count the applications used to send files from the document server over the telephone line or over a network (attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image by I-Fax). Jobs merged for sending are counted separately. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of jobs sent from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel.
If the send is started from Desk Top Binder or Web Image Monitor, for example, then the O: counter increments.
T:FIN Jobs 8 061
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total the finishing methods. The finishing method is specified by
C:FIN Jobs 8 062
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for copy jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application.
SM Appendix
9-295 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
the application.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode F:FIN Jobs 8 063
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for fax jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. Note: Finishing features for fax jobs are not available at this time. P:FIN Jobs
8 064
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. S:FIN Jobs
8 065
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for scan jobs only. The finishing method is specified by the application. Note: Finishing features for scan jobs are not available at this time. L:FIN Jobs
8 066
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for jobs output from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. The finishing method is specified from the print window within document server mode. O:FIN Jobs
8 067
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for jobs executed by an external application, over the network. The finishing method is specified by the application. Number of jobs started in Sort mode. When a stored copy job
8 06x 1 Sort
is set for Sort and then stored on the document server, the L: counter increments. (See SP8 066 1)
8 06x 2 Stack
Number of jobs started out of Sort mode.
8 06x 3 Staple
Number of jobs started in Staple mode.
8 06x 4 Booklet
8 06x 5 Z-Fold
D037/D038/D040/D041
Number of jobs started in Booklet mode. If the machine is in staple mode, the Staple counter also increments. Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set for folding (Z-fold).
9-296 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 06x 6 Punch 8 06x 7 Other
Number of jobs started in Punch mode. When Punch is set for a print job, the P: counter increments. (See SP8 064 6.) Reserved. Not used.
T:Jobs/PGS 8 071
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of jobs broken down by the number of pages in the job, regardless of which application was used. C:Jobs/PGS
8 072
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of copy jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. F:Jobs/PGS
8 073
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of fax jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. P:Jobs/PGS
8 074
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of print jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. S:Jobs/PGS
8 075
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of scan jobs by size based on the number of pages in the job. L:Jobs/PGS
8 076
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of jobs printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel, by the number of pages in the job. O:Jobs/PGS
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of “Other” application jobs (Web Image Monitor, Palm 2, etc.) by size based on the number of pages in the job.
SM Appendix
9-297 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 077
*CTL
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
8 07x 1 1 Page
8 07x 8
21 to 50 Pages
8 07x 2 2 Pages
8 07x 9
51 to 100 Pages
8 07x 3 3 Pages
8 07x 10
101 to 300 Pages
8 07x 4 4 Pages
8 07x 11
301 to 500 Pages
8 07x 5 5 Pages
8 07x 12
501 to 700 Pages
8 07x 6 6 to 10 Pages
8 07x 13
701 to 1000 Pages
8 07x 7 11 to 20 Pages
8 07x 14
1001 to Pages
For example: When a copy job stored on the document server is printed in document server mode, the appropriate L: counter (SP8076 0xx) increments.
Printing a fax report counts as a job and increments the F: counter (SP 8073).
Interrupted jobs (paper jam, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
If a job is paused and re-started, it counts as one job.
If the finisher runs out of staples during a print and staple job, then the job is counted at the time the error occurs.
For copy jobs (SP 8072) and scan jobs (SP 8075), the total is calculated by multiplying the number of sets of copies by the number of pages scanned. (One duplex page counts as 2.)
The first test print and subsequent test prints to adjust settings are added to the number of pages of the copy job (SP 8072).
When printing the first page of a job from within the document server screen, the page is counted.
T:FAX TX Jobs
8 111
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by fax, either directly or using a file stored on the document server, on a telephone line. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
8 113
F: FAX TX Jobs
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-298 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode fax directly on a telephone line. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time. 8 11x 1 B/W 8 11x 2 Color
These counters count jobs, not pages.
This SP counts fax jobs sent over a telephone line with a fax application, including documents stored on the document server.
If the mode is changed during the job, the job will count with the mode set when the job started.
If the same document is faxed to both a public fax line and an I-Fax at a destination where both are available, then this counter increments, and the I-Fax counter (8 12x) also increments.
The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.
T:IFAX TX Jobs
8 121
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent, either directly or using a file stored on the document server, as fax images using I-Fax. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time. F: IFAX TX Jobs
8 123
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent (not stored on the document server), as fax images using I-Fax. Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
8 12x 1 B/W
These counters count jobs, not pages.
The counters for color are provided for future use; the color fax feature is not available at this time.
The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.
SM Appendix
9-299 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 12x 2 Color
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
T:S-to-Email Jobs 8 131
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and attached to an e-mail, regardless of whether the document server was used or not. S: S-to-Email Jobs
8 135
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and attached to e-mail, without storing the original on the document server.
8 13x 1 B/W 8 13x 2 Color 8 13x 3 ACS
These counters count jobs, not pages.
If the job is stored on the document server, after the job is stored it is determined to be color or black-and-white then counted.
If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be sent, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
If several jobs are combined for sending to the Scan Router, Scan-to-Email, or Scan-to-PC, or if one job is sent to more than one destination. each send is counted separately. For example, if the same document is sent by Scan-to-Email as well as Scan-to-PC, then it is counted twice (once for Scan-to-Email and once for Scan-to-PC).
T:Deliv Jobs/Svr 8 141
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent to a Scan Router server. S: Deliv Jobs/Svr
8 145
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned in scanner mode and sent to a Scan Router server.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-300 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 14x 1 B/W 8 14x 2 Color 8 14x 3 ACS
These counters count jobs, not pages.
The jobs are counted even though the arrival and reception of the jobs at the Scan Router server cannot be confirmed.
If even one color image is mixed with black-and-white images, then the job is counted as a “Color” job.
If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be delivered, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.
T:Deliv Jobs/PC 8 151
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent to a folder on a PC (Scan-to-PC). Note: At the present time, 8 151 and 8 155 perform identical counts. S:Deliv Jobs/PC
8 155
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent with Scan-to-PC.
8 15x 1 B/W 8 15x 2 Color
These counters count jobs, not pages.
If the job is cancelled during scanning, it is not counted.
If the job is cancelled while it is waiting to be sent, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
SM Appendix
9-301 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 15x 3 ACS
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.
8 161
T:PCFAX TX Jobs
*CTL
These SPs count the number of PC Fax transmission jobs. A job is counted from when it is registered for sending, not when it is sent.
8 163
F:PCFAX TX Jobs
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] Note: At the present time, these counters perform identical counts.
This counts fax jobs started from a PC using a PC fax application, and sending the data out to the destination from the PC through the copier.
8 161
T:PCFAX TX Jobs
*CTL
8 163
F:PCFAX TX Jobs
*CTL
8 175
S: Dvliv Jobs/WSD
*CTL
8 181
T: Scan to Media Jobs
*CTL
8 185
S: Scan to Media Jobs
*CTL
-
x 1 B/W x 2 Color x 3 ACS
SP 8 191 to 8 196 count the number of scanned sides of pages, not the number of physical pages.
These counters do not count reading user stamp data, or reading color charts to adjust color.
Previews done with a scanner driver are not counted.
A count is done only after all images of a job have been scanned.
Scans made in SP mode are not counted.
Examples
If 3 B5 pages and 1 A3 page are scanned with the scanner application but not stored,
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-302 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode the S: count is 4.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server using the Store File button in the Copy mode window, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied but not stored, the C: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
T:LSize Scan PGS
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan and copy jobs. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax
8 201
transmission are not counted. Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display. F: LSize Scan PGS
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for
8 203
fax transmission. Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display. S:LSize Scan PGS
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan jobs only.
8 205
Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission
are not counted. Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
T:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
8 212
C:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
8 213
F:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
8 215
S:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
8 216
L:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
SM Appendix
These SPs count the number of pages scanned into the document server . [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen
9-303 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 211
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
Reading user stamp data is not counted.
If a job is cancelled, the pages output as far as the cancellation are counted.
If the scanner application scans and stores 3 B5 sheets and 1 A4 sheet, the S: count is 4.
If pages are copied but not stored on the document server, these counters do not change.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
ADF Org Feeds 8 221
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages fed through the ADF for front and back side scanning. Number of front sides fed for scanning: With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count is the same as the number of pages fed for either
8 221 1
Front
simplex or duplex scanning. With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex front side scanning. (The front side is determined by which side the user loads face up.) Number of rear sides fed for scanning: With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex
8 221 2
Back
scanning. With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex rear-side scanning.
When 1 sheet is fed for duplex scanning the Front count is 1 and the Back count is 1.
If a jam occurs during the job, recovery processing is not counted to avoid double counting. Also, the pages are not counted if the jam occurs before the first sheet is output.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-304 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
Scan PGS/Mode 8 231
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each ADF mode to determine the work load on the ADF.
8 231 1 Large Volume
8 231 2 SADF
8 231 3 Mixed Size 8 231 4 Custom Size 8 231 5 Platen 8 231 6 Mixed 1side/2side
Selectable. Large copy jobs that cannot be loaded in the ADF at one time. Selectable. Feeding pages one by one through the ADF. Selectable. Select “Mixed Sizes” on the operation panel. Selectable. Originals of non-standard size. Book mode. Raising the ADF and placing the original directly on the platen. -
If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode.
The user cannot select mixed sizes or non-standard sizes with the fax application so if the original’s page sizes are mixed or non-standard, these are not counted.
If the user selects “Mixed Sizes” for copying in the platen mode, the Mixed Size count is enabled.
In the SADF mode if the user copies 1 page in platen mode and then copies 2 pages with SADF, the Platen count is 1 and the SADF count is 3.
T:Scan PGS/Org 8 241
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of scanned pages by original type for all
C:Scan PGS/Org 8 242
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Copy jobs.
SM Appendix
9-305 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
jobs, regardless of which application was used.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode F:Scan PGS/Org 8 243
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Fax jobs. S:Scan PGS/Org
8 245
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Scan jobs. L:Scan PGS/Org
8 246
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned and stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen 8 241
8 242
8 243
8 245
8 246
8 24x 1: Text
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
8 24x 2: Text/Photo
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
8 24x 3: Photo
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
8 24x 4: GenCopy, Pale
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
8 24x 5: Map
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
8 24x 6: Normal/Detail
Yes
No
Yes
No
No
8 24x 7: Fine/Super Fine
Yes
No
Yes
No
No
8 24x 8: Binary
Yes
No
No
Yes
No
8 24x 9: Grayscale
Yes
No
No
Yes
No
8 24x 10: Color
Yes
No
No
Yes
No
8 24x 11: Other
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode, the count is done for the last selected mode.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-306 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 251
T:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
8 252
C:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
8 254
P:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
8 256
L:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
8 257
O:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
These SPs show how many times Image Edit features have been selected at the operation panel for each application. Some examples of these editing features are:
Erase> Border
Erase> Center
Image Repeat
Centering
Positive/Negative
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] Note: The count totals the number of times the edit features have been used. A detailed breakdown of exactly which features have been used is not given.
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen.
8 261
T:Scan PGS/ColCr
*CTL
-
8 262
C:Scan PGS/ ColCr
*CTL
-
8 266
L:Scn PGS/ColCr
*CTL
-
8 26x 1 Color Conversion These SPs show how many times color
8 26x 2 Color Erase
creation features have been selected at the
8 26x 3 Background
operation panel.
8 26x 4 Other
T:Scan PGS/TWAIN
*CTL
These SPs count the number of pages scanned using a TWAIN driver. These
8 285
S:Scan PGS/TWAIN
*CTL
counters reveal how the TWAIN driver is used for delivery functions.
SM Appendix
9-307 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 281
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] Note: At the present time, these counters perform identical counts.
8 291
T:Scan PGS/Stamp
*CTL
8 293
F:Scan PGS/Stamp
*CTL
These SPs count the number of pages stamped with the stamp in the ADF unit. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode
8 295
S:Scan PGS/Stamp
*CTL
screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen
T:Scan PGS/Size 8 301
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by all applications. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page size [SP 8-441]. C:Scan PGS/Size
8 302
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page size [SP 8-442]. F:Scan PGS/Size
8 303
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Fax application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-443]. S:Scan PGS/Size
8 305
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Scan application. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-445].
8 306
L:Scan PGS/Size
D037/D038/D040/D041
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
9-308 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned and stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-446]. 8 30x 1 A3 8 30x 2 A4 8 30x 3 A5 8 30x 4 B4 8 30x 5 B5 8 30x 6 DLT
-
8 30x 7 LG 8 30x 8 LT 8 30x 9 HLT 8 30x 10 Full Bleed 8 30x 254 Other (Standard) 8 30x 255 Other (Custom)
T:Scan PGS/Rez 8 311
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications that can specify resolution settings. S: Scan PGS/Rez
8 315
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned Note: At the present time, SP8-311 and SP8-315 perform identical counts.
8 31x 1 1200dpi <
SM Appendix
9-309 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
by applications that can specify resolution settings.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 31x 2 600dpi to 1199dpi 8 31x 3 400dpi to 599dpi 8 31x 4 200dpi to 399dpi 8 31x 5 < 199dpi
Copy resolution settings are fixed so they are not counted.
The Fax application does not allow finely-adjusted resolution settings so no count is done for the Fax application.
8 381
T:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 382
C:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 383
F:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 384
P:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 385
S:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 386
L:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 387
O:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
These SPs count the number of pages printed by the customer. The counter for the application used for storing the pages increments. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. Pages stored with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen go to the C: counter.
When the A3/DLT double count function is switched on with SP5104, 1 A3/DLT page is counted as 2.
When several documents are merged for a print job, the number of pages stored are counted for the application that stored them.
These counters are used primarily to calculate charges on use of the machine, so the following pages are not counted as printed pages: - Blank pages in a duplex printing job. - Blank pages inserted as document covers, chapter title sheets, and slip sheets. - Reports printed to confirm counts. - All reports done in the service mode (service summaries, engine maintenance reports, etc.) - Test prints for machine image adjustment. - Error notification reports.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-310 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode - Partially printed pages as the result of a copier jam.
LSize PrtPGS 8 391
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count pages printed on paper sizes A3/DLT and larger. Note: In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.
8 401
T:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 402
C:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 403
F:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 404
P:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 405
S:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 406
L:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
These SPs count the number of pages printed from the document server. The counter for the application used to print the pages is incremented. The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the L: count.
Fax jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the F: count.
This SP counts the amount of paper (front/back counted as 1 page) used for duplex printing. 8 411
Prints/Duplex
*CTL
Last pages printed only on one side are not counted. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
T:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8 421
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing. This is the total for all applications.
8 422
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the copier application.
SM Appendix
9-311 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
C:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode F:PrtPGS/Dup Comb 8 423
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the fax application. P:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 424
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the printer application. S:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 425
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by the scanner application. L:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 426
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing from within the document server mode window at the operation panel. O:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 427
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages processed for printing by Other applications
8 42x 1 Simplex> Duplex 8 42x 2 Duplex> Duplex 8 42x 3 Book> Duplex 8 42x 4 Simplex Combine 8 42x 5 Duplex Combine 8 42x 6 2>
2 pages on 1 side (2-Up)
8 42x 7 4>
4 pages on 1 side (4-Up)
8 42x 8 6>
6 pages on 1 side (6-Up)
8 42x 9 8>
8 pages on 1 side (8-Up)
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-312 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 42x 10 9>
9 pages on 1 side (9-Up)
8 42x 11 16>
16 pages on 1 side (16-Up)
8 42x 12 Booklet 8 42x 13 Magazine
These counts (SP8 421 to SP8 427) are especially useful for customers who need to improve their compliance with ISO standards for the reduction of paper consumption.
Pages that are only partially printed with the n-Up functions are counted as 1 page.
Here is a summary of how the counters work for Booklet and Magazine modes:
Booklet
Magazine
Original Pages
Count
Original Pages
Count
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
3
2
3
2
4
2
4
2
5
3
5
4
6
4
6
4
7
4
7
4
8
4
8
4
T:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8 431
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
8 432
C:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features
SM Appendix
9-313 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
below, regardless of which application was used.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode below with the copy application. P:PrtPGS/ImgEdt 8 434
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the print application. L:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 436
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output from within the document server mode window at the operation panel with the three features below. O:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 437
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with Other applications. Total number of covers or slip sheets inserted. The
8 43x 1 Cover/Slip Sheet
count for a cover printed on both sides counts 2. The number of pages printed in series (one side) or
8 43x 2 Series/Book
printed as a book with booklet right/left pagination. The number of pages printed where stamps were
8 43x 3 User Stamp
applied, including page numbering and date stamping.
T:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8 441
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by all applications. C:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 442
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the copy application.
8 443
F:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the fax
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-314 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode application. P:PrtPGS/Ppr Size 8 444
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the printer application. S:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 445
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the scanner application. L:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 446
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel. O:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 447
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by Other applications.
8 44x 1 A3 8 44x 2 A4 8 44x 3 A5 8 44x 4 B4 8 44x 5 B5 8 44x 6 DLT 8 44x 7 LG 8 44x 8 LT 8 44x 9 HLT
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 44x 10 Full Bleed 8 44x 254 Other (Standard) 8 44x 255 Other (Custom)
SM Appendix
9-315 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
These counters do not distinguish between LEF and SEF.
8 451
PrtPGS/Ppr Tray
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of sheets fed from each paper feed station. 8 451 1 Bypass
Bypass Tray
8 451 2 Tray 1
Copier
8 451 3 Tray 2
Copier
8 451 4 Tray 3
Paper Tray Unit (Option)
8 451 5 Tray 4
Paper Tray Unit (Option)
8 451 6 Tray 5
LCT (Option)
8 451 7 Tray 6
Currently not used.
8 451 8 Tray 7
Currently not used.
8 451 9 Tray 8
Currently not used.
8 451 10 Tray 9
Currently not used.
T:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by all applications. 8 461
These counters are not the same as the PM counter. The PM counter is based on feed timing to accurately measure the service life of the feed rollers. However, these counts are based on output timing.
Blank sheets (covers, chapter covers, slip sheets) are also counted.
During duplex printing, pages printed on both sides count as 1, and a page printed on one side counts as 1.
8 462
C:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the copy
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-316 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode application. F:PrtPGS/Ppr Type 8 463
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the fax application. P:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
8 464
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the printer application. L:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
8 466
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel.
8 46x 1 Normal 8 46x 2 Recycled 8 46x 3 Special 8 46x 4 Thick 8 46x 5 Normal (Back) 8 46x 6 Thick (Back) 8 46x 7 OHP 8 46x 8 Other
8 471
PrtPGS/Mag
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by magnification rate the number of pages printed. 8 471 1 < 49%
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 471 2 50% to 99% 8 471 3 100% 8 471 4 101% to 200%
SM Appendix
9-317 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 471 5 201% <
Counts are done for magnification adjusted for pages, not only on the operation panel but performed remotely with an external network application capable of performing magnification adjustment as well.
Magnification adjustments done with printer drivers with PC applications such as Excel are also counted.
Magnification adjustments done for adjustments after they have been stored on the document server are not counted.
Magnification adjustments performed automatically during Auto Reduce/Enlarge copying are counted.
The magnification rates of blank cover sheets, slip sheets, etc. are automatically assigned a rate of 100%.
8 481
T:PrtPGS/TonSave
*CTL
8 484
P:PrtPGS/TonSave
*CTL
These SPs count the number of pages printed with the Toner Save feature switched on. Note: These SPs return the same results as this SP is limited to the Print application. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
8 491
T:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 492
C:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 493
F:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 496
L:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 497
O:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
These SPs count the number of pages printed in the Color Mode by each application.
8 49x 1 B/W 8 49x 2 Single Color 8 49x 3 Two Color
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-318 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 49x 4 Full Color
8 501
T:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 504
P:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 057
O:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
These SPs count the number of pages printed in the Color Mode by the print application.
8 50x 1 B/W 8 50x 2 Mono Color 8 50x 3 Full Color 8 50x 4 Single Color 8 50x 5 Two Color
T:PrtPGS/Emul 8 511
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed. P:PrtPGS/Emul
8 514
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages
8 514 1
RPCS
8 514 2
RPDL
8 514 3
PS3
8 514 4
R98
8 514 5
R16
8 514 6
GL/GL2
8 514 7
R55
8 514 8
RTIFF
SM Appendix
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
printed.
9-319 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
8 514 9
PDF
8 514 10
PCL5e/5c
8 514 11
PCL XL
8 514 12
IPDL-C
8 514 13
BM-Links
8 514 14
Other
Japan Only
SP8 511 and SP8 514 return the same results as they are both limited to the Print application.
Print jobs output to the document server are not counted.
T:PrtPGS/FIN 8 521
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by all applications. C:PrtPGS/FIN
8 522
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Copy application. F:PrtPGS/FIN
8 523
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Fax application. NOTE: Print finishing options for received faxes are currently not available. P:PrtPGS/FIN
8 524
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Print application. S:PrtPGS/FIN
8 525
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Scanner application.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-320 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode L:PrtPGS/FIN 8 526
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed from within the document server mode window at the operation panel.
8 52x 1 Sort 8 52x 2 Stack 8 52x 3 Staple 8 52x 4 Booklet 8 52x 5 Z-Fold 8 52x 6 Punch 8 52x 7 Other
If stapling is selected for finishing and the stack is too large for stapling, the unstapled pages are still counted.
The counts for staple finishing are based on output to the staple tray, so jam recoveries are counted.
This SP counts the amount of staples used by 8 531
Staples
*CTL
the machine. [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
T:Counter
8 581
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output broken down by color output, regardless of the application used. In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 581 1 Total 8 581 2 Total: Full Color
SM Appendix
9-321 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 581 3 B&W/Single Color 8 581 4 Development: CMY 8 581 5 Development: K 8 581 6 Copy: Color 8 581 7 Copy: B/W 8 581 8 Print: Color 8 581 9 Print: B/W 8 581 10 Total: Color 8 581 11 Total: B/W 8 581 12 Full Color: A3 8 581 13 Full Color: B4 JIS or Smaller 8 581 14 Full Color Print 8 581 15 Mono Color Print 8 581 16 Full Color GPC
8 582
C:Counter
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output of the copy application broken down by color output. 8 582 1 B/W 8 582 2 Single Color 8 582 3 Two Color 8 582 4 Full Color
8 583
F:Counter
D037/D038/D040/D041
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
9-322 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode These SPs count the total output of the fax application broken down by color output. 8 583 1 B/W 8 583 2 Single Color
8 584
P:Counter
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output of the print application broken down by color output. 8 584 1 B/W 8 584 2 Mono Color 8 584 3 Full Color 8 584 4 Single Color 8 584 5 Two Color
8 586
L:Counter
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output of the local storage broken down by color output. 8 582 1 B/W 8 582 2 Single Color 8 582 3 Two Color 8 582 4 Full Color
8 591
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the totals for A3/DLT paper use, number of duplex pages printed, and the number of staples used. These totals are for Other (O:) applications only.
SM Appendix
9-323 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
O:Counter
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 591 1 A3/DLT
-
8 591 2 Duplex
Coverage Counter 8 601
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total coverage for each color and the total printout pages for each printing mode.
8 601 1 B/W 8 601 2 Color 8 601 11 B/W Printing Pages 8 601 12 Color Printing Pages
T:FAX TX PGS 8 631
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number. F:FAX TX PGS
8 633
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number.
8 63x 1 B/W 8 63x 2 Color
If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/W or Color.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8631 and SP8633 are the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for each destination.
Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.
Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-324 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode destination.
T:IFAX TX PGS 8 641
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to as fax images using I-Fax. F:IFAX TX PGS
8 643
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by Fax as fax images using I-Fax.
8 64x 1 B/W 8 64x 2 Color
If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/W or Color.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8641 and SP8643 are the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for each destination.
Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.
Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination.
T:S-to-Email PGS 8 651
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for both the Scan and document server applications. S-to-Email PGS
8 655
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an Appendix: SP Mode Tables
e-mail for the Scan application only. 8 65x 1 B/W 8 65x 2 Color
SM Appendix
9-325 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
The count for B/W and Color pages is done after the document is stored on the HDD. If the job is cancelled before it is stored, the pages are not counted.
If Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to 5 addresses, the count is 10 (the pages are sent to the same SMTP server together).
If Scan-to-PC is used to send a 10-page document to 5 folders, the count is 50 (the document is sent to each destination of the SMB/FTP server).
Due to restrictions on some devices, if Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to a large number of destinations, the count may be divided and counted separately. For example, if a 10-page document is sent to 200 addresses, the count is 10 for the first 100 destinations and the count is also 10 for the second 100 destinations, for a total of 20.).
T:Deliv PGS/Svr 8 661
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server by both Scan and LS applications. Deliv PGS/Svr
8 665
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server by the Scan application.
8 66x 1 B/W 8 66x 2 Color
The B/W and Color counts are done after the document is stored on the HDD of the Scan Router server.
If the job is canceled before storage on the Scan Router server finishes, the counts are not done.
The count is executed even if regardless of confirmation of the arrival at the Scan Router server.
8 671
T:Deliv PGS/PC
D037/D038/D040/D041
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
9-326 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a folder on a PC (Scan-to-PC) with the Scan and LS applications. Deliv PGS/PC 8 675
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent with Scan-to-PC with the Scan application.
8 67x 1 B/W 8 67x 2 Color
8 681
T:PCFAX TXPGS
*CTL
These SPs count the number of pages sent by PC Fax. These SPs are provided for the Fax application only, so the counts for SP8
8 683
F:PCFAX TXPGS
*CTL
681 and SP8 683 are the same. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
This counts pages sent from a PC using a PC fax application, from the PC through the copier to the destination.
When sending the same message to more than one place using broadcasting, the pages are only counted once. (For example, a 10-page fax is sent to location A and location B. The counter goes up by 10, not 20.)
8 691
T:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 692
C:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 693
F:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 694
P:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 695
S:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
These SPs count the number of pages sent from the document server. The counter for the application that was used to store the pages is incremented. [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1] The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the operation panel. Pages stored
L:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen go to the C: counter.
SM Appendix
9-327 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 696
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the count.
If several documents are merged for sending, the number of pages stored are counted for the application that stored them.
When several documents are sent by a Fax broadcast, the F: count is done for the number of pages sent to each destination. TX PGS/Port
8 701
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages sent by the physical port used to send them. For example, if a 3-page original is sent to 4 destinations via ISDN G4, the count for ISDN (G3, G4) is 12.
8 701 1 PSTN-1 8 701 2 PSTN-2 8 701 3 PSTN-3 8 701 4 ISDN (G3,G4) 8 701 5 Network
8 711
8 715
T:Scan PGS/Comp
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
S:Scan PGS/Comp
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages sent by each compression mode. 8 715 1 JPEG/JPEG2000 8 715 2 TIFF(Multi/Single) 8 715 3 PDF 8 715 4 Other
8 725
S: Dvliv PGS/WSD
*CTL
8 731
T: Scan to PGS/Media
*CTL
D037/D038/D040/D041
-
9-328 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 735
S: Scan to PGS/Media
*CTL
x 1 B/W x 2 Color
RX PGS/Port 8 741
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages received by the physical port used to receive them.
8 741 1 PSTN-1 8 741 2 PSTN-2 8 741 3 PSTN-3 8 741 4 ISDN (G3,G4) 8 741 5 Network
Dev Counter 8 771
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the frequency of use (number of rotations of the development rollers) for black and other color toners.
8 771 1 Total 8 771 2 K 8 771 3 Y 8 771 4 M 8 771 5 C
8 781
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the number of already replaced toner bottles. NOTE: Currently, the data in SP7-833-011 through 014 and the data in SP8-781-001 through 004 are the same.
SM Appendix
9-329 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Toner Bottle Info.
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 781 1 Toner: BK
The number of black-toner bottles
8 781 2 Toner: Y
The number of yellow-toner bottles
8 781 3 Toner: M
The number of magenta-toner bottles
8 781 4 Toner: C
The number of cyan-toner bottles
This SP displays the percent of space 8 791
LS Memory Remain
available on the document server for
*CTL
storing documents. [0 to 100 / 0 / 1]
Toner Remain
*CTL
[0 to 100/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the percent of toner remaining for each color. This SP 8 801
allows the user to check the toner supply at any time. Note: This precise method of measuring remaining toner supply (1% steps) is better than other machines in the market that can only measure in increments of 10 (10% steps).
8 801 1 K 8 801 2 Y 8 801 3 M 8 801 4 C
Coverage Count: 0-10% 8 851
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color is from 0% to 10%.
8 851 11 0 to 2%: BK
8 851 31 5 to 7%: BK
8 851 12 0 to 2%: Y
8 851 32 5 to 7%: Y
8 851 13 0 to 2%: M
8 851 33 5 to 7%: M
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-330 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 851 14 0 to 2%: C
8 851 34 5 to 7%: C
8 851 21 3 to 4%: BK
8 851 41 8 to 10%: BK
8 851 22 3 to 4%: Y
8 851 42 8 to 10%: Y
8 851 23 3 to 4%: M
8 851 43 8 to 10%: M
8 851 24 3 to 4%: C
8 851 44 8 to 10%: C
Coverage Count: 11-20% 8 861
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color is from 11% to 20%.
8 861 1 BK 8 861 2 Y 8 861 3 M 8 861 4 C
Coverage Count: 21-30% 8 871
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color is from 21% to 30%.
8 871 1 BK 8 871 2 Y 8 871 3 M 8 871 4 C
8 881
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color is 31% or higher.
SM Appendix
9-331 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Coverage Count: 31%-
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 881 1 BK 8 881 2 Y 8 881 3 M 8 881 4 C
Printing PGS: Present Ink 8 891
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the amount of the remaining current toner for each color.
8 891 1 BK 8 891 2 Y 8 891 3 M 8 891 4 C
Printing PGS: Log: Latest 1 8 901
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the amount of the remaining previous toner for each color.
8 901 1 BK 8 901 2 Y 8 901 3 M 8 901 4 C
Printing PGS: Log: Latest 2 8 911
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the amount of the remaining 2nd previous toner for each color. 8 911 1 BK
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-332 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 911 2 Y 8 911 3 M 8 911 4 C
8 921
Coverage Count: Total
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color. 8 921 1 BK (%) 8 921 2 Y (%) 8 921 3 M (%) 8 921 4 C (%) 8 921 14 BK (Page) 8 921 15 Y (Page) 8 921 16 M (Page) 8 921 17 C (Page)
Machine Status
8 941
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the amount of time the machine spends in each operation mode. These SPs are useful for customers who need to investigate machine operation for improvement in their compliance with ISO Standards. Engine operation time. Does not include time while
8 941 1 Operation Time
controller is saving data to HDD (while engine is not operating).
8 941 2 Standby Time
saves data to HDD. Does not include time spent in Energy Save, Low Power, or Off modes.
SM Appendix
9-333 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Engine not operating. Includes time while controller
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 941 3 Energy Save Time
Includes time while the machine is performing background printing. Includes time in Energy Save mode with Engine on.
8 941 4 Low Power Time
Includes time while machine is performing background printing. Includes time while machine is performing
8 941 5 Off Mode Time
background printing. Does not include time machine remains powered off with the power switches.
8 941 6 SC 8 941 7 PrtJam
8 941 8 OrgJam
Total time when SC errors have been staying. Total time when paper jams have been staying during printing. Total time when original jams have been staying during scanning.
8 941 9 Supply PM Unit End Total time when toner end has been staying
AddBook Register 8 951
*CTL
These SPs count the number of events when the machine manages data registration.
8 951 1 User Code 8 951 2 Mail Address
8 951 3 Fax Destination
8 951 4 Group
8 951 5 Transfer Request 8 951 6 F-Code
D037/D038/D040/D041
User code registrations. Mail address registrations. Fax destination registrations.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Group destination registrations. Fax relay destination registrations for relay TX. F-Code box registrations.
9-334 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode Copy application registrations with the
8 951 7 Copy Program
Program (job settings) feature. Fax application registrations with the
8 951 8 Fax Program
Program (job settings) feature.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 255]
Printer application registrations with the
8 951 9 Printer Program
Program (job settings) feature. Scanner application registrations with the
8 951 10 Scanner Program
Program (job settings) feature.
8 999
Adomin. Counter List
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color. 8 999 1 Total 8 999 2 Copy: Full Color 8 999 3 Copy: BW 8 999 4 Copy: Single Color 8 999 5 Copy: Two Color 8 999 6 Printer Full Color
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 999 7 Printer BW 8 999 8 Printer Single Color 8 999 9 Printer Two Color
SM Appendix
9-335 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 8 999 10 Fax Print: BW 8 999 12 A3/DLT 8 999 13 Duplex 8 999 14 Coverage: Color (%) 8 999 15 Coverage: BW (%) 8 999 16 Coverage: Color Print Page (%) 8 999 17 Coverage: BW Print Page (%) 8 999 101 Transmission Total: Color 8 999 102 Transmission Total: BW 8 999 103 FAX Transmission 8 999 104 Scanner Transmission: Color 8 999 105 Scanner Transmission: BW
9.1.2 INPUT CHECK TABLE When entering the Input Check mode, 8 digits display the result for a section. Each digit corresponds to a different device as shown in the table.
Bit No.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Result
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-336 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
Copier
Reading
Description 0
1
5803 1 C-Dev. Mtr:LOCK
Normal
Lock
5803 2 C-Drum Mtr:LOCK
Normal
Lock
5803 3 Bk-Drum/Dev. Mtr:LOCK
Normal
Lock
5803 4 ITB Mtr:LOCK
Normal
Lock
5803 5 Fusing/P-Exit Mtr:LOCK
Normal
Lock
5803 6 Electrical FAN:LOCK
Normal
Lock
5803 7 Fusing Fan:LOCK
Normal
Lock
5803 8 Dev. Front Fan:LOCK
Normal
Lock
5803 9 Dev. Rear Fan:LOCK
Normal
Lock
5803 10 Fusing Exit Fan:LOCK
Normal
Lock
5803 11 LD Unit FAN:LOCK
Normal
Lock
5803 12 Jun. Gate SOL Fan:LOCK
Normal
Lock
5803 13 Fusing:New Detection
New
Not new
5803 14 Fusing:Area Detection
-
-
Not detected
Detected
Paper detected
No paper detected
5803 15 Zero Cross 5803 16 Regist Sensor
Actuator not
5803 17 Drum Phase Sn:Bk
detected Actuator not
5803 18 Drum Phase Sn:Color
SM Appendix
detected
9-337 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Actuator detected
Actuator detected
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
5803
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 5803 19 Inverter Sensor
Inverter gate open
Inverter gate close
5803 20 Duplex Exit Sensor
Paper detected
No paper detected
5803 21 Duplex Entrance Sensor
Paper detected
No paper detected
Shutter open
Shutter close
5803 23 HVPS:CB
-
-
5803 24 HVPS:T
-
-
5803 25 Right Door Open SW
Door close
Door open
5803 26 Right Lower Cover OP SW
Cover close
Cover open
5803 27 Mechanical Counter:Bk
Not set
Set
5803 28 Mechanical Counter:FC
Not set
Set
5803 29 Key Counter Set Sensor
Set
Not set
5803 30 Key Card Set Sensor
Set
Not set
5803 31 Toner End Sensor: K
End
Not end
5803 32 Toner End Sensor: C
End
Not end
5803 33 Toner End Sensor: M
End
Not end
5803 34 Toner End Sensor: Y
End
Not end
5803 35 Fusing Entrance Sensor
Paper detected
No paper detected
5803 36 Fusing Exit Sensor
Paper detected
No paper detected
5803 37 Paper Exit Sensor
Paper detected
No paper detected
5803 22 ID/MUSIC Sn Shutter HP Sn
5803 38 ITB Contact HP Sensor
HP (Contact)
Not HP (not contact)
5803 39 ITB T-Collect Bttl:Set SW
Set
Not set
5803 40 PCU T-Collect Bttl:Set SW
Set
Not set
5803 41 PCU T-Collect Bttl Full Sn
Full
Not full
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-338 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 5803 42 Vertical Transport 1 Sn
Paper detected
No paper detected
5803 43 Vertical Transport 2 Sn
Paper detected
No paper detected
5803 44 Tray1 Size Detection SW
See "Table 1" below.
5803 45 Tray2 Size Detection SW
See "Table 1" below.
5803 46 Bypass Size Detection SW
See "Table 2" below. Not detect
Detected
5803 48 Bypass HP Sensor
Not HP
HP
5803 49 Tray1 Paper End Sensor
Not end
End
5803 50 Tray2 Paper End Sensor
Not end
End
5803 51 Bypass Paper End Sensor
Not end
End
5803 52 Tray1 Set SW
Set
Not set
5803 53 Tray2 Set SW
Set
Not set
5803 54 Interlock SW 1
Door close
Door open
5803 55 Interlock SW 2
Door close
Door open
5803 56 DIP SW
-
-
5803 57 BCU Version
-
-
Not set
Set
Lock
Normal
5803 58 PCU T-Collect Motor Set 5803 59 Reserve Fan:LOCK 5803 70 R-Tray Paper Exit Sensor
Paper detected
5803 71 R-Tray Set Sensor
Set
5803 72 1-Bin:Transport Sensor
Paper detected
5803 73 1-Bin:Paper Sensor
Paper detected
SM Appendix
9-339 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
No paper detected Not set No paper detected No paper
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
5803 47 Bypass Length Detection Sn
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode detected 5803 74 1-Bin Set Detection
Set
Not set
5803 75 Shift Tray:Half Turn Sn
Not HP
HP
5803 76 Shift Tray Set Detection
Not set
Set
5803 77 1T PFU:Size Sensors
See "Table 4".
5803 78 1T PFU:Paper Lift Sn
Not upper limit
Upper limit
5803 79 1T PFU:Paper Height Sn
-
-
5803 80 1T PFU:Right Cover SW
Open
Close
5803 81 1T PFU:Set Detection
Not set
Set
5803 82 1T PFU:Paper End Sn
Not end
End
5803 83 2T PFU:Upper Size Sns
See "Table 4" below.
5803 84 2T PFU:Lower Size Sns 5803 85 2T PFU:Upper Paper Lift Sn
Not upper limit
Upper limit
5803 86 2T PFU:Lower Paper Lift Sn
Not upper limit
Upper limit
5803 87 2T PFU:Upper Paper Height Sn
-
-
5803 88 2T PFU:Lower Paper Height Sn
-
-
Open
Close
5803 90 2T PFU:Upper PE Sn
Not end
End
5803 91 2T PFU:Lower PE Sn
Not end
End
5803 89 2T PFU:Right Cover SW
No paper
5803 92 2T PFU:V-Transport Sn
Paper detected
5803 94 LD OFF Check:Factory
-
-
5803 200 Scanner HP Sensor
Not HP
HP
5803 201 Platen Cover Sensor
Open
Close
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-340 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
detected
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
ARDF (D366)
6007
Reading
Description 0
1
6007 1 Original Length Sn1 (B5 Sn)
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6007 2 Original Length Sn2 (A4 Sn)
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6007 3 Original Length Sn3 (LG Sn)
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6007 4 Original Width Sn:S
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6007 5 Original Width Sn:M
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6007 6 Original Width Sn:L
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6007 7 Original Width Sn:LL
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6007 9 Original Set Sn
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6007 10 Trailing Edge Sn
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6007 11 Skew Correction Sn
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6007 13 Registration Sn
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6007 14 Exit Sn
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6007 15 Feed Cover SW
ADF cover close
ADF cover open
6007 16 Lift Up Sn
ADF cover close
ADF cover open
Internal Finisher (D429)
Reading
Description 0
1
6120 1 Staple Slide HP Sensor
Not HP
HP
6120 2 Punch Slide HP Sensor
Not HP
HP
SM Appendix
9-341 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
6120
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 6120 3 Staple HP Sensor
Not HP
HP
6120 4 Paper T-Edge Sensor
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6120 5 Pick Roller Lift Sensor
Up
Down
Paper not detected
Paper detected
Down
Up
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6120 9 Rear Jogger HP Sensor
HP
Not HP
6120 10 Front Jogger HP Sensor
HP
Not HP
Normal
Lock
Close
Open
6120 6 Paper Detection Sensor 6120 7 Belt Roller Lift Sensor 6120 8 Entrance Sensor
6120 11 Fan Lock Signal 6120 12 Finisher Open Switch 6120 13 Punch Unit:Area Detect2
See "Table 5" below.
6120 14 Punch Unit:Area Detect1 6120 15 Paper Stack Sensor 2
HP
Not HP
6120 16 Paper Stack Sensor 1
HP
Not HP
6120 17 Punch Position Sensor
Not HP
HP
6120 18 Paper Width Sensor:A3
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6120 19 Paper Width Sensor:LD
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6120 20 Paper Width Sensor:B4
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6120 21 Paper Width Sensor:A4
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6120 22 Paper Width Sensor:16K
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6120 23 Paper Width Sensor:B5
Paper not detected
Paper detected
Full
Not full
Upper
Not upper
6120 24 Punch Hopper Full Sensor 6120 25 Tray Upper Sensor
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-342 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 6120 26 Relay Sensor
Paper not detected
Paper detected
6120 27 Tray Lower Sensor
Lower
Not lower
6120 28 Jogger HP Sensor
Not HP
HP
6120 29 Punch HP Sensor
Not rear
Rear Position
6120 30 Stapler Safety Sensor
No staple
Staple detected
6120 31 Staple Empty Sensor
No staple
Staple detected
Not set
Set
6120 32 Punch Unit Sensor
Table 1: Paper Size Switch (Tray 1/ 2) Switch 1 is used for tray set detection. 0: Pushed, 1: Not pushed
Bit
North America
Europe/Asia
2
1
0
11" x 17" SEF*1
A3 SEF*1
(A3 SEF)
(11" x 17" SEF)
1
0
0
8.5" x 14" SEF *2
B4 SEF *2
(B4 SEF)
(8.5" x 14" SEF)
0
0
0
A4 SEF
A4 SEF
0
1
1
8.5" x 11" SEF
8.5" x 11" SEF
1
1
1
B5 SEF
B5 SEF
1
1
0
11" x 81/2" LEF*3
A4 LEF*3
(A4 LEF)
(11" x 81/2" LEF)
0
0
1
10.5" x 7.25" LEF*4
B5 LEF*4
(B5 LEF)
(10.5" x 7.25" LEF)
0
1
0
A5 LEF
A5 LEF
1
0
1
SM Appendix
9-343 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Models
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode *1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-002 (Tray 1) or SP 5-181-006 (Tray 2). *2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-003 (Tray 1) or SP 5-181-007 (Tray 2). *3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-001 (Tray 1) or SP 5-181-005 (Tray 2). *4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-004 (Tray 1) or SP 5-181-008 (Tray 2).
Table 2: Paper Size (By-pass Table) 0: ON, 1: OFF
By-pass Paper Size Sensor
Length Sensor
NA
EU/ASIA
bit3
Bit2
Bit1
Bit0
1
1
0
0
0
HLT SEF
B6 SEF
1
1
1
1
0
HLT SEF
A5 SEF
1
1
1
0
0
HLT SEF
A5 SEF
0
0
1
1
1
LT/LG SEF*1
A4 SEF
0
0
1
1
0
LT/LG SEF*1
A5 LEF
1
0
0
1
1
DLT SEF
A3 SEF
1
0
0
1
0
LT LEF
A4 LEF
*1: The paper size (LT or LG) can be selected with SP1-007-001.
Table 3: APS Original Size Detection
Original Size
Metric version
D037/D038/D040/D041
Width Sensor
Length Sensor
SP4-301 display
Inch version
W1
W2
W3
9-344 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
L1
L2
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode A3
11" x 17"
O
O
O
O
O
00000011
B4
10" x 14"
O
O
X
O
O
00000011
8.5” x 14”
O
X
X
O
O
00000011
A4 LEF
8.5" x 11"
O
O
O
X
X
00000000
B5 LEF
-
O
O
X
X
X
00000000
A4 SEF
11" x 8.5"
O
X
X
O
X
00000010
B5 SEF
-
X
X
X
O
X
00000010
X
X
X
X
X
00000000
F4 8.5" x 13", 8.25" x 13", or 8" x 13" SP 5126 controls the size that is detected
A5 LEF/ SEF
5.5" x 8.5", 8.5" x 5.5"
Table 4: Paper Size Switch (Tray 3/ 4) "Bit 0" is used for tray set detection. 0: Set, 1: Not set 0: Not Interrupted, 1: Interrupted
Bit
North America
Europe/Asia
3
2
1
0
11" x 17" SEF*1
A3 SEF*1
(A3 SEF)
(11" x 17" SEF)
0
1
1
0
8.5" x 14" SEF *2
B4 SEF *2
(B4 SEF)
(8.5" x 14" SEF)
1
1
1
0
A4 SEF
A4 SEF
1
0
0
0
B5 SEF
B5 SEF
0
0
1
1
8.5" x 11" SEF
8.5" x 11" SEF
0
0
0
0
SM Appendix
9-345 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Models
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 11" x 81/2" LEF*3
A4 LEF*3
(A4 LEF)
(11" x 81/2" LEF)
10.5" x 7.25" LEF*4
B5 LEF*4
(B5 LEF)
(10.5" x 7.25" LEF)
A5 LEF A5 SEF
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
A5 LEF
0
1
0
0
A5 SEF
1
1
0
1
*1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-010 (Tray 3) or SP 5-181-014 (Tray 4). *2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-011 (Tray 3) or SP 5-181-015 (Tray 4). *3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-009 (Tray 3) or SP 5-181-013 (Tray 4). *4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-012 (Tray 3) or SP 5-181-016 (Tray 4).
Table 5: Area Display The bit 0 of these SPs shows the punch unit type. 2: 2 Holes, 2/3: 2/3 Holes, 4 (EU): 4 Holes Europe, 4 (Scan.): 4 Holes Scandinavia
SP
2
2/3
4 (EU)
4 (Scan.)
6120-013
Punch Unit:Area Detect2
0
0
1
1
6120-014
Punch Unit:Area Detect2
0
1
0
1
9.1.3 OUTPUT CHECK TABLE Copier 5804
Display
Description
5804 1 Paper Feed M1:CW:190mm/s
-
5804 2 Paper Feed M1:CW:120mm/s
-
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-346 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
5804 3 Paper Feed M1:CW:60mm/s
-
5804 4 P-Feed M1:CW:60mm/s:Thick
-
5804 5 Paper Feed M1:CCW:190mm/s
-
5804 6 Paper Feed M1:CCW:120mm/s
-
5804 7 Paper Feed M1:CCW:60mm/s
-
5804 8 P-Feed M1:CCW:60mm/s:Thick
-
5804 9 Paper Feed M2:CW:190mm/s
-
5804 10 Paper Feed M2:CW:120mm/s
-
5804 11 Paper Feed M2:CW:60mm/s
-
5804 12 P-Feed M2:CW:60mm/s:Thick
-
5804 13 Paper Feed M2:CCW:190mm/s
-
5804 14 Paper Feed M2:CCW:120mm/s
-
5804 15 Paper Feed M2:CCW:60mm/s
-
5804 16 P-Feed M2:CCW:60mm/s:Thick
-
5804 17 Bypass M:CW:190mm/s
-
5804 18 Bypass M:CW:120mm/s
-
5804 19 Bypass M:CW:60mm/s:400mA
-
5804 20 Bypass M:CW:60mm/s:300mA
-
5804 21 Bypass M:CCW:190mm/s
-
5804 22 Bypass M:CCW:120mm/s
-
5804 23 Bypass M:CCW:60mm/s
-
5804 24 Registration M:120mm/s
-
5804 25 Registration M:60mm/s
-
SM Appendix
9-347 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
System Service Mode
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 5804 26 Regist M:60mm/s:Thick
-
5804 27 Inverter M:CW:280mm/s
-
5804 29 Inverter M:CW:120mm/s
-
5804 31 Inverter M:CW:60mm/s
-
5804 33 Inverter M:280mm/s
-
5804 35 Inverter M:120mm/s
-
5804 36 Fusing Exit Motor: 56mm/s
-
5804 37 Inverter M:60mm/s
-
5804 39 Duplex Exit M:280mm/s
-
5804 40 Duplex Exit M:120mm/s
-
5804 41 Duplex Exit M:60mm/s
-
5804 42 Duplex Ent. M:280mm/s
-
5804 43 Duplex Ent. M:120mm/s
-
5804 44 Duplex Ent. M:60mm/s
-
5804 45 Color Dev. M:120mm/s
-
5804 46 Color Dev. M:60mm/s
-
5804 47 Color Drum. M:120mm/s
-
5804 48 Color Drum. M:60mm/s
-
5804 49 Bk Drum M:120mm/s
-
5804 50 Bk Drum M:60mm/s
-
5804 51 ITB Motor:120mm/s
-
5804 52 ITB Motor:60mm/s
-
5804 53 Fusing/P-Exit M:120mm/s
-
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-348 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
5804 54 Fusing/P-Exit M:60mm/s
-
5804 55 Electrical FAN:H
-
5804 56 Electrical FAN:L
-
5804 57 Fusing Fan:H
-
5804 58 Fusing Fan:L
-
5804 59 Dev. Front FAN:H
-
5804 60 Dev. Front FAN:L
-
5804 61 Dev. Rear FAN:H
-
5804 62 Dev. Rear FAN:L
-
5804 63 Fusing Exit Fan:H
-
5804 64 Fusing Exit Fan:L
-
5804 65 LD Unit Fan:H
-
5804 66 LD Unit Fan:L
-
5804 67 PSU Fan:H
-
5804 69 Junc. Gate SOL Fan:H
-
5804 70 Junc. Gate SOL Fan:L
-
5804 71 Toner Supply M:Bk
-
5804 72 Toner Supply M:C
-
5804 73 Toner Supply M:M
-
5804 74 Toner Supply M:Y
-
5804 75 PCU T-Collect Motor
-
5804 76 ID/MUSIC Sn Shutter Motor
-
5804 77 ITB Contact Motor
-
SM Appendix
9-349 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
System Service Mode
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 5804 78 Bk Dev. Clutch
-
5804 79 Junction Gate SOL
-
5804 80 PWM:Potential Sn:Bk
-
5804 81 PWM:Potential Sn:C
-
5804 82 PWM:Potential Sn:M
-
5804 83 PWM:Potential Sn:Y
-
5804 84 HVPS:Charge AC:Bk:H
-
5804 85 HVPS:Charge AC:Bk:L
-
5804 86 HVPS:Charge AC:C:H
-
5804 87 HVPS:Charge AC:C:L
-
5804 88 HVPS:Charge AC:M:H
-
5804 89 HVPS:Charge AC:M:L
-
5804 90 HVPS:Charge AC:Y:H
-
5804 91 HVPS:Charge AC:Y:L
-
5804 92 HVPS:Charge DC:Bk
-
5804 93 HVPS:Charge DC:C
-
5804 94 HVPS:Charge DC:M
-
5804 95 HVPS:Charge DC:Y
-
5804 96 HVPS:Dev. Bias:Bk
-
5804 97 HVPS:Dev. Bias:C
-
5804 98 HVPS:Dev. Bias:M
-
5804 99 HVPS:Dev. Bias:Y
-
5804 100 HVPS:PTR Bias:- PWM
D037/D038/D040/D041
-
9-350 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
5804 101 HVPS:PTR Bias:+ PWM
-
5804 102 HVPS:ITR Bias:Bk
-
5804 103 HVPS:ITR Bias:C
-
5804 104 HVPS:ITR Bias:M
-
5804 105 HVPS:ITR Bias:Y
-
5804 106 MUSIC Sensor:R:PWM
-
5804 107 MUSIC Sensor:C:PWM
-
5804 108 MUSIC Sensor:F:PWM
-
5804 109 Reserve Fan:H
-
5804 110 Reserve Fan:LOCK
-
5804 111 Toner End Sn Power
-
5804 120 R-Tray M:280mm/s
-
5804 121 R-Tray M:120mm/s
-
5804 122 R-Tray SOL
-
5804 123 Shift Motor
-
5804 124 1T PFU:Tray Lift M
-
5804 125 1T PFU:Paper Feed M
-
5804 126 1T PFU:Paper Feed CL
-
5804 127 2T PFU:Relay CL
-
5804 128 2T PFU:Upper Feed CL
-
5804 129 2T PFU:Lower Feed CL
-
5804 130 2T PFU:P-Feed M:190mm/s
-
5804 131 2T PFU:P-Feed M:120mm/s
-
SM Appendix
9-351 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
System Service Mode
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 5804 132 2T PFU:P-Feed M:60mm/s
-
5804 133 PFU:Upper Tray Lift M
-
5804 134 2T PFU:Lower Tray Lift M
-
5804 192 RFID ON/OFF: Bk
-
5804 193 RFID ON/OFF: C
-
5804 194 RFID ON/OFF: M
-
5804 195 RFID ON/OFF: Y
-
5804 196 RFID COM ON: Bk
-
5804 197 RFID COM ON: C
-
5804 198 RFID COM ON: M
-
5804 199 RFID COM ON: Y
-
5804 202 Scanner Lamp
-
5804 210 Polygon Motor
-
5804 216 LD1: Bk
-
5804 218 LDI: C
-
5804 220 LD1: M
-
5804 222 LD1: Y
-
Internal Finisher (D429)
6121
Description
Description
6121 1 Transport Motor
-
6121 2 Front Jogger Motor
-
6121 3 Rear Jogger Motor
-
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-352 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 6121 4 Stapler Slide Motor
-
6121 5 Stack Feed-out Motor
-
6121 6 Pick Roller Lift Motor
-
6121 7 Staple Motor
-
6121 8 Tray Lift Motor
-
6121 9 Paper Detection SOL
-
6121 10 Paddle Rotation SOL
-
6121 11 Belt Roller SOL
-
6121 12 Junction Gate SOL
-
6121 13 Fan Motor
-
6120 14 Punch Motor
-
6120 15 Punch Slide Motor
-
6120 16 Inverter Roller SOL
-
ARDF (D366)
6008
Display
Description
6008 3 Feed Motor: Forward
Feed Motor-Forward rotation
6008 4 Feed Motor: Reverse
Feed Motor-Reverse rotation
6008 5 Relay Motor: Forward
Transport Motor- Forward rotation
Transport Motor: Forward
Transport Motor- Reverse rotation
Relay Motor Reverse
Transport Motor- Reverse rotation
6008 9 Feed Clutch 6008 10 Pick-up Solenoid
SM Appendix
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
6008 6
-
9-353 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode 6008 11 Junction Gate Solenoid
-
6008 12 Stamp Solenoid
Stamp Solenoid
9.1.4 TEST PATTERN PRINTING Printing Test pattern: SP2-109 Some of these test patterns are used for copy image adjustments but most are used primarily for design testing.
Do not operate the machine until the test pattern is printed out completely. Otherwise, an SC occurs.
1.
Enter the SP mode and select SP2-109-003.
2.
Enter the number for the test pattern that you want to print and press [#].
3.
When you want to select the single color of Magenta, Yellow or Cyan for printing a test pattern, select the color with SP2-109-005 (2: Magenta, 3: Yellow, 4: Cyan).
4.
When you want to change the density of printing a test pattern, select the density with SP2-109-006 to -009 for each color.
If you select "0" with SP2-109-006 to -009, the color to be adjusted to "0" does not come up on a test pattern.
5.
When you are prompted to confirm your selection, touch "Yes" to select the test pattern for printing.
6.
Touch "Copy Window" to open the copy window, then select the settings for the test print (paper size etc.).
If you want to use black and white printing, touch "Black & White" on the LCD. If you want to use color printing, touch "Full Colour" on the LCD.
7.
Press the "Start" key to start the test print.
8.
After checking the test pattern, touch "SP Mode" on the LCD to return to the SP mode display.
9.
Reset all settings to the default values.
10. Touch "Exit" twice to exit SP mode.
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-354 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
System Service Mode
No.
Pattern
No.
Pattern
None
11
Independent Pattern (1dot)
1
Vertical Line (1dot)
12
Independent Pattern (2dot)
2
Vertical Line (2dot)
13
Independent Pattern (4dot)
3
Horizontal Line (1dot)
14
Ttrimming Area
4
Horizontal Line (2dot)
16
Hound's Tooth Check (Horizontal)
5
Grid Vertical Line
17
Band (Horizontal)
6
Grid Horizontal Line
18
Band (Vertical)
7
Grid Pattern Small
19
Checkered Flag Pattern
8
Grid Pattern Large
20
Grayscale (Vertical Margin)
9
Argyle Patter Small
21
Grayscale (Horizontal Margin)
10
Argyle Patter Large
23
Full Dot Pattern
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
0
SM Appendix
9-355 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Printer Service Mode
9.2 PRINTER SERVICE MODE 9.2.1 SP1-XXX (SERVICE MODE)
1001
Bit Switch
001 Bit Switch 1
0
1
bit 0
DFU
-
-
bit 1
DFU
-
-
bit 2
DFU
-
-
bit 3
No I/O Timeout
0: Disable
1: Enable
Enable: The MFP I/O Timeout setting will have no effect. I/O Timeouts will never occur. bit 4
0: Disable
SD Card Save Mode
1: Enable
Enable: Print jobs will be saved to an SD Card in the GW SD slot ( “Card Save Function” in the System Maintenance Reference of the Field Service Manual). bit 5
DFU
-
-
bit 6
DFU
-
-
bit 7
[RPCS,PCL]: Printable area frame border
0: Disable
1: Enable
Enable: The machine prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border on the edges of the printable area.
1001
Bit Switch
002 Bit Switch 2
0
1
bit 0
DFU
-
-
bit 1
DFU
-
-
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-356 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Printer Service Mode bit 2
Applying a collation Type
Shift
Normal
Collate
Collate
A collation type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not already have a ‘Collate Type’ configured. bit 3
If #5-0 is enabled, this Bit Switch has no effect.
[PCL5e/c,PS]: PDL Auto Switching
0: Enable
1: Disable
Disable: The MFPs ability to change the PDL processor mid-job. Some host systems submit jobs that contain both PS and PCL5e/c. If Auto PDL switching is disabled, these jobs will not be printed properly.
1001
bit 4
DFU
-
-
bit 5
DFU
-
-
bit 6
DFU
-
-
bit 7
DFU
-
-
0
1
Bit Switch
003 Bit Switch 3 bit 0
DFU
-
-
bit 1
DFU
-
-
bit 2
[PCL5e/c]: Legacy HP compatibility
0: Disable
1: Enable
Enable: Uses the same left margin as older HP models such as HP4000/HP8000. In other words, the left margin defined in the job (usually "<ESC>*r0A")
bit 3
DFU
-
-
bit 4
DFU
-
-
bit 5
DFU
-
-
SM Appendix
9-357 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
will be changed to "<ESC>*r1A"
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Printer Service Mode
1001
bit 6
DFU
-
-
bit 7
DFU
-
-
-
-
0
1
Disable
Enable
Bit Switch
004 Bit Switch 4 DFU
1001
Bit Switch
005 Bit Switch 5 Show "Collate Type", "Staple Type" and "Punch Type" buttons on the operation panel. bit 0
If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and Punch Type from the operation panel. The available types will depend on the device and configured options. After enabling the function, the settings will appear under: "User Tools > Printer Features > System"
bit 1
DFU
-
-
bit 2
DFU
-
-
bit 3
[PS] PS Criteria
Pattern3
Pattern1
Change the number of PS criterion used by the PS interpreter to determine whether a job is PS data or not. Pattern3: includes most PS commands. Pattern1: A small number of PS tags and headers bit 4
Increase max number of the stored jobs
Disable
Enable (1000)
(100)
to 1000 jobs.
Enable: Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the HDD via Job Type settings to 1000. The default is 100. bit 5
Disable
Face-up output
D037/D038/D040/D041
9-358 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Enable
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Printer Service Mode Enable: All print jobs will be output face-up in the destination tray.
1001
bit 6
DFU
-
-
bit 7
DFU
-
-
-
-
-
-
0
1
Bit Switch
006 Bit Switch 6 DFU
1001
Bit Switch
007 Bit Switch 7 DFU
1001
Bit Switch
008 Bit Switch 8 bit 0
DFU
-
-
bit 1
DFU
-
-
bit 2
DFU
-
-
bit 3
[PCL,PS]: Allow BW jobs to print without
Disable
Enable
requiring User Code
Enable: BW jobs submitted without a user code will be printed even if usercode authentication is enabled. Color jobs will not be printed without a valid user code.
bit 4
DFU
-
-
bit 5
DFU
-
-
bit 6
[PS]: Orientation Auto Detect Function
Enable
Disable
Disable: Automatically chooses page orientations of PostScript jobs (Landscape or Portrait) based on the content printed on the page.
SM Appendix
9-359 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Printer Service Mode bit 7
[PDF]: Orientation Auto Detect Function
Enable
Disable
Automatically chooses page orientations of PDF jobs (Landscape or Portrait) based on the content printed on the page.
1003
1003 1
[Clear Setting] Initialize Printer System Initializes settings in the “System” menu of the user mode.
1003 3 Delete Program
1004
1004 1
[Print Summary] Print Summary Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings).
1005
1005 1
[Display Version] Disp. Version Displays the version of the controller firmware.
1006
[Sample/Locked Print]
*CTL
0: Linked, 1: On
Enables and disables the document server. When you select “0,” the document 1006 1
server is enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service Mode SP5-967. When you select “1,” the document server is enabled regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967.
[Data Recall] 1101
Recalls a set of gamma settings. This can be either a) the factory setting, b) the previous setting, or c) the current setting.
1101 1 Factory
D037/D038/D040/D041
*CTL
9-360 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Printer Service Mode 1101 2 Previous 1101 3 Current 1101 4 ACC
1102
[Resolution Setting] Selects the printing mode (resolution) for the printer gamma adjustment.
1102 1
2400x600 Photo, 1800x600 Photo, 600 x 600 Photo, 2400x600 Text, 1800x600, Text, 600x600 Text
[Test Page] 1103
Prints the test page to check the color balance before and after the gamma adjustment.
1103 1 Color Gray Scale 1103 2 Color Pattern
[Gamma Adjustment] 1104
Adjusts the printer gamma for the mode selected in the “Mode Selection” menu.
1104 1 Black: Highlight
*CTL
[0 to 30 / 15 / 1/step ]
1104 2 Black: Shadow 1104 3 Black: Middle 1104 4 Black: IDmax 1104 21 Cyan: Highlight
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
1104 22 Cyan: Shadow 1104 23 Cyan: Middle
SM Appendix
9-361 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Printer Service Mode 1104 24 Cyan: IDmax 1104 41 Magenta: Highlight 1104 42 Magenta: Shadow 1104 43 Magenta: Middle 1104 44 Magenta: IDmax 1104 61 Yellow: Highlight 1104 62 Yellow: Shadow 1104 63 Yellow: Middle 1104 64 Yellow: IDmax
[Save Tone Control Value]
1105
Stores the print gamma adjusted with the “Gamma Adj.” menu item as the current setting. Before the machine stores the new “current setting", it moves the data currently stored as the “current setting” to the “previous setting” memory storage location.
1105 1 Save Tone Control Value
1106
[Toner Limit] Adjusts the maximum toner amount for image development.
1106 1 Toner Limit Value
D037/D038/D040/D041
*CTL [100 to 400 / 260 / 1 %/step ]
9-362 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner SP Mode
9.3 SCANNER SP MODE 9.3.1 SP1-XXX (SYSTEM AND OTHERS) 1001
[Scan Nv Version]
1001 5 -
1004
*CTL
-
[Compression Type] Selects the compression type for binary picture processing.
1004 1 Compression Type
*CTL
[1 to 3 / 1 / 1/step ] 1: MH, 2: MR, 3: MMR
[Erase margin] 1005
Creates an erase margin for all edges of the scanned image. If the machine has scanned the edge of the original, create a margin. This SP is activated only when the machine uses TWAIN scanning.
1005 1 Range from 0 to 5 mm
1009
*CTL
[Remote scan disable]
*CTL
[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step ]
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: enable, 1: disable
1009 1 Enable or disable remote scan.
1010
[Non Display Clear Light PDF]
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: Display, 1: No display
1010 1 Enable or disable remote scan.
[Org count Disp]
SM Appendix
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
Appendix: SP Mode Tables
1011
0: ON, 1: OFF
9-363 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D037/D038/D040/D041
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Scanner SP Mode 1011 1 Displays the original counter.
1012
1012 1
1013
*CTL
[UserInfo release]
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: No, 1: Yes
Release following settings: Address, Sender, Text / Subject, Filename
[Multimedia Function
*CTL
Setting]
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON
1013 1 On or off multimedia function
9.3.2 SP2-XXX (SCANNING-IMAGE QUALITY) [Compression Level (Grayscale)] 2021
Selects the compression ratio for grayscale processing mode (JPEG) for the three settings that can be selected at the operation panel.
2021 1 Comp 1: 5-95
[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]
2021 2 Comp 2: 5-95
[5 to 95 / 40 / 1 /step ] *CTL
2021 3 Comp 3: 5-95
[5 to 95 / 65 / 1 /step ]
2021 4 Comp 4: 5-95
[5 to 95 / 80 / 1 /step ]
2021 5 Comp 5: 5-95
[5 to 95 / 95 / 1 /step ]
[Compression ratio of ClearLight PDF] 2024
Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that can be selected at the operation panel.
2024 1 Compression Ratio (Normal)
*CTL
2024 2 Compression Ratio (High)
D037/D038/D040/D041
[5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ] [5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]
9-364 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM Appendix
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
PAPER TRAY UNIT PB3030 D331
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
PAPER TRAY UNIT PB3030 D331 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 COVERS AND ROLLER ............................................................................... 1 1.1.1 COVERS.............................................................................................. 1 1.1.2 FEED ROLLER .................................................................................... 2 1.2 DRIVE COMPONENTS ................................................................................ 3 1.2.1 UPPER FEED CLUTCH....................................................................... 3 1.2.2 LOWER FEED CLUTCH...................................................................... 3 1.2.3 RELAY CLUTCH.................................................................................. 4 1.2.4 PAPER FEED MOTOR ........................................................................ 4 1.2.5 LIFT MOTORS..................................................................................... 5 1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ..................................................................... 6 1.3.1 1.3.2 1.3.3 1.3.4
VERTICAL TRANSPORT SENSOR .................................................... 6 PAPER END SENSOR ........................................................................ 7 PAPER SIZE SENSORS ..................................................................... 7 TRAY MAIN BOARD............................................................................ 8
2. DETAILED SECTION DESCRIPTIONS...........................................9 2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT ............................................................................... 9 2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT .............................................. 9 2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ............................................. 10 2.1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION ................................... 10 2.1.4 DRIVE LAYOUT................................................................................. 13 2.2 PAPER FEED AND SEPARATION MECHANISM ...................................... 14 2.3 PAPER LIFT MECHANISM......................................................................... 15 2.4 PAPER END DETECTION.......................................................................... 17 2.5 PAPER HEIGHT DETECTION.................................................................... 18 2.6 PAPER SIZE DETECTION ......................................................................... 19 2.7 SIDE AND END FENCES ........................................................................... 21 2.7.1 SIDE FENCES ................................................................................... 21 2.7.2 END FENCE ...................................................................................... 21
SM
i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D331
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety
Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual.
Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols.
: See or Refer to : Screws
: Connector : Clip ring : E-ring
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Covers and Roller
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the procedures in this section.
1.1.1 COVERS
Rear Cover 1.
Hold brackets [A] ( x 1 each)
2.
Rear cover [B] ( x 3)
Right Cover 1.
Right side stopper [C] ( x 3)
2.
Right cover [D] ( x , knob screw x 2)
SM
1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D331
Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331
1.1 COVERS AND ROLLER
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Covers and Roller
1.1.2 FEED ROLLER
1.
Pull out the tray [A].
2.
Release the lock lever [B].
3.
Feed roller [C]
D331
2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Drive Components
1.2 DRIVE COMPONENTS Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331
the procedures in this section.
1.2.1 UPPER FEED CLUTCH
1.
Rear cover ( "Covers")
2.
Bracket [A] ( x 2)
3.
Hold bracket [B] ( x 1, bushing x 1)
4.
Upper feed clutch [C] ( x 1)
1.2.2 LOWER FEED CLUTCH
1.
Rear cover ( "Covers")
2.
Lower feed clutch [A] ( x 1, = x 1, x 1)
SM
3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D331
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Drive Components
1.2.3 RELAY CLUTCH
1.
Rear cover ( "Covers")
2.
Relay clutch [A] (= x 1, x 1)
1.2.4 PAPER FEED MOTOR
1.
Rear cover ( "Covers")
2.
Tray main board ( "Tray Main Board")
3.
Gear [A] ( x 1)
4.
Paper feed motor bracket [B] ( x 5)
5.
Paper feed motor [C] ( x 2)
D331
4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Drive Components
1.2.5 LIFT MOTORS
Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331
Upper Lift Motor
1.
Rear cover ( "Covers")
2.
Spring [A] (snap ring x 1, spacer x 1)
3.
Lift motor bracket [B] ( x 3, x 1)
4.
Upper lift motor [C] ( x 3)
Lower Lift Motor 1.
Rear cover ( "Covers")
2.
Spring (snap ring x 1, spacer x 1)
3.
Lift motor bracket ( x 4, x 1)
4.
Lower lift motor ( x 3)
SM
5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D331
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS
Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the procedures in this section.
1.3.1 VERTICAL TRANSPORT SENSOR
1.
Open the tray cover [A]
2.
Guide plate [B] ( x 2)
3.
Sensor bracket [C] ( x 1, x 1)
4.
Vertical transport sensor [D] (hooks)
D331
6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331
1.3.2 PAPER END SENSOR
1.
Pull out the tray [A]
2.
Sensor bracket [B] ( x 1, x 1)
3.
Paper end sensor [C] (hooks)
1.3.3 PAPER SIZE SENSORS
1.
Pull out the two trays.
2.
Sensor bracket cover [A] ( x 1)
3.
Sensor bracket [B] ( x 3, x 2)
4.
Paper size sensors (hooks)
SM
7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D331
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
1.3.4 TRAY MAIN BOARD
1.
Rear cover ( "Covers")
2.
Tray main board [A] ( x 4, all 's)
D331
8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Component Layout
2. DETAILED SECTION DESCRIPTIONS
Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331
2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT 2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT
1. Upper paper feed roller 2. Lower paper feed roller 3. Lower bottom plate 4. Optional tray heater
SM
5. Lower tray 6. Upper tray 7. Upper bottom plate
9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D331
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Component Layout
2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT
1. Paper feed motor
12. Lower paper height 1 sensor
2. Upper lift sensor
13. Vertical transport sensor
3. Upper lift motor
14. Lower tray set switch
4. Upper tray set switch
15. Lower paper end sensor
5. Upper paper height 2 sensor
16. Upper paper end sensor
6. Upper paper height 1 sensor
17. Optional tray heater
7. Upper paper feed clutch
18. Lower lift motor
8. Relay clutch
19. Lower paper size sensors
9. Tray cover switch
20. Lower lift sensor
10. Lower paper feed clutch
21. Upper paper size sensors
11. Lower paper height 2 sensor
22. Tray main board
2.1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
Symbol
D331
Name
Function
10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Index No.
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Component Layout
M1
Paper Feed
Drives all rollers.
1
M2
Upper Lift
Lifts the upper tray bottom plate.
3
M3
Lower Lift
Lifts the lower tray bottom plate.
18
Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331
Motors
Sensors S1
Upper Lift
S2
Lower Lift
S3
Upper Paper End
S4
Lower Paper End
S5
S6
S7
S8
S9
S10 S11
SM
Vertical Transport Upper Paper Height 1 Upper Paper Height 2 Lower Paper Height 1 Lower Paper Height 2 Upper Paper Size Lower Paper
Detects when the paper in the upper tray is at the correct feed height. Detects when the paper in the lower tray is at the correct feed height. Informs the copier/printer when the upper tray runs out of paper. Informs the copier/printer when the lower tray runs out of paper.
2
20
16
15
Detects misfeeds.
13
Detects the amount of paper in the upper tray.
6
Detects the amount of paper in the upper tray.
5
Detects the amount of paper in the lower tray.
12
Detects the amount of paper in the lower tray.
11
Determines what paper size is in the upper tray.
21
Determines what paper size is in the lower tray.
19
11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D331
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Component Layout Size
Switches SW1
Tray Cover
SW2
Upper Tray Set
SW3
Lower Tray Set
Detects whether the tray cover is opened or not. Detects whether the upper tray is opened or not.
9 4
Detects whether the lower tray is opened or not.
14
Starts paper feed from the upper tray.
7
Starts paper feed from the lower tray.
10
Drives the relay rollers.
8
Magnetic Clutches MC1
MC2 MC3
Upper Paper Feed Lower Paper Feed Relay
PCBs PCB1
Tray Main
Controls the paper tray unit and communicates with the copier/printer.
22
Others H1
D331
Optional Tray Heater
Removes humidity from the paper in the trays.
12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
17
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Component Layout
Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331
2.1.4 DRIVE LAYOUT
1. Paper feed motor
5. Lower paper feed clutch
2. Drive belt
6. Upper paper feed roller
3. Upper paper feed clutch
7. Relay roller
4. Relay clutch
8. Lower paper feed roller
SM
13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D331
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Feed and Separation Mechanism
2.2 PAPER FEED AND SEPARATION MECHANISM
The paper tray holds 500 sheets. The paper feed roller [A] drives the top sheet of paper from the paper tray to the copier/printer. The friction pad [B] allows only one sheet to feed at a time. The friction pad applies pressure to the feed roller with a spring [C].
D331
14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Lift Mechanism
Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331
2.3 PAPER LIFT MECHANISM
The paper size switch detects when the tray is pushed in. When the paper tray is pushed into the machine, the pin [A] for the lift motor pressure shaft engages the lift motor coupling [B] and the pin [C] for the bottom plate lift shaft in the tray engages the bottom plate pressure lever coupling [D]. The pin [E] on the rear of the tray pushes the lock lever so that the lift motor can lift the bottom plate pressure lever. The lift motor turns on, and turns clockwise as viewed on the diagram. The main pressure spring [H] pulls the bottom plate pressure lever, and this lifts the tray bottom plate. When the top of the stack touches the feed roller, the motor cannot pull up the plate any more, so it pulls the actuator [G] into the lift sensor [F]. The pressure of the feed roller on the paper is now too high, so the lift motor reverses to reduce this pressure. It reverses for 300 ms or 600 ms, depending on the paper size. For smaller paper, it reverses the larger amount (600 ms) to reduce the pressure more. When the paper tray is pulled out, the pins [A, C] disengage from the couplings [B, D], and
SM
15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D331
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Lift Mechanism the bottom plate drops. To make it easier to push the tray in, the lift motor rotates backwards 1.7 seconds to return the bottom plate pressure lever coupling [D] to the original position.
D331
16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper End Detection
Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331
2.4 PAPER END DETECTION
If there is some paper in the paper tray, the paper stack raises the paper end feeler [A] and the paper end sensor [B] is deactivated. When the paper tray runs out of paper, the paper end feeler drops into the cutout [C] in the tray bottom plate and the paper end sensor is activated. When the paper tray is drawn out with no paper in the tray, the shape of the paper end feeler causes it to lift up.
SM
17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D331
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Height Detection
2.5 PAPER HEIGHT DETECTION
The amount of paper in the tray is detected by the combination of on/off signals from two paper height sensors [A] and [B]. When the amount of paper decreases, the bottom plate pressure lever [C] moves the actuator up. The following combination of sensor signals is sent to the copier/printer.
Amount of Paper
Paper Height Sensor 1
Paper Height Sensor 2
Near End
OFF
ON
30%
ON
ON
70%
ON
OFF
100%
OFF
OFF
When the tray contains paper of a small width, the paper feed pressure may become too low when the thickness of the remaining stack of paper has decreased. The lift motor rotates forward 300 ms after the sensor detects a certain amount of paper remaining in the tray to increase paper feed pressure, simulating the pressure generated by a full tray.
D331
18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Size Detection
Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331
2.6 PAPER SIZE DETECTION
There are three paper size sensors [A] (SN1, SN2 and SN3) on the paper tray unit. Each paper tray has its own actuator [B], with a unique combination of notches. This actuator is moved when the paper end fence [C] is adjusted for the installed paper. To determine which size has been installed, the CPU reads which paper size sensors the actuator has switched off. Refer to the size detection lists as shown below.
EU/ AISA Size
SN1
SN2
SN3
SP Setting
A6 SEF
148 x 105
OFF
ON
OFF
A5 LEF
B5 LEF
182 x 257
ON
OFF
ON
B6 SEF/ Exe LEF
A4 LEF
210 x 297
ON
ON
OFF
B5 SEF
257 x 182
OFF
OFF
ON
LT SEF
279 x 216
OFF
OFF
OFF
A4 SEF
297 x 210
ON
OFF
OFF
B4 SEF
364 x 257
ON
ON
ON
SM
19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
LT LEF/ A5 SEF/ HLT SEF
LG SEF
D331
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Paper Size Detection A3 SEF
420 x 297 NA Size
OFF
ON
ON
SN1
SN2
SN3
DLT SEF SP Setting
A6 SEF
148 x 105
OFF
ON
OFF
A5 LEF
B5 LEF
182 x 257
ON
OFF
ON
Exe LEF/ B6 SEF
LT LEF
210 x 297
ON
ON
OFF
B5 SEF
257 x 182
OFF
OFF
ON
LT SEF
279 x 216
OFF
OFF
OFF
A4 SEF
297 x 210
ON
OFF
OFF
LG SEF
364 x 257
ON
ON
ON
DLT SEF
420 x 297
OFF
ON
ON
A4 LEF/ A5 SEF/ HLT SEF
A3 SEF
The CPU disables paper feed from a tray if the paper size cannot be detected. If the paper size actuator is broken, or if there is no tray installed, the Add Paper indicator will light.
D331
20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Side and End Fences
Paper Tray Unit PB3030 D331
2.7 SIDE AND END FENCES
2.7.1 SIDE FENCES If the tray is full of paper and it is pushed in strongly, the fences may deform or bend. This may cause the paper to skew or the side-to-side registration to be incorrect. To correct this, each side fence has a stopper [A] attached to it. Each side fence can be secured with a screw [B], for customers who do not want to change the paper size.
2.7.2 END FENCE As the amount of paper in the tray decreases, the bottom plate [C] lifts up gradually. The end fence [D] is connected to the bottom plate. When the tray bottom plate rises, the end fence moves forward and pushes the back of the paper stack to keep it squared up.
SM
21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D331
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
ARDF DF3030 D366 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 COVERS AND TRAY.................................................................................... 1 1.1.1 REAR COVER ..................................................................................... 1 1.1.2 FRONT COVER AND ORIGINAL TRAY.............................................. 1 1.2 DOCUMENT FEED COMPONENTS ............................................................ 2 1.2.1 ORIGINAL FEED UNIT ........................................................................ 2 1.2.2 PICK-UP ROLLER ............................................................................... 2 1.2.3 FEED BELT ......................................................................................... 3 1.2.4 SEPARATION ROLLER....................................................................... 4 1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ..................................................................... 5 1.3.1 ARDF DRIVE BOARD AND DF POSITION SENSOR ......................... 5 1.3.2 ORIGINAL LENGTH SENSORS AND TRAILING EDGE SENSOR..... 5 1.3.3 ORIGINAL SET SENSOR.................................................................... 6 1.3.4 ORIGINAL SIZE SENSORS AND SKEW CORRECTION SENSOR ... 6 1.3.5 STAMP SOLENOID AND ORIGINAL EXIT SENSOR ......................... 7 1.4 ORIGINAL FEED DRIVE .............................................................................. 8 1.4.1 FEED MOTOR ..................................................................................... 8 1.4.2 PICK-UP SOLENOID ........................................................................... 8 1.4.3 INVERTER SOLENOID ....................................................................... 9 1.4.4 FEED CLUTCH.................................................................................. 10 1.4.5 TRANSPORT MOTOR....................................................................... 11
2. DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS..........................................................12 2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT ............................................................................. 12 2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ............................................ 12 2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT ............................................. 13 2.1.3 DRIVE LAYOUT................................................................................. 16 2.2 BASIC OPERATION ................................................................................... 17 2.2.1 ORIGINAL SET AND SIZE DETECTION........................................... 17 2.2.2 MIXED ORIGINAL SIZE MODE......................................................... 18 2.2.3 PICK-UP AND SEPARATION............................................................ 20 SM
i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
2.2.4 SKEW CORRECTION ....................................................................... 21 2.2.5 ORIGINAL TRANSPORT AND EXIT ................................................. 22 2.2.6 CONDITIONS FOR JAM DETECTION .............................................. 23
3. SERVICE TABLES.........................................................................25 3.1 DIP SWITCHES .......................................................................................... 25
D366
ii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety
Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual.
Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols. : See or Refer to : Screws : Connector : Clip ring : E-ring
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Covers and Tray
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 COVERS AND TRAY 1.1.1 REAR COVER
1.
Open the left cover [A].
2.
Open the original tray [B].
3.
Rear cover [C] (
x 1, hook x 6)
1.1.2 FRONT COVER AND ORIGINAL TRAY
1.
Open the left cover.
2.
Rear cover (
3.
Front cover [A] (
4.
SM
"Rear Cover") x 1)
Keep the original tray open when you remove the front cover.
Original tray [B] (
x 1,
x 1)
1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Document Feed Components
1.2 DOCUMENT FEED COMPONENTS 1.2.1 ORIGINAL FEED UNIT
1.
Open the left cover.
2.
Original feed unit [A].
1.2.2 PICK-UP ROLLER
1.
Open the left cover.
2.
Original feed unit (
3.
Pick-up roller [A] (
D366
"Original Feed Unit") x 1)
2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Document Feed Components
1.2.3 FEED BELT
1.
Open the left cover.
2.
Original feed unit (
3.
Feed belt cover [A] (spring x 1)
"Original Feed Unit")
When reassembling the feed belt cover, make sure that the projection [B] of the feed belt cover is on the guide plate rear [C].
4.
SM
Belt tension unit [D]
3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Document Feed Components
5.
Feed belt [E]
1.2.4 SEPARATION ROLLER
1.
Open the left cover.
2.
Separation roller cover [A].
3.
Separation roller [B] (
D366
x 1)
4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Electrical Components
1.3 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1.3.1 ARDF DRIVE BOARD AND DF POSITION SENSOR
1.
Rear cover (see "Rear Cover")
2.
ARDF drive board [A] (
3.
DF position sensor with bracket [B] (
4.
DF position sensor [C] (hook x 2)
x 3, all
s) x 1,
x 1)
1.3.2 ORIGINAL LENGTH SENSORS AND TRAILING EDGE SENSOR
1.
Original Tray (see "Front Cover and Original Tray")
2.
Tray cover [A] (
SM
x 3)
5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components 3.
Original trailing edge sensor [B] (
4.
Original length sensors [C] (
x 1)
x 1 each)
1.3.3 ORIGINAL SET SENSOR
1.
Open the left cover.
2.
Original feed unit (see the "Original Feed Unit")
3.
Original Tray (see the "Original Tray")
4.
Original feed-in guide plate [A] (
x 3).
5.
Original set sensor bracket [B] (
x 1)
6.
Original set sensor [C]
1.3.4 ORIGINAL SIZE SENSORS AND SKEW CORRECTION SENSOR
1.
Original feed-in guide plate (see "Original Set Sensor")
2.
Original turn guide plate [A] (hook x 1).
3.
Original width sensors [B] (
D366
x 1 each) and skew correction sensor [C] with bracket
6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Electrical Components (
x 1,
x 1)
1.3.5 STAMP SOLENOID AND ORIGINAL EXIT SENSOR
1.
Open the ARDF.
2.
Remove the left edge of the platen sheet.
3.
Release the hook [A].
4.
Open the original exit guide plate [B]
5.
Stamp solenoid [C] (
6.
Original exit sensor [D] (
SM
x 1,
x 1) x 1, hook x 1)
7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Original Feed Drive
1.4 ORIGINAL FEED DRIVE 1.4.1 FEED MOTOR
1.
Rear cover (see "Rear Cover")
2.
Feed motor with bracket [A] (
3.
Feed motor [B] (
x 2,
x 1, spring x 1)
x 2)
1.4.2 PICK-UP SOLENOID
1.
Rear cover (see "Rear Cover")
2.
Harness guide [A] (all
D366
s)
8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Original Feed Drive
3.
Pick-up solenoid [B] (
x 2,
x 1)
1.4.3 INVERTER SOLENOID
1.
Rear cover (see "Rear Cover")
2.
Harness guide (see "Pick-up Solenoid")
3.
Inverter solenoid [A] (
SM
x 2,
x 1,
x 1, gear x 1, gear cover x 1)
9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Original Feed Drive
1.4.4 FEED CLUTCH
1.
Rear cover (see "Rear Cover")
2.
Harness guide (see "Pick-up Solenoid")
3.
Bracket [A] (
4.
Slide the bracket.
5.
Feed clutch [B] (
D366
x 2,
x 3,
x 1, bushing x 1, spring x 1)
x 1)
10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Original Feed Drive
1.4.5 TRANSPORT MOTOR
1.
Rear cover (see "Rear Cover")
2.
Harness guide (see "Pick-up Solenoid")
3.
Left cover sensor with bracket [A] (
4.
Transport motor with bracket [B] (
5.
Transport motor [C] (
SM
x 1, x 2,
x 1) x 1, spring x 1)
x 2)
11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Component Layout
2. DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS 2.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT 2.1.1 MECHANICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT
1. Separation Roller 2. Paper Feed Belt 3. Pick-up Roller 4. Original Trailing Edge Sensor 5. Original Tray 6. Original Length Sensor 1 7. Original Length Sensor 2 8. Original Length Sensor 3 9. Inverter Roller
D366
10. Junction Gate 11. Exit Roller 12. Original Exit Sensor 13. Transport Roller 14. Registration Roller 15. Registration Sensor 16. Skew Correction Roller 17. Skew Correction Sensor
12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Component Layout
2.1.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT LAYOUT Sensors
1. Original Width Sensor 2. Skew Correction Sensor 3. Registration Sensor 4. Cover Sensor 5. Original Set Sensor 6. Exit Sensor 7. Original Sensor 8. Original Length Sensor 9. DF Position Sensor
SM
13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Component Layout
Drive Components
1. Transport Motor 2. Feed Clutch 3. Pick-up Solenoid 4. Inverter Solenoid 5. Feed Motor 6. Main Board
Electrical Component Descriptions Symbol
Name
Function
Index No.
Motors M1
Feed
Drives the feed belt, separation, pick-up, and reverse table rollers.
5
M2
Transport
Drives the transport and exit rollers
1
S9
DF Position
Detects whether the DF is lifted or not.
9
S5
Skew Correction
Detects the leading edge of the original to turn off the DF feed and transport motors.
2
S8
Registration
Detects the original exposure timing, and checks for original misfeeds.
3
S10
Cover Sensor
Detects whether the feed-in cover is opened or not.
4
Sensors
D366
14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Component Layout S1
Original Width Sensor - S
Detects the original width - S.
1
S2
Original Width Sensor - M
Detects the original width - M.
1
S3
Original Width Sensor - L
Detects the original width - L.
1
S4
Original Width Sensor - LL
Detects the original width - LL.
1
S14
Original Length S
Detects the original length - S.
8
S13
Original Length M
Detects the original length - M.
8
S12
Original Length L
Detects the original length - L.
8
S7
Original Set
Detects if an original is on the feed table.
5
Original Exit
Detects the leading edge of the original to turn on the junction gate solenoid and checks for original misfeeds. Detects the trailing edge of the original to turn off the transport and feed motor and junction gate solenoid. In single-sided mode, used to detect original misfeeds.
6
Original
Detects the trailing edge of the last original to stop copy paper feed and to turn off the transport motor, and checks for original misfeeds.
7
3
S6
S11
Solenoids SOL1
Pick-up
Controls the up-down movement of the original table.
SOL2
Stamp
Energizes the stamper to mark the original.
SOL3
Junction Gate
Opens and closes the junction gate.
4
Drives the feed belt, separation, pick-up, and skew correction rollers
5
Magnetic Clutches MC1
SM
Feed
15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Component Layout PCBs PCB1
Main
Interfaces the sensor signals with the copier, and transfers the magnetic clutch, solenoid and motor drive signals from the copier.
6
2.1.3 DRIVE LAYOUT
1. Feed Motor 2. Pick-up Roller 3. Separation Roller 4. Feed Belt 5. Skew Correction Roller 6. Feed Clutch 7. Transport Motor 8. Exit Roller 9. Registration Roller
Feed Motor: Drives the feed belt, separation, pick-up, and skew correction rollers.
Transport Motor: Drives the registration and exit rollers.
D366
16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Basic Operation
2.2 BASIC OPERATION 2.2.1 ORIGINAL SET AND SIZE DETECTION
The original set sensor [A] detects if the original is set or not. The original sensor [B] detects if the original is on the original tray or not (this lets the machine know as early as possible, whether there is another original on the tray). The original size detection mechanism consists of the four original width sensors ([F]: Width Sensor S, [G]: Width Sensor M, [H] Width Sensor L, [I]: Width Sensor LL) and three original length sensors ([C]: Length Sensor S, [D]: Length Sensor M, [E]: Length Sensor L). Based on the combined output of the length sensors and the width sensors, the machine can detect the size of the original. This integrated detection mechanism is detailed in the table below. Width Sensor
Size
Length Sensor
Area
S
M
L
LL
S
M
L
LT
A/B
A3/SEF (297 x 420)
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
O
O
B4/SEF (257 x 364)
ON
ON
-
-
ON
ON
ON
-
O
A4/SEF (210 x 297)
ON
-
-
-
ON
ON
-
O
O
A4/LEF (297 x 210)
ON
ON
ON
ON
-
-
-
O
O
B5/SEF (182 x 257)
-
-
-
-
ON
-
-
-
O
B5/LEF (257 x 182)
ON
ON
-
-
-
-
-
-
O
A5/SEF (148 x 210)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
O
A5/LEF (210 x 148)
ON
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
O
11" x 17"/SEF (DLT)
ON
ON
ON
-
ON
ON
ON
O1
O5
SM
17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Basic Operation 1
-
11" x 15"/SEF
ON
ON
ON
-
ON
ON
ON
10" x 14"/SEF
ON
ON
-
-
ON
ON
ON
O
-
8.5" x 14"/SEF (LG)
ON
-
-
-
ON
ON
ON
O2
-
8.5" x 13"/SEF (F4)
ON
-
-
-
ON
ON
ON
2
8.25" x 13"/SEF
ON
ON
ON
ON
-
-
8" x 13"/SEF (F)
ON
-
-
-
ON
ON
ON
-
-
8.5" x 11"/SEF (LT)
ON
-
-
-
ON
-
-
O3
O6
8.5" x 11"/LEF (LT)
ON
ON
ON
-
-
-
-
O4
O7
7.25" x 10.5"/SEF (US EXE)
ON
-
-
-
ON
-
-
O
-
10.5" x 7.25"/SEF (US EXE)
ON
ON
ON
-
-
-
-
4
-
10" x 8"/SEF
ON
-
-
-
ON
-
-
3
-
5.5" x 8.5"/SEF (HLT)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
O
-
5.5" x 8.5"/LEF (HLT)
ON
-
-
-
-
-
-
O
-
267 mm x 390 mm
ON
ON
ON
-
ON
ON
ON
-
5
195 mm x 267 mm
ON
-
-
-
ON
-
-
-
6
267 mm x 195 mm
ON
ON
ON
-
-
-
-
-
7
O
Symbol O: Yes (Default),
: Yes (Can select this with SP mode), ON: Paper present, LT: North
America, A/B: Europe, Asia
For "O/ " mark, which has superscripted number, it is possible to change the original detection size with SP6-016. For example, instead of LT (O3), the machine can be set up to detect 10” x 8” (
3
).
The F size can be selected with SP5-126. The default is 8.5" x 13"
The machine cannot detect more than one size of original in the same job.
2.2.2 MIXED ORIGINAL SIZE MODE This section explains what happens when the user selects mixed original size mode. Because this ARDF is a sheet-through document feeder, the method for original document width detection is the same as when the originals are the same size, but the document length detection method is different. Therefore, the scanning speed is slightly slower.
D366
18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Basic Operation
Document length detection From when the skew correction sensor switches on until it switches off, the CPU counts the transport motor pulses. The number of pulses determines the length of the original.
Feed-in cycle When the original size for the copy modes listed below cannot be determined, the image cannot be correctly scaled (reduced or enlarged) or processed until the original’s length has been accurately detected. The length must be determined before the image is scanned.
Auto Reduce/Enlarge Centering Erase Center/Border Booklet Image Repeat
The originals follow this path: Scanning glass
Inverter table
1.
Length detection
2.
Inverter table
Scanning glass
3.
Inverter table
Scanning glass (image scanned)
Inverter table (restores the original order) Exit tray
Normal feed-in In a copy mode other than those listed above, when the reduction/enlargement ratio has been determined, the originals are scanned normally. In order to store the scanned images, a large area of memory (the detected original width x 432 mm length) is prepared. Next, only the portion of the image up to the detected original length is read from memory and printed.
SM
19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Basic Operation
2.2.3 PICK-UP AND SEPARATION
The original is set with the image facing up. The original pushes actuator and the original set sensor is activated. After pressing the start button, the feed clutch is activated and the original feed unit [A] moves down. At the same time, the pick-up solenoid is activated and the original table lifts until the original comes in contact with the pick-up roller [B]. The pick-up roller then feeds the top sheet of paper. After being fed from feed belt [C], the topmost sheet is separated from the stack by the separation roller [D] and sent to the skew correction roller. The mechanism is an FRR system, consisting of the original feed belt [C] and separation roller [D].
D366
20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Basic Operation
2.2.4 SKEW CORRECTION
When an original is fed into the feeder, the feed motor [B] rotates forwards. At this time, the feed belt turns but the skew correction roller [C] does not. Because of this, when the leading edge of the paper gets to the skew correction roller, skew in the original is removed. A short time after the leading edge of the original turns on the skew correction sensor [A], the feed motor [B] turns off for 40 ms and rotates in reverse. At this time, the skew correction roller [C] and the feed belt both turn, and original feed continues. The original is fed by the skew correction roller after the feed clutch [D] has turned off.
SM
21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Basic Operation
2.2.5 ORIGINAL TRANSPORT AND EXIT Single-Sided Originals
The feed motor feeds the separated original to the skew correction roller [A] at maximum speed. After skew correction, the feed and transport motors feed the original through the scanning area at a lower speed (the scanning area contains the original exposure guide [B] and DF exposure glass [C]). After scanning, the original is fed out by the transport roller [D] and exit roller [E].
Double-Sided Originals
After skew correction, the feed and transport motors drive the skew correction roller [A], registration roller [B], transport roller [C] and the exit roller [D]. The front side of the original is then scanned. When the original exit sensor detects the leading edge of the original, the junction gate solenoid is activated and the junction gate [E] opens. The original is then transported
D366
22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Basic Operation towards the inverter table. Soon after the trailing edge of the original passes the exit sensor, the junction gate solenoid switches off and the junction gate [E] is closed. When the original has been fed onto the inverter table, the feed motor switches on in reverse. The original is then fed by the inverter roller [F], and then by the skew correction roller [A] and registration roller [B] to the scanning area (where the reverse side will be scanned).
The original is then sent to the inverter table again to be turned over. This is done so that the duplex copies will be properly stacked front side down in the exit tray [G] in the correct order.
Original Sensor During one-to-one copying, copy paper is fed to the skew correction roller in advance (while the original is still being scanned), to increase the copy speed. The original sensor monitors the stack of originals in the feeder, and detects when the trailing edge of the last page has been fed in. The main CPU then stops the copier from feeding an unwanted extra sheet of copy paper.
2.2.6 CONDITIONS FOR JAM DETECTION Jam Mode
Detection Timing When turning on the machine, the skew correction sensor, registration sensor or exit sensor detects an original.
Initial
When the cover is closed or DF is down, the skew correction sensor, registration sensor or exit sensor detects an original. When the cover is opened or DF is lifted up, the skew correction sensor, registration sensor or exit sensor detects an original.
SM
23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Basic Operation The skew correction sensor does not turn off even if the original was fed by the maximum length of the original + 150 mm after the skew correction sensor turned on. Sensor stays on too long
The registration sensor does not turn off even if the original was fed by its length x 1.5 after the registration sensor turned on. The exit sensor does not turn off even if the original was fed by its length x 1.5 after the exit sensor turned on. The skew correction sensor does not turn on even if the original was fed by transport path length x 1.5.
Sensor does not come on
The registration sensor does not turn on even if the original was fed by transport path length x 1.5 after the skew correction sensor turned on. The exit sensor does not turn on even the original was fed by transport path length x 1.5 after the skew correction sensor turned on.
D366
24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Dip Switches
3. SERVICE TABLES 3.1 DIP SWITCHES
DIP-SW
Function
1
2
3
4
0
0
0
0
Normal operating mode (Default)
0
0
0
1
Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 100% speed
0
0
1
0
Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 100% speed
0
0
1
1
Free run: No original: One-sided mode: 100% speed
0
1
0
0
Free run: No original: Two-sided mode: 100% speed
0
1
0
1
Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 32% speed
0
1
1
0
Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 32% speed
0
1
1
1
Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 70% speed
1
0
0
0
Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 70% speed
1
0
0
1
Free run: With original: One-sided mode: 200% speed
1
0
1
0
Free run: With original: Two-sided mode: 200% speed
1
0
1
1
Transport Motor On
1
1
0
0
Feed Motor On
1
1
0
1
Transport Motor On with random mode
1
1
1
0
Feed Motor On with random mode
1
1
1
1
SM
25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D366
ARDF DF3030 D366
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3040 (D388)
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Internal Shift Tray SH3040 (D388) TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 TRAY COVER............................................................................................... 1 – When Attaching the Tray Cover – ........................................................ 1 1.2 TRAY MOTOR AND HALF TURN SENSOR BOARD................................... 2
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety
Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual.
Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols.
: See or Refer to : Screws
: Connector : Clip ring =: Clamp : E-ring
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Tray Cover
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 TRAY COVER
1.
Remove the tray cover [A] by pressing on the two pawls [B] on the left side of the cover.
– When Attaching the Tray Cover –
The right side of the tray cover should be attached first.
1.
Fit the pawls [C] on the shift tray.
2.
Align the square [D] so that it fits into the groove in the underside of the tray cover and does not interfere with the attachment of the cover. Complete the attachment by inserting the left side pawls [B] into place.
Replacement and Adjustment
3.
SM
1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D388
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Tray Motor and Half Turn Sensor Board
1.2 TRAY MOTOR AND HALF TURN SENSOR BOARD
1.
Top cover ( p.1 "Tray Cover")
2.
Slip disc [A]
3.
Tray motor [B] ( x 1)
4.
Half turn sensor board [C] ( x 1).
D388
2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
PAPER FEED UNIT PB3070 D425
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
PAPER FEED UNIT PB3070 D425 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 COVERS AND ROLLER ............................................................................... 1 1.1.1 COVERS.............................................................................................. 1 1.1.2 FEED ROLLER .................................................................................... 1 1.2 MOTORS AND CLUTCH .............................................................................. 2 1.2.1 PAPER FEED MOTOR ........................................................................ 2 1.2.2 TRANSPORT MOTOR......................................................................... 3 1.2.3 PAPER FEED CLUTCH....................................................................... 4 1.2.4 MAIN BOARD ...................................................................................... 4 1.3 SENSORS AND BOARD .............................................................................. 5 1.3.1 PAPER END SENSOR ........................................................................ 5 1.3.2 PAPER SIZE SENSORS ..................................................................... 5 1.3.3 TRAY MAIN BOARD............................................................................ 6
SM
i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D425
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Covers and Roller
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT
D425 Paper Feed Unit PB3070
1.1 COVERS AND ROLLER 1.1.1 COVERS
1.
Securing brackets [A] ( x 1 each)
2.
Rear cover [B] ( x 2)
3.
Rear right cover [C] ( x 1)
1.1.2 FEED ROLLER
1.
Pull out the tray [A]
2.
Release the lock lever [B]
3.
Feed roller [C]
SM
1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D425
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Motors and Clutch
1.2 MOTORS AND CLUTCH
Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the procedures in this section.
1.2.1 PAPER FEED MOTOR 1.
Rear Cover ( Rear Cover)
2.
Release the harness [B] (= x 2).
3.
Paper feed motor with the bracket [A] ( x 3, = x 2, x 1))
Note:
Move the lever [B] in the red circle as shown above when removing the paper feed motor with the bracket.
D425
2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D425 Paper Feed Unit PB3070
Motors and Clutch
4.
Paper feed motor bracket [A] ( x 3)
5.
Paper feed motor [B]
1.2.2 TRANSPORT MOTOR 1.
Pull out the Tray.
2.
Rear cover ( Rear Cover)
3.
Rear right cover ( Rear Right Cover)
4.
Stay [A] ( x 2)
5.
Rear right bracket [A] ( x 1)
6.
Tray end cover [B] ( x 1, = x 1)
SM
3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D425
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Motors and Clutch
7.
Transport motor [A] ( x 3, x 1)
1.2.3 PAPER FEED CLUTCH 1.
Rear Cover ( Rear Cover)
2.
Rear right bracket ( Transport Motor)
3.
Paper feed clutch [A] (= x 1, x 1, x 1)
1.2.4 MAIN BOARD 1.
Rear cover ( Rear Cover)
2.
Main board [A] (All s, x 4)
D425
4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Sensors and Board
1.3 SENSORS AND BOARD Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of D425 Paper Feed Unit PB3070
the procedures in this section.
1.3.1 PAPER END SENSOR
1.
Pull out the tray [A]
2.
Sensor bracket [B] ( x 1, x 1)
3.
Paper end sensor [C] (hooks)
1.3.2 PAPER SIZE SENSORS
1.
Pull out the tray.
2.
Sensor bracket cover [A] ( x 1)
3.
Sensor bracket [B] ( x 3, x 2)
4.
Paper size sensor (hooks)
SM
5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D425
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Sensors and Board
1.3.3 TRAY MAIN BOARD 1.
Rear cover ( Rear Cover)
2.
Main board [A] (All s, x 4)
D425
6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
1 BIN TRAY BN3060 D426
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
1 BIN TRAY BN3060 D426 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ..................................................................... 1 1.1.1 1-BIN TRAY EXIT SENSOR AND PAPER SENSOR .......................... 1 When reinstalling these sensors.............................................................. 2 1.1.2 1-BIN TRAY CONTROL BOARD ......................................................... 2 1.1.3 LED BOARD ........................................................................................ 3
SM
i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D426
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1.1.1 1-BIN TRAY EXIT SENSOR AND PAPER SENSOR 1-Bin tray unit
2.
1-bin tray bottom cover [A] ( x 2)
3.
Sensor assembly [A] ( x 1, = x 2, x 2) D426 1 Bin Tray BN3060
1.
SM
1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D426
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
4.
Sensors;
[A]: Paper sensor ( x 1)
[B]: 1-bin tray exit sensor (hooks)
When reinstalling these sensors Both sensors have a 3-pin connector. Be careful to connect the correct harnesses from the 1-bin tray control board to each sensor.
The blue connector from the 1-bin tray control board must be connected to the paper sensor.
The white connector from the 1-bin tray control board must be connected to the 1-bin tray exit sensor.
1.1.2 1-BIN TRAY CONTROL BOARD 1.
1-bin tray unit
2.
1-bin tray bottom cover ( 1-Bin Tray Exit Sensor and Paper Sensor)
3.
1-bin tray control board [A] ( x 1, x 3)
D426
2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
1.1.3 LED BOARD 1-bin tray unit
2.
1-bin tray bottom cover ( 1-Bin Tray Exit Sensor and Paper Sensor)
3.
LED board ( x 1, x 1)
D426 1 Bin Tray BN3060
1.
SM
3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D426
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SIDE TRAY TYPE C2550 D427
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SIDE TRAY TYPE C2550 D427 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS ..................................................................... 1 1.1.1 SIDE TRAY EXIT SENSOR ................................................................. 1 1.1.2 SIDE TRAY MOTOR............................................................................ 1 1.1.3 SIDE TRAY GATE SOLENOID............................................................ 2 1.1.4 SIDE TRAY BOARD ............................................................................ 3
SM
i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D427
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS 1.1.1 SIDE TRAY EXIT SENSOR 1.
Side tray paper exit unit
2.
Sensor assembly [A] ( x 2, = x 3, x 1)
3.
Side tray exit sensor [A] (hooks)]
1.
SM
D427 Side Tray Type C2550
1.1.2 SIDE TRAY MOTOR Side tray paper exit unit
1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D427
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components
2.
Side tray upper cover [A] ( x 2, tab [B])
3.
Release the tab [B] with a flat-head screwdriver.
Side tray motor [A] ( x 2, x 1)
1.1.3 SIDE TRAY GATE SOLENOID 1.
Side tray paper exit unit
2.
Side tray upper cover ( Side Tray Motor)
D427
2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Electrical Components 3.
Side tray gate solenoid assembly [A] (= x 2, x 1, x 1)
4.
Side tray gate solenoid [A] ( x 2, spring x 1)
1.1.4 SIDE TRAY BOARD Side tray paper exit unit
2.
Side tray upper cover ( Side Tray Motor)
3.
Side tray board [A] ( x 1, x all)
D427 Side Tray Type C2550
1.
SM
3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D427
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3030 D428
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
INTERNAL SHIFT TRAY SH3030 D428 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 TRAY COVER............................................................................................... 1 1.2 TRAY MOTOR AND HALF TURN SENSOR BOARD................................... 2
SM
i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D428
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Tray Cover
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 TRAY COVER
1.
Remove the tray cover [A] by pressing on the two pawls [B] on the left side of the cover.
– When Attaching the Tray Cover –
The right side of the tray cover should be attached first.
1.
Fit the pawls [C] on the shift tray.
2.
Align the square [D] so that it fits into the groove in the underside of the tray cover and does not interfere with the attachment of the cover. Complete the attachment by inserting the left side pawls [B] into place.
D428 Internal Shift Tray SH3030
3.
SM
1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D428
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Tray Motor and Half Turn Sensor Board
1.2 TRAY MOTOR AND HALF TURN SENSOR BOARD
1.
Top cover ( Tray Cover)
2.
Slip disc [A]
3.
Tray motor [B] ( x 1)
4.
Half turn sensor board [C] ( x 1).
D428
2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
INTERNAL FINISHER TYPE C2550 D429
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
INTERNAL FINISHER TYPE C2550 D429 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1 1.1 COMMON PROCEDURES ........................................................................... 1 1.1.1 REAR, LEFT REAR AND REAR INNER COVER ................................ 1 1.1.2 FRONT COVER................................................................................... 2 1.1.3 OUTPUT TRAY LOWER COVER........................................................ 2 When installing the output tray lower cover ............................................. 2 1.1.4 OUTPUT TRAY UNIT .......................................................................... 3 1.2 MOTORS ...................................................................................................... 5 1.2.1 PICK-UP ROLLER CONTACT MOTOR............................................... 5 1.2.2 STAPLER UNIT MOVEMENT MOTOR ............................................... 5 1.3 STAPLER UNIT ............................................................................................ 7 1.4 SENSORS .................................................................................................... 9 1.4.1 MAIN UNIT........................................................................................... 9 Relay Sensor........................................................................................... 9 Belt Roller Position Sensor...................................................................... 9 Stapler Safety Sensor ........................................................................... 10 Stapler Unit HP Sensor ......................................................................... 10 1.4.2 INVERTER UNIT ............................................................................... 11 Entrance Sensor.................................................................................... 11 1.5 FAN............................................................................................................. 12 1.5.1 FRONT FAN ...................................................................................... 12 1.6 MAIN BOARD ............................................................................................. 13 1.7 PUNCH UNIT .............................................................................................. 14 1.7.1 PUNCH SLIDER UNIT ....................................................................... 14
SM
i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D429
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety
Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual.
Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols.
: See or Refer to : Screws
: Connector : Clip ring : E-ring =: Clamp
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Common Procedures
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 1.1 COMMON PROCEDURES
The finisher must be removed from the machine for these procedures except "Output Tray Lower Cover" removal procedure. The following covers cannot be removed while the finisher is attached to the machine.
D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550
1.1.1 REAR, LEFT REAR AND REAR INNER COVER
1.
Rear cover [A] ( x 1)
2.
Left rear cover [B] ( x 2)
3.
Rear inner cover [C] ( x 1)
SM
1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D429
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Common Procedures
1.1.2 FRONT COVER
1.
Remove the knob [A]
2.
Front cover [B] ( x 2)
1.1.3 OUTPUT TRAY LOWER COVER
1.
Output tray lower cover [A] ( x 3)
When installing the output tray lower cover
1.
The two projections [A] of the output tray lower cover (this plate is actually attached to
D429
2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Common Procedures the output tray lower cover) must be inserted along with two guide rails [B] inside the output tray unit.
2.
Push the slide plate [A] to check if the output tray lower cover is correctly installed. The left side picture shows the correct result and right side picture shows the incorrect D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550
result.
1.1.4 OUTPUT TRAY UNIT 1.
Output tray lower cover ( Output Tray Lower Cover)
2.
Rear cover ( Rear, Left Rear and Rear Inner Cover)
3.
Left rear cover ( Rear, Left Rear and Rear Inner Cover)
4.
Rear inner cover ( Rear, Left Rear and Rear Inner Cover)
5.
Remove the screw [A].
SM
3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D429
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Common Procedures
6.
Disconnect the harness [A] (CN10), and make some slack in the cable.
7.
Output tray unit [A]
D429
4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Motors
1.2 MOTORS 1.2.1 PICK-UP ROLLER CONTACT MOTOR Front cover ( Front Cover)
2.
Loosen the harness guide [A] ( x 2)
3.
Bracket with pick-up roller contact motor [A] ( x 2, x 1)
4.
Pick-up roller contact motor [B] ( x 2)
D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550
1.
1.2.2 STAPLER UNIT MOVEMENT MOTOR 1.
SM
Front cover ( Front Cover)
5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D429
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Motors 2.
Bracket with stapler unit movement motor [A] ( x 2, spring x 1, belt)
3.
Two gears [A] ( x 1)
4.
Stapler unit movement motor [A] ( x 2)
D429
6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Stapler Unit
1.3 STAPLER UNIT Front cover ( Front Cover)
2.
White lever [A] (spring x 1, hook)
3.
Black lever [B] (hook)
4.
Shaft [A] ( x 1)
D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550
1.
Remove the green stapler cartridge first, to make this step more easy.
5.
Move the stapler unit [A] to the center.
6.
Stand the internal finisher [B] as shown above.
7.
Remove two screws.
SM
7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D429
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Stapler Unit
Note:
Make sure that the end fences [A] are placed as shown above when replacing the stapler unit.
8.
Move the stapler unit to the rear side, and then remove the stapler unit [A] ( x 2).
D429
8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Sensors
1.4 SENSORS 1.4.1 MAIN UNIT
1.
D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550
Relay Sensor
Relay sensor [A] (hook, x 1)
Belt Roller Position Sensor 1.
Rear cover ( Rear, Left Rear and Rear Inner Cover)
2.
Front cover ( Front Cover)
3.
Top bracket [A] ( x 6)
SM
9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D429
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Sensors
4.
Belt roller position sensor with the bracket [A] ( x 1)
5.
Belt roller position sensor [B] (hook, x 1)
Stapler Safety Sensor 1.
Stapler unit ( Stapler Unit)
2.
Stapler safety sensor [A] ( x 1, hook)
Stapler Unit HP Sensor 1.
Front cover ( Front Cover)
2.
Bracket with stapler unit HP sensor ( x 1)
3.
Stapler unit HP sensor [A] (hook, x 1)
D429
10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Sensors
1.4.2 INVERTER UNIT Entrance Sensor
Bracket with entrance sensor ( x 1)
2.
Entrance sensor [A] ( x 1, hook) D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550
1.
SM
11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D429
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fan
1.5 FAN 1.5.1 FRONT FAN
1.
Front fan [A] ( x 2, = x 1, x 1)
D429
12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Main Board
1.6 MAIN BOARD Rear cover ( Rear, Left Rear and Rear Inner Cover)
2.
Left rear cover ( Rear, Left Rear and Rear Inner Cover)
3.
Main board ( x 2, clip x 2, x all)
SM
D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550
1.
13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D429
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Punch Unit
1.7 PUNCH UNIT
The punch unit must be removed from the internal finisher for this procedure.
1.7.1 PUNCH SLIDER UNIT
1.
Brackets [A] and ground plate [B] at the right side of the punch unit ( x 1 each)
2.
Brackets [A] at the left side of the punch unit ( x 1 each)
3.
Harness bracket [A] ( x 4)
4.
Wire guide cover [B] ( x 1)
D429
14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Punch Unit
Positioning pins [A] ( x 3, spring)
6.
Punch slider unit [A] ( x all)
D429 Internal Finisher Type C2550
5.
SM
15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D429
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
FAX OPTION TYPE C2550/C2530 D432/D433
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
FAX OPTION TYPE C2550/C2530 D432/D433 TABLE OF CONTENTS 1. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE .......................................................1 1.1 FAX OPTION (D432) INSTALLATION .......................................................... 1 1.1.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................................ 1 1.1.2 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ..................................... 2 1.2 FAX OPTION (D433) INSTALLATION .......................................................... 6 1.2.1 COMPONENT CHECK ........................................................................ 6 1.2.2 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ..................................... 6 1.3 FAX UNIT OPTIONS................................................................................... 10 1.3.1 MEMORY UNIT (G578) (D432 ONLY)............................................... 10 1.3.2 HANDSET (B433) .............................................................................. 10 D037/D041 with the internal finisher...................................................... 13
2. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ..........................................14 2.1 FCU............................................................................................................. 14
3. TROUBLESHOOTING ...................................................................15 3.1 ERROR CODES ......................................................................................... 15 3.2 IFAX TROUBLESHOOTING ....................................................................... 36 3.3 IP-FAX TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................................... 39 3.3.1 IP-FAX TRANSMISSION ................................................................... 39 Cannot send by IP Address/Host Name................................................ 39 Cannot send via VoIP Gateway............................................................. 40 Cannot send by Alias Fax number. ....................................................... 41 3.3.2 IP-FAX RECEPTION ......................................................................... 42 Cannot receive via IP Address/Host Name. .......................................... 42 Cannot receive by VoIP Gateway.......................................................... 43 Cannot receive by Alias Fax number..................................................... 44
4. SERVICE TABLE ...........................................................................46 4.1 BEFOREHAND ........................................................................................... 46
SM
i CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
4.2 SERVICE TABLES...................................................................................... 47 4.2.1 SP1-XXX (BIT SWITCHES) ............................................................... 47 4.2.2 SP2-XXX (RAM DATA) ...................................................................... 48 4.2.3 SP3-XXX (TEL LINE SETTINGS) ...................................................... 48 4.2.4 SP4-XXX (ROM VERSIONS)............................................................. 49 4.2.5 SP5-XXX (INITIALIZING)................................................................... 49 4.2.6 SP6-XXX (REPORTS) ....................................................................... 50 4.2.7 SP7-XXX (TESTS)............................................................................. 52 4.3 BIT SWITCHES........................................................................................... 53 4.3.1 SYSTEM SWITCHES ........................................................................ 53 4.3.2 I-FAX SWITCHES.............................................................................. 66 4.3.3 PRINTER SWITCHES ....................................................................... 72 4.3.4 COMMUNICATION SWITCHES ........................................................ 79 4.3.5 G3 SWITCHES .................................................................................. 87 4.3.6 IP FAX SWITCHES............................................................................ 97 4.4 NCU PARAMETERS................................................................................. 105 4.5 DEDICATED TRANSMISSION PARAMETERS........................................ 121 4.5.1 PROGRAMMING PROCEDURE ..................................................... 121 4.5.2 PARAMETERS ................................................................................ 121 Fax Parameters................................................................................... 121 E-mail Parameters............................................................................... 125 4.6 SERVICE RAM ADDRESSES .................................................................. 129
5. SPECIFICATIONS........................................................................139 5.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS .................................................................. 139 5.1.1 FCU ................................................................................................. 139 5.1.2 CAPABILITIES OF PROGRAMMABLE ITEMS ............................... 140 5.2 IFAX SPECIFICATIONS ........................................................................... 142 5.3 IP-FAX SPECIFICATIONS........................................................................ 144 5.4 FAX UNIT CONFIGURATION................................................................... 145
D432/D433
ii CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Read This First Safety and Symbols Replacement Procedure Safety
Turn off the main power switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the replacement procedures in this manual.
Symbols Used in this Manual This manual uses the following symbols.
: See or Refer to : Screws
: Connector : Clip ring : E-ring =: Clamp
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fax Option (D432) Installation
1. INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1.1 FAX OPTION (D432) INSTALLATION This fax option is only used for D038/D041 models.
1.1.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.
Description
Q’ty
1
FCU
1
2
G3 Decal
1
3
Ferrite Core
1
4
Serial Number Decal
1
5
Fax Keytop
1
6
Data Display Decal Sheet (18 languages: ASIA only)
1
7
Handset Bracket (NA only)
1
8
Telephone Cord (NA only)
1
9
Handset Support Bracket (NA only)
1
10
Screw: M3x6 (NA only)
2
11
Clamp*1 (NA only)
1
12
FCC Decal (NA only)
1
TEL Cap (NA only)
1
-
*1: Item No. 11 is used only when the internal finisher (D429) is installed with NA models. (See "Handset Installation” in the Fax Field Service Manual.)
SM
1 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fax Option (D432) Installation
1.1.2 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Before installation, print out all data in the printer buffer.
Push the operation switch to put the machine in standby mode. Make sure the power LED is off, turn the main switch off, and then disconnect the power cord and the network cable.
The copier must be connected to a properly grounded socket outlet.
1.
For NA models, attach the FCC decal near the serial number plate of the mainframe.
2.
Remove the FCU cover [A] ( x 2).
D432/D433
2 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Fax Option (D432) Installation
3.
Press down the MBU [A].
4.
Make sure that the MBU is seated correctly. If not, SC672 occurs.
Remove the jumper [B] (set to OFF) and set it to ON.
The machine may issue SC819 or SC820 if the jumper is not set to "ON" correctly. (Sometimes these SC codes are not issued.)
5.
Install the FCU [A] ( x 2; removed in step 3).
6.
Write the serial number of the fax unit on the serial number decal, and then attach this decal to the bracket [B] of the fax unit.
7.
SM
Attach the ferrite core to the telephone cord.
3 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fax Option (D432) Installation
A telephone cord with the ferrite core must be used for RF interference suppression.
8.
Connect the telephone cord to the "LINE" jack.
9.
Only for NA models: Install the TEL cap in the "TEL" jack if the handset will not be installed.
10. Remove dummy keytop [A] and replace it with the Fax keytop [B].
11. Attach the Super G3 decal [A]. 12. Plug in the machine and turn on the main power switch.
After you turn the machine on, if you see a message that tells you the SRAM has been formatted due to a problem with SRAM, turn the machine off and on again to clear the message.
13. Enter the "User Tools" mode and set date and time.
D432/D433
4 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Fax Option (D432) Installation 14. Do SP3102 in the fax SP mode and enter the serial number for the fax unit. 15. Enter the correct country code with SP1101-016 (System SW 0F, Country/area code for functional settings). 16. Exit the SP mode, and turn the machine off and on.
SM
5 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fax Option (D433) Installation
1.2 FAX OPTION (D433) INSTALLATION This fax option is only used for D037/D040 models.
1.2.1 COMPONENT CHECK Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.
Description
Q’ty
1
FCU
1
2
G3 Decal
1
3
Serial Number Decal
1
4
Fax Operation Panel
1
-
Fax Operation Decal Sheet
1
1.2.2 FAX OPTION INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
Before installation, print out all data in the printer buffer.
Push the operation switch to put the machine in standby mode. Make sure the power LED is off, turn the main switch off, and then disconnect the power cord and the network cable.
D432/D433
6 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Fax Option (D433) Installation
The copier must be connected to a properly grounded socket outlet.
1.
Remove the FCU cover [A] ( x 2).
2.
Press down the MBU [A].
3.
Make sure that the MBU is seated correctly. If not, SC672 occurs.
Remove the jumper [B] (set to OFF) and set it to ON.
The machine may issue SC819 or SC820 if the jumper is not set to "ON" correctly. (Sometimes these SC codes are not issued.)
SM
7 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fax Option (D433) Installation 4.
Install the FCU [A] ( x 2; removed in step 3).
5.
Write the serial number of the fax unit on the serial number decal, and then attach this decal to the bracket [B] of the fax unit.
6.
Connect the telephone cord to the "LINE" jack.
7.
Only for NA models, install the TEL cap in the "TEL" jack if the handset will not be installed.
8.
Slide the dummy cover [A] to the left side with a flat-head screwdriver, and then remove it (hooks).
9.
Put the fax operation panel [A] on the left edge of the copier's operation panel, and then slide it to the right side.
10. Attach the fax function decal at the location [B]. 11. Attach an appropriate fax operation decal at the location [C].
D432/D433
8 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Fax Option (D433) Installation
12. Attach the Super G3 decal [A]. 13. Plug in the machine and turn on the main power switch.
After you turn the machine on, if you see a message that tells you the SRAM has been formatted due to a problem with SRAM, turn the machine off and on again to clear the message.
14. Enter the "User Tools" mode and set date and time. 15. Do SP3102 in the fax SP mode and enter the serial number for the fax unit. 16. Enter the correct country code with SP1101-016 (System SW 0F, Country/area code for functional settings). 17. Exit the SP mode, and turn the machine off and on.
SM
9 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fax Unit Options
1.3 FAX UNIT OPTIONS 1.3.1 MEMORY UNIT (G578) (D432 ONLY) 1.
Remove the FCU from the machine.
2.
Install the memory option [A] on the FCU.
3.
Reinstall the FCU in the machine.
1.3.2 HANDSET (B433)
1.
The optional handset is available for the U.S. version only.
Remove the screw [A] first, and the rear cover [B] ( x7).
D432/D433
10 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Fax Unit Options
2.
Remove the scanner left cover [C] ( x 2).
3.
Make two holes [D] in the scanner left cover.
4.
Attach the handset support bracket [E] inside the scanner left cover.
SM
11 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Fax Unit Options 5.
Secure the handset bracket [F] ( x 2: M3x6 in the accesories of the FCU option).
6.
Reattach the scanner left cover to the machine.
7.
Remove the label [G] from the handset cradle [H].
8.
Attach the cradle to the handset bracket ( x 2: M3x8).
D432/D433
12 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Fax Unit Options
9.
Set the handset on the handset bracket.
10. Put the ferrite core [I] on the handset core as shown. The length [J] must be 60 mm. 11. Connect the handset cable to the “TEL” jack at the rear of the machine.
D037/D041 with the internal finisher Do steps from 1 to 9 in the “Handset (B433)” installation procedure.
1.
Attach the clamp [A] to the scanner left cover.
2.
Set the telephone cable [B] as shown above.
3.
Put the ferrite core [C] on the handset core as shown. The length [D] must be 60 mm.
4.
Connect the handset cable to the “TEL” jack at the rear of the machine.
SM
13 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
FCU
2. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT 2.1 FCU 1.
When you replace the FCU board, remove the MBU board from the old FCU board and install it on the new FCU board.
2.
Set the correct date and time with the User Tools: User Tools > System Settings > Timer Setting > Set Date/Time.
Do not turn off the battery switch (SW1).
Do SP6101 to print the system parameters, and check the settings.
D432/D433
14 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Error Codes
3. TROUBLESHOOTING 3.1 ERROR CODES If an error code occurs, retry the communication. If the same problem occurs, try to fix the problem as suggested below. Note that some error codes appear only in the error code display and on the service report.
Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
Check the line connection.
The machine at the other end may be incompatible.
DIS/NSF not detected 0-00
within 40 s of Start being
Replace the FCU.
pressed
Check for DIS/NSF with an oscilloscope.
If the rx signal is weak, there may be a bad line.
0-01
The other party is out of paper or has a jammed printer.
DCN received unexpectedly
The other party pressed Stop during communication.
0-03
Incompatible modem at the other end
The other terminal is incompatible.
Check the line connection.
Try changing the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings.
0-04
CFR or FTT not received
Replace the FCU.
The other terminal may be faulty; try sending to another machine.
after modem training
If the rx signal is weak or defective, there may be a bad line.
Cross reference Tx level - NCU Parameter 01 (PSTN)
SM
15 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action Cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) Dedicated Tx parameters in Service Program Mode
Check the line connection.
Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer.
Modem training fails even 0-05
G3 shifts down to 2400
Replace the FCU.
bps.
Check for line problems.
Cross reference See error code 0-04.
Check the line connection.
Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings.
0-06
The other terminal did not reply to DCS
Replace the FCU.
The other end may be defective or incompatible; try sending to another machine.
Check for line problems.
Cross reference See error code 0-04.
Check the line connection.
Replace the FCU.
The other end may have jammed or run out of paper.
No post-message 0-07
response from the other
The other end user may have disconnected the call.
end after a page was sent
Check for a bad line.
The other end may be defective; try sending to another machine.
0-08
The other end sent RTN or
Check the line connection.
PIN after receiving a page,
Replace the FCU.
because there were too
The other end may have jammed, or run out of
many errors
D432/D433
paper or memory space.
16 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings.
The other end may have a defective modem/FCU; try sending to another machine.
Check for line problems and noise.
Cross reference
Tx level - NCU Parameter 01 (PSTN)
Cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN)
Dedicated Tx parameters in Service Program Mode
Incompatible or defective remote terminal; try sending to another machine.
Non-standard post 0-14
message response code
Noisy line: resend.
Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings.
received
Replace the FCU.
Cross reference See error code 0-08. The other terminal is not capable of accepting the following functions, or the other terminal’s memory
The other terminal is not 0-15
is full.
capable of specific functions.
CFR or FTT not detected 0-16
Confidential rx
Transfer function
SEP/SUB/PWD/SID
Check the line connection.
Replace the FCU.
Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings.
after modem training in confidential or transfer
The other end may have disconnected, or it may be defective; try calling another machine.
mode
If the rx signal level is too low, there may be a line problem.
SM
17 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action Cross reference See error code 0-08.
0-20
Check the line connection.
Replace the FCU.
Check for line problems.
Facsimile data not
Try calling another fax machine.
received within 6 s of
Try adjusting the reconstruction time for the first line and/or rx cable equalizer setting.
retraining
Cross reference Reconstruction time - G3 Switch 0A, bit 6 Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN)
Check the connections between the FCU and line.
EOL signal (end-of-line) 0-21
from the other end not received within 5 s of the previous EOL signal
Check for line noise or other line problems.
Replace the FCU.
The remote machine may be defective or may have disconnected.
Cross reference Maximum interval between EOLs and between ECM frames - G3 Bit Switch 0A, bit 4
0-22
Check the line connection.
Replace the FCU.
The signal from the other
Defective remote terminal.
end was interrupted for
Check for line noise or other line problems.
more than the acceptable
Try adjusting the acceptable modem carrier drop time.
modem carrier drop time (default: 200 ms)
Cross reference Acceptable modem carrier drop time - G3 Switch 0A, bits 0 and 1
0-23
Too many errors during reception
D432/D433
Check the line connection.
Replace the FCU.
Defective remote terminal
18 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
Check for line noise or other line problems.
Try asking the other end to adjust their tx level.
Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer setting and/or rx error criteria.
Cross reference Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) Rx error criteria - Communication Switch 02, bits 0 and 1
The other terminal did not 0-30
reply to NSS(A) in AI short protocol mode
Check the line connection.
Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings.
The other terminal may not be compatible.
Cross reference Dedicated tx parameters - Section 4
The other terminal sent a 0-32
DCS, which contained functions that the receiving
Check the protocol dump list.
Ask the other party to contact the manufacturer.
machine cannot handle.
0-33
The data reception (not
Check the line connection.
ECM) is not completed
The other terminal may have a defective modem/FCU.
within 10 minutes. 0-52
0-55
Polarity changed during
communication
Check the line connection. Retry communication.
FCU does not detect the
FCU firmware or board defective.
SG3.
SG3 firmware or board defective.
exceeds the capacity of the
SG3 firmware or board defective.
The stored message data 0-56
mailbox in the SG3. 0-70
SM
The communication mode specified in CM/JM was
The other terminal did not have a compatible communication mode (e.g., the other terminal
19 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
not available
was a V.34 data modem and not a fax
(V.8 calling and called
modem.)
terminal)
A polling tx file was not ready at the other terminal when polling rx was initiated from the calling terminal.
The calling terminal fell 0-74
The calling terminal could not detect ANSam due to noise, etc.
back to T.30 mode, because it could not detect ANSam after sending CI.
ANSam was too short to detect.
Check the line connection and condition.
Try making a call to another V.8/V.34 fax.
The terminal could not detect ANSam.
The called terminal fell back to T.30 mode, 0-75
because it could not detect
Check the line connection and condition.
a CM in response to
Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34 fax.
The called terminal could not detect a CM due
ANSam (ANSam timeout). The calling terminal fell back to T.30 mode, 0-76
because it could not detect a JM in response to CM (CM timeout). The called terminal fell because it could not detect a CJ in response to JM
Check the line connection and condition.
Try making a call to another V.8/V.34 fax.
The calling terminal could not detect a JM due
A network that has narrow bandwidth cannot pass JM to the other end.
Check the line connection and condition.
Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34 fax.
The called terminal
Check for line noise or other line problems.
detected CI while waiting
If this error occurs, the called terminal falls
(JM timeout).
0-79
to noise, etc.
back to T.30 mode, 0-77
to noise, etc.
for a V.21 signal.
D432/D433
back to T.30 mode.
20 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
The line was disconnected 0-80
due to a timeout in V.34
phases. Serious noise, narrow bandwidth, or
phase 2 – line probing.
0-81
low signal level can cause these errors.
The line was disconnected
If these errors happen at the transmitting terminal:
due to a timeout in V.34
Try making a call at a later time.
phase 3 – equalizer
Try using V.17 or a slower modem using
training.
dedicated tx parameters.
The line was disconnected 0-82
due to a timeout in the V.34 phase 4 – control channel start-up. The line was disconnected
0-83
The guard timer expired while starting these
Try increasing the tx level.
Try adjusting the tx cable equalizer setting.
If these errors happen at the receiving terminal:
Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer setting.
Try increasing the tx level.
Try using V.17 or a slower modem if the same
due to a timeout in the V.34
error is frequent when receiving from multiple
control channel restart
senders.
sequence. The line was disconnected 0-84
due to abnormal signaling in V.34 phase 4 – control channel start-up. The line was disconnected
0-85
due to abnormal signaling in V.34 control channel restart.
The signal did not stop within 10 s.
Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.
If the same error is frequent, replace the FCU.
The signal did not stop within 10 s.
Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.
If the same error is frequent, replace the FCU.
The other terminal was incompatible.
Ask the other party to contact the
The line was disconnected because the other terminal 0-86
requested a data rate using MPh that was not
manufacturer.
available in the currently selected symbol rate. 0-87
SM
The control channel started
The receiving terminal restarted the control
21 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
after an unsuccessful
channel because data reception in the primary
primary channel.
channel was not successful.
This does not result in an error communication.
The line was disconnected because PPR was 0-88
Try using a lower data rate at the start.
Try adjusting the cable equalizer setting.
Replace the FCU.
Replace the FCU.
Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.
Update the modem ROM.
Replace the FCU.
Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.
Turn off the machine, then turn it back on.
JBIG data error
Check the sender’s JBIG function.
Update the MBU ROM.
JBIG trailing edge maker
FCU defective
error
Check the destination device.
transmitted/received 9 (default) times within the same ECM frame.
2-11 2-12
2-13
2-23 2-24 2-25
2-26
2-27
2-28
2-29
Only one V.21 connection flag was received Modem clock irregularity
Modem initialization error
JBIG compression or reconstruction error JBIG ASIC error JBIG data reconstruction error (BIH error) JBIG data reconstruction error (Float marker error) JBIG data reconstruction error (End marker error) JBIG data reconstruction error (Timeout)
D432/D433
22 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
The machine resets itself 2-50
for a fatal FCU system
the FCU.
error The machine resets itself 2-51
If this is frequent, update the ROM, or replace
because of a fatal
If this is frequent, update the ROM, or replace the FCU.
communication error Snd msg() in the manual 2-53
task is an error because
The user did the same operation many times, and this gave too much load to the machine.
the mailbox for the operation task is full.
4-01
Line current was cut
Check the line connector.
Check for line problems.
Replace the FCU.
Get the ID Codes the same and/or the CSIs
Communication failed because of an ID Code mismatch (Closed 4-10
programmed correctly, then resend.
Network) or Tel. No./CSI
mismatch (Protection
The machine at the other end may be defective.
against Wrong Connections) 5-10
DCR timer expired
Replace the FCU.
because of a lack of
Temporary memory shortage.
memory
Test the SAF memory.
Test the SAF memory.
Ask the other end to resend the message.
Replace an SD card or HDD.
Storage impossible 5-20
5-21
Memory overflow Print data error when
5-23
printing a substitute rx or confidential rx message
5-25
SM
SAF file access error
23 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
Replace the FCU.
Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer.
Replace the FCU.
Check the line connection.
Check for a bad line or defective remote
G3 ECM - T1 time out 6-00
during reception of facsimile data
6-01
6-02
6-04
G3 ECM - no V.21 signal was received G3 ECM - EOR was received
G3 ECM - RTC not
terminal.
detected
G3 ECM - facsimile data 6-05
frame not received within 18 s of CFR, but there was no line fail
Replace the FCU.
Check the line connection.
Check for a bad line or defective remote terminal.
Replace the FCU.
Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer
Cross reference
6-06
6-08
G3 ECM - coding/decoding
Defective FCU.
error
The other terminal may be defective.
G3 ECM - PIP/PIN
The other end pressed Stop during communication.
received in reply to PPS.NULL
6-09
G3 ECM - ERR received
The other terminal may be defective.
Check for a noisy line.
Adjust the tx levels of the communicating machines.
6-10
Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN)
G3 ECM - error frames still
D432/D433
See code 6-05. Check for line noise.
24 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
received at the other end
the dedicated tx parameter for that address).
after all communication attempts at 2400 bps
V.21 flag detected during 6-21
high speed modem
Check the line connection.
Defective remote terminal.
The other terminal may be defective or incompatible.
communication
6-22
The machine resets the
Check for line noise.
sequence because of an
If the same error occurs frequently, replace the
13-17
V.21 signal not stopped within 6 s SIP user name registration error
13-18
SIP server access error
13-24
SIP authentication error
13-25
Network I/F setting error
13-26
13-27
14-00
FCU.
abnormal handshake in the V.34 control channel
6-99
Adjust the tx level (use NCU parameter 01 or
IP address setting error
SMTP Send Error
Defective remote terminal.
Replace the FCU.
Double registration of the SIP user name.
Capacity for user-name registration in the SIP server is not sufficient.
Incorrect initial setting for the SIP server.
Defective SIP server.
Registered password in the device does not match the password in the SIP server.
Network I/F setting error at power on
IPV4 is not active in the active protocol setting.
IP address of the device is not registered.
Active protocol setting does not match the I/F setting for SIP server.
IP address of the device is not registered.
IP address of the device is not registered.
Error occurred during sending to the SMTP server. Occurs for any error other than 14-01 to 16. For example, the mail address of the
SM
25 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action system administrator is not registered.
Failed to connect to the SMTP server (timeout) because the server could not be found.
14-01
SMTP Connection Failed
The PC is not ready to transfer files.
SMTP server not functioning correctly.
The DNS IP address is not registered.
Network not operating correctly.
Destination folder selection not correct.
SMTP server operating incorrectly, or the destination for direct SMTP sending is not correct.
14-02
No Service by SMTP
Contact the system administrator and check that the SMTP server has the correct settings
Service (421)
and operates correctly.
Contact the system administrator for direct SMTP sending and check the sending destination.
Failed to access the SMTP server because the access is denied.
SMTP server operating incorrectly. Contact the system administrator to determine if there is a problem with the SMTP server and to check that the SMTP server settings are
14-03
Access to SMTP Server Denied (450)
correct.
Folder send destination is incorrect. Contact the system administrator to determine that the SMTP server settings and path to the server are correct.
Device settings incorrect. Confirm that the user name and password settings are correct.
Direct SMTP destination incorrect. Contact the system administrator to determine if there is a
D432/D433
26 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action problem at the destination at that the settings at the destination are correct.
14-04
Access to SMTP Server
SMTP server operating incorrectly
Denied (550)
Direct SMTP sending not operating correctly
Failed to access the SMTP server because the HDD on the server is full.
Insufficient free space on the HDD of the SMTP server. Contact the system administrator and check the amount of space remaining on the SMTP server HDD.
14-05
Insufficient free space on the HDD where the
SMTP Server HDD Full
destination folder is located. Contact the
(452)
system administrator and check the amount of space remaining on the HDD where the target folder is located.
Insufficient free space on the HDD at the target destination for SMTP direct sending. Contact the system administrator and check the amount of space remaining on the target HDD.
14-06
User Not Found on SMTP Server (551)
The designated user does not exist.
The designated user does not exist on the SMTP server.
The designated address is not for use with direct SMTP sending.
Failed to access the SMTP server because the transmission failed.
14-07
SM
Data Send to SMTP Server Failed (4XX)
PC not operating correctly.
SMTP server operating incorrectly
Network not operating correctly.
Destination folder setting incorrect.
Direct SMTP sending not operating correctly.
27 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
Failed to access the SMTP server because the transmission failed.
14-08
14-09
14-10
Data Send to SMTP Server
SMTP server operating incorrectly
Failed (5XX)
Destination folder setting incorrect.
Direct SMTP sending not operating correctly.
Software application error.
POP-Before-SMTP or SMTP authorization
Authorization Failed for Sending to SMTP Server
Addresses Exceeded
failed.
Incorrect setting for file transfer
Number of broadcast addresses exceeded the limit for the SMTP server.
14-11
The send buffer is full so the transmission could not be completed. Buffer is full due to
Buffer Full
using Scan-to-Email while the buffer is being used send mail at the same time.
14-12
Data Size Too Large
14-13
Send Cancelled
14-14
Security Locked File Error
detected size of the file was too large.
Processing is interrupted because the user pressed Stop.
Update the software because of the defective software.
14-15
Transmission was cancelled because the
The transmitting a mail is interrupted via DCS due to the incorrect data.
Mail Data Error
Update the software because of the defective software.
14-16
transmission and the division number of a mail
Maximum Division Number
are more than the specified number, the mail
Error
transmission is interrupted.
D432/D433
When a mail is divided for the mail
Update the software because of the defective
28 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action software.
14-17
Incorrect Ticket
software.
14-18
Update the software because of the defective
Access to MCS File Error
The access to MCS file is denied due to the no permission of access.
Update the software because of the defective software.
Failed to create the MCS file because: 14-30
The number of files created with other applications on the Document Server has
MCS File Creation Failed
exceeded the limit.
HDD is full or not operating correctly.
Software error.
UFS file could not be created: 14-31
14-32
14-33
Scan-to-Email and IFAX transmission.
UFS File Creation Failed
Cancelled the Mail Due to
HDD full or not operating correctly.
Software error.
Error detected with NFAX and send was
Error Detected by NFAX
cancelled due to a software error.
No Mail Address For the
is registered.
domain for SMTP sending
SM
Check the address selected in the address book for SMTP sending.
does not exist
Mail Job Task Error
Operational error in normal mail sending or direct SMTP sending.
Address designated in the
14-50
Neither the mail address of the machine nor the mail address of the network administrator
Machine
14-34
Not enough space in UFS area to handle both
Check the domain selection.
Due to an FCU mail job task error, the send was cancelled:
29 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
Address book was being edited during creation of the notification mail.
Software error.
Not even one return notification can be downloaded: 14-51
UCS Destination
The address book was being edited.
Download Error
The number for the specified destination does not exist (it was deleted or edited after the job was created).
14-60
14-61
Send Cancel Failed
cancel the send operation.
Notification Mail Send Failed for All Destinations Transmission Error due to
14-62
15-01
15-02
15-03 15-10
The cancel operation by the user failed to
All addresses for return notification mail failed.
When the 0 line page exists in received pages
the existence of zero line
with G3 communication, the transmission is
page
interrupted.
POP3/IMAP4 Server Not
At startup, the system detected that the IP address of the POP3/IMAP4 server has not
Registered
been registered in the machine.
POP3/IMAP4 Mail Account
The POP3/IMAP4 mail account has not been
Information Not Registered
registered.
Mail Address Not Registered DCS Mail Receive Error
The mail address has not been registered.
Error other than 15-11 to 15-18.
The DNS or POP3/IMAP4 server could not be found: 15-11
Connection Error
The IP address for DNS or POP3/IMAP4 server is not stored in the machine.
D432/D433
The DNS IP address is not registered.
30 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
Network not operating correctly.
POP3/IMAP4 send authorization failed: 15-12
Authorization Error
Incorrect IFAX user name or password.
Access was attempted by another device, such as the PC.
15-13
POP3/IMAP4 settings incorrect.
Occurs only during manual reception. Transmission cannot be received due to
Receive Buffer Full
insufficient buffer space. The buffer is being used for mail send or Scan-to-Email.
15-14
Mail Header Format Error
example, the Date line description is incorrect.
15-15
The mail header is not standard format. For
Mail Divide Error
The e-mail is not in standard format. There is no boundary between parts of the e-mail, including the header.
15-16
Mail Size Receive Error
15-17
Receive Timeout
15-18
Incomplete Mail Received
large.
May occur during manual receiving only because the network is not operating correctly.
Final Destination for 15-31
The mail cannot be received because it is too
Transfer Request
Only one portion of the mail was received.
The format of the final destination for the transfer request was incorrect.
Reception Format Error
The transmission cannot be delivered to the final 15-39
Send/Delivery Destination Error
destination:
Destination file format is incorrect.
Could not create the destination for the file transmission.
15-41
SM
SMTP Receive Error
Reception rejected because the transaction
31 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action exceeded the limit for the “Auth. E-mail RX” setting.
15-42
Off Ramp Gateway Error
15-43
Address Format Error
15-44
Addresses Over
15-61
The delivery destination address was specified with Off Ramp Gateway OFF.
Format error in the address of the Off Ramp Gateway.
The number of addresses for the Off Ramp Gateway exceeded the limit of 30.
Attachment File Format
Error
The attached file is not TIFF format.
Could not receive transmission due to:
Resolution error
Image of resolution greater than 200 dpi without extended memory.
15-62
TIFF File Compatibility
Resolution is not supported.
Error
Page size error
The page size was larger than A3.
Compression error
File was compressed with other than MH, MR, or MMR.
The TIFF file sent as the attachment could not be received because the TIFF header is incorrect: 15-63
TIFF Parameter Error
The TIFF file attachment is a type not supported.
The TIFF file attachment is corrupted.
Software error.
The file received as an attachment caused the 15-64
TIFF Decompression Error
TIFF decompression error:
The TIFF format of the attachment is corrupted.
D432/D433
32 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Error Codes Code
15-71
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
Not Binary Image Data
Software error.
The file could not be received because the attachment was not binary image data.
15-73
MDN Status Error
Could not find the Disposition line in the header of the Return Receipt, or there is a problem with the firmware.
15-74
MDN Message ID Error
Could not find the Original Message ID line in the header of the Return Receipt, or there is a problem with the firmware.
Could not receive the transmission because the destination buffer is full and the destination
15-80
could not be created (this error may occur
Mail Job Task Read Error
when receiving a transfer request or a request for notification of reception). 15-81
Could not repeat receive the transmission because the destination buffer is full and the
Repeated Destination
destination could not be created (this error
Registration Error
may occur when receiving a transfer request or a request for notification of reception). Could not receive the file for transfer to the final destination:
15-91
Send Registration Error
The format of the final destination or the transfer destination is incorrect.
Destinations are full so the final and transfer destinations could not be created.
15-92
Memory Overflow
15-93
Memory Access Error
SM
Transmission could not be received because memory overflowed during the transaction.
Transaction could not complete due to a malfunction of SAF memory.
33 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
15-94
The machine rejected an incoming e-mail for transfer request, because the ID code in the
Incorrect ID Code
incoming e-mail did not match the ID code registered in the machine.
15-95
Transfer Station Function
The machine rejected an incoming e-mail for transfer because the transfer function was unavailable.
22-00
22-01
Original length exceeded
Divide the original into more than one page.
Check the resolution used for scanning. Lower the scan resolution if possible.
the maximum scan length
Memory overflow while
Add optional page memory.
Wait for the files in the queue to be sent.
Delete unnecessary files from memory.
Transfer the substitute reception files to an another fax machine, if the machine’s printer is
receiving
busy or out of order.
Add an optional SAF memory card or hard disk.
Tx or rx job stalled due to 22-02
22-05
23-00
25-00
The job started normally but did not finish normally; data may or may not have been
line disconnection at the
received fully.
other end
22-04
Restart the machine.
The machine cannot store
Update the ROM
received data in the SAF
Replace the FCU.
Defective FCU board or firmware.
Data read timeout during
Restart the machine.
construction
Replace the FCU.
The machine software
Update the ROM
resets itself after a fatal
Replace the FCU.
No G3 parameter confirmation answer
D432/D433
34 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Error Codes Code
Meaning
Suggested Cause/Action
transmission error occurred F0-xx
F6-xx
SM
V.34 modem error
SG3 modem error
Replace the FCU.
Update the SG3 modem ROM.
Replace the SG3 board.
Check for line noise or other line problems.
Try communicating another V.8/V.34 fax.
35 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
IFAX Troubleshooting
3.2 IFAX TROUBLESHOOTING Use the following procedures to determine whether the machine or another part of the network is causing the problem. Communication Route
Item
Action [Remarks]
1. Connection with General LAN
the LAN
the machine.
2. LAN activity
on the PC
Check that the LEDs on the hub are lit.
Check that other devices connected to the LAN can communicate through the LAN.
1. Network settings
Check that the LAN cable is connected to
Check the network settings on the PC.
[Is the IP address registered in the TCP/IP properties in the network setup correct? Check the IP address with the administrator of the network.]
2. Check that PC Between IFAX and
can connect with
PC
the machine
Use the “ping” command on the PC to contact the machine.
[At the MS-DOS prompt, type ping then the IP address of the machine, then press Enter.]
Check the LAN parameters
Check if there is an IP address conflict with other PCs.
3. LAN settings in
[Use the “Network” function in the User Tools.
the machine
If there is an IP address conflict, inform the administrator.]
Between machine
1. LAN settings in
and e-mail server
the machine
Check the LAN parameters
Check if there is an IP address conflict with other PCs.
[Use the “Network” function in the User Tools. If there is an IP address conflict, inform the administrator.]
D432/D433
36 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
IFAX Troubleshooting
Communication Route
Item
Action [Remarks]
Make sure that the machine can log into the e-mail server.
2. E-mail account
Check that the account and password stored in the server are the same as in
on the server
the machine. [Ask the administrator to check.]
Make sure that the client devices which have an account in the server can send/receive e-mail.
3. E-mail server
[Ask the administrator to check. Send a test e-mail with the machine’s own number as the destination. The machine receives the returned e-mail if the communication is performed successfully.]
Make sure that the PC can log into the e-mail server.
1. E-mail account
Check that the account and password stored in the server are the same as in
on the Server
the machine. [Ask the administrator to check.] Between e-mail
server and internet
Make sure that the client devices which have an account in the server can send/receive e-mail.
2. E-mail server
[Ask the administrator to check. Send a test e-mail with the machine’s own number as the destination. The machine receives the returned e-mail if the communication is performed successfully.]
SM
37 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
IFAX Troubleshooting Communication Route
Item
Action [Remarks]
actually used.
3. Destination e-mail address
Make sure that the e-mail address is
Check that the e-mail address contains no incorrect characters such as spaces.
Use the “ping” command to contact the router.
4. Router settings
Check that other devices connected to the router can sent data over the router.
[Ask the administrator of the server to check.] 5. Error message by
another address on the same network,
e-mail from the network of the destination.
D432/D433
Check whether e-mail can be sent to using the application e-mail software.
Check the error e-mail message.
[Inform the administrator of the LAN.]
38 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
IP-Fax Troubleshooting
3.3 IP-FAX TROUBLESHOOTING 3.3.1 IP-FAX TRANSMISSION Cannot send by IP Address/Host Name
Check Point
Action
1
LAN cable connected?
Check the LAN cable connection.
2
Specified IP address/host name correct?
Check the IP address/host name. Cannot breach the firewall. Send by
3
Firewall/NAT is installed?
using another method (Fax, Internet Fax)
4
Transmission sent manually?
Manual sending not supported.
5
IP address of local machine registered?
Register the IP address.
6
7
8
9
Remote terminal port number setting other than 1720?
Send by specifying the port number. Confirm the port number of the remote
Specified port number correct?
fax.
DNS server registered when host name specified?
Contact the network administrator. Check whether the remote fax is a T38
Remote fax a T.38 terminal?
terminal. Check that the remote fax is switched
10 Remote fax switched off or busy?
on. Request the network administrator to
11 Network bandwidth too narrow?
increase the bandwidth. Raise the delay level. IPFAX SW 01 Bit 0 to 3
SM
39 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
IP-Fax Troubleshooting IP-Fax bandwidth is the same as the DCS speed. Set IP-Fax SW00 Bit 6 to 1. Check whether the remote fax
12 Remote fax cancelled transmission?
cancelled the transmission.
Cannot send via VoIP Gateway
Check Point
Action
1
LAN cable connected?
Check the LAN cable connection.
2
VoIP Gateway T.38 standard?
Contact the network administrator.
3
VoIP Gateway installed correctly?
Contact the network administrator.
4
VoIP Gateway power switched on?
Contact the network administrator.
5 6
Is the IP address/host name of the
Check the IP address/host name.
specified Gateway correct? Number of the specified fax correct?
Check the remote fax number. Cannot breach the firewall. Send by
7
Firewall/NAT is installed?
using another method (Fax, Internet Fax)
8
Transmission sent manually?
Manual sending not supported.
9
IP address of local fax registered?
Register the IP address.
10
DNS registered when host name
Contact the network administrator.
specified?
11 Remote fax a G3 fax?
Check that the remote fax is a G3 fax.
12 G3 fax is connected to VoIP gateway?
Check that G3 fax is connected.
13 Remote G3 fax turned on?
Check that G3 fax is switched on.
D432/D433
40 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
IP-Fax Troubleshooting Request the network administrator to increase the bandwidth. Raise the network delay level. 14 Network bandwidth too narrow?
IPFAX SW 01 Bit 0 to 3 IP-Fax bandwidth is the same as the DCS speed. Set IP-Fax SW00 Bit 6 to 1.
Cannot send by Alias Fax number.
Check Point
Action
1
LAN cable connected?
Check the LAN cable connection.
2
Number of specified Alias fax correct?
Confirm the Alias of the remote fax. Error Code: 13-14 Cannot breach the firewall. Send by
3
Firewall/NAT installed?
using another method (Fax, Internet Fax)
4
Transmission sent manually?
Manual sending not supported.
5
Gatekeeper installed correctly?
Contact the network administrator.
6
Gatekeeper power switched on?
Contact the network administrator.
7
8
9
IP address/host name of Gatekeeper
Check the IP address/host name.
correct? DNS server registered when Gatekeeper host name specified?
Contact the network administrator. Check the settings.
Enable H.323 SW is set to on?
See User Parameter SW 34 Bit 0
10 IP address of local fax registered?
Register the IP address of the local fax.
11 Alias number of local fax registered?
Register the Alias number of the local
SM
41 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
IP-Fax Troubleshooting fax. 12 Remote fax registered in Gatekeeper?
Contact the network administrator. Check whether the remote fax is a T38
13 Remote fax a T.38 terminal?
terminal.
14 Remote fax switched off or busy?
Contact the network administrator. Request the system administrator to increase the bandwidth. Raise the delay level.
15 Network bandwidth too narrow?
IPFAX SW 01 Bit 0 to 3 Lower the modem transmission baud rate. IPFAX SW 05 Check whether the remote fax
16 Remote fax cancelled transmission?
cancelled the transmission.
3.3.2 IP-FAX RECEPTION Cannot receive via IP Address/Host Name.
Check Point
Action
1
LAN cable connected?
2
Firewall/NAT is installed?
3
IP address of local fax registered?
4
5
Check the LAN cable connection. Cannot breach the firewall. Send by using another method (Fax, Internet Fax) Register the IP address.
Port number specified at remote sender Request the sender to specify the port fax (if required)?
number.
Specified port number correct (if
Request the sender to check the port
required)?
number.
D432/D433
42 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
IP-Fax Troubleshooting Contact the network administrator. 6
DNS server registered when host name specified on sender side?
The sender machine displays this error code if the sender fax is a Ricoh model.
Request the system administrator to increase the bandwidth. 7
Network bandwidth too narrow?
Lower the start modem reception baud rate on the receiving side. IPFAX SW06
8
Check whether the remote fax cancelled
Remote fax cancelled transmission?
the transmission.
Cannot receive by VoIP Gateway.
Check Point 1
Action
LAN cable connected?
Check the LAN cable connection. Cannot breach the firewall. Request the
2
Firewall/NAT is installed?
remote fax to send by using another method (Fax, Internet Fax)
3
VoIP Gateway installed correctly?
Contact the network administrator.
4
VoIP Gateway power switched on?
Contact the network administrator.
5
6
IP address/host name of specified VoIP Request the remote fax to check the IP Gateway correct on sender’s side? DNS server registered when host name specified on sender side?
7
Network bandwidth too narrow?
8
G3 fax connected?
SM
address/host name. Contact the network administrator. Request the network administrator to increase the bandwidth. Check that G3 fax is connected.
43 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
IP-Fax Troubleshooting 9
G3 fax power switched on?
Check that G3 fax is switched on.
Cannot receive by Alias Fax number.
Check Point 1
Action
LAN cable connected?
Check the LAN cable connection. Cannot the breach firewall. Request the
2
Firewall/NAT is installed?
remote fax to send by using another method (Fax, Internet Fax) Contact the network administrator.
3
Gatekeeper installed correctly?
The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model.
Contact the network administrator. 4
Power to Gatekeeper switched on?
The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model.
Request the sender to check the IP address/host name. 5
IP address/host name of Gatekeeper correct on the sender’s side?
The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model.
Contact the network administrator. DNS server registered when 6
Gatekeeper host name specified on
sender’s side?
The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model.
7
Enable H.323 SW is set to on?
D432/D433
Request the sender to check the settings.
44 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
IP-Fax Troubleshooting User Parameter SW 34 Bit 0
Only if the remote sender fax is a Ricoh fax.
8
Local fax IP address registered?
Register the IP address.
9
Local fax Alias number registered?
Register the Alias number. Request the system administrator to increase the bandwidth.
10 Network bandwidth too narrow?
Lower the start modem reception baud rate on the receiving side. IPFAX SW06
11 Remote fax cancelled transmission?
Check whether the remote fax cancelled the transmission. Contact the network administrator.
12 Local fax registered in Gatekeeper?
The sender machine displays this error code when the sender fax is a Ricoh model.
SM
45 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Beforehand
4. SERVICE TABLE 4.1 BEFOREHAND
Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation power switch to switch the power off, wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off.
The main power LED (C) lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while the main machine is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the machine is accessing the hard disk or memory for reading or writing data.
D432/D433
46 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Service Tables
4.2 SERVICE TABLES 4.2.1 SP1-XXX (BIT SWITCHES)
Bit Switches 1
Mode No.
Function
System Switch Change the bit switches for system settings for the
101 001 – 032
00 – 1F
fax option
"Bit Switches"
Ifax Switch Change the bit switches for internet fax settings for
102 001 – 016
00 – 0F
the fax option
"Bit Switches"
Printer Switch Change the bit switches for printer settings for the fax
103 001 – 016
00 – 0F
option
"Bit Switches"
Communication Switch Change the bit switches for communication settings
104 001 – 032
00 – 1F
for the fax option
"Bit Switches"
G3-1 Switch Change the bit switches for the protocol settings of
105 001 – 016
00 – 0F
the standard G3 board
"Bit Switches"
IP fax Switch Change the bit switches for optional IP fax
111 001 – 016
00 – 0F
parameters
"Bit Switches"
SM
47 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service Tables
4.2.2 SP2-XXX (RAM DATA)
2
Mode No.
Function
RAM Read/Write 101
Change RAM data for the fax board directly.
001
"Service RAM Addresses"
Memory Dump 102 001
G3-1 Memory
Print out RAM data for the fax board.
Dump
"Service RAM Addresses"
G3-1 NCU Parameters 103 001 – 023
NCU parameter settings for the standard G3
CC, 01 – 22
board. "NCU Parameters"
4.2.3 SP3-XXX (TEL LINE SETTINGS)
3
101
Mode No. Service Station 001
102
Function
Fax Number
Serial Number 000
103
Enter the fax number of the service station.
Enter the fax unit’s serial number.
PSTN-1 Port Settings Select the line type setting for the G3-1 line. If 001
Select Line
the machine is installed on a PABX line, select “PABX”, “PABX(GND)” or “PABX(FLASH)”.
002
D432/D433
PSTN Access
Enter the PSTN access number for the
Number
G3-1 line.
48 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Service Tables 003
Memory Lock Disabled
Not used
IPFAX Port Settings
107
001
H323 Port
Sets the H323 port number.
002
SIP Port
Sets the SIP port number.
003
RAS Port
Sets the RAS port number.
004
Gatekeeper port
Sets the Gatekeeper port number.
005
T.38 Port
Sets the T.38 port number.
006
SIP Server Port
Sets the SIP port number.
007
201
IPFAX Protocol Priority
Select "H323" or "SIP".
FAX SW 001 – 032
00 – 1F
4.2.4 SP4-XXX (ROM VERSIONS)
4
Mode No.
Function
101
001
FCU ROM Version
Displays the FCU ROM version.
102
001
Error Codes
Displays the latest 64 fax error codes.
103
001
G3-1 ROM Version
Displays the G3-1 modem version.
4.2.5 SP5-XXX (INITIALIZING)
5 101
SM
Mode No.
Function
Initialize SRAM (except Secure)
49 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service Tables Initializes the bit switches and user parameters, user data in
000
102
the SRAM, files in the SAF memory, and clock.
Erase All Files 000
103
Erases all files stored in the SAF memory.
Reset Bit Switches (except Secure) 000
Resets the bit switches and user parameters.
Factory setting 104
Resets the bit switches and user parameters, user data in the
000
105
SRAM and files in the SAF memory.
Initialize All Bit Switches 000
Initializes all the current bit switch settings.
Initialize Security Bit Switches Initializes only the security bit switches. If you select
106 000
automatic output/display for the user parameter switches, the security settings are initialized.
4.2.6 SP6-XXX (REPORTS)
6
Mode No.
Function
System Parameter List 101 000
-
Touch the “ON” button to print the system parameter list.
Service Monitor Report 102 000 103
-
Touch the “ON” button to print the service monitor report.
G3 Protocol Dump List
D432/D433
50 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Service Tables 001
002
003
G3 All
Prints the protocol dump list of all
Communications
communications for all G3 lines.
G3-1 (All
Prints the protocol dump list of all
Communications)
communications for the G3-1 line.
G3-1
Prints the protocol dump list of the last
(1 Communication)
communication for the G3-1 line.
All Files print out Prints out all the user files in the SAF memory, including confidential messages. 105 000
-
Do not use this function, unless the customer is having trouble printing confidential messages or recovering files stored using the memory lock feature.
Journal Print out
106
107
SM
001
All Journals
002
Specified Date
The machine prints all the communication records on the report. The machine prints all communication records after the specified date.
Log List Print out These log print out functions are for designer
001
All log files
002
Printer
003
SC/TRAP Stored
004
Decompression
005
Scanner
006
JOB/SAF
007
Reconstruction
use only.
51 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service Tables 008
JBIG
009
Fax Driver
010
G3CCU
011
Fax Job
012
CCU
013
Scanner Condition
IP Protocol Dump List
108
001
All Communications
002
1 Communication
Prints the protocol dump list of all communications for the IP fax line. Prints the protocol dump list of the last communication for the IP fax line.
4.2.7 SP7-XXX (TESTS) These are the test modes for PTT approval.
7
Function
101
G3-1 Modem Tests
102
G3-1 DTMF Tests
103
Ringer Test
104
G3-1 V34 (S2400baud)
105
G3-1 V34 (S2800baud)
106
G3-1 V34 (S3000baud)
107
G3-1 V34 (S3200baud)
108
G3-1 V34 (S3429baud)
109
Recorded Message Test
D432/D433
52 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches
4.3 BIT SWITCHES
Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as “Not used”, as this may cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan.
Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List printed by the machine.
4.3.1 SYSTEM SWITCHES
System Switch 00 [SP No. 1-101-001] No
FUNCTION Dedicated transmission
0
parameter programming 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
1
SM
Not used
COMMENTS Set this bit to 1 before changing any dedicated transmission parameters. Reset this bit to 0 after programming dedicated transmission parameters. Do not change
53 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches
System Switch 00 [SP No. 1-101-001] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Technical data printout on the Journal
1: Instead of the personal name, the following data are listed on the Journal for each G3
0: Disabled
communication.
1: Enabled
e.g. 0000 (1) // 32 (2) V34 (3) // 288 (4) // 264 (5) // L0100 (6) 03 (7) 04 (8) (1): EQM value (Line quality data). A larger number means more errors. (2): Symbol rate (V.34 only) (3): Final modem type used (4): Starting data rate (for example, 288 means 28.8 kbps) (5): Final data rate (6): Rx revel (refer to the note after this table for how to read the rx level) 2
(7): Total number of error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception. (8): Total number of burst error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception.
EQM and rx level are fixed at “FFFF” in tx mode.
The seventh and eighth numbers are fixed at “00” for transmission records and ECM reception records.
Rx level calculation Example: 0000 // 32 V34 // 288/264 // L 01 00 03 04 The four-digit hexadecimal value (N) after “L” indicates the rx level. The high byte is given first, followed by the low byte. Divide the decimal value of N by -16 to get the rx level. In the above example, the decimal value of N (= 0100 [H]) is 256. So, the actual rx level is 256/-16 = -16 dB 3
4
5
Do not change this setting.
Not used
When "1" is selected, a line error mark is printed
Line error mark print
on the printout if a line error occurs during
0: OFF, 1: ON (print)
reception.
G3 communication parameter
D432/D433
This is a fault-finding aid. The LCD shows the key
54 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches display
parameters (see below). This is normally disabled
0: Disabled
because it cancels the CSI display for the user.
1: Enabled
Be sure to reset this bit to 0 after testing. This is only used for communication
Protocol dump list output after 6
each communication
troubleshooting. It shows the content of the transmitted facsimile protocol signals. Always reset this bit to 0 after finishing testing.
0: Off
If system switch 09 bit 6 is at “1”, the list is only
1: On
printed if there was an error during the communication.
7
Not used
Do not change the setting.
System Switch 01 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 02 [SP No. 1-101-003] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
0-1 Not used
2
3
Do not change these settings.
Force after transmission stall
With this setting on, the machine resets itself
0: Off
automatically if a transmission stalls and fails to
1: On
complete the job.
Not used
Do not change these settings.
File retention time 4
0: Depends on User
1: A file that had a communication error will not be
Parameter 24 [18(H)]
erased unless the communication is successful.
1: No limit (until the year 2126) 5 6-7
SM
Not used
Do not change this setting.
Memory read/write by RDS
(0,0): All RDS systems are always locked out.
Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0
(0,1), (1,0): Normally, RDS systems are locked
55 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches Always disabled
out, but the user can temporarily switch RDS on to
Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1
allow RDS operations to take place. RDS will
User selectable
automatically be locked out again after a certain
Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 0
time, which is stored in System Switch 03. Note
User selectable
that if an RDS operation takes place, RDS will not
Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 1
switch off until this time limit has expired.
Always enabled
(1,1): At any time, an RDS system can access the machine.
System Switch 03 [SP No. 1-101-004] No
0-7
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Length of time that RDS is
00 - 99 hours (BCD).
temporarily switched on when
This setting is only valid if bits 6 and 7 of System
bits 6 and 7 of System Switch
Switch 02 are set to “User selectable”.
02 are set to “User selectable” The default setting is 24 hours.
System Switch 04 [SP No. 1-101-005] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
0-2 Not used
Do not change these settings.
Printing dedicated tx parameters on Quick/Speed 3
Dial Lists 0: Disabled
1: Each Quick/Speed dial number on the list is printed with the dedicated tx parameters.
1: Enabled 4-7 Not used
Do not change these settings.
System Switch 05 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 06 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 07 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
D432/D433
56 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches System Switch 08 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
System Switch 09 [SP No. 1-101-010] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Addition of image data from 0
confidential transmissions on the transmission result report 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
If this feature is enabled, the top half of the first page of confidential messages will be printed on transmission result reports. 0: Communications that reached phase C
Inclusion of communications 1
(message tx/rx) of the T.30 protocol are listed on
on the Journal when no image the Journal. data was exchanged.
1: Communications that reached phase A (call
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
setup) of T.30 protocol are listed on the Journal. This will include telephone calls.
2
Automatic error report printout 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
0: Error reports will not be printed. 1: Error reports will be printed automatically after failed communications.
Printing of the error code on 3
the error report
1: Error codes are printed on the error reports.
0: No 1: Yes 4
Do not change this setting.
Not used
1: A power failure report will be automatically 5
Power failure report
printed after the power is switched on if a fax
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
message disappeared from the memory when the power was turned off last.
Conditions for printing the
This switch becomes effective only when system
protocol dump list 6
0: Print for all communications 1: Print only when there is a communication error
SM
switch 00 bit 6 is set to 1. 1: Set this bit to 1 when you wish to print a protocol dump list only for communications with errors.
57 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches Priority given to various types
7
of remote terminal ID when
This bit determines which set of priorities the
printing reports
machine uses when listing remote terminal names
0: RTI > CSI > Dial label > Tel. on reports. Number
Dial Label: The name stored, by the user, for the
1: Dial label > Tel. number >
Quick/Speed Dial number.
RTI > CSI
System Switch 0A [SP No. 1-101-011] No
0
FUNCTION
COMMENTS When "1" is selected, a suitable port is
Automatic port selection
automatically selected if the selected port is not
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
used.
1-3 Not used
Do not change these settings. 0: Prevents dialing from the ten-key pad while the external telephone is off-hook. Use this setting
Dialing on the ten-key pad 4
when the external telephone is off-hook 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
when the external telephone is not by the machine, or if a wireless telephone is connected as an external telephone. 1: The user can dial on the machine’s ten-key pad when the handset is off-hook.
5
On hook dial 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
6-7 Not used
0: On hook dial is disabled. Do not change the factory settings
System Switch 0B - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 0C - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 0D - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
D432/D433
58 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches System Switch 0E [SP No. 1-101-015] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
0-1 Not used
Do not change the settings. Direct sending cannot operate when the capture
Enable/disable for direct 2
function is on during sending. Setting this switch to
sending selection
"1" enables direct sending without capture. Setting
0: Direct sending off
this switch to "0" masks the direct sending function
1: Direct sending on
on the operation panel so it cannot be selected. 0: Manual tx and rx are possible while the external
3
Action when the external
handset is off-hook. However, memory tx is not
handset goes off-hook
possible.
0: Manual tx and rx operation
1: The display stays in standby mode even when
1: Memory tx and rx operation
the external handset is used, so that other people
(the display remains the
can use the machine for memory tx operation.
same)
Note that manual tx and rx are not possible with this setting.
4-7 Not used
Do not change these settings.
System Switch 0F [SP No. 1-101-016] No 0-7
SM
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Country/area code for functional
This country/area code determines the
settings (Hex)
factory settings of bit switches and RAM addresses. However, it has no effect on the
00: France
11: USA
01: Germany
12: Asia
02: UK
12: Asia
03: Italy
13: Japan
04: Austria
14: Hong Kong
05: Belgium
15: South Africa
NCU parameter settings and communication parameter RAM addresses. Cross reference NCU country code: SP No. 2-103-001 for G3-1 SP No. 2-104-001 for G3-2 SP No. 2-105-001 for G3-3
59 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches 06: Denmark
16: Australia
07: Finland
17: New Zealand
08: Ireland
18: Singapore
09: Norway
19: Malaysia
0A: Sweden
1A: China
0B: Switzerland
1B: Formosa
0C: Portugal
1C: Korea
0D: Netherland
20: Turkey
0E: Spain
21: Greece
0F: Israel
22: Hungary
10: ---
23: Czech
11: USA
24: Poland
System Switch 10 [SP No. 1-101-017] No
0-7
FUNCTION
COMMENTS Threshold = N x 128 KB + 256 KB
Threshold memory level for parallel memory transmission
N can be between 00 - FF(H) Default setting: 02(H) = 512 KB
System Switch 11 [SP No. 1-101-018] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
TTI printing position 0
0: Superimposed on the page
Change this bit to 1 if the TTI overprints
data
information that the customer considers to be
1: Printed before the data
important (G3 transmissions).
leading edge
D432/D433
60 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches 1
Not used
Japan Only
2
Not used
Do not change the factory settings.
TTI printing type 3
0: Address unit
TTI printing unit can be selected.
1: File unit 4-6 Not used 7
Do not change the factory settings. Japan Only
Not used
System Switch 12 [SP No. 1-101-019] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS TTI: 08 to 92 (BCD) mm Input even numbers only. This setting determines the print start position for
0-7
TTI printing position in the
the TTI from the left edge of the paper. If the TTI is
main scan direction
moved too far to the right, it may overwrite the file number which is on the top right of the page. On an A4 page, if the TTI is moved over by more than 50 mm, it may overwrite the page number.
System Switch 13 - Not used (do not change these settings) System Switch 14 - Not used (do not change these settings)
System Switch 15 [SP No. 1-101-022] No 0
1
SM
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Not used
Do not change the settings.
Going into the Energy Saver
1: The machine will restart from the Energy Saver
mode automatically
mode quickly, because the +5V power supply is
0: Enabled
active even in the Energy Saver mode.
61 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches 1: Disabled 2-3 Not used
Do not change these settings.
Interval for preventing the machine from entering Energy Saver mode if there is a
4-5
pending transmission file.
If there is a file waiting for transmission, the
Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 0
machine does not go to Energy Saver mode
1 min
during the selected period.
Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 1
After transmitting the file, if there is no file waiting
30 min1
for transmission, the machine goes to the Energy
Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 0
Saver mode.
1 hour Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 1 24 hours 6-7 Not used
Do not change
System Switch 16 [SP No. 1-101-023] No
FUNCTION
0-7 Not used
COMMENTS Do not change these settings.
System Switch 17 - Not used (do not change these settings) System Switch 18 - Not used (do not change these settings)
System Switch 19 [SP No. 1-101-026] No 0-6
7
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Not used
Do not change the settings.
Special Original mode
1: If the customer frequently wishes to transmit a
0: Disabled
form or letterhead which has a colored or printed
1: Enabled
background, change this bit to “1”. “Original 1” and
D432/D433
62 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches “Original 2” can be selected in addition to the “Text”, “Text/Photo” and “Photo” modes.
System Switch 1A [SP No. 1-101-027] No.
FUNCTION
COMMENTS Sets a value of 4K. If the amount of memory remaining falls below 4K,
0-7
LS RX memory remaining
documents received in memory are printed to
refresh value setting
create more space in memory. Initial value: 0x80 (512K) 00-FF (0-1020 KB: Hex)
System Switch 1B - Not used (do not change these settings) System Switch 1C - Not used (do not change these settings)
System Switch 1D [SP No. 1-101-030] No
0
1-7
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
RTI/CSI/CPS code display
0: RTI, CSI, CPS codes are displayed on the top
0: ON
line of the LCD panel during communication.
1: OFF
1: Codes are switched off (no display)
Not used
Do not change these settings.
System Switch 1E [SP No. 1-101-031] No
0
SM
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Communication after the
0: When this switch is on and the journal history
Journal data storage area has
becomes full, the next report prints. If the journal
become full
history is not deleted, the next transmission cannot
0: Impossible
be received. This prevents overwriting
1: Possible
communication records before the machine can
63 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches print them. 1: If the buffer memory of the communication records for the Journal is full, fax communications are still possible. But the machine will overwrite the oldest communication records. Note: This setting is effective only when Automatic Journal printout is enabled but the machine cannot print the report (e.g., no paper).
0: If the SAF memory becomes full during Action when the SAF memory has become full during 1
scanning, the successfully scanned pages are transmitted. 1: If the SAF memory becomes full during
scanning 0: The current page is erased. 1: The entire file is erased.
scanning, the file is erased and no pages are transmitted. This bit switch is ignored for parallel memory transmission.
2
This bit determines which identifier, RTI or CSI, is
RTI/CSI display priority
displayed on the LCD while the machine is
0: RTI 1: CSI
communicating in G3 non-standard mode.
File No. printing 3
0: Enabled
1: File numbers are not printed on any reports.
1: Disabled If authorized reception is enabled but the user has stored no acceptable sender RTIs or CSIs, the
Action when authorized
machine will not be able to receive any fax
reception is enabled but authorized RTIs/CSIs are not 4
yet programmed 0: All fax reception is disabled 1: Faxes can be received if the sender has an RTI or CSI
messages. If the customer wishes to receive messages from any sender that includes an RTI or CSI, and to block messages from senders that do not include an RTI or CSI, change this bit to “1”, then enable Authorized Reception. Otherwise, keep this bit at “0 (default setting)”.
D432/D433
64 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches 5-7 Not used
Do not change the settings
System Switch 1F [SP No. 1-101-032] No 0
1
2
3
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Not used
Do not change the settings.
Report printout after an
0: When an original jams, or the SAF memory
original jam during SAF
overflows during scanning, a report will be printed.
storage or if the SAF memory
Change this bit to “1” if the customer does not
fills up
want to have a report in these cases.
0: Enabled
Memory tx – Memory storage report
1: Disabled
Parallel memory tx – Transmission result report
Not used
Do not change the settings.
Received fax print start timing
0: The machine prints each page immediately after
(G3 reception)
the machine receives it.
0: After receiving each page
1: The machine prints the complete message after
1: After receiving all pages
the machine receives all the pages in the memory.
4-6 Not used
Do not change the factory settings. 0: When the fax unit detects a fax SC code other
Action when a fax SC has 7
occurred 0: Automatic reset 1: Fax unit stops
than SC1201 and SC1207, the fax unit automatically resets itself. 1: When the fax unit detects any fax SC code, the fax unit stops. Cross Reference Fax SC codes - See “Troubleshooting”
SM
65 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches
4.3.2 I-FAX SWITCHES I-fax Switch 00 [SP No. 1-102-001] FUNCTION No
COMMENTS This setting sets the maximum size of the original
Original Width of TX
that the destination can receive. (Bits 3~7 are
Attachment File 0
A4
1
B4
2
A3
reserved for future use or not used.) 0: Off (not selected), 1: On (selected) If more than one of these three bits is set to “1”, the larger size has priority. For example, if both Bit 2 and Bit 1 are set to “1” then the maximum size is “A3” (Bit 2).
3-6 Reserved
When mail is sent, there is no negotiation with the receiving machine at the destination, so the sending machine cannot make a selection for the receiving capabilities (original width setting) of the receiving machine. The original width selected
7
with this switch is used as the RX machine’s
Not used
original width setting, and the original is reduced to this size before sending. The default is A4. If the width selected with this switch is higher than the receiving machine can accept, the machine detects this and this causes an error.
I-fax Switch 01 [SP No. 1-102-002] FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Original Line Resolution of TX
These settings set the maximum resolution of the
Attachment File
original that the destination can receive.
0
200x100 Standard
0: Not selected
1
200x200 Detail
2
200x400 Fine
No
D432/D433
1: Selected If more than one of these three bits is set to “1”, the higher resolution has priority. For example, if
66 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches 3
300 x 300 Reserve
4
400 x 400 Super Fine
5
600 x 600 Reserve
6
Reserve
both Bit 0 and Bit 2 are set to “1” then the resolution is set for "Bit 2 200 x 400.
mm/inch This setting selects mm/inch conversion for mail transmission. 0: Off (No conversion), 1: On (Conversion) When on (set to “1”), the machine converts millimeters to inches for sending mail. There is no switch for converting inches to millimeters. Unlike G3 fax transmissions which can negotiate between sender and receiver to determine the setting, mail cannot negotiate between terminals; the mm/inch selection is determined by the sender fax. 7
When this switch is Off (0): Images scanned in inches are sent in inches. Images scanned in mm are sent in mm. Images received in inches are transmitted in inches. Images received in mm are transmitted in mm. When this switch is On (1): Images scanned in inches are sent in inches. Images scanned in mm are converted to inches. Images received in inches are transmitted in inches. Images received in mm are converted to inches.
I-fax Switch 02 [SP No. 1-102-003] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
RX Text Mail Header Processing This setting determines whether the header information is printed with text e-mails 0
when they are received. 0: Prints only text mail. 1: Prints mail header information attached to text mail. When a text mail is received with this switch On (1), the “From” address and
SM
67 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches “Subject” address are printed as header information. When a mail with only binary data is received (a TIFF-F file, for example), this setting is ignored and no header is printed. Output from Attached Document at E-mail TX Error This setting determines whether only the first page or all pages of an e-mail 1
attachment are printed at the sending station when a transmission error occurs. This allows the customer to see which documents have not reached their intended destinations if sent to the wrong e-mail addresses, for example. 0: Prints 1st page only. 1: Prints all pages. Text String for Return Receipt This setting determines the text string output for the Return Receipt that confirms the transmission was received normally at the destination. 00: “Dispatched” Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt with “dispatched” in the 2nd part: Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; dispatched The “dispatched” string is included in the Subject string.
2-3
01: “Displayed” Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt with “displayed” in the 2nd part: Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; displayed The “displayed” string is included in the Subject string. 10: Reserved 11: Reserved A mail requesting a Return Receipt sent from an IFAX with this switch set to “00” (for “dispatched”) received by Microsoft Outlook 2000 may cause an error. If any setting other than “displayed” (01) causes a problem, change the setting to “01” to enable normal sending of the Return Receipt. Media accept feature
4
This setting adds or does not add the media accept feature to the answer mail to confirm a reception.
D432/D433
68 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches 0: Does not add the media accept feature to the answer mail 1: Adds the media accept feature to the answer mail. Use this bit switch if a problem occurs when the machine receives an answer mail, which contains the media accept feature field. 5-6 Not Used Image Resolution of RX Text Mail This setting determines the image resolution of the received mail. 7
0: 200 x 200 1: 400 x 400 The “1” setting requires installation of the Function Upgrade Card in order to have enough SAF (Store and Forward) memory to receive images at 400 x 400 resolution.
I-fax Switch 03 - Not used (do not change the settings) [ SP No. 1-102-004]
I-fax Switch 04 [SP No. 1-102-005] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Subject for Delivery TX/Memory Transfer This setting determines whether the RTI/CSI registered on this machine or the RTI/CSI of the originator is used in the subject lines of transferred documents. 0
0: Puts the RTI/CSI of the originator in the Subject line. If this is used, either the RTI or CSI is used. Only one of these can be received for use in the subject line. 1: Puts the RTI/CSI registered on this machine in the Subject line. When this switch is used to transfer and deliver mail to a PC, the information in the Subject line that indicates where the transmission originated can be used to determine automatically the destination folder for each e-mail. Subject corresponding to mail post database 0: Standard subject
1
1: Mail post database subject The standard subject is replaced by the mail post database subject in the following three cases:
SM
69 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches 1) When the service technician sets the service (software) switch. 2) When memory sending, delivery specified by F code or SMTP reception is done. 3) With relay broadcasting (1st stage without the Schmidt 4 function).
This switch does not apply for condition 3) when the RX system is set up for memory sending, delivery by F-code, sending with SMTP RX and when operators are using FOL (to prevent problems when receiving transmissions).
2-7 Not Used
I-fax Switch 05 [SP No. 1-102-006] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Mail Addresses of SMTP Broadcast Recipients Determines whether the e-mail addresses of the destinations that receive transmissions broadcasted using SMTP protocol are recorded in the Journal. 0
For example: "1st destination + Total number of destinations: 9" in the Journal indicates a broadcast to 9 destinations. 0: Not recorded 1: Recorded I-Fax Automatic Re-dial
1
Setting
Determines whether the I-fax automatically redials
0: OFF
when an error occurs.
1: ON 2-7 Not Used
I-fax Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-007] I-fax Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-008]
D432/D433
70 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches I-fax Switch 08 [SP No. 1-102-009] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Memory Threshold for POP Mail Reception This setting determines the amount of SAF (Store and Forward) memory. (SAF stores fax messages to send later for transmission to more than one location, and also holds incoming messages if they cannot be printed.) When the amount of SAF 0-7 memory available falls below this setting, mail can no longer be received; received mail is then stored on the mail server. 00-FF (0 to 1024 KB: HEX)
The hexadecimal number you enter is multiplied by 4 KB to determine the amount of memory.
I-fax Switch 09 [SP No. 1-102-010] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
0-3 Not used
Do not change the settings This setting determines the number of retries when connection and transmission fails due to
4-7 Restrict TX Retries
errors. 01-F (1-15 Hex)
I-fax Switch 0A - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-011] I-fax Switch 0B - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-012] I-fax Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-013] I-fax Switch 0D - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-014] I-fax Switch 0E - Not used (do not change the settings) [SP No. 1-102-015]
I-fax Switch 0F [SP No. 1-102-016]
SM
71 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Delivery Method for SMTP RX Files
0
This setting determines whether files received with SMTP protocol are delivered or output immediately. 0: Off. Files received via SMTP are output immediately without delivery. 1: On. Files received via SMTP are delivered immediately to their destinations. Signature for the SMTP
1
This setting determines whether a signature is put on an e-mail via SMTP. 0: No signature 1: Signature This setting determines whether an e-mail via SMTP is encrypted.
2
0: Not encrypted 1: Encrypted
3-7 Not used
4.3.3 PRINTER SWITCHES Printer Switch 00 [SP No. 1-103-001] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS 0: If a 2 page RX transmission is split, [*] is printed in the bottom right corner of the 1st page and only a [2] is printed in the upper right corner of the 2nd page.
Select page separation marks 0
0: Off 1: On
1: If a 2 page RX transmission is split into two pages, for example, [*] [2] is printed in the bottom right corner of the 1st page and only a [2] is printed in the upper right corner of the 2nd page.
This helps the user to identify pages that have been split because the size of the paper is smaller than the size of the
D432/D433
72 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches document received. (When A5 is used to print an A4 size document, for example.)
1
Repetition of data when the
1: Default. 10 mm of the trailing edge of the
received page is longer than
previous page are repeated at the top of the next
the printer paper
page.
0: Off
0: The next page continues from where the
1: On
previous page stopped without any repeated text. This switch is only effective when user parameter
2
Prints the date and time on
02 - bit 2 (printing the received date and time on
received fax messages
received fax messages) is enabled.
0: Disabled
1: The machine prints the received and printed
1: Enabled
date and time at the bottom of each received page.
3-7 Not used
Do not change the settings.
Printer Switch 01 [SP No. 1-103-002] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
0-2 Not used
Do not change the settings.
Maximum print width used in the setup protocol 3-4
Bit 4: 0, Bit 3: 0 = Not used
These bits are only effective when bit 7 of printer
Bit 4: 0, Bit 3: 1 = A3
switch 01 is “1”.
Bit 4: 1, Bit 3: 0 = B4 Bit 4: 1, Bit 3: 1 = A4 5-6 Not used
7
Do not change the settings.
Received message width
0: The machine informs the transmitting machine
restriction in the protocol
of the print width depending on the paper size
signal to the sender
available from the paper feed stations.
0: Disabled
Refer to the table on the next page for how the
1: Enabled
machine chooses the paper width used in the setup protocol (NSF/DIS).
SM
73 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches 1: The machine informs the transmitting machine of the fixed paper width which is specified by bits 3 and 4 above.
Printer Switch 02 [SP No. 1-103-003] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
1st paper feed station usage 0
for fax printing 0: Enabled 1: Disabled
1
0: The paper feed station can be used to print fax
2nd paper feed station usage
messages and reports.
for fax printing
1: The specified paper feed station will not be used
0: Enabled
for printing fax messages and reports.
1: Disabled
3rd paper feed station usage 2
Do not disable usage for a paper feed station which has been specified by User
for fax printing
Parameter Switch 0F (15), or which is
0: Enabled
used for the Specified Cassette Selection
1: Disabled
feature.
4th paper feed station usage 3
for fax printing 0: Enabled 1: Disabled
4-7 Not used
Do not change the settings.
Printer Switch 03 [SP No. 1-103-004] No
0
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Length reduction of received
0: Incoming pages are printed without length
data
reduction.
0: Disabled
(Page separation threshold: Printer Switch 03, bits
1: Enabled
4 to 7)
D432/D433
74 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches 1: Incoming page length is reduced when printing. (Maximum reducible length: Printer Switches 04, bits 0 to 4) 1-3 Not used
Do not change the settings Page separation threshold (with reduction disabled with switch 03-0 above).
Page separation setting when
For example, if this setting is set to "10", and A4 is
sub scan compression is
the selected paper size: If the received document is 10 mm or less longer
4-7 forbidden 00-0F (0-15 mm: Hex)
than A4, then the 10 mm are cut and only 1 page
Default: 6 mm
prints. If the received document is 10 mm longer than A4, then the document is split into 2 pages.
Printer Switch 04 SP No. 1-103-005 No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Maximum reducible length when length reduction is enabled with switch 03-0 above. <Maximum reducible length> = <Paper length> + (N x 5mm) “N” is the decimal value of the binary setting of bits 0 to 4.
0-4
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Setting
0
0
0
0
0
0 mm
0
0
0
0
1
5 mm
0
0
1
0
0
20 mm
1
1
1
1
1
155 mm
For A5 sideways and B5 sideways paper <Maximum reducible length> = <Paper length> + 0.75 x (N x 5mm) 5-6 Length of the duplicated image on the next page, when page separation has taken
SM
75 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches place. Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 0 = 4 mm Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 0 = 10 mm Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 1 = 15 mm Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 1 = Not used 7
Do not change the setting.
Not used.
Printer Switch 05 - Not used (do not change the settings)
Printer Switch 06 [SP No. 1-103-007] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Printing while a paper cassette is pulled out, when the Just Size Printing feature is enabled. 0
Cross reference
0: Printing will not start 1: Printing will start if another
Just size printing on/off – User switch 05, bit 5
cassette has a suitable size of paper, based on the paper size selection priority tables. 1-7 Not used.
Do not change the settings.
Printer Switch 07 [SP No. 1-103-008] No
FUNCTION
0-3 Not used.
COMMENTS Do not change the settings.
List of destinations in the Communication Failure Report 1: Only destinations where communication failure 4
for broadcasting
occurred are printed on the Communication
0: All destinations
Failure Report.
1: Only destinations where
D432/D433
76 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches communication failure occurred 5-7 Not used.
Do not change the settings.
Printer Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings) Printer Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings) Printer Switch 0A - Not used (do not change the settings)
Printer Switch 0B - Not used (do not change the settings) Printer Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings) Printer Switch 0D - Not used (do not change the settings)
Printer Switch 0E [SP No. 1-103-015] No
FUNCTION Paper size selection priority
0
0: Width 1: Length Paper size selected for
1
printing A4 width fax data 0: 8.5" x 11" size 1: A4 size
COMMENTS 0: A paper size that has the same width as the received data is selected first. 1: A paper size which has enough length to print all the received lines without reduction is selected first. This switch determines which paper size is selected for printing A4 width fax data, when the machine has both A4 and 8.5" x 11" size paper. 1: If all paper sizes in the machine require page
Page separation 2
0: Enabled 1: Disabled
separation to print a received fax message, the machine does not print the message (Substitute Reception is used). After a larger size of paper is set in a cassette, the machine automatically prints the fax message.
SM
77 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches Printing the sample image on reports Bit 4: 0, Bit 3: 0
“Same size” means the sample image is printed at
= The upper half only
100%, even if page separation occurs.
Bit 4: 0, Bit 3: 1 3-4 = 50% reduction in sub-scan only Bit 4: 1, Bit 3: 0 = Same size
User Parameter Switch 19 (13H) bit 4 must be set to “0” to enable this switch. Refer to Detailed Section Descriptions for more on this feature.
Bit 4: 1, Bit 3: 1 = Not used 5-6 Not used
Do not change the settings.
Equalizing the reduction ratio 0: When page separation has taken place, all the 7
among separated pages
pages are reduced with the same reduction ratio.
(Page Separation)
1: Only the last page is reduced to fit the selected
0: Enabled
paper size when page separation has taken place.
1: Disabled
Other pages are printed without reduction.
Printer Switch 0F [SP No. 1-103-016] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Smoothing feature 0-1
Bit 1: 0 Bit 0: 0 = Disabled
(0, 0) (0, 1): Disable smoothing if the machine
Bit 1: 0 Bit 0: 1 = Disabled
receives halftone images from other
Bit 1: 1 Bit 0: 0 = Enabled
manufacturers fax machines frequently.
Bit 1: 1 Bit 0: 1 = Not used Duplex printing 2
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
1: The machine always prints received fax messages in duplex printing mode:
Binding direction for Duplex 3
printing
0: Sets the binding for the left edge of the stack.
0: Left binding
1: Sets the binding for the top of the stack.
1: Top binding
D432/D433
78 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches 4-7
Do not change the settings.
Not used
4.3.4 COMMUNICATION SWITCHES
Communication Switch 00 [SP No. 1-104-001] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Compression modes available in receive mode These bits determine the compression capabilities
Bit 1: 0 Bit 0: 0 = MH only
to be declared in phase B (handshaking) of the
0-1 Bit 1: 0 Bit 0: 1 = MH/MR
Bit 1: 1 Bit 0: 0 = MH/MR/MMR T.30 protocol. Bit 1: 1 Bit 0: 1 = MH/MR/MMR/JBIG Compression modes available in transmit mode Bit 3: 0 Bit 2: 0 = MH only 2-3 Bit 3: 0 Bit 2: 1 = MH/MR
These bits determine the compression capabilities to be used in the transmission and to be declared
Bit 3: 1 Bit 2: 0 = MH/MR/MMR in phase B (handshaking) of the T.30 protocol. Bit 3: 1 Bit 2: 1 = MH/MR/MMR/JBIG 4
Not used
Do not change the settings.
JBIG compression method: Reception 5
0: Only basic supported 1: Basic and optional both
Change the setting when communication problems occur using JBIG compression.
supported JBIG compression method: 6
Transmission
Change the setting when communication
0: Basic mode priority
problems occur using JBIG compression.
1: Optional mode priority
SM
79 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches 7
Do not change the settings.
Not used
Communication Switch 01 [SP No. 1-104-002] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS If this bit is set to 0, ECM is switched off for all
0
ECM
communications.
0: Off 1: On
In addition, V.8 protocol and JBIG compression are switched off automatically.
1
Do not change the settings.
Not used
(0,1) - The machine will disconnect the line without sending a fax message, if the last 8 digits of the received CSI do not match the last 8 digits of the dialed telephone number. This does not work Wrong connection prevention method 2-3
when manually dialed. (1,0) - The same as above, except that only the last 4 digits are compared.
Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 0 = None Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 1 = 8 digit CSI Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 0 = 4 digit CSI Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 1 = CSI/RTI
(1,1) - The machine will disconnect the line without sending a fax message, if the other end does not identify itself with an RTI or CSI. (0,0) - Nothing is checked; transmission will always go ahead.
This function does not work when dialing is done from the external telephone.
4-5 Not used
Do not change the setting.
Maximum printable page length available 6-7
The setting determined by these bits is informed to
Bit 7: 0 Bit 6: 0 = No limit Bit 7: 0 Bit 6: 1 = B4 (364 mm) Bit 7: 1 Bit 6: 0 = A4 (297 mm)
the transmitting terminal in the pre-message protocol exchange (in the DIS/NSF frames).
Bit 7: 1 Bit 6: 1 = Not used
D432/D433
80 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches Communication Switch 02 [SP No. 1-104-003] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS If there are more consecutive error lines in the received page than the threshold, the machine will send a negative response. The Low and High threshold values depend on the sub-scan
0
1
resolution, and are as follows.
G3 Burst error threshold 0: Low 1: High
100 dpi
6(L) « 12(H)
200 dpi
12(L) « 24(H)
300 dpi
18(L) « 36(H)
400 dpi
24(L) « 48(H)
Acceptable total error line ratio If the error line ratio for a page exceeds the 0: 5% 1: 10%
acceptable ratio, RTN will be sent to the other end.
Treatment of pages received with errors during G3 2
reception
0: Pages received with errors are not printed.
0: Deleted from memory without printing 1: Printed
0: The next page will be sent even if RTN or PIN is
Hang-up decision when a negative code (RTN or PIN) is 3
received during G3 immediate transmission 0: No hang-up, 1: Hang-up
4-7 Not used
received. 1: The machine will send DCN and hang up if it receives RTN or PIN. This bit is ignored for memory transmissions or if ECM is being used. Do not change the settings.
Communication Switch 03 [SP No. 1-104-004] No
SM
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
81 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches Maximum number of page 0-7 retransmissions in a G3 memory transmission
00 - FF (Hex) times. This setting is not used if ECM is switched on. Default setting - 03(H)
Communication Switch 04 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 05 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings)
Communication Switch 09 [SP No. 1-104-010] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS Adjusts the interval of the I-fax dialing. The interval of I-fax dialing is calculated by
0-7 IP-Fax dial interval setting
following formula. [Interval time = specified value with this switch x 0.2 msec]
Communication Switch 0A [SP No. 1-104-011] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Point of resumption of memory 0: The transmission begins from the page where 0
transmission upon redialing
transmission failed the previous time.
0: From the error page
1: Transmission begins from the first page, using
1: From page 1
normal memory transmission.
1-7 Not used
Do not change the settings.
Communication Switch 0B [SP No. 1-104-012] No
D432/D433
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
82 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches 0-3 Not used 4
Do not change the settings.
Print setting when receiving a
0: The machine does not print fax data.
request to forward a fax
1: The machine prints fax data.
5-7 Not used
Do not change the settings.
Communication Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings)
Communication Switch 0D [SP No. 1-104-014] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS 00 to FF (Hex), unit = 4 kbytes (e.g., 06(H) = 24 kbytes) One page is about 24 kbytes.
The available memory
The machine refers to this setting before each fax
threshold, below which ringing reception. If the amount of remaining memory is 0-7 detection (and therefore
below this threshold, the machine cannot receive
reception into memory) is
any fax messages.
disabled
If this setting is kept at 0, the machine will detect ringing signals and go into receive mode even if there is no memory available. This will result in communication failure.
Communication Switch 0E [SP No. 1-104-015] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS 06 to FF (Hex), unit = 2 s
0-7
Minimum interval between
(e.g., 06(H) = 12 s)
automatic dialing attempts
This value is the minimum time that the machine waits before it dials the next destination.
Communication Switch 0F – Not used (do not change the settings.)
SM
83 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches Communication Switch 10 [SP No. 1-104-017] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Memory transmission: 0-7
Maximum number of dialing
01 – FE (Hex) times
attempts to the same destination
Communication Switch 11 – Not used (do not change the settings.)
Communication Switch 12 [SP No. 1-104-019] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Memory transmission: Interval 0-7
between dialing attempts to
01 – FF (Hex) minutes
the same destination
Communication Switch 13 – Not used (do not change the settings.)
Communication Switch 14 [SP No. 1-104-021] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS 0: In immediate transmission, data scanned in inch format are transmitted without conversion. In memory transmission, data stored in the SAF memory in mm format are transmitted without
0
Inch-to-mm conversion during
conversion.
transmission
Note: When storing the scanned data into SAF
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
memory, the fax unit always converts the data into mm format. 1: The machine converts the scanned data or stored data in the SAF memory to the format which was specified in the set-up protocol
D432/D433
84 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches (DIS/NSF) before transmission. 1-5 Not used
Do not change the factory settings.
Available unit of resolution in which fax messages are
For the best performance, do not change the
received 6-7
factory settings.
Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0 = mm
The setting determined by these bits is informed to
Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1 = inch Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 0 = mm and inch (default)
the transmitting terminal in the pre-message protocol exchange (in the DIS/NSF frames).
Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 1 = Not used
Communication Switch 15 – Not used (do not change the settings)
Communication Switch 16 [SP No. 1-104-023] No
FUNCTION
0-7 Not used
COMMENTS Do not change the factory settings.
Communication Switch 17 [SP No. 1-104-024] No
0
1
FUNCTION SEP reception
0: Polling transmission to another maker’s
0: Disabled
machine using the SEP (Selective Polling) signal
1: Enabled
is disabled.
SUB reception
0: Confidential reception to another maker’s
0: Disabled
machine using the SUB (Sub-address) signal is
1: Enabled
disabled.
PWD reception 2
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
3-6 Not used
SM
COMMENTS
0: Disables features that require PWD (Password) signal reception. Do not change the factory settings.
85 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches Action when there is no box with an F-code that matches 7
the received SUB code
Change this setting when the customer requires.
0: Disconnect the line 1: Receive the message (using normal reception mode)
Communication Switch 18 [SP No. 1-104-025] No
FUNCTION
0-4 Not used
COMMENTS Do not change the factory settings.
IP-Fax dial-in routing selection 1: Transfers receiving data to each IP-Fax dial-in 5
0: Off
number.
1: On
IP-Fax dial-in number is 4 digit-number.
6-7 Not used
Do not change the factory settings.
Communication Switch 19 - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 1A - Not used (do not change the settings)
Communication Switch 1B [SP No. 1-104-028] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS If the PABX does not support V.8/V.34 protocol
Extension access code (0 to 7) procedure, set this bit to “1” to disable V.8. to turn V.8 protocol On/Off 0-7 0: On 1: Off
Example: If “0” is the PSTN access code, set bit 0 to 1. When the machine detects “0” as the first dialed number, it automatically disables V.8 protocol. (Alternatively, if “3” is the PSTN access code, set bit 3 to 1.)
D432/D433
86 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches Communication Switch 1C [SP No. 1-104-029] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS Refer to communication switch 1B.
0-1
Extension access code (8 and
Example: If “8” is the PSTN access code, set bit 0
9) to turn V.8 protocol On/Off
to 1. When the machine detects “8” as the first
0: On
dialed number, it automatically disables V.8
1: Off
protocol. (If “9” is the PSTN access code, use bit 1.)
2-7 Not used
Do not change the settings.
Communication Switch 1D - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 1E - Not used (do not change the settings) Communication Switch 1F - Not used (do not change the settings)
4.3.5 G3 SWITCHES
G3 Switch 00 [SP No. 1-105-001] No
0 1
FUNCTION Monitor speaker during
(0, 0): The monitor speaker is disabled all through
communication (tx and rx)
the communication.
Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = Disabled
(0, 1): The monitor speaker is on up to phase B in
Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = Up to Phase the T.30 protocol. B
(1, 0): Used for testing. The monitor speaker is on
Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = All the time
all through the communication. Make sure that you
Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = Not used
reset these bits after testing.
Monitor speaker during 2
memory transmission 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
3-5 Not used
SM
COMMENTS
1: The monitor speaker is enabled during memory transmission. Do not change the settings.
87 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches G3 mode selection for direct 6
line
1: G3 communication through the direct line is
0: Off
enabled.
1:On 7
Do not change the settings.
Not used
G3 Switch 01 [SP No. 1-105-002] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
0-1 Not used
Do not change the settings.
2-3 Not used
Do not change the settings. 1: The bytes in the DIS frame after the 4th byte will
4
DIS frame length
not be transmitted (set to 1 if there are
0: 10 bytes 1: 4 bytes
communication problems with PC-based faxes which cannot receive the extended DIS frames).
5
6
7
Not used
Do not change the setting.
Forbid CED/AMsam output
Do not change this setting (Default: 0: Off), unless
0: Off
communication problem is caused by a CED or
1: On (Forbid output)
ANSam transmission.
Not used
Do not change the setting.
G3 Switch 02 [SP No. 1-105-003] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS Change this bit to 1 only when the other end can
0
G3 protocol mode used
only communicate with machines that send
0: Standard and non-standard
T.30-standard frames only.
1: Standard only
1: Disables NSF/NSS signals (these are used in non-standard mode communication)
1-6 Not used
D432/D433
Do not change the settings.
88 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches 7
Short preamble
Refer to Appendix B in the Group 3 Facsimile
0: Disabled 1: Enabled
Manual for details about Short Preamble.
G3 Switch 03 [SP No. 1-105-004] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS 0: The machine will hang up if it receives the same
DIS detection number 0
DIS frame twice.
(Echo countermeasure)
1: Before sending DCS, the machine will wait for
0: 1
the second DIS which is caused by echo on the
1: 2 1
line. Do not change the settings.
Not Used
0: V.8/V.34 communications will not be possible. 2
V.8 protocol
Note:
0: Disabled
Do not set to 0 unless the line condition is always
1: Enabled
bad enough to slow down the data rate to 14.4 kbps or lower.
ECM frame size 3
0: 256 bytes
Keep this bit at “0” in most cases.
1: 64 bytes 0: When using ECM in non-standard (NSF/NSS) mode, the machine sends a CTC to drop back the modem rate after receiving a PPR, if the following condition is met in communications at 14.4, 12.0, CTC transmission conditions
9.6, and 7.2 kbps.
0: After one PPR signal 4
received 1: After four PPR signals
NTransmit- Number of transmitted frames
received (ITU-T standard)
NResend- Number of frames to be retransmitted 1: When using ECM, the machine sends a CTC to drop back the modem rate after receiving four PPRs. PPR, CTC: These are ECM protocol signals.
SM
89 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches This bit is not effective in V.34 communications. Modem rate used for the next 5
page after receiving a negative code (RTN or PIN)
Do not change the settings
Not Used
This switch is used to prevent reverse polarity in
Select detection of reverse 7
before sending the next page if a negative code is received. This bit is ignored if ECM is being used.
0: No change 1: Fallback 6
1: The machine’s tx modem rate will fall back
ringing on the phone line (applied to PSTN-G3
polarity in ringing
ringing). Do not change this setting
0: Off
0: No detection
1: On
1: Detection
Outside Japan Inside Japan only
G3 Switch 04 [SP No. 1-105-005] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS 0 - F (Hex); 0 - 15 bits
0-3
Training error detection
If the number of error bits in the received TCF is
threshold
below this threshold, the machine informs the sender that training has succeeded.
4-7 Not used
D432/D433
Do not change the settings.
90 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches
G3 Switch 05 [SP No. 1-105-006] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Initial Tx modem rate Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0-3
bps
0
0
0
1
2.4k
0
0
1
0
4.8k
0
0
1
1
7.2k
0
1
0
0
9.6k
0
1
0
1
12.0k
0
1
1
0
14.4k
0
1
1
1
16.8k
1
0
0
0
19.2k
1
0
0
1
21.6k
1
0
1
0
24.0k
1
0
1
1
26.4k
1
1
0
0
28.8k
1
1
0
1
31.2k
1
1
1
0
33.6k
These bits set the initial starting modem rate for transmission. Use the dedicated transmission parameters if you need to change this for specific receivers. If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is selected, V.8 protocol should be disabled manually. Cross reference V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2
Other settings - Not used Initial modem type for 9.6 k or 4-5
7.2 kbps.
These bits set the initial modem type for 9.6 and
Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 0 = V.29
7.2 kbps, if the initial modem rate is set at these
Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 1 = V.17
speeds.
Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 0 = V.34
SM
91 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 1 = Not used 6-7
Do not change the settings.
Not used
G3 Switch 06 [SP No. 1-105-007] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Initial Rx modem rate Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
0-3
bps
0
0
0
1
2.4k
0
0
1
0
4.8k
0
0
1
1
7.2k
0
1
0
0
9.6k
0
1
0
1
12.0k
0
1
1
0
14.4k
0
1
1
1
16.8k
1
0
0
0
19.2k
1
0
0
1
21.6k
These bits set the initial starting modem rate for reception.
Use a lower setting if high speeds pose problems during reception.
If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is selected, V.8 protocol should be disabled manually.
Cross reference: V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2
1
0
1
0
24.0k
1
0
1
1
26.4k
1
1
0
0
28.8k
1
1
0
1
31.2k
1
1
1
0
33.6k
Other settings - Not used 4-7
Modem types available for reception Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4
D432/D433
The setting of these bits is used to inform the transmitting terminal of the
Setting
92 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches 0
0
0
1
V.27ter
0
0
1
0
V.27ter,V.29
0
0
1
1
available modem type for the machine
1
0
If V.34 is not selected, V.8 protocol must
Cross reference:
V.29, V.33
0
be disabled manually.
V.27ter,
V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2
V.27ter, 0
in receive mode.
V.29, V.17/V.33 V.27ter,
0
1
0
1
V.29, V.17/V33, V.34
Other settings - Not used
G3 Switch 07 [SP No. 1-105-008] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS Use a higher setting if there is signal loss at higher frequencies because of the length of wire between the modem and the telephone exchange.
0-1
PSTN cable equalizer
Use the dedicated transmission parameters for
(tx mode: Internal)
specific receivers.
Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = None
Also, try using the cable equalizer if one or more of
Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = Low
the following symptoms occurs.
Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = Medium
Communication error
Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = High
Modem rate fallback occurs frequently. This setting is not effective in V.34
communications.
2-3
SM
PSTN cable equalizer
Use a higher setting if there is signal loss at higher
(rx mode: Internal)
frequencies because of the length of wire between
Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 0 = None
the modem and the telephone exchange.
Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 1 = Low
Also, try using the cable equalizer if one or more of
93 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 0 = Medium
the following symptoms occurs.
Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 1 = High
Communication error with error codes such as 0-20, 0-23, etc. Modem rate fallback occurs frequently. This setting is not effective in V.34
communications. PSTN cable equalizer 4
(V.8/V.17 rx mode: External) 0: Disabled
Keep this bit at “1”.
1: Enabled 5
Do not change the settings.
Not used
0: This uses the fixed table in the ROM for dial tone
6
Parameter selection for dial
detection.
tone detection
1: This uses the specific parameter adjusted with
0: Normal parameter
SRAM (69ECBEH - 69ECDEH). Select this if the
1: Specific parameter
dial tone cannot be detected when the "Normal parameter: 0" is selected.
7
Do not change the settings.
Not used
G3 Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings)
G3 Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings)
G3 Switch 0A [SP No. 1-105-011] No
0-1
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Maximum allowable carrier
These bits set the acceptable modem carrier drop
drop during image data
time.
reception
Try using a longer setting if error code 0-22 is
Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 200 (ms)
frequent.
D432/D433
94 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = 400 (ms) Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = 800 (ms) Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = Not used Select cancellation of 2
high-speed RX if carrier
This switch setting determines if high-speed
signal lost while receiving
receiving ends if the carrier signal is lost when
0: Off
receiving during non-ECM mode
1: On 3
Do not change the settings
Not used
This bit set the maximum interval between EOL
Maximum allowable frame 4
(end-of-line) signals and the maximum interval
interval during image data
between ECM frames from the other end.
reception.
Try using a longer setting if error code 0-21 is
0: 5 s 1: 13 s 5
frequent. Do not change the settings.
Not used
When the sending terminal is controlled by a computer, there may be a delay in receiving page data after the local machine accepts set-up data Reconstruction time for the 6
first line in receive mode 0: 6 s 1: 12 s
and sends CFR. This is outside the T.30 recommendation. But, if this delay occurs, set this bit to 1 to give the sending machine more time to send data. Refer to error code 0-20. ITU-T T.30 recommendation: The first line should come within 5 s of CFR.
7
Not used
Do not change the settings.
G3 Switch 0B - Not used (do not change the settings). G3 Switch 0C - Not used (do not change the settings) G3 Switch 0D - Not used (do not change the settings).
SM
95 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches G3 Switch 0E [SP No 1-105-015] Set CNG send time interval Some machines on the receiving side may not be able to automatically switch the 3-second CNG interval. 0-7
3000-2250ms: 3000-50xNms
High order bit
3000 – 50 x Nms 0F (3000 ms) ≤ N ≤ FF (2250 ms) 00-0E(3000-3700ms: 3000+50xNms
Low order bit
3000 – 50 x Nms 0F (3000 ms) ≤ N ≤ 0F (3700 ms)
G3 Switch 0F [SP No. 1-105-016] No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Alarm when an error occurred 0
in Phase C or later
If the customer wants to hear an alarm after each
0: Disabled
error communication, change this bit to “1”.
1: Enabled Alarm when the handset is 1
off-hook at the end of
If the customer wants to hear an alarm if the
communication
handset is off-hook at the end of fax
0: Disabled
communication, change this bit to “1”.
1: Enabled 2
Not used Sidaa manual calibration
4
setting 0: Off 1: On
5-7 Not used
D432/D433
Do not change the settings. 1: manually calibrates for communication with a line, whose current change occurs such as an optical fiber line. Do not change the settings.
96 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches
4.3.6 IP FAX SWITCHES
IP Fax Switch 00 [SP No. 1-111-001] No. 0 1
2
FUNCTION
COMMENTS Do not change this setting.
Not used IP Fax Transport
Selects TCP or UDP protocol for IP-Fax
0: TCP, 1: UDP IP Fax single port selection 0: OFF, 1: ON (enable)
Selects single data port.
IP Fax double ports (single data 3
port) selection
Selects whether IP-Fax uses a double port.
0: OFF, 1: ON (enable) 4
5
IP Fax Gatekeeper
Enables/disables the communication via the
0: OFF, 1: ON (enable)
gatekeeper for IP-Fax.
IP Fax T30 bit signal reverse 0: LSB first, 1: MSB first
Reverses the T30 bit signal. When "0" is selected, the max bit rate does
6
IP Fax max bit rate setting
not affect the value of the DIS/DCS.
0: Not affected, 1: Affected
When "1" is selected, the max bit rate affects the value of the DIS/DCS. When "0" is selected, fax data is received without checking the telephone number.
IP Fax received telephone number When "1" is selected, fax data is received 7
confirmation
only when confirming that the telephone
0: No confirmation, 1:
number from the sender matches the
Confirmation
registered telephone number in this machine. If this confirmation fails, the line is disconnected.
SM
97 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches IP-Fax Switch 01 No.
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Select IP FAX Delay Level
0-3
Raise the level by selecting a higher setting
Bit3
Bit2
Bit1
Bit0
Setting
0
0
0
0
Level 0
0
0
0
1
Level 1
0
0
1
0
Level 2
0
0
1
1
Level 3
if too many transmission errors are occurring on the network. If TCP/UDP is enabled on the network, raise this setting on the T.30 machine. Increasing the delay time allows the recovery of more lost packets. If only UDP is enabled, increase the number of redundant packets. Level 1~2: 3 Redundant packets Level 3: 4 Redundant packets Selects the preamble wait time. [00 to 0f] There are 16 values in this 4-bit binary
4-7
IP Fax preamble wait time setting
switch combination. Waiting time: set value level x 100 ms Max: 0f (1500 ms) Min: 00 (No wait time) The default is "0000" (00H).
IP Fax Switch 02 [SP No. 1-111-003] No.
FUNCTION
COMMENTS When "0" is selected, the bit signal reverse
IP Fax bit signal reverse setting 0
0: Maker code setting 1: Internal bit switch setting
method is decided by the maker code. When "1" is selected, the bit signal reverse method is decided by the internal bit switch. When communicating between IP Fax devices, LSB first is selected.)
IP Fax transmission speed setting 1
0: Modem speed 1: No limitation
D432/D433
Selects the transmit speed for IP Fax communication.
98 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches This bit switch sets the transport that has
SIP transport setting 2
priority for receiving IP Fax data.
0: TCP
This function is activated only when the
1: UDP
3
sender has both TCP and UDP.
CCM connection
When "1" is selected, only the connection
0: No CCM connection
call message with H.323 or no tunneled
1: CCM connection
H.245 is transmitted via CCM. 0: This answers the INVITE message from
4
Message reception selection from
the SIP server not registered for the
non-registered SIP server
machine.
0: Answer
1: This does not receive the INVITE
1: Not answer
message from the SIP server not registered for the machine and send a refusal message. 0: This does not limit the type of the image
ECM communication setting 5
0: No limit for image compression 1: Limit for image compression
compression with ECM communication. 1: When the other end machine is Ciscco, this permits the image compression other than JBIG or MMR with ECM communication.
6-7
Do not change these settings.
Not used
IP Fax Switch 03 [SP No. 1-111-004] No.
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Effective field limitation for G3 0
standard function information 0: OFF, 1: 4byte (DIS)
Limits the effective field for standard G3 function information.
Switching between G3 standard 1
and G3 non standard
Enables/disables switching between G3
0: Enable switching
standard and G3 non-standard.
1: G3 standard only 2
SM
Not used.
Do not change this setting.
99 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches ECM frame size selection at 3
transmitting
Selects the ECM frame size for sending.
0: 256byte, 1: 64byte DIS detection times for echo 4
prevention
echoes.
0: 1 time, 1: 2 times CTC transmission selection 5
0: PPRx1
condition is decided by error frame numbers. condition is based on the ITU-T method.
Shift down setting at receiving negative code
Selects whether to shift down when negative codes are received.
0: OFF, 1: ON 7
When "0" is selected, the transmission When "1" is selected, the transmission
1: PPRx4
6
Sets the number of times for DIS to detect
Do not change this setting.
Not used
IP Fax Switch 04 [SP No. 1-111-005] No.
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
0 1
Sets the TCF error threshold level. TCF error threshold
[00 to 0f]
2
The default is "1111" (0fH).
3 4-7
Do not change these settings.
Not used
IP Fax Switch 05 [SP No. 1-111-006] No. 0-3
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Modem bit rate setting for transmission Sets the modem bit rate for transmission. The default is "0110" (14.4K bps).
D432/D433
100 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
1
2400 bps
0
0
1
1
4800 bps
0
0
1
1
7200 bps
0
1
0
0
9600 bps
0
1
0
1
12.0 Kbps
0
1
1
0
14.4 Kbps
Modem setting for transmission Sets the modem for transmission. The default is "00" (V29). 4-5
Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 0 = V29 Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 1 = V17 Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 0 = V34* Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 1 = Not used *V34 is not supported for IP-Fax communication.
6-7
Do not change these settings.
Not used
IP Fax Switch 06 [SP No. 1-111-007] No. 0-3
SM
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Modem bit rate setting for reception Sets the modem bit rate for reception. The default is "0110" (14.4K bps). Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
1
2400 bps
0
0
1
0
4800 bps
0
0
1
1
7200 bps
0
1
0
0
9600 bps
101 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches 0
1
0
1
12.0 Kbps
0
1
1
0
14.4 Kbps
Modem setting for reception Sets the modem type for reception. The default is "0100" (V27ter, V29, V17). Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
0
0
0
1
V27ter
0
0
1
0
V27ter, V29
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
4-7
V27ter, V29, V33 (invalid) V27ter, V29, V17 V27ter, V29, V17, V34*
*V34 is not supported for IP-Fax communication.
IP Fax Switch 07 [SP No. 1-111-008] No. 0
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
TSI information
Adds or does not add TSI information to
0: Not added, 1: Added
NSS(S).
DCN transmission setting at T1 1
timeout 0: Not transmitted, 1: Transmitted
2
Transmits or does not transmit DCN at T1 timeout. Do not change this setting.
Not used Hang up setting at DIS reception
3
disabled
Sets whether the machine disconnects after
0: No hang up
DIS reception.
1: Hang up after transmitting DCN
D432/D433
102 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Bit Switches 4
5
6-7
Number of times for training
Selects the number of times training is done
0: 1 time, 1: 2 times
at the same bit rate.
Space CSI transmission setting at
When "0" is selected, frame data is enabled.
no CSI registration
When "1" is selected, the transmitted data is
0: Not transmitted, 1: Transmitted
all spaces.
Not used
Do not change these settings.
IP Fax Switch 08 [SP No. 1-111-009] No.
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
T1 timer adjustment Adjusts the T1 timer. The default is "00" (35 seconds). 0-1
-
Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 35 sec Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = 40 sec Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = 50 sec Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = 60 sec T4 timer adjustment Adjust the T4 timer. The default is "00" (3 seconds).
2-3
Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 0 = 3 sec
-
Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 1 = 3.5 sec Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 0 = 4 sec Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 1 = 5 sec T0 timer adjustment Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 0 = 75 sec 4-5
Bit 5: 0, Bit 4: 1 = 120 sec Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 0 = 180 sec Bit 5: 1, Bit 4: 1 = 240 sec
6-7
SM
Not used
Adjusts the fail safe timer. This timer sets the interval between "setup" data transmission and T.38 phase decision. If your destination return is late on the network or G3 fax return is late, adjust the longer interval timer. The default is "00" (75 seconds). Do not change these settings.
103 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Bit Switches IP Fax Switch 09 [SP No. 1-111-010] No.
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Network I/F setting for SIP 0
connection
Selects the connection type (IPV4 or IPV6)
0: IPv4
to connect to the SIP server.
1: IPv6. Network I/F setting for Fax communication 1
0: Same setting as SIP server connection 1: Automatic setting
Record-route setting 2
0: Disable 1: Enable
3-7
Not used
D432/D433
0: The I/F setting for fax communication follows the setting for SIP server connection. 1: The negotiation between the SIP server and the device decides whether IPv4 or IPv6 is used for the I/F setting for fax communication. 0: Disables the record-route function of the SIP server. 1: Enables the record-route function of the SIP server. Do not change these settings.
104 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
NCU Parameters
4.4 NCU PARAMETERS The following tables give the RAM addresses and the parameter calculation units that the machine uses for ringing signal detection and automatic dialing. The factory settings for each country are also given. Most of these must be changed by RAM read/write (SP2-102), but some can be changed using NCU Parameter programming (SP2-103, 104 and 105); if SP2-103, 104 and 105 can be used, this will be indicated in the Remarks column. The RAM is programmed in hex code unless (BCD) is included in the Unit column.
The following addresses describe settings for the standard NCU.
Change the fourth digit from “5” to “6” (e.g. 680500 to 680600) for the settings for the first optional G3 interface unit and from “5” to “7” (e.g. 680700) for the settings for the second optional G3 interface unit.
Address 680500
Function Country/Area code for NCU parameters Use the Hex value to program the country/area code directly into this address, or use the decimal value to program it using SP2-103-001 Country
Decimal
Hex
France
00
00
Germany
01
UK
Decimal
Hex
USA
17
11
01
Asia
18
12
02
02
Hong Kong
20
14
Italy
03
03
South Africa
21
15
Austria
04
04
Australia
22
16
Belgium
05
05
New Zealand
26
17
Denmark
06
06
Singapore
24
18
Finland
07
07
Malaysia
25
19
Ireland
08
08
China
26
1A
/Area
SM
Country /Area
105 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
NCU Parameters Address
Address
Function Norway
09
09
Taiwan
27
1B
Sweden
10
0A
Korea
28
1C
Switzerland
11
0B
Turkey
32
20
Portugal
12
0C
Greece
33
21
Holland
13
0D
Hungary
34
22
Spain
14
0E
Czech
35
23
Israel
15
0F
Poland
36
24
Function
680501
Line current detection time
680502
Line current wait time
680503
Line current drop detect time
680504
680505
680506
680507
Unit
Line current detection is disabled. 20 ms
Line current is not detected if 680501 contains FF.
PSTN dial tone frequency upper limit (high byte)
If both addresses Hz (BCD)
PSTN dial tone frequency upper
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
limit (low byte) PSTN dial tone frequency lower limit (high byte)
If both addresses Hz (BCD)
PSTN dial tone frequency lower
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
limit (low byte) 20 ms
680508
PSTN dial tone detection time
680509
PSTN dial tone reset time (LOW)
68050A
PSTN dial tone reset time (HIGH)
D432/D433
Remarks
106 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
If 680508 contains FF(H), the machine pauses for the pause time (address 68050D /
SM
NCU Parameters Address 68050B
68050C
Function
68050E).
time
Italy: See Note 2.
PSTN dial tone permissible drop time PSTN wait interval (LOW)
68050E
PSTN wait interval (HIGH)
680510
Remarks
PSTN dial tone continuous tone
68050D
68050F
Unit
-
PSTN ring-back tone detection time PSTN ring-back tone off detection time
20 ms
Detection is disabled if this contains FF.
20 ms
-
20 ms
-
20 ms
-
PSTN detection time for silent 680511
period after ring-back tone detected (LOW) PSTN detection time for silent
680512
period after ring-back tone detected (HIGH)
680513
680514
680515
680516
680517 680518
SM
PSTN busy tone frequency upper limit (high byte)
If both addresses Hz (BCD)
PSTN busy tone frequency upper
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
limit (low byte) PSTN busy tone frequency lower limit (high byte)
If both addresses Hz (BCD)
PSTN busy tone frequency lower
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
limit (low byte) PABX dial tone frequency upper limit (high byte)
If both addresses Hz (BCD)
PABX dial tone frequency upper
107 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
NCU Parameters Address
Function
Unit
Remarks
limit (low byte) 680519
68051A
PABX dial tone frequency lower limit (high byte)
Hz (BCD)
PABX dial tone frequency lower
PABX dial tone detection time
68051C
PABX dial tone reset time (LOW)
68051D
PABX dial tone reset time (HIGH)
68051F
detection is disabled.
If 68051B contains FF, the machine pauses for the pause time (680520 /
PABX dial tone continuous tone 20 ms
time
680521).
PABX dial tone permissible drop time
680520
PABX wait interval (LOW)
680521
PABX wait interval (HIGH)
680522
PABX ringback tone detection time 20 ms
680523
contain FF(H), tone
limit (low byte)
68051B
68051E
If both addresses
-
PABX ringback tone off detection time
If both addresses contain FF(H), tone
20 ms
detection is disabled.
PABX detection time for silent 680524
period after ringback tone
20 ms
detected (LOW)
contain FF(H), tone
PABX detection time for silent 680525
If both addresses
period after ringback tone
detection is disabled. 20 ms
detected (HIGH) 680526 680527
D432/D433
PABX busy tone frequency upper limit (high byte)
If both addresses Hz (BCD)
PABX busy tone frequency upper
108 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
SM
NCU Parameters Address
Function
Unit
Remarks
limit (low byte) 680528
680529
PABX busy tone frequency lower limit (high byte)
Hz (BCD)
PABX busy tone frequency lower
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
limit (low byte)
68052A
Busy tone ON time: range 1
68052B
Busy tone OFF time: range 1
68052C
Busy tone ON time: range 2
68052D
Busy tone OFF time: range 2
68052E
Busy tone ON time: range 3
68052F
Busy tone OFF time: range 3
680530
Busy tone ON time: range 4
680531
Busy tone OFF time: range 4
680532
If both addresses
20 ms
-
20 ms
Busy tone continuous tone detection time Busy tone signal state time tolerance for all ranges, and number of cycles required for detection (a setting of 4 cycles means that ON-OFF-ON or OFF-ON-OFF must be detected twice). Tolerance (±)
680533
Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 75% Bits 2 and 3 must always be kept at 0. Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 50% Bits 2 and 3 must always be kept at 0. Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 25% Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 12.5% Bits 7, 6, 5, 4 - number of cycles required for cadence detection
680534 680535
SM
International dial tone frequency upper limit (high byte)
If both addresses Hz (BCD)
International dial tone frequency
109 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
NCU Parameters Address
Function
Unit
Remarks
upper limit (low byte) 680536
680537
680538
680539
68053A
68053B
68053C
68053D
68053E
68053F
680540
680541
680542
D432/D433
International dial tone frequency lower limit (high byte)
If both addresses Hz (BCD)
International dial tone frequency
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
lower limit (low byte) International dial tone detection time International dial tone reset time If 680538 contains FF,
(LOW)
the machine pauses for
International dial tone reset time
the pause time (68053D
(HIGH)
/ 68053E).
International dial tone continuous tone time
20 ms
Belgium: See Note 2.
International dial tone permissible drop time International dial wait interval (LOW)
-
International dial wait interval (HIGH) Country dial tone upper frequency
If both addresses
limit (HIGH)
contain FF(H), tone
Country dial tone upper frequency limit (LOW)
detection is disabled. Hz (BCD)
Country dial tone lower frequency limit (HIGH)
If both addresses contain FF(H), tone
Country dial tone lower frequency
detection is disabled.
limit (LOW)
110 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
NCU Parameters Address 680543 680544
680545
680546
680547
Function
Unit
Country dial tone detection time If 680543 contains FF,
Country dial tone reset time 20 ms
(LOW)
the machine pauses for the pause time (680548 / 680549).
Country dial tone reset time (HIGH) Country dial tone continuous tone time
-
-
20 ms
-
Country dial tone permissible drop time
680548
Country dial wait interval (LOW)
680549
Country dial wait interval (HIGH) Time between opening or closing
68054A
Remarks
the DO relay and opening the
See Notes 3, 6 and 8. 1 ms
OHDI relay
SP2-103-012 (parameter 11). See Note 3.
68054B
Break time for pulse dialing
1 ms
SP2-103-013 (parameter 12). See Note 3.
68054C
Make time for pulse dialing
1 ms
SP2-103-014 (parameter 13). See Notes 3, 6 and 8. SP2-103-015
Time between final OHDI relay 68054D
closure and DO relay opening or
1 ms
(parameter 14). This parameter is only
closing
valid in Europe.
68054E
SM
Minimum pause between dialed digits (pulse dial mode)
See Note 3 and 8. 20 ms
SP2-103-016 (parameter 15).
111 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
NCU Parameters Address
68054F
680550
Function
Unit
SP2-103-017
Time waited when a pause is
(parameter 16). See
entered at the operation panel
Note 3. SP2-103-018
DTMF tone on time 1 ms
680551
680552
Remarks
(parameter 17). SP2-103-019
DTMF tone off time
(parameter 18).
Tone attenuation level of DTMF
-N x 0.5
signals while dialing
–3.5 dBm
SP2-103-020 (parameter 19). See Note 5. SP2-103-021 (parameter 20).
Tone attenuation value difference 680553
between high frequency tone and low frequency tone in DTMF
The setting must be less -dBm x 0.5
than –5dBm, and should not exceed the setting at
signals
680552h above. See Note 5.
680554
680556
680557
680558
680559
D432/D433
PSTN: DTMF tone attenuation
-N x 0.5
level after dialling
–3.5 dBm
Not used
-
SP2-103-022 (parameter 21). See Note 5. Do not change the settings.
Time between 68054Dh (NCU
This parameter takes
parameter 14) and 68054Eh (NCU 1 ms
effect when the country
parameter 15)
code is set to France.
Not used
-
Grounding time (ground start
20 ms
mode)
112 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Do not change the setting. The Gs relay is closed for this interval.
SM
NCU Parameters Address 68055A
68055B
68055C
Function
Unit
Break time (flash start mode)
1 ms
International dial access code
Remarks The OHDI relay is open for this interval.
For a code of 100:
(High)
BCD
International dial access code
68055B - F1 68055C - 00
(Low) This time is waited for each pause input after the PSTN access code. If this address contains
68055D
PSTN access pause time
20 ms
FF[H], the pause time stored in address 68054F is used. Do not set a number more than 7 in the UK.
Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 0 = -25.0 dBm Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 1 = -35.0 dBm 68055E
Progress tone detection level, and
Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 0 = -30.0 dBm
cadence detection enable flags
Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 0 = -40.0 dBm Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 0 = -49.0 dBm Bits 2, 0 - See Note 2.
68055F To
Not used
-
Long distance call prefix (HIGH)
BCD
680564 680565
Do not change the settings. For a code of 0: 680565 – FF
680566
Long distance call prefix (LOW)
BCD
Not used
-
680567 to 680571
SM
113 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
680566 - FF Do not change the settings.
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
NCU Parameters Address 680572
680573
680574
680575
Function
Unit
Remarks
Acceptable ringing signal
SP2-103-003
frequency: range 1, upper limit
(parameter 02).
Acceptable ringing signal
SP2-103-004
frequency: range 1, lower limit
1000/ N (Hz).
Acceptable ringing signal
(parameter 03). SP2-103-005
frequency: range 2, upper limit
(parameter 04).
Acceptable ringing signal
SP2-103-006
frequency: range 2, lower limit
(parameter 05). SP2-103-007
680576
Number of rings until a call is
1
detected
(parameter 06). The setting must not be zero.
680577
680578
680579
68057A
Minimum required length of the first ring
See Note 4. 20 ms
(parameter 07).
Minimum required length of the second and subsequent rings
20 ms
Ringing signal detection reset time (LOW)
SP2-103-009 (parameter 08). SP2-103-010
20 ms
(parameter 09).
Ringing signal detection reset time
SP2-103-011 (parameter
(HIGH)
10).
68057B to
SP2-103-008
-
Not used
680580
Do not change the settings.
Interval between dialing the last digit and switching the Oh relay 680581
20 ms
over to the external telephone
Factory setting: 500 ms
when dialing from the operation panel in handset mode.
D432/D433
114 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
NCU Parameters Address
Function
Unit
Remarks
Bits 0 and 1 - Handset off-hook detection time Bit 1:0, Bit 0: 0 = 200 ms Bit 1:0, Bit 0: 1 = 800 ms Other Not used 680582
Bits 2 and 3 - Handset on-hook detection time
-
Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 0 = 200 ms Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 1 = 800 ms Other Not used Bits 4 to 7 - Not used 680583 To
-
Not used
6805A0 6805A1
6805A2
6805A3
6805A4
6805A5
6805A6
6805A7
6805A8 6805A9
SM
Acceptable CED detection frequency upper limit (high byte)
Do not change the settings.
If both addresses BCD (Hz)
Acceptable CED detection
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
frequency upper limit (low byte) Acceptable CED detection frequency lower limit (high byte)
If both addresses BCD (Hz)
Acceptable CED detection
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
frequency lower limit (low byte) 20 ms ± 20
CED detection time
ms
Acceptable CNG detection frequency upper limit (high byte)
Factory setting: 200 ms
If both addresses BCD (Hz)
Acceptable CNG detection
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
frequency upper limit (low byte) Acceptable CNG detection
If both addresses
frequency lower limit (high byte)
BCD (Hz)
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
Acceptable CNG detection
115 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
NCU Parameters Address
Function
Unit
Remarks
frequency lower limit (low byte) Do not change the
6805AA
Not used
-
6805AB
CNG on time
20 ms
Factory setting: 500 ms
6805AC
CNG off time
20 ms
Factory setting: 3000 ms
6805AD
6805AE
Number of CNG cycles required for detection
setting.
The data is coded in the -
same way as address 680533.
-
Not used
Do not change the settings.
Acceptable AI short protocol tone 6805AF
(800Hz) detection frequency
If both addresses
upper limit (high byte)
Hz (BCD)
Acceptable AI short protocol tone 6805B0
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
(800Hz) detection frequency upper limit (low byte) Acceptable AI short protocol tone
6805B1
(800Hz) detection frequency lower limit (high byte)
If both addresses Hz(BCD)
Acceptable AI short protocol tone 6805B2
contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
(800Hz) detection frequency lower limit (low byte)
6805B3
6805B4
6805B5
D432/D433
Detection time for 800 Hz AI short protocol tone
20 ms
Factory setting: 360 ms SP2-103-002
PSTN: Tx level from the modem
-N – 3 dBm
PSTN: 1100 Hz tone transmission
- N 6805B4 - 0.5N 6805B5 –3.5 (dB)
level
See Note 7.
116 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
(parameter 01).
SM
NCU Parameters Address 6805B6 6805B7 6805B8
6805B9
6805BD
Function
Unit
PSTN: 2100 Hz tone transmission
- N6805B4 - 0.5N 6805B6 –3 (dB)
level
See Note 7.
PABX: Tx level from the modem PABX: 1100 Hz tone transmission level PABX: 2100 Hz tone transmission level
- dBm - N 6805B7 - 0.5N 6805B8 (dB)
- N 6805B7 - 0.5N 6805B9 (dB)
Modem turn-on level (incoming
-37-0.5N
signal detection level)
(dBm)
Not used
-
6805BE to
Remarks
6805C6
Do not change the settings.
Bits 0 to 3 – Not used 6805C7
Bit 4 = V.34 protocol dump
0: Simple, 1: Detailed (default)
Bits 5 to 7 – Not used. 6805C8 to
Not used
-
T.30 T1 timer
1s
6805D9 6805DA
Do not change the settings.
1: Maximum wait time for post message (EOP/EOM/MPS) can 6805E0 bit Maximum wait time for post
0: 12 s
be changed to 30 s.
3
1: 30 s
Change this bit to “1” if
message
communication errors occur frequently during V.17 reception.
SM
117 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
NCU Parameters Address
Function Voltage setting to detect off-hook
0: Auto
for voltage/DP detection for
1: Fixed V
anexternally connected line.
Here is a summary of the fixed voltage settings (1: Fixed) for an externally connected line.
6805E3
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
0
0
0
0
Not used
0
0
0
1
2.75 V
0
0
1
0
5.5 V
1
0
0
0
22 V
1
1
1
1
41.25 V
Bit 1
Bit 1 sets the level 6805E4
of the call signal, Bit 3 sets the call signal impedance
-
0
RT=0 (Low)
1
RT=1 (High)
0
RZ=0 (High)
Bit 3 1
6805E5
Bit 0 sets the ring
Bit 0
detection method, Bit 1 sets the ring detection method
Bit 1
when fixed.
Do not change these settings
-
RZ=1 (Composite)
0
Auto
1
Fixed
0
Use RDTP
1
Use RDTN
If any setting is changed, select a setting that is higher than the default setting.
Here is a summary of the voltages for the detection of off-hook for DP detection.
D432/D433
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
0
0
0
0
Not used
118 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
NCU Parameters Address
Function 0
0
0
1
2.75 V
0
0
1
0
5.5 V
1
0
0
0
22 V
1
1
1
1
41.25 V
NOTES 1.
If a setting is not required, store FF in the address.
2.
Italy and Belgium only RAM address 68055E: the lower four bits have the following meaning. Bit 2 - 1: International dial tone cadence detection enabled (Belgium) Bit 1 - Not used Bit 0 - 1: PSTN dial tone cadence detection enabled (Italy) If bit 0 or bit 2 is set to 1, the functions of the following RAM addresses are changed. 680508 (if bit 0 = 1) or 680538 (if bit 2 = 1): tolerance for on or off state duration (%), and number of cycles required for detection, coded as in address 680533. 68050B (if bit 0 = 1) or 68053B (if bit 2 = 1): on time, hex code (unit = 20 ms) 68050C (if bit 0 = 1) or 68053C (if bit 2 = 1): off time, hex code (unit = 20 ms)
3.
Pulse dial parameters (addresses 68054A to 68054F) are the values for 10 pps. If 20 pps is used, the machine automatically compensates.
4.
The first ring may not be detected until 1 to 2.5 wavelengths after the time specified by this parameter.
5.
The calculated level must be between 0 and 10. The attenuation levels calculated from RAM data are: High frequency tone:
– 0.5 x N680552/680554–3.5 dBm
– 0.5 x N680555 dBm
Low frequency tone:
– 0.5 x (N680552/680554 + N680553) –3.5 dBm
– 0.5 x (N680555 + N680553) dBm
SM
N680552, for example, means the value stored in address 680552(H) 119 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
NCU Parameters 6.
68054A: Europe - Between Ds opening and Di opening, France - Between Ds closing and Di opening 68054D: Europe - Between Ds closing and Di closing, France - Between Ds opening and Di closing
7.
Tone signals which frequency is lower than 1500Hz (e.g., 800Hz tone for AI short protocol) refer to the setting at 6805B5h. Tones which frequency is higher than 1500Hz refer to the setting at 6805B6h.
8.
68054A, 68054D, 68054E: The actual inter-digit pause (pulse dial mode) is the sum of the period specified by the RAM addresses 68054A, 68054D, and
D432/D433
120 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
68054E.
SM
Dedicated Transmission Parameters
4.5 DEDICATED TRANSMISSION PARAMETERS There are two sets of transmission parameters: Fax and E-mail Each Quick Dial Key and Speed Dial Code has eight bytes of programmable parameters allocated to it. If transmissions to a particular machine often experience problems, store that terminal’s fax number as a Quick Dial or Speed Dial, and adjust the parameters allocated to that number. The programming procedure will be explained first. Then, the eight bytes will be described.
4.5.1 PROGRAMMING PROCEDURE 1.
Set the bit 0 of System Bit Switch 00 to 1.
2.
Enter Address Book Management mode ([User Tools]> System Settings> Key Operator> Address Book Management).
3.
Select the address book that you want to program.
4.
For the fax parameter, select "Fax Dest.", for the E-mail parameter, select "E-mail", then press “Start”. Make sure that the LED of the Start button lights green.
5.
The settings for the switch 00 are now displayed. Press the bit number that you wish to change.
6.
To scroll through the parameter switches, either:
7.
Select the next switch: press “Next” or Select the previous switch: “Prev.” until the correct switch is displayed. Then go back to step 6.
8.
After the setting is changed, press “OK”.
9.
After finishing, reset bit 0 of System Bit Switch 00 to 0.
4.5.2 PARAMETERS Fax Parameters The initial settings of the following fax parameters are all FF(H) - all the parameters are disabled.
Switch 00 FUNCTION AND COMMENTS ITU-T T1 time (for PSTN G3 mode) If the connection time to a particular terminal is longer than the NCU parameter setting, adjust this byte. The T1 time is the value stored in this byte (in hex code), multiplied by 1
SM
121 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Dedicated Transmission Parameters second. Range: 0 to 120 s (00h to 78h) FFh - The local NCU parameter factory setting is used. Do not program a value between 79h and FEh.
Switch 01 No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Tx level Bit4
Bit3
Bit2
Bit1
Bit0
0
0
0
0
0
If communication with a particular 0
remote terminal often contains errors, the signal level may be
0-4
0
0
0
0
1
–1
0
0
0
1
0
–2
0
0
0
1
1
–3
0
0
1
0
0
–4
↓
↓
↓
↓
↓
↓
0
1
1
1
1
–15
1
1
1
1
1
Disabled
inappropriate. Adjust the Tx level for communications with that terminal until the results are better. If the setting is “Disabled”, the NCU parameter 01 setting is used.
Do not use settings other than listed on the left.
Use a higher setting if there is signal loss at higher frequencies because of the length of wire between the
Cable equalizer
modem and the telephone exchange
Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 0 = None 5-7
when calling the number stored in
Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0, Bit 5: 1 = Low
this Quick/Speed Dial.
Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 0 = Medium
Also, try using the cable equalizer if
Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 1 = High
one or more of the following
Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 1, Bit 5: 1 = Disabled
symptoms occurs. Communication error with error codes such as 0-20, 0-23, etc.
D432/D433
122 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Dedicated Transmission Parameters Modem rate fallback occurs frequently.
Do not use settings other than listed on the left.
If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is used.
Switch 02 No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
0-3 Initial Tx modem rate
If training with a particular remote terminal
Bit3
Bit2
Bit1
Bit0
bps
0
0
0
0
Not used
0
0
0
1
2400
0
0
1
0
4800
0
0
1
1
7200
0
1
0
0
9600
0
1
0
1
12000
0
1
1
0
14400
0
1
1
1
16800
1
0
0
0
19200
1
0
0
1
21600
1
0
1
0
24000
1
0
1
1
26400
1
1
0
0
28800
1
1
0
1
31200
always takes too long, the initial modem rate may be too high. Reduce the initial Tx modem rate using these bits. For the settings 14.4 or kbps slower, Switch 04 bit 4 must be changed to 0.
Do not use settings other than listed on the left. If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is used.
SM
123 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Dedicated Transmission Parameters 1
1
1
0
33600
1
1
1
1
Disabled
Other settings: Not used 4-7 Not used
Do not change the settings.
Switch 03 No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Inch-mm conversion before tx Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = Inch-mm conversion 0-1 available Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = Inch only Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = Not used Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = Disabled DIS/NSF detection method Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 0 = First DIS or NSF 2-3 Bit 3: 0, Bit 2: 1 = Second DIS or NSF Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 0 = Not used Bit 3: 1, Bit 2: 1 = Disabled
The machine uses inch-based resolutions for scanning. If “inch only” is selected, the printed copy may be slightly distorted at the other end if that machine uses mm-based resolutions. If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is used.
(0, 1): Use this setting if echoes on the line are interfering with the set-up protocol at the start of transmission. The machine will then wait for the second DIS or NSF before sending DCS or NSS. If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is used. If transmissions to a specific destination always
V.8 protocol 4
0: Off 1: Disabled
end at a lower modem rate (14,400 bps or lower), disable V.8 protocol so as not to use V.34 protocol. 0: V.34 communication will not be possible. If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is used.
Compression modes available This bit determines the capabilities that are 5
in transmit mode
informed to the other terminal during transmission.
0: MH only
If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is
1: Disabled
used.
D432/D433
124 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Dedicated Transmission Parameters For example, if ECM is switched on but is not wanted when sending to a particular terminal, use ECM during transmission
the (0, 0) setting.
Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 0 = Off 6-7 Bit 7: 0, Bit 6: 1 = On
V.8/V.34 protocol and JBIG compression
Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 0 = Not used
are automatically disabled if ECM is
Bit 7: 1, Bit 6: 1 = Disabled
disabled.
If the setting is “Disabled”, the bit switch setting is used.
Switch 04 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 05 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings)
E-mail Parameters The initial settings of the following e-mail parameters are all "0" (all parameters disabled).
Switch 00 No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
MH Compression mode 0
for e-mail attachments
Switches MH compression on and off for files
0: Off
attached to e-mails for sending.
1: On MR Compression mode 1
for e-mail attachments
Switches MR compression on and off for files
0: Off
attached to e-mails for sending.
1: On
SM
125 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Dedicated Transmission Parameters MMR Compression mode 2
for e-mail attachments
Switches MMR compression on and off for files
0: Off
attached to e-mails for sending.
1: On 3-6
Do not change these settings.
Not used Designates the bits to reference for
7
The "0" selection (default) references the settings for
compression method of
Bits 00, 01, 02 above. The "1" selection ignores the
e-mail attachments
selections of Bits 00, 01, 02.
0: Registered (Bit 0 to 6) 1: No registration.
Switch 01 No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Original width of e-mail 0
attachment: A4
Sets the original width of the e-mail attachment as
0: Off
A4.
1: On Original width of e-mail 1
attachment: B4
Sets the original width of the e-mail attachment as
0: Off
B4.
1: On Original width of e-mail 2
attachment: A3
Sets the original width of the e-mail attachment as
0: Off
A3.
1: On 3-6
Do not change these settings.
Not used Designates the bits to
7
reference for original size of e-mail attachments 0: Registered (Bit 0 to 6)
D432/D433
The "0" selection (default) references the settings for Bits 00, 01, 02 above. The "1" selection ignores the selections of Bits 00, 01, 02.
126 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Dedicated Transmission Parameters 1: No registration.
Switch 02 No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Line resolution of e-mail 0
attachment: 200 x 100
Sets the line resolution of the e-mail attachment as
0: Off
200 x100.
1: On Line resolution of e-mail 1
attachment: 200 x 200
Sets the line resolution of the e-mail attachment as
0: Off
200 x 200.
1: On Line resolution of e-mail 2
attachment: 200 x 400
Sets the line resolution of the e-mail attachment as
0: Off
200 x 400.
1: On 3
Not used
Do not change these settings.
Line resolution of e-mail 4
attachment: 400 x 400
Sets the line resolution of the e-mail attachment as
0: Off
400 x 400.
1: On 5-6
Not used
Do not change these settings.
Designates the bits to reference for original size The "0" selection (default) references the settings for 7
of e-mail attachments
Bits 00, 01, 02, 04 above. The "1" selection ignores
0: Registered (Bit 0 to 6)
the selections of Bits 00, 01, 02, 04.
1: No registration.
Switch 03 - Not used (do not change the settings)
SM
127 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Dedicated Transmission Parameters Switch 04 No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS If the other ends have the addresses, which have
0
Full mode address
the full mode function flag ("0"), this machine
selection
determines them as full mode standard machines.
0: Full mode address
This machine attaches the "demand of reception confirmation" to a message when transmitting.
1: No full mode (simple mode)
This machine updates the reception capability to the address book when receiving.
1-7
Do not change these settings.
Not used
Switch 05 No
FUNCTION
COMMENTS
Directr transmission 0
selection to SMTP server
Allows or does not allow the direct transmission to
0: ON
SMTP server.
1: OFF 1-7
Not used
Do not change these settings.
Switch 06 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 07 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 08 - Not used (do not change the settings) Switch 09 - Not used (do not change the settings)
D432/D433
128 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Service RAM Addresses
4.6 SERVICE RAM ADDRESSES
Do not change the settings which are marked as “Not used” or “Read only.”
680001 to 680004(H) - ROM version (Read only) 680001(H) - Revision number (BCD) 680002(H) - Year (BCD) 680003(H) - Month (BCD) 680004(H) - Day (BCD) 680006 to 680015(H) - Machine’s serial number (16 digits - ASCII) 680018(H) - Total program checksum (low) 680019(H) - Total program checksum (high) 680020 to 68003F(H) - System bit switches 680050 to 68005F(H) - Printer bit switches 680060 to 68007F(H) - Communication bit switches 680080 to 68008F(H) - G3 bit switches 680090 to 68009F(H) - G3-2 bit switches: Not used 6800A0 to 6800AF(H) - G3-3 bit switches: Not used 6800D0(H) - User parameter switch 00 (SWUER_00) : Not used 6800D1(H) - User parameter switch 01 (SWUSR_01) : Not used 6800D2(H) - User parameter switch 02 (SWUSR_02) Bit 0: Forwarding mark printing on forwarded messages
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Bit 1: Center mark printing on received copies (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 2: Reception time printing (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 3: TSI print on received messages 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 4: Checkered mark printing (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 5: Not used Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Not used 6800D3(H) - User parameter switch 03 (SWUSR_03: Automatic report printout)
SM
129 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service RAM Addresses Bit 0: Transmission result report (memory transmissions) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 1: Not used Bit 2: Memory storage report 0: Off, 1: On Bit 3: Polling reserve report (polling reception) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 4: Polling result report (polling reception) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 5: Transmission result report (immediate transmissions) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Journal 0: Off, 1: On 6800D4(H) - User parameter switch 04 (SWUSR_04: Automatic report printout) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: Automatic communication failure report and transfer result report output 0: Off, 1: On Bits 2 to 3: Not used Bit 4: Indicates the parties 0: Not indicated, 1: Indicated Bit 5: Include sender’s name on reports 0: Off, 1: On Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Inclusion of a sample image on reports
0: Off, 1: On
6800D5(H) - User parameter switch 05 (SWUSR_05) Bit 0: Substitute reception when the base copier is in an SC condition 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled Bits 1 and 2: Condition for substitute rx when the machine cannot print messages (Paper end, toner end, jam, and during night mode) Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 0 = The machine receives all the fax messages. Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 1 = The machine receives the fax messages with RTI or CSI. Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 0 = The machine receives the fax messages with the same ID code. Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 1 =
The machine does not receive anything.
Bit 3: Not used Bit 4: Not used Bit 5: Just size printing 0: Off, 1: On Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Add paper display when a cassette is empty 0: Off, 1: On 6800D6(H) - User parameter switch 06 (SWUSR_06): Not used 6800D7(H) - User parameter switch 07 (SWUSR_07) Bit 0 Ringing 0: Off, 1: On Bit1: Automatic answering message 0: Off, 1: On Bit 2: Parallel memory transmission 0: Off, 1: On Bits 3 and 4: Not used
D432/D433
130 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Service RAM Addresses Bit 5: Remote control 0: Off, 1: On Bits 6 and 7: Not used 6800D8(H) - User parameter switch 08 (SWUSR_08) Bits 0 and 1: Not used. Bit 2: Authorized reception 0: Only faxes from senders whose RTIs/CSIs are specified for this feature are accepted. 1: Only faxes from senders whose RTIs/CSIs are not specified for this feature are accepted. Bits 3 to 7: Not used. 6800D9(H) - User parameter switch 09 (SWUSR_09): Not used 6800DA(H) - User parameter switch 10 (SWUSR_0A) Bits 0 to 2: Not used Bit 3: Page reduction 0: Off, 1: On Bits 4 and 5: Not used Bit 6: Use both e-mail notification and printed reports to confirm the transmission results 0: Off, 1: On Bit 7: Not used 6800DB(H) - User parameter switch 11 (SWUSR_0B) Bits 0 and 1: Not used Bit 2: White original detection 0: Off, 1: On (alarm and alert message on the LCD) Bit 3: Receive rejection for 1300 Hz transmission 0: Off (receive), 1: On (not receive) Bit 5: Not used Bit 6: Printout of messages received while acting as a forwarding station 0: Off, 1: On Bit 7: Not used 6800DC(H) - User parameter switch 12 (SWUSR_0C): Not used 6800DD(H) - User parameter switch 13 (SWUSR_0D): Not used 6800DE(H) - User parameter switch 14 (SWUSR_0E) Bit 0: Message printout while the machine is in Night Printing mode 0: On, 1: Off Bit 1: Maximum document length detection 0: Double letter, 1: Longer than double-letter (well log) – up to 1,200 mm Bit 2: Not used Bit 3: Fax mode settings, such as resolution, before a mode key (Copy/Fax/Printer/Scanner) is pressed 0: Not cleared, 1: Cleared Bits 4 to 6: Not used Bit 7: Not used 6800DF(H) - User parameter switch 15 (SWUSR_0F)
SM
131 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service RAM Addresses (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) Bits 0, 1 and 2: Cassette for fax printout Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = 1st paper feed station Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 0 = 2nd paper feed station Bit 2: 0, Bit 1: 1, Bit 0: 1 = 3rd paper feed station Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 0 = 4th paper feed station Bit 2: 1, Bit 1: 0, Bit 0: 1 = LCT Other settings Not used Bits 3 and 4: Not used Bit 5: Using the cassette specified by bits 0, 1 and 2 above only 0: On, 1: Off Bits 6 and 7: Not used 6800E0(H) – User parameter switch 16 (SWUSR_10) (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) Bits 0 and 1: Not used Bit 2: Paper size selection priority for an A4 size fax message when A4/LT size paper is not available. 0: A3 has priority, 1: B4 has priority Bits 3 to 7: Not used 6800E1(H) – User parameter switch 17 (SWUSR_11) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: Not used Bit 2: Inclusion of the “Add” button when a sequence of Quick/Speed dials is selected for broadcasting 0:Not needed, 1: Needed Bits 3 to 6: Not used Bit 7: Press “Start” key without an original when using the on hook dial or the external telephone, 0: displays “Cannot detect original size”. 1: Receives fax messages. 6800E2(H) - User parameter switch 18 (SWUSR_12) Bit 0: TTI date 0: Off, 1: On Bit 1: TTI sender
0: Off, 1: On
Bit 2: TTI file number
0: Off, 1: On
Bit 3: TTI page number
0: Off, 1: On
Bits 4 to 6: Not used Bit 7: Japan only 6800E3(H) - User parameter switch 19 (SWUSR_13) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: Journal format
D432/D433
132 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Service RAM Addresses 0: The Journal is separated into transmissions and receptions 1: The Journal is separated into G3-1, G3-2, and G3-3 communications Bit 2: Not used Bit 3: 90° image rotation during B5 portrait Tx (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 4: Reduction of sample images on reports to 50% in the main scan and sub-scan directions. (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Technician adjustment (printer switch 0E bits 3 and 4), 1: 50% reduction Bit 5: Use of A5 size paper for reports (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Off, 1: On Bits 6 and 7: Not used 6800E4(H) - User parameter switch 20 (SWUSR_14) Bit 0: Automatic printing of the LAN fax result report 0: Off, 1: On Bit 1: Not used. Bits 2 to 5: Store documents in memory which could not be printed from PC fax (LAN fax) driver
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Setting
0
0
0
0
0 min.
0
0
0
1
1 min.
↓
↓
↓
↓
↓
1
1
1
0
14 min.
1
1
1
1
15 min.
Bits 6 and 7: Not used. 6800E5(H) - User parameter switch 21 (SWUSR_15) Bit 0: Print results of sending reception notice request message 0: Disabled (print only when error occurs), 1: Enabled Bit 1: Respond to e-mail reception acknowledgment request 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 2: Not used Bit 3: File format for forwarded folders 0: TIFF, 1:PDF Bit 4: Transmit Journal by E-mail 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 5: Not used
SM
133 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service RAM Addresses Bit 6: Network error display 0: Displayed, 1: Not displayed Bit 7: Transmit error mail notification 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled 6800E6(H)
- User parameter switch 22 (SWUSR_16)
(This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) Bit 0: Dial tone detection (PSTN 1) 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bits 1 to 7: Not used 6800E7(H) – User parameter switch 23 (SWUSR_17): Not used 6800E8(H) - User parameter switch 24 (SWUSR_18): Not used 6800E9(H) - User parameter switch 25 (SWUSR_19) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: Reception mode switch timer 0: Off, 1: On (switching Fax or Fax/Tel) Bit 2: Mode priority switch 0: Fax first, 1: Tel first Bit 3: Dial in function (Japan Only) Bit 4: RDS operation 0: Not acceptable, 1: Acceptable for the limit specified by system switch 03
This bit is only effective when RDS operation can be selected by the user (see system switch 02).
Bits 5 to 7: Not used 6800EA(H) and 6800EB(H) - User parameter switches 26 and 27 (SWUSR_1A and 1B): Not used 6800EC(H) - User parameter switch 28(SWUSR_1C) Xxxxx 6800ED(H) - User parameter switch 29(SWUSR_1D) xxxxxx 6800EE(H) and 6800EF(H) - User parameter switches 30 and 31 (SWUSR_1E and 1F): Not used 6800F0(H) - User parameter switch 32 (SWUSR_20) Bit 0: Quotation priority for a destination when there is no destination of the specified type 0: Paper output priority = Priority order: 1. IP-fax destination, 2. Fax Number, 3. E-mail address, 4. Folder 1: Electric putout order = Priority order: 1. E-mail address, 2. Folder, 3. IP-fax destination, 4. Fax number Bits 1 to 7: Not used 6800F1(H) - User parameter switch 33 (SWUSR_21): Not used 6800F2(H) - User parameter switch 34 (SWUSR_22)
D432/D433
134 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Service RAM Addresses Bit 0: Gatekeeper server used with IP-Fax 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bit 1: SIP server used with IP-Fax 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Bits 2 to 7: Not used 680100 to 68010F(H) - G4 Parameter Switches – Not used 680110 to 68012F(H) - G4 Internal Switches – Not used 680130 to 68016F(H) - Service Switches 680170 to 68017F(H) - IFAX Switches 680180 to 68018F(H) - IP-FAX Switches 680190 to 6801AF(H) - Service station’s fax number (SP3-101) 6801B0 to 6801B9(H) - Own fax PABX extension number 6801BA to 6801C3(H) - Own fax number (PSTN) – Not used 6801C4 to 6801D7(H) - Own fax number (ISDN G4) – Not used 6801D8 to 6801E3(H) - The first subscriber number (ISDN G3) – Not used 6801E4 to 6801EF(H) - The second subscriber number (ISDN G3) – Not used 6801F0 to 6801FB(H) - The first subscriber number (ISDN G4) – Not used 6801FC to 680207(H) - The second subscriber number (ISDN G4) – Not used 680208 to 68021B(H) - PSTN-1 RTI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) - See the following note. 68021C to 68022F(H) - PSTN-2 RTI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) - Not used 680230 to 680246(H) - PSTN-3 RTI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) - Not used 680247 to 680286(H) - TTI 1 (Max. 64 characters - ASCII) - See the following note. 680287 to 6802C6(H) - TTI 2 (Max. 64 characters - ASCII) - Not used 6802C7 to 680306(H) - TTI 3 (Max. 64 characters - ASCII) - Not used 680307 to 68031A(H) - PSTN-1 CSI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) 68031B to 68032E(H) - PSTN-2 CSI (Max.20 characters - ASCII) - Not used 68032F to 680342(H) - PSTN-3 CSI (Max.20 characters - ASCII) - Not used 680343(H) - Number of PSTN-1 CSI characters (Hex) 680344(H) - Number of PSTN-2 CSI characters (Hex) - Not used 680345(H) Number of PSTN-3 CSI characters (Hex) - Not used
If the number of characters is less than the maximum (20 for RTI, 32 for TTI), add a stop code (00[H]) after the last character.
680380 to 680387(H) - Last power off time (Read only) 680380(H) - 01(H) - 24-hour clock, 00(H) - 12-hour clock (AM), 02(H) - 12-hour clock (PM) 680381(H) - Year (BCD) 680382(H) - Month (BCD) 680383(H) - Day (BCD)
SM
135 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service RAM Addresses 680384(H) – Hour 680385(H) – Minute 680386(H) – Second 680387(H) - 00: Monday, 01: Tuesday, 02: Wednesday, /// , 06: Sunday 680394(H) - Optional equipment (Read only – Do not change the settings) Bit 0: Page Memory
0: Not installed, 1: Installed
Bit 1: SAF Memory
0: Not installed, 1: Installed
Bits 2 to 7; Not used 680395(H) - Optional equipment (Read only – Do not change the settings) Bits 0 to 3: Not used Bit 4: G3-2 0: Not installed, 1: Installed Bit 5: G3-3 0: Not installed, 1: Installed Bit 6 and 7: Not used 680406 to 68040A – Option G3 board (G3-2) ROM information (Read only) 680406(H) - Suffix (BCD) 680407(H) - Version (BCD) 680408(H) - Year (BCD) 680409(H) - Month (BCD) 68040A(H) - Day (BCD) 68040B to 68040F – Option G3 board (G3-3) ROM information (Read only) 68040B(H) - Suffix (BCD) 68040C(H) - Version (BCD) 68040D(H) - Year (BCD) 68040E(H) - Month (BCD) 68040F(H) - Day (BCD) 680410(H) - G3-1 Modem ROM version (Read only) 680412(H) - G3-2 Modem ROM version (Read only) 680414(H) - G3-3 Modem ROM version (Read only) 680420(H) - Number of multiple sets print (Read only) 680476(H) - Time for economy transmission (hour in 24h clock format - BCD) 680477(H) - Time for economy transmission (minute - BCD) 680492(H) - Transmission monitor volume 00 - 07(H) 680493(H) - Reception monitor volume 680494(H) - On-hook monitor volume 680495(H) - Dialing monitor volume 680496(H) - Buzzer volume
D432/D433
00 - 07(H) 00 - 07(H)
00 - 07(H)
00 - 07(H)
136 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Service RAM Addresses 680497(H) - Beeper volume
00 - 07(H)
6804A8(H) - Machine code (Check ram 4) 68918E(H) - Gatekeeper server address - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 68920E(H) - Gatekeeper server address - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 68928E(H) - Arias Number (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 68930E(H) - SIP user name (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 68938E(H) - SIP digest authentication password (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 68940E(H) - Gateway address information (Max. 7100 characters - ASCII) 68AFCA(H) - Stand-by port number for H.232 connection 68AFCCH) - Stand-by port number for SIP connection 68AFCE(H) - RAS port number 68AFD0(H) - Gatekeeper port number 68AFD2(H) - Port number of data waiting for T.38 68AFD4(H) - Port number of SIP server 68AFD6(H) - Priority for SIP and H.323 68AFD7(H) - SIP function
0: H.323, 1: SIP
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
68AFD8(H) - H.323 function
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
68AFD9(H) - SIP digest authentication function 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 68AFDA(H) - IP-Fax backup data 00 - 600 (H) - Not used 69ED6A(H) to 69ED92(H) - SIP server address (Read only) 69ED6A(H) - Proxy server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69ED72(H) - Proxy server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69ED7A(H) - Redirect server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69ED82(H) - Redirect server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69ED8A(H) - Registrar server - Main (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 69ED92(H) - Registrar server - Sub (Max. 128 characters - ASCII) 6BEBFE(H) - 6BEC1E (H) - Dial tone detection parameter (Max. 11 x 3 lines) This initializes following order. [0x04, 0x40, 0x03, 0x60, 0x64, 0xf4, 0x01,0x64, 0x04, 0xc8, 0x00] 6BEBFE(H) – Dial tone detection frequency – Upper limit (High) Defaults: NA: 06, EU: 06, ASIA: 06 6BEBFF(H) – Dial tone detection frequency – Upper Limit (Low) Defaults: NA: 50, EU: 50, ASIA: 50 6BEC00(H) – Dial tone detection frequency – Lower Limit (High) Defaults: NA: 03, EU: 02, ASIA: 02 6BEC01(H) – Dial tone detection frequency – Lower Limit (Low)
SM
137 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
Service RAM Addresses Defaults: NA: 60, EU: 90, ASIA: 90 6BEC02(H) –Dial tone detection waiting time (20 ms) Defaults: NA: 64, EU 64, ASIA: 64 6BEC03 to 6BEC04 – Dial tone detection monitoring time (20 ms) Defaults
Area
6BEC03
6BEC04
NA
F4
01
EU
F4
01
ASIA
F4
01
6BEC05(H) – Dial tone detect judge time (20 ms) Defaults: NA: 64, EU: 1B, ASIA: 32 6BEC06(H) – Dial tone disconnect permission time (20 ms) Defaults: NA: 11, EU: 0F, ASIA: 11
D432/D433
138 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
General Specifications
5. SPECIFICATIONS 5.1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS 5.1.1 FCU
Type: Circuit: Connection:
Desktop type transceiver PSTN PABX Direct couple Book (Face down) Maximum Length: 432 mm [17 ins] Maximum Width: 297 mm [11.7 ins] ARDF (Face up)
Original Size:
(Single-sided document) Length: 128 - 1200 mm [5.0 - 47.2 ins] Width: 105 - 297 mm [4.1 - 11.7 inch] (Double-sided document) Length: 128 - 432 mm [5.0 - 17 inch] Width: 105 - 297 mm [4.1 - 11.7 inch]
Scanning Method:
Flat bed, with CCD G3 8 x 3.85 lines/mm (Standard) 8 x 7.7 lines/mm (Detail) 8 x 15.4 line/mm (Fine) See Note1
Resolution:
16 x15.4 line/mm (Super Fine) See Note 1 200 x 100 dpi (Standard) 200 x 200 dpi (Detail) 400 x 400 dpi (Super Fine) See Note 1
SM
Optional Expansion Memory required
139 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
General Specifications G3: 3 s at 28800 bps; Measured with G3 ECM using memory for Transmission Time:
an ITU-T #1 test document (Slerexe letter) at standard resolution
Data Compression:
MH, MR, MMR, JBIG
Protocol:
Group 3 with ECM
Modulation:
V.34, V.33, V.17 (TCM), V.29 (QAM), V.27ter (PHM), V.8, V.21 (FSK) G3: 33600/31200/28800/26400/24000/21600/
Data Rate:
19200/16800/14400/12000/9600/7200/4800/2400 bps Automatic fallback
I/O Rate:
With ECM: 0 ms/line Without ECM: 2.5, 5, 10, 20, or 40 ms/line ECM: 128 KB SAF Standard: 4 MB
Memory Capacity:
With optional Expansion Memory: 28 MB Page Memory Standard: 8 MB (Print: 4 MB + Scanner: 4 MB) With optional Expansion Memory: 16 MB (Print 8 MB + Scanner: 8 MB)
5.1.2 CAPABILITIES OF PROGRAMMABLE ITEMS The following table shows the capabilities of each programmable items.
Item
D432
D433
Total Destinations in Address Book
2000
150
Groups
100
10
Destination per Group
500
100
Destinations for All Files
500
300
D432/D433
140 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
General Specifications Programs
100
-
Special Senders
30
30
The following table shows how the capabilities of the document memory will change after the Expansion Memory are installed.
Without the Expansion
With the Expansion
Memory
Memory
D432
D433
D432
D433
Memory Transmission file
400
200
400
-
320
320
2240
-
Memory capacity for memory transmission (See the Note below)
Measured using an ITU-T #1 test document (Slerexe letter) at standard resolution, auto image density mode, and Text mode.
SM
141 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
IFAX Specifications
5.2 IFAX SPECIFICATIONS
Local area network Connectivity:
Ethernet 100base-Tx/10base-T IEEE802.11a/g, g (wireless LAN), 1000 Base-T Main scan: 400 dpi, 200 dpi
Resolution:
Sub scan: 400 dpi, 200 dpi, 100 dpi
To use 400 dpi, IFAX SW01 Bit 4 must be set to “1”.
1 s (through a LAN to the server) Condition: ITU-T #1 test document (Selerexe Letter) MTF correction: OFF Transmission
TTI: None
Time:
Resolution: 200 x 100 dpi Communication speed: 10 Mbps Correspondent device: E-mail server Line conditions: No terminal access Maximum message width is A4/LT.
Document Size:
To use B4 and A3 width, IFAX SW00 Bit 1 (B4) and/or Bit 2 (A3) must be set to “1”.
E-mail File Format:
Single/multi-part MIME conversion Image: TIFF-F (MH, MR, MMR) Transmission:
Protocol:
SMTP, TCP/IP Reception: POP3, SMTP, IMAP4, TCP/IP
Data Rate:
D432/D433
100 Mbps(100base-Tx) 10 Mbps (10base-T)
142 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
IFAX Specifications Authentication Method: Remark:
SMTP-AUTH POP before SMTP A-POP The machine must be set up as an e-mail client before installation. Any client PCs connected to the machine through a LAN must also be e-mail clients, or some features will not work (e.g. Autorouting).
SM
143 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
IP-FAX Specifications
5.3 IP-FAX SPECIFICATIONS
Local Area Network Network:
Ethernet/10base-T, 100base-TX IEEE802.11a/g, g (wireless LAN), 1000 Base-T 8 x 3.85 lines/mm, 200x100dpi (standard character), 8 x 7.7lines/mm, 200x200dpi (detail character),
Scan line density:
8 x 15.4lines/mm (fine character: optional expansion memory required), 16 x 15.4lines/mm, 400x400dpi (super fine character: optional expansion memory required)
Original size:
Maximum A3 or 11"x 17" (DLT)
Maximum scanning
Standard: A3, 297mm x 432mm
size:
Irregular: 297mm x 1200mm
Transmission
Recommended: T.38 Annex protocol, TCP, UDP/IP
protocol:
communication
Compatible machines:
IP-Fax compatible machines Specify IP address and send fax to an IP-Fax compatible fax
IP-Fax transmission
through a network.
function:
Also capable of sending fax from a G3 fax connected to the public telephone lines via a VoIP gateway. Receive a fax sent from an IP-Fax compatible fax through a
IP-Fax reception
network.
function:
Also capable of receiving fax from a G3 fax connected the public telephone lines via a VoIP gateway.
D432/D433
144 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
SM
Fax Unit Configuration
5.4 FAX UNIT CONFIGURATION
Component
Code
MBU GWFCU
No.
Remarks
3 D432/ D433
Speaker
2
Included with the fax unit
1
Expansion Memory
G578
4
Optional only for D432
Handset Type 1018
B433
-
NA only. Also used with AT/AP-C2
SM
145 CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA
D432/D433
D432/D433 Fax Option Type C2550/C2530
CÓPIA NÃO CONTROLADA